2019-03-11 09:18:55 -07:00

34389 lines
1.2 MiB
Raw Blame History

This file contains ambiguous Unicode characters

This file contains Unicode characters that might be confused with other characters. If you think that this is intentional, you can safely ignore this warning. Use the Escape button to reveal them.

// Code generated by private/model/cli/gen-api/main.go. DO NOT EDIT.
package rds
import (
"fmt"
"time"
"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/aws"
"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/aws/awsutil"
"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/aws/request"
"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/private/protocol"
"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/private/protocol/query"
)
const opAddRoleToDBCluster = "AddRoleToDBCluster"
// AddRoleToDBClusterRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
// client's request for the AddRoleToDBCluster operation. The "output" return
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
// successfully.
//
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
//
// See AddRoleToDBCluster for more information on using the AddRoleToDBCluster
// API call, and error handling.
//
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
//
//
// // Example sending a request using the AddRoleToDBClusterRequest method.
// req, resp := client.AddRoleToDBClusterRequest(params)
//
// err := req.Send()
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
// fmt.Println(resp)
// }
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/AddRoleToDBCluster
func (c *RDS) AddRoleToDBClusterRequest(input *AddRoleToDBClusterInput) (req *request.Request, output *AddRoleToDBClusterOutput) {
op := &request.Operation{
Name: opAddRoleToDBCluster,
HTTPMethod: "POST",
HTTPPath: "/",
}
if input == nil {
input = &AddRoleToDBClusterInput{}
}
output = &AddRoleToDBClusterOutput{}
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
req.Handlers.Unmarshal.Swap(query.UnmarshalHandler.Name, protocol.UnmarshalDiscardBodyHandler)
return
}
// AddRoleToDBCluster API operation for Amazon Relational Database Service.
//
// Associates an Identity and Access Management (IAM) role from an Amazon Aurora
// DB cluster. For more information, see Authorizing Amazon Aurora MySQL to
// Access Other AWS Services on Your Behalf (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/AuroraUserGuide/AuroraMySQL.Integrating.Authorizing.html)
// in the Amazon Aurora User Guide.
//
// This action only applies to Aurora DB clusters.
//
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
// the error.
//
// See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Relational Database Service's
// API operation AddRoleToDBCluster for usage and error information.
//
// Returned Error Codes:
// * ErrCodeDBClusterNotFoundFault "DBClusterNotFoundFault"
// DBClusterIdentifier doesn't refer to an existing DB cluster.
//
// * ErrCodeDBClusterRoleAlreadyExistsFault "DBClusterRoleAlreadyExists"
// The specified IAM role Amazon Resource Name (ARN) is already associated with
// the specified DB cluster.
//
// * ErrCodeInvalidDBClusterStateFault "InvalidDBClusterStateFault"
// The requested operation can't be performed while the cluster is in this state.
//
// * ErrCodeDBClusterRoleQuotaExceededFault "DBClusterRoleQuotaExceeded"
// You have exceeded the maximum number of IAM roles that can be associated
// with the specified DB cluster.
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/AddRoleToDBCluster
func (c *RDS) AddRoleToDBCluster(input *AddRoleToDBClusterInput) (*AddRoleToDBClusterOutput, error) {
req, out := c.AddRoleToDBClusterRequest(input)
return out, req.Send()
}
// AddRoleToDBClusterWithContext is the same as AddRoleToDBCluster with the addition of
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
//
// See AddRoleToDBCluster for details on how to use this API operation.
//
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
// for more information on using Contexts.
func (c *RDS) AddRoleToDBClusterWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *AddRoleToDBClusterInput, opts ...request.Option) (*AddRoleToDBClusterOutput, error) {
req, out := c.AddRoleToDBClusterRequest(input)
req.SetContext(ctx)
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
return out, req.Send()
}
const opAddRoleToDBInstance = "AddRoleToDBInstance"
// AddRoleToDBInstanceRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
// client's request for the AddRoleToDBInstance operation. The "output" return
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
// successfully.
//
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
//
// See AddRoleToDBInstance for more information on using the AddRoleToDBInstance
// API call, and error handling.
//
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
//
//
// // Example sending a request using the AddRoleToDBInstanceRequest method.
// req, resp := client.AddRoleToDBInstanceRequest(params)
//
// err := req.Send()
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
// fmt.Println(resp)
// }
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/AddRoleToDBInstance
func (c *RDS) AddRoleToDBInstanceRequest(input *AddRoleToDBInstanceInput) (req *request.Request, output *AddRoleToDBInstanceOutput) {
op := &request.Operation{
Name: opAddRoleToDBInstance,
HTTPMethod: "POST",
HTTPPath: "/",
}
if input == nil {
input = &AddRoleToDBInstanceInput{}
}
output = &AddRoleToDBInstanceOutput{}
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
req.Handlers.Unmarshal.Swap(query.UnmarshalHandler.Name, protocol.UnmarshalDiscardBodyHandler)
return
}
// AddRoleToDBInstance API operation for Amazon Relational Database Service.
//
// Associates an AWS Identity and Access Management (IAM) role with a DB instance.
//
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
// the error.
//
// See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Relational Database Service's
// API operation AddRoleToDBInstance for usage and error information.
//
// Returned Error Codes:
// * ErrCodeDBInstanceNotFoundFault "DBInstanceNotFound"
// DBInstanceIdentifier doesn't refer to an existing DB instance.
//
// * ErrCodeDBInstanceRoleAlreadyExistsFault "DBInstanceRoleAlreadyExists"
// The specified RoleArn or FeatureName value is already associated with the
// DB instance.
//
// * ErrCodeInvalidDBInstanceStateFault "InvalidDBInstanceState"
// The DB instance isn't in a valid state.
//
// * ErrCodeDBInstanceRoleQuotaExceededFault "DBInstanceRoleQuotaExceeded"
// You can't associate any more AWS Identity and Access Management (IAM) roles
// with the DB instance because the quota has been reached.
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/AddRoleToDBInstance
func (c *RDS) AddRoleToDBInstance(input *AddRoleToDBInstanceInput) (*AddRoleToDBInstanceOutput, error) {
req, out := c.AddRoleToDBInstanceRequest(input)
return out, req.Send()
}
// AddRoleToDBInstanceWithContext is the same as AddRoleToDBInstance with the addition of
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
//
// See AddRoleToDBInstance for details on how to use this API operation.
//
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
// for more information on using Contexts.
func (c *RDS) AddRoleToDBInstanceWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *AddRoleToDBInstanceInput, opts ...request.Option) (*AddRoleToDBInstanceOutput, error) {
req, out := c.AddRoleToDBInstanceRequest(input)
req.SetContext(ctx)
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
return out, req.Send()
}
const opAddSourceIdentifierToSubscription = "AddSourceIdentifierToSubscription"
// AddSourceIdentifierToSubscriptionRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
// client's request for the AddSourceIdentifierToSubscription operation. The "output" return
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
// successfully.
//
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
//
// See AddSourceIdentifierToSubscription for more information on using the AddSourceIdentifierToSubscription
// API call, and error handling.
//
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
//
//
// // Example sending a request using the AddSourceIdentifierToSubscriptionRequest method.
// req, resp := client.AddSourceIdentifierToSubscriptionRequest(params)
//
// err := req.Send()
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
// fmt.Println(resp)
// }
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/AddSourceIdentifierToSubscription
func (c *RDS) AddSourceIdentifierToSubscriptionRequest(input *AddSourceIdentifierToSubscriptionInput) (req *request.Request, output *AddSourceIdentifierToSubscriptionOutput) {
op := &request.Operation{
Name: opAddSourceIdentifierToSubscription,
HTTPMethod: "POST",
HTTPPath: "/",
}
if input == nil {
input = &AddSourceIdentifierToSubscriptionInput{}
}
output = &AddSourceIdentifierToSubscriptionOutput{}
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
return
}
// AddSourceIdentifierToSubscription API operation for Amazon Relational Database Service.
//
// Adds a source identifier to an existing RDS event notification subscription.
//
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
// the error.
//
// See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Relational Database Service's
// API operation AddSourceIdentifierToSubscription for usage and error information.
//
// Returned Error Codes:
// * ErrCodeSubscriptionNotFoundFault "SubscriptionNotFound"
// The subscription name does not exist.
//
// * ErrCodeSourceNotFoundFault "SourceNotFound"
// The requested source could not be found.
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/AddSourceIdentifierToSubscription
func (c *RDS) AddSourceIdentifierToSubscription(input *AddSourceIdentifierToSubscriptionInput) (*AddSourceIdentifierToSubscriptionOutput, error) {
req, out := c.AddSourceIdentifierToSubscriptionRequest(input)
return out, req.Send()
}
// AddSourceIdentifierToSubscriptionWithContext is the same as AddSourceIdentifierToSubscription with the addition of
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
//
// See AddSourceIdentifierToSubscription for details on how to use this API operation.
//
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
// for more information on using Contexts.
func (c *RDS) AddSourceIdentifierToSubscriptionWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *AddSourceIdentifierToSubscriptionInput, opts ...request.Option) (*AddSourceIdentifierToSubscriptionOutput, error) {
req, out := c.AddSourceIdentifierToSubscriptionRequest(input)
req.SetContext(ctx)
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
return out, req.Send()
}
const opAddTagsToResource = "AddTagsToResource"
// AddTagsToResourceRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
// client's request for the AddTagsToResource operation. The "output" return
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
// successfully.
//
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
//
// See AddTagsToResource for more information on using the AddTagsToResource
// API call, and error handling.
//
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
//
//
// // Example sending a request using the AddTagsToResourceRequest method.
// req, resp := client.AddTagsToResourceRequest(params)
//
// err := req.Send()
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
// fmt.Println(resp)
// }
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/AddTagsToResource
func (c *RDS) AddTagsToResourceRequest(input *AddTagsToResourceInput) (req *request.Request, output *AddTagsToResourceOutput) {
op := &request.Operation{
Name: opAddTagsToResource,
HTTPMethod: "POST",
HTTPPath: "/",
}
if input == nil {
input = &AddTagsToResourceInput{}
}
output = &AddTagsToResourceOutput{}
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
req.Handlers.Unmarshal.Swap(query.UnmarshalHandler.Name, protocol.UnmarshalDiscardBodyHandler)
return
}
// AddTagsToResource API operation for Amazon Relational Database Service.
//
// Adds metadata tags to an Amazon RDS resource. These tags can also be used
// with cost allocation reporting to track cost associated with Amazon RDS resources,
// or used in a Condition statement in an IAM policy for Amazon RDS.
//
// For an overview on tagging Amazon RDS resources, see Tagging Amazon RDS Resources
// (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/UserGuide/Overview.Tagging.html).
//
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
// the error.
//
// See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Relational Database Service's
// API operation AddTagsToResource for usage and error information.
//
// Returned Error Codes:
// * ErrCodeDBInstanceNotFoundFault "DBInstanceNotFound"
// DBInstanceIdentifier doesn't refer to an existing DB instance.
//
// * ErrCodeDBSnapshotNotFoundFault "DBSnapshotNotFound"
// DBSnapshotIdentifier doesn't refer to an existing DB snapshot.
//
// * ErrCodeDBClusterNotFoundFault "DBClusterNotFoundFault"
// DBClusterIdentifier doesn't refer to an existing DB cluster.
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/AddTagsToResource
func (c *RDS) AddTagsToResource(input *AddTagsToResourceInput) (*AddTagsToResourceOutput, error) {
req, out := c.AddTagsToResourceRequest(input)
return out, req.Send()
}
// AddTagsToResourceWithContext is the same as AddTagsToResource with the addition of
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
//
// See AddTagsToResource for details on how to use this API operation.
//
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
// for more information on using Contexts.
func (c *RDS) AddTagsToResourceWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *AddTagsToResourceInput, opts ...request.Option) (*AddTagsToResourceOutput, error) {
req, out := c.AddTagsToResourceRequest(input)
req.SetContext(ctx)
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
return out, req.Send()
}
const opApplyPendingMaintenanceAction = "ApplyPendingMaintenanceAction"
// ApplyPendingMaintenanceActionRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
// client's request for the ApplyPendingMaintenanceAction operation. The "output" return
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
// successfully.
//
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
//
// See ApplyPendingMaintenanceAction for more information on using the ApplyPendingMaintenanceAction
// API call, and error handling.
//
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
//
//
// // Example sending a request using the ApplyPendingMaintenanceActionRequest method.
// req, resp := client.ApplyPendingMaintenanceActionRequest(params)
//
// err := req.Send()
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
// fmt.Println(resp)
// }
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/ApplyPendingMaintenanceAction
func (c *RDS) ApplyPendingMaintenanceActionRequest(input *ApplyPendingMaintenanceActionInput) (req *request.Request, output *ApplyPendingMaintenanceActionOutput) {
op := &request.Operation{
Name: opApplyPendingMaintenanceAction,
HTTPMethod: "POST",
HTTPPath: "/",
}
if input == nil {
input = &ApplyPendingMaintenanceActionInput{}
}
output = &ApplyPendingMaintenanceActionOutput{}
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
return
}
// ApplyPendingMaintenanceAction API operation for Amazon Relational Database Service.
//
// Applies a pending maintenance action to a resource (for example, to a DB
// instance).
//
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
// the error.
//
// See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Relational Database Service's
// API operation ApplyPendingMaintenanceAction for usage and error information.
//
// Returned Error Codes:
// * ErrCodeResourceNotFoundFault "ResourceNotFoundFault"
// The specified resource ID was not found.
//
// * ErrCodeInvalidDBClusterStateFault "InvalidDBClusterStateFault"
// The requested operation can't be performed while the cluster is in this state.
//
// * ErrCodeInvalidDBInstanceStateFault "InvalidDBInstanceState"
// The DB instance isn't in a valid state.
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/ApplyPendingMaintenanceAction
func (c *RDS) ApplyPendingMaintenanceAction(input *ApplyPendingMaintenanceActionInput) (*ApplyPendingMaintenanceActionOutput, error) {
req, out := c.ApplyPendingMaintenanceActionRequest(input)
return out, req.Send()
}
// ApplyPendingMaintenanceActionWithContext is the same as ApplyPendingMaintenanceAction with the addition of
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
//
// See ApplyPendingMaintenanceAction for details on how to use this API operation.
//
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
// for more information on using Contexts.
func (c *RDS) ApplyPendingMaintenanceActionWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *ApplyPendingMaintenanceActionInput, opts ...request.Option) (*ApplyPendingMaintenanceActionOutput, error) {
req, out := c.ApplyPendingMaintenanceActionRequest(input)
req.SetContext(ctx)
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
return out, req.Send()
}
const opAuthorizeDBSecurityGroupIngress = "AuthorizeDBSecurityGroupIngress"
// AuthorizeDBSecurityGroupIngressRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
// client's request for the AuthorizeDBSecurityGroupIngress operation. The "output" return
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
// successfully.
//
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
//
// See AuthorizeDBSecurityGroupIngress for more information on using the AuthorizeDBSecurityGroupIngress
// API call, and error handling.
//
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
//
//
// // Example sending a request using the AuthorizeDBSecurityGroupIngressRequest method.
// req, resp := client.AuthorizeDBSecurityGroupIngressRequest(params)
//
// err := req.Send()
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
// fmt.Println(resp)
// }
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/AuthorizeDBSecurityGroupIngress
func (c *RDS) AuthorizeDBSecurityGroupIngressRequest(input *AuthorizeDBSecurityGroupIngressInput) (req *request.Request, output *AuthorizeDBSecurityGroupIngressOutput) {
op := &request.Operation{
Name: opAuthorizeDBSecurityGroupIngress,
HTTPMethod: "POST",
HTTPPath: "/",
}
if input == nil {
input = &AuthorizeDBSecurityGroupIngressInput{}
}
output = &AuthorizeDBSecurityGroupIngressOutput{}
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
return
}
// AuthorizeDBSecurityGroupIngress API operation for Amazon Relational Database Service.
//
// Enables ingress to a DBSecurityGroup using one of two forms of authorization.
// First, EC2 or VPC security groups can be added to the DBSecurityGroup if
// the application using the database is running on EC2 or VPC instances. Second,
// IP ranges are available if the application accessing your database is running
// on the Internet. Required parameters for this API are one of CIDR range,
// EC2SecurityGroupId for VPC, or (EC2SecurityGroupOwnerId and either EC2SecurityGroupName
// or EC2SecurityGroupId for non-VPC).
//
// You can't authorize ingress from an EC2 security group in one AWS Region
// to an Amazon RDS DB instance in another. You can't authorize ingress from
// a VPC security group in one VPC to an Amazon RDS DB instance in another.
//
// For an overview of CIDR ranges, go to the Wikipedia Tutorial (http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Classless_Inter-Domain_Routing).
//
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
// the error.
//
// See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Relational Database Service's
// API operation AuthorizeDBSecurityGroupIngress for usage and error information.
//
// Returned Error Codes:
// * ErrCodeDBSecurityGroupNotFoundFault "DBSecurityGroupNotFound"
// DBSecurityGroupName doesn't refer to an existing DB security group.
//
// * ErrCodeInvalidDBSecurityGroupStateFault "InvalidDBSecurityGroupState"
// The state of the DB security group doesn't allow deletion.
//
// * ErrCodeAuthorizationAlreadyExistsFault "AuthorizationAlreadyExists"
// The specified CIDRIP or Amazon EC2 security group is already authorized for
// the specified DB security group.
//
// * ErrCodeAuthorizationQuotaExceededFault "AuthorizationQuotaExceeded"
// The DB security group authorization quota has been reached.
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/AuthorizeDBSecurityGroupIngress
func (c *RDS) AuthorizeDBSecurityGroupIngress(input *AuthorizeDBSecurityGroupIngressInput) (*AuthorizeDBSecurityGroupIngressOutput, error) {
req, out := c.AuthorizeDBSecurityGroupIngressRequest(input)
return out, req.Send()
}
// AuthorizeDBSecurityGroupIngressWithContext is the same as AuthorizeDBSecurityGroupIngress with the addition of
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
//
// See AuthorizeDBSecurityGroupIngress for details on how to use this API operation.
//
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
// for more information on using Contexts.
func (c *RDS) AuthorizeDBSecurityGroupIngressWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *AuthorizeDBSecurityGroupIngressInput, opts ...request.Option) (*AuthorizeDBSecurityGroupIngressOutput, error) {
req, out := c.AuthorizeDBSecurityGroupIngressRequest(input)
req.SetContext(ctx)
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
return out, req.Send()
}
const opBacktrackDBCluster = "BacktrackDBCluster"
// BacktrackDBClusterRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
// client's request for the BacktrackDBCluster operation. The "output" return
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
// successfully.
//
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
//
// See BacktrackDBCluster for more information on using the BacktrackDBCluster
// API call, and error handling.
//
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
//
//
// // Example sending a request using the BacktrackDBClusterRequest method.
// req, resp := client.BacktrackDBClusterRequest(params)
//
// err := req.Send()
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
// fmt.Println(resp)
// }
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/BacktrackDBCluster
func (c *RDS) BacktrackDBClusterRequest(input *BacktrackDBClusterInput) (req *request.Request, output *BacktrackDBClusterOutput) {
op := &request.Operation{
Name: opBacktrackDBCluster,
HTTPMethod: "POST",
HTTPPath: "/",
}
if input == nil {
input = &BacktrackDBClusterInput{}
}
output = &BacktrackDBClusterOutput{}
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
return
}
// BacktrackDBCluster API operation for Amazon Relational Database Service.
//
// Backtracks a DB cluster to a specific time, without creating a new DB cluster.
//
// For more information on backtracking, see Backtracking an Aurora DB Cluster
// (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/AuroraUserGuide/AuroraMySQL.Managing.Backtrack.html)
// in the Amazon Aurora User Guide.
//
// This action only applies to Aurora DB clusters.
//
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
// the error.
//
// See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Relational Database Service's
// API operation BacktrackDBCluster for usage and error information.
//
// Returned Error Codes:
// * ErrCodeDBClusterNotFoundFault "DBClusterNotFoundFault"
// DBClusterIdentifier doesn't refer to an existing DB cluster.
//
// * ErrCodeInvalidDBClusterStateFault "InvalidDBClusterStateFault"
// The requested operation can't be performed while the cluster is in this state.
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/BacktrackDBCluster
func (c *RDS) BacktrackDBCluster(input *BacktrackDBClusterInput) (*BacktrackDBClusterOutput, error) {
req, out := c.BacktrackDBClusterRequest(input)
return out, req.Send()
}
// BacktrackDBClusterWithContext is the same as BacktrackDBCluster with the addition of
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
//
// See BacktrackDBCluster for details on how to use this API operation.
//
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
// for more information on using Contexts.
func (c *RDS) BacktrackDBClusterWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *BacktrackDBClusterInput, opts ...request.Option) (*BacktrackDBClusterOutput, error) {
req, out := c.BacktrackDBClusterRequest(input)
req.SetContext(ctx)
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
return out, req.Send()
}
const opCopyDBClusterParameterGroup = "CopyDBClusterParameterGroup"
// CopyDBClusterParameterGroupRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
// client's request for the CopyDBClusterParameterGroup operation. The "output" return
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
// successfully.
//
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
//
// See CopyDBClusterParameterGroup for more information on using the CopyDBClusterParameterGroup
// API call, and error handling.
//
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
//
//
// // Example sending a request using the CopyDBClusterParameterGroupRequest method.
// req, resp := client.CopyDBClusterParameterGroupRequest(params)
//
// err := req.Send()
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
// fmt.Println(resp)
// }
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/CopyDBClusterParameterGroup
func (c *RDS) CopyDBClusterParameterGroupRequest(input *CopyDBClusterParameterGroupInput) (req *request.Request, output *CopyDBClusterParameterGroupOutput) {
op := &request.Operation{
Name: opCopyDBClusterParameterGroup,
HTTPMethod: "POST",
HTTPPath: "/",
}
if input == nil {
input = &CopyDBClusterParameterGroupInput{}
}
output = &CopyDBClusterParameterGroupOutput{}
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
return
}
// CopyDBClusterParameterGroup API operation for Amazon Relational Database Service.
//
// Copies the specified DB cluster parameter group.
//
// This action only applies to Aurora DB clusters.
//
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
// the error.
//
// See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Relational Database Service's
// API operation CopyDBClusterParameterGroup for usage and error information.
//
// Returned Error Codes:
// * ErrCodeDBParameterGroupNotFoundFault "DBParameterGroupNotFound"
// DBParameterGroupName doesn't refer to an existing DB parameter group.
//
// * ErrCodeDBParameterGroupQuotaExceededFault "DBParameterGroupQuotaExceeded"
// The request would result in the user exceeding the allowed number of DB parameter
// groups.
//
// * ErrCodeDBParameterGroupAlreadyExistsFault "DBParameterGroupAlreadyExists"
// A DB parameter group with the same name exists.
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/CopyDBClusterParameterGroup
func (c *RDS) CopyDBClusterParameterGroup(input *CopyDBClusterParameterGroupInput) (*CopyDBClusterParameterGroupOutput, error) {
req, out := c.CopyDBClusterParameterGroupRequest(input)
return out, req.Send()
}
// CopyDBClusterParameterGroupWithContext is the same as CopyDBClusterParameterGroup with the addition of
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
//
// See CopyDBClusterParameterGroup for details on how to use this API operation.
//
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
// for more information on using Contexts.
func (c *RDS) CopyDBClusterParameterGroupWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *CopyDBClusterParameterGroupInput, opts ...request.Option) (*CopyDBClusterParameterGroupOutput, error) {
req, out := c.CopyDBClusterParameterGroupRequest(input)
req.SetContext(ctx)
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
return out, req.Send()
}
const opCopyDBClusterSnapshot = "CopyDBClusterSnapshot"
// CopyDBClusterSnapshotRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
// client's request for the CopyDBClusterSnapshot operation. The "output" return
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
// successfully.
//
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
//
// See CopyDBClusterSnapshot for more information on using the CopyDBClusterSnapshot
// API call, and error handling.
//
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
//
//
// // Example sending a request using the CopyDBClusterSnapshotRequest method.
// req, resp := client.CopyDBClusterSnapshotRequest(params)
//
// err := req.Send()
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
// fmt.Println(resp)
// }
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/CopyDBClusterSnapshot
func (c *RDS) CopyDBClusterSnapshotRequest(input *CopyDBClusterSnapshotInput) (req *request.Request, output *CopyDBClusterSnapshotOutput) {
op := &request.Operation{
Name: opCopyDBClusterSnapshot,
HTTPMethod: "POST",
HTTPPath: "/",
}
if input == nil {
input = &CopyDBClusterSnapshotInput{}
}
output = &CopyDBClusterSnapshotOutput{}
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
return
}
// CopyDBClusterSnapshot API operation for Amazon Relational Database Service.
//
// Copies a snapshot of a DB cluster.
//
// To copy a DB cluster snapshot from a shared manual DB cluster snapshot, SourceDBClusterSnapshotIdentifier
// must be the Amazon Resource Name (ARN) of the shared DB cluster snapshot.
//
// You can copy an encrypted DB cluster snapshot from another AWS Region. In
// that case, the AWS Region where you call the CopyDBClusterSnapshot action
// is the destination AWS Region for the encrypted DB cluster snapshot to be
// copied to. To copy an encrypted DB cluster snapshot from another AWS Region,
// you must provide the following values:
//
// * KmsKeyId - The AWS Key Management System (AWS KMS) key identifier for
// the key to use to encrypt the copy of the DB cluster snapshot in the destination
// AWS Region.
//
// * PreSignedUrl - A URL that contains a Signature Version 4 signed request
// for the CopyDBClusterSnapshot action to be called in the source AWS Region
// where the DB cluster snapshot is copied from. The pre-signed URL must
// be a valid request for the CopyDBClusterSnapshot API action that can be
// executed in the source AWS Region that contains the encrypted DB cluster
// snapshot to be copied.
//
// The pre-signed URL request must contain the following parameter values:
//
// KmsKeyId - The KMS key identifier for the key to use to encrypt the copy
// of the DB cluster snapshot in the destination AWS Region. This is the
// same identifier for both the CopyDBClusterSnapshot action that is called
// in the destination AWS Region, and the action contained in the pre-signed
// URL.
//
// DestinationRegion - The name of the AWS Region that the DB cluster snapshot
// will be created in.
//
// SourceDBClusterSnapshotIdentifier - The DB cluster snapshot identifier for
// the encrypted DB cluster snapshot to be copied. This identifier must be
// in the Amazon Resource Name (ARN) format for the source AWS Region. For
// example, if you are copying an encrypted DB cluster snapshot from the
// us-west-2 AWS Region, then your SourceDBClusterSnapshotIdentifier looks
// like the following example: arn:aws:rds:us-west-2:123456789012:cluster-snapshot:aurora-cluster1-snapshot-20161115.
//
// To learn how to generate a Signature Version 4 signed request, see Authenticating
// Requests: Using Query Parameters (AWS Signature Version 4) (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonS3/latest/API/sigv4-query-string-auth.html)
// and Signature Version 4 Signing Process (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/general/latest/gr/signature-version-4.html).
//
// * TargetDBClusterSnapshotIdentifier - The identifier for the new copy
// of the DB cluster snapshot in the destination AWS Region.
//
// * SourceDBClusterSnapshotIdentifier - The DB cluster snapshot identifier
// for the encrypted DB cluster snapshot to be copied. This identifier must
// be in the ARN format for the source AWS Region and is the same value as
// the SourceDBClusterSnapshotIdentifier in the pre-signed URL.
//
// To cancel the copy operation once it is in progress, delete the target DB
// cluster snapshot identified by TargetDBClusterSnapshotIdentifier while that
// DB cluster snapshot is in "copying" status.
//
// For more information on copying encrypted DB cluster snapshots from one AWS
// Region to another, see Copying a Snapshot (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/AuroraUserGuide/USER_CopySnapshot.html)
// in the Amazon Aurora User Guide.
//
// For more information on Amazon Aurora, see What Is Amazon Aurora? (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/AuroraUserGuide/CHAP_AuroraOverview.html)
// in the Amazon Aurora User Guide.
//
// This action only applies to Aurora DB clusters.
//
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
// the error.
//
// See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Relational Database Service's
// API operation CopyDBClusterSnapshot for usage and error information.
//
// Returned Error Codes:
// * ErrCodeDBClusterSnapshotAlreadyExistsFault "DBClusterSnapshotAlreadyExistsFault"
// The user already has a DB cluster snapshot with the given identifier.
//
// * ErrCodeDBClusterSnapshotNotFoundFault "DBClusterSnapshotNotFoundFault"
// DBClusterSnapshotIdentifier doesn't refer to an existing DB cluster snapshot.
//
// * ErrCodeInvalidDBClusterStateFault "InvalidDBClusterStateFault"
// The requested operation can't be performed while the cluster is in this state.
//
// * ErrCodeInvalidDBClusterSnapshotStateFault "InvalidDBClusterSnapshotStateFault"
// The supplied value isn't a valid DB cluster snapshot state.
//
// * ErrCodeSnapshotQuotaExceededFault "SnapshotQuotaExceeded"
// The request would result in the user exceeding the allowed number of DB snapshots.
//
// * ErrCodeKMSKeyNotAccessibleFault "KMSKeyNotAccessibleFault"
// An error occurred accessing an AWS KMS key.
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/CopyDBClusterSnapshot
func (c *RDS) CopyDBClusterSnapshot(input *CopyDBClusterSnapshotInput) (*CopyDBClusterSnapshotOutput, error) {
req, out := c.CopyDBClusterSnapshotRequest(input)
return out, req.Send()
}
// CopyDBClusterSnapshotWithContext is the same as CopyDBClusterSnapshot with the addition of
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
//
// See CopyDBClusterSnapshot for details on how to use this API operation.
//
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
// for more information on using Contexts.
func (c *RDS) CopyDBClusterSnapshotWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *CopyDBClusterSnapshotInput, opts ...request.Option) (*CopyDBClusterSnapshotOutput, error) {
req, out := c.CopyDBClusterSnapshotRequest(input)
req.SetContext(ctx)
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
return out, req.Send()
}
const opCopyDBParameterGroup = "CopyDBParameterGroup"
// CopyDBParameterGroupRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
// client's request for the CopyDBParameterGroup operation. The "output" return
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
// successfully.
//
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
//
// See CopyDBParameterGroup for more information on using the CopyDBParameterGroup
// API call, and error handling.
//
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
//
//
// // Example sending a request using the CopyDBParameterGroupRequest method.
// req, resp := client.CopyDBParameterGroupRequest(params)
//
// err := req.Send()
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
// fmt.Println(resp)
// }
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/CopyDBParameterGroup
func (c *RDS) CopyDBParameterGroupRequest(input *CopyDBParameterGroupInput) (req *request.Request, output *CopyDBParameterGroupOutput) {
op := &request.Operation{
Name: opCopyDBParameterGroup,
HTTPMethod: "POST",
HTTPPath: "/",
}
if input == nil {
input = &CopyDBParameterGroupInput{}
}
output = &CopyDBParameterGroupOutput{}
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
return
}
// CopyDBParameterGroup API operation for Amazon Relational Database Service.
//
// Copies the specified DB parameter group.
//
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
// the error.
//
// See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Relational Database Service's
// API operation CopyDBParameterGroup for usage and error information.
//
// Returned Error Codes:
// * ErrCodeDBParameterGroupNotFoundFault "DBParameterGroupNotFound"
// DBParameterGroupName doesn't refer to an existing DB parameter group.
//
// * ErrCodeDBParameterGroupAlreadyExistsFault "DBParameterGroupAlreadyExists"
// A DB parameter group with the same name exists.
//
// * ErrCodeDBParameterGroupQuotaExceededFault "DBParameterGroupQuotaExceeded"
// The request would result in the user exceeding the allowed number of DB parameter
// groups.
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/CopyDBParameterGroup
func (c *RDS) CopyDBParameterGroup(input *CopyDBParameterGroupInput) (*CopyDBParameterGroupOutput, error) {
req, out := c.CopyDBParameterGroupRequest(input)
return out, req.Send()
}
// CopyDBParameterGroupWithContext is the same as CopyDBParameterGroup with the addition of
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
//
// See CopyDBParameterGroup for details on how to use this API operation.
//
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
// for more information on using Contexts.
func (c *RDS) CopyDBParameterGroupWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *CopyDBParameterGroupInput, opts ...request.Option) (*CopyDBParameterGroupOutput, error) {
req, out := c.CopyDBParameterGroupRequest(input)
req.SetContext(ctx)
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
return out, req.Send()
}
const opCopyDBSnapshot = "CopyDBSnapshot"
// CopyDBSnapshotRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
// client's request for the CopyDBSnapshot operation. The "output" return
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
// successfully.
//
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
//
// See CopyDBSnapshot for more information on using the CopyDBSnapshot
// API call, and error handling.
//
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
//
//
// // Example sending a request using the CopyDBSnapshotRequest method.
// req, resp := client.CopyDBSnapshotRequest(params)
//
// err := req.Send()
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
// fmt.Println(resp)
// }
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/CopyDBSnapshot
func (c *RDS) CopyDBSnapshotRequest(input *CopyDBSnapshotInput) (req *request.Request, output *CopyDBSnapshotOutput) {
op := &request.Operation{
Name: opCopyDBSnapshot,
HTTPMethod: "POST",
HTTPPath: "/",
}
if input == nil {
input = &CopyDBSnapshotInput{}
}
output = &CopyDBSnapshotOutput{}
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
return
}
// CopyDBSnapshot API operation for Amazon Relational Database Service.
//
// Copies the specified DB snapshot. The source DB snapshot must be in the "available"
// state.
//
// You can copy a snapshot from one AWS Region to another. In that case, the
// AWS Region where you call the CopyDBSnapshot action is the destination AWS
// Region for the DB snapshot copy.
//
// For more information about copying snapshots, see Copying a DB Snapshot (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/UserGuide/USER_CopyDBSnapshot.html)
// in the Amazon RDS User Guide.
//
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
// the error.
//
// See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Relational Database Service's
// API operation CopyDBSnapshot for usage and error information.
//
// Returned Error Codes:
// * ErrCodeDBSnapshotAlreadyExistsFault "DBSnapshotAlreadyExists"
// DBSnapshotIdentifier is already used by an existing snapshot.
//
// * ErrCodeDBSnapshotNotFoundFault "DBSnapshotNotFound"
// DBSnapshotIdentifier doesn't refer to an existing DB snapshot.
//
// * ErrCodeInvalidDBSnapshotStateFault "InvalidDBSnapshotState"
// The state of the DB snapshot doesn't allow deletion.
//
// * ErrCodeSnapshotQuotaExceededFault "SnapshotQuotaExceeded"
// The request would result in the user exceeding the allowed number of DB snapshots.
//
// * ErrCodeKMSKeyNotAccessibleFault "KMSKeyNotAccessibleFault"
// An error occurred accessing an AWS KMS key.
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/CopyDBSnapshot
func (c *RDS) CopyDBSnapshot(input *CopyDBSnapshotInput) (*CopyDBSnapshotOutput, error) {
req, out := c.CopyDBSnapshotRequest(input)
return out, req.Send()
}
// CopyDBSnapshotWithContext is the same as CopyDBSnapshot with the addition of
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
//
// See CopyDBSnapshot for details on how to use this API operation.
//
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
// for more information on using Contexts.
func (c *RDS) CopyDBSnapshotWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *CopyDBSnapshotInput, opts ...request.Option) (*CopyDBSnapshotOutput, error) {
req, out := c.CopyDBSnapshotRequest(input)
req.SetContext(ctx)
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
return out, req.Send()
}
const opCopyOptionGroup = "CopyOptionGroup"
// CopyOptionGroupRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
// client's request for the CopyOptionGroup operation. The "output" return
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
// successfully.
//
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
//
// See CopyOptionGroup for more information on using the CopyOptionGroup
// API call, and error handling.
//
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
//
//
// // Example sending a request using the CopyOptionGroupRequest method.
// req, resp := client.CopyOptionGroupRequest(params)
//
// err := req.Send()
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
// fmt.Println(resp)
// }
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/CopyOptionGroup
func (c *RDS) CopyOptionGroupRequest(input *CopyOptionGroupInput) (req *request.Request, output *CopyOptionGroupOutput) {
op := &request.Operation{
Name: opCopyOptionGroup,
HTTPMethod: "POST",
HTTPPath: "/",
}
if input == nil {
input = &CopyOptionGroupInput{}
}
output = &CopyOptionGroupOutput{}
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
return
}
// CopyOptionGroup API operation for Amazon Relational Database Service.
//
// Copies the specified option group.
//
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
// the error.
//
// See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Relational Database Service's
// API operation CopyOptionGroup for usage and error information.
//
// Returned Error Codes:
// * ErrCodeOptionGroupAlreadyExistsFault "OptionGroupAlreadyExistsFault"
// The option group you are trying to create already exists.
//
// * ErrCodeOptionGroupNotFoundFault "OptionGroupNotFoundFault"
// The specified option group could not be found.
//
// * ErrCodeOptionGroupQuotaExceededFault "OptionGroupQuotaExceededFault"
// The quota of 20 option groups was exceeded for this AWS account.
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/CopyOptionGroup
func (c *RDS) CopyOptionGroup(input *CopyOptionGroupInput) (*CopyOptionGroupOutput, error) {
req, out := c.CopyOptionGroupRequest(input)
return out, req.Send()
}
// CopyOptionGroupWithContext is the same as CopyOptionGroup with the addition of
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
//
// See CopyOptionGroup for details on how to use this API operation.
//
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
// for more information on using Contexts.
func (c *RDS) CopyOptionGroupWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *CopyOptionGroupInput, opts ...request.Option) (*CopyOptionGroupOutput, error) {
req, out := c.CopyOptionGroupRequest(input)
req.SetContext(ctx)
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
return out, req.Send()
}
const opCreateDBCluster = "CreateDBCluster"
// CreateDBClusterRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
// client's request for the CreateDBCluster operation. The "output" return
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
// successfully.
//
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
//
// See CreateDBCluster for more information on using the CreateDBCluster
// API call, and error handling.
//
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
//
//
// // Example sending a request using the CreateDBClusterRequest method.
// req, resp := client.CreateDBClusterRequest(params)
//
// err := req.Send()
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
// fmt.Println(resp)
// }
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/CreateDBCluster
func (c *RDS) CreateDBClusterRequest(input *CreateDBClusterInput) (req *request.Request, output *CreateDBClusterOutput) {
op := &request.Operation{
Name: opCreateDBCluster,
HTTPMethod: "POST",
HTTPPath: "/",
}
if input == nil {
input = &CreateDBClusterInput{}
}
output = &CreateDBClusterOutput{}
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
return
}
// CreateDBCluster API operation for Amazon Relational Database Service.
//
// Creates a new Amazon Aurora DB cluster.
//
// You can use the ReplicationSourceIdentifier parameter to create the DB cluster
// as a Read Replica of another DB cluster or Amazon RDS MySQL DB instance.
// For cross-region replication where the DB cluster identified by ReplicationSourceIdentifier
// is encrypted, you must also specify the PreSignedUrl parameter.
//
// For more information on Amazon Aurora, see What Is Amazon Aurora? (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/AuroraUserGuide/CHAP_AuroraOverview.html)
// in the Amazon Aurora User Guide.
//
// This action only applies to Aurora DB clusters.
//
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
// the error.
//
// See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Relational Database Service's
// API operation CreateDBCluster for usage and error information.
//
// Returned Error Codes:
// * ErrCodeDBClusterAlreadyExistsFault "DBClusterAlreadyExistsFault"
// The user already has a DB cluster with the given identifier.
//
// * ErrCodeInsufficientStorageClusterCapacityFault "InsufficientStorageClusterCapacity"
// There is insufficient storage available for the current action. You might
// be able to resolve this error by updating your subnet group to use different
// Availability Zones that have more storage available.
//
// * ErrCodeDBClusterQuotaExceededFault "DBClusterQuotaExceededFault"
// The user attempted to create a new DB cluster and the user has already reached
// the maximum allowed DB cluster quota.
//
// * ErrCodeStorageQuotaExceededFault "StorageQuotaExceeded"
// The request would result in the user exceeding the allowed amount of storage
// available across all DB instances.
//
// * ErrCodeDBSubnetGroupNotFoundFault "DBSubnetGroupNotFoundFault"
// DBSubnetGroupName doesn't refer to an existing DB subnet group.
//
// * ErrCodeInvalidVPCNetworkStateFault "InvalidVPCNetworkStateFault"
// The DB subnet group doesn't cover all Availability Zones after it's created
// because of users' change.
//
// * ErrCodeInvalidDBClusterStateFault "InvalidDBClusterStateFault"
// The requested operation can't be performed while the cluster is in this state.
//
// * ErrCodeInvalidDBSubnetGroupStateFault "InvalidDBSubnetGroupStateFault"
// The DB subnet group cannot be deleted because it's in use.
//
// * ErrCodeInvalidSubnet "InvalidSubnet"
// The requested subnet is invalid, or multiple subnets were requested that
// are not all in a common VPC.
//
// * ErrCodeInvalidDBInstanceStateFault "InvalidDBInstanceState"
// The DB instance isn't in a valid state.
//
// * ErrCodeDBClusterParameterGroupNotFoundFault "DBClusterParameterGroupNotFound"
// DBClusterParameterGroupName doesn't refer to an existing DB cluster parameter
// group.
//
// * ErrCodeKMSKeyNotAccessibleFault "KMSKeyNotAccessibleFault"
// An error occurred accessing an AWS KMS key.
//
// * ErrCodeDBClusterNotFoundFault "DBClusterNotFoundFault"
// DBClusterIdentifier doesn't refer to an existing DB cluster.
//
// * ErrCodeDBInstanceNotFoundFault "DBInstanceNotFound"
// DBInstanceIdentifier doesn't refer to an existing DB instance.
//
// * ErrCodeDBSubnetGroupDoesNotCoverEnoughAZs "DBSubnetGroupDoesNotCoverEnoughAZs"
// Subnets in the DB subnet group should cover at least two Availability Zones
// unless there is only one Availability Zone.
//
// * ErrCodeGlobalClusterNotFoundFault "GlobalClusterNotFoundFault"
//
// * ErrCodeInvalidGlobalClusterStateFault "InvalidGlobalClusterStateFault"
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/CreateDBCluster
func (c *RDS) CreateDBCluster(input *CreateDBClusterInput) (*CreateDBClusterOutput, error) {
req, out := c.CreateDBClusterRequest(input)
return out, req.Send()
}
// CreateDBClusterWithContext is the same as CreateDBCluster with the addition of
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
//
// See CreateDBCluster for details on how to use this API operation.
//
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
// for more information on using Contexts.
func (c *RDS) CreateDBClusterWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *CreateDBClusterInput, opts ...request.Option) (*CreateDBClusterOutput, error) {
req, out := c.CreateDBClusterRequest(input)
req.SetContext(ctx)
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
return out, req.Send()
}
const opCreateDBClusterEndpoint = "CreateDBClusterEndpoint"
// CreateDBClusterEndpointRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
// client's request for the CreateDBClusterEndpoint operation. The "output" return
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
// successfully.
//
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
//
// See CreateDBClusterEndpoint for more information on using the CreateDBClusterEndpoint
// API call, and error handling.
//
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
//
//
// // Example sending a request using the CreateDBClusterEndpointRequest method.
// req, resp := client.CreateDBClusterEndpointRequest(params)
//
// err := req.Send()
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
// fmt.Println(resp)
// }
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/CreateDBClusterEndpoint
func (c *RDS) CreateDBClusterEndpointRequest(input *CreateDBClusterEndpointInput) (req *request.Request, output *CreateDBClusterEndpointOutput) {
op := &request.Operation{
Name: opCreateDBClusterEndpoint,
HTTPMethod: "POST",
HTTPPath: "/",
}
if input == nil {
input = &CreateDBClusterEndpointInput{}
}
output = &CreateDBClusterEndpointOutput{}
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
return
}
// CreateDBClusterEndpoint API operation for Amazon Relational Database Service.
//
// Creates a new custom endpoint and associates it with an Amazon Aurora DB
// cluster.
//
// This action only applies to Aurora DB clusters.
//
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
// the error.
//
// See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Relational Database Service's
// API operation CreateDBClusterEndpoint for usage and error information.
//
// Returned Error Codes:
// * ErrCodeDBClusterEndpointQuotaExceededFault "DBClusterEndpointQuotaExceededFault"
// The cluster already has the maximum number of custom endpoints.
//
// * ErrCodeDBClusterEndpointAlreadyExistsFault "DBClusterEndpointAlreadyExistsFault"
// The specified custom endpoint can't be created because it already exists.
//
// * ErrCodeDBClusterNotFoundFault "DBClusterNotFoundFault"
// DBClusterIdentifier doesn't refer to an existing DB cluster.
//
// * ErrCodeInvalidDBClusterStateFault "InvalidDBClusterStateFault"
// The requested operation can't be performed while the cluster is in this state.
//
// * ErrCodeDBInstanceNotFoundFault "DBInstanceNotFound"
// DBInstanceIdentifier doesn't refer to an existing DB instance.
//
// * ErrCodeInvalidDBInstanceStateFault "InvalidDBInstanceState"
// The DB instance isn't in a valid state.
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/CreateDBClusterEndpoint
func (c *RDS) CreateDBClusterEndpoint(input *CreateDBClusterEndpointInput) (*CreateDBClusterEndpointOutput, error) {
req, out := c.CreateDBClusterEndpointRequest(input)
return out, req.Send()
}
// CreateDBClusterEndpointWithContext is the same as CreateDBClusterEndpoint with the addition of
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
//
// See CreateDBClusterEndpoint for details on how to use this API operation.
//
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
// for more information on using Contexts.
func (c *RDS) CreateDBClusterEndpointWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *CreateDBClusterEndpointInput, opts ...request.Option) (*CreateDBClusterEndpointOutput, error) {
req, out := c.CreateDBClusterEndpointRequest(input)
req.SetContext(ctx)
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
return out, req.Send()
}
const opCreateDBClusterParameterGroup = "CreateDBClusterParameterGroup"
// CreateDBClusterParameterGroupRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
// client's request for the CreateDBClusterParameterGroup operation. The "output" return
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
// successfully.
//
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
//
// See CreateDBClusterParameterGroup for more information on using the CreateDBClusterParameterGroup
// API call, and error handling.
//
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
//
//
// // Example sending a request using the CreateDBClusterParameterGroupRequest method.
// req, resp := client.CreateDBClusterParameterGroupRequest(params)
//
// err := req.Send()
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
// fmt.Println(resp)
// }
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/CreateDBClusterParameterGroup
func (c *RDS) CreateDBClusterParameterGroupRequest(input *CreateDBClusterParameterGroupInput) (req *request.Request, output *CreateDBClusterParameterGroupOutput) {
op := &request.Operation{
Name: opCreateDBClusterParameterGroup,
HTTPMethod: "POST",
HTTPPath: "/",
}
if input == nil {
input = &CreateDBClusterParameterGroupInput{}
}
output = &CreateDBClusterParameterGroupOutput{}
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
return
}
// CreateDBClusterParameterGroup API operation for Amazon Relational Database Service.
//
// Creates a new DB cluster parameter group.
//
// Parameters in a DB cluster parameter group apply to all of the instances
// in a DB cluster.
//
// A DB cluster parameter group is initially created with the default parameters
// for the database engine used by instances in the DB cluster. To provide custom
// values for any of the parameters, you must modify the group after creating
// it using ModifyDBClusterParameterGroup. Once you've created a DB cluster
// parameter group, you need to associate it with your DB cluster using ModifyDBCluster.
// When you associate a new DB cluster parameter group with a running DB cluster,
// you need to reboot the DB instances in the DB cluster without failover for
// the new DB cluster parameter group and associated settings to take effect.
//
// After you create a DB cluster parameter group, you should wait at least 5
// minutes before creating your first DB cluster that uses that DB cluster parameter
// group as the default parameter group. This allows Amazon RDS to fully complete
// the create action before the DB cluster parameter group is used as the default
// for a new DB cluster. This is especially important for parameters that are
// critical when creating the default database for a DB cluster, such as the
// character set for the default database defined by the character_set_database
// parameter. You can use the Parameter Groups option of the Amazon RDS console
// (https://console.aws.amazon.com/rds/) or the DescribeDBClusterParameters
// command to verify that your DB cluster parameter group has been created or
// modified.
//
// For more information on Amazon Aurora, see What Is Amazon Aurora? (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/AuroraUserGuide/CHAP_AuroraOverview.html)
// in the Amazon Aurora User Guide.
//
// This action only applies to Aurora DB clusters.
//
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
// the error.
//
// See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Relational Database Service's
// API operation CreateDBClusterParameterGroup for usage and error information.
//
// Returned Error Codes:
// * ErrCodeDBParameterGroupQuotaExceededFault "DBParameterGroupQuotaExceeded"
// The request would result in the user exceeding the allowed number of DB parameter
// groups.
//
// * ErrCodeDBParameterGroupAlreadyExistsFault "DBParameterGroupAlreadyExists"
// A DB parameter group with the same name exists.
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/CreateDBClusterParameterGroup
func (c *RDS) CreateDBClusterParameterGroup(input *CreateDBClusterParameterGroupInput) (*CreateDBClusterParameterGroupOutput, error) {
req, out := c.CreateDBClusterParameterGroupRequest(input)
return out, req.Send()
}
// CreateDBClusterParameterGroupWithContext is the same as CreateDBClusterParameterGroup with the addition of
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
//
// See CreateDBClusterParameterGroup for details on how to use this API operation.
//
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
// for more information on using Contexts.
func (c *RDS) CreateDBClusterParameterGroupWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *CreateDBClusterParameterGroupInput, opts ...request.Option) (*CreateDBClusterParameterGroupOutput, error) {
req, out := c.CreateDBClusterParameterGroupRequest(input)
req.SetContext(ctx)
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
return out, req.Send()
}
const opCreateDBClusterSnapshot = "CreateDBClusterSnapshot"
// CreateDBClusterSnapshotRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
// client's request for the CreateDBClusterSnapshot operation. The "output" return
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
// successfully.
//
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
//
// See CreateDBClusterSnapshot for more information on using the CreateDBClusterSnapshot
// API call, and error handling.
//
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
//
//
// // Example sending a request using the CreateDBClusterSnapshotRequest method.
// req, resp := client.CreateDBClusterSnapshotRequest(params)
//
// err := req.Send()
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
// fmt.Println(resp)
// }
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/CreateDBClusterSnapshot
func (c *RDS) CreateDBClusterSnapshotRequest(input *CreateDBClusterSnapshotInput) (req *request.Request, output *CreateDBClusterSnapshotOutput) {
op := &request.Operation{
Name: opCreateDBClusterSnapshot,
HTTPMethod: "POST",
HTTPPath: "/",
}
if input == nil {
input = &CreateDBClusterSnapshotInput{}
}
output = &CreateDBClusterSnapshotOutput{}
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
return
}
// CreateDBClusterSnapshot API operation for Amazon Relational Database Service.
//
// Creates a snapshot of a DB cluster. For more information on Amazon Aurora,
// see What Is Amazon Aurora? (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/AuroraUserGuide/CHAP_AuroraOverview.html)
// in the Amazon Aurora User Guide.
//
// This action only applies to Aurora DB clusters.
//
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
// the error.
//
// See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Relational Database Service's
// API operation CreateDBClusterSnapshot for usage and error information.
//
// Returned Error Codes:
// * ErrCodeDBClusterSnapshotAlreadyExistsFault "DBClusterSnapshotAlreadyExistsFault"
// The user already has a DB cluster snapshot with the given identifier.
//
// * ErrCodeInvalidDBClusterStateFault "InvalidDBClusterStateFault"
// The requested operation can't be performed while the cluster is in this state.
//
// * ErrCodeDBClusterNotFoundFault "DBClusterNotFoundFault"
// DBClusterIdentifier doesn't refer to an existing DB cluster.
//
// * ErrCodeSnapshotQuotaExceededFault "SnapshotQuotaExceeded"
// The request would result in the user exceeding the allowed number of DB snapshots.
//
// * ErrCodeInvalidDBClusterSnapshotStateFault "InvalidDBClusterSnapshotStateFault"
// The supplied value isn't a valid DB cluster snapshot state.
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/CreateDBClusterSnapshot
func (c *RDS) CreateDBClusterSnapshot(input *CreateDBClusterSnapshotInput) (*CreateDBClusterSnapshotOutput, error) {
req, out := c.CreateDBClusterSnapshotRequest(input)
return out, req.Send()
}
// CreateDBClusterSnapshotWithContext is the same as CreateDBClusterSnapshot with the addition of
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
//
// See CreateDBClusterSnapshot for details on how to use this API operation.
//
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
// for more information on using Contexts.
func (c *RDS) CreateDBClusterSnapshotWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *CreateDBClusterSnapshotInput, opts ...request.Option) (*CreateDBClusterSnapshotOutput, error) {
req, out := c.CreateDBClusterSnapshotRequest(input)
req.SetContext(ctx)
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
return out, req.Send()
}
const opCreateDBInstance = "CreateDBInstance"
// CreateDBInstanceRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
// client's request for the CreateDBInstance operation. The "output" return
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
// successfully.
//
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
//
// See CreateDBInstance for more information on using the CreateDBInstance
// API call, and error handling.
//
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
//
//
// // Example sending a request using the CreateDBInstanceRequest method.
// req, resp := client.CreateDBInstanceRequest(params)
//
// err := req.Send()
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
// fmt.Println(resp)
// }
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/CreateDBInstance
func (c *RDS) CreateDBInstanceRequest(input *CreateDBInstanceInput) (req *request.Request, output *CreateDBInstanceOutput) {
op := &request.Operation{
Name: opCreateDBInstance,
HTTPMethod: "POST",
HTTPPath: "/",
}
if input == nil {
input = &CreateDBInstanceInput{}
}
output = &CreateDBInstanceOutput{}
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
return
}
// CreateDBInstance API operation for Amazon Relational Database Service.
//
// Creates a new DB instance.
//
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
// the error.
//
// See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Relational Database Service's
// API operation CreateDBInstance for usage and error information.
//
// Returned Error Codes:
// * ErrCodeDBInstanceAlreadyExistsFault "DBInstanceAlreadyExists"
// The user already has a DB instance with the given identifier.
//
// * ErrCodeInsufficientDBInstanceCapacityFault "InsufficientDBInstanceCapacity"
// The specified DB instance class isn't available in the specified Availability
// Zone.
//
// * ErrCodeDBParameterGroupNotFoundFault "DBParameterGroupNotFound"
// DBParameterGroupName doesn't refer to an existing DB parameter group.
//
// * ErrCodeDBSecurityGroupNotFoundFault "DBSecurityGroupNotFound"
// DBSecurityGroupName doesn't refer to an existing DB security group.
//
// * ErrCodeInstanceQuotaExceededFault "InstanceQuotaExceeded"
// The request would result in the user exceeding the allowed number of DB instances.
//
// * ErrCodeStorageQuotaExceededFault "StorageQuotaExceeded"
// The request would result in the user exceeding the allowed amount of storage
// available across all DB instances.
//
// * ErrCodeDBSubnetGroupNotFoundFault "DBSubnetGroupNotFoundFault"
// DBSubnetGroupName doesn't refer to an existing DB subnet group.
//
// * ErrCodeDBSubnetGroupDoesNotCoverEnoughAZs "DBSubnetGroupDoesNotCoverEnoughAZs"
// Subnets in the DB subnet group should cover at least two Availability Zones
// unless there is only one Availability Zone.
//
// * ErrCodeInvalidDBClusterStateFault "InvalidDBClusterStateFault"
// The requested operation can't be performed while the cluster is in this state.
//
// * ErrCodeInvalidSubnet "InvalidSubnet"
// The requested subnet is invalid, or multiple subnets were requested that
// are not all in a common VPC.
//
// * ErrCodeInvalidVPCNetworkStateFault "InvalidVPCNetworkStateFault"
// The DB subnet group doesn't cover all Availability Zones after it's created
// because of users' change.
//
// * ErrCodeProvisionedIopsNotAvailableInAZFault "ProvisionedIopsNotAvailableInAZFault"
// Provisioned IOPS not available in the specified Availability Zone.
//
// * ErrCodeOptionGroupNotFoundFault "OptionGroupNotFoundFault"
// The specified option group could not be found.
//
// * ErrCodeDBClusterNotFoundFault "DBClusterNotFoundFault"
// DBClusterIdentifier doesn't refer to an existing DB cluster.
//
// * ErrCodeStorageTypeNotSupportedFault "StorageTypeNotSupported"
// Storage of the StorageType specified can't be associated with the DB instance.
//
// * ErrCodeAuthorizationNotFoundFault "AuthorizationNotFound"
// The specified CIDRIP or Amazon EC2 security group isn't authorized for the
// specified DB security group.
//
// RDS also may not be authorized by using IAM to perform necessary actions
// on your behalf.
//
// * ErrCodeKMSKeyNotAccessibleFault "KMSKeyNotAccessibleFault"
// An error occurred accessing an AWS KMS key.
//
// * ErrCodeDomainNotFoundFault "DomainNotFoundFault"
// Domain doesn't refer to an existing Active Directory domain.
//
// * ErrCodeBackupPolicyNotFoundFault "BackupPolicyNotFoundFault"
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/CreateDBInstance
func (c *RDS) CreateDBInstance(input *CreateDBInstanceInput) (*CreateDBInstanceOutput, error) {
req, out := c.CreateDBInstanceRequest(input)
return out, req.Send()
}
// CreateDBInstanceWithContext is the same as CreateDBInstance with the addition of
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
//
// See CreateDBInstance for details on how to use this API operation.
//
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
// for more information on using Contexts.
func (c *RDS) CreateDBInstanceWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *CreateDBInstanceInput, opts ...request.Option) (*CreateDBInstanceOutput, error) {
req, out := c.CreateDBInstanceRequest(input)
req.SetContext(ctx)
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
return out, req.Send()
}
const opCreateDBInstanceReadReplica = "CreateDBInstanceReadReplica"
// CreateDBInstanceReadReplicaRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
// client's request for the CreateDBInstanceReadReplica operation. The "output" return
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
// successfully.
//
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
//
// See CreateDBInstanceReadReplica for more information on using the CreateDBInstanceReadReplica
// API call, and error handling.
//
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
//
//
// // Example sending a request using the CreateDBInstanceReadReplicaRequest method.
// req, resp := client.CreateDBInstanceReadReplicaRequest(params)
//
// err := req.Send()
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
// fmt.Println(resp)
// }
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/CreateDBInstanceReadReplica
func (c *RDS) CreateDBInstanceReadReplicaRequest(input *CreateDBInstanceReadReplicaInput) (req *request.Request, output *CreateDBInstanceReadReplicaOutput) {
op := &request.Operation{
Name: opCreateDBInstanceReadReplica,
HTTPMethod: "POST",
HTTPPath: "/",
}
if input == nil {
input = &CreateDBInstanceReadReplicaInput{}
}
output = &CreateDBInstanceReadReplicaOutput{}
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
return
}
// CreateDBInstanceReadReplica API operation for Amazon Relational Database Service.
//
// Creates a new DB instance that acts as a Read Replica for an existing source
// DB instance. You can create a Read Replica for a DB instance running MySQL,
// MariaDB, or PostgreSQL. For more information, see Working with PostgreSQL,
// MySQL, and MariaDB Read Replicas (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/UserGuide/USER_ReadRepl.html)
// in the Amazon RDS User Guide.
//
// Amazon Aurora doesn't support this action. You must call the CreateDBInstance
// action to create a DB instance for an Aurora DB cluster.
//
// All Read Replica DB instances are created with backups disabled. All other
// DB instance attributes (including DB security groups and DB parameter groups)
// are inherited from the source DB instance, except as specified following.
//
// Your source DB instance must have backup retention enabled.
//
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
// the error.
//
// See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Relational Database Service's
// API operation CreateDBInstanceReadReplica for usage and error information.
//
// Returned Error Codes:
// * ErrCodeDBInstanceAlreadyExistsFault "DBInstanceAlreadyExists"
// The user already has a DB instance with the given identifier.
//
// * ErrCodeInsufficientDBInstanceCapacityFault "InsufficientDBInstanceCapacity"
// The specified DB instance class isn't available in the specified Availability
// Zone.
//
// * ErrCodeDBParameterGroupNotFoundFault "DBParameterGroupNotFound"
// DBParameterGroupName doesn't refer to an existing DB parameter group.
//
// * ErrCodeDBSecurityGroupNotFoundFault "DBSecurityGroupNotFound"
// DBSecurityGroupName doesn't refer to an existing DB security group.
//
// * ErrCodeInstanceQuotaExceededFault "InstanceQuotaExceeded"
// The request would result in the user exceeding the allowed number of DB instances.
//
// * ErrCodeStorageQuotaExceededFault "StorageQuotaExceeded"
// The request would result in the user exceeding the allowed amount of storage
// available across all DB instances.
//
// * ErrCodeDBInstanceNotFoundFault "DBInstanceNotFound"
// DBInstanceIdentifier doesn't refer to an existing DB instance.
//
// * ErrCodeInvalidDBInstanceStateFault "InvalidDBInstanceState"
// The DB instance isn't in a valid state.
//
// * ErrCodeDBSubnetGroupNotFoundFault "DBSubnetGroupNotFoundFault"
// DBSubnetGroupName doesn't refer to an existing DB subnet group.
//
// * ErrCodeDBSubnetGroupDoesNotCoverEnoughAZs "DBSubnetGroupDoesNotCoverEnoughAZs"
// Subnets in the DB subnet group should cover at least two Availability Zones
// unless there is only one Availability Zone.
//
// * ErrCodeInvalidSubnet "InvalidSubnet"
// The requested subnet is invalid, or multiple subnets were requested that
// are not all in a common VPC.
//
// * ErrCodeInvalidVPCNetworkStateFault "InvalidVPCNetworkStateFault"
// The DB subnet group doesn't cover all Availability Zones after it's created
// because of users' change.
//
// * ErrCodeProvisionedIopsNotAvailableInAZFault "ProvisionedIopsNotAvailableInAZFault"
// Provisioned IOPS not available in the specified Availability Zone.
//
// * ErrCodeOptionGroupNotFoundFault "OptionGroupNotFoundFault"
// The specified option group could not be found.
//
// * ErrCodeDBSubnetGroupNotAllowedFault "DBSubnetGroupNotAllowedFault"
// The DBSubnetGroup shouldn't be specified while creating read replicas that
// lie in the same region as the source instance.
//
// * ErrCodeInvalidDBSubnetGroupFault "InvalidDBSubnetGroupFault"
// The DBSubnetGroup doesn't belong to the same VPC as that of an existing cross-region
// read replica of the same source instance.
//
// * ErrCodeStorageTypeNotSupportedFault "StorageTypeNotSupported"
// Storage of the StorageType specified can't be associated with the DB instance.
//
// * ErrCodeKMSKeyNotAccessibleFault "KMSKeyNotAccessibleFault"
// An error occurred accessing an AWS KMS key.
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/CreateDBInstanceReadReplica
func (c *RDS) CreateDBInstanceReadReplica(input *CreateDBInstanceReadReplicaInput) (*CreateDBInstanceReadReplicaOutput, error) {
req, out := c.CreateDBInstanceReadReplicaRequest(input)
return out, req.Send()
}
// CreateDBInstanceReadReplicaWithContext is the same as CreateDBInstanceReadReplica with the addition of
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
//
// See CreateDBInstanceReadReplica for details on how to use this API operation.
//
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
// for more information on using Contexts.
func (c *RDS) CreateDBInstanceReadReplicaWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *CreateDBInstanceReadReplicaInput, opts ...request.Option) (*CreateDBInstanceReadReplicaOutput, error) {
req, out := c.CreateDBInstanceReadReplicaRequest(input)
req.SetContext(ctx)
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
return out, req.Send()
}
const opCreateDBParameterGroup = "CreateDBParameterGroup"
// CreateDBParameterGroupRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
// client's request for the CreateDBParameterGroup operation. The "output" return
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
// successfully.
//
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
//
// See CreateDBParameterGroup for more information on using the CreateDBParameterGroup
// API call, and error handling.
//
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
//
//
// // Example sending a request using the CreateDBParameterGroupRequest method.
// req, resp := client.CreateDBParameterGroupRequest(params)
//
// err := req.Send()
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
// fmt.Println(resp)
// }
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/CreateDBParameterGroup
func (c *RDS) CreateDBParameterGroupRequest(input *CreateDBParameterGroupInput) (req *request.Request, output *CreateDBParameterGroupOutput) {
op := &request.Operation{
Name: opCreateDBParameterGroup,
HTTPMethod: "POST",
HTTPPath: "/",
}
if input == nil {
input = &CreateDBParameterGroupInput{}
}
output = &CreateDBParameterGroupOutput{}
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
return
}
// CreateDBParameterGroup API operation for Amazon Relational Database Service.
//
// Creates a new DB parameter group.
//
// A DB parameter group is initially created with the default parameters for
// the database engine used by the DB instance. To provide custom values for
// any of the parameters, you must modify the group after creating it using
// ModifyDBParameterGroup. Once you've created a DB parameter group, you need
// to associate it with your DB instance using ModifyDBInstance. When you associate
// a new DB parameter group with a running DB instance, you need to reboot the
// DB instance without failover for the new DB parameter group and associated
// settings to take effect.
//
// After you create a DB parameter group, you should wait at least 5 minutes
// before creating your first DB instance that uses that DB parameter group
// as the default parameter group. This allows Amazon RDS to fully complete
// the create action before the parameter group is used as the default for a
// new DB instance. This is especially important for parameters that are critical
// when creating the default database for a DB instance, such as the character
// set for the default database defined by the character_set_database parameter.
// You can use the Parameter Groups option of the Amazon RDS console (https://console.aws.amazon.com/rds/)
// or the DescribeDBParameters command to verify that your DB parameter group
// has been created or modified.
//
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
// the error.
//
// See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Relational Database Service's
// API operation CreateDBParameterGroup for usage and error information.
//
// Returned Error Codes:
// * ErrCodeDBParameterGroupQuotaExceededFault "DBParameterGroupQuotaExceeded"
// The request would result in the user exceeding the allowed number of DB parameter
// groups.
//
// * ErrCodeDBParameterGroupAlreadyExistsFault "DBParameterGroupAlreadyExists"
// A DB parameter group with the same name exists.
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/CreateDBParameterGroup
func (c *RDS) CreateDBParameterGroup(input *CreateDBParameterGroupInput) (*CreateDBParameterGroupOutput, error) {
req, out := c.CreateDBParameterGroupRequest(input)
return out, req.Send()
}
// CreateDBParameterGroupWithContext is the same as CreateDBParameterGroup with the addition of
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
//
// See CreateDBParameterGroup for details on how to use this API operation.
//
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
// for more information on using Contexts.
func (c *RDS) CreateDBParameterGroupWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *CreateDBParameterGroupInput, opts ...request.Option) (*CreateDBParameterGroupOutput, error) {
req, out := c.CreateDBParameterGroupRequest(input)
req.SetContext(ctx)
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
return out, req.Send()
}
const opCreateDBSecurityGroup = "CreateDBSecurityGroup"
// CreateDBSecurityGroupRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
// client's request for the CreateDBSecurityGroup operation. The "output" return
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
// successfully.
//
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
//
// See CreateDBSecurityGroup for more information on using the CreateDBSecurityGroup
// API call, and error handling.
//
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
//
//
// // Example sending a request using the CreateDBSecurityGroupRequest method.
// req, resp := client.CreateDBSecurityGroupRequest(params)
//
// err := req.Send()
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
// fmt.Println(resp)
// }
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/CreateDBSecurityGroup
func (c *RDS) CreateDBSecurityGroupRequest(input *CreateDBSecurityGroupInput) (req *request.Request, output *CreateDBSecurityGroupOutput) {
op := &request.Operation{
Name: opCreateDBSecurityGroup,
HTTPMethod: "POST",
HTTPPath: "/",
}
if input == nil {
input = &CreateDBSecurityGroupInput{}
}
output = &CreateDBSecurityGroupOutput{}
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
return
}
// CreateDBSecurityGroup API operation for Amazon Relational Database Service.
//
// Creates a new DB security group. DB security groups control access to a DB
// instance.
//
// A DB security group controls access to EC2-Classic DB instances that are
// not in a VPC.
//
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
// the error.
//
// See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Relational Database Service's
// API operation CreateDBSecurityGroup for usage and error information.
//
// Returned Error Codes:
// * ErrCodeDBSecurityGroupAlreadyExistsFault "DBSecurityGroupAlreadyExists"
// A DB security group with the name specified in DBSecurityGroupName already
// exists.
//
// * ErrCodeDBSecurityGroupQuotaExceededFault "QuotaExceeded.DBSecurityGroup"
// The request would result in the user exceeding the allowed number of DB security
// groups.
//
// * ErrCodeDBSecurityGroupNotSupportedFault "DBSecurityGroupNotSupported"
// A DB security group isn't allowed for this action.
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/CreateDBSecurityGroup
func (c *RDS) CreateDBSecurityGroup(input *CreateDBSecurityGroupInput) (*CreateDBSecurityGroupOutput, error) {
req, out := c.CreateDBSecurityGroupRequest(input)
return out, req.Send()
}
// CreateDBSecurityGroupWithContext is the same as CreateDBSecurityGroup with the addition of
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
//
// See CreateDBSecurityGroup for details on how to use this API operation.
//
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
// for more information on using Contexts.
func (c *RDS) CreateDBSecurityGroupWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *CreateDBSecurityGroupInput, opts ...request.Option) (*CreateDBSecurityGroupOutput, error) {
req, out := c.CreateDBSecurityGroupRequest(input)
req.SetContext(ctx)
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
return out, req.Send()
}
const opCreateDBSnapshot = "CreateDBSnapshot"
// CreateDBSnapshotRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
// client's request for the CreateDBSnapshot operation. The "output" return
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
// successfully.
//
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
//
// See CreateDBSnapshot for more information on using the CreateDBSnapshot
// API call, and error handling.
//
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
//
//
// // Example sending a request using the CreateDBSnapshotRequest method.
// req, resp := client.CreateDBSnapshotRequest(params)
//
// err := req.Send()
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
// fmt.Println(resp)
// }
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/CreateDBSnapshot
func (c *RDS) CreateDBSnapshotRequest(input *CreateDBSnapshotInput) (req *request.Request, output *CreateDBSnapshotOutput) {
op := &request.Operation{
Name: opCreateDBSnapshot,
HTTPMethod: "POST",
HTTPPath: "/",
}
if input == nil {
input = &CreateDBSnapshotInput{}
}
output = &CreateDBSnapshotOutput{}
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
return
}
// CreateDBSnapshot API operation for Amazon Relational Database Service.
//
// Creates a DBSnapshot. The source DBInstance must be in "available" state.
//
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
// the error.
//
// See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Relational Database Service's
// API operation CreateDBSnapshot for usage and error information.
//
// Returned Error Codes:
// * ErrCodeDBSnapshotAlreadyExistsFault "DBSnapshotAlreadyExists"
// DBSnapshotIdentifier is already used by an existing snapshot.
//
// * ErrCodeInvalidDBInstanceStateFault "InvalidDBInstanceState"
// The DB instance isn't in a valid state.
//
// * ErrCodeDBInstanceNotFoundFault "DBInstanceNotFound"
// DBInstanceIdentifier doesn't refer to an existing DB instance.
//
// * ErrCodeSnapshotQuotaExceededFault "SnapshotQuotaExceeded"
// The request would result in the user exceeding the allowed number of DB snapshots.
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/CreateDBSnapshot
func (c *RDS) CreateDBSnapshot(input *CreateDBSnapshotInput) (*CreateDBSnapshotOutput, error) {
req, out := c.CreateDBSnapshotRequest(input)
return out, req.Send()
}
// CreateDBSnapshotWithContext is the same as CreateDBSnapshot with the addition of
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
//
// See CreateDBSnapshot for details on how to use this API operation.
//
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
// for more information on using Contexts.
func (c *RDS) CreateDBSnapshotWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *CreateDBSnapshotInput, opts ...request.Option) (*CreateDBSnapshotOutput, error) {
req, out := c.CreateDBSnapshotRequest(input)
req.SetContext(ctx)
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
return out, req.Send()
}
const opCreateDBSubnetGroup = "CreateDBSubnetGroup"
// CreateDBSubnetGroupRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
// client's request for the CreateDBSubnetGroup operation. The "output" return
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
// successfully.
//
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
//
// See CreateDBSubnetGroup for more information on using the CreateDBSubnetGroup
// API call, and error handling.
//
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
//
//
// // Example sending a request using the CreateDBSubnetGroupRequest method.
// req, resp := client.CreateDBSubnetGroupRequest(params)
//
// err := req.Send()
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
// fmt.Println(resp)
// }
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/CreateDBSubnetGroup
func (c *RDS) CreateDBSubnetGroupRequest(input *CreateDBSubnetGroupInput) (req *request.Request, output *CreateDBSubnetGroupOutput) {
op := &request.Operation{
Name: opCreateDBSubnetGroup,
HTTPMethod: "POST",
HTTPPath: "/",
}
if input == nil {
input = &CreateDBSubnetGroupInput{}
}
output = &CreateDBSubnetGroupOutput{}
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
return
}
// CreateDBSubnetGroup API operation for Amazon Relational Database Service.
//
// Creates a new DB subnet group. DB subnet groups must contain at least one
// subnet in at least two AZs in the AWS Region.
//
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
// the error.
//
// See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Relational Database Service's
// API operation CreateDBSubnetGroup for usage and error information.
//
// Returned Error Codes:
// * ErrCodeDBSubnetGroupAlreadyExistsFault "DBSubnetGroupAlreadyExists"
// DBSubnetGroupName is already used by an existing DB subnet group.
//
// * ErrCodeDBSubnetGroupQuotaExceededFault "DBSubnetGroupQuotaExceeded"
// The request would result in the user exceeding the allowed number of DB subnet
// groups.
//
// * ErrCodeDBSubnetQuotaExceededFault "DBSubnetQuotaExceededFault"
// The request would result in the user exceeding the allowed number of subnets
// in a DB subnet groups.
//
// * ErrCodeDBSubnetGroupDoesNotCoverEnoughAZs "DBSubnetGroupDoesNotCoverEnoughAZs"
// Subnets in the DB subnet group should cover at least two Availability Zones
// unless there is only one Availability Zone.
//
// * ErrCodeInvalidSubnet "InvalidSubnet"
// The requested subnet is invalid, or multiple subnets were requested that
// are not all in a common VPC.
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/CreateDBSubnetGroup
func (c *RDS) CreateDBSubnetGroup(input *CreateDBSubnetGroupInput) (*CreateDBSubnetGroupOutput, error) {
req, out := c.CreateDBSubnetGroupRequest(input)
return out, req.Send()
}
// CreateDBSubnetGroupWithContext is the same as CreateDBSubnetGroup with the addition of
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
//
// See CreateDBSubnetGroup for details on how to use this API operation.
//
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
// for more information on using Contexts.
func (c *RDS) CreateDBSubnetGroupWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *CreateDBSubnetGroupInput, opts ...request.Option) (*CreateDBSubnetGroupOutput, error) {
req, out := c.CreateDBSubnetGroupRequest(input)
req.SetContext(ctx)
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
return out, req.Send()
}
const opCreateEventSubscription = "CreateEventSubscription"
// CreateEventSubscriptionRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
// client's request for the CreateEventSubscription operation. The "output" return
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
// successfully.
//
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
//
// See CreateEventSubscription for more information on using the CreateEventSubscription
// API call, and error handling.
//
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
//
//
// // Example sending a request using the CreateEventSubscriptionRequest method.
// req, resp := client.CreateEventSubscriptionRequest(params)
//
// err := req.Send()
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
// fmt.Println(resp)
// }
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/CreateEventSubscription
func (c *RDS) CreateEventSubscriptionRequest(input *CreateEventSubscriptionInput) (req *request.Request, output *CreateEventSubscriptionOutput) {
op := &request.Operation{
Name: opCreateEventSubscription,
HTTPMethod: "POST",
HTTPPath: "/",
}
if input == nil {
input = &CreateEventSubscriptionInput{}
}
output = &CreateEventSubscriptionOutput{}
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
return
}
// CreateEventSubscription API operation for Amazon Relational Database Service.
//
// Creates an RDS event notification subscription. This action requires a topic
// ARN (Amazon Resource Name) created by either the RDS console, the SNS console,
// or the SNS API. To obtain an ARN with SNS, you must create a topic in Amazon
// SNS and subscribe to the topic. The ARN is displayed in the SNS console.
//
// You can specify the type of source (SourceType) you want to be notified of,
// provide a list of RDS sources (SourceIds) that triggers the events, and provide
// a list of event categories (EventCategories) for events you want to be notified
// of. For example, you can specify SourceType = db-instance, SourceIds = mydbinstance1,
// mydbinstance2 and EventCategories = Availability, Backup.
//
// If you specify both the SourceType and SourceIds, such as SourceType = db-instance
// and SourceIdentifier = myDBInstance1, you are notified of all the db-instance
// events for the specified source. If you specify a SourceType but do not specify
// a SourceIdentifier, you receive notice of the events for that source type
// for all your RDS sources. If you do not specify either the SourceType nor
// the SourceIdentifier, you are notified of events generated from all RDS sources
// belonging to your customer account.
//
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
// the error.
//
// See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Relational Database Service's
// API operation CreateEventSubscription for usage and error information.
//
// Returned Error Codes:
// * ErrCodeEventSubscriptionQuotaExceededFault "EventSubscriptionQuotaExceeded"
// You have reached the maximum number of event subscriptions.
//
// * ErrCodeSubscriptionAlreadyExistFault "SubscriptionAlreadyExist"
// The supplied subscription name already exists.
//
// * ErrCodeSNSInvalidTopicFault "SNSInvalidTopic"
// SNS has responded that there is a problem with the SND topic specified.
//
// * ErrCodeSNSNoAuthorizationFault "SNSNoAuthorization"
// You do not have permission to publish to the SNS topic ARN.
//
// * ErrCodeSNSTopicArnNotFoundFault "SNSTopicArnNotFound"
// The SNS topic ARN does not exist.
//
// * ErrCodeSubscriptionCategoryNotFoundFault "SubscriptionCategoryNotFound"
// The supplied category does not exist.
//
// * ErrCodeSourceNotFoundFault "SourceNotFound"
// The requested source could not be found.
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/CreateEventSubscription
func (c *RDS) CreateEventSubscription(input *CreateEventSubscriptionInput) (*CreateEventSubscriptionOutput, error) {
req, out := c.CreateEventSubscriptionRequest(input)
return out, req.Send()
}
// CreateEventSubscriptionWithContext is the same as CreateEventSubscription with the addition of
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
//
// See CreateEventSubscription for details on how to use this API operation.
//
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
// for more information on using Contexts.
func (c *RDS) CreateEventSubscriptionWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *CreateEventSubscriptionInput, opts ...request.Option) (*CreateEventSubscriptionOutput, error) {
req, out := c.CreateEventSubscriptionRequest(input)
req.SetContext(ctx)
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
return out, req.Send()
}
const opCreateGlobalCluster = "CreateGlobalCluster"
// CreateGlobalClusterRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
// client's request for the CreateGlobalCluster operation. The "output" return
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
// successfully.
//
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
//
// See CreateGlobalCluster for more information on using the CreateGlobalCluster
// API call, and error handling.
//
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
//
//
// // Example sending a request using the CreateGlobalClusterRequest method.
// req, resp := client.CreateGlobalClusterRequest(params)
//
// err := req.Send()
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
// fmt.Println(resp)
// }
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/CreateGlobalCluster
func (c *RDS) CreateGlobalClusterRequest(input *CreateGlobalClusterInput) (req *request.Request, output *CreateGlobalClusterOutput) {
op := &request.Operation{
Name: opCreateGlobalCluster,
HTTPMethod: "POST",
HTTPPath: "/",
}
if input == nil {
input = &CreateGlobalClusterInput{}
}
output = &CreateGlobalClusterOutput{}
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
return
}
// CreateGlobalCluster API operation for Amazon Relational Database Service.
//
// Creates an Aurora global database spread across multiple regions. The global
// database contains a single primary cluster with read-write capability, and
// a read-only secondary cluster that receives data from the primary cluster
// through high-speed replication performed by the Aurora storage subsystem.
//
// You can create a global database that is initially empty, and then add a
// primary cluster and a secondary cluster to it. Or you can specify an existing
// Aurora cluster during the create operation, and this cluster becomes the
// primary cluster of the global database.
//
// This action only applies to Aurora DB clusters.
//
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
// the error.
//
// See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Relational Database Service's
// API operation CreateGlobalCluster for usage and error information.
//
// Returned Error Codes:
// * ErrCodeGlobalClusterAlreadyExistsFault "GlobalClusterAlreadyExistsFault"
//
// * ErrCodeGlobalClusterQuotaExceededFault "GlobalClusterQuotaExceededFault"
//
// * ErrCodeInvalidDBClusterStateFault "InvalidDBClusterStateFault"
// The requested operation can't be performed while the cluster is in this state.
//
// * ErrCodeDBClusterNotFoundFault "DBClusterNotFoundFault"
// DBClusterIdentifier doesn't refer to an existing DB cluster.
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/CreateGlobalCluster
func (c *RDS) CreateGlobalCluster(input *CreateGlobalClusterInput) (*CreateGlobalClusterOutput, error) {
req, out := c.CreateGlobalClusterRequest(input)
return out, req.Send()
}
// CreateGlobalClusterWithContext is the same as CreateGlobalCluster with the addition of
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
//
// See CreateGlobalCluster for details on how to use this API operation.
//
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
// for more information on using Contexts.
func (c *RDS) CreateGlobalClusterWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *CreateGlobalClusterInput, opts ...request.Option) (*CreateGlobalClusterOutput, error) {
req, out := c.CreateGlobalClusterRequest(input)
req.SetContext(ctx)
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
return out, req.Send()
}
const opCreateOptionGroup = "CreateOptionGroup"
// CreateOptionGroupRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
// client's request for the CreateOptionGroup operation. The "output" return
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
// successfully.
//
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
//
// See CreateOptionGroup for more information on using the CreateOptionGroup
// API call, and error handling.
//
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
//
//
// // Example sending a request using the CreateOptionGroupRequest method.
// req, resp := client.CreateOptionGroupRequest(params)
//
// err := req.Send()
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
// fmt.Println(resp)
// }
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/CreateOptionGroup
func (c *RDS) CreateOptionGroupRequest(input *CreateOptionGroupInput) (req *request.Request, output *CreateOptionGroupOutput) {
op := &request.Operation{
Name: opCreateOptionGroup,
HTTPMethod: "POST",
HTTPPath: "/",
}
if input == nil {
input = &CreateOptionGroupInput{}
}
output = &CreateOptionGroupOutput{}
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
return
}
// CreateOptionGroup API operation for Amazon Relational Database Service.
//
// Creates a new option group. You can create up to 20 option groups.
//
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
// the error.
//
// See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Relational Database Service's
// API operation CreateOptionGroup for usage and error information.
//
// Returned Error Codes:
// * ErrCodeOptionGroupAlreadyExistsFault "OptionGroupAlreadyExistsFault"
// The option group you are trying to create already exists.
//
// * ErrCodeOptionGroupQuotaExceededFault "OptionGroupQuotaExceededFault"
// The quota of 20 option groups was exceeded for this AWS account.
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/CreateOptionGroup
func (c *RDS) CreateOptionGroup(input *CreateOptionGroupInput) (*CreateOptionGroupOutput, error) {
req, out := c.CreateOptionGroupRequest(input)
return out, req.Send()
}
// CreateOptionGroupWithContext is the same as CreateOptionGroup with the addition of
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
//
// See CreateOptionGroup for details on how to use this API operation.
//
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
// for more information on using Contexts.
func (c *RDS) CreateOptionGroupWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *CreateOptionGroupInput, opts ...request.Option) (*CreateOptionGroupOutput, error) {
req, out := c.CreateOptionGroupRequest(input)
req.SetContext(ctx)
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
return out, req.Send()
}
const opDeleteDBCluster = "DeleteDBCluster"
// DeleteDBClusterRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
// client's request for the DeleteDBCluster operation. The "output" return
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
// successfully.
//
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
//
// See DeleteDBCluster for more information on using the DeleteDBCluster
// API call, and error handling.
//
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
//
//
// // Example sending a request using the DeleteDBClusterRequest method.
// req, resp := client.DeleteDBClusterRequest(params)
//
// err := req.Send()
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
// fmt.Println(resp)
// }
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/DeleteDBCluster
func (c *RDS) DeleteDBClusterRequest(input *DeleteDBClusterInput) (req *request.Request, output *DeleteDBClusterOutput) {
op := &request.Operation{
Name: opDeleteDBCluster,
HTTPMethod: "POST",
HTTPPath: "/",
}
if input == nil {
input = &DeleteDBClusterInput{}
}
output = &DeleteDBClusterOutput{}
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
return
}
// DeleteDBCluster API operation for Amazon Relational Database Service.
//
// The DeleteDBCluster action deletes a previously provisioned DB cluster. When
// you delete a DB cluster, all automated backups for that DB cluster are deleted
// and can't be recovered. Manual DB cluster snapshots of the specified DB cluster
// are not deleted.
//
// For more information on Amazon Aurora, see What Is Amazon Aurora? (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/AuroraUserGuide/CHAP_AuroraOverview.html)in the Amazon Aurora User Guide.
//
// This action only applies to Aurora DB clusters.
//
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
// the error.
//
// See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Relational Database Service's
// API operation DeleteDBCluster for usage and error information.
//
// Returned Error Codes:
// * ErrCodeDBClusterNotFoundFault "DBClusterNotFoundFault"
// DBClusterIdentifier doesn't refer to an existing DB cluster.
//
// * ErrCodeInvalidDBClusterStateFault "InvalidDBClusterStateFault"
// The requested operation can't be performed while the cluster is in this state.
//
// * ErrCodeDBClusterSnapshotAlreadyExistsFault "DBClusterSnapshotAlreadyExistsFault"
// The user already has a DB cluster snapshot with the given identifier.
//
// * ErrCodeSnapshotQuotaExceededFault "SnapshotQuotaExceeded"
// The request would result in the user exceeding the allowed number of DB snapshots.
//
// * ErrCodeInvalidDBClusterSnapshotStateFault "InvalidDBClusterSnapshotStateFault"
// The supplied value isn't a valid DB cluster snapshot state.
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/DeleteDBCluster
func (c *RDS) DeleteDBCluster(input *DeleteDBClusterInput) (*DeleteDBClusterOutput, error) {
req, out := c.DeleteDBClusterRequest(input)
return out, req.Send()
}
// DeleteDBClusterWithContext is the same as DeleteDBCluster with the addition of
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
//
// See DeleteDBCluster for details on how to use this API operation.
//
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
// for more information on using Contexts.
func (c *RDS) DeleteDBClusterWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DeleteDBClusterInput, opts ...request.Option) (*DeleteDBClusterOutput, error) {
req, out := c.DeleteDBClusterRequest(input)
req.SetContext(ctx)
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
return out, req.Send()
}
const opDeleteDBClusterEndpoint = "DeleteDBClusterEndpoint"
// DeleteDBClusterEndpointRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
// client's request for the DeleteDBClusterEndpoint operation. The "output" return
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
// successfully.
//
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
//
// See DeleteDBClusterEndpoint for more information on using the DeleteDBClusterEndpoint
// API call, and error handling.
//
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
//
//
// // Example sending a request using the DeleteDBClusterEndpointRequest method.
// req, resp := client.DeleteDBClusterEndpointRequest(params)
//
// err := req.Send()
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
// fmt.Println(resp)
// }
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/DeleteDBClusterEndpoint
func (c *RDS) DeleteDBClusterEndpointRequest(input *DeleteDBClusterEndpointInput) (req *request.Request, output *DeleteDBClusterEndpointOutput) {
op := &request.Operation{
Name: opDeleteDBClusterEndpoint,
HTTPMethod: "POST",
HTTPPath: "/",
}
if input == nil {
input = &DeleteDBClusterEndpointInput{}
}
output = &DeleteDBClusterEndpointOutput{}
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
return
}
// DeleteDBClusterEndpoint API operation for Amazon Relational Database Service.
//
// Deletes a custom endpoint and removes it from an Amazon Aurora DB cluster.
//
// This action only applies to Aurora DB clusters.
//
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
// the error.
//
// See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Relational Database Service's
// API operation DeleteDBClusterEndpoint for usage and error information.
//
// Returned Error Codes:
// * ErrCodeInvalidDBClusterEndpointStateFault "InvalidDBClusterEndpointStateFault"
// The requested operation can't be performed on the endpoint while the endpoint
// is in this state.
//
// * ErrCodeDBClusterEndpointNotFoundFault "DBClusterEndpointNotFoundFault"
// The specified custom endpoint doesn't exist.
//
// * ErrCodeInvalidDBClusterStateFault "InvalidDBClusterStateFault"
// The requested operation can't be performed while the cluster is in this state.
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/DeleteDBClusterEndpoint
func (c *RDS) DeleteDBClusterEndpoint(input *DeleteDBClusterEndpointInput) (*DeleteDBClusterEndpointOutput, error) {
req, out := c.DeleteDBClusterEndpointRequest(input)
return out, req.Send()
}
// DeleteDBClusterEndpointWithContext is the same as DeleteDBClusterEndpoint with the addition of
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
//
// See DeleteDBClusterEndpoint for details on how to use this API operation.
//
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
// for more information on using Contexts.
func (c *RDS) DeleteDBClusterEndpointWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DeleteDBClusterEndpointInput, opts ...request.Option) (*DeleteDBClusterEndpointOutput, error) {
req, out := c.DeleteDBClusterEndpointRequest(input)
req.SetContext(ctx)
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
return out, req.Send()
}
const opDeleteDBClusterParameterGroup = "DeleteDBClusterParameterGroup"
// DeleteDBClusterParameterGroupRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
// client's request for the DeleteDBClusterParameterGroup operation. The "output" return
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
// successfully.
//
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
//
// See DeleteDBClusterParameterGroup for more information on using the DeleteDBClusterParameterGroup
// API call, and error handling.
//
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
//
//
// // Example sending a request using the DeleteDBClusterParameterGroupRequest method.
// req, resp := client.DeleteDBClusterParameterGroupRequest(params)
//
// err := req.Send()
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
// fmt.Println(resp)
// }
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/DeleteDBClusterParameterGroup
func (c *RDS) DeleteDBClusterParameterGroupRequest(input *DeleteDBClusterParameterGroupInput) (req *request.Request, output *DeleteDBClusterParameterGroupOutput) {
op := &request.Operation{
Name: opDeleteDBClusterParameterGroup,
HTTPMethod: "POST",
HTTPPath: "/",
}
if input == nil {
input = &DeleteDBClusterParameterGroupInput{}
}
output = &DeleteDBClusterParameterGroupOutput{}
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
req.Handlers.Unmarshal.Swap(query.UnmarshalHandler.Name, protocol.UnmarshalDiscardBodyHandler)
return
}
// DeleteDBClusterParameterGroup API operation for Amazon Relational Database Service.
//
// Deletes a specified DB cluster parameter group. The DB cluster parameter
// group to be deleted can't be associated with any DB clusters.
//
// For more information on Amazon Aurora, see What Is Amazon Aurora? (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/AuroraUserGuide/CHAP_AuroraOverview.html)
// in the Amazon Aurora User Guide.
//
// This action only applies to Aurora DB clusters.
//
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
// the error.
//
// See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Relational Database Service's
// API operation DeleteDBClusterParameterGroup for usage and error information.
//
// Returned Error Codes:
// * ErrCodeInvalidDBParameterGroupStateFault "InvalidDBParameterGroupState"
// The DB parameter group is in use or is in an invalid state. If you are attempting
// to delete the parameter group, you can't delete it when the parameter group
// is in this state.
//
// * ErrCodeDBParameterGroupNotFoundFault "DBParameterGroupNotFound"
// DBParameterGroupName doesn't refer to an existing DB parameter group.
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/DeleteDBClusterParameterGroup
func (c *RDS) DeleteDBClusterParameterGroup(input *DeleteDBClusterParameterGroupInput) (*DeleteDBClusterParameterGroupOutput, error) {
req, out := c.DeleteDBClusterParameterGroupRequest(input)
return out, req.Send()
}
// DeleteDBClusterParameterGroupWithContext is the same as DeleteDBClusterParameterGroup with the addition of
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
//
// See DeleteDBClusterParameterGroup for details on how to use this API operation.
//
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
// for more information on using Contexts.
func (c *RDS) DeleteDBClusterParameterGroupWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DeleteDBClusterParameterGroupInput, opts ...request.Option) (*DeleteDBClusterParameterGroupOutput, error) {
req, out := c.DeleteDBClusterParameterGroupRequest(input)
req.SetContext(ctx)
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
return out, req.Send()
}
const opDeleteDBClusterSnapshot = "DeleteDBClusterSnapshot"
// DeleteDBClusterSnapshotRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
// client's request for the DeleteDBClusterSnapshot operation. The "output" return
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
// successfully.
//
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
//
// See DeleteDBClusterSnapshot for more information on using the DeleteDBClusterSnapshot
// API call, and error handling.
//
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
//
//
// // Example sending a request using the DeleteDBClusterSnapshotRequest method.
// req, resp := client.DeleteDBClusterSnapshotRequest(params)
//
// err := req.Send()
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
// fmt.Println(resp)
// }
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/DeleteDBClusterSnapshot
func (c *RDS) DeleteDBClusterSnapshotRequest(input *DeleteDBClusterSnapshotInput) (req *request.Request, output *DeleteDBClusterSnapshotOutput) {
op := &request.Operation{
Name: opDeleteDBClusterSnapshot,
HTTPMethod: "POST",
HTTPPath: "/",
}
if input == nil {
input = &DeleteDBClusterSnapshotInput{}
}
output = &DeleteDBClusterSnapshotOutput{}
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
return
}
// DeleteDBClusterSnapshot API operation for Amazon Relational Database Service.
//
// Deletes a DB cluster snapshot. If the snapshot is being copied, the copy
// operation is terminated.
//
// The DB cluster snapshot must be in the available state to be deleted.
//
// For more information on Amazon Aurora, see What Is Amazon Aurora? (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/AuroraUserGuide/CHAP_AuroraOverview.html)
// in the Amazon Aurora User Guide.
//
// This action only applies to Aurora DB clusters.
//
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
// the error.
//
// See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Relational Database Service's
// API operation DeleteDBClusterSnapshot for usage and error information.
//
// Returned Error Codes:
// * ErrCodeInvalidDBClusterSnapshotStateFault "InvalidDBClusterSnapshotStateFault"
// The supplied value isn't a valid DB cluster snapshot state.
//
// * ErrCodeDBClusterSnapshotNotFoundFault "DBClusterSnapshotNotFoundFault"
// DBClusterSnapshotIdentifier doesn't refer to an existing DB cluster snapshot.
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/DeleteDBClusterSnapshot
func (c *RDS) DeleteDBClusterSnapshot(input *DeleteDBClusterSnapshotInput) (*DeleteDBClusterSnapshotOutput, error) {
req, out := c.DeleteDBClusterSnapshotRequest(input)
return out, req.Send()
}
// DeleteDBClusterSnapshotWithContext is the same as DeleteDBClusterSnapshot with the addition of
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
//
// See DeleteDBClusterSnapshot for details on how to use this API operation.
//
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
// for more information on using Contexts.
func (c *RDS) DeleteDBClusterSnapshotWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DeleteDBClusterSnapshotInput, opts ...request.Option) (*DeleteDBClusterSnapshotOutput, error) {
req, out := c.DeleteDBClusterSnapshotRequest(input)
req.SetContext(ctx)
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
return out, req.Send()
}
const opDeleteDBInstance = "DeleteDBInstance"
// DeleteDBInstanceRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
// client's request for the DeleteDBInstance operation. The "output" return
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
// successfully.
//
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
//
// See DeleteDBInstance for more information on using the DeleteDBInstance
// API call, and error handling.
//
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
//
//
// // Example sending a request using the DeleteDBInstanceRequest method.
// req, resp := client.DeleteDBInstanceRequest(params)
//
// err := req.Send()
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
// fmt.Println(resp)
// }
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/DeleteDBInstance
func (c *RDS) DeleteDBInstanceRequest(input *DeleteDBInstanceInput) (req *request.Request, output *DeleteDBInstanceOutput) {
op := &request.Operation{
Name: opDeleteDBInstance,
HTTPMethod: "POST",
HTTPPath: "/",
}
if input == nil {
input = &DeleteDBInstanceInput{}
}
output = &DeleteDBInstanceOutput{}
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
return
}
// DeleteDBInstance API operation for Amazon Relational Database Service.
//
// The DeleteDBInstance action deletes a previously provisioned DB instance.
// When you delete a DB instance, all automated backups for that instance are
// deleted and can't be recovered. Manual DB snapshots of the DB instance to
// be deleted by DeleteDBInstance are not deleted.
//
// If you request a final DB snapshot the status of the Amazon RDS DB instance
// is deleting until the DB snapshot is created. The API action DescribeDBInstance
// is used to monitor the status of this operation. The action can't be canceled
// or reverted once submitted.
//
// Note that when a DB instance is in a failure state and has a status of failed,
// incompatible-restore, or incompatible-network, you can only delete it when
// the SkipFinalSnapshot parameter is set to true.
//
// If the specified DB instance is part of an Amazon Aurora DB cluster, you
// can't delete the DB instance if both of the following conditions are true:
//
// * The DB cluster is a Read Replica of another Amazon Aurora DB cluster.
//
// * The DB instance is the only instance in the DB cluster.
//
// To delete a DB instance in this case, first call the PromoteReadReplicaDBCluster
// API action to promote the DB cluster so it's no longer a Read Replica. After
// the promotion completes, then call the DeleteDBInstance API action to delete
// the final instance in the DB cluster.
//
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
// the error.
//
// See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Relational Database Service's
// API operation DeleteDBInstance for usage and error information.
//
// Returned Error Codes:
// * ErrCodeDBInstanceNotFoundFault "DBInstanceNotFound"
// DBInstanceIdentifier doesn't refer to an existing DB instance.
//
// * ErrCodeInvalidDBInstanceStateFault "InvalidDBInstanceState"
// The DB instance isn't in a valid state.
//
// * ErrCodeDBSnapshotAlreadyExistsFault "DBSnapshotAlreadyExists"
// DBSnapshotIdentifier is already used by an existing snapshot.
//
// * ErrCodeSnapshotQuotaExceededFault "SnapshotQuotaExceeded"
// The request would result in the user exceeding the allowed number of DB snapshots.
//
// * ErrCodeInvalidDBClusterStateFault "InvalidDBClusterStateFault"
// The requested operation can't be performed while the cluster is in this state.
//
// * ErrCodeDBInstanceAutomatedBackupQuotaExceededFault "DBInstanceAutomatedBackupQuotaExceeded"
// The quota for retained automated backups was exceeded. This prevents you
// from retaining any additional automated backups. The retained automated backups
// quota is the same as your DB Instance quota.
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/DeleteDBInstance
func (c *RDS) DeleteDBInstance(input *DeleteDBInstanceInput) (*DeleteDBInstanceOutput, error) {
req, out := c.DeleteDBInstanceRequest(input)
return out, req.Send()
}
// DeleteDBInstanceWithContext is the same as DeleteDBInstance with the addition of
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
//
// See DeleteDBInstance for details on how to use this API operation.
//
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
// for more information on using Contexts.
func (c *RDS) DeleteDBInstanceWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DeleteDBInstanceInput, opts ...request.Option) (*DeleteDBInstanceOutput, error) {
req, out := c.DeleteDBInstanceRequest(input)
req.SetContext(ctx)
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
return out, req.Send()
}
const opDeleteDBInstanceAutomatedBackup = "DeleteDBInstanceAutomatedBackup"
// DeleteDBInstanceAutomatedBackupRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
// client's request for the DeleteDBInstanceAutomatedBackup operation. The "output" return
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
// successfully.
//
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
//
// See DeleteDBInstanceAutomatedBackup for more information on using the DeleteDBInstanceAutomatedBackup
// API call, and error handling.
//
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
//
//
// // Example sending a request using the DeleteDBInstanceAutomatedBackupRequest method.
// req, resp := client.DeleteDBInstanceAutomatedBackupRequest(params)
//
// err := req.Send()
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
// fmt.Println(resp)
// }
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/DeleteDBInstanceAutomatedBackup
func (c *RDS) DeleteDBInstanceAutomatedBackupRequest(input *DeleteDBInstanceAutomatedBackupInput) (req *request.Request, output *DeleteDBInstanceAutomatedBackupOutput) {
op := &request.Operation{
Name: opDeleteDBInstanceAutomatedBackup,
HTTPMethod: "POST",
HTTPPath: "/",
}
if input == nil {
input = &DeleteDBInstanceAutomatedBackupInput{}
}
output = &DeleteDBInstanceAutomatedBackupOutput{}
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
return
}
// DeleteDBInstanceAutomatedBackup API operation for Amazon Relational Database Service.
//
// Deletes automated backups based on the source instance's DbiResourceId value
// or the restorable instance's resource ID.
//
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
// the error.
//
// See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Relational Database Service's
// API operation DeleteDBInstanceAutomatedBackup for usage and error information.
//
// Returned Error Codes:
// * ErrCodeInvalidDBInstanceAutomatedBackupStateFault "InvalidDBInstanceAutomatedBackupState"
// The automated backup is in an invalid state. For example, this automated
// backup is associated with an active instance.
//
// * ErrCodeDBInstanceAutomatedBackupNotFoundFault "DBInstanceAutomatedBackupNotFound"
// No automated backup for this DB instance was found.
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/DeleteDBInstanceAutomatedBackup
func (c *RDS) DeleteDBInstanceAutomatedBackup(input *DeleteDBInstanceAutomatedBackupInput) (*DeleteDBInstanceAutomatedBackupOutput, error) {
req, out := c.DeleteDBInstanceAutomatedBackupRequest(input)
return out, req.Send()
}
// DeleteDBInstanceAutomatedBackupWithContext is the same as DeleteDBInstanceAutomatedBackup with the addition of
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
//
// See DeleteDBInstanceAutomatedBackup for details on how to use this API operation.
//
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
// for more information on using Contexts.
func (c *RDS) DeleteDBInstanceAutomatedBackupWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DeleteDBInstanceAutomatedBackupInput, opts ...request.Option) (*DeleteDBInstanceAutomatedBackupOutput, error) {
req, out := c.DeleteDBInstanceAutomatedBackupRequest(input)
req.SetContext(ctx)
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
return out, req.Send()
}
const opDeleteDBParameterGroup = "DeleteDBParameterGroup"
// DeleteDBParameterGroupRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
// client's request for the DeleteDBParameterGroup operation. The "output" return
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
// successfully.
//
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
//
// See DeleteDBParameterGroup for more information on using the DeleteDBParameterGroup
// API call, and error handling.
//
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
//
//
// // Example sending a request using the DeleteDBParameterGroupRequest method.
// req, resp := client.DeleteDBParameterGroupRequest(params)
//
// err := req.Send()
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
// fmt.Println(resp)
// }
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/DeleteDBParameterGroup
func (c *RDS) DeleteDBParameterGroupRequest(input *DeleteDBParameterGroupInput) (req *request.Request, output *DeleteDBParameterGroupOutput) {
op := &request.Operation{
Name: opDeleteDBParameterGroup,
HTTPMethod: "POST",
HTTPPath: "/",
}
if input == nil {
input = &DeleteDBParameterGroupInput{}
}
output = &DeleteDBParameterGroupOutput{}
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
req.Handlers.Unmarshal.Swap(query.UnmarshalHandler.Name, protocol.UnmarshalDiscardBodyHandler)
return
}
// DeleteDBParameterGroup API operation for Amazon Relational Database Service.
//
// Deletes a specified DB parameter group. The DB parameter group to be deleted
// can't be associated with any DB instances.
//
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
// the error.
//
// See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Relational Database Service's
// API operation DeleteDBParameterGroup for usage and error information.
//
// Returned Error Codes:
// * ErrCodeInvalidDBParameterGroupStateFault "InvalidDBParameterGroupState"
// The DB parameter group is in use or is in an invalid state. If you are attempting
// to delete the parameter group, you can't delete it when the parameter group
// is in this state.
//
// * ErrCodeDBParameterGroupNotFoundFault "DBParameterGroupNotFound"
// DBParameterGroupName doesn't refer to an existing DB parameter group.
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/DeleteDBParameterGroup
func (c *RDS) DeleteDBParameterGroup(input *DeleteDBParameterGroupInput) (*DeleteDBParameterGroupOutput, error) {
req, out := c.DeleteDBParameterGroupRequest(input)
return out, req.Send()
}
// DeleteDBParameterGroupWithContext is the same as DeleteDBParameterGroup with the addition of
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
//
// See DeleteDBParameterGroup for details on how to use this API operation.
//
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
// for more information on using Contexts.
func (c *RDS) DeleteDBParameterGroupWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DeleteDBParameterGroupInput, opts ...request.Option) (*DeleteDBParameterGroupOutput, error) {
req, out := c.DeleteDBParameterGroupRequest(input)
req.SetContext(ctx)
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
return out, req.Send()
}
const opDeleteDBSecurityGroup = "DeleteDBSecurityGroup"
// DeleteDBSecurityGroupRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
// client's request for the DeleteDBSecurityGroup operation. The "output" return
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
// successfully.
//
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
//
// See DeleteDBSecurityGroup for more information on using the DeleteDBSecurityGroup
// API call, and error handling.
//
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
//
//
// // Example sending a request using the DeleteDBSecurityGroupRequest method.
// req, resp := client.DeleteDBSecurityGroupRequest(params)
//
// err := req.Send()
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
// fmt.Println(resp)
// }
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/DeleteDBSecurityGroup
func (c *RDS) DeleteDBSecurityGroupRequest(input *DeleteDBSecurityGroupInput) (req *request.Request, output *DeleteDBSecurityGroupOutput) {
op := &request.Operation{
Name: opDeleteDBSecurityGroup,
HTTPMethod: "POST",
HTTPPath: "/",
}
if input == nil {
input = &DeleteDBSecurityGroupInput{}
}
output = &DeleteDBSecurityGroupOutput{}
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
req.Handlers.Unmarshal.Swap(query.UnmarshalHandler.Name, protocol.UnmarshalDiscardBodyHandler)
return
}
// DeleteDBSecurityGroup API operation for Amazon Relational Database Service.
//
// Deletes a DB security group.
//
// The specified DB security group must not be associated with any DB instances.
//
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
// the error.
//
// See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Relational Database Service's
// API operation DeleteDBSecurityGroup for usage and error information.
//
// Returned Error Codes:
// * ErrCodeInvalidDBSecurityGroupStateFault "InvalidDBSecurityGroupState"
// The state of the DB security group doesn't allow deletion.
//
// * ErrCodeDBSecurityGroupNotFoundFault "DBSecurityGroupNotFound"
// DBSecurityGroupName doesn't refer to an existing DB security group.
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/DeleteDBSecurityGroup
func (c *RDS) DeleteDBSecurityGroup(input *DeleteDBSecurityGroupInput) (*DeleteDBSecurityGroupOutput, error) {
req, out := c.DeleteDBSecurityGroupRequest(input)
return out, req.Send()
}
// DeleteDBSecurityGroupWithContext is the same as DeleteDBSecurityGroup with the addition of
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
//
// See DeleteDBSecurityGroup for details on how to use this API operation.
//
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
// for more information on using Contexts.
func (c *RDS) DeleteDBSecurityGroupWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DeleteDBSecurityGroupInput, opts ...request.Option) (*DeleteDBSecurityGroupOutput, error) {
req, out := c.DeleteDBSecurityGroupRequest(input)
req.SetContext(ctx)
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
return out, req.Send()
}
const opDeleteDBSnapshot = "DeleteDBSnapshot"
// DeleteDBSnapshotRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
// client's request for the DeleteDBSnapshot operation. The "output" return
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
// successfully.
//
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
//
// See DeleteDBSnapshot for more information on using the DeleteDBSnapshot
// API call, and error handling.
//
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
//
//
// // Example sending a request using the DeleteDBSnapshotRequest method.
// req, resp := client.DeleteDBSnapshotRequest(params)
//
// err := req.Send()
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
// fmt.Println(resp)
// }
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/DeleteDBSnapshot
func (c *RDS) DeleteDBSnapshotRequest(input *DeleteDBSnapshotInput) (req *request.Request, output *DeleteDBSnapshotOutput) {
op := &request.Operation{
Name: opDeleteDBSnapshot,
HTTPMethod: "POST",
HTTPPath: "/",
}
if input == nil {
input = &DeleteDBSnapshotInput{}
}
output = &DeleteDBSnapshotOutput{}
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
return
}
// DeleteDBSnapshot API operation for Amazon Relational Database Service.
//
// Deletes a DB snapshot. If the snapshot is being copied, the copy operation
// is terminated.
//
// The DB snapshot must be in the available state to be deleted.
//
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
// the error.
//
// See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Relational Database Service's
// API operation DeleteDBSnapshot for usage and error information.
//
// Returned Error Codes:
// * ErrCodeInvalidDBSnapshotStateFault "InvalidDBSnapshotState"
// The state of the DB snapshot doesn't allow deletion.
//
// * ErrCodeDBSnapshotNotFoundFault "DBSnapshotNotFound"
// DBSnapshotIdentifier doesn't refer to an existing DB snapshot.
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/DeleteDBSnapshot
func (c *RDS) DeleteDBSnapshot(input *DeleteDBSnapshotInput) (*DeleteDBSnapshotOutput, error) {
req, out := c.DeleteDBSnapshotRequest(input)
return out, req.Send()
}
// DeleteDBSnapshotWithContext is the same as DeleteDBSnapshot with the addition of
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
//
// See DeleteDBSnapshot for details on how to use this API operation.
//
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
// for more information on using Contexts.
func (c *RDS) DeleteDBSnapshotWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DeleteDBSnapshotInput, opts ...request.Option) (*DeleteDBSnapshotOutput, error) {
req, out := c.DeleteDBSnapshotRequest(input)
req.SetContext(ctx)
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
return out, req.Send()
}
const opDeleteDBSubnetGroup = "DeleteDBSubnetGroup"
// DeleteDBSubnetGroupRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
// client's request for the DeleteDBSubnetGroup operation. The "output" return
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
// successfully.
//
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
//
// See DeleteDBSubnetGroup for more information on using the DeleteDBSubnetGroup
// API call, and error handling.
//
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
//
//
// // Example sending a request using the DeleteDBSubnetGroupRequest method.
// req, resp := client.DeleteDBSubnetGroupRequest(params)
//
// err := req.Send()
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
// fmt.Println(resp)
// }
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/DeleteDBSubnetGroup
func (c *RDS) DeleteDBSubnetGroupRequest(input *DeleteDBSubnetGroupInput) (req *request.Request, output *DeleteDBSubnetGroupOutput) {
op := &request.Operation{
Name: opDeleteDBSubnetGroup,
HTTPMethod: "POST",
HTTPPath: "/",
}
if input == nil {
input = &DeleteDBSubnetGroupInput{}
}
output = &DeleteDBSubnetGroupOutput{}
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
req.Handlers.Unmarshal.Swap(query.UnmarshalHandler.Name, protocol.UnmarshalDiscardBodyHandler)
return
}
// DeleteDBSubnetGroup API operation for Amazon Relational Database Service.
//
// Deletes a DB subnet group.
//
// The specified database subnet group must not be associated with any DB instances.
//
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
// the error.
//
// See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Relational Database Service's
// API operation DeleteDBSubnetGroup for usage and error information.
//
// Returned Error Codes:
// * ErrCodeInvalidDBSubnetGroupStateFault "InvalidDBSubnetGroupStateFault"
// The DB subnet group cannot be deleted because it's in use.
//
// * ErrCodeInvalidDBSubnetStateFault "InvalidDBSubnetStateFault"
// The DB subnet isn't in the available state.
//
// * ErrCodeDBSubnetGroupNotFoundFault "DBSubnetGroupNotFoundFault"
// DBSubnetGroupName doesn't refer to an existing DB subnet group.
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/DeleteDBSubnetGroup
func (c *RDS) DeleteDBSubnetGroup(input *DeleteDBSubnetGroupInput) (*DeleteDBSubnetGroupOutput, error) {
req, out := c.DeleteDBSubnetGroupRequest(input)
return out, req.Send()
}
// DeleteDBSubnetGroupWithContext is the same as DeleteDBSubnetGroup with the addition of
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
//
// See DeleteDBSubnetGroup for details on how to use this API operation.
//
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
// for more information on using Contexts.
func (c *RDS) DeleteDBSubnetGroupWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DeleteDBSubnetGroupInput, opts ...request.Option) (*DeleteDBSubnetGroupOutput, error) {
req, out := c.DeleteDBSubnetGroupRequest(input)
req.SetContext(ctx)
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
return out, req.Send()
}
const opDeleteEventSubscription = "DeleteEventSubscription"
// DeleteEventSubscriptionRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
// client's request for the DeleteEventSubscription operation. The "output" return
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
// successfully.
//
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
//
// See DeleteEventSubscription for more information on using the DeleteEventSubscription
// API call, and error handling.
//
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
//
//
// // Example sending a request using the DeleteEventSubscriptionRequest method.
// req, resp := client.DeleteEventSubscriptionRequest(params)
//
// err := req.Send()
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
// fmt.Println(resp)
// }
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/DeleteEventSubscription
func (c *RDS) DeleteEventSubscriptionRequest(input *DeleteEventSubscriptionInput) (req *request.Request, output *DeleteEventSubscriptionOutput) {
op := &request.Operation{
Name: opDeleteEventSubscription,
HTTPMethod: "POST",
HTTPPath: "/",
}
if input == nil {
input = &DeleteEventSubscriptionInput{}
}
output = &DeleteEventSubscriptionOutput{}
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
return
}
// DeleteEventSubscription API operation for Amazon Relational Database Service.
//
// Deletes an RDS event notification subscription.
//
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
// the error.
//
// See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Relational Database Service's
// API operation DeleteEventSubscription for usage and error information.
//
// Returned Error Codes:
// * ErrCodeSubscriptionNotFoundFault "SubscriptionNotFound"
// The subscription name does not exist.
//
// * ErrCodeInvalidEventSubscriptionStateFault "InvalidEventSubscriptionState"
// This error can occur if someone else is modifying a subscription. You should
// retry the action.
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/DeleteEventSubscription
func (c *RDS) DeleteEventSubscription(input *DeleteEventSubscriptionInput) (*DeleteEventSubscriptionOutput, error) {
req, out := c.DeleteEventSubscriptionRequest(input)
return out, req.Send()
}
// DeleteEventSubscriptionWithContext is the same as DeleteEventSubscription with the addition of
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
//
// See DeleteEventSubscription for details on how to use this API operation.
//
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
// for more information on using Contexts.
func (c *RDS) DeleteEventSubscriptionWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DeleteEventSubscriptionInput, opts ...request.Option) (*DeleteEventSubscriptionOutput, error) {
req, out := c.DeleteEventSubscriptionRequest(input)
req.SetContext(ctx)
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
return out, req.Send()
}
const opDeleteGlobalCluster = "DeleteGlobalCluster"
// DeleteGlobalClusterRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
// client's request for the DeleteGlobalCluster operation. The "output" return
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
// successfully.
//
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
//
// See DeleteGlobalCluster for more information on using the DeleteGlobalCluster
// API call, and error handling.
//
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
//
//
// // Example sending a request using the DeleteGlobalClusterRequest method.
// req, resp := client.DeleteGlobalClusterRequest(params)
//
// err := req.Send()
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
// fmt.Println(resp)
// }
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/DeleteGlobalCluster
func (c *RDS) DeleteGlobalClusterRequest(input *DeleteGlobalClusterInput) (req *request.Request, output *DeleteGlobalClusterOutput) {
op := &request.Operation{
Name: opDeleteGlobalCluster,
HTTPMethod: "POST",
HTTPPath: "/",
}
if input == nil {
input = &DeleteGlobalClusterInput{}
}
output = &DeleteGlobalClusterOutput{}
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
return
}
// DeleteGlobalCluster API operation for Amazon Relational Database Service.
//
// Deletes a global database cluster. The primary and secondary clusters must
// already be detached or destroyed first.
//
// This action only applies to Aurora DB clusters.
//
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
// the error.
//
// See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Relational Database Service's
// API operation DeleteGlobalCluster for usage and error information.
//
// Returned Error Codes:
// * ErrCodeGlobalClusterNotFoundFault "GlobalClusterNotFoundFault"
//
// * ErrCodeInvalidGlobalClusterStateFault "InvalidGlobalClusterStateFault"
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/DeleteGlobalCluster
func (c *RDS) DeleteGlobalCluster(input *DeleteGlobalClusterInput) (*DeleteGlobalClusterOutput, error) {
req, out := c.DeleteGlobalClusterRequest(input)
return out, req.Send()
}
// DeleteGlobalClusterWithContext is the same as DeleteGlobalCluster with the addition of
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
//
// See DeleteGlobalCluster for details on how to use this API operation.
//
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
// for more information on using Contexts.
func (c *RDS) DeleteGlobalClusterWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DeleteGlobalClusterInput, opts ...request.Option) (*DeleteGlobalClusterOutput, error) {
req, out := c.DeleteGlobalClusterRequest(input)
req.SetContext(ctx)
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
return out, req.Send()
}
const opDeleteOptionGroup = "DeleteOptionGroup"
// DeleteOptionGroupRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
// client's request for the DeleteOptionGroup operation. The "output" return
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
// successfully.
//
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
//
// See DeleteOptionGroup for more information on using the DeleteOptionGroup
// API call, and error handling.
//
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
//
//
// // Example sending a request using the DeleteOptionGroupRequest method.
// req, resp := client.DeleteOptionGroupRequest(params)
//
// err := req.Send()
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
// fmt.Println(resp)
// }
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/DeleteOptionGroup
func (c *RDS) DeleteOptionGroupRequest(input *DeleteOptionGroupInput) (req *request.Request, output *DeleteOptionGroupOutput) {
op := &request.Operation{
Name: opDeleteOptionGroup,
HTTPMethod: "POST",
HTTPPath: "/",
}
if input == nil {
input = &DeleteOptionGroupInput{}
}
output = &DeleteOptionGroupOutput{}
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
req.Handlers.Unmarshal.Swap(query.UnmarshalHandler.Name, protocol.UnmarshalDiscardBodyHandler)
return
}
// DeleteOptionGroup API operation for Amazon Relational Database Service.
//
// Deletes an existing option group.
//
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
// the error.
//
// See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Relational Database Service's
// API operation DeleteOptionGroup for usage and error information.
//
// Returned Error Codes:
// * ErrCodeOptionGroupNotFoundFault "OptionGroupNotFoundFault"
// The specified option group could not be found.
//
// * ErrCodeInvalidOptionGroupStateFault "InvalidOptionGroupStateFault"
// The option group isn't in the available state.
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/DeleteOptionGroup
func (c *RDS) DeleteOptionGroup(input *DeleteOptionGroupInput) (*DeleteOptionGroupOutput, error) {
req, out := c.DeleteOptionGroupRequest(input)
return out, req.Send()
}
// DeleteOptionGroupWithContext is the same as DeleteOptionGroup with the addition of
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
//
// See DeleteOptionGroup for details on how to use this API operation.
//
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
// for more information on using Contexts.
func (c *RDS) DeleteOptionGroupWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DeleteOptionGroupInput, opts ...request.Option) (*DeleteOptionGroupOutput, error) {
req, out := c.DeleteOptionGroupRequest(input)
req.SetContext(ctx)
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
return out, req.Send()
}
const opDescribeAccountAttributes = "DescribeAccountAttributes"
// DescribeAccountAttributesRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
// client's request for the DescribeAccountAttributes operation. The "output" return
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
// successfully.
//
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
//
// See DescribeAccountAttributes for more information on using the DescribeAccountAttributes
// API call, and error handling.
//
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
//
//
// // Example sending a request using the DescribeAccountAttributesRequest method.
// req, resp := client.DescribeAccountAttributesRequest(params)
//
// err := req.Send()
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
// fmt.Println(resp)
// }
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/DescribeAccountAttributes
func (c *RDS) DescribeAccountAttributesRequest(input *DescribeAccountAttributesInput) (req *request.Request, output *DescribeAccountAttributesOutput) {
op := &request.Operation{
Name: opDescribeAccountAttributes,
HTTPMethod: "POST",
HTTPPath: "/",
}
if input == nil {
input = &DescribeAccountAttributesInput{}
}
output = &DescribeAccountAttributesOutput{}
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
return
}
// DescribeAccountAttributes API operation for Amazon Relational Database Service.
//
// Lists all of the attributes for a customer account. The attributes include
// Amazon RDS quotas for the account, such as the number of DB instances allowed.
// The description for a quota includes the quota name, current usage toward
// that quota, and the quota's maximum value.
//
// This command doesn't take any parameters.
//
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
// the error.
//
// See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Relational Database Service's
// API operation DescribeAccountAttributes for usage and error information.
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/DescribeAccountAttributes
func (c *RDS) DescribeAccountAttributes(input *DescribeAccountAttributesInput) (*DescribeAccountAttributesOutput, error) {
req, out := c.DescribeAccountAttributesRequest(input)
return out, req.Send()
}
// DescribeAccountAttributesWithContext is the same as DescribeAccountAttributes with the addition of
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
//
// See DescribeAccountAttributes for details on how to use this API operation.
//
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
// for more information on using Contexts.
func (c *RDS) DescribeAccountAttributesWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DescribeAccountAttributesInput, opts ...request.Option) (*DescribeAccountAttributesOutput, error) {
req, out := c.DescribeAccountAttributesRequest(input)
req.SetContext(ctx)
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
return out, req.Send()
}
const opDescribeCertificates = "DescribeCertificates"
// DescribeCertificatesRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
// client's request for the DescribeCertificates operation. The "output" return
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
// successfully.
//
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
//
// See DescribeCertificates for more information on using the DescribeCertificates
// API call, and error handling.
//
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
//
//
// // Example sending a request using the DescribeCertificatesRequest method.
// req, resp := client.DescribeCertificatesRequest(params)
//
// err := req.Send()
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
// fmt.Println(resp)
// }
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/DescribeCertificates
func (c *RDS) DescribeCertificatesRequest(input *DescribeCertificatesInput) (req *request.Request, output *DescribeCertificatesOutput) {
op := &request.Operation{
Name: opDescribeCertificates,
HTTPMethod: "POST",
HTTPPath: "/",
}
if input == nil {
input = &DescribeCertificatesInput{}
}
output = &DescribeCertificatesOutput{}
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
return
}
// DescribeCertificates API operation for Amazon Relational Database Service.
//
// Lists the set of CA certificates provided by Amazon RDS for this AWS account.
//
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
// the error.
//
// See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Relational Database Service's
// API operation DescribeCertificates for usage and error information.
//
// Returned Error Codes:
// * ErrCodeCertificateNotFoundFault "CertificateNotFound"
// CertificateIdentifier doesn't refer to an existing certificate.
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/DescribeCertificates
func (c *RDS) DescribeCertificates(input *DescribeCertificatesInput) (*DescribeCertificatesOutput, error) {
req, out := c.DescribeCertificatesRequest(input)
return out, req.Send()
}
// DescribeCertificatesWithContext is the same as DescribeCertificates with the addition of
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
//
// See DescribeCertificates for details on how to use this API operation.
//
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
// for more information on using Contexts.
func (c *RDS) DescribeCertificatesWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DescribeCertificatesInput, opts ...request.Option) (*DescribeCertificatesOutput, error) {
req, out := c.DescribeCertificatesRequest(input)
req.SetContext(ctx)
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
return out, req.Send()
}
const opDescribeDBClusterBacktracks = "DescribeDBClusterBacktracks"
// DescribeDBClusterBacktracksRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
// client's request for the DescribeDBClusterBacktracks operation. The "output" return
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
// successfully.
//
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
//
// See DescribeDBClusterBacktracks for more information on using the DescribeDBClusterBacktracks
// API call, and error handling.
//
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
//
//
// // Example sending a request using the DescribeDBClusterBacktracksRequest method.
// req, resp := client.DescribeDBClusterBacktracksRequest(params)
//
// err := req.Send()
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
// fmt.Println(resp)
// }
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/DescribeDBClusterBacktracks
func (c *RDS) DescribeDBClusterBacktracksRequest(input *DescribeDBClusterBacktracksInput) (req *request.Request, output *DescribeDBClusterBacktracksOutput) {
op := &request.Operation{
Name: opDescribeDBClusterBacktracks,
HTTPMethod: "POST",
HTTPPath: "/",
}
if input == nil {
input = &DescribeDBClusterBacktracksInput{}
}
output = &DescribeDBClusterBacktracksOutput{}
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
return
}
// DescribeDBClusterBacktracks API operation for Amazon Relational Database Service.
//
// Returns information about backtracks for a DB cluster.
//
// For more information on Amazon Aurora, see What Is Amazon Aurora? (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/AuroraUserGuide/CHAP_AuroraOverview.html)
// in the Amazon Aurora User Guide.
//
// This action only applies to Aurora DB clusters.
//
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
// the error.
//
// See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Relational Database Service's
// API operation DescribeDBClusterBacktracks for usage and error information.
//
// Returned Error Codes:
// * ErrCodeDBClusterNotFoundFault "DBClusterNotFoundFault"
// DBClusterIdentifier doesn't refer to an existing DB cluster.
//
// * ErrCodeDBClusterBacktrackNotFoundFault "DBClusterBacktrackNotFoundFault"
// BacktrackIdentifier doesn't refer to an existing backtrack.
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/DescribeDBClusterBacktracks
func (c *RDS) DescribeDBClusterBacktracks(input *DescribeDBClusterBacktracksInput) (*DescribeDBClusterBacktracksOutput, error) {
req, out := c.DescribeDBClusterBacktracksRequest(input)
return out, req.Send()
}
// DescribeDBClusterBacktracksWithContext is the same as DescribeDBClusterBacktracks with the addition of
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
//
// See DescribeDBClusterBacktracks for details on how to use this API operation.
//
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
// for more information on using Contexts.
func (c *RDS) DescribeDBClusterBacktracksWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DescribeDBClusterBacktracksInput, opts ...request.Option) (*DescribeDBClusterBacktracksOutput, error) {
req, out := c.DescribeDBClusterBacktracksRequest(input)
req.SetContext(ctx)
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
return out, req.Send()
}
const opDescribeDBClusterEndpoints = "DescribeDBClusterEndpoints"
// DescribeDBClusterEndpointsRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
// client's request for the DescribeDBClusterEndpoints operation. The "output" return
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
// successfully.
//
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
//
// See DescribeDBClusterEndpoints for more information on using the DescribeDBClusterEndpoints
// API call, and error handling.
//
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
//
//
// // Example sending a request using the DescribeDBClusterEndpointsRequest method.
// req, resp := client.DescribeDBClusterEndpointsRequest(params)
//
// err := req.Send()
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
// fmt.Println(resp)
// }
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/DescribeDBClusterEndpoints
func (c *RDS) DescribeDBClusterEndpointsRequest(input *DescribeDBClusterEndpointsInput) (req *request.Request, output *DescribeDBClusterEndpointsOutput) {
op := &request.Operation{
Name: opDescribeDBClusterEndpoints,
HTTPMethod: "POST",
HTTPPath: "/",
}
if input == nil {
input = &DescribeDBClusterEndpointsInput{}
}
output = &DescribeDBClusterEndpointsOutput{}
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
return
}
// DescribeDBClusterEndpoints API operation for Amazon Relational Database Service.
//
// Returns information about endpoints for an Amazon Aurora DB cluster.
//
// This action only applies to Aurora DB clusters.
//
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
// the error.
//
// See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Relational Database Service's
// API operation DescribeDBClusterEndpoints for usage and error information.
//
// Returned Error Codes:
// * ErrCodeDBClusterNotFoundFault "DBClusterNotFoundFault"
// DBClusterIdentifier doesn't refer to an existing DB cluster.
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/DescribeDBClusterEndpoints
func (c *RDS) DescribeDBClusterEndpoints(input *DescribeDBClusterEndpointsInput) (*DescribeDBClusterEndpointsOutput, error) {
req, out := c.DescribeDBClusterEndpointsRequest(input)
return out, req.Send()
}
// DescribeDBClusterEndpointsWithContext is the same as DescribeDBClusterEndpoints with the addition of
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
//
// See DescribeDBClusterEndpoints for details on how to use this API operation.
//
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
// for more information on using Contexts.
func (c *RDS) DescribeDBClusterEndpointsWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DescribeDBClusterEndpointsInput, opts ...request.Option) (*DescribeDBClusterEndpointsOutput, error) {
req, out := c.DescribeDBClusterEndpointsRequest(input)
req.SetContext(ctx)
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
return out, req.Send()
}
const opDescribeDBClusterParameterGroups = "DescribeDBClusterParameterGroups"
// DescribeDBClusterParameterGroupsRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
// client's request for the DescribeDBClusterParameterGroups operation. The "output" return
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
// successfully.
//
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
//
// See DescribeDBClusterParameterGroups for more information on using the DescribeDBClusterParameterGroups
// API call, and error handling.
//
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
//
//
// // Example sending a request using the DescribeDBClusterParameterGroupsRequest method.
// req, resp := client.DescribeDBClusterParameterGroupsRequest(params)
//
// err := req.Send()
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
// fmt.Println(resp)
// }
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/DescribeDBClusterParameterGroups
func (c *RDS) DescribeDBClusterParameterGroupsRequest(input *DescribeDBClusterParameterGroupsInput) (req *request.Request, output *DescribeDBClusterParameterGroupsOutput) {
op := &request.Operation{
Name: opDescribeDBClusterParameterGroups,
HTTPMethod: "POST",
HTTPPath: "/",
}
if input == nil {
input = &DescribeDBClusterParameterGroupsInput{}
}
output = &DescribeDBClusterParameterGroupsOutput{}
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
return
}
// DescribeDBClusterParameterGroups API operation for Amazon Relational Database Service.
//
// Returns a list of DBClusterParameterGroup descriptions. If a DBClusterParameterGroupName
// parameter is specified, the list will contain only the description of the
// specified DB cluster parameter group.
//
// For more information on Amazon Aurora, see What Is Amazon Aurora? (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/AuroraUserGuide/CHAP_AuroraOverview.html)
// in the Amazon Aurora User Guide.
//
// This action only applies to Aurora DB clusters.
//
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
// the error.
//
// See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Relational Database Service's
// API operation DescribeDBClusterParameterGroups for usage and error information.
//
// Returned Error Codes:
// * ErrCodeDBParameterGroupNotFoundFault "DBParameterGroupNotFound"
// DBParameterGroupName doesn't refer to an existing DB parameter group.
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/DescribeDBClusterParameterGroups
func (c *RDS) DescribeDBClusterParameterGroups(input *DescribeDBClusterParameterGroupsInput) (*DescribeDBClusterParameterGroupsOutput, error) {
req, out := c.DescribeDBClusterParameterGroupsRequest(input)
return out, req.Send()
}
// DescribeDBClusterParameterGroupsWithContext is the same as DescribeDBClusterParameterGroups with the addition of
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
//
// See DescribeDBClusterParameterGroups for details on how to use this API operation.
//
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
// for more information on using Contexts.
func (c *RDS) DescribeDBClusterParameterGroupsWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DescribeDBClusterParameterGroupsInput, opts ...request.Option) (*DescribeDBClusterParameterGroupsOutput, error) {
req, out := c.DescribeDBClusterParameterGroupsRequest(input)
req.SetContext(ctx)
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
return out, req.Send()
}
const opDescribeDBClusterParameters = "DescribeDBClusterParameters"
// DescribeDBClusterParametersRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
// client's request for the DescribeDBClusterParameters operation. The "output" return
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
// successfully.
//
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
//
// See DescribeDBClusterParameters for more information on using the DescribeDBClusterParameters
// API call, and error handling.
//
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
//
//
// // Example sending a request using the DescribeDBClusterParametersRequest method.
// req, resp := client.DescribeDBClusterParametersRequest(params)
//
// err := req.Send()
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
// fmt.Println(resp)
// }
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/DescribeDBClusterParameters
func (c *RDS) DescribeDBClusterParametersRequest(input *DescribeDBClusterParametersInput) (req *request.Request, output *DescribeDBClusterParametersOutput) {
op := &request.Operation{
Name: opDescribeDBClusterParameters,
HTTPMethod: "POST",
HTTPPath: "/",
}
if input == nil {
input = &DescribeDBClusterParametersInput{}
}
output = &DescribeDBClusterParametersOutput{}
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
return
}
// DescribeDBClusterParameters API operation for Amazon Relational Database Service.
//
// Returns the detailed parameter list for a particular DB cluster parameter
// group.
//
// For more information on Amazon Aurora, see What Is Amazon Aurora? (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/AuroraUserGuide/CHAP_AuroraOverview.html)
// in the Amazon Aurora User Guide.
//
// This action only applies to Aurora DB clusters.
//
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
// the error.
//
// See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Relational Database Service's
// API operation DescribeDBClusterParameters for usage and error information.
//
// Returned Error Codes:
// * ErrCodeDBParameterGroupNotFoundFault "DBParameterGroupNotFound"
// DBParameterGroupName doesn't refer to an existing DB parameter group.
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/DescribeDBClusterParameters
func (c *RDS) DescribeDBClusterParameters(input *DescribeDBClusterParametersInput) (*DescribeDBClusterParametersOutput, error) {
req, out := c.DescribeDBClusterParametersRequest(input)
return out, req.Send()
}
// DescribeDBClusterParametersWithContext is the same as DescribeDBClusterParameters with the addition of
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
//
// See DescribeDBClusterParameters for details on how to use this API operation.
//
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
// for more information on using Contexts.
func (c *RDS) DescribeDBClusterParametersWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DescribeDBClusterParametersInput, opts ...request.Option) (*DescribeDBClusterParametersOutput, error) {
req, out := c.DescribeDBClusterParametersRequest(input)
req.SetContext(ctx)
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
return out, req.Send()
}
const opDescribeDBClusterSnapshotAttributes = "DescribeDBClusterSnapshotAttributes"
// DescribeDBClusterSnapshotAttributesRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
// client's request for the DescribeDBClusterSnapshotAttributes operation. The "output" return
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
// successfully.
//
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
//
// See DescribeDBClusterSnapshotAttributes for more information on using the DescribeDBClusterSnapshotAttributes
// API call, and error handling.
//
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
//
//
// // Example sending a request using the DescribeDBClusterSnapshotAttributesRequest method.
// req, resp := client.DescribeDBClusterSnapshotAttributesRequest(params)
//
// err := req.Send()
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
// fmt.Println(resp)
// }
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/DescribeDBClusterSnapshotAttributes
func (c *RDS) DescribeDBClusterSnapshotAttributesRequest(input *DescribeDBClusterSnapshotAttributesInput) (req *request.Request, output *DescribeDBClusterSnapshotAttributesOutput) {
op := &request.Operation{
Name: opDescribeDBClusterSnapshotAttributes,
HTTPMethod: "POST",
HTTPPath: "/",
}
if input == nil {
input = &DescribeDBClusterSnapshotAttributesInput{}
}
output = &DescribeDBClusterSnapshotAttributesOutput{}
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
return
}
// DescribeDBClusterSnapshotAttributes API operation for Amazon Relational Database Service.
//
// Returns a list of DB cluster snapshot attribute names and values for a manual
// DB cluster snapshot.
//
// When sharing snapshots with other AWS accounts, DescribeDBClusterSnapshotAttributes
// returns the restore attribute and a list of IDs for the AWS accounts that
// are authorized to copy or restore the manual DB cluster snapshot. If all
// is included in the list of values for the restore attribute, then the manual
// DB cluster snapshot is public and can be copied or restored by all AWS accounts.
//
// To add or remove access for an AWS account to copy or restore a manual DB
// cluster snapshot, or to make the manual DB cluster snapshot public or private,
// use the ModifyDBClusterSnapshotAttribute API action.
//
// This action only applies to Aurora DB clusters.
//
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
// the error.
//
// See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Relational Database Service's
// API operation DescribeDBClusterSnapshotAttributes for usage and error information.
//
// Returned Error Codes:
// * ErrCodeDBClusterSnapshotNotFoundFault "DBClusterSnapshotNotFoundFault"
// DBClusterSnapshotIdentifier doesn't refer to an existing DB cluster snapshot.
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/DescribeDBClusterSnapshotAttributes
func (c *RDS) DescribeDBClusterSnapshotAttributes(input *DescribeDBClusterSnapshotAttributesInput) (*DescribeDBClusterSnapshotAttributesOutput, error) {
req, out := c.DescribeDBClusterSnapshotAttributesRequest(input)
return out, req.Send()
}
// DescribeDBClusterSnapshotAttributesWithContext is the same as DescribeDBClusterSnapshotAttributes with the addition of
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
//
// See DescribeDBClusterSnapshotAttributes for details on how to use this API operation.
//
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
// for more information on using Contexts.
func (c *RDS) DescribeDBClusterSnapshotAttributesWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DescribeDBClusterSnapshotAttributesInput, opts ...request.Option) (*DescribeDBClusterSnapshotAttributesOutput, error) {
req, out := c.DescribeDBClusterSnapshotAttributesRequest(input)
req.SetContext(ctx)
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
return out, req.Send()
}
const opDescribeDBClusterSnapshots = "DescribeDBClusterSnapshots"
// DescribeDBClusterSnapshotsRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
// client's request for the DescribeDBClusterSnapshots operation. The "output" return
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
// successfully.
//
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
//
// See DescribeDBClusterSnapshots for more information on using the DescribeDBClusterSnapshots
// API call, and error handling.
//
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
//
//
// // Example sending a request using the DescribeDBClusterSnapshotsRequest method.
// req, resp := client.DescribeDBClusterSnapshotsRequest(params)
//
// err := req.Send()
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
// fmt.Println(resp)
// }
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/DescribeDBClusterSnapshots
func (c *RDS) DescribeDBClusterSnapshotsRequest(input *DescribeDBClusterSnapshotsInput) (req *request.Request, output *DescribeDBClusterSnapshotsOutput) {
op := &request.Operation{
Name: opDescribeDBClusterSnapshots,
HTTPMethod: "POST",
HTTPPath: "/",
}
if input == nil {
input = &DescribeDBClusterSnapshotsInput{}
}
output = &DescribeDBClusterSnapshotsOutput{}
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
return
}
// DescribeDBClusterSnapshots API operation for Amazon Relational Database Service.
//
// Returns information about DB cluster snapshots. This API action supports
// pagination.
//
// For more information on Amazon Aurora, see What Is Amazon Aurora? (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/AuroraUserGuide/CHAP_AuroraOverview.html)
// in the Amazon Aurora User Guide.
//
// This action only applies to Aurora DB clusters.
//
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
// the error.
//
// See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Relational Database Service's
// API operation DescribeDBClusterSnapshots for usage and error information.
//
// Returned Error Codes:
// * ErrCodeDBClusterSnapshotNotFoundFault "DBClusterSnapshotNotFoundFault"
// DBClusterSnapshotIdentifier doesn't refer to an existing DB cluster snapshot.
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/DescribeDBClusterSnapshots
func (c *RDS) DescribeDBClusterSnapshots(input *DescribeDBClusterSnapshotsInput) (*DescribeDBClusterSnapshotsOutput, error) {
req, out := c.DescribeDBClusterSnapshotsRequest(input)
return out, req.Send()
}
// DescribeDBClusterSnapshotsWithContext is the same as DescribeDBClusterSnapshots with the addition of
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
//
// See DescribeDBClusterSnapshots for details on how to use this API operation.
//
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
// for more information on using Contexts.
func (c *RDS) DescribeDBClusterSnapshotsWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DescribeDBClusterSnapshotsInput, opts ...request.Option) (*DescribeDBClusterSnapshotsOutput, error) {
req, out := c.DescribeDBClusterSnapshotsRequest(input)
req.SetContext(ctx)
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
return out, req.Send()
}
const opDescribeDBClusters = "DescribeDBClusters"
// DescribeDBClustersRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
// client's request for the DescribeDBClusters operation. The "output" return
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
// successfully.
//
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
//
// See DescribeDBClusters for more information on using the DescribeDBClusters
// API call, and error handling.
//
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
//
//
// // Example sending a request using the DescribeDBClustersRequest method.
// req, resp := client.DescribeDBClustersRequest(params)
//
// err := req.Send()
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
// fmt.Println(resp)
// }
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/DescribeDBClusters
func (c *RDS) DescribeDBClustersRequest(input *DescribeDBClustersInput) (req *request.Request, output *DescribeDBClustersOutput) {
op := &request.Operation{
Name: opDescribeDBClusters,
HTTPMethod: "POST",
HTTPPath: "/",
Paginator: &request.Paginator{
InputTokens: []string{"Marker"},
OutputTokens: []string{"Marker"},
LimitToken: "MaxRecords",
TruncationToken: "",
},
}
if input == nil {
input = &DescribeDBClustersInput{}
}
output = &DescribeDBClustersOutput{}
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
return
}
// DescribeDBClusters API operation for Amazon Relational Database Service.
//
// Returns information about provisioned Aurora DB clusters. This API supports
// pagination.
//
// For more information on Amazon Aurora, see What Is Amazon Aurora? (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/AuroraUserGuide/CHAP_AuroraOverview.html)
// in the Amazon Aurora User Guide.
//
// This action only applies to Aurora DB clusters.
//
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
// the error.
//
// See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Relational Database Service's
// API operation DescribeDBClusters for usage and error information.
//
// Returned Error Codes:
// * ErrCodeDBClusterNotFoundFault "DBClusterNotFoundFault"
// DBClusterIdentifier doesn't refer to an existing DB cluster.
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/DescribeDBClusters
func (c *RDS) DescribeDBClusters(input *DescribeDBClustersInput) (*DescribeDBClustersOutput, error) {
req, out := c.DescribeDBClustersRequest(input)
return out, req.Send()
}
// DescribeDBClustersWithContext is the same as DescribeDBClusters with the addition of
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
//
// See DescribeDBClusters for details on how to use this API operation.
//
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
// for more information on using Contexts.
func (c *RDS) DescribeDBClustersWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DescribeDBClustersInput, opts ...request.Option) (*DescribeDBClustersOutput, error) {
req, out := c.DescribeDBClustersRequest(input)
req.SetContext(ctx)
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
return out, req.Send()
}
// DescribeDBClustersPages iterates over the pages of a DescribeDBClusters operation,
// calling the "fn" function with the response data for each page. To stop
// iterating, return false from the fn function.
//
// See DescribeDBClusters method for more information on how to use this operation.
//
// Note: This operation can generate multiple requests to a service.
//
// // Example iterating over at most 3 pages of a DescribeDBClusters operation.
// pageNum := 0
// err := client.DescribeDBClustersPages(params,
// func(page *DescribeDBClustersOutput, lastPage bool) bool {
// pageNum++
// fmt.Println(page)
// return pageNum <= 3
// })
//
func (c *RDS) DescribeDBClustersPages(input *DescribeDBClustersInput, fn func(*DescribeDBClustersOutput, bool) bool) error {
return c.DescribeDBClustersPagesWithContext(aws.BackgroundContext(), input, fn)
}
// DescribeDBClustersPagesWithContext same as DescribeDBClustersPages except
// it takes a Context and allows setting request options on the pages.
//
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
// for more information on using Contexts.
func (c *RDS) DescribeDBClustersPagesWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DescribeDBClustersInput, fn func(*DescribeDBClustersOutput, bool) bool, opts ...request.Option) error {
p := request.Pagination{
NewRequest: func() (*request.Request, error) {
var inCpy *DescribeDBClustersInput
if input != nil {
tmp := *input
inCpy = &tmp
}
req, _ := c.DescribeDBClustersRequest(inCpy)
req.SetContext(ctx)
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
return req, nil
},
}
cont := true
for p.Next() && cont {
cont = fn(p.Page().(*DescribeDBClustersOutput), !p.HasNextPage())
}
return p.Err()
}
const opDescribeDBEngineVersions = "DescribeDBEngineVersions"
// DescribeDBEngineVersionsRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
// client's request for the DescribeDBEngineVersions operation. The "output" return
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
// successfully.
//
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
//
// See DescribeDBEngineVersions for more information on using the DescribeDBEngineVersions
// API call, and error handling.
//
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
//
//
// // Example sending a request using the DescribeDBEngineVersionsRequest method.
// req, resp := client.DescribeDBEngineVersionsRequest(params)
//
// err := req.Send()
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
// fmt.Println(resp)
// }
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/DescribeDBEngineVersions
func (c *RDS) DescribeDBEngineVersionsRequest(input *DescribeDBEngineVersionsInput) (req *request.Request, output *DescribeDBEngineVersionsOutput) {
op := &request.Operation{
Name: opDescribeDBEngineVersions,
HTTPMethod: "POST",
HTTPPath: "/",
Paginator: &request.Paginator{
InputTokens: []string{"Marker"},
OutputTokens: []string{"Marker"},
LimitToken: "MaxRecords",
TruncationToken: "",
},
}
if input == nil {
input = &DescribeDBEngineVersionsInput{}
}
output = &DescribeDBEngineVersionsOutput{}
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
return
}
// DescribeDBEngineVersions API operation for Amazon Relational Database Service.
//
// Returns a list of the available DB engines.
//
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
// the error.
//
// See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Relational Database Service's
// API operation DescribeDBEngineVersions for usage and error information.
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/DescribeDBEngineVersions
func (c *RDS) DescribeDBEngineVersions(input *DescribeDBEngineVersionsInput) (*DescribeDBEngineVersionsOutput, error) {
req, out := c.DescribeDBEngineVersionsRequest(input)
return out, req.Send()
}
// DescribeDBEngineVersionsWithContext is the same as DescribeDBEngineVersions with the addition of
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
//
// See DescribeDBEngineVersions for details on how to use this API operation.
//
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
// for more information on using Contexts.
func (c *RDS) DescribeDBEngineVersionsWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DescribeDBEngineVersionsInput, opts ...request.Option) (*DescribeDBEngineVersionsOutput, error) {
req, out := c.DescribeDBEngineVersionsRequest(input)
req.SetContext(ctx)
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
return out, req.Send()
}
// DescribeDBEngineVersionsPages iterates over the pages of a DescribeDBEngineVersions operation,
// calling the "fn" function with the response data for each page. To stop
// iterating, return false from the fn function.
//
// See DescribeDBEngineVersions method for more information on how to use this operation.
//
// Note: This operation can generate multiple requests to a service.
//
// // Example iterating over at most 3 pages of a DescribeDBEngineVersions operation.
// pageNum := 0
// err := client.DescribeDBEngineVersionsPages(params,
// func(page *DescribeDBEngineVersionsOutput, lastPage bool) bool {
// pageNum++
// fmt.Println(page)
// return pageNum <= 3
// })
//
func (c *RDS) DescribeDBEngineVersionsPages(input *DescribeDBEngineVersionsInput, fn func(*DescribeDBEngineVersionsOutput, bool) bool) error {
return c.DescribeDBEngineVersionsPagesWithContext(aws.BackgroundContext(), input, fn)
}
// DescribeDBEngineVersionsPagesWithContext same as DescribeDBEngineVersionsPages except
// it takes a Context and allows setting request options on the pages.
//
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
// for more information on using Contexts.
func (c *RDS) DescribeDBEngineVersionsPagesWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DescribeDBEngineVersionsInput, fn func(*DescribeDBEngineVersionsOutput, bool) bool, opts ...request.Option) error {
p := request.Pagination{
NewRequest: func() (*request.Request, error) {
var inCpy *DescribeDBEngineVersionsInput
if input != nil {
tmp := *input
inCpy = &tmp
}
req, _ := c.DescribeDBEngineVersionsRequest(inCpy)
req.SetContext(ctx)
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
return req, nil
},
}
cont := true
for p.Next() && cont {
cont = fn(p.Page().(*DescribeDBEngineVersionsOutput), !p.HasNextPage())
}
return p.Err()
}
const opDescribeDBInstanceAutomatedBackups = "DescribeDBInstanceAutomatedBackups"
// DescribeDBInstanceAutomatedBackupsRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
// client's request for the DescribeDBInstanceAutomatedBackups operation. The "output" return
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
// successfully.
//
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
//
// See DescribeDBInstanceAutomatedBackups for more information on using the DescribeDBInstanceAutomatedBackups
// API call, and error handling.
//
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
//
//
// // Example sending a request using the DescribeDBInstanceAutomatedBackupsRequest method.
// req, resp := client.DescribeDBInstanceAutomatedBackupsRequest(params)
//
// err := req.Send()
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
// fmt.Println(resp)
// }
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/DescribeDBInstanceAutomatedBackups
func (c *RDS) DescribeDBInstanceAutomatedBackupsRequest(input *DescribeDBInstanceAutomatedBackupsInput) (req *request.Request, output *DescribeDBInstanceAutomatedBackupsOutput) {
op := &request.Operation{
Name: opDescribeDBInstanceAutomatedBackups,
HTTPMethod: "POST",
HTTPPath: "/",
Paginator: &request.Paginator{
InputTokens: []string{"Marker"},
OutputTokens: []string{"Marker"},
LimitToken: "MaxRecords",
TruncationToken: "",
},
}
if input == nil {
input = &DescribeDBInstanceAutomatedBackupsInput{}
}
output = &DescribeDBInstanceAutomatedBackupsOutput{}
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
return
}
// DescribeDBInstanceAutomatedBackups API operation for Amazon Relational Database Service.
//
// Displays backups for both current and deleted instances. For example, use
// this operation to find details about automated backups for previously deleted
// instances. Current instances with retention periods greater than zero (0)
// are returned for both the DescribeDBInstanceAutomatedBackups and DescribeDBInstances
// operations.
//
// All parameters are optional.
//
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
// the error.
//
// See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Relational Database Service's
// API operation DescribeDBInstanceAutomatedBackups for usage and error information.
//
// Returned Error Codes:
// * ErrCodeDBInstanceAutomatedBackupNotFoundFault "DBInstanceAutomatedBackupNotFound"
// No automated backup for this DB instance was found.
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/DescribeDBInstanceAutomatedBackups
func (c *RDS) DescribeDBInstanceAutomatedBackups(input *DescribeDBInstanceAutomatedBackupsInput) (*DescribeDBInstanceAutomatedBackupsOutput, error) {
req, out := c.DescribeDBInstanceAutomatedBackupsRequest(input)
return out, req.Send()
}
// DescribeDBInstanceAutomatedBackupsWithContext is the same as DescribeDBInstanceAutomatedBackups with the addition of
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
//
// See DescribeDBInstanceAutomatedBackups for details on how to use this API operation.
//
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
// for more information on using Contexts.
func (c *RDS) DescribeDBInstanceAutomatedBackupsWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DescribeDBInstanceAutomatedBackupsInput, opts ...request.Option) (*DescribeDBInstanceAutomatedBackupsOutput, error) {
req, out := c.DescribeDBInstanceAutomatedBackupsRequest(input)
req.SetContext(ctx)
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
return out, req.Send()
}
// DescribeDBInstanceAutomatedBackupsPages iterates over the pages of a DescribeDBInstanceAutomatedBackups operation,
// calling the "fn" function with the response data for each page. To stop
// iterating, return false from the fn function.
//
// See DescribeDBInstanceAutomatedBackups method for more information on how to use this operation.
//
// Note: This operation can generate multiple requests to a service.
//
// // Example iterating over at most 3 pages of a DescribeDBInstanceAutomatedBackups operation.
// pageNum := 0
// err := client.DescribeDBInstanceAutomatedBackupsPages(params,
// func(page *DescribeDBInstanceAutomatedBackupsOutput, lastPage bool) bool {
// pageNum++
// fmt.Println(page)
// return pageNum <= 3
// })
//
func (c *RDS) DescribeDBInstanceAutomatedBackupsPages(input *DescribeDBInstanceAutomatedBackupsInput, fn func(*DescribeDBInstanceAutomatedBackupsOutput, bool) bool) error {
return c.DescribeDBInstanceAutomatedBackupsPagesWithContext(aws.BackgroundContext(), input, fn)
}
// DescribeDBInstanceAutomatedBackupsPagesWithContext same as DescribeDBInstanceAutomatedBackupsPages except
// it takes a Context and allows setting request options on the pages.
//
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
// for more information on using Contexts.
func (c *RDS) DescribeDBInstanceAutomatedBackupsPagesWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DescribeDBInstanceAutomatedBackupsInput, fn func(*DescribeDBInstanceAutomatedBackupsOutput, bool) bool, opts ...request.Option) error {
p := request.Pagination{
NewRequest: func() (*request.Request, error) {
var inCpy *DescribeDBInstanceAutomatedBackupsInput
if input != nil {
tmp := *input
inCpy = &tmp
}
req, _ := c.DescribeDBInstanceAutomatedBackupsRequest(inCpy)
req.SetContext(ctx)
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
return req, nil
},
}
cont := true
for p.Next() && cont {
cont = fn(p.Page().(*DescribeDBInstanceAutomatedBackupsOutput), !p.HasNextPage())
}
return p.Err()
}
const opDescribeDBInstances = "DescribeDBInstances"
// DescribeDBInstancesRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
// client's request for the DescribeDBInstances operation. The "output" return
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
// successfully.
//
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
//
// See DescribeDBInstances for more information on using the DescribeDBInstances
// API call, and error handling.
//
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
//
//
// // Example sending a request using the DescribeDBInstancesRequest method.
// req, resp := client.DescribeDBInstancesRequest(params)
//
// err := req.Send()
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
// fmt.Println(resp)
// }
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/DescribeDBInstances
func (c *RDS) DescribeDBInstancesRequest(input *DescribeDBInstancesInput) (req *request.Request, output *DescribeDBInstancesOutput) {
op := &request.Operation{
Name: opDescribeDBInstances,
HTTPMethod: "POST",
HTTPPath: "/",
Paginator: &request.Paginator{
InputTokens: []string{"Marker"},
OutputTokens: []string{"Marker"},
LimitToken: "MaxRecords",
TruncationToken: "",
},
}
if input == nil {
input = &DescribeDBInstancesInput{}
}
output = &DescribeDBInstancesOutput{}
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
return
}
// DescribeDBInstances API operation for Amazon Relational Database Service.
//
// Returns information about provisioned RDS instances. This API supports pagination.
//
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
// the error.
//
// See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Relational Database Service's
// API operation DescribeDBInstances for usage and error information.
//
// Returned Error Codes:
// * ErrCodeDBInstanceNotFoundFault "DBInstanceNotFound"
// DBInstanceIdentifier doesn't refer to an existing DB instance.
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/DescribeDBInstances
func (c *RDS) DescribeDBInstances(input *DescribeDBInstancesInput) (*DescribeDBInstancesOutput, error) {
req, out := c.DescribeDBInstancesRequest(input)
return out, req.Send()
}
// DescribeDBInstancesWithContext is the same as DescribeDBInstances with the addition of
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
//
// See DescribeDBInstances for details on how to use this API operation.
//
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
// for more information on using Contexts.
func (c *RDS) DescribeDBInstancesWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DescribeDBInstancesInput, opts ...request.Option) (*DescribeDBInstancesOutput, error) {
req, out := c.DescribeDBInstancesRequest(input)
req.SetContext(ctx)
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
return out, req.Send()
}
// DescribeDBInstancesPages iterates over the pages of a DescribeDBInstances operation,
// calling the "fn" function with the response data for each page. To stop
// iterating, return false from the fn function.
//
// See DescribeDBInstances method for more information on how to use this operation.
//
// Note: This operation can generate multiple requests to a service.
//
// // Example iterating over at most 3 pages of a DescribeDBInstances operation.
// pageNum := 0
// err := client.DescribeDBInstancesPages(params,
// func(page *DescribeDBInstancesOutput, lastPage bool) bool {
// pageNum++
// fmt.Println(page)
// return pageNum <= 3
// })
//
func (c *RDS) DescribeDBInstancesPages(input *DescribeDBInstancesInput, fn func(*DescribeDBInstancesOutput, bool) bool) error {
return c.DescribeDBInstancesPagesWithContext(aws.BackgroundContext(), input, fn)
}
// DescribeDBInstancesPagesWithContext same as DescribeDBInstancesPages except
// it takes a Context and allows setting request options on the pages.
//
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
// for more information on using Contexts.
func (c *RDS) DescribeDBInstancesPagesWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DescribeDBInstancesInput, fn func(*DescribeDBInstancesOutput, bool) bool, opts ...request.Option) error {
p := request.Pagination{
NewRequest: func() (*request.Request, error) {
var inCpy *DescribeDBInstancesInput
if input != nil {
tmp := *input
inCpy = &tmp
}
req, _ := c.DescribeDBInstancesRequest(inCpy)
req.SetContext(ctx)
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
return req, nil
},
}
cont := true
for p.Next() && cont {
cont = fn(p.Page().(*DescribeDBInstancesOutput), !p.HasNextPage())
}
return p.Err()
}
const opDescribeDBLogFiles = "DescribeDBLogFiles"
// DescribeDBLogFilesRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
// client's request for the DescribeDBLogFiles operation. The "output" return
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
// successfully.
//
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
//
// See DescribeDBLogFiles for more information on using the DescribeDBLogFiles
// API call, and error handling.
//
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
//
//
// // Example sending a request using the DescribeDBLogFilesRequest method.
// req, resp := client.DescribeDBLogFilesRequest(params)
//
// err := req.Send()
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
// fmt.Println(resp)
// }
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/DescribeDBLogFiles
func (c *RDS) DescribeDBLogFilesRequest(input *DescribeDBLogFilesInput) (req *request.Request, output *DescribeDBLogFilesOutput) {
op := &request.Operation{
Name: opDescribeDBLogFiles,
HTTPMethod: "POST",
HTTPPath: "/",
Paginator: &request.Paginator{
InputTokens: []string{"Marker"},
OutputTokens: []string{"Marker"},
LimitToken: "MaxRecords",
TruncationToken: "",
},
}
if input == nil {
input = &DescribeDBLogFilesInput{}
}
output = &DescribeDBLogFilesOutput{}
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
return
}
// DescribeDBLogFiles API operation for Amazon Relational Database Service.
//
// Returns a list of DB log files for the DB instance.
//
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
// the error.
//
// See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Relational Database Service's
// API operation DescribeDBLogFiles for usage and error information.
//
// Returned Error Codes:
// * ErrCodeDBInstanceNotFoundFault "DBInstanceNotFound"
// DBInstanceIdentifier doesn't refer to an existing DB instance.
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/DescribeDBLogFiles
func (c *RDS) DescribeDBLogFiles(input *DescribeDBLogFilesInput) (*DescribeDBLogFilesOutput, error) {
req, out := c.DescribeDBLogFilesRequest(input)
return out, req.Send()
}
// DescribeDBLogFilesWithContext is the same as DescribeDBLogFiles with the addition of
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
//
// See DescribeDBLogFiles for details on how to use this API operation.
//
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
// for more information on using Contexts.
func (c *RDS) DescribeDBLogFilesWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DescribeDBLogFilesInput, opts ...request.Option) (*DescribeDBLogFilesOutput, error) {
req, out := c.DescribeDBLogFilesRequest(input)
req.SetContext(ctx)
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
return out, req.Send()
}
// DescribeDBLogFilesPages iterates over the pages of a DescribeDBLogFiles operation,
// calling the "fn" function with the response data for each page. To stop
// iterating, return false from the fn function.
//
// See DescribeDBLogFiles method for more information on how to use this operation.
//
// Note: This operation can generate multiple requests to a service.
//
// // Example iterating over at most 3 pages of a DescribeDBLogFiles operation.
// pageNum := 0
// err := client.DescribeDBLogFilesPages(params,
// func(page *DescribeDBLogFilesOutput, lastPage bool) bool {
// pageNum++
// fmt.Println(page)
// return pageNum <= 3
// })
//
func (c *RDS) DescribeDBLogFilesPages(input *DescribeDBLogFilesInput, fn func(*DescribeDBLogFilesOutput, bool) bool) error {
return c.DescribeDBLogFilesPagesWithContext(aws.BackgroundContext(), input, fn)
}
// DescribeDBLogFilesPagesWithContext same as DescribeDBLogFilesPages except
// it takes a Context and allows setting request options on the pages.
//
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
// for more information on using Contexts.
func (c *RDS) DescribeDBLogFilesPagesWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DescribeDBLogFilesInput, fn func(*DescribeDBLogFilesOutput, bool) bool, opts ...request.Option) error {
p := request.Pagination{
NewRequest: func() (*request.Request, error) {
var inCpy *DescribeDBLogFilesInput
if input != nil {
tmp := *input
inCpy = &tmp
}
req, _ := c.DescribeDBLogFilesRequest(inCpy)
req.SetContext(ctx)
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
return req, nil
},
}
cont := true
for p.Next() && cont {
cont = fn(p.Page().(*DescribeDBLogFilesOutput), !p.HasNextPage())
}
return p.Err()
}
const opDescribeDBParameterGroups = "DescribeDBParameterGroups"
// DescribeDBParameterGroupsRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
// client's request for the DescribeDBParameterGroups operation. The "output" return
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
// successfully.
//
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
//
// See DescribeDBParameterGroups for more information on using the DescribeDBParameterGroups
// API call, and error handling.
//
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
//
//
// // Example sending a request using the DescribeDBParameterGroupsRequest method.
// req, resp := client.DescribeDBParameterGroupsRequest(params)
//
// err := req.Send()
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
// fmt.Println(resp)
// }
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/DescribeDBParameterGroups
func (c *RDS) DescribeDBParameterGroupsRequest(input *DescribeDBParameterGroupsInput) (req *request.Request, output *DescribeDBParameterGroupsOutput) {
op := &request.Operation{
Name: opDescribeDBParameterGroups,
HTTPMethod: "POST",
HTTPPath: "/",
Paginator: &request.Paginator{
InputTokens: []string{"Marker"},
OutputTokens: []string{"Marker"},
LimitToken: "MaxRecords",
TruncationToken: "",
},
}
if input == nil {
input = &DescribeDBParameterGroupsInput{}
}
output = &DescribeDBParameterGroupsOutput{}
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
return
}
// DescribeDBParameterGroups API operation for Amazon Relational Database Service.
//
// Returns a list of DBParameterGroup descriptions. If a DBParameterGroupName
// is specified, the list will contain only the description of the specified
// DB parameter group.
//
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
// the error.
//
// See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Relational Database Service's
// API operation DescribeDBParameterGroups for usage and error information.
//
// Returned Error Codes:
// * ErrCodeDBParameterGroupNotFoundFault "DBParameterGroupNotFound"
// DBParameterGroupName doesn't refer to an existing DB parameter group.
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/DescribeDBParameterGroups
func (c *RDS) DescribeDBParameterGroups(input *DescribeDBParameterGroupsInput) (*DescribeDBParameterGroupsOutput, error) {
req, out := c.DescribeDBParameterGroupsRequest(input)
return out, req.Send()
}
// DescribeDBParameterGroupsWithContext is the same as DescribeDBParameterGroups with the addition of
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
//
// See DescribeDBParameterGroups for details on how to use this API operation.
//
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
// for more information on using Contexts.
func (c *RDS) DescribeDBParameterGroupsWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DescribeDBParameterGroupsInput, opts ...request.Option) (*DescribeDBParameterGroupsOutput, error) {
req, out := c.DescribeDBParameterGroupsRequest(input)
req.SetContext(ctx)
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
return out, req.Send()
}
// DescribeDBParameterGroupsPages iterates over the pages of a DescribeDBParameterGroups operation,
// calling the "fn" function with the response data for each page. To stop
// iterating, return false from the fn function.
//
// See DescribeDBParameterGroups method for more information on how to use this operation.
//
// Note: This operation can generate multiple requests to a service.
//
// // Example iterating over at most 3 pages of a DescribeDBParameterGroups operation.
// pageNum := 0
// err := client.DescribeDBParameterGroupsPages(params,
// func(page *DescribeDBParameterGroupsOutput, lastPage bool) bool {
// pageNum++
// fmt.Println(page)
// return pageNum <= 3
// })
//
func (c *RDS) DescribeDBParameterGroupsPages(input *DescribeDBParameterGroupsInput, fn func(*DescribeDBParameterGroupsOutput, bool) bool) error {
return c.DescribeDBParameterGroupsPagesWithContext(aws.BackgroundContext(), input, fn)
}
// DescribeDBParameterGroupsPagesWithContext same as DescribeDBParameterGroupsPages except
// it takes a Context and allows setting request options on the pages.
//
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
// for more information on using Contexts.
func (c *RDS) DescribeDBParameterGroupsPagesWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DescribeDBParameterGroupsInput, fn func(*DescribeDBParameterGroupsOutput, bool) bool, opts ...request.Option) error {
p := request.Pagination{
NewRequest: func() (*request.Request, error) {
var inCpy *DescribeDBParameterGroupsInput
if input != nil {
tmp := *input
inCpy = &tmp
}
req, _ := c.DescribeDBParameterGroupsRequest(inCpy)
req.SetContext(ctx)
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
return req, nil
},
}
cont := true
for p.Next() && cont {
cont = fn(p.Page().(*DescribeDBParameterGroupsOutput), !p.HasNextPage())
}
return p.Err()
}
const opDescribeDBParameters = "DescribeDBParameters"
// DescribeDBParametersRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
// client's request for the DescribeDBParameters operation. The "output" return
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
// successfully.
//
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
//
// See DescribeDBParameters for more information on using the DescribeDBParameters
// API call, and error handling.
//
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
//
//
// // Example sending a request using the DescribeDBParametersRequest method.
// req, resp := client.DescribeDBParametersRequest(params)
//
// err := req.Send()
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
// fmt.Println(resp)
// }
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/DescribeDBParameters
func (c *RDS) DescribeDBParametersRequest(input *DescribeDBParametersInput) (req *request.Request, output *DescribeDBParametersOutput) {
op := &request.Operation{
Name: opDescribeDBParameters,
HTTPMethod: "POST",
HTTPPath: "/",
Paginator: &request.Paginator{
InputTokens: []string{"Marker"},
OutputTokens: []string{"Marker"},
LimitToken: "MaxRecords",
TruncationToken: "",
},
}
if input == nil {
input = &DescribeDBParametersInput{}
}
output = &DescribeDBParametersOutput{}
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
return
}
// DescribeDBParameters API operation for Amazon Relational Database Service.
//
// Returns the detailed parameter list for a particular DB parameter group.
//
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
// the error.
//
// See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Relational Database Service's
// API operation DescribeDBParameters for usage and error information.
//
// Returned Error Codes:
// * ErrCodeDBParameterGroupNotFoundFault "DBParameterGroupNotFound"
// DBParameterGroupName doesn't refer to an existing DB parameter group.
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/DescribeDBParameters
func (c *RDS) DescribeDBParameters(input *DescribeDBParametersInput) (*DescribeDBParametersOutput, error) {
req, out := c.DescribeDBParametersRequest(input)
return out, req.Send()
}
// DescribeDBParametersWithContext is the same as DescribeDBParameters with the addition of
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
//
// See DescribeDBParameters for details on how to use this API operation.
//
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
// for more information on using Contexts.
func (c *RDS) DescribeDBParametersWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DescribeDBParametersInput, opts ...request.Option) (*DescribeDBParametersOutput, error) {
req, out := c.DescribeDBParametersRequest(input)
req.SetContext(ctx)
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
return out, req.Send()
}
// DescribeDBParametersPages iterates over the pages of a DescribeDBParameters operation,
// calling the "fn" function with the response data for each page. To stop
// iterating, return false from the fn function.
//
// See DescribeDBParameters method for more information on how to use this operation.
//
// Note: This operation can generate multiple requests to a service.
//
// // Example iterating over at most 3 pages of a DescribeDBParameters operation.
// pageNum := 0
// err := client.DescribeDBParametersPages(params,
// func(page *DescribeDBParametersOutput, lastPage bool) bool {
// pageNum++
// fmt.Println(page)
// return pageNum <= 3
// })
//
func (c *RDS) DescribeDBParametersPages(input *DescribeDBParametersInput, fn func(*DescribeDBParametersOutput, bool) bool) error {
return c.DescribeDBParametersPagesWithContext(aws.BackgroundContext(), input, fn)
}
// DescribeDBParametersPagesWithContext same as DescribeDBParametersPages except
// it takes a Context and allows setting request options on the pages.
//
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
// for more information on using Contexts.
func (c *RDS) DescribeDBParametersPagesWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DescribeDBParametersInput, fn func(*DescribeDBParametersOutput, bool) bool, opts ...request.Option) error {
p := request.Pagination{
NewRequest: func() (*request.Request, error) {
var inCpy *DescribeDBParametersInput
if input != nil {
tmp := *input
inCpy = &tmp
}
req, _ := c.DescribeDBParametersRequest(inCpy)
req.SetContext(ctx)
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
return req, nil
},
}
cont := true
for p.Next() && cont {
cont = fn(p.Page().(*DescribeDBParametersOutput), !p.HasNextPage())
}
return p.Err()
}
const opDescribeDBSecurityGroups = "DescribeDBSecurityGroups"
// DescribeDBSecurityGroupsRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
// client's request for the DescribeDBSecurityGroups operation. The "output" return
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
// successfully.
//
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
//
// See DescribeDBSecurityGroups for more information on using the DescribeDBSecurityGroups
// API call, and error handling.
//
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
//
//
// // Example sending a request using the DescribeDBSecurityGroupsRequest method.
// req, resp := client.DescribeDBSecurityGroupsRequest(params)
//
// err := req.Send()
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
// fmt.Println(resp)
// }
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/DescribeDBSecurityGroups
func (c *RDS) DescribeDBSecurityGroupsRequest(input *DescribeDBSecurityGroupsInput) (req *request.Request, output *DescribeDBSecurityGroupsOutput) {
op := &request.Operation{
Name: opDescribeDBSecurityGroups,
HTTPMethod: "POST",
HTTPPath: "/",
Paginator: &request.Paginator{
InputTokens: []string{"Marker"},
OutputTokens: []string{"Marker"},
LimitToken: "MaxRecords",
TruncationToken: "",
},
}
if input == nil {
input = &DescribeDBSecurityGroupsInput{}
}
output = &DescribeDBSecurityGroupsOutput{}
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
return
}
// DescribeDBSecurityGroups API operation for Amazon Relational Database Service.
//
// Returns a list of DBSecurityGroup descriptions. If a DBSecurityGroupName
// is specified, the list will contain only the descriptions of the specified
// DB security group.
//
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
// the error.
//
// See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Relational Database Service's
// API operation DescribeDBSecurityGroups for usage and error information.
//
// Returned Error Codes:
// * ErrCodeDBSecurityGroupNotFoundFault "DBSecurityGroupNotFound"
// DBSecurityGroupName doesn't refer to an existing DB security group.
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/DescribeDBSecurityGroups
func (c *RDS) DescribeDBSecurityGroups(input *DescribeDBSecurityGroupsInput) (*DescribeDBSecurityGroupsOutput, error) {
req, out := c.DescribeDBSecurityGroupsRequest(input)
return out, req.Send()
}
// DescribeDBSecurityGroupsWithContext is the same as DescribeDBSecurityGroups with the addition of
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
//
// See DescribeDBSecurityGroups for details on how to use this API operation.
//
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
// for more information on using Contexts.
func (c *RDS) DescribeDBSecurityGroupsWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DescribeDBSecurityGroupsInput, opts ...request.Option) (*DescribeDBSecurityGroupsOutput, error) {
req, out := c.DescribeDBSecurityGroupsRequest(input)
req.SetContext(ctx)
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
return out, req.Send()
}
// DescribeDBSecurityGroupsPages iterates over the pages of a DescribeDBSecurityGroups operation,
// calling the "fn" function with the response data for each page. To stop
// iterating, return false from the fn function.
//
// See DescribeDBSecurityGroups method for more information on how to use this operation.
//
// Note: This operation can generate multiple requests to a service.
//
// // Example iterating over at most 3 pages of a DescribeDBSecurityGroups operation.
// pageNum := 0
// err := client.DescribeDBSecurityGroupsPages(params,
// func(page *DescribeDBSecurityGroupsOutput, lastPage bool) bool {
// pageNum++
// fmt.Println(page)
// return pageNum <= 3
// })
//
func (c *RDS) DescribeDBSecurityGroupsPages(input *DescribeDBSecurityGroupsInput, fn func(*DescribeDBSecurityGroupsOutput, bool) bool) error {
return c.DescribeDBSecurityGroupsPagesWithContext(aws.BackgroundContext(), input, fn)
}
// DescribeDBSecurityGroupsPagesWithContext same as DescribeDBSecurityGroupsPages except
// it takes a Context and allows setting request options on the pages.
//
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
// for more information on using Contexts.
func (c *RDS) DescribeDBSecurityGroupsPagesWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DescribeDBSecurityGroupsInput, fn func(*DescribeDBSecurityGroupsOutput, bool) bool, opts ...request.Option) error {
p := request.Pagination{
NewRequest: func() (*request.Request, error) {
var inCpy *DescribeDBSecurityGroupsInput
if input != nil {
tmp := *input
inCpy = &tmp
}
req, _ := c.DescribeDBSecurityGroupsRequest(inCpy)
req.SetContext(ctx)
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
return req, nil
},
}
cont := true
for p.Next() && cont {
cont = fn(p.Page().(*DescribeDBSecurityGroupsOutput), !p.HasNextPage())
}
return p.Err()
}
const opDescribeDBSnapshotAttributes = "DescribeDBSnapshotAttributes"
// DescribeDBSnapshotAttributesRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
// client's request for the DescribeDBSnapshotAttributes operation. The "output" return
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
// successfully.
//
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
//
// See DescribeDBSnapshotAttributes for more information on using the DescribeDBSnapshotAttributes
// API call, and error handling.
//
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
//
//
// // Example sending a request using the DescribeDBSnapshotAttributesRequest method.
// req, resp := client.DescribeDBSnapshotAttributesRequest(params)
//
// err := req.Send()
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
// fmt.Println(resp)
// }
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/DescribeDBSnapshotAttributes
func (c *RDS) DescribeDBSnapshotAttributesRequest(input *DescribeDBSnapshotAttributesInput) (req *request.Request, output *DescribeDBSnapshotAttributesOutput) {
op := &request.Operation{
Name: opDescribeDBSnapshotAttributes,
HTTPMethod: "POST",
HTTPPath: "/",
}
if input == nil {
input = &DescribeDBSnapshotAttributesInput{}
}
output = &DescribeDBSnapshotAttributesOutput{}
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
return
}
// DescribeDBSnapshotAttributes API operation for Amazon Relational Database Service.
//
// Returns a list of DB snapshot attribute names and values for a manual DB
// snapshot.
//
// When sharing snapshots with other AWS accounts, DescribeDBSnapshotAttributes
// returns the restore attribute and a list of IDs for the AWS accounts that
// are authorized to copy or restore the manual DB snapshot. If all is included
// in the list of values for the restore attribute, then the manual DB snapshot
// is public and can be copied or restored by all AWS accounts.
//
// To add or remove access for an AWS account to copy or restore a manual DB
// snapshot, or to make the manual DB snapshot public or private, use the ModifyDBSnapshotAttribute
// API action.
//
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
// the error.
//
// See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Relational Database Service's
// API operation DescribeDBSnapshotAttributes for usage and error information.
//
// Returned Error Codes:
// * ErrCodeDBSnapshotNotFoundFault "DBSnapshotNotFound"
// DBSnapshotIdentifier doesn't refer to an existing DB snapshot.
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/DescribeDBSnapshotAttributes
func (c *RDS) DescribeDBSnapshotAttributes(input *DescribeDBSnapshotAttributesInput) (*DescribeDBSnapshotAttributesOutput, error) {
req, out := c.DescribeDBSnapshotAttributesRequest(input)
return out, req.Send()
}
// DescribeDBSnapshotAttributesWithContext is the same as DescribeDBSnapshotAttributes with the addition of
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
//
// See DescribeDBSnapshotAttributes for details on how to use this API operation.
//
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
// for more information on using Contexts.
func (c *RDS) DescribeDBSnapshotAttributesWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DescribeDBSnapshotAttributesInput, opts ...request.Option) (*DescribeDBSnapshotAttributesOutput, error) {
req, out := c.DescribeDBSnapshotAttributesRequest(input)
req.SetContext(ctx)
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
return out, req.Send()
}
const opDescribeDBSnapshots = "DescribeDBSnapshots"
// DescribeDBSnapshotsRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
// client's request for the DescribeDBSnapshots operation. The "output" return
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
// successfully.
//
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
//
// See DescribeDBSnapshots for more information on using the DescribeDBSnapshots
// API call, and error handling.
//
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
//
//
// // Example sending a request using the DescribeDBSnapshotsRequest method.
// req, resp := client.DescribeDBSnapshotsRequest(params)
//
// err := req.Send()
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
// fmt.Println(resp)
// }
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/DescribeDBSnapshots
func (c *RDS) DescribeDBSnapshotsRequest(input *DescribeDBSnapshotsInput) (req *request.Request, output *DescribeDBSnapshotsOutput) {
op := &request.Operation{
Name: opDescribeDBSnapshots,
HTTPMethod: "POST",
HTTPPath: "/",
Paginator: &request.Paginator{
InputTokens: []string{"Marker"},
OutputTokens: []string{"Marker"},
LimitToken: "MaxRecords",
TruncationToken: "",
},
}
if input == nil {
input = &DescribeDBSnapshotsInput{}
}
output = &DescribeDBSnapshotsOutput{}
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
return
}
// DescribeDBSnapshots API operation for Amazon Relational Database Service.
//
// Returns information about DB snapshots. This API action supports pagination.
//
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
// the error.
//
// See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Relational Database Service's
// API operation DescribeDBSnapshots for usage and error information.
//
// Returned Error Codes:
// * ErrCodeDBSnapshotNotFoundFault "DBSnapshotNotFound"
// DBSnapshotIdentifier doesn't refer to an existing DB snapshot.
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/DescribeDBSnapshots
func (c *RDS) DescribeDBSnapshots(input *DescribeDBSnapshotsInput) (*DescribeDBSnapshotsOutput, error) {
req, out := c.DescribeDBSnapshotsRequest(input)
return out, req.Send()
}
// DescribeDBSnapshotsWithContext is the same as DescribeDBSnapshots with the addition of
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
//
// See DescribeDBSnapshots for details on how to use this API operation.
//
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
// for more information on using Contexts.
func (c *RDS) DescribeDBSnapshotsWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DescribeDBSnapshotsInput, opts ...request.Option) (*DescribeDBSnapshotsOutput, error) {
req, out := c.DescribeDBSnapshotsRequest(input)
req.SetContext(ctx)
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
return out, req.Send()
}
// DescribeDBSnapshotsPages iterates over the pages of a DescribeDBSnapshots operation,
// calling the "fn" function with the response data for each page. To stop
// iterating, return false from the fn function.
//
// See DescribeDBSnapshots method for more information on how to use this operation.
//
// Note: This operation can generate multiple requests to a service.
//
// // Example iterating over at most 3 pages of a DescribeDBSnapshots operation.
// pageNum := 0
// err := client.DescribeDBSnapshotsPages(params,
// func(page *DescribeDBSnapshotsOutput, lastPage bool) bool {
// pageNum++
// fmt.Println(page)
// return pageNum <= 3
// })
//
func (c *RDS) DescribeDBSnapshotsPages(input *DescribeDBSnapshotsInput, fn func(*DescribeDBSnapshotsOutput, bool) bool) error {
return c.DescribeDBSnapshotsPagesWithContext(aws.BackgroundContext(), input, fn)
}
// DescribeDBSnapshotsPagesWithContext same as DescribeDBSnapshotsPages except
// it takes a Context and allows setting request options on the pages.
//
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
// for more information on using Contexts.
func (c *RDS) DescribeDBSnapshotsPagesWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DescribeDBSnapshotsInput, fn func(*DescribeDBSnapshotsOutput, bool) bool, opts ...request.Option) error {
p := request.Pagination{
NewRequest: func() (*request.Request, error) {
var inCpy *DescribeDBSnapshotsInput
if input != nil {
tmp := *input
inCpy = &tmp
}
req, _ := c.DescribeDBSnapshotsRequest(inCpy)
req.SetContext(ctx)
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
return req, nil
},
}
cont := true
for p.Next() && cont {
cont = fn(p.Page().(*DescribeDBSnapshotsOutput), !p.HasNextPage())
}
return p.Err()
}
const opDescribeDBSubnetGroups = "DescribeDBSubnetGroups"
// DescribeDBSubnetGroupsRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
// client's request for the DescribeDBSubnetGroups operation. The "output" return
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
// successfully.
//
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
//
// See DescribeDBSubnetGroups for more information on using the DescribeDBSubnetGroups
// API call, and error handling.
//
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
//
//
// // Example sending a request using the DescribeDBSubnetGroupsRequest method.
// req, resp := client.DescribeDBSubnetGroupsRequest(params)
//
// err := req.Send()
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
// fmt.Println(resp)
// }
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/DescribeDBSubnetGroups
func (c *RDS) DescribeDBSubnetGroupsRequest(input *DescribeDBSubnetGroupsInput) (req *request.Request, output *DescribeDBSubnetGroupsOutput) {
op := &request.Operation{
Name: opDescribeDBSubnetGroups,
HTTPMethod: "POST",
HTTPPath: "/",
Paginator: &request.Paginator{
InputTokens: []string{"Marker"},
OutputTokens: []string{"Marker"},
LimitToken: "MaxRecords",
TruncationToken: "",
},
}
if input == nil {
input = &DescribeDBSubnetGroupsInput{}
}
output = &DescribeDBSubnetGroupsOutput{}
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
return
}
// DescribeDBSubnetGroups API operation for Amazon Relational Database Service.
//
// Returns a list of DBSubnetGroup descriptions. If a DBSubnetGroupName is specified,
// the list will contain only the descriptions of the specified DBSubnetGroup.
//
// For an overview of CIDR ranges, go to the Wikipedia Tutorial (http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Classless_Inter-Domain_Routing).
//
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
// the error.
//
// See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Relational Database Service's
// API operation DescribeDBSubnetGroups for usage and error information.
//
// Returned Error Codes:
// * ErrCodeDBSubnetGroupNotFoundFault "DBSubnetGroupNotFoundFault"
// DBSubnetGroupName doesn't refer to an existing DB subnet group.
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/DescribeDBSubnetGroups
func (c *RDS) DescribeDBSubnetGroups(input *DescribeDBSubnetGroupsInput) (*DescribeDBSubnetGroupsOutput, error) {
req, out := c.DescribeDBSubnetGroupsRequest(input)
return out, req.Send()
}
// DescribeDBSubnetGroupsWithContext is the same as DescribeDBSubnetGroups with the addition of
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
//
// See DescribeDBSubnetGroups for details on how to use this API operation.
//
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
// for more information on using Contexts.
func (c *RDS) DescribeDBSubnetGroupsWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DescribeDBSubnetGroupsInput, opts ...request.Option) (*DescribeDBSubnetGroupsOutput, error) {
req, out := c.DescribeDBSubnetGroupsRequest(input)
req.SetContext(ctx)
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
return out, req.Send()
}
// DescribeDBSubnetGroupsPages iterates over the pages of a DescribeDBSubnetGroups operation,
// calling the "fn" function with the response data for each page. To stop
// iterating, return false from the fn function.
//
// See DescribeDBSubnetGroups method for more information on how to use this operation.
//
// Note: This operation can generate multiple requests to a service.
//
// // Example iterating over at most 3 pages of a DescribeDBSubnetGroups operation.
// pageNum := 0
// err := client.DescribeDBSubnetGroupsPages(params,
// func(page *DescribeDBSubnetGroupsOutput, lastPage bool) bool {
// pageNum++
// fmt.Println(page)
// return pageNum <= 3
// })
//
func (c *RDS) DescribeDBSubnetGroupsPages(input *DescribeDBSubnetGroupsInput, fn func(*DescribeDBSubnetGroupsOutput, bool) bool) error {
return c.DescribeDBSubnetGroupsPagesWithContext(aws.BackgroundContext(), input, fn)
}
// DescribeDBSubnetGroupsPagesWithContext same as DescribeDBSubnetGroupsPages except
// it takes a Context and allows setting request options on the pages.
//
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
// for more information on using Contexts.
func (c *RDS) DescribeDBSubnetGroupsPagesWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DescribeDBSubnetGroupsInput, fn func(*DescribeDBSubnetGroupsOutput, bool) bool, opts ...request.Option) error {
p := request.Pagination{
NewRequest: func() (*request.Request, error) {
var inCpy *DescribeDBSubnetGroupsInput
if input != nil {
tmp := *input
inCpy = &tmp
}
req, _ := c.DescribeDBSubnetGroupsRequest(inCpy)
req.SetContext(ctx)
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
return req, nil
},
}
cont := true
for p.Next() && cont {
cont = fn(p.Page().(*DescribeDBSubnetGroupsOutput), !p.HasNextPage())
}
return p.Err()
}
const opDescribeEngineDefaultClusterParameters = "DescribeEngineDefaultClusterParameters"
// DescribeEngineDefaultClusterParametersRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
// client's request for the DescribeEngineDefaultClusterParameters operation. The "output" return
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
// successfully.
//
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
//
// See DescribeEngineDefaultClusterParameters for more information on using the DescribeEngineDefaultClusterParameters
// API call, and error handling.
//
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
//
//
// // Example sending a request using the DescribeEngineDefaultClusterParametersRequest method.
// req, resp := client.DescribeEngineDefaultClusterParametersRequest(params)
//
// err := req.Send()
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
// fmt.Println(resp)
// }
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/DescribeEngineDefaultClusterParameters
func (c *RDS) DescribeEngineDefaultClusterParametersRequest(input *DescribeEngineDefaultClusterParametersInput) (req *request.Request, output *DescribeEngineDefaultClusterParametersOutput) {
op := &request.Operation{
Name: opDescribeEngineDefaultClusterParameters,
HTTPMethod: "POST",
HTTPPath: "/",
}
if input == nil {
input = &DescribeEngineDefaultClusterParametersInput{}
}
output = &DescribeEngineDefaultClusterParametersOutput{}
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
return
}
// DescribeEngineDefaultClusterParameters API operation for Amazon Relational Database Service.
//
// Returns the default engine and system parameter information for the cluster
// database engine.
//
// For more information on Amazon Aurora, see What Is Amazon Aurora? (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/AuroraUserGuide/CHAP_AuroraOverview.html)
// in the Amazon Aurora User Guide.
//
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
// the error.
//
// See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Relational Database Service's
// API operation DescribeEngineDefaultClusterParameters for usage and error information.
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/DescribeEngineDefaultClusterParameters
func (c *RDS) DescribeEngineDefaultClusterParameters(input *DescribeEngineDefaultClusterParametersInput) (*DescribeEngineDefaultClusterParametersOutput, error) {
req, out := c.DescribeEngineDefaultClusterParametersRequest(input)
return out, req.Send()
}
// DescribeEngineDefaultClusterParametersWithContext is the same as DescribeEngineDefaultClusterParameters with the addition of
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
//
// See DescribeEngineDefaultClusterParameters for details on how to use this API operation.
//
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
// for more information on using Contexts.
func (c *RDS) DescribeEngineDefaultClusterParametersWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DescribeEngineDefaultClusterParametersInput, opts ...request.Option) (*DescribeEngineDefaultClusterParametersOutput, error) {
req, out := c.DescribeEngineDefaultClusterParametersRequest(input)
req.SetContext(ctx)
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
return out, req.Send()
}
const opDescribeEngineDefaultParameters = "DescribeEngineDefaultParameters"
// DescribeEngineDefaultParametersRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
// client's request for the DescribeEngineDefaultParameters operation. The "output" return
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
// successfully.
//
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
//
// See DescribeEngineDefaultParameters for more information on using the DescribeEngineDefaultParameters
// API call, and error handling.
//
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
//
//
// // Example sending a request using the DescribeEngineDefaultParametersRequest method.
// req, resp := client.DescribeEngineDefaultParametersRequest(params)
//
// err := req.Send()
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
// fmt.Println(resp)
// }
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/DescribeEngineDefaultParameters
func (c *RDS) DescribeEngineDefaultParametersRequest(input *DescribeEngineDefaultParametersInput) (req *request.Request, output *DescribeEngineDefaultParametersOutput) {
op := &request.Operation{
Name: opDescribeEngineDefaultParameters,
HTTPMethod: "POST",
HTTPPath: "/",
Paginator: &request.Paginator{
InputTokens: []string{"Marker"},
OutputTokens: []string{"EngineDefaults.Marker"},
LimitToken: "MaxRecords",
TruncationToken: "",
},
}
if input == nil {
input = &DescribeEngineDefaultParametersInput{}
}
output = &DescribeEngineDefaultParametersOutput{}
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
return
}
// DescribeEngineDefaultParameters API operation for Amazon Relational Database Service.
//
// Returns the default engine and system parameter information for the specified
// database engine.
//
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
// the error.
//
// See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Relational Database Service's
// API operation DescribeEngineDefaultParameters for usage and error information.
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/DescribeEngineDefaultParameters
func (c *RDS) DescribeEngineDefaultParameters(input *DescribeEngineDefaultParametersInput) (*DescribeEngineDefaultParametersOutput, error) {
req, out := c.DescribeEngineDefaultParametersRequest(input)
return out, req.Send()
}
// DescribeEngineDefaultParametersWithContext is the same as DescribeEngineDefaultParameters with the addition of
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
//
// See DescribeEngineDefaultParameters for details on how to use this API operation.
//
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
// for more information on using Contexts.
func (c *RDS) DescribeEngineDefaultParametersWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DescribeEngineDefaultParametersInput, opts ...request.Option) (*DescribeEngineDefaultParametersOutput, error) {
req, out := c.DescribeEngineDefaultParametersRequest(input)
req.SetContext(ctx)
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
return out, req.Send()
}
// DescribeEngineDefaultParametersPages iterates over the pages of a DescribeEngineDefaultParameters operation,
// calling the "fn" function with the response data for each page. To stop
// iterating, return false from the fn function.
//
// See DescribeEngineDefaultParameters method for more information on how to use this operation.
//
// Note: This operation can generate multiple requests to a service.
//
// // Example iterating over at most 3 pages of a DescribeEngineDefaultParameters operation.
// pageNum := 0
// err := client.DescribeEngineDefaultParametersPages(params,
// func(page *DescribeEngineDefaultParametersOutput, lastPage bool) bool {
// pageNum++
// fmt.Println(page)
// return pageNum <= 3
// })
//
func (c *RDS) DescribeEngineDefaultParametersPages(input *DescribeEngineDefaultParametersInput, fn func(*DescribeEngineDefaultParametersOutput, bool) bool) error {
return c.DescribeEngineDefaultParametersPagesWithContext(aws.BackgroundContext(), input, fn)
}
// DescribeEngineDefaultParametersPagesWithContext same as DescribeEngineDefaultParametersPages except
// it takes a Context and allows setting request options on the pages.
//
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
// for more information on using Contexts.
func (c *RDS) DescribeEngineDefaultParametersPagesWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DescribeEngineDefaultParametersInput, fn func(*DescribeEngineDefaultParametersOutput, bool) bool, opts ...request.Option) error {
p := request.Pagination{
NewRequest: func() (*request.Request, error) {
var inCpy *DescribeEngineDefaultParametersInput
if input != nil {
tmp := *input
inCpy = &tmp
}
req, _ := c.DescribeEngineDefaultParametersRequest(inCpy)
req.SetContext(ctx)
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
return req, nil
},
}
cont := true
for p.Next() && cont {
cont = fn(p.Page().(*DescribeEngineDefaultParametersOutput), !p.HasNextPage())
}
return p.Err()
}
const opDescribeEventCategories = "DescribeEventCategories"
// DescribeEventCategoriesRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
// client's request for the DescribeEventCategories operation. The "output" return
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
// successfully.
//
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
//
// See DescribeEventCategories for more information on using the DescribeEventCategories
// API call, and error handling.
//
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
//
//
// // Example sending a request using the DescribeEventCategoriesRequest method.
// req, resp := client.DescribeEventCategoriesRequest(params)
//
// err := req.Send()
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
// fmt.Println(resp)
// }
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/DescribeEventCategories
func (c *RDS) DescribeEventCategoriesRequest(input *DescribeEventCategoriesInput) (req *request.Request, output *DescribeEventCategoriesOutput) {
op := &request.Operation{
Name: opDescribeEventCategories,
HTTPMethod: "POST",
HTTPPath: "/",
}
if input == nil {
input = &DescribeEventCategoriesInput{}
}
output = &DescribeEventCategoriesOutput{}
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
return
}
// DescribeEventCategories API operation for Amazon Relational Database Service.
//
// Displays a list of categories for all event source types, or, if specified,
// for a specified source type. You can see a list of the event categories and
// source types in the Events (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/UserGuide/USER_Events.html)
// topic in the Amazon RDS User Guide.
//
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
// the error.
//
// See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Relational Database Service's
// API operation DescribeEventCategories for usage and error information.
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/DescribeEventCategories
func (c *RDS) DescribeEventCategories(input *DescribeEventCategoriesInput) (*DescribeEventCategoriesOutput, error) {
req, out := c.DescribeEventCategoriesRequest(input)
return out, req.Send()
}
// DescribeEventCategoriesWithContext is the same as DescribeEventCategories with the addition of
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
//
// See DescribeEventCategories for details on how to use this API operation.
//
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
// for more information on using Contexts.
func (c *RDS) DescribeEventCategoriesWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DescribeEventCategoriesInput, opts ...request.Option) (*DescribeEventCategoriesOutput, error) {
req, out := c.DescribeEventCategoriesRequest(input)
req.SetContext(ctx)
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
return out, req.Send()
}
const opDescribeEventSubscriptions = "DescribeEventSubscriptions"
// DescribeEventSubscriptionsRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
// client's request for the DescribeEventSubscriptions operation. The "output" return
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
// successfully.
//
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
//
// See DescribeEventSubscriptions for more information on using the DescribeEventSubscriptions
// API call, and error handling.
//
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
//
//
// // Example sending a request using the DescribeEventSubscriptionsRequest method.
// req, resp := client.DescribeEventSubscriptionsRequest(params)
//
// err := req.Send()
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
// fmt.Println(resp)
// }
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/DescribeEventSubscriptions
func (c *RDS) DescribeEventSubscriptionsRequest(input *DescribeEventSubscriptionsInput) (req *request.Request, output *DescribeEventSubscriptionsOutput) {
op := &request.Operation{
Name: opDescribeEventSubscriptions,
HTTPMethod: "POST",
HTTPPath: "/",
Paginator: &request.Paginator{
InputTokens: []string{"Marker"},
OutputTokens: []string{"Marker"},
LimitToken: "MaxRecords",
TruncationToken: "",
},
}
if input == nil {
input = &DescribeEventSubscriptionsInput{}
}
output = &DescribeEventSubscriptionsOutput{}
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
return
}
// DescribeEventSubscriptions API operation for Amazon Relational Database Service.
//
// Lists all the subscription descriptions for a customer account. The description
// for a subscription includes SubscriptionName, SNSTopicARN, CustomerID, SourceType,
// SourceID, CreationTime, and Status.
//
// If you specify a SubscriptionName, lists the description for that subscription.
//
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
// the error.
//
// See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Relational Database Service's
// API operation DescribeEventSubscriptions for usage and error information.
//
// Returned Error Codes:
// * ErrCodeSubscriptionNotFoundFault "SubscriptionNotFound"
// The subscription name does not exist.
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/DescribeEventSubscriptions
func (c *RDS) DescribeEventSubscriptions(input *DescribeEventSubscriptionsInput) (*DescribeEventSubscriptionsOutput, error) {
req, out := c.DescribeEventSubscriptionsRequest(input)
return out, req.Send()
}
// DescribeEventSubscriptionsWithContext is the same as DescribeEventSubscriptions with the addition of
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
//
// See DescribeEventSubscriptions for details on how to use this API operation.
//
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
// for more information on using Contexts.
func (c *RDS) DescribeEventSubscriptionsWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DescribeEventSubscriptionsInput, opts ...request.Option) (*DescribeEventSubscriptionsOutput, error) {
req, out := c.DescribeEventSubscriptionsRequest(input)
req.SetContext(ctx)
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
return out, req.Send()
}
// DescribeEventSubscriptionsPages iterates over the pages of a DescribeEventSubscriptions operation,
// calling the "fn" function with the response data for each page. To stop
// iterating, return false from the fn function.
//
// See DescribeEventSubscriptions method for more information on how to use this operation.
//
// Note: This operation can generate multiple requests to a service.
//
// // Example iterating over at most 3 pages of a DescribeEventSubscriptions operation.
// pageNum := 0
// err := client.DescribeEventSubscriptionsPages(params,
// func(page *DescribeEventSubscriptionsOutput, lastPage bool) bool {
// pageNum++
// fmt.Println(page)
// return pageNum <= 3
// })
//
func (c *RDS) DescribeEventSubscriptionsPages(input *DescribeEventSubscriptionsInput, fn func(*DescribeEventSubscriptionsOutput, bool) bool) error {
return c.DescribeEventSubscriptionsPagesWithContext(aws.BackgroundContext(), input, fn)
}
// DescribeEventSubscriptionsPagesWithContext same as DescribeEventSubscriptionsPages except
// it takes a Context and allows setting request options on the pages.
//
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
// for more information on using Contexts.
func (c *RDS) DescribeEventSubscriptionsPagesWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DescribeEventSubscriptionsInput, fn func(*DescribeEventSubscriptionsOutput, bool) bool, opts ...request.Option) error {
p := request.Pagination{
NewRequest: func() (*request.Request, error) {
var inCpy *DescribeEventSubscriptionsInput
if input != nil {
tmp := *input
inCpy = &tmp
}
req, _ := c.DescribeEventSubscriptionsRequest(inCpy)
req.SetContext(ctx)
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
return req, nil
},
}
cont := true
for p.Next() && cont {
cont = fn(p.Page().(*DescribeEventSubscriptionsOutput), !p.HasNextPage())
}
return p.Err()
}
const opDescribeEvents = "DescribeEvents"
// DescribeEventsRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
// client's request for the DescribeEvents operation. The "output" return
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
// successfully.
//
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
//
// See DescribeEvents for more information on using the DescribeEvents
// API call, and error handling.
//
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
//
//
// // Example sending a request using the DescribeEventsRequest method.
// req, resp := client.DescribeEventsRequest(params)
//
// err := req.Send()
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
// fmt.Println(resp)
// }
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/DescribeEvents
func (c *RDS) DescribeEventsRequest(input *DescribeEventsInput) (req *request.Request, output *DescribeEventsOutput) {
op := &request.Operation{
Name: opDescribeEvents,
HTTPMethod: "POST",
HTTPPath: "/",
Paginator: &request.Paginator{
InputTokens: []string{"Marker"},
OutputTokens: []string{"Marker"},
LimitToken: "MaxRecords",
TruncationToken: "",
},
}
if input == nil {
input = &DescribeEventsInput{}
}
output = &DescribeEventsOutput{}
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
return
}
// DescribeEvents API operation for Amazon Relational Database Service.
//
// Returns events related to DB instances, DB security groups, DB snapshots,
// and DB parameter groups for the past 14 days. Events specific to a particular
// DB instance, DB security group, database snapshot, or DB parameter group
// can be obtained by providing the name as a parameter. By default, the past
// hour of events are returned.
//
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
// the error.
//
// See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Relational Database Service's
// API operation DescribeEvents for usage and error information.
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/DescribeEvents
func (c *RDS) DescribeEvents(input *DescribeEventsInput) (*DescribeEventsOutput, error) {
req, out := c.DescribeEventsRequest(input)
return out, req.Send()
}
// DescribeEventsWithContext is the same as DescribeEvents with the addition of
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
//
// See DescribeEvents for details on how to use this API operation.
//
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
// for more information on using Contexts.
func (c *RDS) DescribeEventsWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DescribeEventsInput, opts ...request.Option) (*DescribeEventsOutput, error) {
req, out := c.DescribeEventsRequest(input)
req.SetContext(ctx)
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
return out, req.Send()
}
// DescribeEventsPages iterates over the pages of a DescribeEvents operation,
// calling the "fn" function with the response data for each page. To stop
// iterating, return false from the fn function.
//
// See DescribeEvents method for more information on how to use this operation.
//
// Note: This operation can generate multiple requests to a service.
//
// // Example iterating over at most 3 pages of a DescribeEvents operation.
// pageNum := 0
// err := client.DescribeEventsPages(params,
// func(page *DescribeEventsOutput, lastPage bool) bool {
// pageNum++
// fmt.Println(page)
// return pageNum <= 3
// })
//
func (c *RDS) DescribeEventsPages(input *DescribeEventsInput, fn func(*DescribeEventsOutput, bool) bool) error {
return c.DescribeEventsPagesWithContext(aws.BackgroundContext(), input, fn)
}
// DescribeEventsPagesWithContext same as DescribeEventsPages except
// it takes a Context and allows setting request options on the pages.
//
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
// for more information on using Contexts.
func (c *RDS) DescribeEventsPagesWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DescribeEventsInput, fn func(*DescribeEventsOutput, bool) bool, opts ...request.Option) error {
p := request.Pagination{
NewRequest: func() (*request.Request, error) {
var inCpy *DescribeEventsInput
if input != nil {
tmp := *input
inCpy = &tmp
}
req, _ := c.DescribeEventsRequest(inCpy)
req.SetContext(ctx)
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
return req, nil
},
}
cont := true
for p.Next() && cont {
cont = fn(p.Page().(*DescribeEventsOutput), !p.HasNextPage())
}
return p.Err()
}
const opDescribeGlobalClusters = "DescribeGlobalClusters"
// DescribeGlobalClustersRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
// client's request for the DescribeGlobalClusters operation. The "output" return
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
// successfully.
//
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
//
// See DescribeGlobalClusters for more information on using the DescribeGlobalClusters
// API call, and error handling.
//
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
//
//
// // Example sending a request using the DescribeGlobalClustersRequest method.
// req, resp := client.DescribeGlobalClustersRequest(params)
//
// err := req.Send()
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
// fmt.Println(resp)
// }
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/DescribeGlobalClusters
func (c *RDS) DescribeGlobalClustersRequest(input *DescribeGlobalClustersInput) (req *request.Request, output *DescribeGlobalClustersOutput) {
op := &request.Operation{
Name: opDescribeGlobalClusters,
HTTPMethod: "POST",
HTTPPath: "/",
Paginator: &request.Paginator{
InputTokens: []string{"Marker"},
OutputTokens: []string{"Marker"},
LimitToken: "MaxRecords",
TruncationToken: "",
},
}
if input == nil {
input = &DescribeGlobalClustersInput{}
}
output = &DescribeGlobalClustersOutput{}
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
return
}
// DescribeGlobalClusters API operation for Amazon Relational Database Service.
//
// Returns information about Aurora global database clusters. This API supports
// pagination.
//
// For more information on Amazon Aurora, see What Is Amazon Aurora? (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/AuroraUserGuide/CHAP_AuroraOverview.html)
// in the Amazon Aurora User Guide.
//
// This action only applies to Aurora DB clusters.
//
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
// the error.
//
// See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Relational Database Service's
// API operation DescribeGlobalClusters for usage and error information.
//
// Returned Error Codes:
// * ErrCodeGlobalClusterNotFoundFault "GlobalClusterNotFoundFault"
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/DescribeGlobalClusters
func (c *RDS) DescribeGlobalClusters(input *DescribeGlobalClustersInput) (*DescribeGlobalClustersOutput, error) {
req, out := c.DescribeGlobalClustersRequest(input)
return out, req.Send()
}
// DescribeGlobalClustersWithContext is the same as DescribeGlobalClusters with the addition of
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
//
// See DescribeGlobalClusters for details on how to use this API operation.
//
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
// for more information on using Contexts.
func (c *RDS) DescribeGlobalClustersWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DescribeGlobalClustersInput, opts ...request.Option) (*DescribeGlobalClustersOutput, error) {
req, out := c.DescribeGlobalClustersRequest(input)
req.SetContext(ctx)
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
return out, req.Send()
}
// DescribeGlobalClustersPages iterates over the pages of a DescribeGlobalClusters operation,
// calling the "fn" function with the response data for each page. To stop
// iterating, return false from the fn function.
//
// See DescribeGlobalClusters method for more information on how to use this operation.
//
// Note: This operation can generate multiple requests to a service.
//
// // Example iterating over at most 3 pages of a DescribeGlobalClusters operation.
// pageNum := 0
// err := client.DescribeGlobalClustersPages(params,
// func(page *DescribeGlobalClustersOutput, lastPage bool) bool {
// pageNum++
// fmt.Println(page)
// return pageNum <= 3
// })
//
func (c *RDS) DescribeGlobalClustersPages(input *DescribeGlobalClustersInput, fn func(*DescribeGlobalClustersOutput, bool) bool) error {
return c.DescribeGlobalClustersPagesWithContext(aws.BackgroundContext(), input, fn)
}
// DescribeGlobalClustersPagesWithContext same as DescribeGlobalClustersPages except
// it takes a Context and allows setting request options on the pages.
//
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
// for more information on using Contexts.
func (c *RDS) DescribeGlobalClustersPagesWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DescribeGlobalClustersInput, fn func(*DescribeGlobalClustersOutput, bool) bool, opts ...request.Option) error {
p := request.Pagination{
NewRequest: func() (*request.Request, error) {
var inCpy *DescribeGlobalClustersInput
if input != nil {
tmp := *input
inCpy = &tmp
}
req, _ := c.DescribeGlobalClustersRequest(inCpy)
req.SetContext(ctx)
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
return req, nil
},
}
cont := true
for p.Next() && cont {
cont = fn(p.Page().(*DescribeGlobalClustersOutput), !p.HasNextPage())
}
return p.Err()
}
const opDescribeOptionGroupOptions = "DescribeOptionGroupOptions"
// DescribeOptionGroupOptionsRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
// client's request for the DescribeOptionGroupOptions operation. The "output" return
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
// successfully.
//
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
//
// See DescribeOptionGroupOptions for more information on using the DescribeOptionGroupOptions
// API call, and error handling.
//
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
//
//
// // Example sending a request using the DescribeOptionGroupOptionsRequest method.
// req, resp := client.DescribeOptionGroupOptionsRequest(params)
//
// err := req.Send()
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
// fmt.Println(resp)
// }
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/DescribeOptionGroupOptions
func (c *RDS) DescribeOptionGroupOptionsRequest(input *DescribeOptionGroupOptionsInput) (req *request.Request, output *DescribeOptionGroupOptionsOutput) {
op := &request.Operation{
Name: opDescribeOptionGroupOptions,
HTTPMethod: "POST",
HTTPPath: "/",
Paginator: &request.Paginator{
InputTokens: []string{"Marker"},
OutputTokens: []string{"Marker"},
LimitToken: "MaxRecords",
TruncationToken: "",
},
}
if input == nil {
input = &DescribeOptionGroupOptionsInput{}
}
output = &DescribeOptionGroupOptionsOutput{}
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
return
}
// DescribeOptionGroupOptions API operation for Amazon Relational Database Service.
//
// Describes all available options.
//
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
// the error.
//
// See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Relational Database Service's
// API operation DescribeOptionGroupOptions for usage and error information.
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/DescribeOptionGroupOptions
func (c *RDS) DescribeOptionGroupOptions(input *DescribeOptionGroupOptionsInput) (*DescribeOptionGroupOptionsOutput, error) {
req, out := c.DescribeOptionGroupOptionsRequest(input)
return out, req.Send()
}
// DescribeOptionGroupOptionsWithContext is the same as DescribeOptionGroupOptions with the addition of
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
//
// See DescribeOptionGroupOptions for details on how to use this API operation.
//
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
// for more information on using Contexts.
func (c *RDS) DescribeOptionGroupOptionsWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DescribeOptionGroupOptionsInput, opts ...request.Option) (*DescribeOptionGroupOptionsOutput, error) {
req, out := c.DescribeOptionGroupOptionsRequest(input)
req.SetContext(ctx)
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
return out, req.Send()
}
// DescribeOptionGroupOptionsPages iterates over the pages of a DescribeOptionGroupOptions operation,
// calling the "fn" function with the response data for each page. To stop
// iterating, return false from the fn function.
//
// See DescribeOptionGroupOptions method for more information on how to use this operation.
//
// Note: This operation can generate multiple requests to a service.
//
// // Example iterating over at most 3 pages of a DescribeOptionGroupOptions operation.
// pageNum := 0
// err := client.DescribeOptionGroupOptionsPages(params,
// func(page *DescribeOptionGroupOptionsOutput, lastPage bool) bool {
// pageNum++
// fmt.Println(page)
// return pageNum <= 3
// })
//
func (c *RDS) DescribeOptionGroupOptionsPages(input *DescribeOptionGroupOptionsInput, fn func(*DescribeOptionGroupOptionsOutput, bool) bool) error {
return c.DescribeOptionGroupOptionsPagesWithContext(aws.BackgroundContext(), input, fn)
}
// DescribeOptionGroupOptionsPagesWithContext same as DescribeOptionGroupOptionsPages except
// it takes a Context and allows setting request options on the pages.
//
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
// for more information on using Contexts.
func (c *RDS) DescribeOptionGroupOptionsPagesWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DescribeOptionGroupOptionsInput, fn func(*DescribeOptionGroupOptionsOutput, bool) bool, opts ...request.Option) error {
p := request.Pagination{
NewRequest: func() (*request.Request, error) {
var inCpy *DescribeOptionGroupOptionsInput
if input != nil {
tmp := *input
inCpy = &tmp
}
req, _ := c.DescribeOptionGroupOptionsRequest(inCpy)
req.SetContext(ctx)
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
return req, nil
},
}
cont := true
for p.Next() && cont {
cont = fn(p.Page().(*DescribeOptionGroupOptionsOutput), !p.HasNextPage())
}
return p.Err()
}
const opDescribeOptionGroups = "DescribeOptionGroups"
// DescribeOptionGroupsRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
// client's request for the DescribeOptionGroups operation. The "output" return
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
// successfully.
//
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
//
// See DescribeOptionGroups for more information on using the DescribeOptionGroups
// API call, and error handling.
//
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
//
//
// // Example sending a request using the DescribeOptionGroupsRequest method.
// req, resp := client.DescribeOptionGroupsRequest(params)
//
// err := req.Send()
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
// fmt.Println(resp)
// }
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/DescribeOptionGroups
func (c *RDS) DescribeOptionGroupsRequest(input *DescribeOptionGroupsInput) (req *request.Request, output *DescribeOptionGroupsOutput) {
op := &request.Operation{
Name: opDescribeOptionGroups,
HTTPMethod: "POST",
HTTPPath: "/",
Paginator: &request.Paginator{
InputTokens: []string{"Marker"},
OutputTokens: []string{"Marker"},
LimitToken: "MaxRecords",
TruncationToken: "",
},
}
if input == nil {
input = &DescribeOptionGroupsInput{}
}
output = &DescribeOptionGroupsOutput{}
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
return
}
// DescribeOptionGroups API operation for Amazon Relational Database Service.
//
// Describes the available option groups.
//
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
// the error.
//
// See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Relational Database Service's
// API operation DescribeOptionGroups for usage and error information.
//
// Returned Error Codes:
// * ErrCodeOptionGroupNotFoundFault "OptionGroupNotFoundFault"
// The specified option group could not be found.
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/DescribeOptionGroups
func (c *RDS) DescribeOptionGroups(input *DescribeOptionGroupsInput) (*DescribeOptionGroupsOutput, error) {
req, out := c.DescribeOptionGroupsRequest(input)
return out, req.Send()
}
// DescribeOptionGroupsWithContext is the same as DescribeOptionGroups with the addition of
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
//
// See DescribeOptionGroups for details on how to use this API operation.
//
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
// for more information on using Contexts.
func (c *RDS) DescribeOptionGroupsWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DescribeOptionGroupsInput, opts ...request.Option) (*DescribeOptionGroupsOutput, error) {
req, out := c.DescribeOptionGroupsRequest(input)
req.SetContext(ctx)
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
return out, req.Send()
}
// DescribeOptionGroupsPages iterates over the pages of a DescribeOptionGroups operation,
// calling the "fn" function with the response data for each page. To stop
// iterating, return false from the fn function.
//
// See DescribeOptionGroups method for more information on how to use this operation.
//
// Note: This operation can generate multiple requests to a service.
//
// // Example iterating over at most 3 pages of a DescribeOptionGroups operation.
// pageNum := 0
// err := client.DescribeOptionGroupsPages(params,
// func(page *DescribeOptionGroupsOutput, lastPage bool) bool {
// pageNum++
// fmt.Println(page)
// return pageNum <= 3
// })
//
func (c *RDS) DescribeOptionGroupsPages(input *DescribeOptionGroupsInput, fn func(*DescribeOptionGroupsOutput, bool) bool) error {
return c.DescribeOptionGroupsPagesWithContext(aws.BackgroundContext(), input, fn)
}
// DescribeOptionGroupsPagesWithContext same as DescribeOptionGroupsPages except
// it takes a Context and allows setting request options on the pages.
//
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
// for more information on using Contexts.
func (c *RDS) DescribeOptionGroupsPagesWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DescribeOptionGroupsInput, fn func(*DescribeOptionGroupsOutput, bool) bool, opts ...request.Option) error {
p := request.Pagination{
NewRequest: func() (*request.Request, error) {
var inCpy *DescribeOptionGroupsInput
if input != nil {
tmp := *input
inCpy = &tmp
}
req, _ := c.DescribeOptionGroupsRequest(inCpy)
req.SetContext(ctx)
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
return req, nil
},
}
cont := true
for p.Next() && cont {
cont = fn(p.Page().(*DescribeOptionGroupsOutput), !p.HasNextPage())
}
return p.Err()
}
const opDescribeOrderableDBInstanceOptions = "DescribeOrderableDBInstanceOptions"
// DescribeOrderableDBInstanceOptionsRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
// client's request for the DescribeOrderableDBInstanceOptions operation. The "output" return
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
// successfully.
//
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
//
// See DescribeOrderableDBInstanceOptions for more information on using the DescribeOrderableDBInstanceOptions
// API call, and error handling.
//
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
//
//
// // Example sending a request using the DescribeOrderableDBInstanceOptionsRequest method.
// req, resp := client.DescribeOrderableDBInstanceOptionsRequest(params)
//
// err := req.Send()
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
// fmt.Println(resp)
// }
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/DescribeOrderableDBInstanceOptions
func (c *RDS) DescribeOrderableDBInstanceOptionsRequest(input *DescribeOrderableDBInstanceOptionsInput) (req *request.Request, output *DescribeOrderableDBInstanceOptionsOutput) {
op := &request.Operation{
Name: opDescribeOrderableDBInstanceOptions,
HTTPMethod: "POST",
HTTPPath: "/",
Paginator: &request.Paginator{
InputTokens: []string{"Marker"},
OutputTokens: []string{"Marker"},
LimitToken: "MaxRecords",
TruncationToken: "",
},
}
if input == nil {
input = &DescribeOrderableDBInstanceOptionsInput{}
}
output = &DescribeOrderableDBInstanceOptionsOutput{}
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
return
}
// DescribeOrderableDBInstanceOptions API operation for Amazon Relational Database Service.
//
// Returns a list of orderable DB instance options for the specified engine.
//
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
// the error.
//
// See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Relational Database Service's
// API operation DescribeOrderableDBInstanceOptions for usage and error information.
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/DescribeOrderableDBInstanceOptions
func (c *RDS) DescribeOrderableDBInstanceOptions(input *DescribeOrderableDBInstanceOptionsInput) (*DescribeOrderableDBInstanceOptionsOutput, error) {
req, out := c.DescribeOrderableDBInstanceOptionsRequest(input)
return out, req.Send()
}
// DescribeOrderableDBInstanceOptionsWithContext is the same as DescribeOrderableDBInstanceOptions with the addition of
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
//
// See DescribeOrderableDBInstanceOptions for details on how to use this API operation.
//
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
// for more information on using Contexts.
func (c *RDS) DescribeOrderableDBInstanceOptionsWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DescribeOrderableDBInstanceOptionsInput, opts ...request.Option) (*DescribeOrderableDBInstanceOptionsOutput, error) {
req, out := c.DescribeOrderableDBInstanceOptionsRequest(input)
req.SetContext(ctx)
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
return out, req.Send()
}
// DescribeOrderableDBInstanceOptionsPages iterates over the pages of a DescribeOrderableDBInstanceOptions operation,
// calling the "fn" function with the response data for each page. To stop
// iterating, return false from the fn function.
//
// See DescribeOrderableDBInstanceOptions method for more information on how to use this operation.
//
// Note: This operation can generate multiple requests to a service.
//
// // Example iterating over at most 3 pages of a DescribeOrderableDBInstanceOptions operation.
// pageNum := 0
// err := client.DescribeOrderableDBInstanceOptionsPages(params,
// func(page *DescribeOrderableDBInstanceOptionsOutput, lastPage bool) bool {
// pageNum++
// fmt.Println(page)
// return pageNum <= 3
// })
//
func (c *RDS) DescribeOrderableDBInstanceOptionsPages(input *DescribeOrderableDBInstanceOptionsInput, fn func(*DescribeOrderableDBInstanceOptionsOutput, bool) bool) error {
return c.DescribeOrderableDBInstanceOptionsPagesWithContext(aws.BackgroundContext(), input, fn)
}
// DescribeOrderableDBInstanceOptionsPagesWithContext same as DescribeOrderableDBInstanceOptionsPages except
// it takes a Context and allows setting request options on the pages.
//
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
// for more information on using Contexts.
func (c *RDS) DescribeOrderableDBInstanceOptionsPagesWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DescribeOrderableDBInstanceOptionsInput, fn func(*DescribeOrderableDBInstanceOptionsOutput, bool) bool, opts ...request.Option) error {
p := request.Pagination{
NewRequest: func() (*request.Request, error) {
var inCpy *DescribeOrderableDBInstanceOptionsInput
if input != nil {
tmp := *input
inCpy = &tmp
}
req, _ := c.DescribeOrderableDBInstanceOptionsRequest(inCpy)
req.SetContext(ctx)
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
return req, nil
},
}
cont := true
for p.Next() && cont {
cont = fn(p.Page().(*DescribeOrderableDBInstanceOptionsOutput), !p.HasNextPage())
}
return p.Err()
}
const opDescribePendingMaintenanceActions = "DescribePendingMaintenanceActions"
// DescribePendingMaintenanceActionsRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
// client's request for the DescribePendingMaintenanceActions operation. The "output" return
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
// successfully.
//
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
//
// See DescribePendingMaintenanceActions for more information on using the DescribePendingMaintenanceActions
// API call, and error handling.
//
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
//
//
// // Example sending a request using the DescribePendingMaintenanceActionsRequest method.
// req, resp := client.DescribePendingMaintenanceActionsRequest(params)
//
// err := req.Send()
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
// fmt.Println(resp)
// }
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/DescribePendingMaintenanceActions
func (c *RDS) DescribePendingMaintenanceActionsRequest(input *DescribePendingMaintenanceActionsInput) (req *request.Request, output *DescribePendingMaintenanceActionsOutput) {
op := &request.Operation{
Name: opDescribePendingMaintenanceActions,
HTTPMethod: "POST",
HTTPPath: "/",
}
if input == nil {
input = &DescribePendingMaintenanceActionsInput{}
}
output = &DescribePendingMaintenanceActionsOutput{}
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
return
}
// DescribePendingMaintenanceActions API operation for Amazon Relational Database Service.
//
// Returns a list of resources (for example, DB instances) that have at least
// one pending maintenance action.
//
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
// the error.
//
// See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Relational Database Service's
// API operation DescribePendingMaintenanceActions for usage and error information.
//
// Returned Error Codes:
// * ErrCodeResourceNotFoundFault "ResourceNotFoundFault"
// The specified resource ID was not found.
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/DescribePendingMaintenanceActions
func (c *RDS) DescribePendingMaintenanceActions(input *DescribePendingMaintenanceActionsInput) (*DescribePendingMaintenanceActionsOutput, error) {
req, out := c.DescribePendingMaintenanceActionsRequest(input)
return out, req.Send()
}
// DescribePendingMaintenanceActionsWithContext is the same as DescribePendingMaintenanceActions with the addition of
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
//
// See DescribePendingMaintenanceActions for details on how to use this API operation.
//
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
// for more information on using Contexts.
func (c *RDS) DescribePendingMaintenanceActionsWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DescribePendingMaintenanceActionsInput, opts ...request.Option) (*DescribePendingMaintenanceActionsOutput, error) {
req, out := c.DescribePendingMaintenanceActionsRequest(input)
req.SetContext(ctx)
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
return out, req.Send()
}
const opDescribeReservedDBInstances = "DescribeReservedDBInstances"
// DescribeReservedDBInstancesRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
// client's request for the DescribeReservedDBInstances operation. The "output" return
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
// successfully.
//
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
//
// See DescribeReservedDBInstances for more information on using the DescribeReservedDBInstances
// API call, and error handling.
//
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
//
//
// // Example sending a request using the DescribeReservedDBInstancesRequest method.
// req, resp := client.DescribeReservedDBInstancesRequest(params)
//
// err := req.Send()
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
// fmt.Println(resp)
// }
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/DescribeReservedDBInstances
func (c *RDS) DescribeReservedDBInstancesRequest(input *DescribeReservedDBInstancesInput) (req *request.Request, output *DescribeReservedDBInstancesOutput) {
op := &request.Operation{
Name: opDescribeReservedDBInstances,
HTTPMethod: "POST",
HTTPPath: "/",
Paginator: &request.Paginator{
InputTokens: []string{"Marker"},
OutputTokens: []string{"Marker"},
LimitToken: "MaxRecords",
TruncationToken: "",
},
}
if input == nil {
input = &DescribeReservedDBInstancesInput{}
}
output = &DescribeReservedDBInstancesOutput{}
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
return
}
// DescribeReservedDBInstances API operation for Amazon Relational Database Service.
//
// Returns information about reserved DB instances for this account, or about
// a specified reserved DB instance.
//
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
// the error.
//
// See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Relational Database Service's
// API operation DescribeReservedDBInstances for usage and error information.
//
// Returned Error Codes:
// * ErrCodeReservedDBInstanceNotFoundFault "ReservedDBInstanceNotFound"
// The specified reserved DB Instance not found.
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/DescribeReservedDBInstances
func (c *RDS) DescribeReservedDBInstances(input *DescribeReservedDBInstancesInput) (*DescribeReservedDBInstancesOutput, error) {
req, out := c.DescribeReservedDBInstancesRequest(input)
return out, req.Send()
}
// DescribeReservedDBInstancesWithContext is the same as DescribeReservedDBInstances with the addition of
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
//
// See DescribeReservedDBInstances for details on how to use this API operation.
//
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
// for more information on using Contexts.
func (c *RDS) DescribeReservedDBInstancesWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DescribeReservedDBInstancesInput, opts ...request.Option) (*DescribeReservedDBInstancesOutput, error) {
req, out := c.DescribeReservedDBInstancesRequest(input)
req.SetContext(ctx)
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
return out, req.Send()
}
// DescribeReservedDBInstancesPages iterates over the pages of a DescribeReservedDBInstances operation,
// calling the "fn" function with the response data for each page. To stop
// iterating, return false from the fn function.
//
// See DescribeReservedDBInstances method for more information on how to use this operation.
//
// Note: This operation can generate multiple requests to a service.
//
// // Example iterating over at most 3 pages of a DescribeReservedDBInstances operation.
// pageNum := 0
// err := client.DescribeReservedDBInstancesPages(params,
// func(page *DescribeReservedDBInstancesOutput, lastPage bool) bool {
// pageNum++
// fmt.Println(page)
// return pageNum <= 3
// })
//
func (c *RDS) DescribeReservedDBInstancesPages(input *DescribeReservedDBInstancesInput, fn func(*DescribeReservedDBInstancesOutput, bool) bool) error {
return c.DescribeReservedDBInstancesPagesWithContext(aws.BackgroundContext(), input, fn)
}
// DescribeReservedDBInstancesPagesWithContext same as DescribeReservedDBInstancesPages except
// it takes a Context and allows setting request options on the pages.
//
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
// for more information on using Contexts.
func (c *RDS) DescribeReservedDBInstancesPagesWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DescribeReservedDBInstancesInput, fn func(*DescribeReservedDBInstancesOutput, bool) bool, opts ...request.Option) error {
p := request.Pagination{
NewRequest: func() (*request.Request, error) {
var inCpy *DescribeReservedDBInstancesInput
if input != nil {
tmp := *input
inCpy = &tmp
}
req, _ := c.DescribeReservedDBInstancesRequest(inCpy)
req.SetContext(ctx)
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
return req, nil
},
}
cont := true
for p.Next() && cont {
cont = fn(p.Page().(*DescribeReservedDBInstancesOutput), !p.HasNextPage())
}
return p.Err()
}
const opDescribeReservedDBInstancesOfferings = "DescribeReservedDBInstancesOfferings"
// DescribeReservedDBInstancesOfferingsRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
// client's request for the DescribeReservedDBInstancesOfferings operation. The "output" return
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
// successfully.
//
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
//
// See DescribeReservedDBInstancesOfferings for more information on using the DescribeReservedDBInstancesOfferings
// API call, and error handling.
//
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
//
//
// // Example sending a request using the DescribeReservedDBInstancesOfferingsRequest method.
// req, resp := client.DescribeReservedDBInstancesOfferingsRequest(params)
//
// err := req.Send()
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
// fmt.Println(resp)
// }
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/DescribeReservedDBInstancesOfferings
func (c *RDS) DescribeReservedDBInstancesOfferingsRequest(input *DescribeReservedDBInstancesOfferingsInput) (req *request.Request, output *DescribeReservedDBInstancesOfferingsOutput) {
op := &request.Operation{
Name: opDescribeReservedDBInstancesOfferings,
HTTPMethod: "POST",
HTTPPath: "/",
Paginator: &request.Paginator{
InputTokens: []string{"Marker"},
OutputTokens: []string{"Marker"},
LimitToken: "MaxRecords",
TruncationToken: "",
},
}
if input == nil {
input = &DescribeReservedDBInstancesOfferingsInput{}
}
output = &DescribeReservedDBInstancesOfferingsOutput{}
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
return
}
// DescribeReservedDBInstancesOfferings API operation for Amazon Relational Database Service.
//
// Lists available reserved DB instance offerings.
//
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
// the error.
//
// See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Relational Database Service's
// API operation DescribeReservedDBInstancesOfferings for usage and error information.
//
// Returned Error Codes:
// * ErrCodeReservedDBInstancesOfferingNotFoundFault "ReservedDBInstancesOfferingNotFound"
// Specified offering does not exist.
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/DescribeReservedDBInstancesOfferings
func (c *RDS) DescribeReservedDBInstancesOfferings(input *DescribeReservedDBInstancesOfferingsInput) (*DescribeReservedDBInstancesOfferingsOutput, error) {
req, out := c.DescribeReservedDBInstancesOfferingsRequest(input)
return out, req.Send()
}
// DescribeReservedDBInstancesOfferingsWithContext is the same as DescribeReservedDBInstancesOfferings with the addition of
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
//
// See DescribeReservedDBInstancesOfferings for details on how to use this API operation.
//
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
// for more information on using Contexts.
func (c *RDS) DescribeReservedDBInstancesOfferingsWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DescribeReservedDBInstancesOfferingsInput, opts ...request.Option) (*DescribeReservedDBInstancesOfferingsOutput, error) {
req, out := c.DescribeReservedDBInstancesOfferingsRequest(input)
req.SetContext(ctx)
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
return out, req.Send()
}
// DescribeReservedDBInstancesOfferingsPages iterates over the pages of a DescribeReservedDBInstancesOfferings operation,
// calling the "fn" function with the response data for each page. To stop
// iterating, return false from the fn function.
//
// See DescribeReservedDBInstancesOfferings method for more information on how to use this operation.
//
// Note: This operation can generate multiple requests to a service.
//
// // Example iterating over at most 3 pages of a DescribeReservedDBInstancesOfferings operation.
// pageNum := 0
// err := client.DescribeReservedDBInstancesOfferingsPages(params,
// func(page *DescribeReservedDBInstancesOfferingsOutput, lastPage bool) bool {
// pageNum++
// fmt.Println(page)
// return pageNum <= 3
// })
//
func (c *RDS) DescribeReservedDBInstancesOfferingsPages(input *DescribeReservedDBInstancesOfferingsInput, fn func(*DescribeReservedDBInstancesOfferingsOutput, bool) bool) error {
return c.DescribeReservedDBInstancesOfferingsPagesWithContext(aws.BackgroundContext(), input, fn)
}
// DescribeReservedDBInstancesOfferingsPagesWithContext same as DescribeReservedDBInstancesOfferingsPages except
// it takes a Context and allows setting request options on the pages.
//
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
// for more information on using Contexts.
func (c *RDS) DescribeReservedDBInstancesOfferingsPagesWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DescribeReservedDBInstancesOfferingsInput, fn func(*DescribeReservedDBInstancesOfferingsOutput, bool) bool, opts ...request.Option) error {
p := request.Pagination{
NewRequest: func() (*request.Request, error) {
var inCpy *DescribeReservedDBInstancesOfferingsInput
if input != nil {
tmp := *input
inCpy = &tmp
}
req, _ := c.DescribeReservedDBInstancesOfferingsRequest(inCpy)
req.SetContext(ctx)
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
return req, nil
},
}
cont := true
for p.Next() && cont {
cont = fn(p.Page().(*DescribeReservedDBInstancesOfferingsOutput), !p.HasNextPage())
}
return p.Err()
}
const opDescribeSourceRegions = "DescribeSourceRegions"
// DescribeSourceRegionsRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
// client's request for the DescribeSourceRegions operation. The "output" return
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
// successfully.
//
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
//
// See DescribeSourceRegions for more information on using the DescribeSourceRegions
// API call, and error handling.
//
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
//
//
// // Example sending a request using the DescribeSourceRegionsRequest method.
// req, resp := client.DescribeSourceRegionsRequest(params)
//
// err := req.Send()
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
// fmt.Println(resp)
// }
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/DescribeSourceRegions
func (c *RDS) DescribeSourceRegionsRequest(input *DescribeSourceRegionsInput) (req *request.Request, output *DescribeSourceRegionsOutput) {
op := &request.Operation{
Name: opDescribeSourceRegions,
HTTPMethod: "POST",
HTTPPath: "/",
}
if input == nil {
input = &DescribeSourceRegionsInput{}
}
output = &DescribeSourceRegionsOutput{}
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
return
}
// DescribeSourceRegions API operation for Amazon Relational Database Service.
//
// Returns a list of the source AWS Regions where the current AWS Region can
// create a Read Replica or copy a DB snapshot from. This API action supports
// pagination.
//
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
// the error.
//
// See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Relational Database Service's
// API operation DescribeSourceRegions for usage and error information.
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/DescribeSourceRegions
func (c *RDS) DescribeSourceRegions(input *DescribeSourceRegionsInput) (*DescribeSourceRegionsOutput, error) {
req, out := c.DescribeSourceRegionsRequest(input)
return out, req.Send()
}
// DescribeSourceRegionsWithContext is the same as DescribeSourceRegions with the addition of
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
//
// See DescribeSourceRegions for details on how to use this API operation.
//
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
// for more information on using Contexts.
func (c *RDS) DescribeSourceRegionsWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DescribeSourceRegionsInput, opts ...request.Option) (*DescribeSourceRegionsOutput, error) {
req, out := c.DescribeSourceRegionsRequest(input)
req.SetContext(ctx)
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
return out, req.Send()
}
const opDescribeValidDBInstanceModifications = "DescribeValidDBInstanceModifications"
// DescribeValidDBInstanceModificationsRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
// client's request for the DescribeValidDBInstanceModifications operation. The "output" return
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
// successfully.
//
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
//
// See DescribeValidDBInstanceModifications for more information on using the DescribeValidDBInstanceModifications
// API call, and error handling.
//
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
//
//
// // Example sending a request using the DescribeValidDBInstanceModificationsRequest method.
// req, resp := client.DescribeValidDBInstanceModificationsRequest(params)
//
// err := req.Send()
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
// fmt.Println(resp)
// }
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/DescribeValidDBInstanceModifications
func (c *RDS) DescribeValidDBInstanceModificationsRequest(input *DescribeValidDBInstanceModificationsInput) (req *request.Request, output *DescribeValidDBInstanceModificationsOutput) {
op := &request.Operation{
Name: opDescribeValidDBInstanceModifications,
HTTPMethod: "POST",
HTTPPath: "/",
}
if input == nil {
input = &DescribeValidDBInstanceModificationsInput{}
}
output = &DescribeValidDBInstanceModificationsOutput{}
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
return
}
// DescribeValidDBInstanceModifications API operation for Amazon Relational Database Service.
//
// You can call DescribeValidDBInstanceModifications to learn what modifications
// you can make to your DB instance. You can use this information when you call
// ModifyDBInstance.
//
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
// the error.
//
// See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Relational Database Service's
// API operation DescribeValidDBInstanceModifications for usage and error information.
//
// Returned Error Codes:
// * ErrCodeDBInstanceNotFoundFault "DBInstanceNotFound"
// DBInstanceIdentifier doesn't refer to an existing DB instance.
//
// * ErrCodeInvalidDBInstanceStateFault "InvalidDBInstanceState"
// The DB instance isn't in a valid state.
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/DescribeValidDBInstanceModifications
func (c *RDS) DescribeValidDBInstanceModifications(input *DescribeValidDBInstanceModificationsInput) (*DescribeValidDBInstanceModificationsOutput, error) {
req, out := c.DescribeValidDBInstanceModificationsRequest(input)
return out, req.Send()
}
// DescribeValidDBInstanceModificationsWithContext is the same as DescribeValidDBInstanceModifications with the addition of
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
//
// See DescribeValidDBInstanceModifications for details on how to use this API operation.
//
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
// for more information on using Contexts.
func (c *RDS) DescribeValidDBInstanceModificationsWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DescribeValidDBInstanceModificationsInput, opts ...request.Option) (*DescribeValidDBInstanceModificationsOutput, error) {
req, out := c.DescribeValidDBInstanceModificationsRequest(input)
req.SetContext(ctx)
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
return out, req.Send()
}
const opDownloadDBLogFilePortion = "DownloadDBLogFilePortion"
// DownloadDBLogFilePortionRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
// client's request for the DownloadDBLogFilePortion operation. The "output" return
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
// successfully.
//
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
//
// See DownloadDBLogFilePortion for more information on using the DownloadDBLogFilePortion
// API call, and error handling.
//
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
//
//
// // Example sending a request using the DownloadDBLogFilePortionRequest method.
// req, resp := client.DownloadDBLogFilePortionRequest(params)
//
// err := req.Send()
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
// fmt.Println(resp)
// }
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/DownloadDBLogFilePortion
func (c *RDS) DownloadDBLogFilePortionRequest(input *DownloadDBLogFilePortionInput) (req *request.Request, output *DownloadDBLogFilePortionOutput) {
op := &request.Operation{
Name: opDownloadDBLogFilePortion,
HTTPMethod: "POST",
HTTPPath: "/",
Paginator: &request.Paginator{
InputTokens: []string{"Marker"},
OutputTokens: []string{"Marker"},
LimitToken: "NumberOfLines",
TruncationToken: "AdditionalDataPending",
},
}
if input == nil {
input = &DownloadDBLogFilePortionInput{}
}
output = &DownloadDBLogFilePortionOutput{}
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
return
}
// DownloadDBLogFilePortion API operation for Amazon Relational Database Service.
//
// Downloads all or a portion of the specified log file, up to 1 MB in size.
//
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
// the error.
//
// See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Relational Database Service's
// API operation DownloadDBLogFilePortion for usage and error information.
//
// Returned Error Codes:
// * ErrCodeDBInstanceNotFoundFault "DBInstanceNotFound"
// DBInstanceIdentifier doesn't refer to an existing DB instance.
//
// * ErrCodeDBLogFileNotFoundFault "DBLogFileNotFoundFault"
// LogFileName doesn't refer to an existing DB log file.
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/DownloadDBLogFilePortion
func (c *RDS) DownloadDBLogFilePortion(input *DownloadDBLogFilePortionInput) (*DownloadDBLogFilePortionOutput, error) {
req, out := c.DownloadDBLogFilePortionRequest(input)
return out, req.Send()
}
// DownloadDBLogFilePortionWithContext is the same as DownloadDBLogFilePortion with the addition of
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
//
// See DownloadDBLogFilePortion for details on how to use this API operation.
//
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
// for more information on using Contexts.
func (c *RDS) DownloadDBLogFilePortionWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DownloadDBLogFilePortionInput, opts ...request.Option) (*DownloadDBLogFilePortionOutput, error) {
req, out := c.DownloadDBLogFilePortionRequest(input)
req.SetContext(ctx)
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
return out, req.Send()
}
// DownloadDBLogFilePortionPages iterates over the pages of a DownloadDBLogFilePortion operation,
// calling the "fn" function with the response data for each page. To stop
// iterating, return false from the fn function.
//
// See DownloadDBLogFilePortion method for more information on how to use this operation.
//
// Note: This operation can generate multiple requests to a service.
//
// // Example iterating over at most 3 pages of a DownloadDBLogFilePortion operation.
// pageNum := 0
// err := client.DownloadDBLogFilePortionPages(params,
// func(page *DownloadDBLogFilePortionOutput, lastPage bool) bool {
// pageNum++
// fmt.Println(page)
// return pageNum <= 3
// })
//
func (c *RDS) DownloadDBLogFilePortionPages(input *DownloadDBLogFilePortionInput, fn func(*DownloadDBLogFilePortionOutput, bool) bool) error {
return c.DownloadDBLogFilePortionPagesWithContext(aws.BackgroundContext(), input, fn)
}
// DownloadDBLogFilePortionPagesWithContext same as DownloadDBLogFilePortionPages except
// it takes a Context and allows setting request options on the pages.
//
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
// for more information on using Contexts.
func (c *RDS) DownloadDBLogFilePortionPagesWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DownloadDBLogFilePortionInput, fn func(*DownloadDBLogFilePortionOutput, bool) bool, opts ...request.Option) error {
p := request.Pagination{
NewRequest: func() (*request.Request, error) {
var inCpy *DownloadDBLogFilePortionInput
if input != nil {
tmp := *input
inCpy = &tmp
}
req, _ := c.DownloadDBLogFilePortionRequest(inCpy)
req.SetContext(ctx)
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
return req, nil
},
}
cont := true
for p.Next() && cont {
cont = fn(p.Page().(*DownloadDBLogFilePortionOutput), !p.HasNextPage())
}
return p.Err()
}
const opFailoverDBCluster = "FailoverDBCluster"
// FailoverDBClusterRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
// client's request for the FailoverDBCluster operation. The "output" return
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
// successfully.
//
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
//
// See FailoverDBCluster for more information on using the FailoverDBCluster
// API call, and error handling.
//
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
//
//
// // Example sending a request using the FailoverDBClusterRequest method.
// req, resp := client.FailoverDBClusterRequest(params)
//
// err := req.Send()
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
// fmt.Println(resp)
// }
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/FailoverDBCluster
func (c *RDS) FailoverDBClusterRequest(input *FailoverDBClusterInput) (req *request.Request, output *FailoverDBClusterOutput) {
op := &request.Operation{
Name: opFailoverDBCluster,
HTTPMethod: "POST",
HTTPPath: "/",
}
if input == nil {
input = &FailoverDBClusterInput{}
}
output = &FailoverDBClusterOutput{}
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
return
}
// FailoverDBCluster API operation for Amazon Relational Database Service.
//
// Forces a failover for a DB cluster.
//
// A failover for a DB cluster promotes one of the Aurora Replicas (read-only
// instances) in the DB cluster to be the primary instance (the cluster writer).
//
// Amazon Aurora will automatically fail over to an Aurora Replica, if one exists,
// when the primary instance fails. You can force a failover when you want to
// simulate a failure of a primary instance for testing. Because each instance
// in a DB cluster has its own endpoint address, you will need to clean up and
// re-establish any existing connections that use those endpoint addresses when
// the failover is complete.
//
// For more information on Amazon Aurora, see What Is Amazon Aurora? (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/AuroraUserGuide/CHAP_AuroraOverview.html)
// in the Amazon Aurora User Guide.
//
// This action only applies to Aurora DB clusters.
//
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
// the error.
//
// See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Relational Database Service's
// API operation FailoverDBCluster for usage and error information.
//
// Returned Error Codes:
// * ErrCodeDBClusterNotFoundFault "DBClusterNotFoundFault"
// DBClusterIdentifier doesn't refer to an existing DB cluster.
//
// * ErrCodeInvalidDBClusterStateFault "InvalidDBClusterStateFault"
// The requested operation can't be performed while the cluster is in this state.
//
// * ErrCodeInvalidDBInstanceStateFault "InvalidDBInstanceState"
// The DB instance isn't in a valid state.
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/FailoverDBCluster
func (c *RDS) FailoverDBCluster(input *FailoverDBClusterInput) (*FailoverDBClusterOutput, error) {
req, out := c.FailoverDBClusterRequest(input)
return out, req.Send()
}
// FailoverDBClusterWithContext is the same as FailoverDBCluster with the addition of
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
//
// See FailoverDBCluster for details on how to use this API operation.
//
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
// for more information on using Contexts.
func (c *RDS) FailoverDBClusterWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *FailoverDBClusterInput, opts ...request.Option) (*FailoverDBClusterOutput, error) {
req, out := c.FailoverDBClusterRequest(input)
req.SetContext(ctx)
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
return out, req.Send()
}
const opListTagsForResource = "ListTagsForResource"
// ListTagsForResourceRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
// client's request for the ListTagsForResource operation. The "output" return
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
// successfully.
//
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
//
// See ListTagsForResource for more information on using the ListTagsForResource
// API call, and error handling.
//
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
//
//
// // Example sending a request using the ListTagsForResourceRequest method.
// req, resp := client.ListTagsForResourceRequest(params)
//
// err := req.Send()
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
// fmt.Println(resp)
// }
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/ListTagsForResource
func (c *RDS) ListTagsForResourceRequest(input *ListTagsForResourceInput) (req *request.Request, output *ListTagsForResourceOutput) {
op := &request.Operation{
Name: opListTagsForResource,
HTTPMethod: "POST",
HTTPPath: "/",
}
if input == nil {
input = &ListTagsForResourceInput{}
}
output = &ListTagsForResourceOutput{}
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
return
}
// ListTagsForResource API operation for Amazon Relational Database Service.
//
// Lists all tags on an Amazon RDS resource.
//
// For an overview on tagging an Amazon RDS resource, see Tagging Amazon RDS
// Resources (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/UserGuide/Overview.Tagging.html)
// in the Amazon RDS User Guide.
//
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
// the error.
//
// See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Relational Database Service's
// API operation ListTagsForResource for usage and error information.
//
// Returned Error Codes:
// * ErrCodeDBInstanceNotFoundFault "DBInstanceNotFound"
// DBInstanceIdentifier doesn't refer to an existing DB instance.
//
// * ErrCodeDBSnapshotNotFoundFault "DBSnapshotNotFound"
// DBSnapshotIdentifier doesn't refer to an existing DB snapshot.
//
// * ErrCodeDBClusterNotFoundFault "DBClusterNotFoundFault"
// DBClusterIdentifier doesn't refer to an existing DB cluster.
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/ListTagsForResource
func (c *RDS) ListTagsForResource(input *ListTagsForResourceInput) (*ListTagsForResourceOutput, error) {
req, out := c.ListTagsForResourceRequest(input)
return out, req.Send()
}
// ListTagsForResourceWithContext is the same as ListTagsForResource with the addition of
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
//
// See ListTagsForResource for details on how to use this API operation.
//
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
// for more information on using Contexts.
func (c *RDS) ListTagsForResourceWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *ListTagsForResourceInput, opts ...request.Option) (*ListTagsForResourceOutput, error) {
req, out := c.ListTagsForResourceRequest(input)
req.SetContext(ctx)
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
return out, req.Send()
}
const opModifyCurrentDBClusterCapacity = "ModifyCurrentDBClusterCapacity"
// ModifyCurrentDBClusterCapacityRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
// client's request for the ModifyCurrentDBClusterCapacity operation. The "output" return
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
// successfully.
//
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
//
// See ModifyCurrentDBClusterCapacity for more information on using the ModifyCurrentDBClusterCapacity
// API call, and error handling.
//
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
//
//
// // Example sending a request using the ModifyCurrentDBClusterCapacityRequest method.
// req, resp := client.ModifyCurrentDBClusterCapacityRequest(params)
//
// err := req.Send()
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
// fmt.Println(resp)
// }
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/ModifyCurrentDBClusterCapacity
func (c *RDS) ModifyCurrentDBClusterCapacityRequest(input *ModifyCurrentDBClusterCapacityInput) (req *request.Request, output *ModifyCurrentDBClusterCapacityOutput) {
op := &request.Operation{
Name: opModifyCurrentDBClusterCapacity,
HTTPMethod: "POST",
HTTPPath: "/",
}
if input == nil {
input = &ModifyCurrentDBClusterCapacityInput{}
}
output = &ModifyCurrentDBClusterCapacityOutput{}
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
return
}
// ModifyCurrentDBClusterCapacity API operation for Amazon Relational Database Service.
//
// Set the capacity of an Aurora Serverless DB cluster to a specific value.
//
// Aurora Serverless scales seamlessly based on the workload on the DB cluster.
// In some cases, the capacity might not scale fast enough to meet a sudden
// change in workload, such as a large number of new transactions. Call ModifyCurrentDBClusterCapacity
// to set the capacity explicitly.
//
// After this call sets the DB cluster capacity, Aurora Serverless can automatically
// scale the DB cluster based on the cooldown period for scaling up and the
// cooldown period for scaling down.
//
// For more information about Aurora Serverless, see Using Amazon Aurora Serverless
// (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/AuroraUserGuide/aurora-serverless.html)
// in the Amazon Aurora User Guide.
//
// If you call ModifyCurrentDBClusterCapacity with the default TimeoutAction,
// connections that prevent Aurora Serverless from finding a scaling point might
// be dropped. For more information about scaling points, see Autoscaling for
// Aurora Serverless (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/AuroraUserGuide/aurora-serverless.how-it-works.html#aurora-serverless.how-it-works.auto-scaling)
// in the Amazon Aurora User Guide.
//
// This action only applies to Aurora DB clusters.
//
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
// the error.
//
// See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Relational Database Service's
// API operation ModifyCurrentDBClusterCapacity for usage and error information.
//
// Returned Error Codes:
// * ErrCodeDBClusterNotFoundFault "DBClusterNotFoundFault"
// DBClusterIdentifier doesn't refer to an existing DB cluster.
//
// * ErrCodeInvalidDBClusterStateFault "InvalidDBClusterStateFault"
// The requested operation can't be performed while the cluster is in this state.
//
// * ErrCodeInvalidDBClusterCapacityFault "InvalidDBClusterCapacityFault"
// Capacity isn't a valid Aurora Serverless DB cluster capacity. Valid capacity
// values are 2, 4, 8, 16, 32, 64, 128, and 256.
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/ModifyCurrentDBClusterCapacity
func (c *RDS) ModifyCurrentDBClusterCapacity(input *ModifyCurrentDBClusterCapacityInput) (*ModifyCurrentDBClusterCapacityOutput, error) {
req, out := c.ModifyCurrentDBClusterCapacityRequest(input)
return out, req.Send()
}
// ModifyCurrentDBClusterCapacityWithContext is the same as ModifyCurrentDBClusterCapacity with the addition of
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
//
// See ModifyCurrentDBClusterCapacity for details on how to use this API operation.
//
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
// for more information on using Contexts.
func (c *RDS) ModifyCurrentDBClusterCapacityWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *ModifyCurrentDBClusterCapacityInput, opts ...request.Option) (*ModifyCurrentDBClusterCapacityOutput, error) {
req, out := c.ModifyCurrentDBClusterCapacityRequest(input)
req.SetContext(ctx)
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
return out, req.Send()
}
const opModifyDBCluster = "ModifyDBCluster"
// ModifyDBClusterRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
// client's request for the ModifyDBCluster operation. The "output" return
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
// successfully.
//
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
//
// See ModifyDBCluster for more information on using the ModifyDBCluster
// API call, and error handling.
//
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
//
//
// // Example sending a request using the ModifyDBClusterRequest method.
// req, resp := client.ModifyDBClusterRequest(params)
//
// err := req.Send()
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
// fmt.Println(resp)
// }
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/ModifyDBCluster
func (c *RDS) ModifyDBClusterRequest(input *ModifyDBClusterInput) (req *request.Request, output *ModifyDBClusterOutput) {
op := &request.Operation{
Name: opModifyDBCluster,
HTTPMethod: "POST",
HTTPPath: "/",
}
if input == nil {
input = &ModifyDBClusterInput{}
}
output = &ModifyDBClusterOutput{}
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
return
}
// ModifyDBCluster API operation for Amazon Relational Database Service.
//
// Modify a setting for an Amazon Aurora DB cluster. You can change one or more
// database configuration parameters by specifying these parameters and the
// new values in the request. For more information on Amazon Aurora, see What
// Is Amazon Aurora? (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/AuroraUserGuide/CHAP_AuroraOverview.html)
// in the Amazon Aurora User Guide.
//
// This action only applies to Aurora DB clusters.
//
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
// the error.
//
// See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Relational Database Service's
// API operation ModifyDBCluster for usage and error information.
//
// Returned Error Codes:
// * ErrCodeDBClusterNotFoundFault "DBClusterNotFoundFault"
// DBClusterIdentifier doesn't refer to an existing DB cluster.
//
// * ErrCodeInvalidDBClusterStateFault "InvalidDBClusterStateFault"
// The requested operation can't be performed while the cluster is in this state.
//
// * ErrCodeStorageQuotaExceededFault "StorageQuotaExceeded"
// The request would result in the user exceeding the allowed amount of storage
// available across all DB instances.
//
// * ErrCodeDBSubnetGroupNotFoundFault "DBSubnetGroupNotFoundFault"
// DBSubnetGroupName doesn't refer to an existing DB subnet group.
//
// * ErrCodeInvalidVPCNetworkStateFault "InvalidVPCNetworkStateFault"
// The DB subnet group doesn't cover all Availability Zones after it's created
// because of users' change.
//
// * ErrCodeInvalidDBSubnetGroupStateFault "InvalidDBSubnetGroupStateFault"
// The DB subnet group cannot be deleted because it's in use.
//
// * ErrCodeInvalidSubnet "InvalidSubnet"
// The requested subnet is invalid, or multiple subnets were requested that
// are not all in a common VPC.
//
// * ErrCodeDBClusterParameterGroupNotFoundFault "DBClusterParameterGroupNotFound"
// DBClusterParameterGroupName doesn't refer to an existing DB cluster parameter
// group.
//
// * ErrCodeInvalidDBSecurityGroupStateFault "InvalidDBSecurityGroupState"
// The state of the DB security group doesn't allow deletion.
//
// * ErrCodeInvalidDBInstanceStateFault "InvalidDBInstanceState"
// The DB instance isn't in a valid state.
//
// * ErrCodeDBClusterAlreadyExistsFault "DBClusterAlreadyExistsFault"
// The user already has a DB cluster with the given identifier.
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/ModifyDBCluster
func (c *RDS) ModifyDBCluster(input *ModifyDBClusterInput) (*ModifyDBClusterOutput, error) {
req, out := c.ModifyDBClusterRequest(input)
return out, req.Send()
}
// ModifyDBClusterWithContext is the same as ModifyDBCluster with the addition of
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
//
// See ModifyDBCluster for details on how to use this API operation.
//
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
// for more information on using Contexts.
func (c *RDS) ModifyDBClusterWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *ModifyDBClusterInput, opts ...request.Option) (*ModifyDBClusterOutput, error) {
req, out := c.ModifyDBClusterRequest(input)
req.SetContext(ctx)
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
return out, req.Send()
}
const opModifyDBClusterEndpoint = "ModifyDBClusterEndpoint"
// ModifyDBClusterEndpointRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
// client's request for the ModifyDBClusterEndpoint operation. The "output" return
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
// successfully.
//
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
//
// See ModifyDBClusterEndpoint for more information on using the ModifyDBClusterEndpoint
// API call, and error handling.
//
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
//
//
// // Example sending a request using the ModifyDBClusterEndpointRequest method.
// req, resp := client.ModifyDBClusterEndpointRequest(params)
//
// err := req.Send()
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
// fmt.Println(resp)
// }
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/ModifyDBClusterEndpoint
func (c *RDS) ModifyDBClusterEndpointRequest(input *ModifyDBClusterEndpointInput) (req *request.Request, output *ModifyDBClusterEndpointOutput) {
op := &request.Operation{
Name: opModifyDBClusterEndpoint,
HTTPMethod: "POST",
HTTPPath: "/",
}
if input == nil {
input = &ModifyDBClusterEndpointInput{}
}
output = &ModifyDBClusterEndpointOutput{}
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
return
}
// ModifyDBClusterEndpoint API operation for Amazon Relational Database Service.
//
// Modifies the properties of an endpoint in an Amazon Aurora DB cluster.
//
// This action only applies to Aurora DB clusters.
//
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
// the error.
//
// See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Relational Database Service's
// API operation ModifyDBClusterEndpoint for usage and error information.
//
// Returned Error Codes:
// * ErrCodeInvalidDBClusterStateFault "InvalidDBClusterStateFault"
// The requested operation can't be performed while the cluster is in this state.
//
// * ErrCodeInvalidDBClusterEndpointStateFault "InvalidDBClusterEndpointStateFault"
// The requested operation can't be performed on the endpoint while the endpoint
// is in this state.
//
// * ErrCodeDBClusterEndpointNotFoundFault "DBClusterEndpointNotFoundFault"
// The specified custom endpoint doesn't exist.
//
// * ErrCodeDBInstanceNotFoundFault "DBInstanceNotFound"
// DBInstanceIdentifier doesn't refer to an existing DB instance.
//
// * ErrCodeInvalidDBInstanceStateFault "InvalidDBInstanceState"
// The DB instance isn't in a valid state.
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/ModifyDBClusterEndpoint
func (c *RDS) ModifyDBClusterEndpoint(input *ModifyDBClusterEndpointInput) (*ModifyDBClusterEndpointOutput, error) {
req, out := c.ModifyDBClusterEndpointRequest(input)
return out, req.Send()
}
// ModifyDBClusterEndpointWithContext is the same as ModifyDBClusterEndpoint with the addition of
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
//
// See ModifyDBClusterEndpoint for details on how to use this API operation.
//
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
// for more information on using Contexts.
func (c *RDS) ModifyDBClusterEndpointWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *ModifyDBClusterEndpointInput, opts ...request.Option) (*ModifyDBClusterEndpointOutput, error) {
req, out := c.ModifyDBClusterEndpointRequest(input)
req.SetContext(ctx)
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
return out, req.Send()
}
const opModifyDBClusterParameterGroup = "ModifyDBClusterParameterGroup"
// ModifyDBClusterParameterGroupRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
// client's request for the ModifyDBClusterParameterGroup operation. The "output" return
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
// successfully.
//
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
//
// See ModifyDBClusterParameterGroup for more information on using the ModifyDBClusterParameterGroup
// API call, and error handling.
//
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
//
//
// // Example sending a request using the ModifyDBClusterParameterGroupRequest method.
// req, resp := client.ModifyDBClusterParameterGroupRequest(params)
//
// err := req.Send()
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
// fmt.Println(resp)
// }
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/ModifyDBClusterParameterGroup
func (c *RDS) ModifyDBClusterParameterGroupRequest(input *ModifyDBClusterParameterGroupInput) (req *request.Request, output *DBClusterParameterGroupNameMessage) {
op := &request.Operation{
Name: opModifyDBClusterParameterGroup,
HTTPMethod: "POST",
HTTPPath: "/",
}
if input == nil {
input = &ModifyDBClusterParameterGroupInput{}
}
output = &DBClusterParameterGroupNameMessage{}
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
return
}
// ModifyDBClusterParameterGroup API operation for Amazon Relational Database Service.
//
// Modifies the parameters of a DB cluster parameter group. To modify more than
// one parameter, submit a list of the following: ParameterName, ParameterValue,
// and ApplyMethod. A maximum of 20 parameters can be modified in a single request.
//
// For more information on Amazon Aurora, see What Is Amazon Aurora? (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/AuroraUserGuide/CHAP_AuroraOverview.html)
// in the Amazon Aurora User Guide.
//
// Changes to dynamic parameters are applied immediately. Changes to static
// parameters require a reboot without failover to the DB cluster associated
// with the parameter group before the change can take effect.
//
// After you create a DB cluster parameter group, you should wait at least 5
// minutes before creating your first DB cluster that uses that DB cluster parameter
// group as the default parameter group. This allows Amazon RDS to fully complete
// the create action before the parameter group is used as the default for a
// new DB cluster. This is especially important for parameters that are critical
// when creating the default database for a DB cluster, such as the character
// set for the default database defined by the character_set_database parameter.
// You can use the Parameter Groups option of the Amazon RDS console (https://console.aws.amazon.com/rds/)
// or the DescribeDBClusterParameters command to verify that your DB cluster
// parameter group has been created or modified.
//
// This action only applies to Aurora DB clusters.
//
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
// the error.
//
// See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Relational Database Service's
// API operation ModifyDBClusterParameterGroup for usage and error information.
//
// Returned Error Codes:
// * ErrCodeDBParameterGroupNotFoundFault "DBParameterGroupNotFound"
// DBParameterGroupName doesn't refer to an existing DB parameter group.
//
// * ErrCodeInvalidDBParameterGroupStateFault "InvalidDBParameterGroupState"
// The DB parameter group is in use or is in an invalid state. If you are attempting
// to delete the parameter group, you can't delete it when the parameter group
// is in this state.
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/ModifyDBClusterParameterGroup
func (c *RDS) ModifyDBClusterParameterGroup(input *ModifyDBClusterParameterGroupInput) (*DBClusterParameterGroupNameMessage, error) {
req, out := c.ModifyDBClusterParameterGroupRequest(input)
return out, req.Send()
}
// ModifyDBClusterParameterGroupWithContext is the same as ModifyDBClusterParameterGroup with the addition of
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
//
// See ModifyDBClusterParameterGroup for details on how to use this API operation.
//
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
// for more information on using Contexts.
func (c *RDS) ModifyDBClusterParameterGroupWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *ModifyDBClusterParameterGroupInput, opts ...request.Option) (*DBClusterParameterGroupNameMessage, error) {
req, out := c.ModifyDBClusterParameterGroupRequest(input)
req.SetContext(ctx)
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
return out, req.Send()
}
const opModifyDBClusterSnapshotAttribute = "ModifyDBClusterSnapshotAttribute"
// ModifyDBClusterSnapshotAttributeRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
// client's request for the ModifyDBClusterSnapshotAttribute operation. The "output" return
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
// successfully.
//
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
//
// See ModifyDBClusterSnapshotAttribute for more information on using the ModifyDBClusterSnapshotAttribute
// API call, and error handling.
//
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
//
//
// // Example sending a request using the ModifyDBClusterSnapshotAttributeRequest method.
// req, resp := client.ModifyDBClusterSnapshotAttributeRequest(params)
//
// err := req.Send()
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
// fmt.Println(resp)
// }
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/ModifyDBClusterSnapshotAttribute
func (c *RDS) ModifyDBClusterSnapshotAttributeRequest(input *ModifyDBClusterSnapshotAttributeInput) (req *request.Request, output *ModifyDBClusterSnapshotAttributeOutput) {
op := &request.Operation{
Name: opModifyDBClusterSnapshotAttribute,
HTTPMethod: "POST",
HTTPPath: "/",
}
if input == nil {
input = &ModifyDBClusterSnapshotAttributeInput{}
}
output = &ModifyDBClusterSnapshotAttributeOutput{}
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
return
}
// ModifyDBClusterSnapshotAttribute API operation for Amazon Relational Database Service.
//
// Adds an attribute and values to, or removes an attribute and values from,
// a manual DB cluster snapshot.
//
// To share a manual DB cluster snapshot with other AWS accounts, specify restore
// as the AttributeName and use the ValuesToAdd parameter to add a list of IDs
// of the AWS accounts that are authorized to restore the manual DB cluster
// snapshot. Use the value all to make the manual DB cluster snapshot public,
// which means that it can be copied or restored by all AWS accounts. Do not
// add the all value for any manual DB cluster snapshots that contain private
// information that you don't want available to all AWS accounts. If a manual
// DB cluster snapshot is encrypted, it can be shared, but only by specifying
// a list of authorized AWS account IDs for the ValuesToAdd parameter. You can't
// use all as a value for that parameter in this case.
//
// To view which AWS accounts have access to copy or restore a manual DB cluster
// snapshot, or whether a manual DB cluster snapshot public or private, use
// the DescribeDBClusterSnapshotAttributes API action.
//
// This action only applies to Aurora DB clusters.
//
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
// the error.
//
// See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Relational Database Service's
// API operation ModifyDBClusterSnapshotAttribute for usage and error information.
//
// Returned Error Codes:
// * ErrCodeDBClusterSnapshotNotFoundFault "DBClusterSnapshotNotFoundFault"
// DBClusterSnapshotIdentifier doesn't refer to an existing DB cluster snapshot.
//
// * ErrCodeInvalidDBClusterSnapshotStateFault "InvalidDBClusterSnapshotStateFault"
// The supplied value isn't a valid DB cluster snapshot state.
//
// * ErrCodeSharedSnapshotQuotaExceededFault "SharedSnapshotQuotaExceeded"
// You have exceeded the maximum number of accounts that you can share a manual
// DB snapshot with.
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/ModifyDBClusterSnapshotAttribute
func (c *RDS) ModifyDBClusterSnapshotAttribute(input *ModifyDBClusterSnapshotAttributeInput) (*ModifyDBClusterSnapshotAttributeOutput, error) {
req, out := c.ModifyDBClusterSnapshotAttributeRequest(input)
return out, req.Send()
}
// ModifyDBClusterSnapshotAttributeWithContext is the same as ModifyDBClusterSnapshotAttribute with the addition of
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
//
// See ModifyDBClusterSnapshotAttribute for details on how to use this API operation.
//
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
// for more information on using Contexts.
func (c *RDS) ModifyDBClusterSnapshotAttributeWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *ModifyDBClusterSnapshotAttributeInput, opts ...request.Option) (*ModifyDBClusterSnapshotAttributeOutput, error) {
req, out := c.ModifyDBClusterSnapshotAttributeRequest(input)
req.SetContext(ctx)
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
return out, req.Send()
}
const opModifyDBInstance = "ModifyDBInstance"
// ModifyDBInstanceRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
// client's request for the ModifyDBInstance operation. The "output" return
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
// successfully.
//
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
//
// See ModifyDBInstance for more information on using the ModifyDBInstance
// API call, and error handling.
//
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
//
//
// // Example sending a request using the ModifyDBInstanceRequest method.
// req, resp := client.ModifyDBInstanceRequest(params)
//
// err := req.Send()
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
// fmt.Println(resp)
// }
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/ModifyDBInstance
func (c *RDS) ModifyDBInstanceRequest(input *ModifyDBInstanceInput) (req *request.Request, output *ModifyDBInstanceOutput) {
op := &request.Operation{
Name: opModifyDBInstance,
HTTPMethod: "POST",
HTTPPath: "/",
}
if input == nil {
input = &ModifyDBInstanceInput{}
}
output = &ModifyDBInstanceOutput{}
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
return
}
// ModifyDBInstance API operation for Amazon Relational Database Service.
//
// Modifies settings for a DB instance. You can change one or more database
// configuration parameters by specifying these parameters and the new values
// in the request. To learn what modifications you can make to your DB instance,
// call DescribeValidDBInstanceModifications before you call ModifyDBInstance.
//
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
// the error.
//
// See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Relational Database Service's
// API operation ModifyDBInstance for usage and error information.
//
// Returned Error Codes:
// * ErrCodeInvalidDBInstanceStateFault "InvalidDBInstanceState"
// The DB instance isn't in a valid state.
//
// * ErrCodeInvalidDBSecurityGroupStateFault "InvalidDBSecurityGroupState"
// The state of the DB security group doesn't allow deletion.
//
// * ErrCodeDBInstanceAlreadyExistsFault "DBInstanceAlreadyExists"
// The user already has a DB instance with the given identifier.
//
// * ErrCodeDBInstanceNotFoundFault "DBInstanceNotFound"
// DBInstanceIdentifier doesn't refer to an existing DB instance.
//
// * ErrCodeDBSecurityGroupNotFoundFault "DBSecurityGroupNotFound"
// DBSecurityGroupName doesn't refer to an existing DB security group.
//
// * ErrCodeDBParameterGroupNotFoundFault "DBParameterGroupNotFound"
// DBParameterGroupName doesn't refer to an existing DB parameter group.
//
// * ErrCodeInsufficientDBInstanceCapacityFault "InsufficientDBInstanceCapacity"
// The specified DB instance class isn't available in the specified Availability
// Zone.
//
// * ErrCodeStorageQuotaExceededFault "StorageQuotaExceeded"
// The request would result in the user exceeding the allowed amount of storage
// available across all DB instances.
//
// * ErrCodeInvalidVPCNetworkStateFault "InvalidVPCNetworkStateFault"
// The DB subnet group doesn't cover all Availability Zones after it's created
// because of users' change.
//
// * ErrCodeProvisionedIopsNotAvailableInAZFault "ProvisionedIopsNotAvailableInAZFault"
// Provisioned IOPS not available in the specified Availability Zone.
//
// * ErrCodeOptionGroupNotFoundFault "OptionGroupNotFoundFault"
// The specified option group could not be found.
//
// * ErrCodeDBUpgradeDependencyFailureFault "DBUpgradeDependencyFailure"
// The DB upgrade failed because a resource the DB depends on can't be modified.
//
// * ErrCodeStorageTypeNotSupportedFault "StorageTypeNotSupported"
// Storage of the StorageType specified can't be associated with the DB instance.
//
// * ErrCodeAuthorizationNotFoundFault "AuthorizationNotFound"
// The specified CIDRIP or Amazon EC2 security group isn't authorized for the
// specified DB security group.
//
// RDS also may not be authorized by using IAM to perform necessary actions
// on your behalf.
//
// * ErrCodeCertificateNotFoundFault "CertificateNotFound"
// CertificateIdentifier doesn't refer to an existing certificate.
//
// * ErrCodeDomainNotFoundFault "DomainNotFoundFault"
// Domain doesn't refer to an existing Active Directory domain.
//
// * ErrCodeBackupPolicyNotFoundFault "BackupPolicyNotFoundFault"
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/ModifyDBInstance
func (c *RDS) ModifyDBInstance(input *ModifyDBInstanceInput) (*ModifyDBInstanceOutput, error) {
req, out := c.ModifyDBInstanceRequest(input)
return out, req.Send()
}
// ModifyDBInstanceWithContext is the same as ModifyDBInstance with the addition of
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
//
// See ModifyDBInstance for details on how to use this API operation.
//
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
// for more information on using Contexts.
func (c *RDS) ModifyDBInstanceWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *ModifyDBInstanceInput, opts ...request.Option) (*ModifyDBInstanceOutput, error) {
req, out := c.ModifyDBInstanceRequest(input)
req.SetContext(ctx)
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
return out, req.Send()
}
const opModifyDBParameterGroup = "ModifyDBParameterGroup"
// ModifyDBParameterGroupRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
// client's request for the ModifyDBParameterGroup operation. The "output" return
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
// successfully.
//
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
//
// See ModifyDBParameterGroup for more information on using the ModifyDBParameterGroup
// API call, and error handling.
//
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
//
//
// // Example sending a request using the ModifyDBParameterGroupRequest method.
// req, resp := client.ModifyDBParameterGroupRequest(params)
//
// err := req.Send()
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
// fmt.Println(resp)
// }
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/ModifyDBParameterGroup
func (c *RDS) ModifyDBParameterGroupRequest(input *ModifyDBParameterGroupInput) (req *request.Request, output *DBParameterGroupNameMessage) {
op := &request.Operation{
Name: opModifyDBParameterGroup,
HTTPMethod: "POST",
HTTPPath: "/",
}
if input == nil {
input = &ModifyDBParameterGroupInput{}
}
output = &DBParameterGroupNameMessage{}
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
return
}
// ModifyDBParameterGroup API operation for Amazon Relational Database Service.
//
// Modifies the parameters of a DB parameter group. To modify more than one
// parameter, submit a list of the following: ParameterName, ParameterValue,
// and ApplyMethod. A maximum of 20 parameters can be modified in a single request.
//
// Changes to dynamic parameters are applied immediately. Changes to static
// parameters require a reboot without failover to the DB instance associated
// with the parameter group before the change can take effect.
//
// After you modify a DB parameter group, you should wait at least 5 minutes
// before creating your first DB instance that uses that DB parameter group
// as the default parameter group. This allows Amazon RDS to fully complete
// the modify action before the parameter group is used as the default for a
// new DB instance. This is especially important for parameters that are critical
// when creating the default database for a DB instance, such as the character
// set for the default database defined by the character_set_database parameter.
// You can use the Parameter Groups option of the Amazon RDS console (https://console.aws.amazon.com/rds/)
// or the DescribeDBParameters command to verify that your DB parameter group
// has been created or modified.
//
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
// the error.
//
// See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Relational Database Service's
// API operation ModifyDBParameterGroup for usage and error information.
//
// Returned Error Codes:
// * ErrCodeDBParameterGroupNotFoundFault "DBParameterGroupNotFound"
// DBParameterGroupName doesn't refer to an existing DB parameter group.
//
// * ErrCodeInvalidDBParameterGroupStateFault "InvalidDBParameterGroupState"
// The DB parameter group is in use or is in an invalid state. If you are attempting
// to delete the parameter group, you can't delete it when the parameter group
// is in this state.
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/ModifyDBParameterGroup
func (c *RDS) ModifyDBParameterGroup(input *ModifyDBParameterGroupInput) (*DBParameterGroupNameMessage, error) {
req, out := c.ModifyDBParameterGroupRequest(input)
return out, req.Send()
}
// ModifyDBParameterGroupWithContext is the same as ModifyDBParameterGroup with the addition of
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
//
// See ModifyDBParameterGroup for details on how to use this API operation.
//
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
// for more information on using Contexts.
func (c *RDS) ModifyDBParameterGroupWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *ModifyDBParameterGroupInput, opts ...request.Option) (*DBParameterGroupNameMessage, error) {
req, out := c.ModifyDBParameterGroupRequest(input)
req.SetContext(ctx)
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
return out, req.Send()
}
const opModifyDBSnapshot = "ModifyDBSnapshot"
// ModifyDBSnapshotRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
// client's request for the ModifyDBSnapshot operation. The "output" return
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
// successfully.
//
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
//
// See ModifyDBSnapshot for more information on using the ModifyDBSnapshot
// API call, and error handling.
//
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
//
//
// // Example sending a request using the ModifyDBSnapshotRequest method.
// req, resp := client.ModifyDBSnapshotRequest(params)
//
// err := req.Send()
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
// fmt.Println(resp)
// }
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/ModifyDBSnapshot
func (c *RDS) ModifyDBSnapshotRequest(input *ModifyDBSnapshotInput) (req *request.Request, output *ModifyDBSnapshotOutput) {
op := &request.Operation{
Name: opModifyDBSnapshot,
HTTPMethod: "POST",
HTTPPath: "/",
}
if input == nil {
input = &ModifyDBSnapshotInput{}
}
output = &ModifyDBSnapshotOutput{}
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
return
}
// ModifyDBSnapshot API operation for Amazon Relational Database Service.
//
// Updates a manual DB snapshot, which can be encrypted or not encrypted, with
// a new engine version.
//
// Amazon RDS supports upgrading DB snapshots for MySQL and Oracle.
//
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
// the error.
//
// See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Relational Database Service's
// API operation ModifyDBSnapshot for usage and error information.
//
// Returned Error Codes:
// * ErrCodeDBSnapshotNotFoundFault "DBSnapshotNotFound"
// DBSnapshotIdentifier doesn't refer to an existing DB snapshot.
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/ModifyDBSnapshot
func (c *RDS) ModifyDBSnapshot(input *ModifyDBSnapshotInput) (*ModifyDBSnapshotOutput, error) {
req, out := c.ModifyDBSnapshotRequest(input)
return out, req.Send()
}
// ModifyDBSnapshotWithContext is the same as ModifyDBSnapshot with the addition of
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
//
// See ModifyDBSnapshot for details on how to use this API operation.
//
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
// for more information on using Contexts.
func (c *RDS) ModifyDBSnapshotWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *ModifyDBSnapshotInput, opts ...request.Option) (*ModifyDBSnapshotOutput, error) {
req, out := c.ModifyDBSnapshotRequest(input)
req.SetContext(ctx)
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
return out, req.Send()
}
const opModifyDBSnapshotAttribute = "ModifyDBSnapshotAttribute"
// ModifyDBSnapshotAttributeRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
// client's request for the ModifyDBSnapshotAttribute operation. The "output" return
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
// successfully.
//
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
//
// See ModifyDBSnapshotAttribute for more information on using the ModifyDBSnapshotAttribute
// API call, and error handling.
//
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
//
//
// // Example sending a request using the ModifyDBSnapshotAttributeRequest method.
// req, resp := client.ModifyDBSnapshotAttributeRequest(params)
//
// err := req.Send()
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
// fmt.Println(resp)
// }
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/ModifyDBSnapshotAttribute
func (c *RDS) ModifyDBSnapshotAttributeRequest(input *ModifyDBSnapshotAttributeInput) (req *request.Request, output *ModifyDBSnapshotAttributeOutput) {
op := &request.Operation{
Name: opModifyDBSnapshotAttribute,
HTTPMethod: "POST",
HTTPPath: "/",
}
if input == nil {
input = &ModifyDBSnapshotAttributeInput{}
}
output = &ModifyDBSnapshotAttributeOutput{}
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
return
}
// ModifyDBSnapshotAttribute API operation for Amazon Relational Database Service.
//
// Adds an attribute and values to, or removes an attribute and values from,
// a manual DB snapshot.
//
// To share a manual DB snapshot with other AWS accounts, specify restore as
// the AttributeName and use the ValuesToAdd parameter to add a list of IDs
// of the AWS accounts that are authorized to restore the manual DB snapshot.
// Uses the value all to make the manual DB snapshot public, which means it
// can be copied or restored by all AWS accounts. Do not add the all value for
// any manual DB snapshots that contain private information that you don't want
// available to all AWS accounts. If the manual DB snapshot is encrypted, it
// can be shared, but only by specifying a list of authorized AWS account IDs
// for the ValuesToAdd parameter. You can't use all as a value for that parameter
// in this case.
//
// To view which AWS accounts have access to copy or restore a manual DB snapshot,
// or whether a manual DB snapshot public or private, use the DescribeDBSnapshotAttributes
// API action.
//
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
// the error.
//
// See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Relational Database Service's
// API operation ModifyDBSnapshotAttribute for usage and error information.
//
// Returned Error Codes:
// * ErrCodeDBSnapshotNotFoundFault "DBSnapshotNotFound"
// DBSnapshotIdentifier doesn't refer to an existing DB snapshot.
//
// * ErrCodeInvalidDBSnapshotStateFault "InvalidDBSnapshotState"
// The state of the DB snapshot doesn't allow deletion.
//
// * ErrCodeSharedSnapshotQuotaExceededFault "SharedSnapshotQuotaExceeded"
// You have exceeded the maximum number of accounts that you can share a manual
// DB snapshot with.
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/ModifyDBSnapshotAttribute
func (c *RDS) ModifyDBSnapshotAttribute(input *ModifyDBSnapshotAttributeInput) (*ModifyDBSnapshotAttributeOutput, error) {
req, out := c.ModifyDBSnapshotAttributeRequest(input)
return out, req.Send()
}
// ModifyDBSnapshotAttributeWithContext is the same as ModifyDBSnapshotAttribute with the addition of
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
//
// See ModifyDBSnapshotAttribute for details on how to use this API operation.
//
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
// for more information on using Contexts.
func (c *RDS) ModifyDBSnapshotAttributeWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *ModifyDBSnapshotAttributeInput, opts ...request.Option) (*ModifyDBSnapshotAttributeOutput, error) {
req, out := c.ModifyDBSnapshotAttributeRequest(input)
req.SetContext(ctx)
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
return out, req.Send()
}
const opModifyDBSubnetGroup = "ModifyDBSubnetGroup"
// ModifyDBSubnetGroupRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
// client's request for the ModifyDBSubnetGroup operation. The "output" return
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
// successfully.
//
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
//
// See ModifyDBSubnetGroup for more information on using the ModifyDBSubnetGroup
// API call, and error handling.
//
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
//
//
// // Example sending a request using the ModifyDBSubnetGroupRequest method.
// req, resp := client.ModifyDBSubnetGroupRequest(params)
//
// err := req.Send()
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
// fmt.Println(resp)
// }
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/ModifyDBSubnetGroup
func (c *RDS) ModifyDBSubnetGroupRequest(input *ModifyDBSubnetGroupInput) (req *request.Request, output *ModifyDBSubnetGroupOutput) {
op := &request.Operation{
Name: opModifyDBSubnetGroup,
HTTPMethod: "POST",
HTTPPath: "/",
}
if input == nil {
input = &ModifyDBSubnetGroupInput{}
}
output = &ModifyDBSubnetGroupOutput{}
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
return
}
// ModifyDBSubnetGroup API operation for Amazon Relational Database Service.
//
// Modifies an existing DB subnet group. DB subnet groups must contain at least
// one subnet in at least two AZs in the AWS Region.
//
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
// the error.
//
// See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Relational Database Service's
// API operation ModifyDBSubnetGroup for usage and error information.
//
// Returned Error Codes:
// * ErrCodeDBSubnetGroupNotFoundFault "DBSubnetGroupNotFoundFault"
// DBSubnetGroupName doesn't refer to an existing DB subnet group.
//
// * ErrCodeDBSubnetQuotaExceededFault "DBSubnetQuotaExceededFault"
// The request would result in the user exceeding the allowed number of subnets
// in a DB subnet groups.
//
// * ErrCodeSubnetAlreadyInUse "SubnetAlreadyInUse"
// The DB subnet is already in use in the Availability Zone.
//
// * ErrCodeDBSubnetGroupDoesNotCoverEnoughAZs "DBSubnetGroupDoesNotCoverEnoughAZs"
// Subnets in the DB subnet group should cover at least two Availability Zones
// unless there is only one Availability Zone.
//
// * ErrCodeInvalidSubnet "InvalidSubnet"
// The requested subnet is invalid, or multiple subnets were requested that
// are not all in a common VPC.
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/ModifyDBSubnetGroup
func (c *RDS) ModifyDBSubnetGroup(input *ModifyDBSubnetGroupInput) (*ModifyDBSubnetGroupOutput, error) {
req, out := c.ModifyDBSubnetGroupRequest(input)
return out, req.Send()
}
// ModifyDBSubnetGroupWithContext is the same as ModifyDBSubnetGroup with the addition of
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
//
// See ModifyDBSubnetGroup for details on how to use this API operation.
//
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
// for more information on using Contexts.
func (c *RDS) ModifyDBSubnetGroupWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *ModifyDBSubnetGroupInput, opts ...request.Option) (*ModifyDBSubnetGroupOutput, error) {
req, out := c.ModifyDBSubnetGroupRequest(input)
req.SetContext(ctx)
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
return out, req.Send()
}
const opModifyEventSubscription = "ModifyEventSubscription"
// ModifyEventSubscriptionRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
// client's request for the ModifyEventSubscription operation. The "output" return
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
// successfully.
//
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
//
// See ModifyEventSubscription for more information on using the ModifyEventSubscription
// API call, and error handling.
//
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
//
//
// // Example sending a request using the ModifyEventSubscriptionRequest method.
// req, resp := client.ModifyEventSubscriptionRequest(params)
//
// err := req.Send()
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
// fmt.Println(resp)
// }
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/ModifyEventSubscription
func (c *RDS) ModifyEventSubscriptionRequest(input *ModifyEventSubscriptionInput) (req *request.Request, output *ModifyEventSubscriptionOutput) {
op := &request.Operation{
Name: opModifyEventSubscription,
HTTPMethod: "POST",
HTTPPath: "/",
}
if input == nil {
input = &ModifyEventSubscriptionInput{}
}
output = &ModifyEventSubscriptionOutput{}
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
return
}
// ModifyEventSubscription API operation for Amazon Relational Database Service.
//
// Modifies an existing RDS event notification subscription. Note that you can't
// modify the source identifiers using this call; to change source identifiers
// for a subscription, use the AddSourceIdentifierToSubscription and RemoveSourceIdentifierFromSubscription
// calls.
//
// You can see a list of the event categories for a given SourceType in the
// Events (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/UserGuide/USER_Events.html)
// topic in the Amazon RDS User Guide or by using the DescribeEventCategories
// action.
//
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
// the error.
//
// See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Relational Database Service's
// API operation ModifyEventSubscription for usage and error information.
//
// Returned Error Codes:
// * ErrCodeEventSubscriptionQuotaExceededFault "EventSubscriptionQuotaExceeded"
// You have reached the maximum number of event subscriptions.
//
// * ErrCodeSubscriptionNotFoundFault "SubscriptionNotFound"
// The subscription name does not exist.
//
// * ErrCodeSNSInvalidTopicFault "SNSInvalidTopic"
// SNS has responded that there is a problem with the SND topic specified.
//
// * ErrCodeSNSNoAuthorizationFault "SNSNoAuthorization"
// You do not have permission to publish to the SNS topic ARN.
//
// * ErrCodeSNSTopicArnNotFoundFault "SNSTopicArnNotFound"
// The SNS topic ARN does not exist.
//
// * ErrCodeSubscriptionCategoryNotFoundFault "SubscriptionCategoryNotFound"
// The supplied category does not exist.
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/ModifyEventSubscription
func (c *RDS) ModifyEventSubscription(input *ModifyEventSubscriptionInput) (*ModifyEventSubscriptionOutput, error) {
req, out := c.ModifyEventSubscriptionRequest(input)
return out, req.Send()
}
// ModifyEventSubscriptionWithContext is the same as ModifyEventSubscription with the addition of
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
//
// See ModifyEventSubscription for details on how to use this API operation.
//
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
// for more information on using Contexts.
func (c *RDS) ModifyEventSubscriptionWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *ModifyEventSubscriptionInput, opts ...request.Option) (*ModifyEventSubscriptionOutput, error) {
req, out := c.ModifyEventSubscriptionRequest(input)
req.SetContext(ctx)
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
return out, req.Send()
}
const opModifyGlobalCluster = "ModifyGlobalCluster"
// ModifyGlobalClusterRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
// client's request for the ModifyGlobalCluster operation. The "output" return
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
// successfully.
//
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
//
// See ModifyGlobalCluster for more information on using the ModifyGlobalCluster
// API call, and error handling.
//
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
//
//
// // Example sending a request using the ModifyGlobalClusterRequest method.
// req, resp := client.ModifyGlobalClusterRequest(params)
//
// err := req.Send()
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
// fmt.Println(resp)
// }
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/ModifyGlobalCluster
func (c *RDS) ModifyGlobalClusterRequest(input *ModifyGlobalClusterInput) (req *request.Request, output *ModifyGlobalClusterOutput) {
op := &request.Operation{
Name: opModifyGlobalCluster,
HTTPMethod: "POST",
HTTPPath: "/",
}
if input == nil {
input = &ModifyGlobalClusterInput{}
}
output = &ModifyGlobalClusterOutput{}
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
return
}
// ModifyGlobalCluster API operation for Amazon Relational Database Service.
//
// Modify a setting for an Amazon Aurora global cluster. You can change one
// or more database configuration parameters by specifying these parameters
// and the new values in the request. For more information on Amazon Aurora,
// see What Is Amazon Aurora? (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/AuroraUserGuide/CHAP_AuroraOverview.html)
// in the Amazon Aurora User Guide.
//
// This action only applies to Aurora DB clusters.
//
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
// the error.
//
// See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Relational Database Service's
// API operation ModifyGlobalCluster for usage and error information.
//
// Returned Error Codes:
// * ErrCodeGlobalClusterNotFoundFault "GlobalClusterNotFoundFault"
//
// * ErrCodeInvalidGlobalClusterStateFault "InvalidGlobalClusterStateFault"
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/ModifyGlobalCluster
func (c *RDS) ModifyGlobalCluster(input *ModifyGlobalClusterInput) (*ModifyGlobalClusterOutput, error) {
req, out := c.ModifyGlobalClusterRequest(input)
return out, req.Send()
}
// ModifyGlobalClusterWithContext is the same as ModifyGlobalCluster with the addition of
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
//
// See ModifyGlobalCluster for details on how to use this API operation.
//
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
// for more information on using Contexts.
func (c *RDS) ModifyGlobalClusterWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *ModifyGlobalClusterInput, opts ...request.Option) (*ModifyGlobalClusterOutput, error) {
req, out := c.ModifyGlobalClusterRequest(input)
req.SetContext(ctx)
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
return out, req.Send()
}
const opModifyOptionGroup = "ModifyOptionGroup"
// ModifyOptionGroupRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
// client's request for the ModifyOptionGroup operation. The "output" return
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
// successfully.
//
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
//
// See ModifyOptionGroup for more information on using the ModifyOptionGroup
// API call, and error handling.
//
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
//
//
// // Example sending a request using the ModifyOptionGroupRequest method.
// req, resp := client.ModifyOptionGroupRequest(params)
//
// err := req.Send()
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
// fmt.Println(resp)
// }
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/ModifyOptionGroup
func (c *RDS) ModifyOptionGroupRequest(input *ModifyOptionGroupInput) (req *request.Request, output *ModifyOptionGroupOutput) {
op := &request.Operation{
Name: opModifyOptionGroup,
HTTPMethod: "POST",
HTTPPath: "/",
}
if input == nil {
input = &ModifyOptionGroupInput{}
}
output = &ModifyOptionGroupOutput{}
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
return
}
// ModifyOptionGroup API operation for Amazon Relational Database Service.
//
// Modifies an existing option group.
//
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
// the error.
//
// See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Relational Database Service's
// API operation ModifyOptionGroup for usage and error information.
//
// Returned Error Codes:
// * ErrCodeInvalidOptionGroupStateFault "InvalidOptionGroupStateFault"
// The option group isn't in the available state.
//
// * ErrCodeOptionGroupNotFoundFault "OptionGroupNotFoundFault"
// The specified option group could not be found.
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/ModifyOptionGroup
func (c *RDS) ModifyOptionGroup(input *ModifyOptionGroupInput) (*ModifyOptionGroupOutput, error) {
req, out := c.ModifyOptionGroupRequest(input)
return out, req.Send()
}
// ModifyOptionGroupWithContext is the same as ModifyOptionGroup with the addition of
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
//
// See ModifyOptionGroup for details on how to use this API operation.
//
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
// for more information on using Contexts.
func (c *RDS) ModifyOptionGroupWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *ModifyOptionGroupInput, opts ...request.Option) (*ModifyOptionGroupOutput, error) {
req, out := c.ModifyOptionGroupRequest(input)
req.SetContext(ctx)
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
return out, req.Send()
}
const opPromoteReadReplica = "PromoteReadReplica"
// PromoteReadReplicaRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
// client's request for the PromoteReadReplica operation. The "output" return
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
// successfully.
//
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
//
// See PromoteReadReplica for more information on using the PromoteReadReplica
// API call, and error handling.
//
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
//
//
// // Example sending a request using the PromoteReadReplicaRequest method.
// req, resp := client.PromoteReadReplicaRequest(params)
//
// err := req.Send()
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
// fmt.Println(resp)
// }
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/PromoteReadReplica
func (c *RDS) PromoteReadReplicaRequest(input *PromoteReadReplicaInput) (req *request.Request, output *PromoteReadReplicaOutput) {
op := &request.Operation{
Name: opPromoteReadReplica,
HTTPMethod: "POST",
HTTPPath: "/",
}
if input == nil {
input = &PromoteReadReplicaInput{}
}
output = &PromoteReadReplicaOutput{}
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
return
}
// PromoteReadReplica API operation for Amazon Relational Database Service.
//
// Promotes a Read Replica DB instance to a standalone DB instance.
//
// Backup duration is a function of the amount of changes to the database since
// the previous backup. If you plan to promote a Read Replica to a standalone
// instance, we recommend that you enable backups and complete at least one
// backup prior to promotion. In addition, a Read Replica cannot be promoted
// to a standalone instance when it is in the backing-up status. If you have
// enabled backups on your Read Replica, configure the automated backup window
// so that daily backups do not interfere with Read Replica promotion.
//
// This command doesn't apply to Aurora MySQL and Aurora PostgreSQL.
//
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
// the error.
//
// See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Relational Database Service's
// API operation PromoteReadReplica for usage and error information.
//
// Returned Error Codes:
// * ErrCodeInvalidDBInstanceStateFault "InvalidDBInstanceState"
// The DB instance isn't in a valid state.
//
// * ErrCodeDBInstanceNotFoundFault "DBInstanceNotFound"
// DBInstanceIdentifier doesn't refer to an existing DB instance.
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/PromoteReadReplica
func (c *RDS) PromoteReadReplica(input *PromoteReadReplicaInput) (*PromoteReadReplicaOutput, error) {
req, out := c.PromoteReadReplicaRequest(input)
return out, req.Send()
}
// PromoteReadReplicaWithContext is the same as PromoteReadReplica with the addition of
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
//
// See PromoteReadReplica for details on how to use this API operation.
//
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
// for more information on using Contexts.
func (c *RDS) PromoteReadReplicaWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *PromoteReadReplicaInput, opts ...request.Option) (*PromoteReadReplicaOutput, error) {
req, out := c.PromoteReadReplicaRequest(input)
req.SetContext(ctx)
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
return out, req.Send()
}
const opPromoteReadReplicaDBCluster = "PromoteReadReplicaDBCluster"
// PromoteReadReplicaDBClusterRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
// client's request for the PromoteReadReplicaDBCluster operation. The "output" return
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
// successfully.
//
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
//
// See PromoteReadReplicaDBCluster for more information on using the PromoteReadReplicaDBCluster
// API call, and error handling.
//
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
//
//
// // Example sending a request using the PromoteReadReplicaDBClusterRequest method.
// req, resp := client.PromoteReadReplicaDBClusterRequest(params)
//
// err := req.Send()
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
// fmt.Println(resp)
// }
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/PromoteReadReplicaDBCluster
func (c *RDS) PromoteReadReplicaDBClusterRequest(input *PromoteReadReplicaDBClusterInput) (req *request.Request, output *PromoteReadReplicaDBClusterOutput) {
op := &request.Operation{
Name: opPromoteReadReplicaDBCluster,
HTTPMethod: "POST",
HTTPPath: "/",
}
if input == nil {
input = &PromoteReadReplicaDBClusterInput{}
}
output = &PromoteReadReplicaDBClusterOutput{}
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
return
}
// PromoteReadReplicaDBCluster API operation for Amazon Relational Database Service.
//
// Promotes a Read Replica DB cluster to a standalone DB cluster.
//
// This action only applies to Aurora DB clusters.
//
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
// the error.
//
// See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Relational Database Service's
// API operation PromoteReadReplicaDBCluster for usage and error information.
//
// Returned Error Codes:
// * ErrCodeDBClusterNotFoundFault "DBClusterNotFoundFault"
// DBClusterIdentifier doesn't refer to an existing DB cluster.
//
// * ErrCodeInvalidDBClusterStateFault "InvalidDBClusterStateFault"
// The requested operation can't be performed while the cluster is in this state.
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/PromoteReadReplicaDBCluster
func (c *RDS) PromoteReadReplicaDBCluster(input *PromoteReadReplicaDBClusterInput) (*PromoteReadReplicaDBClusterOutput, error) {
req, out := c.PromoteReadReplicaDBClusterRequest(input)
return out, req.Send()
}
// PromoteReadReplicaDBClusterWithContext is the same as PromoteReadReplicaDBCluster with the addition of
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
//
// See PromoteReadReplicaDBCluster for details on how to use this API operation.
//
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
// for more information on using Contexts.
func (c *RDS) PromoteReadReplicaDBClusterWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *PromoteReadReplicaDBClusterInput, opts ...request.Option) (*PromoteReadReplicaDBClusterOutput, error) {
req, out := c.PromoteReadReplicaDBClusterRequest(input)
req.SetContext(ctx)
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
return out, req.Send()
}
const opPurchaseReservedDBInstancesOffering = "PurchaseReservedDBInstancesOffering"
// PurchaseReservedDBInstancesOfferingRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
// client's request for the PurchaseReservedDBInstancesOffering operation. The "output" return
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
// successfully.
//
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
//
// See PurchaseReservedDBInstancesOffering for more information on using the PurchaseReservedDBInstancesOffering
// API call, and error handling.
//
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
//
//
// // Example sending a request using the PurchaseReservedDBInstancesOfferingRequest method.
// req, resp := client.PurchaseReservedDBInstancesOfferingRequest(params)
//
// err := req.Send()
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
// fmt.Println(resp)
// }
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/PurchaseReservedDBInstancesOffering
func (c *RDS) PurchaseReservedDBInstancesOfferingRequest(input *PurchaseReservedDBInstancesOfferingInput) (req *request.Request, output *PurchaseReservedDBInstancesOfferingOutput) {
op := &request.Operation{
Name: opPurchaseReservedDBInstancesOffering,
HTTPMethod: "POST",
HTTPPath: "/",
}
if input == nil {
input = &PurchaseReservedDBInstancesOfferingInput{}
}
output = &PurchaseReservedDBInstancesOfferingOutput{}
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
return
}
// PurchaseReservedDBInstancesOffering API operation for Amazon Relational Database Service.
//
// Purchases a reserved DB instance offering.
//
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
// the error.
//
// See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Relational Database Service's
// API operation PurchaseReservedDBInstancesOffering for usage and error information.
//
// Returned Error Codes:
// * ErrCodeReservedDBInstancesOfferingNotFoundFault "ReservedDBInstancesOfferingNotFound"
// Specified offering does not exist.
//
// * ErrCodeReservedDBInstanceAlreadyExistsFault "ReservedDBInstanceAlreadyExists"
// User already has a reservation with the given identifier.
//
// * ErrCodeReservedDBInstanceQuotaExceededFault "ReservedDBInstanceQuotaExceeded"
// Request would exceed the user's DB Instance quota.
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/PurchaseReservedDBInstancesOffering
func (c *RDS) PurchaseReservedDBInstancesOffering(input *PurchaseReservedDBInstancesOfferingInput) (*PurchaseReservedDBInstancesOfferingOutput, error) {
req, out := c.PurchaseReservedDBInstancesOfferingRequest(input)
return out, req.Send()
}
// PurchaseReservedDBInstancesOfferingWithContext is the same as PurchaseReservedDBInstancesOffering with the addition of
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
//
// See PurchaseReservedDBInstancesOffering for details on how to use this API operation.
//
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
// for more information on using Contexts.
func (c *RDS) PurchaseReservedDBInstancesOfferingWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *PurchaseReservedDBInstancesOfferingInput, opts ...request.Option) (*PurchaseReservedDBInstancesOfferingOutput, error) {
req, out := c.PurchaseReservedDBInstancesOfferingRequest(input)
req.SetContext(ctx)
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
return out, req.Send()
}
const opRebootDBInstance = "RebootDBInstance"
// RebootDBInstanceRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
// client's request for the RebootDBInstance operation. The "output" return
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
// successfully.
//
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
//
// See RebootDBInstance for more information on using the RebootDBInstance
// API call, and error handling.
//
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
//
//
// // Example sending a request using the RebootDBInstanceRequest method.
// req, resp := client.RebootDBInstanceRequest(params)
//
// err := req.Send()
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
// fmt.Println(resp)
// }
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/RebootDBInstance
func (c *RDS) RebootDBInstanceRequest(input *RebootDBInstanceInput) (req *request.Request, output *RebootDBInstanceOutput) {
op := &request.Operation{
Name: opRebootDBInstance,
HTTPMethod: "POST",
HTTPPath: "/",
}
if input == nil {
input = &RebootDBInstanceInput{}
}
output = &RebootDBInstanceOutput{}
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
return
}
// RebootDBInstance API operation for Amazon Relational Database Service.
//
// You might need to reboot your DB instance, usually for maintenance reasons.
// For example, if you make certain modifications, or if you change the DB parameter
// group associated with the DB instance, you must reboot the instance for the
// changes to take effect.
//
// Rebooting a DB instance restarts the database engine service. Rebooting a
// DB instance results in a momentary outage, during which the DB instance status
// is set to rebooting.
//
// For more information about rebooting, see Rebooting a DB Instance (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/UserGuide/USER_RebootInstance.html)
// in the Amazon RDS User Guide.
//
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
// the error.
//
// See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Relational Database Service's
// API operation RebootDBInstance for usage and error information.
//
// Returned Error Codes:
// * ErrCodeInvalidDBInstanceStateFault "InvalidDBInstanceState"
// The DB instance isn't in a valid state.
//
// * ErrCodeDBInstanceNotFoundFault "DBInstanceNotFound"
// DBInstanceIdentifier doesn't refer to an existing DB instance.
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/RebootDBInstance
func (c *RDS) RebootDBInstance(input *RebootDBInstanceInput) (*RebootDBInstanceOutput, error) {
req, out := c.RebootDBInstanceRequest(input)
return out, req.Send()
}
// RebootDBInstanceWithContext is the same as RebootDBInstance with the addition of
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
//
// See RebootDBInstance for details on how to use this API operation.
//
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
// for more information on using Contexts.
func (c *RDS) RebootDBInstanceWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *RebootDBInstanceInput, opts ...request.Option) (*RebootDBInstanceOutput, error) {
req, out := c.RebootDBInstanceRequest(input)
req.SetContext(ctx)
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
return out, req.Send()
}
const opRemoveFromGlobalCluster = "RemoveFromGlobalCluster"
// RemoveFromGlobalClusterRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
// client's request for the RemoveFromGlobalCluster operation. The "output" return
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
// successfully.
//
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
//
// See RemoveFromGlobalCluster for more information on using the RemoveFromGlobalCluster
// API call, and error handling.
//
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
//
//
// // Example sending a request using the RemoveFromGlobalClusterRequest method.
// req, resp := client.RemoveFromGlobalClusterRequest(params)
//
// err := req.Send()
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
// fmt.Println(resp)
// }
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/RemoveFromGlobalCluster
func (c *RDS) RemoveFromGlobalClusterRequest(input *RemoveFromGlobalClusterInput) (req *request.Request, output *RemoveFromGlobalClusterOutput) {
op := &request.Operation{
Name: opRemoveFromGlobalCluster,
HTTPMethod: "POST",
HTTPPath: "/",
}
if input == nil {
input = &RemoveFromGlobalClusterInput{}
}
output = &RemoveFromGlobalClusterOutput{}
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
return
}
// RemoveFromGlobalCluster API operation for Amazon Relational Database Service.
//
// Detaches an Aurora secondary cluster from an Aurora global database cluster.
// The cluster becomes a standalone cluster with read-write capability instead
// of being read-only and receiving data from a primary cluster in a different
// region.
//
// This action only applies to Aurora DB clusters.
//
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
// the error.
//
// See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Relational Database Service's
// API operation RemoveFromGlobalCluster for usage and error information.
//
// Returned Error Codes:
// * ErrCodeGlobalClusterNotFoundFault "GlobalClusterNotFoundFault"
//
// * ErrCodeInvalidGlobalClusterStateFault "InvalidGlobalClusterStateFault"
//
// * ErrCodeDBClusterNotFoundFault "DBClusterNotFoundFault"
// DBClusterIdentifier doesn't refer to an existing DB cluster.
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/RemoveFromGlobalCluster
func (c *RDS) RemoveFromGlobalCluster(input *RemoveFromGlobalClusterInput) (*RemoveFromGlobalClusterOutput, error) {
req, out := c.RemoveFromGlobalClusterRequest(input)
return out, req.Send()
}
// RemoveFromGlobalClusterWithContext is the same as RemoveFromGlobalCluster with the addition of
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
//
// See RemoveFromGlobalCluster for details on how to use this API operation.
//
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
// for more information on using Contexts.
func (c *RDS) RemoveFromGlobalClusterWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *RemoveFromGlobalClusterInput, opts ...request.Option) (*RemoveFromGlobalClusterOutput, error) {
req, out := c.RemoveFromGlobalClusterRequest(input)
req.SetContext(ctx)
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
return out, req.Send()
}
const opRemoveRoleFromDBCluster = "RemoveRoleFromDBCluster"
// RemoveRoleFromDBClusterRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
// client's request for the RemoveRoleFromDBCluster operation. The "output" return
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
// successfully.
//
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
//
// See RemoveRoleFromDBCluster for more information on using the RemoveRoleFromDBCluster
// API call, and error handling.
//
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
//
//
// // Example sending a request using the RemoveRoleFromDBClusterRequest method.
// req, resp := client.RemoveRoleFromDBClusterRequest(params)
//
// err := req.Send()
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
// fmt.Println(resp)
// }
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/RemoveRoleFromDBCluster
func (c *RDS) RemoveRoleFromDBClusterRequest(input *RemoveRoleFromDBClusterInput) (req *request.Request, output *RemoveRoleFromDBClusterOutput) {
op := &request.Operation{
Name: opRemoveRoleFromDBCluster,
HTTPMethod: "POST",
HTTPPath: "/",
}
if input == nil {
input = &RemoveRoleFromDBClusterInput{}
}
output = &RemoveRoleFromDBClusterOutput{}
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
req.Handlers.Unmarshal.Swap(query.UnmarshalHandler.Name, protocol.UnmarshalDiscardBodyHandler)
return
}
// RemoveRoleFromDBCluster API operation for Amazon Relational Database Service.
//
// Disassociates an AWS Identity and Access Management (IAM) role from an Amazon
// Aurora DB cluster. For more information, see Authorizing Amazon Aurora MySQL
// to Access Other AWS Services on Your Behalf (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/AuroraUserGuide/AuroraMySQL.Integrating.Authorizing.html)
// in the Amazon Aurora User Guide.
//
// This action only applies to Aurora DB clusters.
//
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
// the error.
//
// See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Relational Database Service's
// API operation RemoveRoleFromDBCluster for usage and error information.
//
// Returned Error Codes:
// * ErrCodeDBClusterNotFoundFault "DBClusterNotFoundFault"
// DBClusterIdentifier doesn't refer to an existing DB cluster.
//
// * ErrCodeDBClusterRoleNotFoundFault "DBClusterRoleNotFound"
// The specified IAM role Amazon Resource Name (ARN) isn't associated with the
// specified DB cluster.
//
// * ErrCodeInvalidDBClusterStateFault "InvalidDBClusterStateFault"
// The requested operation can't be performed while the cluster is in this state.
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/RemoveRoleFromDBCluster
func (c *RDS) RemoveRoleFromDBCluster(input *RemoveRoleFromDBClusterInput) (*RemoveRoleFromDBClusterOutput, error) {
req, out := c.RemoveRoleFromDBClusterRequest(input)
return out, req.Send()
}
// RemoveRoleFromDBClusterWithContext is the same as RemoveRoleFromDBCluster with the addition of
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
//
// See RemoveRoleFromDBCluster for details on how to use this API operation.
//
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
// for more information on using Contexts.
func (c *RDS) RemoveRoleFromDBClusterWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *RemoveRoleFromDBClusterInput, opts ...request.Option) (*RemoveRoleFromDBClusterOutput, error) {
req, out := c.RemoveRoleFromDBClusterRequest(input)
req.SetContext(ctx)
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
return out, req.Send()
}
const opRemoveRoleFromDBInstance = "RemoveRoleFromDBInstance"
// RemoveRoleFromDBInstanceRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
// client's request for the RemoveRoleFromDBInstance operation. The "output" return
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
// successfully.
//
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
//
// See RemoveRoleFromDBInstance for more information on using the RemoveRoleFromDBInstance
// API call, and error handling.
//
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
//
//
// // Example sending a request using the RemoveRoleFromDBInstanceRequest method.
// req, resp := client.RemoveRoleFromDBInstanceRequest(params)
//
// err := req.Send()
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
// fmt.Println(resp)
// }
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/RemoveRoleFromDBInstance
func (c *RDS) RemoveRoleFromDBInstanceRequest(input *RemoveRoleFromDBInstanceInput) (req *request.Request, output *RemoveRoleFromDBInstanceOutput) {
op := &request.Operation{
Name: opRemoveRoleFromDBInstance,
HTTPMethod: "POST",
HTTPPath: "/",
}
if input == nil {
input = &RemoveRoleFromDBInstanceInput{}
}
output = &RemoveRoleFromDBInstanceOutput{}
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
req.Handlers.Unmarshal.Swap(query.UnmarshalHandler.Name, protocol.UnmarshalDiscardBodyHandler)
return
}
// RemoveRoleFromDBInstance API operation for Amazon Relational Database Service.
//
// Disassociates an AWS Identity and Access Management (IAM) role from a DB
// instance.
//
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
// the error.
//
// See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Relational Database Service's
// API operation RemoveRoleFromDBInstance for usage and error information.
//
// Returned Error Codes:
// * ErrCodeDBInstanceNotFoundFault "DBInstanceNotFound"
// DBInstanceIdentifier doesn't refer to an existing DB instance.
//
// * ErrCodeDBInstanceRoleNotFoundFault "DBInstanceRoleNotFound"
// The specified RoleArn value doesn't match the specifed feature for the DB
// instance.
//
// * ErrCodeInvalidDBInstanceStateFault "InvalidDBInstanceState"
// The DB instance isn't in a valid state.
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/RemoveRoleFromDBInstance
func (c *RDS) RemoveRoleFromDBInstance(input *RemoveRoleFromDBInstanceInput) (*RemoveRoleFromDBInstanceOutput, error) {
req, out := c.RemoveRoleFromDBInstanceRequest(input)
return out, req.Send()
}
// RemoveRoleFromDBInstanceWithContext is the same as RemoveRoleFromDBInstance with the addition of
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
//
// See RemoveRoleFromDBInstance for details on how to use this API operation.
//
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
// for more information on using Contexts.
func (c *RDS) RemoveRoleFromDBInstanceWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *RemoveRoleFromDBInstanceInput, opts ...request.Option) (*RemoveRoleFromDBInstanceOutput, error) {
req, out := c.RemoveRoleFromDBInstanceRequest(input)
req.SetContext(ctx)
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
return out, req.Send()
}
const opRemoveSourceIdentifierFromSubscription = "RemoveSourceIdentifierFromSubscription"
// RemoveSourceIdentifierFromSubscriptionRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
// client's request for the RemoveSourceIdentifierFromSubscription operation. The "output" return
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
// successfully.
//
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
//
// See RemoveSourceIdentifierFromSubscription for more information on using the RemoveSourceIdentifierFromSubscription
// API call, and error handling.
//
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
//
//
// // Example sending a request using the RemoveSourceIdentifierFromSubscriptionRequest method.
// req, resp := client.RemoveSourceIdentifierFromSubscriptionRequest(params)
//
// err := req.Send()
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
// fmt.Println(resp)
// }
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/RemoveSourceIdentifierFromSubscription
func (c *RDS) RemoveSourceIdentifierFromSubscriptionRequest(input *RemoveSourceIdentifierFromSubscriptionInput) (req *request.Request, output *RemoveSourceIdentifierFromSubscriptionOutput) {
op := &request.Operation{
Name: opRemoveSourceIdentifierFromSubscription,
HTTPMethod: "POST",
HTTPPath: "/",
}
if input == nil {
input = &RemoveSourceIdentifierFromSubscriptionInput{}
}
output = &RemoveSourceIdentifierFromSubscriptionOutput{}
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
return
}
// RemoveSourceIdentifierFromSubscription API operation for Amazon Relational Database Service.
//
// Removes a source identifier from an existing RDS event notification subscription.
//
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
// the error.
//
// See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Relational Database Service's
// API operation RemoveSourceIdentifierFromSubscription for usage and error information.
//
// Returned Error Codes:
// * ErrCodeSubscriptionNotFoundFault "SubscriptionNotFound"
// The subscription name does not exist.
//
// * ErrCodeSourceNotFoundFault "SourceNotFound"
// The requested source could not be found.
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/RemoveSourceIdentifierFromSubscription
func (c *RDS) RemoveSourceIdentifierFromSubscription(input *RemoveSourceIdentifierFromSubscriptionInput) (*RemoveSourceIdentifierFromSubscriptionOutput, error) {
req, out := c.RemoveSourceIdentifierFromSubscriptionRequest(input)
return out, req.Send()
}
// RemoveSourceIdentifierFromSubscriptionWithContext is the same as RemoveSourceIdentifierFromSubscription with the addition of
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
//
// See RemoveSourceIdentifierFromSubscription for details on how to use this API operation.
//
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
// for more information on using Contexts.
func (c *RDS) RemoveSourceIdentifierFromSubscriptionWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *RemoveSourceIdentifierFromSubscriptionInput, opts ...request.Option) (*RemoveSourceIdentifierFromSubscriptionOutput, error) {
req, out := c.RemoveSourceIdentifierFromSubscriptionRequest(input)
req.SetContext(ctx)
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
return out, req.Send()
}
const opRemoveTagsFromResource = "RemoveTagsFromResource"
// RemoveTagsFromResourceRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
// client's request for the RemoveTagsFromResource operation. The "output" return
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
// successfully.
//
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
//
// See RemoveTagsFromResource for more information on using the RemoveTagsFromResource
// API call, and error handling.
//
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
//
//
// // Example sending a request using the RemoveTagsFromResourceRequest method.
// req, resp := client.RemoveTagsFromResourceRequest(params)
//
// err := req.Send()
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
// fmt.Println(resp)
// }
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/RemoveTagsFromResource
func (c *RDS) RemoveTagsFromResourceRequest(input *RemoveTagsFromResourceInput) (req *request.Request, output *RemoveTagsFromResourceOutput) {
op := &request.Operation{
Name: opRemoveTagsFromResource,
HTTPMethod: "POST",
HTTPPath: "/",
}
if input == nil {
input = &RemoveTagsFromResourceInput{}
}
output = &RemoveTagsFromResourceOutput{}
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
req.Handlers.Unmarshal.Swap(query.UnmarshalHandler.Name, protocol.UnmarshalDiscardBodyHandler)
return
}
// RemoveTagsFromResource API operation for Amazon Relational Database Service.
//
// Removes metadata tags from an Amazon RDS resource.
//
// For an overview on tagging an Amazon RDS resource, see Tagging Amazon RDS
// Resources (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/UserGuide/Overview.Tagging.html)
// in the Amazon RDS User Guide.
//
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
// the error.
//
// See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Relational Database Service's
// API operation RemoveTagsFromResource for usage and error information.
//
// Returned Error Codes:
// * ErrCodeDBInstanceNotFoundFault "DBInstanceNotFound"
// DBInstanceIdentifier doesn't refer to an existing DB instance.
//
// * ErrCodeDBSnapshotNotFoundFault "DBSnapshotNotFound"
// DBSnapshotIdentifier doesn't refer to an existing DB snapshot.
//
// * ErrCodeDBClusterNotFoundFault "DBClusterNotFoundFault"
// DBClusterIdentifier doesn't refer to an existing DB cluster.
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/RemoveTagsFromResource
func (c *RDS) RemoveTagsFromResource(input *RemoveTagsFromResourceInput) (*RemoveTagsFromResourceOutput, error) {
req, out := c.RemoveTagsFromResourceRequest(input)
return out, req.Send()
}
// RemoveTagsFromResourceWithContext is the same as RemoveTagsFromResource with the addition of
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
//
// See RemoveTagsFromResource for details on how to use this API operation.
//
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
// for more information on using Contexts.
func (c *RDS) RemoveTagsFromResourceWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *RemoveTagsFromResourceInput, opts ...request.Option) (*RemoveTagsFromResourceOutput, error) {
req, out := c.RemoveTagsFromResourceRequest(input)
req.SetContext(ctx)
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
return out, req.Send()
}
const opResetDBClusterParameterGroup = "ResetDBClusterParameterGroup"
// ResetDBClusterParameterGroupRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
// client's request for the ResetDBClusterParameterGroup operation. The "output" return
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
// successfully.
//
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
//
// See ResetDBClusterParameterGroup for more information on using the ResetDBClusterParameterGroup
// API call, and error handling.
//
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
//
//
// // Example sending a request using the ResetDBClusterParameterGroupRequest method.
// req, resp := client.ResetDBClusterParameterGroupRequest(params)
//
// err := req.Send()
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
// fmt.Println(resp)
// }
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/ResetDBClusterParameterGroup
func (c *RDS) ResetDBClusterParameterGroupRequest(input *ResetDBClusterParameterGroupInput) (req *request.Request, output *DBClusterParameterGroupNameMessage) {
op := &request.Operation{
Name: opResetDBClusterParameterGroup,
HTTPMethod: "POST",
HTTPPath: "/",
}
if input == nil {
input = &ResetDBClusterParameterGroupInput{}
}
output = &DBClusterParameterGroupNameMessage{}
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
return
}
// ResetDBClusterParameterGroup API operation for Amazon Relational Database Service.
//
// Modifies the parameters of a DB cluster parameter group to the default value.
// To reset specific parameters submit a list of the following: ParameterName
// and ApplyMethod. To reset the entire DB cluster parameter group, specify
// the DBClusterParameterGroupName and ResetAllParameters parameters.
//
// When resetting the entire group, dynamic parameters are updated immediately
// and static parameters are set to pending-reboot to take effect on the next
// DB instance restart or RebootDBInstance request. You must call RebootDBInstance
// for every DB instance in your DB cluster that you want the updated static
// parameter to apply to.
//
// For more information on Amazon Aurora, see What Is Amazon Aurora? (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/AuroraUserGuide/CHAP_AuroraOverview.html)
// in the Amazon Aurora User Guide.
//
// This action only applies to Aurora DB clusters.
//
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
// the error.
//
// See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Relational Database Service's
// API operation ResetDBClusterParameterGroup for usage and error information.
//
// Returned Error Codes:
// * ErrCodeInvalidDBParameterGroupStateFault "InvalidDBParameterGroupState"
// The DB parameter group is in use or is in an invalid state. If you are attempting
// to delete the parameter group, you can't delete it when the parameter group
// is in this state.
//
// * ErrCodeDBParameterGroupNotFoundFault "DBParameterGroupNotFound"
// DBParameterGroupName doesn't refer to an existing DB parameter group.
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/ResetDBClusterParameterGroup
func (c *RDS) ResetDBClusterParameterGroup(input *ResetDBClusterParameterGroupInput) (*DBClusterParameterGroupNameMessage, error) {
req, out := c.ResetDBClusterParameterGroupRequest(input)
return out, req.Send()
}
// ResetDBClusterParameterGroupWithContext is the same as ResetDBClusterParameterGroup with the addition of
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
//
// See ResetDBClusterParameterGroup for details on how to use this API operation.
//
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
// for more information on using Contexts.
func (c *RDS) ResetDBClusterParameterGroupWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *ResetDBClusterParameterGroupInput, opts ...request.Option) (*DBClusterParameterGroupNameMessage, error) {
req, out := c.ResetDBClusterParameterGroupRequest(input)
req.SetContext(ctx)
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
return out, req.Send()
}
const opResetDBParameterGroup = "ResetDBParameterGroup"
// ResetDBParameterGroupRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
// client's request for the ResetDBParameterGroup operation. The "output" return
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
// successfully.
//
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
//
// See ResetDBParameterGroup for more information on using the ResetDBParameterGroup
// API call, and error handling.
//
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
//
//
// // Example sending a request using the ResetDBParameterGroupRequest method.
// req, resp := client.ResetDBParameterGroupRequest(params)
//
// err := req.Send()
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
// fmt.Println(resp)
// }
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/ResetDBParameterGroup
func (c *RDS) ResetDBParameterGroupRequest(input *ResetDBParameterGroupInput) (req *request.Request, output *DBParameterGroupNameMessage) {
op := &request.Operation{
Name: opResetDBParameterGroup,
HTTPMethod: "POST",
HTTPPath: "/",
}
if input == nil {
input = &ResetDBParameterGroupInput{}
}
output = &DBParameterGroupNameMessage{}
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
return
}
// ResetDBParameterGroup API operation for Amazon Relational Database Service.
//
// Modifies the parameters of a DB parameter group to the engine/system default
// value. To reset specific parameters, provide a list of the following: ParameterName
// and ApplyMethod. To reset the entire DB parameter group, specify the DBParameterGroup
// name and ResetAllParameters parameters. When resetting the entire group,
// dynamic parameters are updated immediately and static parameters are set
// to pending-reboot to take effect on the next DB instance restart or RebootDBInstance
// request.
//
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
// the error.
//
// See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Relational Database Service's
// API operation ResetDBParameterGroup for usage and error information.
//
// Returned Error Codes:
// * ErrCodeInvalidDBParameterGroupStateFault "InvalidDBParameterGroupState"
// The DB parameter group is in use or is in an invalid state. If you are attempting
// to delete the parameter group, you can't delete it when the parameter group
// is in this state.
//
// * ErrCodeDBParameterGroupNotFoundFault "DBParameterGroupNotFound"
// DBParameterGroupName doesn't refer to an existing DB parameter group.
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/ResetDBParameterGroup
func (c *RDS) ResetDBParameterGroup(input *ResetDBParameterGroupInput) (*DBParameterGroupNameMessage, error) {
req, out := c.ResetDBParameterGroupRequest(input)
return out, req.Send()
}
// ResetDBParameterGroupWithContext is the same as ResetDBParameterGroup with the addition of
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
//
// See ResetDBParameterGroup for details on how to use this API operation.
//
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
// for more information on using Contexts.
func (c *RDS) ResetDBParameterGroupWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *ResetDBParameterGroupInput, opts ...request.Option) (*DBParameterGroupNameMessage, error) {
req, out := c.ResetDBParameterGroupRequest(input)
req.SetContext(ctx)
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
return out, req.Send()
}
const opRestoreDBClusterFromS3 = "RestoreDBClusterFromS3"
// RestoreDBClusterFromS3Request generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
// client's request for the RestoreDBClusterFromS3 operation. The "output" return
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
// successfully.
//
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
//
// See RestoreDBClusterFromS3 for more information on using the RestoreDBClusterFromS3
// API call, and error handling.
//
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
//
//
// // Example sending a request using the RestoreDBClusterFromS3Request method.
// req, resp := client.RestoreDBClusterFromS3Request(params)
//
// err := req.Send()
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
// fmt.Println(resp)
// }
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/RestoreDBClusterFromS3
func (c *RDS) RestoreDBClusterFromS3Request(input *RestoreDBClusterFromS3Input) (req *request.Request, output *RestoreDBClusterFromS3Output) {
op := &request.Operation{
Name: opRestoreDBClusterFromS3,
HTTPMethod: "POST",
HTTPPath: "/",
}
if input == nil {
input = &RestoreDBClusterFromS3Input{}
}
output = &RestoreDBClusterFromS3Output{}
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
return
}
// RestoreDBClusterFromS3 API operation for Amazon Relational Database Service.
//
// Creates an Amazon Aurora DB cluster from data stored in an Amazon S3 bucket.
// Amazon RDS must be authorized to access the Amazon S3 bucket and the data
// must be created using the Percona XtraBackup utility as described in Migrating
// Data to an Amazon Aurora MySQL DB Cluster (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/AuroraUserGuide/AuroraMySQL.Migrating.html)
// in the Amazon Aurora User Guide.
//
// This action only applies to Aurora DB clusters.
//
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
// the error.
//
// See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Relational Database Service's
// API operation RestoreDBClusterFromS3 for usage and error information.
//
// Returned Error Codes:
// * ErrCodeDBClusterAlreadyExistsFault "DBClusterAlreadyExistsFault"
// The user already has a DB cluster with the given identifier.
//
// * ErrCodeDBClusterQuotaExceededFault "DBClusterQuotaExceededFault"
// The user attempted to create a new DB cluster and the user has already reached
// the maximum allowed DB cluster quota.
//
// * ErrCodeStorageQuotaExceededFault "StorageQuotaExceeded"
// The request would result in the user exceeding the allowed amount of storage
// available across all DB instances.
//
// * ErrCodeDBSubnetGroupNotFoundFault "DBSubnetGroupNotFoundFault"
// DBSubnetGroupName doesn't refer to an existing DB subnet group.
//
// * ErrCodeInvalidVPCNetworkStateFault "InvalidVPCNetworkStateFault"
// The DB subnet group doesn't cover all Availability Zones after it's created
// because of users' change.
//
// * ErrCodeInvalidDBClusterStateFault "InvalidDBClusterStateFault"
// The requested operation can't be performed while the cluster is in this state.
//
// * ErrCodeInvalidDBSubnetGroupStateFault "InvalidDBSubnetGroupStateFault"
// The DB subnet group cannot be deleted because it's in use.
//
// * ErrCodeInvalidSubnet "InvalidSubnet"
// The requested subnet is invalid, or multiple subnets were requested that
// are not all in a common VPC.
//
// * ErrCodeInvalidS3BucketFault "InvalidS3BucketFault"
// The specified Amazon S3 bucket name can't be found or Amazon RDS isn't authorized
// to access the specified Amazon S3 bucket. Verify the SourceS3BucketName and
// S3IngestionRoleArn values and try again.
//
// * ErrCodeDBClusterParameterGroupNotFoundFault "DBClusterParameterGroupNotFound"
// DBClusterParameterGroupName doesn't refer to an existing DB cluster parameter
// group.
//
// * ErrCodeKMSKeyNotAccessibleFault "KMSKeyNotAccessibleFault"
// An error occurred accessing an AWS KMS key.
//
// * ErrCodeDBClusterNotFoundFault "DBClusterNotFoundFault"
// DBClusterIdentifier doesn't refer to an existing DB cluster.
//
// * ErrCodeInsufficientStorageClusterCapacityFault "InsufficientStorageClusterCapacity"
// There is insufficient storage available for the current action. You might
// be able to resolve this error by updating your subnet group to use different
// Availability Zones that have more storage available.
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/RestoreDBClusterFromS3
func (c *RDS) RestoreDBClusterFromS3(input *RestoreDBClusterFromS3Input) (*RestoreDBClusterFromS3Output, error) {
req, out := c.RestoreDBClusterFromS3Request(input)
return out, req.Send()
}
// RestoreDBClusterFromS3WithContext is the same as RestoreDBClusterFromS3 with the addition of
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
//
// See RestoreDBClusterFromS3 for details on how to use this API operation.
//
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
// for more information on using Contexts.
func (c *RDS) RestoreDBClusterFromS3WithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *RestoreDBClusterFromS3Input, opts ...request.Option) (*RestoreDBClusterFromS3Output, error) {
req, out := c.RestoreDBClusterFromS3Request(input)
req.SetContext(ctx)
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
return out, req.Send()
}
const opRestoreDBClusterFromSnapshot = "RestoreDBClusterFromSnapshot"
// RestoreDBClusterFromSnapshotRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
// client's request for the RestoreDBClusterFromSnapshot operation. The "output" return
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
// successfully.
//
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
//
// See RestoreDBClusterFromSnapshot for more information on using the RestoreDBClusterFromSnapshot
// API call, and error handling.
//
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
//
//
// // Example sending a request using the RestoreDBClusterFromSnapshotRequest method.
// req, resp := client.RestoreDBClusterFromSnapshotRequest(params)
//
// err := req.Send()
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
// fmt.Println(resp)
// }
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/RestoreDBClusterFromSnapshot
func (c *RDS) RestoreDBClusterFromSnapshotRequest(input *RestoreDBClusterFromSnapshotInput) (req *request.Request, output *RestoreDBClusterFromSnapshotOutput) {
op := &request.Operation{
Name: opRestoreDBClusterFromSnapshot,
HTTPMethod: "POST",
HTTPPath: "/",
}
if input == nil {
input = &RestoreDBClusterFromSnapshotInput{}
}
output = &RestoreDBClusterFromSnapshotOutput{}
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
return
}
// RestoreDBClusterFromSnapshot API operation for Amazon Relational Database Service.
//
// Creates a new DB cluster from a DB snapshot or DB cluster snapshot.
//
// If a DB snapshot is specified, the target DB cluster is created from the
// source DB snapshot with a default configuration and default security group.
//
// If a DB cluster snapshot is specified, the target DB cluster is created from
// the source DB cluster restore point with the same configuration as the original
// source DB cluster, except that the new DB cluster is created with the default
// security group.
//
// For more information on Amazon Aurora, see What Is Amazon Aurora? (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/AuroraUserGuide/CHAP_AuroraOverview.html)
// in the Amazon Aurora User Guide.
//
// This action only applies to Aurora DB clusters.
//
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
// the error.
//
// See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Relational Database Service's
// API operation RestoreDBClusterFromSnapshot for usage and error information.
//
// Returned Error Codes:
// * ErrCodeDBClusterAlreadyExistsFault "DBClusterAlreadyExistsFault"
// The user already has a DB cluster with the given identifier.
//
// * ErrCodeDBClusterQuotaExceededFault "DBClusterQuotaExceededFault"
// The user attempted to create a new DB cluster and the user has already reached
// the maximum allowed DB cluster quota.
//
// * ErrCodeStorageQuotaExceededFault "StorageQuotaExceeded"
// The request would result in the user exceeding the allowed amount of storage
// available across all DB instances.
//
// * ErrCodeDBSubnetGroupNotFoundFault "DBSubnetGroupNotFoundFault"
// DBSubnetGroupName doesn't refer to an existing DB subnet group.
//
// * ErrCodeDBSnapshotNotFoundFault "DBSnapshotNotFound"
// DBSnapshotIdentifier doesn't refer to an existing DB snapshot.
//
// * ErrCodeDBClusterSnapshotNotFoundFault "DBClusterSnapshotNotFoundFault"
// DBClusterSnapshotIdentifier doesn't refer to an existing DB cluster snapshot.
//
// * ErrCodeInsufficientDBClusterCapacityFault "InsufficientDBClusterCapacityFault"
// The DB cluster doesn't have enough capacity for the current operation.
//
// * ErrCodeInsufficientStorageClusterCapacityFault "InsufficientStorageClusterCapacity"
// There is insufficient storage available for the current action. You might
// be able to resolve this error by updating your subnet group to use different
// Availability Zones that have more storage available.
//
// * ErrCodeInvalidDBSnapshotStateFault "InvalidDBSnapshotState"
// The state of the DB snapshot doesn't allow deletion.
//
// * ErrCodeInvalidDBClusterSnapshotStateFault "InvalidDBClusterSnapshotStateFault"
// The supplied value isn't a valid DB cluster snapshot state.
//
// * ErrCodeStorageQuotaExceededFault "StorageQuotaExceeded"
// The request would result in the user exceeding the allowed amount of storage
// available across all DB instances.
//
// * ErrCodeInvalidVPCNetworkStateFault "InvalidVPCNetworkStateFault"
// The DB subnet group doesn't cover all Availability Zones after it's created
// because of users' change.
//
// * ErrCodeInvalidRestoreFault "InvalidRestoreFault"
// Cannot restore from VPC backup to non-VPC DB instance.
//
// * ErrCodeDBSubnetGroupNotFoundFault "DBSubnetGroupNotFoundFault"
// DBSubnetGroupName doesn't refer to an existing DB subnet group.
//
// * ErrCodeInvalidSubnet "InvalidSubnet"
// The requested subnet is invalid, or multiple subnets were requested that
// are not all in a common VPC.
//
// * ErrCodeOptionGroupNotFoundFault "OptionGroupNotFoundFault"
// The specified option group could not be found.
//
// * ErrCodeKMSKeyNotAccessibleFault "KMSKeyNotAccessibleFault"
// An error occurred accessing an AWS KMS key.
//
// * ErrCodeDBClusterParameterGroupNotFoundFault "DBClusterParameterGroupNotFound"
// DBClusterParameterGroupName doesn't refer to an existing DB cluster parameter
// group.
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/RestoreDBClusterFromSnapshot
func (c *RDS) RestoreDBClusterFromSnapshot(input *RestoreDBClusterFromSnapshotInput) (*RestoreDBClusterFromSnapshotOutput, error) {
req, out := c.RestoreDBClusterFromSnapshotRequest(input)
return out, req.Send()
}
// RestoreDBClusterFromSnapshotWithContext is the same as RestoreDBClusterFromSnapshot with the addition of
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
//
// See RestoreDBClusterFromSnapshot for details on how to use this API operation.
//
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
// for more information on using Contexts.
func (c *RDS) RestoreDBClusterFromSnapshotWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *RestoreDBClusterFromSnapshotInput, opts ...request.Option) (*RestoreDBClusterFromSnapshotOutput, error) {
req, out := c.RestoreDBClusterFromSnapshotRequest(input)
req.SetContext(ctx)
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
return out, req.Send()
}
const opRestoreDBClusterToPointInTime = "RestoreDBClusterToPointInTime"
// RestoreDBClusterToPointInTimeRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
// client's request for the RestoreDBClusterToPointInTime operation. The "output" return
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
// successfully.
//
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
//
// See RestoreDBClusterToPointInTime for more information on using the RestoreDBClusterToPointInTime
// API call, and error handling.
//
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
//
//
// // Example sending a request using the RestoreDBClusterToPointInTimeRequest method.
// req, resp := client.RestoreDBClusterToPointInTimeRequest(params)
//
// err := req.Send()
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
// fmt.Println(resp)
// }
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/RestoreDBClusterToPointInTime
func (c *RDS) RestoreDBClusterToPointInTimeRequest(input *RestoreDBClusterToPointInTimeInput) (req *request.Request, output *RestoreDBClusterToPointInTimeOutput) {
op := &request.Operation{
Name: opRestoreDBClusterToPointInTime,
HTTPMethod: "POST",
HTTPPath: "/",
}
if input == nil {
input = &RestoreDBClusterToPointInTimeInput{}
}
output = &RestoreDBClusterToPointInTimeOutput{}
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
return
}
// RestoreDBClusterToPointInTime API operation for Amazon Relational Database Service.
//
// Restores a DB cluster to an arbitrary point in time. Users can restore to
// any point in time before LatestRestorableTime for up to BackupRetentionPeriod
// days. The target DB cluster is created from the source DB cluster with the
// same configuration as the original DB cluster, except that the new DB cluster
// is created with the default DB security group.
//
// This action only restores the DB cluster, not the DB instances for that DB
// cluster. You must invoke the CreateDBInstance action to create DB instances
// for the restored DB cluster, specifying the identifier of the restored DB
// cluster in DBClusterIdentifier. You can create DB instances only after the
// RestoreDBClusterToPointInTime action has completed and the DB cluster is
// available.
//
// For more information on Amazon Aurora, see What Is Amazon Aurora? (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/AuroraUserGuide/CHAP_AuroraOverview.html)
// in the Amazon Aurora User Guide.
//
// This action only applies to Aurora DB clusters.
//
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
// the error.
//
// See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Relational Database Service's
// API operation RestoreDBClusterToPointInTime for usage and error information.
//
// Returned Error Codes:
// * ErrCodeDBClusterAlreadyExistsFault "DBClusterAlreadyExistsFault"
// The user already has a DB cluster with the given identifier.
//
// * ErrCodeDBClusterNotFoundFault "DBClusterNotFoundFault"
// DBClusterIdentifier doesn't refer to an existing DB cluster.
//
// * ErrCodeDBClusterQuotaExceededFault "DBClusterQuotaExceededFault"
// The user attempted to create a new DB cluster and the user has already reached
// the maximum allowed DB cluster quota.
//
// * ErrCodeDBClusterSnapshotNotFoundFault "DBClusterSnapshotNotFoundFault"
// DBClusterSnapshotIdentifier doesn't refer to an existing DB cluster snapshot.
//
// * ErrCodeDBSubnetGroupNotFoundFault "DBSubnetGroupNotFoundFault"
// DBSubnetGroupName doesn't refer to an existing DB subnet group.
//
// * ErrCodeInsufficientDBClusterCapacityFault "InsufficientDBClusterCapacityFault"
// The DB cluster doesn't have enough capacity for the current operation.
//
// * ErrCodeInsufficientStorageClusterCapacityFault "InsufficientStorageClusterCapacity"
// There is insufficient storage available for the current action. You might
// be able to resolve this error by updating your subnet group to use different
// Availability Zones that have more storage available.
//
// * ErrCodeInvalidDBClusterSnapshotStateFault "InvalidDBClusterSnapshotStateFault"
// The supplied value isn't a valid DB cluster snapshot state.
//
// * ErrCodeInvalidDBClusterStateFault "InvalidDBClusterStateFault"
// The requested operation can't be performed while the cluster is in this state.
//
// * ErrCodeInvalidDBSnapshotStateFault "InvalidDBSnapshotState"
// The state of the DB snapshot doesn't allow deletion.
//
// * ErrCodeInvalidRestoreFault "InvalidRestoreFault"
// Cannot restore from VPC backup to non-VPC DB instance.
//
// * ErrCodeInvalidSubnet "InvalidSubnet"
// The requested subnet is invalid, or multiple subnets were requested that
// are not all in a common VPC.
//
// * ErrCodeInvalidVPCNetworkStateFault "InvalidVPCNetworkStateFault"
// The DB subnet group doesn't cover all Availability Zones after it's created
// because of users' change.
//
// * ErrCodeKMSKeyNotAccessibleFault "KMSKeyNotAccessibleFault"
// An error occurred accessing an AWS KMS key.
//
// * ErrCodeOptionGroupNotFoundFault "OptionGroupNotFoundFault"
// The specified option group could not be found.
//
// * ErrCodeStorageQuotaExceededFault "StorageQuotaExceeded"
// The request would result in the user exceeding the allowed amount of storage
// available across all DB instances.
//
// * ErrCodeDBClusterParameterGroupNotFoundFault "DBClusterParameterGroupNotFound"
// DBClusterParameterGroupName doesn't refer to an existing DB cluster parameter
// group.
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/RestoreDBClusterToPointInTime
func (c *RDS) RestoreDBClusterToPointInTime(input *RestoreDBClusterToPointInTimeInput) (*RestoreDBClusterToPointInTimeOutput, error) {
req, out := c.RestoreDBClusterToPointInTimeRequest(input)
return out, req.Send()
}
// RestoreDBClusterToPointInTimeWithContext is the same as RestoreDBClusterToPointInTime with the addition of
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
//
// See RestoreDBClusterToPointInTime for details on how to use this API operation.
//
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
// for more information on using Contexts.
func (c *RDS) RestoreDBClusterToPointInTimeWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *RestoreDBClusterToPointInTimeInput, opts ...request.Option) (*RestoreDBClusterToPointInTimeOutput, error) {
req, out := c.RestoreDBClusterToPointInTimeRequest(input)
req.SetContext(ctx)
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
return out, req.Send()
}
const opRestoreDBInstanceFromDBSnapshot = "RestoreDBInstanceFromDBSnapshot"
// RestoreDBInstanceFromDBSnapshotRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
// client's request for the RestoreDBInstanceFromDBSnapshot operation. The "output" return
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
// successfully.
//
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
//
// See RestoreDBInstanceFromDBSnapshot for more information on using the RestoreDBInstanceFromDBSnapshot
// API call, and error handling.
//
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
//
//
// // Example sending a request using the RestoreDBInstanceFromDBSnapshotRequest method.
// req, resp := client.RestoreDBInstanceFromDBSnapshotRequest(params)
//
// err := req.Send()
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
// fmt.Println(resp)
// }
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/RestoreDBInstanceFromDBSnapshot
func (c *RDS) RestoreDBInstanceFromDBSnapshotRequest(input *RestoreDBInstanceFromDBSnapshotInput) (req *request.Request, output *RestoreDBInstanceFromDBSnapshotOutput) {
op := &request.Operation{
Name: opRestoreDBInstanceFromDBSnapshot,
HTTPMethod: "POST",
HTTPPath: "/",
}
if input == nil {
input = &RestoreDBInstanceFromDBSnapshotInput{}
}
output = &RestoreDBInstanceFromDBSnapshotOutput{}
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
return
}
// RestoreDBInstanceFromDBSnapshot API operation for Amazon Relational Database Service.
//
// Creates a new DB instance from a DB snapshot. The target database is created
// from the source database restore point with the most of original configuration
// with the default security group and the default DB parameter group. By default,
// the new DB instance is created as a single-AZ deployment except when the
// instance is a SQL Server instance that has an option group that is associated
// with mirroring; in this case, the instance becomes a mirrored AZ deployment
// and not a single-AZ deployment.
//
// If your intent is to replace your original DB instance with the new, restored
// DB instance, then rename your original DB instance before you call the RestoreDBInstanceFromDBSnapshot
// action. RDS doesn't allow two DB instances with the same name. Once you have
// renamed your original DB instance with a different identifier, then you can
// pass the original name of the DB instance as the DBInstanceIdentifier in
// the call to the RestoreDBInstanceFromDBSnapshot action. The result is that
// you will replace the original DB instance with the DB instance created from
// the snapshot.
//
// If you are restoring from a shared manual DB snapshot, the DBSnapshotIdentifier
// must be the ARN of the shared DB snapshot.
//
// This command doesn't apply to Aurora MySQL and Aurora PostgreSQL. For Aurora,
// use RestoreDBClusterFromSnapshot.
//
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
// the error.
//
// See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Relational Database Service's
// API operation RestoreDBInstanceFromDBSnapshot for usage and error information.
//
// Returned Error Codes:
// * ErrCodeDBInstanceAlreadyExistsFault "DBInstanceAlreadyExists"
// The user already has a DB instance with the given identifier.
//
// * ErrCodeDBSnapshotNotFoundFault "DBSnapshotNotFound"
// DBSnapshotIdentifier doesn't refer to an existing DB snapshot.
//
// * ErrCodeInstanceQuotaExceededFault "InstanceQuotaExceeded"
// The request would result in the user exceeding the allowed number of DB instances.
//
// * ErrCodeInsufficientDBInstanceCapacityFault "InsufficientDBInstanceCapacity"
// The specified DB instance class isn't available in the specified Availability
// Zone.
//
// * ErrCodeInvalidDBSnapshotStateFault "InvalidDBSnapshotState"
// The state of the DB snapshot doesn't allow deletion.
//
// * ErrCodeStorageQuotaExceededFault "StorageQuotaExceeded"
// The request would result in the user exceeding the allowed amount of storage
// available across all DB instances.
//
// * ErrCodeInvalidVPCNetworkStateFault "InvalidVPCNetworkStateFault"
// The DB subnet group doesn't cover all Availability Zones after it's created
// because of users' change.
//
// * ErrCodeInvalidRestoreFault "InvalidRestoreFault"
// Cannot restore from VPC backup to non-VPC DB instance.
//
// * ErrCodeDBSubnetGroupNotFoundFault "DBSubnetGroupNotFoundFault"
// DBSubnetGroupName doesn't refer to an existing DB subnet group.
//
// * ErrCodeDBSubnetGroupDoesNotCoverEnoughAZs "DBSubnetGroupDoesNotCoverEnoughAZs"
// Subnets in the DB subnet group should cover at least two Availability Zones
// unless there is only one Availability Zone.
//
// * ErrCodeInvalidSubnet "InvalidSubnet"
// The requested subnet is invalid, or multiple subnets were requested that
// are not all in a common VPC.
//
// * ErrCodeProvisionedIopsNotAvailableInAZFault "ProvisionedIopsNotAvailableInAZFault"
// Provisioned IOPS not available in the specified Availability Zone.
//
// * ErrCodeOptionGroupNotFoundFault "OptionGroupNotFoundFault"
// The specified option group could not be found.
//
// * ErrCodeStorageTypeNotSupportedFault "StorageTypeNotSupported"
// Storage of the StorageType specified can't be associated with the DB instance.
//
// * ErrCodeAuthorizationNotFoundFault "AuthorizationNotFound"
// The specified CIDRIP or Amazon EC2 security group isn't authorized for the
// specified DB security group.
//
// RDS also may not be authorized by using IAM to perform necessary actions
// on your behalf.
//
// * ErrCodeKMSKeyNotAccessibleFault "KMSKeyNotAccessibleFault"
// An error occurred accessing an AWS KMS key.
//
// * ErrCodeDBSecurityGroupNotFoundFault "DBSecurityGroupNotFound"
// DBSecurityGroupName doesn't refer to an existing DB security group.
//
// * ErrCodeDomainNotFoundFault "DomainNotFoundFault"
// Domain doesn't refer to an existing Active Directory domain.
//
// * ErrCodeDBParameterGroupNotFoundFault "DBParameterGroupNotFound"
// DBParameterGroupName doesn't refer to an existing DB parameter group.
//
// * ErrCodeBackupPolicyNotFoundFault "BackupPolicyNotFoundFault"
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/RestoreDBInstanceFromDBSnapshot
func (c *RDS) RestoreDBInstanceFromDBSnapshot(input *RestoreDBInstanceFromDBSnapshotInput) (*RestoreDBInstanceFromDBSnapshotOutput, error) {
req, out := c.RestoreDBInstanceFromDBSnapshotRequest(input)
return out, req.Send()
}
// RestoreDBInstanceFromDBSnapshotWithContext is the same as RestoreDBInstanceFromDBSnapshot with the addition of
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
//
// See RestoreDBInstanceFromDBSnapshot for details on how to use this API operation.
//
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
// for more information on using Contexts.
func (c *RDS) RestoreDBInstanceFromDBSnapshotWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *RestoreDBInstanceFromDBSnapshotInput, opts ...request.Option) (*RestoreDBInstanceFromDBSnapshotOutput, error) {
req, out := c.RestoreDBInstanceFromDBSnapshotRequest(input)
req.SetContext(ctx)
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
return out, req.Send()
}
const opRestoreDBInstanceFromS3 = "RestoreDBInstanceFromS3"
// RestoreDBInstanceFromS3Request generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
// client's request for the RestoreDBInstanceFromS3 operation. The "output" return
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
// successfully.
//
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
//
// See RestoreDBInstanceFromS3 for more information on using the RestoreDBInstanceFromS3
// API call, and error handling.
//
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
//
//
// // Example sending a request using the RestoreDBInstanceFromS3Request method.
// req, resp := client.RestoreDBInstanceFromS3Request(params)
//
// err := req.Send()
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
// fmt.Println(resp)
// }
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/RestoreDBInstanceFromS3
func (c *RDS) RestoreDBInstanceFromS3Request(input *RestoreDBInstanceFromS3Input) (req *request.Request, output *RestoreDBInstanceFromS3Output) {
op := &request.Operation{
Name: opRestoreDBInstanceFromS3,
HTTPMethod: "POST",
HTTPPath: "/",
}
if input == nil {
input = &RestoreDBInstanceFromS3Input{}
}
output = &RestoreDBInstanceFromS3Output{}
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
return
}
// RestoreDBInstanceFromS3 API operation for Amazon Relational Database Service.
//
// Amazon Relational Database Service (Amazon RDS) supports importing MySQL
// databases by using backup files. You can create a backup of your on-premises
// database, store it on Amazon Simple Storage Service (Amazon S3), and then
// restore the backup file onto a new Amazon RDS DB instance running MySQL.
// For more information, see Importing Data into an Amazon RDS MySQL DB Instance
// (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/UserGuide/MySQL.Procedural.Importing.html)
// in the Amazon RDS User Guide.
//
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
// the error.
//
// See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Relational Database Service's
// API operation RestoreDBInstanceFromS3 for usage and error information.
//
// Returned Error Codes:
// * ErrCodeDBInstanceAlreadyExistsFault "DBInstanceAlreadyExists"
// The user already has a DB instance with the given identifier.
//
// * ErrCodeInsufficientDBInstanceCapacityFault "InsufficientDBInstanceCapacity"
// The specified DB instance class isn't available in the specified Availability
// Zone.
//
// * ErrCodeDBParameterGroupNotFoundFault "DBParameterGroupNotFound"
// DBParameterGroupName doesn't refer to an existing DB parameter group.
//
// * ErrCodeDBSecurityGroupNotFoundFault "DBSecurityGroupNotFound"
// DBSecurityGroupName doesn't refer to an existing DB security group.
//
// * ErrCodeInstanceQuotaExceededFault "InstanceQuotaExceeded"
// The request would result in the user exceeding the allowed number of DB instances.
//
// * ErrCodeStorageQuotaExceededFault "StorageQuotaExceeded"
// The request would result in the user exceeding the allowed amount of storage
// available across all DB instances.
//
// * ErrCodeDBSubnetGroupNotFoundFault "DBSubnetGroupNotFoundFault"
// DBSubnetGroupName doesn't refer to an existing DB subnet group.
//
// * ErrCodeDBSubnetGroupDoesNotCoverEnoughAZs "DBSubnetGroupDoesNotCoverEnoughAZs"
// Subnets in the DB subnet group should cover at least two Availability Zones
// unless there is only one Availability Zone.
//
// * ErrCodeInvalidSubnet "InvalidSubnet"
// The requested subnet is invalid, or multiple subnets were requested that
// are not all in a common VPC.
//
// * ErrCodeInvalidVPCNetworkStateFault "InvalidVPCNetworkStateFault"
// The DB subnet group doesn't cover all Availability Zones after it's created
// because of users' change.
//
// * ErrCodeInvalidS3BucketFault "InvalidS3BucketFault"
// The specified Amazon S3 bucket name can't be found or Amazon RDS isn't authorized
// to access the specified Amazon S3 bucket. Verify the SourceS3BucketName and
// S3IngestionRoleArn values and try again.
//
// * ErrCodeProvisionedIopsNotAvailableInAZFault "ProvisionedIopsNotAvailableInAZFault"
// Provisioned IOPS not available in the specified Availability Zone.
//
// * ErrCodeOptionGroupNotFoundFault "OptionGroupNotFoundFault"
// The specified option group could not be found.
//
// * ErrCodeStorageTypeNotSupportedFault "StorageTypeNotSupported"
// Storage of the StorageType specified can't be associated with the DB instance.
//
// * ErrCodeAuthorizationNotFoundFault "AuthorizationNotFound"
// The specified CIDRIP or Amazon EC2 security group isn't authorized for the
// specified DB security group.
//
// RDS also may not be authorized by using IAM to perform necessary actions
// on your behalf.
//
// * ErrCodeKMSKeyNotAccessibleFault "KMSKeyNotAccessibleFault"
// An error occurred accessing an AWS KMS key.
//
// * ErrCodeBackupPolicyNotFoundFault "BackupPolicyNotFoundFault"
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/RestoreDBInstanceFromS3
func (c *RDS) RestoreDBInstanceFromS3(input *RestoreDBInstanceFromS3Input) (*RestoreDBInstanceFromS3Output, error) {
req, out := c.RestoreDBInstanceFromS3Request(input)
return out, req.Send()
}
// RestoreDBInstanceFromS3WithContext is the same as RestoreDBInstanceFromS3 with the addition of
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
//
// See RestoreDBInstanceFromS3 for details on how to use this API operation.
//
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
// for more information on using Contexts.
func (c *RDS) RestoreDBInstanceFromS3WithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *RestoreDBInstanceFromS3Input, opts ...request.Option) (*RestoreDBInstanceFromS3Output, error) {
req, out := c.RestoreDBInstanceFromS3Request(input)
req.SetContext(ctx)
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
return out, req.Send()
}
const opRestoreDBInstanceToPointInTime = "RestoreDBInstanceToPointInTime"
// RestoreDBInstanceToPointInTimeRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
// client's request for the RestoreDBInstanceToPointInTime operation. The "output" return
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
// successfully.
//
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
//
// See RestoreDBInstanceToPointInTime for more information on using the RestoreDBInstanceToPointInTime
// API call, and error handling.
//
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
//
//
// // Example sending a request using the RestoreDBInstanceToPointInTimeRequest method.
// req, resp := client.RestoreDBInstanceToPointInTimeRequest(params)
//
// err := req.Send()
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
// fmt.Println(resp)
// }
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/RestoreDBInstanceToPointInTime
func (c *RDS) RestoreDBInstanceToPointInTimeRequest(input *RestoreDBInstanceToPointInTimeInput) (req *request.Request, output *RestoreDBInstanceToPointInTimeOutput) {
op := &request.Operation{
Name: opRestoreDBInstanceToPointInTime,
HTTPMethod: "POST",
HTTPPath: "/",
}
if input == nil {
input = &RestoreDBInstanceToPointInTimeInput{}
}
output = &RestoreDBInstanceToPointInTimeOutput{}
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
return
}
// RestoreDBInstanceToPointInTime API operation for Amazon Relational Database Service.
//
// Restores a DB instance to an arbitrary point in time. You can restore to
// any point in time before the time identified by the LatestRestorableTime
// property. You can restore to a point up to the number of days specified by
// the BackupRetentionPeriod property.
//
// The target database is created with most of the original configuration, but
// in a system-selected Availability Zone, with the default security group,
// the default subnet group, and the default DB parameter group. By default,
// the new DB instance is created as a single-AZ deployment except when the
// instance is a SQL Server instance that has an option group that is associated
// with mirroring; in this case, the instance becomes a mirrored deployment
// and not a single-AZ deployment.
//
// This command doesn't apply to Aurora MySQL and Aurora PostgreSQL. For Aurora,
// use RestoreDBClusterToPointInTime.
//
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
// the error.
//
// See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Relational Database Service's
// API operation RestoreDBInstanceToPointInTime for usage and error information.
//
// Returned Error Codes:
// * ErrCodeDBInstanceAlreadyExistsFault "DBInstanceAlreadyExists"
// The user already has a DB instance with the given identifier.
//
// * ErrCodeDBInstanceNotFoundFault "DBInstanceNotFound"
// DBInstanceIdentifier doesn't refer to an existing DB instance.
//
// * ErrCodeInstanceQuotaExceededFault "InstanceQuotaExceeded"
// The request would result in the user exceeding the allowed number of DB instances.
//
// * ErrCodeInsufficientDBInstanceCapacityFault "InsufficientDBInstanceCapacity"
// The specified DB instance class isn't available in the specified Availability
// Zone.
//
// * ErrCodeInvalidDBInstanceStateFault "InvalidDBInstanceState"
// The DB instance isn't in a valid state.
//
// * ErrCodePointInTimeRestoreNotEnabledFault "PointInTimeRestoreNotEnabled"
// SourceDBInstanceIdentifier refers to a DB instance with BackupRetentionPeriod
// equal to 0.
//
// * ErrCodeStorageQuotaExceededFault "StorageQuotaExceeded"
// The request would result in the user exceeding the allowed amount of storage
// available across all DB instances.
//
// * ErrCodeInvalidVPCNetworkStateFault "InvalidVPCNetworkStateFault"
// The DB subnet group doesn't cover all Availability Zones after it's created
// because of users' change.
//
// * ErrCodeInvalidRestoreFault "InvalidRestoreFault"
// Cannot restore from VPC backup to non-VPC DB instance.
//
// * ErrCodeDBSubnetGroupNotFoundFault "DBSubnetGroupNotFoundFault"
// DBSubnetGroupName doesn't refer to an existing DB subnet group.
//
// * ErrCodeDBSubnetGroupDoesNotCoverEnoughAZs "DBSubnetGroupDoesNotCoverEnoughAZs"
// Subnets in the DB subnet group should cover at least two Availability Zones
// unless there is only one Availability Zone.
//
// * ErrCodeInvalidSubnet "InvalidSubnet"
// The requested subnet is invalid, or multiple subnets were requested that
// are not all in a common VPC.
//
// * ErrCodeProvisionedIopsNotAvailableInAZFault "ProvisionedIopsNotAvailableInAZFault"
// Provisioned IOPS not available in the specified Availability Zone.
//
// * ErrCodeOptionGroupNotFoundFault "OptionGroupNotFoundFault"
// The specified option group could not be found.
//
// * ErrCodeStorageTypeNotSupportedFault "StorageTypeNotSupported"
// Storage of the StorageType specified can't be associated with the DB instance.
//
// * ErrCodeAuthorizationNotFoundFault "AuthorizationNotFound"
// The specified CIDRIP or Amazon EC2 security group isn't authorized for the
// specified DB security group.
//
// RDS also may not be authorized by using IAM to perform necessary actions
// on your behalf.
//
// * ErrCodeKMSKeyNotAccessibleFault "KMSKeyNotAccessibleFault"
// An error occurred accessing an AWS KMS key.
//
// * ErrCodeDBSecurityGroupNotFoundFault "DBSecurityGroupNotFound"
// DBSecurityGroupName doesn't refer to an existing DB security group.
//
// * ErrCodeDomainNotFoundFault "DomainNotFoundFault"
// Domain doesn't refer to an existing Active Directory domain.
//
// * ErrCodeBackupPolicyNotFoundFault "BackupPolicyNotFoundFault"
//
// * ErrCodeDBParameterGroupNotFoundFault "DBParameterGroupNotFound"
// DBParameterGroupName doesn't refer to an existing DB parameter group.
//
// * ErrCodeDBInstanceAutomatedBackupNotFoundFault "DBInstanceAutomatedBackupNotFound"
// No automated backup for this DB instance was found.
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/RestoreDBInstanceToPointInTime
func (c *RDS) RestoreDBInstanceToPointInTime(input *RestoreDBInstanceToPointInTimeInput) (*RestoreDBInstanceToPointInTimeOutput, error) {
req, out := c.RestoreDBInstanceToPointInTimeRequest(input)
return out, req.Send()
}
// RestoreDBInstanceToPointInTimeWithContext is the same as RestoreDBInstanceToPointInTime with the addition of
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
//
// See RestoreDBInstanceToPointInTime for details on how to use this API operation.
//
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
// for more information on using Contexts.
func (c *RDS) RestoreDBInstanceToPointInTimeWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *RestoreDBInstanceToPointInTimeInput, opts ...request.Option) (*RestoreDBInstanceToPointInTimeOutput, error) {
req, out := c.RestoreDBInstanceToPointInTimeRequest(input)
req.SetContext(ctx)
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
return out, req.Send()
}
const opRevokeDBSecurityGroupIngress = "RevokeDBSecurityGroupIngress"
// RevokeDBSecurityGroupIngressRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
// client's request for the RevokeDBSecurityGroupIngress operation. The "output" return
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
// successfully.
//
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
//
// See RevokeDBSecurityGroupIngress for more information on using the RevokeDBSecurityGroupIngress
// API call, and error handling.
//
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
//
//
// // Example sending a request using the RevokeDBSecurityGroupIngressRequest method.
// req, resp := client.RevokeDBSecurityGroupIngressRequest(params)
//
// err := req.Send()
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
// fmt.Println(resp)
// }
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/RevokeDBSecurityGroupIngress
func (c *RDS) RevokeDBSecurityGroupIngressRequest(input *RevokeDBSecurityGroupIngressInput) (req *request.Request, output *RevokeDBSecurityGroupIngressOutput) {
op := &request.Operation{
Name: opRevokeDBSecurityGroupIngress,
HTTPMethod: "POST",
HTTPPath: "/",
}
if input == nil {
input = &RevokeDBSecurityGroupIngressInput{}
}
output = &RevokeDBSecurityGroupIngressOutput{}
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
return
}
// RevokeDBSecurityGroupIngress API operation for Amazon Relational Database Service.
//
// Revokes ingress from a DBSecurityGroup for previously authorized IP ranges
// or EC2 or VPC Security Groups. Required parameters for this API are one of
// CIDRIP, EC2SecurityGroupId for VPC, or (EC2SecurityGroupOwnerId and either
// EC2SecurityGroupName or EC2SecurityGroupId).
//
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
// the error.
//
// See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Relational Database Service's
// API operation RevokeDBSecurityGroupIngress for usage and error information.
//
// Returned Error Codes:
// * ErrCodeDBSecurityGroupNotFoundFault "DBSecurityGroupNotFound"
// DBSecurityGroupName doesn't refer to an existing DB security group.
//
// * ErrCodeAuthorizationNotFoundFault "AuthorizationNotFound"
// The specified CIDRIP or Amazon EC2 security group isn't authorized for the
// specified DB security group.
//
// RDS also may not be authorized by using IAM to perform necessary actions
// on your behalf.
//
// * ErrCodeInvalidDBSecurityGroupStateFault "InvalidDBSecurityGroupState"
// The state of the DB security group doesn't allow deletion.
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/RevokeDBSecurityGroupIngress
func (c *RDS) RevokeDBSecurityGroupIngress(input *RevokeDBSecurityGroupIngressInput) (*RevokeDBSecurityGroupIngressOutput, error) {
req, out := c.RevokeDBSecurityGroupIngressRequest(input)
return out, req.Send()
}
// RevokeDBSecurityGroupIngressWithContext is the same as RevokeDBSecurityGroupIngress with the addition of
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
//
// See RevokeDBSecurityGroupIngress for details on how to use this API operation.
//
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
// for more information on using Contexts.
func (c *RDS) RevokeDBSecurityGroupIngressWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *RevokeDBSecurityGroupIngressInput, opts ...request.Option) (*RevokeDBSecurityGroupIngressOutput, error) {
req, out := c.RevokeDBSecurityGroupIngressRequest(input)
req.SetContext(ctx)
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
return out, req.Send()
}
const opStartDBCluster = "StartDBCluster"
// StartDBClusterRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
// client's request for the StartDBCluster operation. The "output" return
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
// successfully.
//
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
//
// See StartDBCluster for more information on using the StartDBCluster
// API call, and error handling.
//
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
//
//
// // Example sending a request using the StartDBClusterRequest method.
// req, resp := client.StartDBClusterRequest(params)
//
// err := req.Send()
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
// fmt.Println(resp)
// }
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/StartDBCluster
func (c *RDS) StartDBClusterRequest(input *StartDBClusterInput) (req *request.Request, output *StartDBClusterOutput) {
op := &request.Operation{
Name: opStartDBCluster,
HTTPMethod: "POST",
HTTPPath: "/",
}
if input == nil {
input = &StartDBClusterInput{}
}
output = &StartDBClusterOutput{}
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
return
}
// StartDBCluster API operation for Amazon Relational Database Service.
//
// Starts an Amazon Aurora DB cluster that was stopped using the AWS console,
// the stop-db-cluster AWS CLI command, or the StopDBCluster action.
//
// For more information, see Stopping and Starting an Aurora Cluster (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/AuroraUserGuide/aurora-cluster-stop-start.html)
// in the Amazon Aurora User Guide.
//
// This action only applies to Aurora DB clusters.
//
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
// the error.
//
// See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Relational Database Service's
// API operation StartDBCluster for usage and error information.
//
// Returned Error Codes:
// * ErrCodeDBClusterNotFoundFault "DBClusterNotFoundFault"
// DBClusterIdentifier doesn't refer to an existing DB cluster.
//
// * ErrCodeInvalidDBClusterStateFault "InvalidDBClusterStateFault"
// The requested operation can't be performed while the cluster is in this state.
//
// * ErrCodeInvalidDBInstanceStateFault "InvalidDBInstanceState"
// The DB instance isn't in a valid state.
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/StartDBCluster
func (c *RDS) StartDBCluster(input *StartDBClusterInput) (*StartDBClusterOutput, error) {
req, out := c.StartDBClusterRequest(input)
return out, req.Send()
}
// StartDBClusterWithContext is the same as StartDBCluster with the addition of
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
//
// See StartDBCluster for details on how to use this API operation.
//
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
// for more information on using Contexts.
func (c *RDS) StartDBClusterWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *StartDBClusterInput, opts ...request.Option) (*StartDBClusterOutput, error) {
req, out := c.StartDBClusterRequest(input)
req.SetContext(ctx)
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
return out, req.Send()
}
const opStartDBInstance = "StartDBInstance"
// StartDBInstanceRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
// client's request for the StartDBInstance operation. The "output" return
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
// successfully.
//
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
//
// See StartDBInstance for more information on using the StartDBInstance
// API call, and error handling.
//
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
//
//
// // Example sending a request using the StartDBInstanceRequest method.
// req, resp := client.StartDBInstanceRequest(params)
//
// err := req.Send()
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
// fmt.Println(resp)
// }
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/StartDBInstance
func (c *RDS) StartDBInstanceRequest(input *StartDBInstanceInput) (req *request.Request, output *StartDBInstanceOutput) {
op := &request.Operation{
Name: opStartDBInstance,
HTTPMethod: "POST",
HTTPPath: "/",
}
if input == nil {
input = &StartDBInstanceInput{}
}
output = &StartDBInstanceOutput{}
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
return
}
// StartDBInstance API operation for Amazon Relational Database Service.
//
// Starts an Amazon RDS DB instance that was stopped using the AWS console,
// the stop-db-instance AWS CLI command, or the StopDBInstance action.
//
// For more information, see Starting an Amazon RDS DB instance That Was Previously
// Stopped (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/UserGuide/USER_StartInstance.html)
// in the Amazon RDS User Guide.
//
// This command doesn't apply to Aurora MySQL and Aurora PostgreSQL. For Aurora
// DB clusters, use StartDBCluster instead.
//
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
// the error.
//
// See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Relational Database Service's
// API operation StartDBInstance for usage and error information.
//
// Returned Error Codes:
// * ErrCodeDBInstanceNotFoundFault "DBInstanceNotFound"
// DBInstanceIdentifier doesn't refer to an existing DB instance.
//
// * ErrCodeInvalidDBInstanceStateFault "InvalidDBInstanceState"
// The DB instance isn't in a valid state.
//
// * ErrCodeInsufficientDBInstanceCapacityFault "InsufficientDBInstanceCapacity"
// The specified DB instance class isn't available in the specified Availability
// Zone.
//
// * ErrCodeDBSubnetGroupNotFoundFault "DBSubnetGroupNotFoundFault"
// DBSubnetGroupName doesn't refer to an existing DB subnet group.
//
// * ErrCodeDBSubnetGroupDoesNotCoverEnoughAZs "DBSubnetGroupDoesNotCoverEnoughAZs"
// Subnets in the DB subnet group should cover at least two Availability Zones
// unless there is only one Availability Zone.
//
// * ErrCodeInvalidDBClusterStateFault "InvalidDBClusterStateFault"
// The requested operation can't be performed while the cluster is in this state.
//
// * ErrCodeInvalidSubnet "InvalidSubnet"
// The requested subnet is invalid, or multiple subnets were requested that
// are not all in a common VPC.
//
// * ErrCodeInvalidVPCNetworkStateFault "InvalidVPCNetworkStateFault"
// The DB subnet group doesn't cover all Availability Zones after it's created
// because of users' change.
//
// * ErrCodeDBClusterNotFoundFault "DBClusterNotFoundFault"
// DBClusterIdentifier doesn't refer to an existing DB cluster.
//
// * ErrCodeAuthorizationNotFoundFault "AuthorizationNotFound"
// The specified CIDRIP or Amazon EC2 security group isn't authorized for the
// specified DB security group.
//
// RDS also may not be authorized by using IAM to perform necessary actions
// on your behalf.
//
// * ErrCodeKMSKeyNotAccessibleFault "KMSKeyNotAccessibleFault"
// An error occurred accessing an AWS KMS key.
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/StartDBInstance
func (c *RDS) StartDBInstance(input *StartDBInstanceInput) (*StartDBInstanceOutput, error) {
req, out := c.StartDBInstanceRequest(input)
return out, req.Send()
}
// StartDBInstanceWithContext is the same as StartDBInstance with the addition of
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
//
// See StartDBInstance for details on how to use this API operation.
//
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
// for more information on using Contexts.
func (c *RDS) StartDBInstanceWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *StartDBInstanceInput, opts ...request.Option) (*StartDBInstanceOutput, error) {
req, out := c.StartDBInstanceRequest(input)
req.SetContext(ctx)
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
return out, req.Send()
}
const opStopDBCluster = "StopDBCluster"
// StopDBClusterRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
// client's request for the StopDBCluster operation. The "output" return
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
// successfully.
//
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
//
// See StopDBCluster for more information on using the StopDBCluster
// API call, and error handling.
//
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
//
//
// // Example sending a request using the StopDBClusterRequest method.
// req, resp := client.StopDBClusterRequest(params)
//
// err := req.Send()
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
// fmt.Println(resp)
// }
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/StopDBCluster
func (c *RDS) StopDBClusterRequest(input *StopDBClusterInput) (req *request.Request, output *StopDBClusterOutput) {
op := &request.Operation{
Name: opStopDBCluster,
HTTPMethod: "POST",
HTTPPath: "/",
}
if input == nil {
input = &StopDBClusterInput{}
}
output = &StopDBClusterOutput{}
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
return
}
// StopDBCluster API operation for Amazon Relational Database Service.
//
// Stops an Amazon Aurora DB cluster. When you stop a DB cluster, Aurora retains
// the DB cluster's metadata, including its endpoints and DB parameter groups.
// Aurora also retains the transaction logs so you can do a point-in-time restore
// if necessary.
//
// For more information, see Stopping and Starting an Aurora Cluster (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/AuroraUserGuide/aurora-cluster-stop-start.html)
// in the Amazon Aurora User Guide.
//
// This action only applies to Aurora DB clusters.
//
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
// the error.
//
// See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Relational Database Service's
// API operation StopDBCluster for usage and error information.
//
// Returned Error Codes:
// * ErrCodeDBClusterNotFoundFault "DBClusterNotFoundFault"
// DBClusterIdentifier doesn't refer to an existing DB cluster.
//
// * ErrCodeInvalidDBClusterStateFault "InvalidDBClusterStateFault"
// The requested operation can't be performed while the cluster is in this state.
//
// * ErrCodeInvalidDBInstanceStateFault "InvalidDBInstanceState"
// The DB instance isn't in a valid state.
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/StopDBCluster
func (c *RDS) StopDBCluster(input *StopDBClusterInput) (*StopDBClusterOutput, error) {
req, out := c.StopDBClusterRequest(input)
return out, req.Send()
}
// StopDBClusterWithContext is the same as StopDBCluster with the addition of
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
//
// See StopDBCluster for details on how to use this API operation.
//
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
// for more information on using Contexts.
func (c *RDS) StopDBClusterWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *StopDBClusterInput, opts ...request.Option) (*StopDBClusterOutput, error) {
req, out := c.StopDBClusterRequest(input)
req.SetContext(ctx)
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
return out, req.Send()
}
const opStopDBInstance = "StopDBInstance"
// StopDBInstanceRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
// client's request for the StopDBInstance operation. The "output" return
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
// successfully.
//
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
//
// See StopDBInstance for more information on using the StopDBInstance
// API call, and error handling.
//
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
//
//
// // Example sending a request using the StopDBInstanceRequest method.
// req, resp := client.StopDBInstanceRequest(params)
//
// err := req.Send()
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
// fmt.Println(resp)
// }
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/StopDBInstance
func (c *RDS) StopDBInstanceRequest(input *StopDBInstanceInput) (req *request.Request, output *StopDBInstanceOutput) {
op := &request.Operation{
Name: opStopDBInstance,
HTTPMethod: "POST",
HTTPPath: "/",
}
if input == nil {
input = &StopDBInstanceInput{}
}
output = &StopDBInstanceOutput{}
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
return
}
// StopDBInstance API operation for Amazon Relational Database Service.
//
// Stops an Amazon RDS DB instance. When you stop a DB instance, Amazon RDS
// retains the DB instance's metadata, including its endpoint, DB parameter
// group, and option group membership. Amazon RDS also retains the transaction
// logs so you can do a point-in-time restore if necessary.
//
// For more information, see Stopping an Amazon RDS DB Instance Temporarily
// (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/UserGuide/USER_StopInstance.html)
// in the Amazon RDS User Guide.
//
// This command doesn't apply to Aurora MySQL and Aurora PostgreSQL. For Aurora
// clusters, use StopDBCluster instead.
//
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
// the error.
//
// See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Relational Database Service's
// API operation StopDBInstance for usage and error information.
//
// Returned Error Codes:
// * ErrCodeDBInstanceNotFoundFault "DBInstanceNotFound"
// DBInstanceIdentifier doesn't refer to an existing DB instance.
//
// * ErrCodeInvalidDBInstanceStateFault "InvalidDBInstanceState"
// The DB instance isn't in a valid state.
//
// * ErrCodeDBSnapshotAlreadyExistsFault "DBSnapshotAlreadyExists"
// DBSnapshotIdentifier is already used by an existing snapshot.
//
// * ErrCodeSnapshotQuotaExceededFault "SnapshotQuotaExceeded"
// The request would result in the user exceeding the allowed number of DB snapshots.
//
// * ErrCodeInvalidDBClusterStateFault "InvalidDBClusterStateFault"
// The requested operation can't be performed while the cluster is in this state.
//
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/StopDBInstance
func (c *RDS) StopDBInstance(input *StopDBInstanceInput) (*StopDBInstanceOutput, error) {
req, out := c.StopDBInstanceRequest(input)
return out, req.Send()
}
// StopDBInstanceWithContext is the same as StopDBInstance with the addition of
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
//
// See StopDBInstance for details on how to use this API operation.
//
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
// for more information on using Contexts.
func (c *RDS) StopDBInstanceWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *StopDBInstanceInput, opts ...request.Option) (*StopDBInstanceOutput, error) {
req, out := c.StopDBInstanceRequest(input)
req.SetContext(ctx)
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
return out, req.Send()
}
// Describes a quota for an AWS account, for example, the number of DB instances
// allowed.
type AccountQuota struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// The name of the Amazon RDS quota for this AWS account.
AccountQuotaName *string `type:"string"`
// The maximum allowed value for the quota.
Max *int64 `type:"long"`
// The amount currently used toward the quota maximum.
Used *int64 `type:"long"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s AccountQuota) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s AccountQuota) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetAccountQuotaName sets the AccountQuotaName field's value.
func (s *AccountQuota) SetAccountQuotaName(v string) *AccountQuota {
s.AccountQuotaName = &v
return s
}
// SetMax sets the Max field's value.
func (s *AccountQuota) SetMax(v int64) *AccountQuota {
s.Max = &v
return s
}
// SetUsed sets the Used field's value.
func (s *AccountQuota) SetUsed(v int64) *AccountQuota {
s.Used = &v
return s
}
type AddRoleToDBClusterInput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// The name of the DB cluster to associate the IAM role with.
//
// DBClusterIdentifier is a required field
DBClusterIdentifier *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
// The Amazon Resource Name (ARN) of the IAM role to associate with the Aurora
// DB cluster, for example arn:aws:iam::123456789012:role/AuroraAccessRole.
//
// RoleArn is a required field
RoleArn *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s AddRoleToDBClusterInput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s AddRoleToDBClusterInput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
func (s *AddRoleToDBClusterInput) Validate() error {
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "AddRoleToDBClusterInput"}
if s.DBClusterIdentifier == nil {
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("DBClusterIdentifier"))
}
if s.RoleArn == nil {
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("RoleArn"))
}
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
return invalidParams
}
return nil
}
// SetDBClusterIdentifier sets the DBClusterIdentifier field's value.
func (s *AddRoleToDBClusterInput) SetDBClusterIdentifier(v string) *AddRoleToDBClusterInput {
s.DBClusterIdentifier = &v
return s
}
// SetRoleArn sets the RoleArn field's value.
func (s *AddRoleToDBClusterInput) SetRoleArn(v string) *AddRoleToDBClusterInput {
s.RoleArn = &v
return s
}
type AddRoleToDBClusterOutput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s AddRoleToDBClusterOutput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s AddRoleToDBClusterOutput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
type AddRoleToDBInstanceInput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// The name of the DB instance to associate the IAM role with.
//
// DBInstanceIdentifier is a required field
DBInstanceIdentifier *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
// The name of the feature for the DB instance that the IAM role is to be associated
// with. For the list of supported feature names, see DBEngineVersion.
//
// FeatureName is a required field
FeatureName *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
// The Amazon Resource Name (ARN) of the IAM role to associate with the DB instance,
// for example arn:aws:iam::123456789012:role/AccessRole.
//
// RoleArn is a required field
RoleArn *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s AddRoleToDBInstanceInput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s AddRoleToDBInstanceInput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
func (s *AddRoleToDBInstanceInput) Validate() error {
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "AddRoleToDBInstanceInput"}
if s.DBInstanceIdentifier == nil {
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("DBInstanceIdentifier"))
}
if s.FeatureName == nil {
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("FeatureName"))
}
if s.RoleArn == nil {
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("RoleArn"))
}
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
return invalidParams
}
return nil
}
// SetDBInstanceIdentifier sets the DBInstanceIdentifier field's value.
func (s *AddRoleToDBInstanceInput) SetDBInstanceIdentifier(v string) *AddRoleToDBInstanceInput {
s.DBInstanceIdentifier = &v
return s
}
// SetFeatureName sets the FeatureName field's value.
func (s *AddRoleToDBInstanceInput) SetFeatureName(v string) *AddRoleToDBInstanceInput {
s.FeatureName = &v
return s
}
// SetRoleArn sets the RoleArn field's value.
func (s *AddRoleToDBInstanceInput) SetRoleArn(v string) *AddRoleToDBInstanceInput {
s.RoleArn = &v
return s
}
type AddRoleToDBInstanceOutput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s AddRoleToDBInstanceOutput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s AddRoleToDBInstanceOutput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
type AddSourceIdentifierToSubscriptionInput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// The identifier of the event source to be added.
//
// Constraints:
//
// * If the source type is a DB instance, then a DBInstanceIdentifier must
// be supplied.
//
// * If the source type is a DB security group, a DBSecurityGroupName must
// be supplied.
//
// * If the source type is a DB parameter group, a DBParameterGroupName must
// be supplied.
//
// * If the source type is a DB snapshot, a DBSnapshotIdentifier must be
// supplied.
//
// SourceIdentifier is a required field
SourceIdentifier *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
// The name of the RDS event notification subscription you want to add a source
// identifier to.
//
// SubscriptionName is a required field
SubscriptionName *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s AddSourceIdentifierToSubscriptionInput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s AddSourceIdentifierToSubscriptionInput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
func (s *AddSourceIdentifierToSubscriptionInput) Validate() error {
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "AddSourceIdentifierToSubscriptionInput"}
if s.SourceIdentifier == nil {
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("SourceIdentifier"))
}
if s.SubscriptionName == nil {
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("SubscriptionName"))
}
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
return invalidParams
}
return nil
}
// SetSourceIdentifier sets the SourceIdentifier field's value.
func (s *AddSourceIdentifierToSubscriptionInput) SetSourceIdentifier(v string) *AddSourceIdentifierToSubscriptionInput {
s.SourceIdentifier = &v
return s
}
// SetSubscriptionName sets the SubscriptionName field's value.
func (s *AddSourceIdentifierToSubscriptionInput) SetSubscriptionName(v string) *AddSourceIdentifierToSubscriptionInput {
s.SubscriptionName = &v
return s
}
type AddSourceIdentifierToSubscriptionOutput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// Contains the results of a successful invocation of the DescribeEventSubscriptions
// action.
EventSubscription *EventSubscription `type:"structure"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s AddSourceIdentifierToSubscriptionOutput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s AddSourceIdentifierToSubscriptionOutput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetEventSubscription sets the EventSubscription field's value.
func (s *AddSourceIdentifierToSubscriptionOutput) SetEventSubscription(v *EventSubscription) *AddSourceIdentifierToSubscriptionOutput {
s.EventSubscription = v
return s
}
type AddTagsToResourceInput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// The Amazon RDS resource that the tags are added to. This value is an Amazon
// Resource Name (ARN). For information about creating an ARN, see Constructing
// an RDS Amazon Resource Name (ARN) (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/UserGuide/USER_Tagging.ARN.html#USER_Tagging.ARN.Constructing).
//
// ResourceName is a required field
ResourceName *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
// The tags to be assigned to the Amazon RDS resource.
//
// Tags is a required field
Tags []*Tag `locationNameList:"Tag" type:"list" required:"true"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s AddTagsToResourceInput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s AddTagsToResourceInput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
func (s *AddTagsToResourceInput) Validate() error {
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "AddTagsToResourceInput"}
if s.ResourceName == nil {
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("ResourceName"))
}
if s.Tags == nil {
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Tags"))
}
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
return invalidParams
}
return nil
}
// SetResourceName sets the ResourceName field's value.
func (s *AddTagsToResourceInput) SetResourceName(v string) *AddTagsToResourceInput {
s.ResourceName = &v
return s
}
// SetTags sets the Tags field's value.
func (s *AddTagsToResourceInput) SetTags(v []*Tag) *AddTagsToResourceInput {
s.Tags = v
return s
}
type AddTagsToResourceOutput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s AddTagsToResourceOutput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s AddTagsToResourceOutput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
type ApplyPendingMaintenanceActionInput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// The pending maintenance action to apply to this resource.
//
// Valid values: system-update, db-upgrade
//
// ApplyAction is a required field
ApplyAction *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
// A value that specifies the type of opt-in request, or undoes an opt-in request.
// An opt-in request of type immediate can't be undone.
//
// Valid values:
//
// * immediate - Apply the maintenance action immediately.
//
// * next-maintenance - Apply the maintenance action during the next maintenance
// window for the resource.
//
// * undo-opt-in - Cancel any existing next-maintenance opt-in requests.
//
// OptInType is a required field
OptInType *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
// The RDS Amazon Resource Name (ARN) of the resource that the pending maintenance
// action applies to. For information about creating an ARN, see Constructing
// an RDS Amazon Resource Name (ARN) (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/UserGuide/USER_Tagging.ARN.html#USER_Tagging.ARN.Constructing).
//
// ResourceIdentifier is a required field
ResourceIdentifier *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s ApplyPendingMaintenanceActionInput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s ApplyPendingMaintenanceActionInput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
func (s *ApplyPendingMaintenanceActionInput) Validate() error {
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "ApplyPendingMaintenanceActionInput"}
if s.ApplyAction == nil {
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("ApplyAction"))
}
if s.OptInType == nil {
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("OptInType"))
}
if s.ResourceIdentifier == nil {
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("ResourceIdentifier"))
}
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
return invalidParams
}
return nil
}
// SetApplyAction sets the ApplyAction field's value.
func (s *ApplyPendingMaintenanceActionInput) SetApplyAction(v string) *ApplyPendingMaintenanceActionInput {
s.ApplyAction = &v
return s
}
// SetOptInType sets the OptInType field's value.
func (s *ApplyPendingMaintenanceActionInput) SetOptInType(v string) *ApplyPendingMaintenanceActionInput {
s.OptInType = &v
return s
}
// SetResourceIdentifier sets the ResourceIdentifier field's value.
func (s *ApplyPendingMaintenanceActionInput) SetResourceIdentifier(v string) *ApplyPendingMaintenanceActionInput {
s.ResourceIdentifier = &v
return s
}
type ApplyPendingMaintenanceActionOutput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// Describes the pending maintenance actions for a resource.
ResourcePendingMaintenanceActions *ResourcePendingMaintenanceActions `type:"structure"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s ApplyPendingMaintenanceActionOutput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s ApplyPendingMaintenanceActionOutput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetResourcePendingMaintenanceActions sets the ResourcePendingMaintenanceActions field's value.
func (s *ApplyPendingMaintenanceActionOutput) SetResourcePendingMaintenanceActions(v *ResourcePendingMaintenanceActions) *ApplyPendingMaintenanceActionOutput {
s.ResourcePendingMaintenanceActions = v
return s
}
type AuthorizeDBSecurityGroupIngressInput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// The IP range to authorize.
CIDRIP *string `type:"string"`
// The name of the DB security group to add authorization to.
//
// DBSecurityGroupName is a required field
DBSecurityGroupName *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
// Id of the EC2 security group to authorize. For VPC DB security groups, EC2SecurityGroupId
// must be provided. Otherwise, EC2SecurityGroupOwnerId and either EC2SecurityGroupName
// or EC2SecurityGroupId must be provided.
EC2SecurityGroupId *string `type:"string"`
// Name of the EC2 security group to authorize. For VPC DB security groups,
// EC2SecurityGroupId must be provided. Otherwise, EC2SecurityGroupOwnerId and
// either EC2SecurityGroupName or EC2SecurityGroupId must be provided.
EC2SecurityGroupName *string `type:"string"`
// AWS account number of the owner of the EC2 security group specified in the
// EC2SecurityGroupName parameter. The AWS Access Key ID is not an acceptable
// value. For VPC DB security groups, EC2SecurityGroupId must be provided. Otherwise,
// EC2SecurityGroupOwnerId and either EC2SecurityGroupName or EC2SecurityGroupId
// must be provided.
EC2SecurityGroupOwnerId *string `type:"string"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s AuthorizeDBSecurityGroupIngressInput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s AuthorizeDBSecurityGroupIngressInput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
func (s *AuthorizeDBSecurityGroupIngressInput) Validate() error {
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "AuthorizeDBSecurityGroupIngressInput"}
if s.DBSecurityGroupName == nil {
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("DBSecurityGroupName"))
}
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
return invalidParams
}
return nil
}
// SetCIDRIP sets the CIDRIP field's value.
func (s *AuthorizeDBSecurityGroupIngressInput) SetCIDRIP(v string) *AuthorizeDBSecurityGroupIngressInput {
s.CIDRIP = &v
return s
}
// SetDBSecurityGroupName sets the DBSecurityGroupName field's value.
func (s *AuthorizeDBSecurityGroupIngressInput) SetDBSecurityGroupName(v string) *AuthorizeDBSecurityGroupIngressInput {
s.DBSecurityGroupName = &v
return s
}
// SetEC2SecurityGroupId sets the EC2SecurityGroupId field's value.
func (s *AuthorizeDBSecurityGroupIngressInput) SetEC2SecurityGroupId(v string) *AuthorizeDBSecurityGroupIngressInput {
s.EC2SecurityGroupId = &v
return s
}
// SetEC2SecurityGroupName sets the EC2SecurityGroupName field's value.
func (s *AuthorizeDBSecurityGroupIngressInput) SetEC2SecurityGroupName(v string) *AuthorizeDBSecurityGroupIngressInput {
s.EC2SecurityGroupName = &v
return s
}
// SetEC2SecurityGroupOwnerId sets the EC2SecurityGroupOwnerId field's value.
func (s *AuthorizeDBSecurityGroupIngressInput) SetEC2SecurityGroupOwnerId(v string) *AuthorizeDBSecurityGroupIngressInput {
s.EC2SecurityGroupOwnerId = &v
return s
}
type AuthorizeDBSecurityGroupIngressOutput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// Contains the details for an Amazon RDS DB security group.
//
// This data type is used as a response element in the DescribeDBSecurityGroups
// action.
DBSecurityGroup *DBSecurityGroup `type:"structure"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s AuthorizeDBSecurityGroupIngressOutput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s AuthorizeDBSecurityGroupIngressOutput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetDBSecurityGroup sets the DBSecurityGroup field's value.
func (s *AuthorizeDBSecurityGroupIngressOutput) SetDBSecurityGroup(v *DBSecurityGroup) *AuthorizeDBSecurityGroupIngressOutput {
s.DBSecurityGroup = v
return s
}
// Contains Availability Zone information.
//
// This data type is used as an element in the following data type:
//
// * OrderableDBInstanceOption
type AvailabilityZone struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// The name of the Availability Zone.
Name *string `type:"string"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s AvailabilityZone) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s AvailabilityZone) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetName sets the Name field's value.
func (s *AvailabilityZone) SetName(v string) *AvailabilityZone {
s.Name = &v
return s
}
// Contains the available processor feature information for the DB instance
// class of a DB instance.
//
// For more information, see Configuring the Processor of the DB Instance Class
// (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/UserGuide/Concepts.DBInstanceClass.html#USER_ConfigureProcessor)
// in the Amazon RDS User Guide.
type AvailableProcessorFeature struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// The allowed values for the processor feature of the DB instance class.
AllowedValues *string `type:"string"`
// The default value for the processor feature of the DB instance class.
DefaultValue *string `type:"string"`
// The name of the processor feature. Valid names are coreCount and threadsPerCore.
Name *string `type:"string"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s AvailableProcessorFeature) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s AvailableProcessorFeature) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetAllowedValues sets the AllowedValues field's value.
func (s *AvailableProcessorFeature) SetAllowedValues(v string) *AvailableProcessorFeature {
s.AllowedValues = &v
return s
}
// SetDefaultValue sets the DefaultValue field's value.
func (s *AvailableProcessorFeature) SetDefaultValue(v string) *AvailableProcessorFeature {
s.DefaultValue = &v
return s
}
// SetName sets the Name field's value.
func (s *AvailableProcessorFeature) SetName(v string) *AvailableProcessorFeature {
s.Name = &v
return s
}
type BacktrackDBClusterInput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// The timestamp of the time to backtrack the DB cluster to, specified in ISO
// 8601 format. For more information about ISO 8601, see the ISO8601 Wikipedia
// page. (http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/ISO_8601)
//
// If the specified time is not a consistent time for the DB cluster, Aurora
// automatically chooses the nearest possible consistent time for the DB cluster.
//
// Constraints:
//
// * Must contain a valid ISO 8601 timestamp.
//
// * Can't contain a timestamp set in the future.
//
// Example: 2017-07-08T18:00Z
//
// BacktrackTo is a required field
BacktrackTo *time.Time `type:"timestamp" required:"true"`
// The DB cluster identifier of the DB cluster to be backtracked. This parameter
// is stored as a lowercase string.
//
// Constraints:
//
// * Must contain from 1 to 63 alphanumeric characters or hyphens.
//
// * First character must be a letter.
//
// * Can't end with a hyphen or contain two consecutive hyphens.
//
// Example: my-cluster1
//
// DBClusterIdentifier is a required field
DBClusterIdentifier *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
// A value that, if specified, forces the DB cluster to backtrack when binary
// logging is enabled. Otherwise, an error occurs when binary logging is enabled.
Force *bool `type:"boolean"`
// If BacktrackTo is set to a timestamp earlier than the earliest backtrack
// time, this value backtracks the DB cluster to the earliest possible backtrack
// time. Otherwise, an error occurs.
UseEarliestTimeOnPointInTimeUnavailable *bool `type:"boolean"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s BacktrackDBClusterInput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s BacktrackDBClusterInput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
func (s *BacktrackDBClusterInput) Validate() error {
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "BacktrackDBClusterInput"}
if s.BacktrackTo == nil {
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("BacktrackTo"))
}
if s.DBClusterIdentifier == nil {
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("DBClusterIdentifier"))
}
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
return invalidParams
}
return nil
}
// SetBacktrackTo sets the BacktrackTo field's value.
func (s *BacktrackDBClusterInput) SetBacktrackTo(v time.Time) *BacktrackDBClusterInput {
s.BacktrackTo = &v
return s
}
// SetDBClusterIdentifier sets the DBClusterIdentifier field's value.
func (s *BacktrackDBClusterInput) SetDBClusterIdentifier(v string) *BacktrackDBClusterInput {
s.DBClusterIdentifier = &v
return s
}
// SetForce sets the Force field's value.
func (s *BacktrackDBClusterInput) SetForce(v bool) *BacktrackDBClusterInput {
s.Force = &v
return s
}
// SetUseEarliestTimeOnPointInTimeUnavailable sets the UseEarliestTimeOnPointInTimeUnavailable field's value.
func (s *BacktrackDBClusterInput) SetUseEarliestTimeOnPointInTimeUnavailable(v bool) *BacktrackDBClusterInput {
s.UseEarliestTimeOnPointInTimeUnavailable = &v
return s
}
// This data type is used as a response element in the DescribeDBClusterBacktracks
// action.
type BacktrackDBClusterOutput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// Contains the backtrack identifier.
BacktrackIdentifier *string `type:"string"`
// The timestamp of the time at which the backtrack was requested.
BacktrackRequestCreationTime *time.Time `type:"timestamp"`
// The timestamp of the time to which the DB cluster was backtracked.
BacktrackTo *time.Time `type:"timestamp"`
// The timestamp of the time from which the DB cluster was backtracked.
BacktrackedFrom *time.Time `type:"timestamp"`
// Contains a user-supplied DB cluster identifier. This identifier is the unique
// key that identifies a DB cluster.
DBClusterIdentifier *string `type:"string"`
// The status of the backtrack. This property returns one of the following values:
//
// * applying - The backtrack is currently being applied to or rolled back
// from the DB cluster.
//
// * completed - The backtrack has successfully been applied to or rolled
// back from the DB cluster.
//
// * failed - An error occurred while the backtrack was applied to or rolled
// back from the DB cluster.
//
// * pending - The backtrack is currently pending application to or rollback
// from the DB cluster.
Status *string `type:"string"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s BacktrackDBClusterOutput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s BacktrackDBClusterOutput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetBacktrackIdentifier sets the BacktrackIdentifier field's value.
func (s *BacktrackDBClusterOutput) SetBacktrackIdentifier(v string) *BacktrackDBClusterOutput {
s.BacktrackIdentifier = &v
return s
}
// SetBacktrackRequestCreationTime sets the BacktrackRequestCreationTime field's value.
func (s *BacktrackDBClusterOutput) SetBacktrackRequestCreationTime(v time.Time) *BacktrackDBClusterOutput {
s.BacktrackRequestCreationTime = &v
return s
}
// SetBacktrackTo sets the BacktrackTo field's value.
func (s *BacktrackDBClusterOutput) SetBacktrackTo(v time.Time) *BacktrackDBClusterOutput {
s.BacktrackTo = &v
return s
}
// SetBacktrackedFrom sets the BacktrackedFrom field's value.
func (s *BacktrackDBClusterOutput) SetBacktrackedFrom(v time.Time) *BacktrackDBClusterOutput {
s.BacktrackedFrom = &v
return s
}
// SetDBClusterIdentifier sets the DBClusterIdentifier field's value.
func (s *BacktrackDBClusterOutput) SetDBClusterIdentifier(v string) *BacktrackDBClusterOutput {
s.DBClusterIdentifier = &v
return s
}
// SetStatus sets the Status field's value.
func (s *BacktrackDBClusterOutput) SetStatus(v string) *BacktrackDBClusterOutput {
s.Status = &v
return s
}
// A CA certificate for an AWS account.
type Certificate struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// The Amazon Resource Name (ARN) for the certificate.
CertificateArn *string `type:"string"`
// The unique key that identifies a certificate.
CertificateIdentifier *string `type:"string"`
// The type of the certificate.
CertificateType *string `type:"string"`
// The thumbprint of the certificate.
Thumbprint *string `type:"string"`
// The starting date from which the certificate is valid.
ValidFrom *time.Time `type:"timestamp"`
// The final date that the certificate continues to be valid.
ValidTill *time.Time `type:"timestamp"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s Certificate) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s Certificate) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetCertificateArn sets the CertificateArn field's value.
func (s *Certificate) SetCertificateArn(v string) *Certificate {
s.CertificateArn = &v
return s
}
// SetCertificateIdentifier sets the CertificateIdentifier field's value.
func (s *Certificate) SetCertificateIdentifier(v string) *Certificate {
s.CertificateIdentifier = &v
return s
}
// SetCertificateType sets the CertificateType field's value.
func (s *Certificate) SetCertificateType(v string) *Certificate {
s.CertificateType = &v
return s
}
// SetThumbprint sets the Thumbprint field's value.
func (s *Certificate) SetThumbprint(v string) *Certificate {
s.Thumbprint = &v
return s
}
// SetValidFrom sets the ValidFrom field's value.
func (s *Certificate) SetValidFrom(v time.Time) *Certificate {
s.ValidFrom = &v
return s
}
// SetValidTill sets the ValidTill field's value.
func (s *Certificate) SetValidTill(v time.Time) *Certificate {
s.ValidTill = &v
return s
}
// This data type is used as a response element in the action DescribeDBEngineVersions.
type CharacterSet struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// The description of the character set.
CharacterSetDescription *string `type:"string"`
// The name of the character set.
CharacterSetName *string `type:"string"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s CharacterSet) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s CharacterSet) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetCharacterSetDescription sets the CharacterSetDescription field's value.
func (s *CharacterSet) SetCharacterSetDescription(v string) *CharacterSet {
s.CharacterSetDescription = &v
return s
}
// SetCharacterSetName sets the CharacterSetName field's value.
func (s *CharacterSet) SetCharacterSetName(v string) *CharacterSet {
s.CharacterSetName = &v
return s
}
// The configuration setting for the log types to be enabled for export to CloudWatch
// Logs for a specific DB instance or DB cluster.
//
// The EnableLogTypes and DisableLogTypes arrays determine which logs will be
// exported (or not exported) to CloudWatch Logs. The values within these arrays
// depend on the DB engine being used. For more information, see Publishing
// Database Logs to Amazon CloudWatch Logs (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/UserGuide/USER_LogAccess.html#USER_LogAccess.Procedural.UploadtoCloudWatch)
// in the Amazon RDS User Guide.
type CloudwatchLogsExportConfiguration struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// The list of log types to disable.
DisableLogTypes []*string `type:"list"`
// The list of log types to enable.
EnableLogTypes []*string `type:"list"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s CloudwatchLogsExportConfiguration) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s CloudwatchLogsExportConfiguration) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetDisableLogTypes sets the DisableLogTypes field's value.
func (s *CloudwatchLogsExportConfiguration) SetDisableLogTypes(v []*string) *CloudwatchLogsExportConfiguration {
s.DisableLogTypes = v
return s
}
// SetEnableLogTypes sets the EnableLogTypes field's value.
func (s *CloudwatchLogsExportConfiguration) SetEnableLogTypes(v []*string) *CloudwatchLogsExportConfiguration {
s.EnableLogTypes = v
return s
}
type CopyDBClusterParameterGroupInput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// The identifier or Amazon Resource Name (ARN) for the source DB cluster parameter
// group. For information about creating an ARN, see Constructing an ARN for
// Amazon RDS (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/AuroraUserGuide/USER_Tagging.ARN.html#USER_Tagging.ARN.Constructing)
// in the Amazon Aurora User Guide.
//
// Constraints:
//
// * Must specify a valid DB cluster parameter group.
//
// * If the source DB cluster parameter group is in the same AWS Region as
// the copy, specify a valid DB parameter group identifier, for example my-db-cluster-param-group,
// or a valid ARN.
//
// * If the source DB parameter group is in a different AWS Region than the
// copy, specify a valid DB cluster parameter group ARN, for example arn:aws:rds:us-east-1:123456789012:cluster-pg:custom-cluster-group1.
//
// SourceDBClusterParameterGroupIdentifier is a required field
SourceDBClusterParameterGroupIdentifier *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
// A list of tags. For more information, see Tagging Amazon RDS Resources (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/UserGuide/USER_Tagging.html)
// in the Amazon RDS User Guide.
Tags []*Tag `locationNameList:"Tag" type:"list"`
// A description for the copied DB cluster parameter group.
//
// TargetDBClusterParameterGroupDescription is a required field
TargetDBClusterParameterGroupDescription *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
// The identifier for the copied DB cluster parameter group.
//
// Constraints:
//
// * Can't be null, empty, or blank
//
// * Must contain from 1 to 255 letters, numbers, or hyphens
//
// * First character must be a letter
//
// * Can't end with a hyphen or contain two consecutive hyphens
//
// Example: my-cluster-param-group1
//
// TargetDBClusterParameterGroupIdentifier is a required field
TargetDBClusterParameterGroupIdentifier *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s CopyDBClusterParameterGroupInput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s CopyDBClusterParameterGroupInput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
func (s *CopyDBClusterParameterGroupInput) Validate() error {
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "CopyDBClusterParameterGroupInput"}
if s.SourceDBClusterParameterGroupIdentifier == nil {
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("SourceDBClusterParameterGroupIdentifier"))
}
if s.TargetDBClusterParameterGroupDescription == nil {
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("TargetDBClusterParameterGroupDescription"))
}
if s.TargetDBClusterParameterGroupIdentifier == nil {
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("TargetDBClusterParameterGroupIdentifier"))
}
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
return invalidParams
}
return nil
}
// SetSourceDBClusterParameterGroupIdentifier sets the SourceDBClusterParameterGroupIdentifier field's value.
func (s *CopyDBClusterParameterGroupInput) SetSourceDBClusterParameterGroupIdentifier(v string) *CopyDBClusterParameterGroupInput {
s.SourceDBClusterParameterGroupIdentifier = &v
return s
}
// SetTags sets the Tags field's value.
func (s *CopyDBClusterParameterGroupInput) SetTags(v []*Tag) *CopyDBClusterParameterGroupInput {
s.Tags = v
return s
}
// SetTargetDBClusterParameterGroupDescription sets the TargetDBClusterParameterGroupDescription field's value.
func (s *CopyDBClusterParameterGroupInput) SetTargetDBClusterParameterGroupDescription(v string) *CopyDBClusterParameterGroupInput {
s.TargetDBClusterParameterGroupDescription = &v
return s
}
// SetTargetDBClusterParameterGroupIdentifier sets the TargetDBClusterParameterGroupIdentifier field's value.
func (s *CopyDBClusterParameterGroupInput) SetTargetDBClusterParameterGroupIdentifier(v string) *CopyDBClusterParameterGroupInput {
s.TargetDBClusterParameterGroupIdentifier = &v
return s
}
type CopyDBClusterParameterGroupOutput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// Contains the details of an Amazon RDS DB cluster parameter group.
//
// This data type is used as a response element in the DescribeDBClusterParameterGroups
// action.
DBClusterParameterGroup *DBClusterParameterGroup `type:"structure"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s CopyDBClusterParameterGroupOutput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s CopyDBClusterParameterGroupOutput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetDBClusterParameterGroup sets the DBClusterParameterGroup field's value.
func (s *CopyDBClusterParameterGroupOutput) SetDBClusterParameterGroup(v *DBClusterParameterGroup) *CopyDBClusterParameterGroupOutput {
s.DBClusterParameterGroup = v
return s
}
type CopyDBClusterSnapshotInput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// True to copy all tags from the source DB cluster snapshot to the target DB
// cluster snapshot, and otherwise false. The default is false.
CopyTags *bool `type:"boolean"`
// DestinationRegion is used for presigning the request to a given region.
DestinationRegion *string `type:"string"`
// The AWS AWS KMS key ID for an encrypted DB cluster snapshot. The KMS key
// ID is the Amazon Resource Name (ARN), KMS key identifier, or the KMS key
// alias for the KMS encryption key.
//
// If you copy an encrypted DB cluster snapshot from your AWS account, you can
// specify a value for KmsKeyId to encrypt the copy with a new KMS encryption
// key. If you don't specify a value for KmsKeyId, then the copy of the DB cluster
// snapshot is encrypted with the same KMS key as the source DB cluster snapshot.
//
// If you copy an encrypted DB cluster snapshot that is shared from another
// AWS account, then you must specify a value for KmsKeyId.
//
// To copy an encrypted DB cluster snapshot to another AWS Region, you must
// set KmsKeyId to the KMS key ID you want to use to encrypt the copy of the
// DB cluster snapshot in the destination AWS Region. KMS encryption keys are
// specific to the AWS Region that they are created in, and you can't use encryption
// keys from one AWS Region in another AWS Region.
//
// If you copy an unencrypted DB cluster snapshot and specify a value for the
// KmsKeyId parameter, an error is returned.
KmsKeyId *string `type:"string"`
// The URL that contains a Signature Version 4 signed request for the CopyDBClusterSnapshot
// API action in the AWS Region that contains the source DB cluster snapshot
// to copy. The PreSignedUrl parameter must be used when copying an encrypted
// DB cluster snapshot from another AWS Region.
//
// The pre-signed URL must be a valid request for the CopyDBSClusterSnapshot
// API action that can be executed in the source AWS Region that contains the
// encrypted DB cluster snapshot to be copied. The pre-signed URL request must
// contain the following parameter values:
//
// * KmsKeyId - The AWS KMS key identifier for the key to use to encrypt
// the copy of the DB cluster snapshot in the destination AWS Region. This
// is the same identifier for both the CopyDBClusterSnapshot action that
// is called in the destination AWS Region, and the action contained in the
// pre-signed URL.
//
// * DestinationRegion - The name of the AWS Region that the DB cluster snapshot
// will be created in.
//
// * SourceDBClusterSnapshotIdentifier - The DB cluster snapshot identifier
// for the encrypted DB cluster snapshot to be copied. This identifier must
// be in the Amazon Resource Name (ARN) format for the source AWS Region.
// For example, if you are copying an encrypted DB cluster snapshot from
// the us-west-2 AWS Region, then your SourceDBClusterSnapshotIdentifier
// looks like the following example: arn:aws:rds:us-west-2:123456789012:cluster-snapshot:aurora-cluster1-snapshot-20161115.
//
// To learn how to generate a Signature Version 4 signed request, see Authenticating
// Requests: Using Query Parameters (AWS Signature Version 4) (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonS3/latest/API/sigv4-query-string-auth.html)
// and Signature Version 4 Signing Process (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/general/latest/gr/signature-version-4.html).
PreSignedUrl *string `type:"string"`
// The identifier of the DB cluster snapshot to copy. This parameter is not
// case-sensitive.
//
// You can't copy an encrypted, shared DB cluster snapshot from one AWS Region
// to another.
//
// Constraints:
//
// * Must specify a valid system snapshot in the "available" state.
//
// * If the source snapshot is in the same AWS Region as the copy, specify
// a valid DB snapshot identifier.
//
// * If the source snapshot is in a different AWS Region than the copy, specify
// a valid DB cluster snapshot ARN. For more information, go to Copying
// Snapshots Across AWS Regions (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/AuroraUserGuide/USER_CopySnapshot.html#USER_CopySnapshot.AcrossRegions)
// in the Amazon Aurora User Guide.
//
// Example: my-cluster-snapshot1
//
// SourceDBClusterSnapshotIdentifier is a required field
SourceDBClusterSnapshotIdentifier *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
// SourceRegion is the source region where the resource exists. This is not
// sent over the wire and is only used for presigning. This value should always
// have the same region as the source ARN.
SourceRegion *string `type:"string" ignore:"true"`
// A list of tags. For more information, see Tagging Amazon RDS Resources (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/UserGuide/USER_Tagging.html)
// in the Amazon RDS User Guide.
Tags []*Tag `locationNameList:"Tag" type:"list"`
// The identifier of the new DB cluster snapshot to create from the source DB
// cluster snapshot. This parameter is not case-sensitive.
//
// Constraints:
//
// * Must contain from 1 to 63 letters, numbers, or hyphens.
//
// * First character must be a letter.
//
// * Can't end with a hyphen or contain two consecutive hyphens.
//
// Example: my-cluster-snapshot2
//
// TargetDBClusterSnapshotIdentifier is a required field
TargetDBClusterSnapshotIdentifier *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s CopyDBClusterSnapshotInput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s CopyDBClusterSnapshotInput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
func (s *CopyDBClusterSnapshotInput) Validate() error {
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "CopyDBClusterSnapshotInput"}
if s.SourceDBClusterSnapshotIdentifier == nil {
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("SourceDBClusterSnapshotIdentifier"))
}
if s.TargetDBClusterSnapshotIdentifier == nil {
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("TargetDBClusterSnapshotIdentifier"))
}
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
return invalidParams
}
return nil
}
// SetCopyTags sets the CopyTags field's value.
func (s *CopyDBClusterSnapshotInput) SetCopyTags(v bool) *CopyDBClusterSnapshotInput {
s.CopyTags = &v
return s
}
// SetDestinationRegion sets the DestinationRegion field's value.
func (s *CopyDBClusterSnapshotInput) SetDestinationRegion(v string) *CopyDBClusterSnapshotInput {
s.DestinationRegion = &v
return s
}
// SetKmsKeyId sets the KmsKeyId field's value.
func (s *CopyDBClusterSnapshotInput) SetKmsKeyId(v string) *CopyDBClusterSnapshotInput {
s.KmsKeyId = &v
return s
}
// SetPreSignedUrl sets the PreSignedUrl field's value.
func (s *CopyDBClusterSnapshotInput) SetPreSignedUrl(v string) *CopyDBClusterSnapshotInput {
s.PreSignedUrl = &v
return s
}
// SetSourceDBClusterSnapshotIdentifier sets the SourceDBClusterSnapshotIdentifier field's value.
func (s *CopyDBClusterSnapshotInput) SetSourceDBClusterSnapshotIdentifier(v string) *CopyDBClusterSnapshotInput {
s.SourceDBClusterSnapshotIdentifier = &v
return s
}
// SetSourceRegion sets the SourceRegion field's value.
func (s *CopyDBClusterSnapshotInput) SetSourceRegion(v string) *CopyDBClusterSnapshotInput {
s.SourceRegion = &v
return s
}
// SetTags sets the Tags field's value.
func (s *CopyDBClusterSnapshotInput) SetTags(v []*Tag) *CopyDBClusterSnapshotInput {
s.Tags = v
return s
}
// SetTargetDBClusterSnapshotIdentifier sets the TargetDBClusterSnapshotIdentifier field's value.
func (s *CopyDBClusterSnapshotInput) SetTargetDBClusterSnapshotIdentifier(v string) *CopyDBClusterSnapshotInput {
s.TargetDBClusterSnapshotIdentifier = &v
return s
}
type CopyDBClusterSnapshotOutput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// Contains the details for an Amazon RDS DB cluster snapshot
//
// This data type is used as a response element in the DescribeDBClusterSnapshots
// action.
DBClusterSnapshot *DBClusterSnapshot `type:"structure"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s CopyDBClusterSnapshotOutput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s CopyDBClusterSnapshotOutput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetDBClusterSnapshot sets the DBClusterSnapshot field's value.
func (s *CopyDBClusterSnapshotOutput) SetDBClusterSnapshot(v *DBClusterSnapshot) *CopyDBClusterSnapshotOutput {
s.DBClusterSnapshot = v
return s
}
type CopyDBParameterGroupInput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// The identifier or ARN for the source DB parameter group. For information
// about creating an ARN, see Constructing an ARN for Amazon RDS (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/UserGuide/USER_Tagging.ARN.html#USER_Tagging.ARN.Constructing)
// in the Amazon RDS User Guide.
//
// Constraints:
//
// * Must specify a valid DB parameter group.
//
// * Must specify a valid DB parameter group identifier, for example my-db-param-group,
// or a valid ARN.
//
// SourceDBParameterGroupIdentifier is a required field
SourceDBParameterGroupIdentifier *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
// A list of tags. For more information, see Tagging Amazon RDS Resources (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/UserGuide/USER_Tagging.html)
// in the Amazon RDS User Guide.
Tags []*Tag `locationNameList:"Tag" type:"list"`
// A description for the copied DB parameter group.
//
// TargetDBParameterGroupDescription is a required field
TargetDBParameterGroupDescription *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
// The identifier for the copied DB parameter group.
//
// Constraints:
//
// * Can't be null, empty, or blank
//
// * Must contain from 1 to 255 letters, numbers, or hyphens
//
// * First character must be a letter
//
// * Can't end with a hyphen or contain two consecutive hyphens
//
// Example: my-db-parameter-group
//
// TargetDBParameterGroupIdentifier is a required field
TargetDBParameterGroupIdentifier *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s CopyDBParameterGroupInput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s CopyDBParameterGroupInput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
func (s *CopyDBParameterGroupInput) Validate() error {
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "CopyDBParameterGroupInput"}
if s.SourceDBParameterGroupIdentifier == nil {
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("SourceDBParameterGroupIdentifier"))
}
if s.TargetDBParameterGroupDescription == nil {
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("TargetDBParameterGroupDescription"))
}
if s.TargetDBParameterGroupIdentifier == nil {
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("TargetDBParameterGroupIdentifier"))
}
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
return invalidParams
}
return nil
}
// SetSourceDBParameterGroupIdentifier sets the SourceDBParameterGroupIdentifier field's value.
func (s *CopyDBParameterGroupInput) SetSourceDBParameterGroupIdentifier(v string) *CopyDBParameterGroupInput {
s.SourceDBParameterGroupIdentifier = &v
return s
}
// SetTags sets the Tags field's value.
func (s *CopyDBParameterGroupInput) SetTags(v []*Tag) *CopyDBParameterGroupInput {
s.Tags = v
return s
}
// SetTargetDBParameterGroupDescription sets the TargetDBParameterGroupDescription field's value.
func (s *CopyDBParameterGroupInput) SetTargetDBParameterGroupDescription(v string) *CopyDBParameterGroupInput {
s.TargetDBParameterGroupDescription = &v
return s
}
// SetTargetDBParameterGroupIdentifier sets the TargetDBParameterGroupIdentifier field's value.
func (s *CopyDBParameterGroupInput) SetTargetDBParameterGroupIdentifier(v string) *CopyDBParameterGroupInput {
s.TargetDBParameterGroupIdentifier = &v
return s
}
type CopyDBParameterGroupOutput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// Contains the details of an Amazon RDS DB parameter group.
//
// This data type is used as a response element in the DescribeDBParameterGroups
// action.
DBParameterGroup *DBParameterGroup `type:"structure"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s CopyDBParameterGroupOutput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s CopyDBParameterGroupOutput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetDBParameterGroup sets the DBParameterGroup field's value.
func (s *CopyDBParameterGroupOutput) SetDBParameterGroup(v *DBParameterGroup) *CopyDBParameterGroupOutput {
s.DBParameterGroup = v
return s
}
type CopyDBSnapshotInput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// True to copy all tags from the source DB snapshot to the target DB snapshot,
// and otherwise false. The default is false.
CopyTags *bool `type:"boolean"`
// DestinationRegion is used for presigning the request to a given region.
DestinationRegion *string `type:"string"`
// The AWS KMS key ID for an encrypted DB snapshot. The KMS key ID is the Amazon
// Resource Name (ARN), KMS key identifier, or the KMS key alias for the KMS
// encryption key.
//
// If you copy an encrypted DB snapshot from your AWS account, you can specify
// a value for this parameter to encrypt the copy with a new KMS encryption
// key. If you don't specify a value for this parameter, then the copy of the
// DB snapshot is encrypted with the same KMS key as the source DB snapshot.
//
// If you copy an encrypted DB snapshot that is shared from another AWS account,
// then you must specify a value for this parameter.
//
// If you specify this parameter when you copy an unencrypted snapshot, the
// copy is encrypted.
//
// If you copy an encrypted snapshot to a different AWS Region, then you must
// specify a KMS key for the destination AWS Region. KMS encryption keys are
// specific to the AWS Region that they are created in, and you can't use encryption
// keys from one AWS Region in another AWS Region.
KmsKeyId *string `type:"string"`
// The name of an option group to associate with the copy of the snapshot.
//
// Specify this option if you are copying a snapshot from one AWS Region to
// another, and your DB instance uses a nondefault option group. If your source
// DB instance uses Transparent Data Encryption for Oracle or Microsoft SQL
// Server, you must specify this option when copying across AWS Regions. For
// more information, see Option Group Considerations (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/UserGuide/USER_CopySnapshot.html#USER_CopySnapshot.Options)
// in the Amazon RDS User Guide.
OptionGroupName *string `type:"string"`
// The URL that contains a Signature Version 4 signed request for the CopyDBSnapshot
// API action in the source AWS Region that contains the source DB snapshot
// to copy.
//
// You must specify this parameter when you copy an encrypted DB snapshot from
// another AWS Region by using the Amazon RDS API. You can specify the --source-region
// option instead of this parameter when you copy an encrypted DB snapshot from
// another AWS Region by using the AWS CLI.
//
// The presigned URL must be a valid request for the CopyDBSnapshot API action
// that can be executed in the source AWS Region that contains the encrypted
// DB snapshot to be copied. The presigned URL request must contain the following
// parameter values:
//
// * DestinationRegion - The AWS Region that the encrypted DB snapshot is
// copied to. This AWS Region is the same one where the CopyDBSnapshot action
// is called that contains this presigned URL.
//
// For example, if you copy an encrypted DB snapshot from the us-west-2 AWS
// Region to the us-east-1 AWS Region, then you call the CopyDBSnapshot action
// in the us-east-1 AWS Region and provide a presigned URL that contains
// a call to the CopyDBSnapshot action in the us-west-2 AWS Region. For this
// example, the DestinationRegion in the presigned URL must be set to the
// us-east-1 AWS Region.
//
// * KmsKeyId - The AWS KMS key identifier for the key to use to encrypt
// the copy of the DB snapshot in the destination AWS Region. This is the
// same identifier for both the CopyDBSnapshot action that is called in the
// destination AWS Region, and the action contained in the presigned URL.
//
//
// * SourceDBSnapshotIdentifier - The DB snapshot identifier for the encrypted
// snapshot to be copied. This identifier must be in the Amazon Resource
// Name (ARN) format for the source AWS Region. For example, if you are copying
// an encrypted DB snapshot from the us-west-2 AWS Region, then your SourceDBSnapshotIdentifier
// looks like the following example: arn:aws:rds:us-west-2:123456789012:snapshot:mysql-instance1-snapshot-20161115.
//
//
// To learn how to generate a Signature Version 4 signed request, see Authenticating
// Requests: Using Query Parameters (AWS Signature Version 4) (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonS3/latest/API/sigv4-query-string-auth.html)
// and Signature Version 4 Signing Process (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/general/latest/gr/signature-version-4.html).
PreSignedUrl *string `type:"string"`
// The identifier for the source DB snapshot.
//
// If the source snapshot is in the same AWS Region as the copy, specify a valid
// DB snapshot identifier. For example, you might specify rds:mysql-instance1-snapshot-20130805.
//
// If the source snapshot is in a different AWS Region than the copy, specify
// a valid DB snapshot ARN. For example, you might specify arn:aws:rds:us-west-2:123456789012:snapshot:mysql-instance1-snapshot-20130805.
//
// If you are copying from a shared manual DB snapshot, this parameter must
// be the Amazon Resource Name (ARN) of the shared DB snapshot.
//
// If you are copying an encrypted snapshot this parameter must be in the ARN
// format for the source AWS Region, and must match the SourceDBSnapshotIdentifier
// in the PreSignedUrl parameter.
//
// Constraints:
//
// * Must specify a valid system snapshot in the "available" state.
//
// Example: rds:mydb-2012-04-02-00-01
//
// Example: arn:aws:rds:us-west-2:123456789012:snapshot:mysql-instance1-snapshot-20130805
//
// SourceDBSnapshotIdentifier is a required field
SourceDBSnapshotIdentifier *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
// SourceRegion is the source region where the resource exists. This is not
// sent over the wire and is only used for presigning. This value should always
// have the same region as the source ARN.
SourceRegion *string `type:"string" ignore:"true"`
// A list of tags. For more information, see Tagging Amazon RDS Resources (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/UserGuide/USER_Tagging.html)
// in the Amazon RDS User Guide.
Tags []*Tag `locationNameList:"Tag" type:"list"`
// The identifier for the copy of the snapshot.
//
// Constraints:
//
// * Can't be null, empty, or blank
//
// * Must contain from 1 to 255 letters, numbers, or hyphens
//
// * First character must be a letter
//
// * Can't end with a hyphen or contain two consecutive hyphens
//
// Example: my-db-snapshot
//
// TargetDBSnapshotIdentifier is a required field
TargetDBSnapshotIdentifier *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s CopyDBSnapshotInput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s CopyDBSnapshotInput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
func (s *CopyDBSnapshotInput) Validate() error {
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "CopyDBSnapshotInput"}
if s.SourceDBSnapshotIdentifier == nil {
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("SourceDBSnapshotIdentifier"))
}
if s.TargetDBSnapshotIdentifier == nil {
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("TargetDBSnapshotIdentifier"))
}
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
return invalidParams
}
return nil
}
// SetCopyTags sets the CopyTags field's value.
func (s *CopyDBSnapshotInput) SetCopyTags(v bool) *CopyDBSnapshotInput {
s.CopyTags = &v
return s
}
// SetDestinationRegion sets the DestinationRegion field's value.
func (s *CopyDBSnapshotInput) SetDestinationRegion(v string) *CopyDBSnapshotInput {
s.DestinationRegion = &v
return s
}
// SetKmsKeyId sets the KmsKeyId field's value.
func (s *CopyDBSnapshotInput) SetKmsKeyId(v string) *CopyDBSnapshotInput {
s.KmsKeyId = &v
return s
}
// SetOptionGroupName sets the OptionGroupName field's value.
func (s *CopyDBSnapshotInput) SetOptionGroupName(v string) *CopyDBSnapshotInput {
s.OptionGroupName = &v
return s
}
// SetPreSignedUrl sets the PreSignedUrl field's value.
func (s *CopyDBSnapshotInput) SetPreSignedUrl(v string) *CopyDBSnapshotInput {
s.PreSignedUrl = &v
return s
}
// SetSourceDBSnapshotIdentifier sets the SourceDBSnapshotIdentifier field's value.
func (s *CopyDBSnapshotInput) SetSourceDBSnapshotIdentifier(v string) *CopyDBSnapshotInput {
s.SourceDBSnapshotIdentifier = &v
return s
}
// SetSourceRegion sets the SourceRegion field's value.
func (s *CopyDBSnapshotInput) SetSourceRegion(v string) *CopyDBSnapshotInput {
s.SourceRegion = &v
return s
}
// SetTags sets the Tags field's value.
func (s *CopyDBSnapshotInput) SetTags(v []*Tag) *CopyDBSnapshotInput {
s.Tags = v
return s
}
// SetTargetDBSnapshotIdentifier sets the TargetDBSnapshotIdentifier field's value.
func (s *CopyDBSnapshotInput) SetTargetDBSnapshotIdentifier(v string) *CopyDBSnapshotInput {
s.TargetDBSnapshotIdentifier = &v
return s
}
type CopyDBSnapshotOutput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// Contains the details of an Amazon RDS DB snapshot.
//
// This data type is used as a response element in the DescribeDBSnapshots action.
DBSnapshot *DBSnapshot `type:"structure"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s CopyDBSnapshotOutput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s CopyDBSnapshotOutput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetDBSnapshot sets the DBSnapshot field's value.
func (s *CopyDBSnapshotOutput) SetDBSnapshot(v *DBSnapshot) *CopyDBSnapshotOutput {
s.DBSnapshot = v
return s
}
type CopyOptionGroupInput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// The identifier or ARN for the source option group. For information about
// creating an ARN, see Constructing an ARN for Amazon RDS (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/UserGuide/USER_Tagging.ARN.html#USER_Tagging.ARN.Constructing)
// in the Amazon RDS User Guide.
//
// Constraints:
//
// * Must specify a valid option group.
//
// * If the source option group is in the same AWS Region as the copy, specify
// a valid option group identifier, for example my-option-group, or a valid
// ARN.
//
// * If the source option group is in a different AWS Region than the copy,
// specify a valid option group ARN, for example arn:aws:rds:us-west-2:123456789012:og:special-options.
//
// SourceOptionGroupIdentifier is a required field
SourceOptionGroupIdentifier *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
// A list of tags. For more information, see Tagging Amazon RDS Resources (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/UserGuide/USER_Tagging.html)
// in the Amazon RDS User Guide.
Tags []*Tag `locationNameList:"Tag" type:"list"`
// The description for the copied option group.
//
// TargetOptionGroupDescription is a required field
TargetOptionGroupDescription *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
// The identifier for the copied option group.
//
// Constraints:
//
// * Can't be null, empty, or blank
//
// * Must contain from 1 to 255 letters, numbers, or hyphens
//
// * First character must be a letter
//
// * Can't end with a hyphen or contain two consecutive hyphens
//
// Example: my-option-group
//
// TargetOptionGroupIdentifier is a required field
TargetOptionGroupIdentifier *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s CopyOptionGroupInput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s CopyOptionGroupInput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
func (s *CopyOptionGroupInput) Validate() error {
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "CopyOptionGroupInput"}
if s.SourceOptionGroupIdentifier == nil {
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("SourceOptionGroupIdentifier"))
}
if s.TargetOptionGroupDescription == nil {
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("TargetOptionGroupDescription"))
}
if s.TargetOptionGroupIdentifier == nil {
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("TargetOptionGroupIdentifier"))
}
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
return invalidParams
}
return nil
}
// SetSourceOptionGroupIdentifier sets the SourceOptionGroupIdentifier field's value.
func (s *CopyOptionGroupInput) SetSourceOptionGroupIdentifier(v string) *CopyOptionGroupInput {
s.SourceOptionGroupIdentifier = &v
return s
}
// SetTags sets the Tags field's value.
func (s *CopyOptionGroupInput) SetTags(v []*Tag) *CopyOptionGroupInput {
s.Tags = v
return s
}
// SetTargetOptionGroupDescription sets the TargetOptionGroupDescription field's value.
func (s *CopyOptionGroupInput) SetTargetOptionGroupDescription(v string) *CopyOptionGroupInput {
s.TargetOptionGroupDescription = &v
return s
}
// SetTargetOptionGroupIdentifier sets the TargetOptionGroupIdentifier field's value.
func (s *CopyOptionGroupInput) SetTargetOptionGroupIdentifier(v string) *CopyOptionGroupInput {
s.TargetOptionGroupIdentifier = &v
return s
}
type CopyOptionGroupOutput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
OptionGroup *OptionGroup `type:"structure"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s CopyOptionGroupOutput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s CopyOptionGroupOutput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetOptionGroup sets the OptionGroup field's value.
func (s *CopyOptionGroupOutput) SetOptionGroup(v *OptionGroup) *CopyOptionGroupOutput {
s.OptionGroup = v
return s
}
type CreateDBClusterEndpointInput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// The identifier to use for the new endpoint. This parameter is stored as a
// lowercase string.
//
// DBClusterEndpointIdentifier is a required field
DBClusterEndpointIdentifier *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
// The DB cluster identifier of the DB cluster associated with the endpoint.
// This parameter is stored as a lowercase string.
//
// DBClusterIdentifier is a required field
DBClusterIdentifier *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
// The type of the endpoint. One of: READER, ANY.
//
// EndpointType is a required field
EndpointType *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
// List of DB instance identifiers that aren't part of the custom endpoint group.
// All other eligible instances are reachable through the custom endpoint. Only
// relevant if the list of static members is empty.
ExcludedMembers []*string `type:"list"`
// List of DB instance identifiers that are part of the custom endpoint group.
StaticMembers []*string `type:"list"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s CreateDBClusterEndpointInput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s CreateDBClusterEndpointInput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
func (s *CreateDBClusterEndpointInput) Validate() error {
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "CreateDBClusterEndpointInput"}
if s.DBClusterEndpointIdentifier == nil {
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("DBClusterEndpointIdentifier"))
}
if s.DBClusterIdentifier == nil {
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("DBClusterIdentifier"))
}
if s.EndpointType == nil {
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("EndpointType"))
}
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
return invalidParams
}
return nil
}
// SetDBClusterEndpointIdentifier sets the DBClusterEndpointIdentifier field's value.
func (s *CreateDBClusterEndpointInput) SetDBClusterEndpointIdentifier(v string) *CreateDBClusterEndpointInput {
s.DBClusterEndpointIdentifier = &v
return s
}
// SetDBClusterIdentifier sets the DBClusterIdentifier field's value.
func (s *CreateDBClusterEndpointInput) SetDBClusterIdentifier(v string) *CreateDBClusterEndpointInput {
s.DBClusterIdentifier = &v
return s
}
// SetEndpointType sets the EndpointType field's value.
func (s *CreateDBClusterEndpointInput) SetEndpointType(v string) *CreateDBClusterEndpointInput {
s.EndpointType = &v
return s
}
// SetExcludedMembers sets the ExcludedMembers field's value.
func (s *CreateDBClusterEndpointInput) SetExcludedMembers(v []*string) *CreateDBClusterEndpointInput {
s.ExcludedMembers = v
return s
}
// SetStaticMembers sets the StaticMembers field's value.
func (s *CreateDBClusterEndpointInput) SetStaticMembers(v []*string) *CreateDBClusterEndpointInput {
s.StaticMembers = v
return s
}
// This data type represents the information you need to connect to an Amazon
// Aurora DB cluster. This data type is used as a response element in the following
// actions:
//
// * CreateDBClusterEndpoint
//
// * DescribeDBClusterEndpoints
//
// * ModifyDBClusterEndpoint
//
// * DeleteDBClusterEndpoint
//
// For the data structure that represents Amazon RDS DB instance endpoints,
// see Endpoint.
type CreateDBClusterEndpointOutput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// The type associated with a custom endpoint. One of: READER, ANY.
CustomEndpointType *string `type:"string"`
// The Amazon Resource Name (ARN) for the endpoint.
DBClusterEndpointArn *string `type:"string"`
// The identifier associated with the endpoint. This parameter is stored as
// a lowercase string.
DBClusterEndpointIdentifier *string `type:"string"`
// A unique system-generated identifier for an endpoint. It remains the same
// for the whole life of the endpoint.
DBClusterEndpointResourceIdentifier *string `type:"string"`
// The DB cluster identifier of the DB cluster associated with the endpoint.
// This parameter is stored as a lowercase string.
DBClusterIdentifier *string `type:"string"`
// The DNS address of the endpoint.
Endpoint *string `type:"string"`
// The type of the endpoint. One of: READER, WRITER, CUSTOM.
EndpointType *string `type:"string"`
// List of DB instance identifiers that aren't part of the custom endpoint group.
// All other eligible instances are reachable through the custom endpoint. Only
// relevant if the list of static members is empty.
ExcludedMembers []*string `type:"list"`
// List of DB instance identifiers that are part of the custom endpoint group.
StaticMembers []*string `type:"list"`
// The current status of the endpoint. One of: creating, available, deleting,
// modifying.
Status *string `type:"string"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s CreateDBClusterEndpointOutput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s CreateDBClusterEndpointOutput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetCustomEndpointType sets the CustomEndpointType field's value.
func (s *CreateDBClusterEndpointOutput) SetCustomEndpointType(v string) *CreateDBClusterEndpointOutput {
s.CustomEndpointType = &v
return s
}
// SetDBClusterEndpointArn sets the DBClusterEndpointArn field's value.
func (s *CreateDBClusterEndpointOutput) SetDBClusterEndpointArn(v string) *CreateDBClusterEndpointOutput {
s.DBClusterEndpointArn = &v
return s
}
// SetDBClusterEndpointIdentifier sets the DBClusterEndpointIdentifier field's value.
func (s *CreateDBClusterEndpointOutput) SetDBClusterEndpointIdentifier(v string) *CreateDBClusterEndpointOutput {
s.DBClusterEndpointIdentifier = &v
return s
}
// SetDBClusterEndpointResourceIdentifier sets the DBClusterEndpointResourceIdentifier field's value.
func (s *CreateDBClusterEndpointOutput) SetDBClusterEndpointResourceIdentifier(v string) *CreateDBClusterEndpointOutput {
s.DBClusterEndpointResourceIdentifier = &v
return s
}
// SetDBClusterIdentifier sets the DBClusterIdentifier field's value.
func (s *CreateDBClusterEndpointOutput) SetDBClusterIdentifier(v string) *CreateDBClusterEndpointOutput {
s.DBClusterIdentifier = &v
return s
}
// SetEndpoint sets the Endpoint field's value.
func (s *CreateDBClusterEndpointOutput) SetEndpoint(v string) *CreateDBClusterEndpointOutput {
s.Endpoint = &v
return s
}
// SetEndpointType sets the EndpointType field's value.
func (s *CreateDBClusterEndpointOutput) SetEndpointType(v string) *CreateDBClusterEndpointOutput {
s.EndpointType = &v
return s
}
// SetExcludedMembers sets the ExcludedMembers field's value.
func (s *CreateDBClusterEndpointOutput) SetExcludedMembers(v []*string) *CreateDBClusterEndpointOutput {
s.ExcludedMembers = v
return s
}
// SetStaticMembers sets the StaticMembers field's value.
func (s *CreateDBClusterEndpointOutput) SetStaticMembers(v []*string) *CreateDBClusterEndpointOutput {
s.StaticMembers = v
return s
}
// SetStatus sets the Status field's value.
func (s *CreateDBClusterEndpointOutput) SetStatus(v string) *CreateDBClusterEndpointOutput {
s.Status = &v
return s
}
type CreateDBClusterInput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// A list of EC2 Availability Zones that instances in the DB cluster can be
// created in. For information on AWS Regions and Availability Zones, see Choosing
// the Regions and Availability Zones (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/AuroraUserGuide/Concepts.RegionsAndAvailabilityZones.html)
// in the Amazon Aurora User Guide.
AvailabilityZones []*string `locationNameList:"AvailabilityZone" type:"list"`
// The target backtrack window, in seconds. To disable backtracking, set this
// value to 0.
//
// Default: 0
//
// Constraints:
//
// * If specified, this value must be set to a number from 0 to 259,200 (72
// hours).
BacktrackWindow *int64 `type:"long"`
// The number of days for which automated backups are retained. You must specify
// a minimum value of 1.
//
// Default: 1
//
// Constraints:
//
// * Must be a value from 1 to 35
BackupRetentionPeriod *int64 `type:"integer"`
// A value that indicates that the DB cluster should be associated with the
// specified CharacterSet.
CharacterSetName *string `type:"string"`
// True to copy all tags from the DB cluster to snapshots of the DB cluster,
// and otherwise false. The default is false.
CopyTagsToSnapshot *bool `type:"boolean"`
// The DB cluster identifier. This parameter is stored as a lowercase string.
//
// Constraints:
//
// * Must contain from 1 to 63 letters, numbers, or hyphens.
//
// * First character must be a letter.
//
// * Can't end with a hyphen or contain two consecutive hyphens.
//
// Example: my-cluster1
//
// DBClusterIdentifier is a required field
DBClusterIdentifier *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
// The name of the DB cluster parameter group to associate with this DB cluster.
// If this argument is omitted, default.aurora5.6 is used.
//
// Constraints:
//
// * If supplied, must match the name of an existing DB cluster parameter
// group.
DBClusterParameterGroupName *string `type:"string"`
// A DB subnet group to associate with this DB cluster.
//
// Constraints: Must match the name of an existing DBSubnetGroup. Must not be
// default.
//
// Example: mySubnetgroup
DBSubnetGroupName *string `type:"string"`
// The name for your database of up to 64 alpha-numeric characters. If you do
// not provide a name, Amazon RDS will not create a database in the DB cluster
// you are creating.
DatabaseName *string `type:"string"`
// Indicates if the DB cluster should have deletion protection enabled. The
// database can't be deleted when this value is set to true. The default is
// false.
DeletionProtection *bool `type:"boolean"`
// DestinationRegion is used for presigning the request to a given region.
DestinationRegion *string `type:"string"`
// The list of log types that need to be enabled for exporting to CloudWatch
// Logs. The values in the list depend on the DB engine being used. For more
// information, see Publishing Database Logs to Amazon CloudWatch Logs (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/AuroraUserGuide/USER_LogAccess.html#USER_LogAccess.Procedural.UploadtoCloudWatch)
// in the Amazon Aurora User Guide.
EnableCloudwatchLogsExports []*string `type:"list"`
// True to enable mapping of AWS Identity and Access Management (IAM) accounts
// to database accounts, and otherwise false.
//
// Default: false
EnableIAMDatabaseAuthentication *bool `type:"boolean"`
// The name of the database engine to be used for this DB cluster.
//
// Valid Values: aurora (for MySQL 5.6-compatible Aurora), aurora-mysql (for
// MySQL 5.7-compatible Aurora), and aurora-postgresql
//
// Engine is a required field
Engine *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
// The DB engine mode of the DB cluster, either provisioned, serverless, parallelquery,
// or global.
EngineMode *string `type:"string"`
// The version number of the database engine to use.
//
// Aurora MySQL
//
// Example: 5.6.10a, 5.7.12
//
// Aurora PostgreSQL
//
// Example: 9.6.3
EngineVersion *string `type:"string"`
// The global cluster ID of an Aurora cluster that becomes the primary cluster
// in the new global database cluster.
GlobalClusterIdentifier *string `type:"string"`
// The AWS KMS key identifier for an encrypted DB cluster.
//
// The KMS key identifier is the Amazon Resource Name (ARN) for the KMS encryption
// key. If you are creating a DB cluster with the same AWS account that owns
// the KMS encryption key used to encrypt the new DB cluster, then you can use
// the KMS key alias instead of the ARN for the KMS encryption key.
//
// If an encryption key is not specified in KmsKeyId:
//
// * If ReplicationSourceIdentifier identifies an encrypted source, then
// Amazon RDS will use the encryption key used to encrypt the source. Otherwise,
// Amazon RDS will use your default encryption key.
//
// * If the StorageEncrypted parameter is true and ReplicationSourceIdentifier
// is not specified, then Amazon RDS will use your default encryption key.
//
// AWS KMS creates the default encryption key for your AWS account. Your AWS
// account has a different default encryption key for each AWS Region.
//
// If you create a Read Replica of an encrypted DB cluster in another AWS Region,
// you must set KmsKeyId to a KMS key ID that is valid in the destination AWS
// Region. This key is used to encrypt the Read Replica in that AWS Region.
KmsKeyId *string `type:"string"`
// The password for the master database user. This password can contain any
// printable ASCII character except "/", """, or "@".
//
// Constraints: Must contain from 8 to 41 characters.
MasterUserPassword *string `type:"string"`
// The name of the master user for the DB cluster.
//
// Constraints:
//
// * Must be 1 to 16 letters or numbers.
//
// * First character must be a letter.
//
// * Can't be a reserved word for the chosen database engine.
MasterUsername *string `type:"string"`
// A value that indicates that the DB cluster should be associated with the
// specified option group.
//
// Permanent options can't be removed from an option group. The option group
// can't be removed from a DB cluster once it is associated with a DB cluster.
OptionGroupName *string `type:"string"`
// The port number on which the instances in the DB cluster accept connections.
//
// Default: 3306 if engine is set as aurora or 5432 if set to aurora-postgresql.
Port *int64 `type:"integer"`
// A URL that contains a Signature Version 4 signed request for the CreateDBCluster
// action to be called in the source AWS Region where the DB cluster is replicated
// from. You only need to specify PreSignedUrl when you are performing cross-region
// replication from an encrypted DB cluster.
//
// The pre-signed URL must be a valid request for the CreateDBCluster API action
// that can be executed in the source AWS Region that contains the encrypted
// DB cluster to be copied.
//
// The pre-signed URL request must contain the following parameter values:
//
// * KmsKeyId - The AWS KMS key identifier for the key to use to encrypt
// the copy of the DB cluster in the destination AWS Region. This should
// refer to the same KMS key for both the CreateDBCluster action that is
// called in the destination AWS Region, and the action contained in the
// pre-signed URL.
//
// * DestinationRegion - The name of the AWS Region that Aurora Read Replica
// will be created in.
//
// * ReplicationSourceIdentifier - The DB cluster identifier for the encrypted
// DB cluster to be copied. This identifier must be in the Amazon Resource
// Name (ARN) format for the source AWS Region. For example, if you are copying
// an encrypted DB cluster from the us-west-2 AWS Region, then your ReplicationSourceIdentifier
// would look like Example: arn:aws:rds:us-west-2:123456789012:cluster:aurora-cluster1.
//
// To learn how to generate a Signature Version 4 signed request, see Authenticating
// Requests: Using Query Parameters (AWS Signature Version 4) (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonS3/latest/API/sigv4-query-string-auth.html)
// and Signature Version 4 Signing Process (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/general/latest/gr/signature-version-4.html).
PreSignedUrl *string `type:"string"`
// The daily time range during which automated backups are created if automated
// backups are enabled using the BackupRetentionPeriod parameter.
//
// The default is a 30-minute window selected at random from an 8-hour block
// of time for each AWS Region. To see the time blocks available, see Adjusting
// the Preferred DB Cluster Maintenance Window (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/AuroraUserGuide/USER_UpgradeDBInstance.Maintenance.html#AdjustingTheMaintenanceWindow.Aurora)
// in the Amazon Aurora User Guide.
//
// Constraints:
//
// * Must be in the format hh24:mi-hh24:mi.
//
// * Must be in Universal Coordinated Time (UTC).
//
// * Must not conflict with the preferred maintenance window.
//
// * Must be at least 30 minutes.
PreferredBackupWindow *string `type:"string"`
// The weekly time range during which system maintenance can occur, in Universal
// Coordinated Time (UTC).
//
// Format: ddd:hh24:mi-ddd:hh24:mi
//
// The default is a 30-minute window selected at random from an 8-hour block
// of time for each AWS Region, occurring on a random day of the week. To see
// the time blocks available, see Adjusting the Preferred DB Cluster Maintenance
// Window (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/AuroraUserGuide/USER_UpgradeDBInstance.Maintenance.html#AdjustingTheMaintenanceWindow.Aurora)
// in the Amazon Aurora User Guide.
//
// Valid Days: Mon, Tue, Wed, Thu, Fri, Sat, Sun.
//
// Constraints: Minimum 30-minute window.
PreferredMaintenanceWindow *string `type:"string"`
// The Amazon Resource Name (ARN) of the source DB instance or DB cluster if
// this DB cluster is created as a Read Replica.
ReplicationSourceIdentifier *string `type:"string"`
// For DB clusters in serverless DB engine mode, the scaling properties of the
// DB cluster.
ScalingConfiguration *ScalingConfiguration `type:"structure"`
// SourceRegion is the source region where the resource exists. This is not
// sent over the wire and is only used for presigning. This value should always
// have the same region as the source ARN.
SourceRegion *string `type:"string" ignore:"true"`
// Specifies whether the DB cluster is encrypted.
StorageEncrypted *bool `type:"boolean"`
// A list of tags. For more information, see Tagging Amazon RDS Resources (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/UserGuide/USER_Tagging.html)
// in the Amazon RDS User Guide.
Tags []*Tag `locationNameList:"Tag" type:"list"`
// A list of EC2 VPC security groups to associate with this DB cluster.
VpcSecurityGroupIds []*string `locationNameList:"VpcSecurityGroupId" type:"list"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s CreateDBClusterInput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s CreateDBClusterInput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
func (s *CreateDBClusterInput) Validate() error {
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "CreateDBClusterInput"}
if s.DBClusterIdentifier == nil {
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("DBClusterIdentifier"))
}
if s.Engine == nil {
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Engine"))
}
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
return invalidParams
}
return nil
}
// SetAvailabilityZones sets the AvailabilityZones field's value.
func (s *CreateDBClusterInput) SetAvailabilityZones(v []*string) *CreateDBClusterInput {
s.AvailabilityZones = v
return s
}
// SetBacktrackWindow sets the BacktrackWindow field's value.
func (s *CreateDBClusterInput) SetBacktrackWindow(v int64) *CreateDBClusterInput {
s.BacktrackWindow = &v
return s
}
// SetBackupRetentionPeriod sets the BackupRetentionPeriod field's value.
func (s *CreateDBClusterInput) SetBackupRetentionPeriod(v int64) *CreateDBClusterInput {
s.BackupRetentionPeriod = &v
return s
}
// SetCharacterSetName sets the CharacterSetName field's value.
func (s *CreateDBClusterInput) SetCharacterSetName(v string) *CreateDBClusterInput {
s.CharacterSetName = &v
return s
}
// SetCopyTagsToSnapshot sets the CopyTagsToSnapshot field's value.
func (s *CreateDBClusterInput) SetCopyTagsToSnapshot(v bool) *CreateDBClusterInput {
s.CopyTagsToSnapshot = &v
return s
}
// SetDBClusterIdentifier sets the DBClusterIdentifier field's value.
func (s *CreateDBClusterInput) SetDBClusterIdentifier(v string) *CreateDBClusterInput {
s.DBClusterIdentifier = &v
return s
}
// SetDBClusterParameterGroupName sets the DBClusterParameterGroupName field's value.
func (s *CreateDBClusterInput) SetDBClusterParameterGroupName(v string) *CreateDBClusterInput {
s.DBClusterParameterGroupName = &v
return s
}
// SetDBSubnetGroupName sets the DBSubnetGroupName field's value.
func (s *CreateDBClusterInput) SetDBSubnetGroupName(v string) *CreateDBClusterInput {
s.DBSubnetGroupName = &v
return s
}
// SetDatabaseName sets the DatabaseName field's value.
func (s *CreateDBClusterInput) SetDatabaseName(v string) *CreateDBClusterInput {
s.DatabaseName = &v
return s
}
// SetDeletionProtection sets the DeletionProtection field's value.
func (s *CreateDBClusterInput) SetDeletionProtection(v bool) *CreateDBClusterInput {
s.DeletionProtection = &v
return s
}
// SetDestinationRegion sets the DestinationRegion field's value.
func (s *CreateDBClusterInput) SetDestinationRegion(v string) *CreateDBClusterInput {
s.DestinationRegion = &v
return s
}
// SetEnableCloudwatchLogsExports sets the EnableCloudwatchLogsExports field's value.
func (s *CreateDBClusterInput) SetEnableCloudwatchLogsExports(v []*string) *CreateDBClusterInput {
s.EnableCloudwatchLogsExports = v
return s
}
// SetEnableIAMDatabaseAuthentication sets the EnableIAMDatabaseAuthentication field's value.
func (s *CreateDBClusterInput) SetEnableIAMDatabaseAuthentication(v bool) *CreateDBClusterInput {
s.EnableIAMDatabaseAuthentication = &v
return s
}
// SetEngine sets the Engine field's value.
func (s *CreateDBClusterInput) SetEngine(v string) *CreateDBClusterInput {
s.Engine = &v
return s
}
// SetEngineMode sets the EngineMode field's value.
func (s *CreateDBClusterInput) SetEngineMode(v string) *CreateDBClusterInput {
s.EngineMode = &v
return s
}
// SetEngineVersion sets the EngineVersion field's value.
func (s *CreateDBClusterInput) SetEngineVersion(v string) *CreateDBClusterInput {
s.EngineVersion = &v
return s
}
// SetGlobalClusterIdentifier sets the GlobalClusterIdentifier field's value.
func (s *CreateDBClusterInput) SetGlobalClusterIdentifier(v string) *CreateDBClusterInput {
s.GlobalClusterIdentifier = &v
return s
}
// SetKmsKeyId sets the KmsKeyId field's value.
func (s *CreateDBClusterInput) SetKmsKeyId(v string) *CreateDBClusterInput {
s.KmsKeyId = &v
return s
}
// SetMasterUserPassword sets the MasterUserPassword field's value.
func (s *CreateDBClusterInput) SetMasterUserPassword(v string) *CreateDBClusterInput {
s.MasterUserPassword = &v
return s
}
// SetMasterUsername sets the MasterUsername field's value.
func (s *CreateDBClusterInput) SetMasterUsername(v string) *CreateDBClusterInput {
s.MasterUsername = &v
return s
}
// SetOptionGroupName sets the OptionGroupName field's value.
func (s *CreateDBClusterInput) SetOptionGroupName(v string) *CreateDBClusterInput {
s.OptionGroupName = &v
return s
}
// SetPort sets the Port field's value.
func (s *CreateDBClusterInput) SetPort(v int64) *CreateDBClusterInput {
s.Port = &v
return s
}
// SetPreSignedUrl sets the PreSignedUrl field's value.
func (s *CreateDBClusterInput) SetPreSignedUrl(v string) *CreateDBClusterInput {
s.PreSignedUrl = &v
return s
}
// SetPreferredBackupWindow sets the PreferredBackupWindow field's value.
func (s *CreateDBClusterInput) SetPreferredBackupWindow(v string) *CreateDBClusterInput {
s.PreferredBackupWindow = &v
return s
}
// SetPreferredMaintenanceWindow sets the PreferredMaintenanceWindow field's value.
func (s *CreateDBClusterInput) SetPreferredMaintenanceWindow(v string) *CreateDBClusterInput {
s.PreferredMaintenanceWindow = &v
return s
}
// SetReplicationSourceIdentifier sets the ReplicationSourceIdentifier field's value.
func (s *CreateDBClusterInput) SetReplicationSourceIdentifier(v string) *CreateDBClusterInput {
s.ReplicationSourceIdentifier = &v
return s
}
// SetScalingConfiguration sets the ScalingConfiguration field's value.
func (s *CreateDBClusterInput) SetScalingConfiguration(v *ScalingConfiguration) *CreateDBClusterInput {
s.ScalingConfiguration = v
return s
}
// SetSourceRegion sets the SourceRegion field's value.
func (s *CreateDBClusterInput) SetSourceRegion(v string) *CreateDBClusterInput {
s.SourceRegion = &v
return s
}
// SetStorageEncrypted sets the StorageEncrypted field's value.
func (s *CreateDBClusterInput) SetStorageEncrypted(v bool) *CreateDBClusterInput {
s.StorageEncrypted = &v
return s
}
// SetTags sets the Tags field's value.
func (s *CreateDBClusterInput) SetTags(v []*Tag) *CreateDBClusterInput {
s.Tags = v
return s
}
// SetVpcSecurityGroupIds sets the VpcSecurityGroupIds field's value.
func (s *CreateDBClusterInput) SetVpcSecurityGroupIds(v []*string) *CreateDBClusterInput {
s.VpcSecurityGroupIds = v
return s
}
type CreateDBClusterOutput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// Contains the details of an Amazon Aurora DB cluster.
//
// This data type is used as a response element in the DescribeDBClusters, StopDBCluster,
// and StartDBCluster actions.
DBCluster *DBCluster `type:"structure"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s CreateDBClusterOutput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s CreateDBClusterOutput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetDBCluster sets the DBCluster field's value.
func (s *CreateDBClusterOutput) SetDBCluster(v *DBCluster) *CreateDBClusterOutput {
s.DBCluster = v
return s
}
type CreateDBClusterParameterGroupInput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// The name of the DB cluster parameter group.
//
// Constraints:
//
// * Must match the name of an existing DB cluster parameter group.
//
// This value is stored as a lowercase string.
//
// DBClusterParameterGroupName is a required field
DBClusterParameterGroupName *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
// The DB cluster parameter group family name. A DB cluster parameter group
// can be associated with one and only one DB cluster parameter group family,
// and can be applied only to a DB cluster running a database engine and engine
// version compatible with that DB cluster parameter group family.
//
// Aurora MySQL
//
// Example: aurora5.6, aurora-mysql5.7
//
// Aurora PostgreSQL
//
// Example: aurora-postgresql9.6
//
// DBParameterGroupFamily is a required field
DBParameterGroupFamily *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
// The description for the DB cluster parameter group.
//
// Description is a required field
Description *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
// A list of tags. For more information, see Tagging Amazon RDS Resources (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/UserGuide/USER_Tagging.html)
// in the Amazon RDS User Guide.
Tags []*Tag `locationNameList:"Tag" type:"list"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s CreateDBClusterParameterGroupInput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s CreateDBClusterParameterGroupInput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
func (s *CreateDBClusterParameterGroupInput) Validate() error {
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "CreateDBClusterParameterGroupInput"}
if s.DBClusterParameterGroupName == nil {
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("DBClusterParameterGroupName"))
}
if s.DBParameterGroupFamily == nil {
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("DBParameterGroupFamily"))
}
if s.Description == nil {
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Description"))
}
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
return invalidParams
}
return nil
}
// SetDBClusterParameterGroupName sets the DBClusterParameterGroupName field's value.
func (s *CreateDBClusterParameterGroupInput) SetDBClusterParameterGroupName(v string) *CreateDBClusterParameterGroupInput {
s.DBClusterParameterGroupName = &v
return s
}
// SetDBParameterGroupFamily sets the DBParameterGroupFamily field's value.
func (s *CreateDBClusterParameterGroupInput) SetDBParameterGroupFamily(v string) *CreateDBClusterParameterGroupInput {
s.DBParameterGroupFamily = &v
return s
}
// SetDescription sets the Description field's value.
func (s *CreateDBClusterParameterGroupInput) SetDescription(v string) *CreateDBClusterParameterGroupInput {
s.Description = &v
return s
}
// SetTags sets the Tags field's value.
func (s *CreateDBClusterParameterGroupInput) SetTags(v []*Tag) *CreateDBClusterParameterGroupInput {
s.Tags = v
return s
}
type CreateDBClusterParameterGroupOutput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// Contains the details of an Amazon RDS DB cluster parameter group.
//
// This data type is used as a response element in the DescribeDBClusterParameterGroups
// action.
DBClusterParameterGroup *DBClusterParameterGroup `type:"structure"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s CreateDBClusterParameterGroupOutput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s CreateDBClusterParameterGroupOutput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetDBClusterParameterGroup sets the DBClusterParameterGroup field's value.
func (s *CreateDBClusterParameterGroupOutput) SetDBClusterParameterGroup(v *DBClusterParameterGroup) *CreateDBClusterParameterGroupOutput {
s.DBClusterParameterGroup = v
return s
}
type CreateDBClusterSnapshotInput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// The identifier of the DB cluster to create a snapshot for. This parameter
// is not case-sensitive.
//
// Constraints:
//
// * Must match the identifier of an existing DBCluster.
//
// Example: my-cluster1
//
// DBClusterIdentifier is a required field
DBClusterIdentifier *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
// The identifier of the DB cluster snapshot. This parameter is stored as a
// lowercase string.
//
// Constraints:
//
// * Must contain from 1 to 63 letters, numbers, or hyphens.
//
// * First character must be a letter.
//
// * Can't end with a hyphen or contain two consecutive hyphens.
//
// Example: my-cluster1-snapshot1
//
// DBClusterSnapshotIdentifier is a required field
DBClusterSnapshotIdentifier *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
// The tags to be assigned to the DB cluster snapshot.
Tags []*Tag `locationNameList:"Tag" type:"list"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s CreateDBClusterSnapshotInput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s CreateDBClusterSnapshotInput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
func (s *CreateDBClusterSnapshotInput) Validate() error {
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "CreateDBClusterSnapshotInput"}
if s.DBClusterIdentifier == nil {
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("DBClusterIdentifier"))
}
if s.DBClusterSnapshotIdentifier == nil {
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("DBClusterSnapshotIdentifier"))
}
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
return invalidParams
}
return nil
}
// SetDBClusterIdentifier sets the DBClusterIdentifier field's value.
func (s *CreateDBClusterSnapshotInput) SetDBClusterIdentifier(v string) *CreateDBClusterSnapshotInput {
s.DBClusterIdentifier = &v
return s
}
// SetDBClusterSnapshotIdentifier sets the DBClusterSnapshotIdentifier field's value.
func (s *CreateDBClusterSnapshotInput) SetDBClusterSnapshotIdentifier(v string) *CreateDBClusterSnapshotInput {
s.DBClusterSnapshotIdentifier = &v
return s
}
// SetTags sets the Tags field's value.
func (s *CreateDBClusterSnapshotInput) SetTags(v []*Tag) *CreateDBClusterSnapshotInput {
s.Tags = v
return s
}
type CreateDBClusterSnapshotOutput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// Contains the details for an Amazon RDS DB cluster snapshot
//
// This data type is used as a response element in the DescribeDBClusterSnapshots
// action.
DBClusterSnapshot *DBClusterSnapshot `type:"structure"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s CreateDBClusterSnapshotOutput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s CreateDBClusterSnapshotOutput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetDBClusterSnapshot sets the DBClusterSnapshot field's value.
func (s *CreateDBClusterSnapshotOutput) SetDBClusterSnapshot(v *DBClusterSnapshot) *CreateDBClusterSnapshotOutput {
s.DBClusterSnapshot = v
return s
}
type CreateDBInstanceInput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// The amount of storage (in gibibytes) to allocate for the DB instance.
//
// Type: Integer
//
// Amazon Aurora
//
// Not applicable. Aurora cluster volumes automatically grow as the amount of
// data in your database increases, though you are only charged for the space
// that you use in an Aurora cluster volume.
//
// MySQL
//
// Constraints to the amount of storage for each storage type are the following:
//
// * General Purpose (SSD) storage (gp2): Must be an integer from 20 to 32768.
//
// * Provisioned IOPS storage (io1): Must be an integer from 100 to 32768.
//
// * Magnetic storage (standard): Must be an integer from 5 to 3072.
//
// MariaDB
//
// Constraints to the amount of storage for each storage type are the following:
//
// * General Purpose (SSD) storage (gp2): Must be an integer from 20 to 32768.
//
// * Provisioned IOPS storage (io1): Must be an integer from 100 to 32768.
//
// * Magnetic storage (standard): Must be an integer from 5 to 3072.
//
// PostgreSQL
//
// Constraints to the amount of storage for each storage type are the following:
//
// * General Purpose (SSD) storage (gp2): Must be an integer from 20 to 32768.
//
// * Provisioned IOPS storage (io1): Must be an integer from 100 to 32768.
//
// * Magnetic storage (standard): Must be an integer from 5 to 3072.
//
// Oracle
//
// Constraints to the amount of storage for each storage type are the following:
//
// * General Purpose (SSD) storage (gp2): Must be an integer from 20 to 32768.
//
// * Provisioned IOPS storage (io1): Must be an integer from 100 to 32768.
//
// * Magnetic storage (standard): Must be an integer from 10 to 3072.
//
// SQL Server
//
// Constraints to the amount of storage for each storage type are the following:
//
// * General Purpose (SSD) storage (gp2):
//
// Enterprise and Standard editions: Must be an integer from 200 to 16384.
//
// Web and Express editions: Must be an integer from 20 to 16384.
//
// * Provisioned IOPS storage (io1):
//
// Enterprise and Standard editions: Must be an integer from 200 to 16384.
//
// Web and Express editions: Must be an integer from 100 to 16384.
//
// * Magnetic storage (standard):
//
// Enterprise and Standard editions: Must be an integer from 200 to 1024.
//
// Web and Express editions: Must be an integer from 20 to 1024.
AllocatedStorage *int64 `type:"integer"`
// Indicates that minor engine upgrades are applied automatically to the DB
// instance during the maintenance window.
//
// Default: true
AutoMinorVersionUpgrade *bool `type:"boolean"`
// The EC2 Availability Zone that the DB instance is created in. For information
// on AWS Regions and Availability Zones, see Regions and Availability Zones
// (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/UserGuide/Concepts.RegionsAndAvailabilityZones.html).
//
// Default: A random, system-chosen Availability Zone in the endpoint's AWS
// Region.
//
// Example: us-east-1d
//
// Constraint: The AvailabilityZone parameter can't be specified if the MultiAZ
// parameter is set to true. The specified Availability Zone must be in the
// same AWS Region as the current endpoint.
AvailabilityZone *string `type:"string"`
// The number of days for which automated backups are retained. Setting this
// parameter to a positive number enables backups. Setting this parameter to
// 0 disables automated backups.
//
// Amazon Aurora
//
// Not applicable. The retention period for automated backups is managed by
// the DB cluster. For more information, see CreateDBCluster.
//
// Default: 1
//
// Constraints:
//
// * Must be a value from 0 to 35
//
// * Can't be set to 0 if the DB instance is a source to Read Replicas
BackupRetentionPeriod *int64 `type:"integer"`
// For supported engines, indicates that the DB instance should be associated
// with the specified CharacterSet.
//
// Amazon Aurora
//
// Not applicable. The character set is managed by the DB cluster. For more
// information, see CreateDBCluster.
CharacterSetName *string `type:"string"`
// True to copy all tags from the DB instance to snapshots of the DB instance,
// and otherwise false. The default is false.
//
// Amazon Aurora
//
// Not applicable. Copying tags to snapshots is managed by the DB cluster. Setting
// this value for an Aurora DB instance has no effect on the DB cluster setting.
// For more information, see CreateDBCluster.
CopyTagsToSnapshot *bool `type:"boolean"`
// The identifier of the DB cluster that the instance will belong to.
//
// For information on creating a DB cluster, see CreateDBCluster.
//
// Type: String
DBClusterIdentifier *string `type:"string"`
// The compute and memory capacity of the DB instance, for example, db.m4.large.
// Not all DB instance classes are available in all AWS Regions, or for all
// database engines. For the full list of DB instance classes, and availability
// for your engine, see DB Instance Class (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/UserGuide/Concepts.DBInstanceClass.html)
// in the Amazon RDS User Guide.
//
// DBInstanceClass is a required field
DBInstanceClass *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
// The DB instance identifier. This parameter is stored as a lowercase string.
//
// Constraints:
//
// * Must contain from 1 to 63 letters, numbers, or hyphens.
//
// * First character must be a letter.
//
// * Can't end with a hyphen or contain two consecutive hyphens.
//
// Example: mydbinstance
//
// DBInstanceIdentifier is a required field
DBInstanceIdentifier *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
// The meaning of this parameter differs according to the database engine you
// use.
//
// Type: String
//
// MySQL
//
// The name of the database to create when the DB instance is created. If this
// parameter is not specified, no database is created in the DB instance.
//
// Constraints:
//
// * Must contain 1 to 64 letters or numbers.
//
// * Can't be a word reserved by the specified database engine
//
// MariaDB
//
// The name of the database to create when the DB instance is created. If this
// parameter is not specified, no database is created in the DB instance.
//
// Constraints:
//
// * Must contain 1 to 64 letters or numbers.
//
// * Can't be a word reserved by the specified database engine
//
// PostgreSQL
//
// The name of the database to create when the DB instance is created. If this
// parameter is not specified, the default "postgres" database is created in
// the DB instance.
//
// Constraints:
//
// * Must contain 1 to 63 letters, numbers, or underscores.
//
// * Must begin with a letter or an underscore. Subsequent characters can
// be letters, underscores, or digits (0-9).
//
// * Can't be a word reserved by the specified database engine
//
// Oracle
//
// The Oracle System ID (SID) of the created DB instance. If you specify null,
// the default value ORCL is used. You can't specify the string NULL, or any
// other reserved word, for DBName.
//
// Default: ORCL
//
// Constraints:
//
// * Can't be longer than 8 characters
//
// SQL Server
//
// Not applicable. Must be null.
//
// Amazon Aurora
//
// The name of the database to create when the primary instance of the DB cluster
// is created. If this parameter is not specified, no database is created in
// the DB instance.
//
// Constraints:
//
// * Must contain 1 to 64 letters or numbers.
//
// * Can't be a word reserved by the specified database engine
DBName *string `type:"string"`
// The name of the DB parameter group to associate with this DB instance. If
// this argument is omitted, the default DBParameterGroup for the specified
// engine is used.
//
// Constraints:
//
// * Must be 1 to 255 letters, numbers, or hyphens.
//
// * First character must be a letter
//
// * Can't end with a hyphen or contain two consecutive hyphens
DBParameterGroupName *string `type:"string"`
// A list of DB security groups to associate with this DB instance.
//
// Default: The default DB security group for the database engine.
DBSecurityGroups []*string `locationNameList:"DBSecurityGroupName" type:"list"`
// A DB subnet group to associate with this DB instance.
//
// If there is no DB subnet group, then it is a non-VPC DB instance.
DBSubnetGroupName *string `type:"string"`
// Indicates if the DB instance should have deletion protection enabled. The
// database can't be deleted when this value is set to true. The default is
// false. For more information, see Deleting a DB Instance (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/UserGuide/USER_DeleteInstance.html).
DeletionProtection *bool `type:"boolean"`
// Specify the Active Directory Domain to create the instance in.
Domain *string `type:"string"`
// Specify the name of the IAM role to be used when making API calls to the
// Directory Service.
DomainIAMRoleName *string `type:"string"`
// The list of log types that need to be enabled for exporting to CloudWatch
// Logs. The values in the list depend on the DB engine being used. For more
// information, see Publishing Database Logs to Amazon CloudWatch Logs (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/UserGuide/USER_LogAccess.html#USER_LogAccess.Procedural.UploadtoCloudWatch)
// in the Amazon Relational Database Service User Guide.
EnableCloudwatchLogsExports []*string `type:"list"`
// True to enable mapping of AWS Identity and Access Management (IAM) accounts
// to database accounts, and otherwise false.
//
// You can enable IAM database authentication for the following database engines:
//
// Amazon Aurora
//
// Not applicable. Mapping AWS IAM accounts to database accounts is managed
// by the DB cluster. For more information, see CreateDBCluster.
//
// MySQL
//
// * For MySQL 5.6, minor version 5.6.34 or higher
//
// * For MySQL 5.7, minor version 5.7.16 or higher
//
// Default: false
EnableIAMDatabaseAuthentication *bool `type:"boolean"`
// True to enable Performance Insights for the DB instance, and otherwise false.
//
// For more information, see Using Amazon Performance Insights (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/UserGuide/USER_PerfInsights.html)
// in the Amazon Relational Database Service User Guide.
EnablePerformanceInsights *bool `type:"boolean"`
// The name of the database engine to be used for this instance.
//
// Not every database engine is available for every AWS Region.
//
// Valid Values:
//
// * aurora (for MySQL 5.6-compatible Aurora)
//
// * aurora-mysql (for MySQL 5.7-compatible Aurora)
//
// * aurora-postgresql
//
// * mariadb
//
// * mysql
//
// * oracle-ee
//
// * oracle-se2
//
// * oracle-se1
//
// * oracle-se
//
// * postgres
//
// * sqlserver-ee
//
// * sqlserver-se
//
// * sqlserver-ex
//
// * sqlserver-web
//
// Engine is a required field
Engine *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
// The version number of the database engine to use.
//
// For a list of valid engine versions, call DescribeDBEngineVersions.
//
// The following are the database engines and links to information about the
// major and minor versions that are available with Amazon RDS. Not every database
// engine is available for every AWS Region.
//
// Amazon Aurora
//
// Not applicable. The version number of the database engine to be used by the
// DB instance is managed by the DB cluster. For more information, see CreateDBCluster.
//
// MariaDB
//
// See MariaDB on Amazon RDS Versions (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/UserGuide/CHAP_MariaDB.html#MariaDB.Concepts.VersionMgmt)
// in the Amazon RDS User Guide.
//
// Microsoft SQL Server
//
// See Version and Feature Support on Amazon RDS (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/UserGuide/CHAP_SQLServer.html#SQLServer.Concepts.General.FeatureSupport)
// in the Amazon RDS User Guide.
//
// MySQL
//
// See MySQL on Amazon RDS Versions (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/UserGuide/CHAP_MySQL.html#MySQL.Concepts.VersionMgmt)
// in the Amazon RDS User Guide.
//
// Oracle
//
// See Oracle Database Engine Release Notes (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/UserGuide/Appendix.Oracle.PatchComposition.html)
// in the Amazon RDS User Guide.
//
// PostgreSQL
//
// See Supported PostgreSQL Database Versions (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/UserGuide/CHAP_PostgreSQL.html#PostgreSQL.Concepts.General.DBVersions)
// in the Amazon RDS User Guide.
EngineVersion *string `type:"string"`
// The amount of Provisioned IOPS (input/output operations per second) to be
// initially allocated for the DB instance. For information about valid Iops
// values, see see Amazon RDS Provisioned IOPS Storage to Improve Performance
// (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/UserGuide/CHAP_Storage.html#USER_PIOPS)
// in the Amazon RDS User Guide.
//
// Constraints: Must be a multiple between 1 and 50 of the storage amount for
// the DB instance.
Iops *int64 `type:"integer"`
// The AWS KMS key identifier for an encrypted DB instance.
//
// The KMS key identifier is the Amazon Resource Name (ARN) for the KMS encryption
// key. If you are creating a DB instance with the same AWS account that owns
// the KMS encryption key used to encrypt the new DB instance, then you can
// use the KMS key alias instead of the ARN for the KM encryption key.
//
// Amazon Aurora
//
// Not applicable. The KMS key identifier is managed by the DB cluster. For
// more information, see CreateDBCluster.
//
// If the StorageEncrypted parameter is true, and you do not specify a value
// for the KmsKeyId parameter, then Amazon RDS will use your default encryption
// key. AWS KMS creates the default encryption key for your AWS account. Your
// AWS account has a different default encryption key for each AWS Region.
KmsKeyId *string `type:"string"`
// License model information for this DB instance.
//
// Valid values: license-included | bring-your-own-license | general-public-license
LicenseModel *string `type:"string"`
// The password for the master user. The password can include any printable
// ASCII character except "/", """, or "@".
//
// Amazon Aurora
//
// Not applicable. The password for the master user is managed by the DB cluster.
// For more information, see CreateDBCluster.
//
// MariaDB
//
// Constraints: Must contain from 8 to 41 characters.
//
// Microsoft SQL Server
//
// Constraints: Must contain from 8 to 128 characters.
//
// MySQL
//
// Constraints: Must contain from 8 to 41 characters.
//
// Oracle
//
// Constraints: Must contain from 8 to 30 characters.
//
// PostgreSQL
//
// Constraints: Must contain from 8 to 128 characters.
MasterUserPassword *string `type:"string"`
// The name for the master user.
//
// Amazon Aurora
//
// Not applicable. The name for the master user is managed by the DB cluster.
// For more information, see CreateDBCluster.
//
// MariaDB
//
// Constraints:
//
// * Required for MariaDB.
//
// * Must be 1 to 16 letters or numbers.
//
// * Can't be a reserved word for the chosen database engine.
//
// Microsoft SQL Server
//
// Constraints:
//
// * Required for SQL Server.
//
// * Must be 1 to 128 letters or numbers.
//
// * The first character must be a letter.
//
// * Can't be a reserved word for the chosen database engine.
//
// MySQL
//
// Constraints:
//
// * Required for MySQL.
//
// * Must be 1 to 16 letters or numbers.
//
// * First character must be a letter.
//
// * Can't be a reserved word for the chosen database engine.
//
// Oracle
//
// Constraints:
//
// * Required for Oracle.
//
// * Must be 1 to 30 letters or numbers.
//
// * First character must be a letter.
//
// * Can't be a reserved word for the chosen database engine.
//
// PostgreSQL
//
// Constraints:
//
// * Required for PostgreSQL.
//
// * Must be 1 to 63 letters or numbers.
//
// * First character must be a letter.
//
// * Can't be a reserved word for the chosen database engine.
MasterUsername *string `type:"string"`
// The interval, in seconds, between points when Enhanced Monitoring metrics
// are collected for the DB instance. To disable collecting Enhanced Monitoring
// metrics, specify 0. The default is 0.
//
// If MonitoringRoleArn is specified, then you must also set MonitoringInterval
// to a value other than 0.
//
// Valid Values: 0, 1, 5, 10, 15, 30, 60
MonitoringInterval *int64 `type:"integer"`
// The ARN for the IAM role that permits RDS to send enhanced monitoring metrics
// to Amazon CloudWatch Logs. For example, arn:aws:iam:123456789012:role/emaccess.
// For information on creating a monitoring role, go to Setting Up and Enabling
// Enhanced Monitoring (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/UserGuide/USER_Monitoring.OS.html#USER_Monitoring.OS.Enabling)
// in the Amazon RDS User Guide.
//
// If MonitoringInterval is set to a value other than 0, then you must supply
// a MonitoringRoleArn value.
MonitoringRoleArn *string `type:"string"`
// A value that specifies whether the DB instance is a Multi-AZ deployment.
// You can't set the AvailabilityZone parameter if the MultiAZ parameter is
// set to true.
MultiAZ *bool `type:"boolean"`
// Indicates that the DB instance should be associated with the specified option
// group.
//
// Permanent options, such as the TDE option for Oracle Advanced Security TDE,
// can't be removed from an option group, and that option group can't be removed
// from a DB instance once it is associated with a DB instance
OptionGroupName *string `type:"string"`
// The AWS KMS key identifier for encryption of Performance Insights data. The
// KMS key ID is the Amazon Resource Name (ARN), KMS key identifier, or the
// KMS key alias for the KMS encryption key.
PerformanceInsightsKMSKeyId *string `type:"string"`
// The amount of time, in days, to retain Performance Insights data. Valid values
// are 7 or 731 (2 years).
PerformanceInsightsRetentionPeriod *int64 `type:"integer"`
// The port number on which the database accepts connections.
//
// MySQL
//
// Default: 3306
//
// Valid Values: 1150-65535
//
// Type: Integer
//
// MariaDB
//
// Default: 3306
//
// Valid Values: 1150-65535
//
// Type: Integer
//
// PostgreSQL
//
// Default: 5432
//
// Valid Values: 1150-65535
//
// Type: Integer
//
// Oracle
//
// Default: 1521
//
// Valid Values: 1150-65535
//
// SQL Server
//
// Default: 1433
//
// Valid Values: 1150-65535 except for 1434, 3389, 47001, 49152, and 49152 through
// 49156.
//
// Amazon Aurora
//
// Default: 3306
//
// Valid Values: 1150-65535
//
// Type: Integer
Port *int64 `type:"integer"`
// The daily time range during which automated backups are created if automated
// backups are enabled, using the BackupRetentionPeriod parameter. For more
// information, see The Backup Window (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/UserGuide/USER_WorkingWithAutomatedBackups.html#USER_WorkingWithAutomatedBackups.BackupWindow)
// in the Amazon RDS User Guide.
//
// Amazon Aurora
//
// Not applicable. The daily time range for creating automated backups is managed
// by the DB cluster. For more information, see CreateDBCluster.
//
// The default is a 30-minute window selected at random from an 8-hour block
// of time for each AWS Region. To see the time blocks available, see Adjusting
// the Preferred DB Instance Maintenance Window (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/UserGuide/USER_UpgradeDBInstance.Maintenance.html#AdjustingTheMaintenanceWindow)
// in the Amazon RDS User Guide.
//
// Constraints:
//
// * Must be in the format hh24:mi-hh24:mi.
//
// * Must be in Universal Coordinated Time (UTC).
//
// * Must not conflict with the preferred maintenance window.
//
// * Must be at least 30 minutes.
PreferredBackupWindow *string `type:"string"`
// The time range each week during which system maintenance can occur, in Universal
// Coordinated Time (UTC). For more information, see Amazon RDS Maintenance
// Window (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/UserGuide/USER_UpgradeDBInstance.Maintenance.html#Concepts.DBMaintenance).
//
// Format: ddd:hh24:mi-ddd:hh24:mi
//
// The default is a 30-minute window selected at random from an 8-hour block
// of time for each AWS Region, occurring on a random day of the week.
//
// Valid Days: Mon, Tue, Wed, Thu, Fri, Sat, Sun.
//
// Constraints: Minimum 30-minute window.
PreferredMaintenanceWindow *string `type:"string"`
// The number of CPU cores and the number of threads per core for the DB instance
// class of the DB instance.
ProcessorFeatures []*ProcessorFeature `locationNameList:"ProcessorFeature" type:"list"`
// A value that specifies the order in which an Aurora Replica is promoted to
// the primary instance after a failure of the existing primary instance. For
// more information, see Fault Tolerance for an Aurora DB Cluster (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/AuroraUserGuide/Aurora.Managing.Backups.html#Aurora.Managing.FaultTolerance)
// in the Amazon Aurora User Guide.
//
// Default: 1
//
// Valid Values: 0 - 15
PromotionTier *int64 `type:"integer"`
// Specifies the accessibility options for the DB instance. A value of true
// specifies an Internet-facing instance with a publicly resolvable DNS name,
// which resolves to a public IP address. A value of false specifies an internal
// instance with a DNS name that resolves to a private IP address.
//
// Default: The default behavior varies depending on whether DBSubnetGroupName
// is specified.
//
// If DBSubnetGroupName is not specified, and PubliclyAccessible is not specified,
// the following applies:
//
// * If the default VPC in the target region doesnt have an Internet gateway
// attached to it, the DB instance is private.
//
// * If the default VPC in the target region has an Internet gateway attached
// to it, the DB instance is public.
//
// If DBSubnetGroupName is specified, and PubliclyAccessible is not specified,
// the following applies:
//
// * If the subnets are part of a VPC that doesnt have an Internet gateway
// attached to it, the DB instance is private.
//
// * If the subnets are part of a VPC that has an Internet gateway attached
// to it, the DB instance is public.
PubliclyAccessible *bool `type:"boolean"`
// Specifies whether the DB instance is encrypted.
//
// Amazon Aurora
//
// Not applicable. The encryption for DB instances is managed by the DB cluster.
// For more information, see CreateDBCluster.
//
// Default: false
StorageEncrypted *bool `type:"boolean"`
// Specifies the storage type to be associated with the DB instance.
//
// Valid values: standard | gp2 | io1
//
// If you specify io1, you must also include a value for the Iops parameter.
//
// Default: io1 if the Iops parameter is specified, otherwise standard
StorageType *string `type:"string"`
// A list of tags. For more information, see Tagging Amazon RDS Resources (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/UserGuide/USER_Tagging.html)
// in the Amazon RDS User Guide.
Tags []*Tag `locationNameList:"Tag" type:"list"`
// The ARN from the key store with which to associate the instance for TDE encryption.
TdeCredentialArn *string `type:"string"`
// The password for the given ARN from the key store in order to access the
// device.
TdeCredentialPassword *string `type:"string"`
// The time zone of the DB instance. The time zone parameter is currently supported
// only by Microsoft SQL Server (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/UserGuide/CHAP_SQLServer.html#SQLServer.Concepts.General.TimeZone).
Timezone *string `type:"string"`
// A list of Amazon EC2 VPC security groups to associate with this DB instance.
//
// Amazon Aurora
//
// Not applicable. The associated list of EC2 VPC security groups is managed
// by the DB cluster. For more information, see CreateDBCluster.
//
// Default: The default EC2 VPC security group for the DB subnet group's VPC.
VpcSecurityGroupIds []*string `locationNameList:"VpcSecurityGroupId" type:"list"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s CreateDBInstanceInput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s CreateDBInstanceInput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
func (s *CreateDBInstanceInput) Validate() error {
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "CreateDBInstanceInput"}
if s.DBInstanceClass == nil {
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("DBInstanceClass"))
}
if s.DBInstanceIdentifier == nil {
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("DBInstanceIdentifier"))
}
if s.Engine == nil {
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Engine"))
}
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
return invalidParams
}
return nil
}
// SetAllocatedStorage sets the AllocatedStorage field's value.
func (s *CreateDBInstanceInput) SetAllocatedStorage(v int64) *CreateDBInstanceInput {
s.AllocatedStorage = &v
return s
}
// SetAutoMinorVersionUpgrade sets the AutoMinorVersionUpgrade field's value.
func (s *CreateDBInstanceInput) SetAutoMinorVersionUpgrade(v bool) *CreateDBInstanceInput {
s.AutoMinorVersionUpgrade = &v
return s
}
// SetAvailabilityZone sets the AvailabilityZone field's value.
func (s *CreateDBInstanceInput) SetAvailabilityZone(v string) *CreateDBInstanceInput {
s.AvailabilityZone = &v
return s
}
// SetBackupRetentionPeriod sets the BackupRetentionPeriod field's value.
func (s *CreateDBInstanceInput) SetBackupRetentionPeriod(v int64) *CreateDBInstanceInput {
s.BackupRetentionPeriod = &v
return s
}
// SetCharacterSetName sets the CharacterSetName field's value.
func (s *CreateDBInstanceInput) SetCharacterSetName(v string) *CreateDBInstanceInput {
s.CharacterSetName = &v
return s
}
// SetCopyTagsToSnapshot sets the CopyTagsToSnapshot field's value.
func (s *CreateDBInstanceInput) SetCopyTagsToSnapshot(v bool) *CreateDBInstanceInput {
s.CopyTagsToSnapshot = &v
return s
}
// SetDBClusterIdentifier sets the DBClusterIdentifier field's value.
func (s *CreateDBInstanceInput) SetDBClusterIdentifier(v string) *CreateDBInstanceInput {
s.DBClusterIdentifier = &v
return s
}
// SetDBInstanceClass sets the DBInstanceClass field's value.
func (s *CreateDBInstanceInput) SetDBInstanceClass(v string) *CreateDBInstanceInput {
s.DBInstanceClass = &v
return s
}
// SetDBInstanceIdentifier sets the DBInstanceIdentifier field's value.
func (s *CreateDBInstanceInput) SetDBInstanceIdentifier(v string) *CreateDBInstanceInput {
s.DBInstanceIdentifier = &v
return s
}
// SetDBName sets the DBName field's value.
func (s *CreateDBInstanceInput) SetDBName(v string) *CreateDBInstanceInput {
s.DBName = &v
return s
}
// SetDBParameterGroupName sets the DBParameterGroupName field's value.
func (s *CreateDBInstanceInput) SetDBParameterGroupName(v string) *CreateDBInstanceInput {
s.DBParameterGroupName = &v
return s
}
// SetDBSecurityGroups sets the DBSecurityGroups field's value.
func (s *CreateDBInstanceInput) SetDBSecurityGroups(v []*string) *CreateDBInstanceInput {
s.DBSecurityGroups = v
return s
}
// SetDBSubnetGroupName sets the DBSubnetGroupName field's value.
func (s *CreateDBInstanceInput) SetDBSubnetGroupName(v string) *CreateDBInstanceInput {
s.DBSubnetGroupName = &v
return s
}
// SetDeletionProtection sets the DeletionProtection field's value.
func (s *CreateDBInstanceInput) SetDeletionProtection(v bool) *CreateDBInstanceInput {
s.DeletionProtection = &v
return s
}
// SetDomain sets the Domain field's value.
func (s *CreateDBInstanceInput) SetDomain(v string) *CreateDBInstanceInput {
s.Domain = &v
return s
}
// SetDomainIAMRoleName sets the DomainIAMRoleName field's value.
func (s *CreateDBInstanceInput) SetDomainIAMRoleName(v string) *CreateDBInstanceInput {
s.DomainIAMRoleName = &v
return s
}
// SetEnableCloudwatchLogsExports sets the EnableCloudwatchLogsExports field's value.
func (s *CreateDBInstanceInput) SetEnableCloudwatchLogsExports(v []*string) *CreateDBInstanceInput {
s.EnableCloudwatchLogsExports = v
return s
}
// SetEnableIAMDatabaseAuthentication sets the EnableIAMDatabaseAuthentication field's value.
func (s *CreateDBInstanceInput) SetEnableIAMDatabaseAuthentication(v bool) *CreateDBInstanceInput {
s.EnableIAMDatabaseAuthentication = &v
return s
}
// SetEnablePerformanceInsights sets the EnablePerformanceInsights field's value.
func (s *CreateDBInstanceInput) SetEnablePerformanceInsights(v bool) *CreateDBInstanceInput {
s.EnablePerformanceInsights = &v
return s
}
// SetEngine sets the Engine field's value.
func (s *CreateDBInstanceInput) SetEngine(v string) *CreateDBInstanceInput {
s.Engine = &v
return s
}
// SetEngineVersion sets the EngineVersion field's value.
func (s *CreateDBInstanceInput) SetEngineVersion(v string) *CreateDBInstanceInput {
s.EngineVersion = &v
return s
}
// SetIops sets the Iops field's value.
func (s *CreateDBInstanceInput) SetIops(v int64) *CreateDBInstanceInput {
s.Iops = &v
return s
}
// SetKmsKeyId sets the KmsKeyId field's value.
func (s *CreateDBInstanceInput) SetKmsKeyId(v string) *CreateDBInstanceInput {
s.KmsKeyId = &v
return s
}
// SetLicenseModel sets the LicenseModel field's value.
func (s *CreateDBInstanceInput) SetLicenseModel(v string) *CreateDBInstanceInput {
s.LicenseModel = &v
return s
}
// SetMasterUserPassword sets the MasterUserPassword field's value.
func (s *CreateDBInstanceInput) SetMasterUserPassword(v string) *CreateDBInstanceInput {
s.MasterUserPassword = &v
return s
}
// SetMasterUsername sets the MasterUsername field's value.
func (s *CreateDBInstanceInput) SetMasterUsername(v string) *CreateDBInstanceInput {
s.MasterUsername = &v
return s
}
// SetMonitoringInterval sets the MonitoringInterval field's value.
func (s *CreateDBInstanceInput) SetMonitoringInterval(v int64) *CreateDBInstanceInput {
s.MonitoringInterval = &v
return s
}
// SetMonitoringRoleArn sets the MonitoringRoleArn field's value.
func (s *CreateDBInstanceInput) SetMonitoringRoleArn(v string) *CreateDBInstanceInput {
s.MonitoringRoleArn = &v
return s
}
// SetMultiAZ sets the MultiAZ field's value.
func (s *CreateDBInstanceInput) SetMultiAZ(v bool) *CreateDBInstanceInput {
s.MultiAZ = &v
return s
}
// SetOptionGroupName sets the OptionGroupName field's value.
func (s *CreateDBInstanceInput) SetOptionGroupName(v string) *CreateDBInstanceInput {
s.OptionGroupName = &v
return s
}
// SetPerformanceInsightsKMSKeyId sets the PerformanceInsightsKMSKeyId field's value.
func (s *CreateDBInstanceInput) SetPerformanceInsightsKMSKeyId(v string) *CreateDBInstanceInput {
s.PerformanceInsightsKMSKeyId = &v
return s
}
// SetPerformanceInsightsRetentionPeriod sets the PerformanceInsightsRetentionPeriod field's value.
func (s *CreateDBInstanceInput) SetPerformanceInsightsRetentionPeriod(v int64) *CreateDBInstanceInput {
s.PerformanceInsightsRetentionPeriod = &v
return s
}
// SetPort sets the Port field's value.
func (s *CreateDBInstanceInput) SetPort(v int64) *CreateDBInstanceInput {
s.Port = &v
return s
}
// SetPreferredBackupWindow sets the PreferredBackupWindow field's value.
func (s *CreateDBInstanceInput) SetPreferredBackupWindow(v string) *CreateDBInstanceInput {
s.PreferredBackupWindow = &v
return s
}
// SetPreferredMaintenanceWindow sets the PreferredMaintenanceWindow field's value.
func (s *CreateDBInstanceInput) SetPreferredMaintenanceWindow(v string) *CreateDBInstanceInput {
s.PreferredMaintenanceWindow = &v
return s
}
// SetProcessorFeatures sets the ProcessorFeatures field's value.
func (s *CreateDBInstanceInput) SetProcessorFeatures(v []*ProcessorFeature) *CreateDBInstanceInput {
s.ProcessorFeatures = v
return s
}
// SetPromotionTier sets the PromotionTier field's value.
func (s *CreateDBInstanceInput) SetPromotionTier(v int64) *CreateDBInstanceInput {
s.PromotionTier = &v
return s
}
// SetPubliclyAccessible sets the PubliclyAccessible field's value.
func (s *CreateDBInstanceInput) SetPubliclyAccessible(v bool) *CreateDBInstanceInput {
s.PubliclyAccessible = &v
return s
}
// SetStorageEncrypted sets the StorageEncrypted field's value.
func (s *CreateDBInstanceInput) SetStorageEncrypted(v bool) *CreateDBInstanceInput {
s.StorageEncrypted = &v
return s
}
// SetStorageType sets the StorageType field's value.
func (s *CreateDBInstanceInput) SetStorageType(v string) *CreateDBInstanceInput {
s.StorageType = &v
return s
}
// SetTags sets the Tags field's value.
func (s *CreateDBInstanceInput) SetTags(v []*Tag) *CreateDBInstanceInput {
s.Tags = v
return s
}
// SetTdeCredentialArn sets the TdeCredentialArn field's value.
func (s *CreateDBInstanceInput) SetTdeCredentialArn(v string) *CreateDBInstanceInput {
s.TdeCredentialArn = &v
return s
}
// SetTdeCredentialPassword sets the TdeCredentialPassword field's value.
func (s *CreateDBInstanceInput) SetTdeCredentialPassword(v string) *CreateDBInstanceInput {
s.TdeCredentialPassword = &v
return s
}
// SetTimezone sets the Timezone field's value.
func (s *CreateDBInstanceInput) SetTimezone(v string) *CreateDBInstanceInput {
s.Timezone = &v
return s
}
// SetVpcSecurityGroupIds sets the VpcSecurityGroupIds field's value.
func (s *CreateDBInstanceInput) SetVpcSecurityGroupIds(v []*string) *CreateDBInstanceInput {
s.VpcSecurityGroupIds = v
return s
}
type CreateDBInstanceOutput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// Contains the details of an Amazon RDS DB instance.
//
// This data type is used as a response element in the DescribeDBInstances action.
DBInstance *DBInstance `type:"structure"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s CreateDBInstanceOutput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s CreateDBInstanceOutput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetDBInstance sets the DBInstance field's value.
func (s *CreateDBInstanceOutput) SetDBInstance(v *DBInstance) *CreateDBInstanceOutput {
s.DBInstance = v
return s
}
type CreateDBInstanceReadReplicaInput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// Indicates that minor engine upgrades are applied automatically to the Read
// Replica during the maintenance window.
//
// Default: Inherits from the source DB instance
AutoMinorVersionUpgrade *bool `type:"boolean"`
// The Amazon EC2 Availability Zone that the Read Replica is created in.
//
// Default: A random, system-chosen Availability Zone in the endpoint's AWS
// Region.
//
// Example: us-east-1d
AvailabilityZone *string `type:"string"`
// True to copy all tags from the Read Replica to snapshots of the Read Replica,
// and otherwise false. The default is false.
CopyTagsToSnapshot *bool `type:"boolean"`
// The compute and memory capacity of the Read Replica, for example, db.m4.large.
// Not all DB instance classes are available in all AWS Regions, or for all
// database engines. For the full list of DB instance classes, and availability
// for your engine, see DB Instance Class (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/UserGuide/Concepts.DBInstanceClass.html)
// in the Amazon RDS User Guide.
//
// Default: Inherits from the source DB instance.
DBInstanceClass *string `type:"string"`
// The DB instance identifier of the Read Replica. This identifier is the unique
// key that identifies a DB instance. This parameter is stored as a lowercase
// string.
//
// DBInstanceIdentifier is a required field
DBInstanceIdentifier *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
// Specifies a DB subnet group for the DB instance. The new DB instance is created
// in the VPC associated with the DB subnet group. If no DB subnet group is
// specified, then the new DB instance is not created in a VPC.
//
// Constraints:
//
// * Can only be specified if the source DB instance identifier specifies
// a DB instance in another AWS Region.
//
// * If supplied, must match the name of an existing DBSubnetGroup.
//
// * The specified DB subnet group must be in the same AWS Region in which
// the operation is running.
//
// * All Read Replicas in one AWS Region that are created from the same source
// DB instance must either:>
//
// Specify DB subnet groups from the same VPC. All these Read Replicas are created
// in the same VPC.
//
// Not specify a DB subnet group. All these Read Replicas are created outside
// of any VPC.
//
// Example: mySubnetgroup
DBSubnetGroupName *string `type:"string"`
// Indicates if the DB instance should have deletion protection enabled. The
// database can't be deleted when this value is set to true. The default is
// false. For more information, see Deleting a DB Instance (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/UserGuide/USER_DeleteInstance.html).
DeletionProtection *bool `type:"boolean"`
// DestinationRegion is used for presigning the request to a given region.
DestinationRegion *string `type:"string"`
// The list of logs that the new DB instance is to export to CloudWatch Logs.
// The values in the list depend on the DB engine being used. For more information,
// see Publishing Database Logs to Amazon CloudWatch Logs (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/UserGuide/USER_LogAccess.html#USER_LogAccess.Procedural.UploadtoCloudWatch)
// in the Amazon RDS User Guide.
EnableCloudwatchLogsExports []*string `type:"list"`
// True to enable mapping of AWS Identity and Access Management (IAM) accounts
// to database accounts, and otherwise false.
//
// You can enable IAM database authentication for the following database engines
//
// * For MySQL 5.6, minor version 5.6.34 or higher
//
// * For MySQL 5.7, minor version 5.7.16 or higher
//
// * Aurora MySQL 5.6 or higher
//
// Default: false
EnableIAMDatabaseAuthentication *bool `type:"boolean"`
// True to enable Performance Insights for the read replica, and otherwise false.
//
// For more information, see Using Amazon Performance Insights (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/UserGuide/USER_PerfInsights.html)
// in the Amazon RDS User Guide.
EnablePerformanceInsights *bool `type:"boolean"`
// The amount of Provisioned IOPS (input/output operations per second) to be
// initially allocated for the DB instance.
Iops *int64 `type:"integer"`
// The AWS KMS key ID for an encrypted Read Replica. The KMS key ID is the Amazon
// Resource Name (ARN), KMS key identifier, or the KMS key alias for the KMS
// encryption key.
//
// If you create an encrypted Read Replica in the same AWS Region as the source
// DB instance, then you do not have to specify a value for this parameter.
// The Read Replica is encrypted with the same KMS key as the source DB instance.
//
// If you create an encrypted Read Replica in a different AWS Region, then you
// must specify a KMS key for the destination AWS Region. KMS encryption keys
// are specific to the AWS Region that they are created in, and you can't use
// encryption keys from one AWS Region in another AWS Region.
//
// You can't create an encrypted Read Replica from an unencrypted DB instance.
KmsKeyId *string `type:"string"`
// The interval, in seconds, between points when Enhanced Monitoring metrics
// are collected for the Read Replica. To disable collecting Enhanced Monitoring
// metrics, specify 0. The default is 0.
//
// If MonitoringRoleArn is specified, then you must also set MonitoringInterval
// to a value other than 0.
//
// Valid Values: 0, 1, 5, 10, 15, 30, 60
MonitoringInterval *int64 `type:"integer"`
// The ARN for the IAM role that permits RDS to send enhanced monitoring metrics
// to Amazon CloudWatch Logs. For example, arn:aws:iam:123456789012:role/emaccess.
// For information on creating a monitoring role, go to To create an IAM role
// for Amazon RDS Enhanced Monitoring (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/UserGuide/USER_Monitoring.html#USER_Monitoring.OS.IAMRole)
// in the Amazon RDS User Guide.
//
// If MonitoringInterval is set to a value other than 0, then you must supply
// a MonitoringRoleArn value.
MonitoringRoleArn *string `type:"string"`
// Specifies whether the Read Replica is in a Multi-AZ deployment.
//
// You can create a Read Replica as a Multi-AZ DB instance. RDS creates a standby
// of your replica in another Availability Zone for failover support for the
// replica. Creating your Read Replica as a Multi-AZ DB instance is independent
// of whether the source database is a Multi-AZ DB instance.
MultiAZ *bool `type:"boolean"`
// The option group the DB instance is associated with. If omitted, the default
// option group for the engine specified is used.
OptionGroupName *string `type:"string"`
// The AWS KMS key identifier for encryption of Performance Insights data. The
// KMS key ID is the Amazon Resource Name (ARN), KMS key identifier, or the
// KMS key alias for the KMS encryption key.
PerformanceInsightsKMSKeyId *string `type:"string"`
// The amount of time, in days, to retain Performance Insights data. Valid values
// are 7 or 731 (2 years).
PerformanceInsightsRetentionPeriod *int64 `type:"integer"`
// The port number that the DB instance uses for connections.
//
// Default: Inherits from the source DB instance
//
// Valid Values: 1150-65535
Port *int64 `type:"integer"`
// The URL that contains a Signature Version 4 signed request for the CreateDBInstanceReadReplica
// API action in the source AWS Region that contains the source DB instance.
//
// You must specify this parameter when you create an encrypted Read Replica
// from another AWS Region by using the Amazon RDS API. You can specify the
// --source-region option instead of this parameter when you create an encrypted
// Read Replica from another AWS Region by using the AWS CLI.
//
// The presigned URL must be a valid request for the CreateDBInstanceReadReplica
// API action that can be executed in the source AWS Region that contains the
// encrypted source DB instance. The presigned URL request must contain the
// following parameter values:
//
// * DestinationRegion - The AWS Region that the encrypted Read Replica is
// created in. This AWS Region is the same one where the CreateDBInstanceReadReplica
// action is called that contains this presigned URL.
//
// For example, if you create an encrypted DB instance in the us-west-1 AWS
// Region, from a source DB instance in the us-east-2 AWS Region, then you
// call the CreateDBInstanceReadReplica action in the us-east-1 AWS Region
// and provide a presigned URL that contains a call to the CreateDBInstanceReadReplica
// action in the us-west-2 AWS Region. For this example, the DestinationRegion
// in the presigned URL must be set to the us-east-1 AWS Region.
//
// * KmsKeyId - The AWS KMS key identifier for the key to use to encrypt
// the Read Replica in the destination AWS Region. This is the same identifier
// for both the CreateDBInstanceReadReplica action that is called in the
// destination AWS Region, and the action contained in the presigned URL.
//
//
// * SourceDBInstanceIdentifier - The DB instance identifier for the encrypted
// DB instance to be replicated. This identifier must be in the Amazon Resource
// Name (ARN) format for the source AWS Region. For example, if you are creating
// an encrypted Read Replica from a DB instance in the us-west-2 AWS Region,
// then your SourceDBInstanceIdentifier looks like the following example:
// arn:aws:rds:us-west-2:123456789012:instance:mysql-instance1-20161115.
//
//
// To learn how to generate a Signature Version 4 signed request, see Authenticating
// Requests: Using Query Parameters (AWS Signature Version 4) (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonS3/latest/API/sigv4-query-string-auth.html)
// and Signature Version 4 Signing Process (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/general/latest/gr/signature-version-4.html).
PreSignedUrl *string `type:"string"`
// The number of CPU cores and the number of threads per core for the DB instance
// class of the DB instance.
ProcessorFeatures []*ProcessorFeature `locationNameList:"ProcessorFeature" type:"list"`
// Specifies the accessibility options for the DB instance. A value of true
// specifies an Internet-facing instance with a publicly resolvable DNS name,
// which resolves to a public IP address. A value of false specifies an internal
// instance with a DNS name that resolves to a private IP address. For more
// information, see CreateDBInstance.
PubliclyAccessible *bool `type:"boolean"`
// The identifier of the DB instance that will act as the source for the Read
// Replica. Each DB instance can have up to five Read Replicas.
//
// Constraints:
//
// * Must be the identifier of an existing MySQL, MariaDB, or PostgreSQL
// DB instance.
//
// * Can specify a DB instance that is a MySQL Read Replica only if the source
// is running MySQL 5.6 or later.
//
// * Can specify a DB instance that is a PostgreSQL DB instance only if the
// source is running PostgreSQL 9.3.5 or later (9.4.7 and higher for cross-region
// replication).
//
// * The specified DB instance must have automatic backups enabled, its backup
// retention period must be greater than 0.
//
// * If the source DB instance is in the same AWS Region as the Read Replica,
// specify a valid DB instance identifier.
//
// * If the source DB instance is in a different AWS Region than the Read
// Replica, specify a valid DB instance ARN. For more information, go to
// Constructing an ARN for Amazon RDS (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/UserGuide/USER_Tagging.ARN.html#USER_Tagging.ARN.Constructing)
// in the Amazon RDS User Guide.
//
// SourceDBInstanceIdentifier is a required field
SourceDBInstanceIdentifier *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
// SourceRegion is the source region where the resource exists. This is not
// sent over the wire and is only used for presigning. This value should always
// have the same region as the source ARN.
SourceRegion *string `type:"string" ignore:"true"`
// Specifies the storage type to be associated with the Read Replica.
//
// Valid values: standard | gp2 | io1
//
// If you specify io1, you must also include a value for the Iops parameter.
//
// Default: io1 if the Iops parameter is specified, otherwise standard
StorageType *string `type:"string"`
// A list of tags. For more information, see Tagging Amazon RDS Resources (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/UserGuide/USER_Tagging.html)
// in the Amazon RDS User Guide.
Tags []*Tag `locationNameList:"Tag" type:"list"`
// A value that specifies that the DB instance class of the DB instance uses
// its default processor features.
UseDefaultProcessorFeatures *bool `type:"boolean"`
// A list of EC2 VPC security groups to associate with the Read Replica.
//
// Default: The default EC2 VPC security group for the DB subnet group's VPC.
VpcSecurityGroupIds []*string `locationNameList:"VpcSecurityGroupId" type:"list"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s CreateDBInstanceReadReplicaInput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s CreateDBInstanceReadReplicaInput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
func (s *CreateDBInstanceReadReplicaInput) Validate() error {
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "CreateDBInstanceReadReplicaInput"}
if s.DBInstanceIdentifier == nil {
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("DBInstanceIdentifier"))
}
if s.SourceDBInstanceIdentifier == nil {
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("SourceDBInstanceIdentifier"))
}
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
return invalidParams
}
return nil
}
// SetAutoMinorVersionUpgrade sets the AutoMinorVersionUpgrade field's value.
func (s *CreateDBInstanceReadReplicaInput) SetAutoMinorVersionUpgrade(v bool) *CreateDBInstanceReadReplicaInput {
s.AutoMinorVersionUpgrade = &v
return s
}
// SetAvailabilityZone sets the AvailabilityZone field's value.
func (s *CreateDBInstanceReadReplicaInput) SetAvailabilityZone(v string) *CreateDBInstanceReadReplicaInput {
s.AvailabilityZone = &v
return s
}
// SetCopyTagsToSnapshot sets the CopyTagsToSnapshot field's value.
func (s *CreateDBInstanceReadReplicaInput) SetCopyTagsToSnapshot(v bool) *CreateDBInstanceReadReplicaInput {
s.CopyTagsToSnapshot = &v
return s
}
// SetDBInstanceClass sets the DBInstanceClass field's value.
func (s *CreateDBInstanceReadReplicaInput) SetDBInstanceClass(v string) *CreateDBInstanceReadReplicaInput {
s.DBInstanceClass = &v
return s
}
// SetDBInstanceIdentifier sets the DBInstanceIdentifier field's value.
func (s *CreateDBInstanceReadReplicaInput) SetDBInstanceIdentifier(v string) *CreateDBInstanceReadReplicaInput {
s.DBInstanceIdentifier = &v
return s
}
// SetDBSubnetGroupName sets the DBSubnetGroupName field's value.
func (s *CreateDBInstanceReadReplicaInput) SetDBSubnetGroupName(v string) *CreateDBInstanceReadReplicaInput {
s.DBSubnetGroupName = &v
return s
}
// SetDeletionProtection sets the DeletionProtection field's value.
func (s *CreateDBInstanceReadReplicaInput) SetDeletionProtection(v bool) *CreateDBInstanceReadReplicaInput {
s.DeletionProtection = &v
return s
}
// SetDestinationRegion sets the DestinationRegion field's value.
func (s *CreateDBInstanceReadReplicaInput) SetDestinationRegion(v string) *CreateDBInstanceReadReplicaInput {
s.DestinationRegion = &v
return s
}
// SetEnableCloudwatchLogsExports sets the EnableCloudwatchLogsExports field's value.
func (s *CreateDBInstanceReadReplicaInput) SetEnableCloudwatchLogsExports(v []*string) *CreateDBInstanceReadReplicaInput {
s.EnableCloudwatchLogsExports = v
return s
}
// SetEnableIAMDatabaseAuthentication sets the EnableIAMDatabaseAuthentication field's value.
func (s *CreateDBInstanceReadReplicaInput) SetEnableIAMDatabaseAuthentication(v bool) *CreateDBInstanceReadReplicaInput {
s.EnableIAMDatabaseAuthentication = &v
return s
}
// SetEnablePerformanceInsights sets the EnablePerformanceInsights field's value.
func (s *CreateDBInstanceReadReplicaInput) SetEnablePerformanceInsights(v bool) *CreateDBInstanceReadReplicaInput {
s.EnablePerformanceInsights = &v
return s
}
// SetIops sets the Iops field's value.
func (s *CreateDBInstanceReadReplicaInput) SetIops(v int64) *CreateDBInstanceReadReplicaInput {
s.Iops = &v
return s
}
// SetKmsKeyId sets the KmsKeyId field's value.
func (s *CreateDBInstanceReadReplicaInput) SetKmsKeyId(v string) *CreateDBInstanceReadReplicaInput {
s.KmsKeyId = &v
return s
}
// SetMonitoringInterval sets the MonitoringInterval field's value.
func (s *CreateDBInstanceReadReplicaInput) SetMonitoringInterval(v int64) *CreateDBInstanceReadReplicaInput {
s.MonitoringInterval = &v
return s
}
// SetMonitoringRoleArn sets the MonitoringRoleArn field's value.
func (s *CreateDBInstanceReadReplicaInput) SetMonitoringRoleArn(v string) *CreateDBInstanceReadReplicaInput {
s.MonitoringRoleArn = &v
return s
}
// SetMultiAZ sets the MultiAZ field's value.
func (s *CreateDBInstanceReadReplicaInput) SetMultiAZ(v bool) *CreateDBInstanceReadReplicaInput {
s.MultiAZ = &v
return s
}
// SetOptionGroupName sets the OptionGroupName field's value.
func (s *CreateDBInstanceReadReplicaInput) SetOptionGroupName(v string) *CreateDBInstanceReadReplicaInput {
s.OptionGroupName = &v
return s
}
// SetPerformanceInsightsKMSKeyId sets the PerformanceInsightsKMSKeyId field's value.
func (s *CreateDBInstanceReadReplicaInput) SetPerformanceInsightsKMSKeyId(v string) *CreateDBInstanceReadReplicaInput {
s.PerformanceInsightsKMSKeyId = &v
return s
}
// SetPerformanceInsightsRetentionPeriod sets the PerformanceInsightsRetentionPeriod field's value.
func (s *CreateDBInstanceReadReplicaInput) SetPerformanceInsightsRetentionPeriod(v int64) *CreateDBInstanceReadReplicaInput {
s.PerformanceInsightsRetentionPeriod = &v
return s
}
// SetPort sets the Port field's value.
func (s *CreateDBInstanceReadReplicaInput) SetPort(v int64) *CreateDBInstanceReadReplicaInput {
s.Port = &v
return s
}
// SetPreSignedUrl sets the PreSignedUrl field's value.
func (s *CreateDBInstanceReadReplicaInput) SetPreSignedUrl(v string) *CreateDBInstanceReadReplicaInput {
s.PreSignedUrl = &v
return s
}
// SetProcessorFeatures sets the ProcessorFeatures field's value.
func (s *CreateDBInstanceReadReplicaInput) SetProcessorFeatures(v []*ProcessorFeature) *CreateDBInstanceReadReplicaInput {
s.ProcessorFeatures = v
return s
}
// SetPubliclyAccessible sets the PubliclyAccessible field's value.
func (s *CreateDBInstanceReadReplicaInput) SetPubliclyAccessible(v bool) *CreateDBInstanceReadReplicaInput {
s.PubliclyAccessible = &v
return s
}
// SetSourceDBInstanceIdentifier sets the SourceDBInstanceIdentifier field's value.
func (s *CreateDBInstanceReadReplicaInput) SetSourceDBInstanceIdentifier(v string) *CreateDBInstanceReadReplicaInput {
s.SourceDBInstanceIdentifier = &v
return s
}
// SetSourceRegion sets the SourceRegion field's value.
func (s *CreateDBInstanceReadReplicaInput) SetSourceRegion(v string) *CreateDBInstanceReadReplicaInput {
s.SourceRegion = &v
return s
}
// SetStorageType sets the StorageType field's value.
func (s *CreateDBInstanceReadReplicaInput) SetStorageType(v string) *CreateDBInstanceReadReplicaInput {
s.StorageType = &v
return s
}
// SetTags sets the Tags field's value.
func (s *CreateDBInstanceReadReplicaInput) SetTags(v []*Tag) *CreateDBInstanceReadReplicaInput {
s.Tags = v
return s
}
// SetUseDefaultProcessorFeatures sets the UseDefaultProcessorFeatures field's value.
func (s *CreateDBInstanceReadReplicaInput) SetUseDefaultProcessorFeatures(v bool) *CreateDBInstanceReadReplicaInput {
s.UseDefaultProcessorFeatures = &v
return s
}
// SetVpcSecurityGroupIds sets the VpcSecurityGroupIds field's value.
func (s *CreateDBInstanceReadReplicaInput) SetVpcSecurityGroupIds(v []*string) *CreateDBInstanceReadReplicaInput {
s.VpcSecurityGroupIds = v
return s
}
type CreateDBInstanceReadReplicaOutput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// Contains the details of an Amazon RDS DB instance.
//
// This data type is used as a response element in the DescribeDBInstances action.
DBInstance *DBInstance `type:"structure"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s CreateDBInstanceReadReplicaOutput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s CreateDBInstanceReadReplicaOutput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetDBInstance sets the DBInstance field's value.
func (s *CreateDBInstanceReadReplicaOutput) SetDBInstance(v *DBInstance) *CreateDBInstanceReadReplicaOutput {
s.DBInstance = v
return s
}
type CreateDBParameterGroupInput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// The DB parameter group family name. A DB parameter group can be associated
// with one and only one DB parameter group family, and can be applied only
// to a DB instance running a database engine and engine version compatible
// with that DB parameter group family.
//
// To list all of the available parameter group families, use the following
// command:
//
// aws rds describe-db-engine-versions --query "DBEngineVersions[].DBParameterGroupFamily"
//
// The output contains duplicates.
//
// DBParameterGroupFamily is a required field
DBParameterGroupFamily *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
// The name of the DB parameter group.
//
// Constraints:
//
// * Must be 1 to 255 letters, numbers, or hyphens.
//
// * First character must be a letter
//
// * Can't end with a hyphen or contain two consecutive hyphens
//
// This value is stored as a lowercase string.
//
// DBParameterGroupName is a required field
DBParameterGroupName *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
// The description for the DB parameter group.
//
// Description is a required field
Description *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
// A list of tags. For more information, see Tagging Amazon RDS Resources (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/UserGuide/USER_Tagging.html)
// in the Amazon RDS User Guide.
Tags []*Tag `locationNameList:"Tag" type:"list"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s CreateDBParameterGroupInput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s CreateDBParameterGroupInput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
func (s *CreateDBParameterGroupInput) Validate() error {
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "CreateDBParameterGroupInput"}
if s.DBParameterGroupFamily == nil {
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("DBParameterGroupFamily"))
}
if s.DBParameterGroupName == nil {
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("DBParameterGroupName"))
}
if s.Description == nil {
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Description"))
}
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
return invalidParams
}
return nil
}
// SetDBParameterGroupFamily sets the DBParameterGroupFamily field's value.
func (s *CreateDBParameterGroupInput) SetDBParameterGroupFamily(v string) *CreateDBParameterGroupInput {
s.DBParameterGroupFamily = &v
return s
}
// SetDBParameterGroupName sets the DBParameterGroupName field's value.
func (s *CreateDBParameterGroupInput) SetDBParameterGroupName(v string) *CreateDBParameterGroupInput {
s.DBParameterGroupName = &v
return s
}
// SetDescription sets the Description field's value.
func (s *CreateDBParameterGroupInput) SetDescription(v string) *CreateDBParameterGroupInput {
s.Description = &v
return s
}
// SetTags sets the Tags field's value.
func (s *CreateDBParameterGroupInput) SetTags(v []*Tag) *CreateDBParameterGroupInput {
s.Tags = v
return s
}
type CreateDBParameterGroupOutput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// Contains the details of an Amazon RDS DB parameter group.
//
// This data type is used as a response element in the DescribeDBParameterGroups
// action.
DBParameterGroup *DBParameterGroup `type:"structure"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s CreateDBParameterGroupOutput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s CreateDBParameterGroupOutput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetDBParameterGroup sets the DBParameterGroup field's value.
func (s *CreateDBParameterGroupOutput) SetDBParameterGroup(v *DBParameterGroup) *CreateDBParameterGroupOutput {
s.DBParameterGroup = v
return s
}
type CreateDBSecurityGroupInput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// The description for the DB security group.
//
// DBSecurityGroupDescription is a required field
DBSecurityGroupDescription *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
// The name for the DB security group. This value is stored as a lowercase string.
//
// Constraints:
//
// * Must be 1 to 255 letters, numbers, or hyphens.
//
// * First character must be a letter
//
// * Can't end with a hyphen or contain two consecutive hyphens
//
// * Must not be "Default"
//
// Example: mysecuritygroup
//
// DBSecurityGroupName is a required field
DBSecurityGroupName *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
// A list of tags. For more information, see Tagging Amazon RDS Resources (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/UserGuide/USER_Tagging.html)
// in the Amazon RDS User Guide.
Tags []*Tag `locationNameList:"Tag" type:"list"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s CreateDBSecurityGroupInput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s CreateDBSecurityGroupInput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
func (s *CreateDBSecurityGroupInput) Validate() error {
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "CreateDBSecurityGroupInput"}
if s.DBSecurityGroupDescription == nil {
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("DBSecurityGroupDescription"))
}
if s.DBSecurityGroupName == nil {
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("DBSecurityGroupName"))
}
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
return invalidParams
}
return nil
}
// SetDBSecurityGroupDescription sets the DBSecurityGroupDescription field's value.
func (s *CreateDBSecurityGroupInput) SetDBSecurityGroupDescription(v string) *CreateDBSecurityGroupInput {
s.DBSecurityGroupDescription = &v
return s
}
// SetDBSecurityGroupName sets the DBSecurityGroupName field's value.
func (s *CreateDBSecurityGroupInput) SetDBSecurityGroupName(v string) *CreateDBSecurityGroupInput {
s.DBSecurityGroupName = &v
return s
}
// SetTags sets the Tags field's value.
func (s *CreateDBSecurityGroupInput) SetTags(v []*Tag) *CreateDBSecurityGroupInput {
s.Tags = v
return s
}
type CreateDBSecurityGroupOutput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// Contains the details for an Amazon RDS DB security group.
//
// This data type is used as a response element in the DescribeDBSecurityGroups
// action.
DBSecurityGroup *DBSecurityGroup `type:"structure"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s CreateDBSecurityGroupOutput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s CreateDBSecurityGroupOutput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetDBSecurityGroup sets the DBSecurityGroup field's value.
func (s *CreateDBSecurityGroupOutput) SetDBSecurityGroup(v *DBSecurityGroup) *CreateDBSecurityGroupOutput {
s.DBSecurityGroup = v
return s
}
type CreateDBSnapshotInput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// The identifier of the DB instance that you want to create the snapshot of.
//
// Constraints:
//
// * Must match the identifier of an existing DBInstance.
//
// DBInstanceIdentifier is a required field
DBInstanceIdentifier *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
// The identifier for the DB snapshot.
//
// Constraints:
//
// * Can't be null, empty, or blank
//
// * Must contain from 1 to 255 letters, numbers, or hyphens
//
// * First character must be a letter
//
// * Can't end with a hyphen or contain two consecutive hyphens
//
// Example: my-snapshot-id
//
// DBSnapshotIdentifier is a required field
DBSnapshotIdentifier *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
// A list of tags. For more information, see Tagging Amazon RDS Resources (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/UserGuide/USER_Tagging.html)
// in the Amazon RDS User Guide.
Tags []*Tag `locationNameList:"Tag" type:"list"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s CreateDBSnapshotInput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s CreateDBSnapshotInput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
func (s *CreateDBSnapshotInput) Validate() error {
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "CreateDBSnapshotInput"}
if s.DBInstanceIdentifier == nil {
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("DBInstanceIdentifier"))
}
if s.DBSnapshotIdentifier == nil {
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("DBSnapshotIdentifier"))
}
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
return invalidParams
}
return nil
}
// SetDBInstanceIdentifier sets the DBInstanceIdentifier field's value.
func (s *CreateDBSnapshotInput) SetDBInstanceIdentifier(v string) *CreateDBSnapshotInput {
s.DBInstanceIdentifier = &v
return s
}
// SetDBSnapshotIdentifier sets the DBSnapshotIdentifier field's value.
func (s *CreateDBSnapshotInput) SetDBSnapshotIdentifier(v string) *CreateDBSnapshotInput {
s.DBSnapshotIdentifier = &v
return s
}
// SetTags sets the Tags field's value.
func (s *CreateDBSnapshotInput) SetTags(v []*Tag) *CreateDBSnapshotInput {
s.Tags = v
return s
}
type CreateDBSnapshotOutput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// Contains the details of an Amazon RDS DB snapshot.
//
// This data type is used as a response element in the DescribeDBSnapshots action.
DBSnapshot *DBSnapshot `type:"structure"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s CreateDBSnapshotOutput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s CreateDBSnapshotOutput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetDBSnapshot sets the DBSnapshot field's value.
func (s *CreateDBSnapshotOutput) SetDBSnapshot(v *DBSnapshot) *CreateDBSnapshotOutput {
s.DBSnapshot = v
return s
}
type CreateDBSubnetGroupInput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// The description for the DB subnet group.
//
// DBSubnetGroupDescription is a required field
DBSubnetGroupDescription *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
// The name for the DB subnet group. This value is stored as a lowercase string.
//
// Constraints: Must contain no more than 255 letters, numbers, periods, underscores,
// spaces, or hyphens. Must not be default.
//
// Example: mySubnetgroup
//
// DBSubnetGroupName is a required field
DBSubnetGroupName *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
// The EC2 Subnet IDs for the DB subnet group.
//
// SubnetIds is a required field
SubnetIds []*string `locationNameList:"SubnetIdentifier" type:"list" required:"true"`
// A list of tags. For more information, see Tagging Amazon RDS Resources (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/UserGuide/USER_Tagging.html)
// in the Amazon RDS User Guide.
Tags []*Tag `locationNameList:"Tag" type:"list"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s CreateDBSubnetGroupInput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s CreateDBSubnetGroupInput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
func (s *CreateDBSubnetGroupInput) Validate() error {
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "CreateDBSubnetGroupInput"}
if s.DBSubnetGroupDescription == nil {
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("DBSubnetGroupDescription"))
}
if s.DBSubnetGroupName == nil {
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("DBSubnetGroupName"))
}
if s.SubnetIds == nil {
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("SubnetIds"))
}
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
return invalidParams
}
return nil
}
// SetDBSubnetGroupDescription sets the DBSubnetGroupDescription field's value.
func (s *CreateDBSubnetGroupInput) SetDBSubnetGroupDescription(v string) *CreateDBSubnetGroupInput {
s.DBSubnetGroupDescription = &v
return s
}
// SetDBSubnetGroupName sets the DBSubnetGroupName field's value.
func (s *CreateDBSubnetGroupInput) SetDBSubnetGroupName(v string) *CreateDBSubnetGroupInput {
s.DBSubnetGroupName = &v
return s
}
// SetSubnetIds sets the SubnetIds field's value.
func (s *CreateDBSubnetGroupInput) SetSubnetIds(v []*string) *CreateDBSubnetGroupInput {
s.SubnetIds = v
return s
}
// SetTags sets the Tags field's value.
func (s *CreateDBSubnetGroupInput) SetTags(v []*Tag) *CreateDBSubnetGroupInput {
s.Tags = v
return s
}
type CreateDBSubnetGroupOutput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// Contains the details of an Amazon RDS DB subnet group.
//
// This data type is used as a response element in the DescribeDBSubnetGroups
// action.
DBSubnetGroup *DBSubnetGroup `type:"structure"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s CreateDBSubnetGroupOutput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s CreateDBSubnetGroupOutput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetDBSubnetGroup sets the DBSubnetGroup field's value.
func (s *CreateDBSubnetGroupOutput) SetDBSubnetGroup(v *DBSubnetGroup) *CreateDBSubnetGroupOutput {
s.DBSubnetGroup = v
return s
}
type CreateEventSubscriptionInput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// A Boolean value; set to true to activate the subscription, set to false to
// create the subscription but not active it.
Enabled *bool `type:"boolean"`
// A list of event categories for a SourceType that you want to subscribe to.
// You can see a list of the categories for a given SourceType in the Events
// (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/UserGuide/USER_Events.html)
// topic in the Amazon RDS User Guide or by using the DescribeEventCategories
// action.
EventCategories []*string `locationNameList:"EventCategory" type:"list"`
// The Amazon Resource Name (ARN) of the SNS topic created for event notification.
// The ARN is created by Amazon SNS when you create a topic and subscribe to
// it.
//
// SnsTopicArn is a required field
SnsTopicArn *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
// The list of identifiers of the event sources for which events are returned.
// If not specified, then all sources are included in the response. An identifier
// must begin with a letter and must contain only ASCII letters, digits, and
// hyphens; it can't end with a hyphen or contain two consecutive hyphens.
//
// Constraints:
//
// * If SourceIds are supplied, SourceType must also be provided.
//
// * If the source type is a DB instance, then a DBInstanceIdentifier must
// be supplied.
//
// * If the source type is a DB security group, a DBSecurityGroupName must
// be supplied.
//
// * If the source type is a DB parameter group, a DBParameterGroupName must
// be supplied.
//
// * If the source type is a DB snapshot, a DBSnapshotIdentifier must be
// supplied.
SourceIds []*string `locationNameList:"SourceId" type:"list"`
// The type of source that is generating the events. For example, if you want
// to be notified of events generated by a DB instance, you would set this parameter
// to db-instance. if this value is not specified, all events are returned.
//
// Valid values: db-instance | db-cluster | db-parameter-group | db-security-group
// | db-snapshot | db-cluster-snapshot
SourceType *string `type:"string"`
// The name of the subscription.
//
// Constraints: The name must be less than 255 characters.
//
// SubscriptionName is a required field
SubscriptionName *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
// A list of tags. For more information, see Tagging Amazon RDS Resources (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/UserGuide/USER_Tagging.html)
// in the Amazon RDS User Guide.
Tags []*Tag `locationNameList:"Tag" type:"list"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s CreateEventSubscriptionInput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s CreateEventSubscriptionInput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
func (s *CreateEventSubscriptionInput) Validate() error {
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "CreateEventSubscriptionInput"}
if s.SnsTopicArn == nil {
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("SnsTopicArn"))
}
if s.SubscriptionName == nil {
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("SubscriptionName"))
}
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
return invalidParams
}
return nil
}
// SetEnabled sets the Enabled field's value.
func (s *CreateEventSubscriptionInput) SetEnabled(v bool) *CreateEventSubscriptionInput {
s.Enabled = &v
return s
}
// SetEventCategories sets the EventCategories field's value.
func (s *CreateEventSubscriptionInput) SetEventCategories(v []*string) *CreateEventSubscriptionInput {
s.EventCategories = v
return s
}
// SetSnsTopicArn sets the SnsTopicArn field's value.
func (s *CreateEventSubscriptionInput) SetSnsTopicArn(v string) *CreateEventSubscriptionInput {
s.SnsTopicArn = &v
return s
}
// SetSourceIds sets the SourceIds field's value.
func (s *CreateEventSubscriptionInput) SetSourceIds(v []*string) *CreateEventSubscriptionInput {
s.SourceIds = v
return s
}
// SetSourceType sets the SourceType field's value.
func (s *CreateEventSubscriptionInput) SetSourceType(v string) *CreateEventSubscriptionInput {
s.SourceType = &v
return s
}
// SetSubscriptionName sets the SubscriptionName field's value.
func (s *CreateEventSubscriptionInput) SetSubscriptionName(v string) *CreateEventSubscriptionInput {
s.SubscriptionName = &v
return s
}
// SetTags sets the Tags field's value.
func (s *CreateEventSubscriptionInput) SetTags(v []*Tag) *CreateEventSubscriptionInput {
s.Tags = v
return s
}
type CreateEventSubscriptionOutput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// Contains the results of a successful invocation of the DescribeEventSubscriptions
// action.
EventSubscription *EventSubscription `type:"structure"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s CreateEventSubscriptionOutput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s CreateEventSubscriptionOutput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetEventSubscription sets the EventSubscription field's value.
func (s *CreateEventSubscriptionOutput) SetEventSubscription(v *EventSubscription) *CreateEventSubscriptionOutput {
s.EventSubscription = v
return s
}
type CreateGlobalClusterInput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// The name for your database of up to 64 alpha-numeric characters. If you do
// not provide a name, Amazon Aurora will not create a database in the global
// database cluster you are creating.
DatabaseName *string `type:"string"`
// The deletion protection setting for the new global database. The global database
// can't be deleted when this value is set to true.
DeletionProtection *bool `type:"boolean"`
// Provides the name of the database engine to be used for this DB cluster.
Engine *string `type:"string"`
// The engine version of the Aurora global database.
EngineVersion *string `type:"string"`
// The cluster identifier of the new global database cluster.
GlobalClusterIdentifier *string `type:"string"`
// The Amazon Resource Name (ARN) to use as the primary cluster of the global
// database. This parameter is optional.
SourceDBClusterIdentifier *string `type:"string"`
// The storage encryption setting for the new global database cluster.
StorageEncrypted *bool `type:"boolean"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s CreateGlobalClusterInput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s CreateGlobalClusterInput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetDatabaseName sets the DatabaseName field's value.
func (s *CreateGlobalClusterInput) SetDatabaseName(v string) *CreateGlobalClusterInput {
s.DatabaseName = &v
return s
}
// SetDeletionProtection sets the DeletionProtection field's value.
func (s *CreateGlobalClusterInput) SetDeletionProtection(v bool) *CreateGlobalClusterInput {
s.DeletionProtection = &v
return s
}
// SetEngine sets the Engine field's value.
func (s *CreateGlobalClusterInput) SetEngine(v string) *CreateGlobalClusterInput {
s.Engine = &v
return s
}
// SetEngineVersion sets the EngineVersion field's value.
func (s *CreateGlobalClusterInput) SetEngineVersion(v string) *CreateGlobalClusterInput {
s.EngineVersion = &v
return s
}
// SetGlobalClusterIdentifier sets the GlobalClusterIdentifier field's value.
func (s *CreateGlobalClusterInput) SetGlobalClusterIdentifier(v string) *CreateGlobalClusterInput {
s.GlobalClusterIdentifier = &v
return s
}
// SetSourceDBClusterIdentifier sets the SourceDBClusterIdentifier field's value.
func (s *CreateGlobalClusterInput) SetSourceDBClusterIdentifier(v string) *CreateGlobalClusterInput {
s.SourceDBClusterIdentifier = &v
return s
}
// SetStorageEncrypted sets the StorageEncrypted field's value.
func (s *CreateGlobalClusterInput) SetStorageEncrypted(v bool) *CreateGlobalClusterInput {
s.StorageEncrypted = &v
return s
}
type CreateGlobalClusterOutput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// A data type representing an Aurora global database.
GlobalCluster *GlobalCluster `type:"structure"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s CreateGlobalClusterOutput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s CreateGlobalClusterOutput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetGlobalCluster sets the GlobalCluster field's value.
func (s *CreateGlobalClusterOutput) SetGlobalCluster(v *GlobalCluster) *CreateGlobalClusterOutput {
s.GlobalCluster = v
return s
}
type CreateOptionGroupInput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// Specifies the name of the engine that this option group should be associated
// with.
//
// EngineName is a required field
EngineName *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
// Specifies the major version of the engine that this option group should be
// associated with.
//
// MajorEngineVersion is a required field
MajorEngineVersion *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
// The description of the option group.
//
// OptionGroupDescription is a required field
OptionGroupDescription *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
// Specifies the name of the option group to be created.
//
// Constraints:
//
// * Must be 1 to 255 letters, numbers, or hyphens
//
// * First character must be a letter
//
// * Can't end with a hyphen or contain two consecutive hyphens
//
// Example: myoptiongroup
//
// OptionGroupName is a required field
OptionGroupName *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
// A list of tags. For more information, see Tagging Amazon RDS Resources (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/UserGuide/USER_Tagging.html)
// in the Amazon RDS User Guide.
Tags []*Tag `locationNameList:"Tag" type:"list"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s CreateOptionGroupInput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s CreateOptionGroupInput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
func (s *CreateOptionGroupInput) Validate() error {
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "CreateOptionGroupInput"}
if s.EngineName == nil {
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("EngineName"))
}
if s.MajorEngineVersion == nil {
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("MajorEngineVersion"))
}
if s.OptionGroupDescription == nil {
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("OptionGroupDescription"))
}
if s.OptionGroupName == nil {
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("OptionGroupName"))
}
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
return invalidParams
}
return nil
}
// SetEngineName sets the EngineName field's value.
func (s *CreateOptionGroupInput) SetEngineName(v string) *CreateOptionGroupInput {
s.EngineName = &v
return s
}
// SetMajorEngineVersion sets the MajorEngineVersion field's value.
func (s *CreateOptionGroupInput) SetMajorEngineVersion(v string) *CreateOptionGroupInput {
s.MajorEngineVersion = &v
return s
}
// SetOptionGroupDescription sets the OptionGroupDescription field's value.
func (s *CreateOptionGroupInput) SetOptionGroupDescription(v string) *CreateOptionGroupInput {
s.OptionGroupDescription = &v
return s
}
// SetOptionGroupName sets the OptionGroupName field's value.
func (s *CreateOptionGroupInput) SetOptionGroupName(v string) *CreateOptionGroupInput {
s.OptionGroupName = &v
return s
}
// SetTags sets the Tags field's value.
func (s *CreateOptionGroupInput) SetTags(v []*Tag) *CreateOptionGroupInput {
s.Tags = v
return s
}
type CreateOptionGroupOutput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
OptionGroup *OptionGroup `type:"structure"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s CreateOptionGroupOutput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s CreateOptionGroupOutput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetOptionGroup sets the OptionGroup field's value.
func (s *CreateOptionGroupOutput) SetOptionGroup(v *OptionGroup) *CreateOptionGroupOutput {
s.OptionGroup = v
return s
}
// Contains the details of an Amazon Aurora DB cluster.
//
// This data type is used as a response element in the DescribeDBClusters, StopDBCluster,
// and StartDBCluster actions.
type DBCluster struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// For all database engines except Amazon Aurora, AllocatedStorage specifies
// the allocated storage size in gibibytes (GiB). For Aurora, AllocatedStorage
// always returns 1, because Aurora DB cluster storage size is not fixed, but
// instead automatically adjusts as needed.
AllocatedStorage *int64 `type:"integer"`
// Provides a list of the AWS Identity and Access Management (IAM) roles that
// are associated with the DB cluster. IAM roles that are associated with a
// DB cluster grant permission for the DB cluster to access other AWS services
// on your behalf.
AssociatedRoles []*DBClusterRole `locationNameList:"DBClusterRole" type:"list"`
// Provides the list of EC2 Availability Zones that instances in the DB cluster
// can be created in.
AvailabilityZones []*string `locationNameList:"AvailabilityZone" type:"list"`
// The number of change records stored for Backtrack.
BacktrackConsumedChangeRecords *int64 `type:"long"`
// The target backtrack window, in seconds. If this value is set to 0, backtracking
// is disabled for the DB cluster. Otherwise, backtracking is enabled.
BacktrackWindow *int64 `type:"long"`
// Specifies the number of days for which automatic DB snapshots are retained.
BackupRetentionPeriod *int64 `type:"integer"`
// The current capacity of an Aurora Serverless DB cluster. The capacity is
// 0 (zero) when the cluster is paused.
//
// For more information about Aurora Serverless, see Using Amazon Aurora Serverless
// (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/AuroraUserGuide/aurora-serverless.html)
// in the Amazon Aurora User Guide.
Capacity *int64 `type:"integer"`
// If present, specifies the name of the character set that this cluster is
// associated with.
CharacterSetName *string `type:"string"`
// Identifies the clone group to which the DB cluster is associated.
CloneGroupId *string `type:"string"`
// Specifies the time when the DB cluster was created, in Universal Coordinated
// Time (UTC).
ClusterCreateTime *time.Time `type:"timestamp"`
// Specifies whether tags are copied from the DB cluster to snapshots of the
// DB cluster.
CopyTagsToSnapshot *bool `type:"boolean"`
// Identifies all custom endpoints associated with the cluster.
CustomEndpoints []*string `type:"list"`
// The Amazon Resource Name (ARN) for the DB cluster.
DBClusterArn *string `type:"string"`
// Contains a user-supplied DB cluster identifier. This identifier is the unique
// key that identifies a DB cluster.
DBClusterIdentifier *string `type:"string"`
// Provides the list of instances that make up the DB cluster.
DBClusterMembers []*DBClusterMember `locationNameList:"DBClusterMember" type:"list"`
// Provides the list of option group memberships for this DB cluster.
DBClusterOptionGroupMemberships []*DBClusterOptionGroupStatus `locationNameList:"DBClusterOptionGroup" type:"list"`
// Specifies the name of the DB cluster parameter group for the DB cluster.
DBClusterParameterGroup *string `type:"string"`
// Specifies information on the subnet group associated with the DB cluster,
// including the name, description, and subnets in the subnet group.
DBSubnetGroup *string `type:"string"`
// Contains the name of the initial database of this DB cluster that was provided
// at create time, if one was specified when the DB cluster was created. This
// same name is returned for the life of the DB cluster.
DatabaseName *string `type:"string"`
// The AWS Region-unique, immutable identifier for the DB cluster. This identifier
// is found in AWS CloudTrail log entries whenever the AWS KMS key for the DB
// cluster is accessed.
DbClusterResourceId *string `type:"string"`
// Indicates if the DB cluster has deletion protection enabled. The database
// can't be deleted when this value is set to true.
DeletionProtection *bool `type:"boolean"`
// The earliest time to which a DB cluster can be backtracked.
EarliestBacktrackTime *time.Time `type:"timestamp"`
// The earliest time to which a database can be restored with point-in-time
// restore.
EarliestRestorableTime *time.Time `type:"timestamp"`
// A list of log types that this DB cluster is configured to export to CloudWatch
// Logs.
//
// Log types vary by DB engine. For information about the log types for each
// DB engine, see Amazon RDS Database Log Files (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/AuroraUserGuide/USER_LogAccess.html)
// in the Amazon Aurora User Guide.
EnabledCloudwatchLogsExports []*string `type:"list"`
// Specifies the connection endpoint for the primary instance of the DB cluster.
Endpoint *string `type:"string"`
// Provides the name of the database engine to be used for this DB cluster.
Engine *string `type:"string"`
// The DB engine mode of the DB cluster, either provisioned, serverless, or
// parallelquery.
EngineMode *string `type:"string"`
// Indicates the database engine version.
EngineVersion *string `type:"string"`
// Specifies the ID that Amazon Route 53 assigns when you create a hosted zone.
HostedZoneId *string `type:"string"`
// HTTP endpoint functionality is in beta for Aurora Serverless and is subject
// to change.
//
// Value that is true if the HTTP endpoint for an Aurora Serverless DB cluster
// is enabled and false otherwise.
//
// When enabled, the HTTP endpoint provides a connectionless web service API
// for running SQL queries on the Aurora Serverless DB cluster. You can also
// query your database from inside the RDS console with the query editor.
//
// For more information about Aurora Serverless, see Using Amazon Aurora Serverless
// (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/AuroraUserGuide/aurora-serverless.html)
// in the Amazon Aurora User Guide.
HttpEndpointEnabled *bool `type:"boolean"`
// True if mapping of AWS Identity and Access Management (IAM) accounts to database
// accounts is enabled, and otherwise false.
IAMDatabaseAuthenticationEnabled *bool `type:"boolean"`
// If StorageEncrypted is true, the AWS KMS key identifier for the encrypted
// DB cluster.
KmsKeyId *string `type:"string"`
// Specifies the latest time to which a database can be restored with point-in-time
// restore.
LatestRestorableTime *time.Time `type:"timestamp"`
// Contains the master username for the DB cluster.
MasterUsername *string `type:"string"`
// Specifies whether the DB cluster has instances in multiple Availability Zones.
MultiAZ *bool `type:"boolean"`
// Specifies the progress of the operation as a percentage.
PercentProgress *string `type:"string"`
// Specifies the port that the database engine is listening on.
Port *int64 `type:"integer"`
// Specifies the daily time range during which automated backups are created
// if automated backups are enabled, as determined by the BackupRetentionPeriod.
PreferredBackupWindow *string `type:"string"`
// Specifies the weekly time range during which system maintenance can occur,
// in Universal Coordinated Time (UTC).
PreferredMaintenanceWindow *string `type:"string"`
// Contains one or more identifiers of the Read Replicas associated with this
// DB cluster.
ReadReplicaIdentifiers []*string `locationNameList:"ReadReplicaIdentifier" type:"list"`
// The reader endpoint for the DB cluster. The reader endpoint for a DB cluster
// load-balances connections across the Aurora Replicas that are available in
// a DB cluster. As clients request new connections to the reader endpoint,
// Aurora distributes the connection requests among the Aurora Replicas in the
// DB cluster. This functionality can help balance your read workload across
// multiple Aurora Replicas in your DB cluster.
//
// If a failover occurs, and the Aurora Replica that you are connected to is
// promoted to be the primary instance, your connection is dropped. To continue
// sending your read workload to other Aurora Replicas in the cluster, you can
// then reconnect to the reader endpoint.
ReaderEndpoint *string `type:"string"`
// Contains the identifier of the source DB cluster if this DB cluster is a
// Read Replica.
ReplicationSourceIdentifier *string `type:"string"`
// Shows the scaling configuration for an Aurora DB cluster in serverless DB
// engine mode.
//
// For more information, see Using Amazon Aurora Serverless (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/AuroraUserGuide/aurora-serverless.html)
// in the Amazon Aurora User Guide.
ScalingConfigurationInfo *ScalingConfigurationInfo `type:"structure"`
// Specifies the current state of this DB cluster.
Status *string `type:"string"`
// Specifies whether the DB cluster is encrypted.
StorageEncrypted *bool `type:"boolean"`
// Provides a list of VPC security groups that the DB cluster belongs to.
VpcSecurityGroups []*VpcSecurityGroupMembership `locationNameList:"VpcSecurityGroupMembership" type:"list"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s DBCluster) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s DBCluster) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetAllocatedStorage sets the AllocatedStorage field's value.
func (s *DBCluster) SetAllocatedStorage(v int64) *DBCluster {
s.AllocatedStorage = &v
return s
}
// SetAssociatedRoles sets the AssociatedRoles field's value.
func (s *DBCluster) SetAssociatedRoles(v []*DBClusterRole) *DBCluster {
s.AssociatedRoles = v
return s
}
// SetAvailabilityZones sets the AvailabilityZones field's value.
func (s *DBCluster) SetAvailabilityZones(v []*string) *DBCluster {
s.AvailabilityZones = v
return s
}
// SetBacktrackConsumedChangeRecords sets the BacktrackConsumedChangeRecords field's value.
func (s *DBCluster) SetBacktrackConsumedChangeRecords(v int64) *DBCluster {
s.BacktrackConsumedChangeRecords = &v
return s
}
// SetBacktrackWindow sets the BacktrackWindow field's value.
func (s *DBCluster) SetBacktrackWindow(v int64) *DBCluster {
s.BacktrackWindow = &v
return s
}
// SetBackupRetentionPeriod sets the BackupRetentionPeriod field's value.
func (s *DBCluster) SetBackupRetentionPeriod(v int64) *DBCluster {
s.BackupRetentionPeriod = &v
return s
}
// SetCapacity sets the Capacity field's value.
func (s *DBCluster) SetCapacity(v int64) *DBCluster {
s.Capacity = &v
return s
}
// SetCharacterSetName sets the CharacterSetName field's value.
func (s *DBCluster) SetCharacterSetName(v string) *DBCluster {
s.CharacterSetName = &v
return s
}
// SetCloneGroupId sets the CloneGroupId field's value.
func (s *DBCluster) SetCloneGroupId(v string) *DBCluster {
s.CloneGroupId = &v
return s
}
// SetClusterCreateTime sets the ClusterCreateTime field's value.
func (s *DBCluster) SetClusterCreateTime(v time.Time) *DBCluster {
s.ClusterCreateTime = &v
return s
}
// SetCopyTagsToSnapshot sets the CopyTagsToSnapshot field's value.
func (s *DBCluster) SetCopyTagsToSnapshot(v bool) *DBCluster {
s.CopyTagsToSnapshot = &v
return s
}
// SetCustomEndpoints sets the CustomEndpoints field's value.
func (s *DBCluster) SetCustomEndpoints(v []*string) *DBCluster {
s.CustomEndpoints = v
return s
}
// SetDBClusterArn sets the DBClusterArn field's value.
func (s *DBCluster) SetDBClusterArn(v string) *DBCluster {
s.DBClusterArn = &v
return s
}
// SetDBClusterIdentifier sets the DBClusterIdentifier field's value.
func (s *DBCluster) SetDBClusterIdentifier(v string) *DBCluster {
s.DBClusterIdentifier = &v
return s
}
// SetDBClusterMembers sets the DBClusterMembers field's value.
func (s *DBCluster) SetDBClusterMembers(v []*DBClusterMember) *DBCluster {
s.DBClusterMembers = v
return s
}
// SetDBClusterOptionGroupMemberships sets the DBClusterOptionGroupMemberships field's value.
func (s *DBCluster) SetDBClusterOptionGroupMemberships(v []*DBClusterOptionGroupStatus) *DBCluster {
s.DBClusterOptionGroupMemberships = v
return s
}
// SetDBClusterParameterGroup sets the DBClusterParameterGroup field's value.
func (s *DBCluster) SetDBClusterParameterGroup(v string) *DBCluster {
s.DBClusterParameterGroup = &v
return s
}
// SetDBSubnetGroup sets the DBSubnetGroup field's value.
func (s *DBCluster) SetDBSubnetGroup(v string) *DBCluster {
s.DBSubnetGroup = &v
return s
}
// SetDatabaseName sets the DatabaseName field's value.
func (s *DBCluster) SetDatabaseName(v string) *DBCluster {
s.DatabaseName = &v
return s
}
// SetDbClusterResourceId sets the DbClusterResourceId field's value.
func (s *DBCluster) SetDbClusterResourceId(v string) *DBCluster {
s.DbClusterResourceId = &v
return s
}
// SetDeletionProtection sets the DeletionProtection field's value.
func (s *DBCluster) SetDeletionProtection(v bool) *DBCluster {
s.DeletionProtection = &v
return s
}
// SetEarliestBacktrackTime sets the EarliestBacktrackTime field's value.
func (s *DBCluster) SetEarliestBacktrackTime(v time.Time) *DBCluster {
s.EarliestBacktrackTime = &v
return s
}
// SetEarliestRestorableTime sets the EarliestRestorableTime field's value.
func (s *DBCluster) SetEarliestRestorableTime(v time.Time) *DBCluster {
s.EarliestRestorableTime = &v
return s
}
// SetEnabledCloudwatchLogsExports sets the EnabledCloudwatchLogsExports field's value.
func (s *DBCluster) SetEnabledCloudwatchLogsExports(v []*string) *DBCluster {
s.EnabledCloudwatchLogsExports = v
return s
}
// SetEndpoint sets the Endpoint field's value.
func (s *DBCluster) SetEndpoint(v string) *DBCluster {
s.Endpoint = &v
return s
}
// SetEngine sets the Engine field's value.
func (s *DBCluster) SetEngine(v string) *DBCluster {
s.Engine = &v
return s
}
// SetEngineMode sets the EngineMode field's value.
func (s *DBCluster) SetEngineMode(v string) *DBCluster {
s.EngineMode = &v
return s
}
// SetEngineVersion sets the EngineVersion field's value.
func (s *DBCluster) SetEngineVersion(v string) *DBCluster {
s.EngineVersion = &v
return s
}
// SetHostedZoneId sets the HostedZoneId field's value.
func (s *DBCluster) SetHostedZoneId(v string) *DBCluster {
s.HostedZoneId = &v
return s
}
// SetHttpEndpointEnabled sets the HttpEndpointEnabled field's value.
func (s *DBCluster) SetHttpEndpointEnabled(v bool) *DBCluster {
s.HttpEndpointEnabled = &v
return s
}
// SetIAMDatabaseAuthenticationEnabled sets the IAMDatabaseAuthenticationEnabled field's value.
func (s *DBCluster) SetIAMDatabaseAuthenticationEnabled(v bool) *DBCluster {
s.IAMDatabaseAuthenticationEnabled = &v
return s
}
// SetKmsKeyId sets the KmsKeyId field's value.
func (s *DBCluster) SetKmsKeyId(v string) *DBCluster {
s.KmsKeyId = &v
return s
}
// SetLatestRestorableTime sets the LatestRestorableTime field's value.
func (s *DBCluster) SetLatestRestorableTime(v time.Time) *DBCluster {
s.LatestRestorableTime = &v
return s
}
// SetMasterUsername sets the MasterUsername field's value.
func (s *DBCluster) SetMasterUsername(v string) *DBCluster {
s.MasterUsername = &v
return s
}
// SetMultiAZ sets the MultiAZ field's value.
func (s *DBCluster) SetMultiAZ(v bool) *DBCluster {
s.MultiAZ = &v
return s
}
// SetPercentProgress sets the PercentProgress field's value.
func (s *DBCluster) SetPercentProgress(v string) *DBCluster {
s.PercentProgress = &v
return s
}
// SetPort sets the Port field's value.
func (s *DBCluster) SetPort(v int64) *DBCluster {
s.Port = &v
return s
}
// SetPreferredBackupWindow sets the PreferredBackupWindow field's value.
func (s *DBCluster) SetPreferredBackupWindow(v string) *DBCluster {
s.PreferredBackupWindow = &v
return s
}
// SetPreferredMaintenanceWindow sets the PreferredMaintenanceWindow field's value.
func (s *DBCluster) SetPreferredMaintenanceWindow(v string) *DBCluster {
s.PreferredMaintenanceWindow = &v
return s
}
// SetReadReplicaIdentifiers sets the ReadReplicaIdentifiers field's value.
func (s *DBCluster) SetReadReplicaIdentifiers(v []*string) *DBCluster {
s.ReadReplicaIdentifiers = v
return s
}
// SetReaderEndpoint sets the ReaderEndpoint field's value.
func (s *DBCluster) SetReaderEndpoint(v string) *DBCluster {
s.ReaderEndpoint = &v
return s
}
// SetReplicationSourceIdentifier sets the ReplicationSourceIdentifier field's value.
func (s *DBCluster) SetReplicationSourceIdentifier(v string) *DBCluster {
s.ReplicationSourceIdentifier = &v
return s
}
// SetScalingConfigurationInfo sets the ScalingConfigurationInfo field's value.
func (s *DBCluster) SetScalingConfigurationInfo(v *ScalingConfigurationInfo) *DBCluster {
s.ScalingConfigurationInfo = v
return s
}
// SetStatus sets the Status field's value.
func (s *DBCluster) SetStatus(v string) *DBCluster {
s.Status = &v
return s
}
// SetStorageEncrypted sets the StorageEncrypted field's value.
func (s *DBCluster) SetStorageEncrypted(v bool) *DBCluster {
s.StorageEncrypted = &v
return s
}
// SetVpcSecurityGroups sets the VpcSecurityGroups field's value.
func (s *DBCluster) SetVpcSecurityGroups(v []*VpcSecurityGroupMembership) *DBCluster {
s.VpcSecurityGroups = v
return s
}
// This data type represents the information you need to connect to an Amazon
// Aurora DB cluster. This data type is used as a response element in the following
// actions:
//
// * CreateDBClusterEndpoint
//
// * DescribeDBClusterEndpoints
//
// * ModifyDBClusterEndpoint
//
// * DeleteDBClusterEndpoint
//
// For the data structure that represents Amazon RDS DB instance endpoints,
// see Endpoint.
type DBClusterEndpoint struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// The type associated with a custom endpoint. One of: READER, ANY.
CustomEndpointType *string `type:"string"`
// The Amazon Resource Name (ARN) for the endpoint.
DBClusterEndpointArn *string `type:"string"`
// The identifier associated with the endpoint. This parameter is stored as
// a lowercase string.
DBClusterEndpointIdentifier *string `type:"string"`
// A unique system-generated identifier for an endpoint. It remains the same
// for the whole life of the endpoint.
DBClusterEndpointResourceIdentifier *string `type:"string"`
// The DB cluster identifier of the DB cluster associated with the endpoint.
// This parameter is stored as a lowercase string.
DBClusterIdentifier *string `type:"string"`
// The DNS address of the endpoint.
Endpoint *string `type:"string"`
// The type of the endpoint. One of: READER, WRITER, CUSTOM.
EndpointType *string `type:"string"`
// List of DB instance identifiers that aren't part of the custom endpoint group.
// All other eligible instances are reachable through the custom endpoint. Only
// relevant if the list of static members is empty.
ExcludedMembers []*string `type:"list"`
// List of DB instance identifiers that are part of the custom endpoint group.
StaticMembers []*string `type:"list"`
// The current status of the endpoint. One of: creating, available, deleting,
// modifying.
Status *string `type:"string"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s DBClusterEndpoint) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s DBClusterEndpoint) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetCustomEndpointType sets the CustomEndpointType field's value.
func (s *DBClusterEndpoint) SetCustomEndpointType(v string) *DBClusterEndpoint {
s.CustomEndpointType = &v
return s
}
// SetDBClusterEndpointArn sets the DBClusterEndpointArn field's value.
func (s *DBClusterEndpoint) SetDBClusterEndpointArn(v string) *DBClusterEndpoint {
s.DBClusterEndpointArn = &v
return s
}
// SetDBClusterEndpointIdentifier sets the DBClusterEndpointIdentifier field's value.
func (s *DBClusterEndpoint) SetDBClusterEndpointIdentifier(v string) *DBClusterEndpoint {
s.DBClusterEndpointIdentifier = &v
return s
}
// SetDBClusterEndpointResourceIdentifier sets the DBClusterEndpointResourceIdentifier field's value.
func (s *DBClusterEndpoint) SetDBClusterEndpointResourceIdentifier(v string) *DBClusterEndpoint {
s.DBClusterEndpointResourceIdentifier = &v
return s
}
// SetDBClusterIdentifier sets the DBClusterIdentifier field's value.
func (s *DBClusterEndpoint) SetDBClusterIdentifier(v string) *DBClusterEndpoint {
s.DBClusterIdentifier = &v
return s
}
// SetEndpoint sets the Endpoint field's value.
func (s *DBClusterEndpoint) SetEndpoint(v string) *DBClusterEndpoint {
s.Endpoint = &v
return s
}
// SetEndpointType sets the EndpointType field's value.
func (s *DBClusterEndpoint) SetEndpointType(v string) *DBClusterEndpoint {
s.EndpointType = &v
return s
}
// SetExcludedMembers sets the ExcludedMembers field's value.
func (s *DBClusterEndpoint) SetExcludedMembers(v []*string) *DBClusterEndpoint {
s.ExcludedMembers = v
return s
}
// SetStaticMembers sets the StaticMembers field's value.
func (s *DBClusterEndpoint) SetStaticMembers(v []*string) *DBClusterEndpoint {
s.StaticMembers = v
return s
}
// SetStatus sets the Status field's value.
func (s *DBClusterEndpoint) SetStatus(v string) *DBClusterEndpoint {
s.Status = &v
return s
}
// Contains information about an instance that is part of a DB cluster.
type DBClusterMember struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// Specifies the status of the DB cluster parameter group for this member of
// the DB cluster.
DBClusterParameterGroupStatus *string `type:"string"`
// Specifies the instance identifier for this member of the DB cluster.
DBInstanceIdentifier *string `type:"string"`
// Value that is true if the cluster member is the primary instance for the
// DB cluster and false otherwise.
IsClusterWriter *bool `type:"boolean"`
// A value that specifies the order in which an Aurora Replica is promoted to
// the primary instance after a failure of the existing primary instance. For
// more information, see Fault Tolerance for an Aurora DB Cluster (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/AuroraUserGuide/Aurora.Managing.Backups.html#Aurora.Managing.FaultTolerance)
// in the Amazon Aurora User Guide.
PromotionTier *int64 `type:"integer"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s DBClusterMember) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s DBClusterMember) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetDBClusterParameterGroupStatus sets the DBClusterParameterGroupStatus field's value.
func (s *DBClusterMember) SetDBClusterParameterGroupStatus(v string) *DBClusterMember {
s.DBClusterParameterGroupStatus = &v
return s
}
// SetDBInstanceIdentifier sets the DBInstanceIdentifier field's value.
func (s *DBClusterMember) SetDBInstanceIdentifier(v string) *DBClusterMember {
s.DBInstanceIdentifier = &v
return s
}
// SetIsClusterWriter sets the IsClusterWriter field's value.
func (s *DBClusterMember) SetIsClusterWriter(v bool) *DBClusterMember {
s.IsClusterWriter = &v
return s
}
// SetPromotionTier sets the PromotionTier field's value.
func (s *DBClusterMember) SetPromotionTier(v int64) *DBClusterMember {
s.PromotionTier = &v
return s
}
// Contains status information for a DB cluster option group.
type DBClusterOptionGroupStatus struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// Specifies the name of the DB cluster option group.
DBClusterOptionGroupName *string `type:"string"`
// Specifies the status of the DB cluster option group.
Status *string `type:"string"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s DBClusterOptionGroupStatus) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s DBClusterOptionGroupStatus) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetDBClusterOptionGroupName sets the DBClusterOptionGroupName field's value.
func (s *DBClusterOptionGroupStatus) SetDBClusterOptionGroupName(v string) *DBClusterOptionGroupStatus {
s.DBClusterOptionGroupName = &v
return s
}
// SetStatus sets the Status field's value.
func (s *DBClusterOptionGroupStatus) SetStatus(v string) *DBClusterOptionGroupStatus {
s.Status = &v
return s
}
// Contains the details of an Amazon RDS DB cluster parameter group.
//
// This data type is used as a response element in the DescribeDBClusterParameterGroups
// action.
type DBClusterParameterGroup struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// The Amazon Resource Name (ARN) for the DB cluster parameter group.
DBClusterParameterGroupArn *string `type:"string"`
// Provides the name of the DB cluster parameter group.
DBClusterParameterGroupName *string `type:"string"`
// Provides the name of the DB parameter group family that this DB cluster parameter
// group is compatible with.
DBParameterGroupFamily *string `type:"string"`
// Provides the customer-specified description for this DB cluster parameter
// group.
Description *string `type:"string"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s DBClusterParameterGroup) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s DBClusterParameterGroup) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetDBClusterParameterGroupArn sets the DBClusterParameterGroupArn field's value.
func (s *DBClusterParameterGroup) SetDBClusterParameterGroupArn(v string) *DBClusterParameterGroup {
s.DBClusterParameterGroupArn = &v
return s
}
// SetDBClusterParameterGroupName sets the DBClusterParameterGroupName field's value.
func (s *DBClusterParameterGroup) SetDBClusterParameterGroupName(v string) *DBClusterParameterGroup {
s.DBClusterParameterGroupName = &v
return s
}
// SetDBParameterGroupFamily sets the DBParameterGroupFamily field's value.
func (s *DBClusterParameterGroup) SetDBParameterGroupFamily(v string) *DBClusterParameterGroup {
s.DBParameterGroupFamily = &v
return s
}
// SetDescription sets the Description field's value.
func (s *DBClusterParameterGroup) SetDescription(v string) *DBClusterParameterGroup {
s.Description = &v
return s
}
type DBClusterParameterGroupNameMessage struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// The name of the DB cluster parameter group.
//
// Constraints:
//
// * Must be 1 to 255 letters or numbers.
//
// * First character must be a letter
//
// * Can't end with a hyphen or contain two consecutive hyphens
//
// This value is stored as a lowercase string.
DBClusterParameterGroupName *string `type:"string"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s DBClusterParameterGroupNameMessage) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s DBClusterParameterGroupNameMessage) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetDBClusterParameterGroupName sets the DBClusterParameterGroupName field's value.
func (s *DBClusterParameterGroupNameMessage) SetDBClusterParameterGroupName(v string) *DBClusterParameterGroupNameMessage {
s.DBClusterParameterGroupName = &v
return s
}
// Describes an AWS Identity and Access Management (IAM) role that is associated
// with a DB cluster.
type DBClusterRole struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
FeatureName *string `type:"string"`
// The Amazon Resource Name (ARN) of the IAM role that is associated with the
// DB cluster.
RoleArn *string `type:"string"`
// Describes the state of association between the IAM role and the DB cluster.
// The Status property returns one of the following values:
//
// * ACTIVE - the IAM role ARN is associated with the DB cluster and can
// be used to access other AWS services on your behalf.
//
// * PENDING - the IAM role ARN is being associated with the DB cluster.
//
// * INVALID - the IAM role ARN is associated with the DB cluster, but the
// DB cluster is unable to assume the IAM role in order to access other AWS
// services on your behalf.
Status *string `type:"string"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s DBClusterRole) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s DBClusterRole) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetFeatureName sets the FeatureName field's value.
func (s *DBClusterRole) SetFeatureName(v string) *DBClusterRole {
s.FeatureName = &v
return s
}
// SetRoleArn sets the RoleArn field's value.
func (s *DBClusterRole) SetRoleArn(v string) *DBClusterRole {
s.RoleArn = &v
return s
}
// SetStatus sets the Status field's value.
func (s *DBClusterRole) SetStatus(v string) *DBClusterRole {
s.Status = &v
return s
}
// Contains the details for an Amazon RDS DB cluster snapshot
//
// This data type is used as a response element in the DescribeDBClusterSnapshots
// action.
type DBClusterSnapshot struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// Specifies the allocated storage size in gibibytes (GiB).
AllocatedStorage *int64 `type:"integer"`
// Provides the list of EC2 Availability Zones that instances in the DB cluster
// snapshot can be restored in.
AvailabilityZones []*string `locationNameList:"AvailabilityZone" type:"list"`
// Specifies the time when the DB cluster was created, in Universal Coordinated
// Time (UTC).
ClusterCreateTime *time.Time `type:"timestamp"`
// Specifies the DB cluster identifier of the DB cluster that this DB cluster
// snapshot was created from.
DBClusterIdentifier *string `type:"string"`
// The Amazon Resource Name (ARN) for the DB cluster snapshot.
DBClusterSnapshotArn *string `type:"string"`
// Specifies the identifier for the DB cluster snapshot.
DBClusterSnapshotIdentifier *string `type:"string"`
// Specifies the name of the database engine.
Engine *string `type:"string"`
// Provides the version of the database engine for this DB cluster snapshot.
EngineVersion *string `type:"string"`
// True if mapping of AWS Identity and Access Management (IAM) accounts to database
// accounts is enabled, and otherwise false.
IAMDatabaseAuthenticationEnabled *bool `type:"boolean"`
// If StorageEncrypted is true, the AWS KMS key identifier for the encrypted
// DB cluster snapshot.
KmsKeyId *string `type:"string"`
// Provides the license model information for this DB cluster snapshot.
LicenseModel *string `type:"string"`
// Provides the master username for the DB cluster snapshot.
MasterUsername *string `type:"string"`
// Specifies the percentage of the estimated data that has been transferred.
PercentProgress *int64 `type:"integer"`
// Specifies the port that the DB cluster was listening on at the time of the
// snapshot.
Port *int64 `type:"integer"`
// Provides the time when the snapshot was taken, in Universal Coordinated Time
// (UTC).
SnapshotCreateTime *time.Time `type:"timestamp"`
// Provides the type of the DB cluster snapshot.
SnapshotType *string `type:"string"`
// If the DB cluster snapshot was copied from a source DB cluster snapshot,
// the Amazon Resource Name (ARN) for the source DB cluster snapshot, otherwise,
// a null value.
SourceDBClusterSnapshotArn *string `type:"string"`
// Specifies the status of this DB cluster snapshot.
Status *string `type:"string"`
// Specifies whether the DB cluster snapshot is encrypted.
StorageEncrypted *bool `type:"boolean"`
// Provides the VPC ID associated with the DB cluster snapshot.
VpcId *string `type:"string"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s DBClusterSnapshot) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s DBClusterSnapshot) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetAllocatedStorage sets the AllocatedStorage field's value.
func (s *DBClusterSnapshot) SetAllocatedStorage(v int64) *DBClusterSnapshot {
s.AllocatedStorage = &v
return s
}
// SetAvailabilityZones sets the AvailabilityZones field's value.
func (s *DBClusterSnapshot) SetAvailabilityZones(v []*string) *DBClusterSnapshot {
s.AvailabilityZones = v
return s
}
// SetClusterCreateTime sets the ClusterCreateTime field's value.
func (s *DBClusterSnapshot) SetClusterCreateTime(v time.Time) *DBClusterSnapshot {
s.ClusterCreateTime = &v
return s
}
// SetDBClusterIdentifier sets the DBClusterIdentifier field's value.
func (s *DBClusterSnapshot) SetDBClusterIdentifier(v string) *DBClusterSnapshot {
s.DBClusterIdentifier = &v
return s
}
// SetDBClusterSnapshotArn sets the DBClusterSnapshotArn field's value.
func (s *DBClusterSnapshot) SetDBClusterSnapshotArn(v string) *DBClusterSnapshot {
s.DBClusterSnapshotArn = &v
return s
}
// SetDBClusterSnapshotIdentifier sets the DBClusterSnapshotIdentifier field's value.
func (s *DBClusterSnapshot) SetDBClusterSnapshotIdentifier(v string) *DBClusterSnapshot {
s.DBClusterSnapshotIdentifier = &v
return s
}
// SetEngine sets the Engine field's value.
func (s *DBClusterSnapshot) SetEngine(v string) *DBClusterSnapshot {
s.Engine = &v
return s
}
// SetEngineVersion sets the EngineVersion field's value.
func (s *DBClusterSnapshot) SetEngineVersion(v string) *DBClusterSnapshot {
s.EngineVersion = &v
return s
}
// SetIAMDatabaseAuthenticationEnabled sets the IAMDatabaseAuthenticationEnabled field's value.
func (s *DBClusterSnapshot) SetIAMDatabaseAuthenticationEnabled(v bool) *DBClusterSnapshot {
s.IAMDatabaseAuthenticationEnabled = &v
return s
}
// SetKmsKeyId sets the KmsKeyId field's value.
func (s *DBClusterSnapshot) SetKmsKeyId(v string) *DBClusterSnapshot {
s.KmsKeyId = &v
return s
}
// SetLicenseModel sets the LicenseModel field's value.
func (s *DBClusterSnapshot) SetLicenseModel(v string) *DBClusterSnapshot {
s.LicenseModel = &v
return s
}
// SetMasterUsername sets the MasterUsername field's value.
func (s *DBClusterSnapshot) SetMasterUsername(v string) *DBClusterSnapshot {
s.MasterUsername = &v
return s
}
// SetPercentProgress sets the PercentProgress field's value.
func (s *DBClusterSnapshot) SetPercentProgress(v int64) *DBClusterSnapshot {
s.PercentProgress = &v
return s
}
// SetPort sets the Port field's value.
func (s *DBClusterSnapshot) SetPort(v int64) *DBClusterSnapshot {
s.Port = &v
return s
}
// SetSnapshotCreateTime sets the SnapshotCreateTime field's value.
func (s *DBClusterSnapshot) SetSnapshotCreateTime(v time.Time) *DBClusterSnapshot {
s.SnapshotCreateTime = &v
return s
}
// SetSnapshotType sets the SnapshotType field's value.
func (s *DBClusterSnapshot) SetSnapshotType(v string) *DBClusterSnapshot {
s.SnapshotType = &v
return s
}
// SetSourceDBClusterSnapshotArn sets the SourceDBClusterSnapshotArn field's value.
func (s *DBClusterSnapshot) SetSourceDBClusterSnapshotArn(v string) *DBClusterSnapshot {
s.SourceDBClusterSnapshotArn = &v
return s
}
// SetStatus sets the Status field's value.
func (s *DBClusterSnapshot) SetStatus(v string) *DBClusterSnapshot {
s.Status = &v
return s
}
// SetStorageEncrypted sets the StorageEncrypted field's value.
func (s *DBClusterSnapshot) SetStorageEncrypted(v bool) *DBClusterSnapshot {
s.StorageEncrypted = &v
return s
}
// SetVpcId sets the VpcId field's value.
func (s *DBClusterSnapshot) SetVpcId(v string) *DBClusterSnapshot {
s.VpcId = &v
return s
}
// Contains the name and values of a manual DB cluster snapshot attribute.
//
// Manual DB cluster snapshot attributes are used to authorize other AWS accounts
// to restore a manual DB cluster snapshot. For more information, see the ModifyDBClusterSnapshotAttribute
// API action.
type DBClusterSnapshotAttribute struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// The name of the manual DB cluster snapshot attribute.
//
// The attribute named restore refers to the list of AWS accounts that have
// permission to copy or restore the manual DB cluster snapshot. For more information,
// see the ModifyDBClusterSnapshotAttribute API action.
AttributeName *string `type:"string"`
// The value(s) for the manual DB cluster snapshot attribute.
//
// If the AttributeName field is set to restore, then this element returns a
// list of IDs of the AWS accounts that are authorized to copy or restore the
// manual DB cluster snapshot. If a value of all is in the list, then the manual
// DB cluster snapshot is public and available for any AWS account to copy or
// restore.
AttributeValues []*string `locationNameList:"AttributeValue" type:"list"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s DBClusterSnapshotAttribute) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s DBClusterSnapshotAttribute) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetAttributeName sets the AttributeName field's value.
func (s *DBClusterSnapshotAttribute) SetAttributeName(v string) *DBClusterSnapshotAttribute {
s.AttributeName = &v
return s
}
// SetAttributeValues sets the AttributeValues field's value.
func (s *DBClusterSnapshotAttribute) SetAttributeValues(v []*string) *DBClusterSnapshotAttribute {
s.AttributeValues = v
return s
}
// Contains the results of a successful call to the DescribeDBClusterSnapshotAttributes
// API action.
//
// Manual DB cluster snapshot attributes are used to authorize other AWS accounts
// to copy or restore a manual DB cluster snapshot. For more information, see
// the ModifyDBClusterSnapshotAttribute API action.
type DBClusterSnapshotAttributesResult struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// The list of attributes and values for the manual DB cluster snapshot.
DBClusterSnapshotAttributes []*DBClusterSnapshotAttribute `locationNameList:"DBClusterSnapshotAttribute" type:"list"`
// The identifier of the manual DB cluster snapshot that the attributes apply
// to.
DBClusterSnapshotIdentifier *string `type:"string"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s DBClusterSnapshotAttributesResult) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s DBClusterSnapshotAttributesResult) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetDBClusterSnapshotAttributes sets the DBClusterSnapshotAttributes field's value.
func (s *DBClusterSnapshotAttributesResult) SetDBClusterSnapshotAttributes(v []*DBClusterSnapshotAttribute) *DBClusterSnapshotAttributesResult {
s.DBClusterSnapshotAttributes = v
return s
}
// SetDBClusterSnapshotIdentifier sets the DBClusterSnapshotIdentifier field's value.
func (s *DBClusterSnapshotAttributesResult) SetDBClusterSnapshotIdentifier(v string) *DBClusterSnapshotAttributesResult {
s.DBClusterSnapshotIdentifier = &v
return s
}
// This data type is used as a response element in the action DescribeDBEngineVersions.
type DBEngineVersion struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// The description of the database engine.
DBEngineDescription *string `type:"string"`
// The description of the database engine version.
DBEngineVersionDescription *string `type:"string"`
// The name of the DB parameter group family for the database engine.
DBParameterGroupFamily *string `type:"string"`
// The default character set for new instances of this engine version, if the
// CharacterSetName parameter of the CreateDBInstance API is not specified.
DefaultCharacterSet *CharacterSet `type:"structure"`
// The name of the database engine.
Engine *string `type:"string"`
// The version number of the database engine.
EngineVersion *string `type:"string"`
// The types of logs that the database engine has available for export to CloudWatch
// Logs.
ExportableLogTypes []*string `type:"list"`
// A list of the character sets supported by this engine for the CharacterSetName
// parameter of the CreateDBInstance action.
SupportedCharacterSets []*CharacterSet `locationNameList:"CharacterSet" type:"list"`
// A list of the supported DB engine modes.
SupportedEngineModes []*string `type:"list"`
// A list of features supported by the DB engine. Supported feature names include
// the following.
//
// * s3Import
SupportedFeatureNames []*string `type:"list"`
// A list of the time zones supported by this engine for the Timezone parameter
// of the CreateDBInstance action.
SupportedTimezones []*Timezone `locationNameList:"Timezone" type:"list"`
// A value that indicates whether the engine version supports exporting the
// log types specified by ExportableLogTypes to CloudWatch Logs.
SupportsLogExportsToCloudwatchLogs *bool `type:"boolean"`
// Indicates whether the database engine version supports read replicas.
SupportsReadReplica *bool `type:"boolean"`
// A list of engine versions that this database engine version can be upgraded
// to.
ValidUpgradeTarget []*UpgradeTarget `locationNameList:"UpgradeTarget" type:"list"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s DBEngineVersion) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s DBEngineVersion) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetDBEngineDescription sets the DBEngineDescription field's value.
func (s *DBEngineVersion) SetDBEngineDescription(v string) *DBEngineVersion {
s.DBEngineDescription = &v
return s
}
// SetDBEngineVersionDescription sets the DBEngineVersionDescription field's value.
func (s *DBEngineVersion) SetDBEngineVersionDescription(v string) *DBEngineVersion {
s.DBEngineVersionDescription = &v
return s
}
// SetDBParameterGroupFamily sets the DBParameterGroupFamily field's value.
func (s *DBEngineVersion) SetDBParameterGroupFamily(v string) *DBEngineVersion {
s.DBParameterGroupFamily = &v
return s
}
// SetDefaultCharacterSet sets the DefaultCharacterSet field's value.
func (s *DBEngineVersion) SetDefaultCharacterSet(v *CharacterSet) *DBEngineVersion {
s.DefaultCharacterSet = v
return s
}
// SetEngine sets the Engine field's value.
func (s *DBEngineVersion) SetEngine(v string) *DBEngineVersion {
s.Engine = &v
return s
}
// SetEngineVersion sets the EngineVersion field's value.
func (s *DBEngineVersion) SetEngineVersion(v string) *DBEngineVersion {
s.EngineVersion = &v
return s
}
// SetExportableLogTypes sets the ExportableLogTypes field's value.
func (s *DBEngineVersion) SetExportableLogTypes(v []*string) *DBEngineVersion {
s.ExportableLogTypes = v
return s
}
// SetSupportedCharacterSets sets the SupportedCharacterSets field's value.
func (s *DBEngineVersion) SetSupportedCharacterSets(v []*CharacterSet) *DBEngineVersion {
s.SupportedCharacterSets = v
return s
}
// SetSupportedEngineModes sets the SupportedEngineModes field's value.
func (s *DBEngineVersion) SetSupportedEngineModes(v []*string) *DBEngineVersion {
s.SupportedEngineModes = v
return s
}
// SetSupportedFeatureNames sets the SupportedFeatureNames field's value.
func (s *DBEngineVersion) SetSupportedFeatureNames(v []*string) *DBEngineVersion {
s.SupportedFeatureNames = v
return s
}
// SetSupportedTimezones sets the SupportedTimezones field's value.
func (s *DBEngineVersion) SetSupportedTimezones(v []*Timezone) *DBEngineVersion {
s.SupportedTimezones = v
return s
}
// SetSupportsLogExportsToCloudwatchLogs sets the SupportsLogExportsToCloudwatchLogs field's value.
func (s *DBEngineVersion) SetSupportsLogExportsToCloudwatchLogs(v bool) *DBEngineVersion {
s.SupportsLogExportsToCloudwatchLogs = &v
return s
}
// SetSupportsReadReplica sets the SupportsReadReplica field's value.
func (s *DBEngineVersion) SetSupportsReadReplica(v bool) *DBEngineVersion {
s.SupportsReadReplica = &v
return s
}
// SetValidUpgradeTarget sets the ValidUpgradeTarget field's value.
func (s *DBEngineVersion) SetValidUpgradeTarget(v []*UpgradeTarget) *DBEngineVersion {
s.ValidUpgradeTarget = v
return s
}
// Contains the details of an Amazon RDS DB instance.
//
// This data type is used as a response element in the DescribeDBInstances action.
type DBInstance struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// Specifies the allocated storage size specified in gibibytes.
AllocatedStorage *int64 `type:"integer"`
// The AWS Identity and Access Management (IAM) roles associated with the DB
// instance.
AssociatedRoles []*DBInstanceRole `locationNameList:"DBInstanceRole" type:"list"`
// Indicates that minor version patches are applied automatically.
AutoMinorVersionUpgrade *bool `type:"boolean"`
// Specifies the name of the Availability Zone the DB instance is located in.
AvailabilityZone *string `type:"string"`
// Specifies the number of days for which automatic DB snapshots are retained.
BackupRetentionPeriod *int64 `type:"integer"`
// The identifier of the CA certificate for this DB instance.
CACertificateIdentifier *string `type:"string"`
// If present, specifies the name of the character set that this instance is
// associated with.
CharacterSetName *string `type:"string"`
// Specifies whether tags are copied from the DB instance to snapshots of the
// DB instance.
//
// Amazon Aurora
//
// Not applicable. Copying tags to snapshots is managed by the DB cluster. Setting
// this value for an Aurora DB instance has no effect on the DB cluster setting.
// For more information, see DBCluster.
CopyTagsToSnapshot *bool `type:"boolean"`
// If the DB instance is a member of a DB cluster, contains the name of the
// DB cluster that the DB instance is a member of.
DBClusterIdentifier *string `type:"string"`
// The Amazon Resource Name (ARN) for the DB instance.
DBInstanceArn *string `type:"string"`
// Contains the name of the compute and memory capacity class of the DB instance.
DBInstanceClass *string `type:"string"`
// Contains a user-supplied database identifier. This identifier is the unique
// key that identifies a DB instance.
DBInstanceIdentifier *string `type:"string"`
// Specifies the current state of this database.
DBInstanceStatus *string `type:"string"`
// The meaning of this parameter differs according to the database engine you
// use. For example, this value returns MySQL, MariaDB, or PostgreSQL information
// when returning values from CreateDBInstanceReadReplica since Read Replicas
// are only supported for these engines.
//
// MySQL, MariaDB, SQL Server, PostgreSQL
//
// Contains the name of the initial database of this instance that was provided
// at create time, if one was specified when the DB instance was created. This
// same name is returned for the life of the DB instance.
//
// Type: String
//
// Oracle
//
// Contains the Oracle System ID (SID) of the created DB instance. Not shown
// when the returned parameters do not apply to an Oracle DB instance.
DBName *string `type:"string"`
// Provides the list of DB parameter groups applied to this DB instance.
DBParameterGroups []*DBParameterGroupStatus `locationNameList:"DBParameterGroup" type:"list"`
// Provides List of DB security group elements containing only DBSecurityGroup.Name
// and DBSecurityGroup.Status subelements.
DBSecurityGroups []*DBSecurityGroupMembership `locationNameList:"DBSecurityGroup" type:"list"`
// Specifies information on the subnet group associated with the DB instance,
// including the name, description, and subnets in the subnet group.
DBSubnetGroup *DBSubnetGroup `type:"structure"`
// Specifies the port that the DB instance listens on. If the DB instance is
// part of a DB cluster, this can be a different port than the DB cluster port.
DbInstancePort *int64 `type:"integer"`
// The AWS Region-unique, immutable identifier for the DB instance. This identifier
// is found in AWS CloudTrail log entries whenever the AWS KMS key for the DB
// instance is accessed.
DbiResourceId *string `type:"string"`
// Indicates if the DB instance has deletion protection enabled. The database
// can't be deleted when this value is set to true. For more information, see
// Deleting a DB Instance (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/UserGuide/USER_DeleteInstance.html).
DeletionProtection *bool `type:"boolean"`
// The Active Directory Domain membership records associated with the DB instance.
DomainMemberships []*DomainMembership `locationNameList:"DomainMembership" type:"list"`
// A list of log types that this DB instance is configured to export to CloudWatch
// Logs.
//
// Log types vary by DB engine. For information about the log types for each
// DB engine, see Amazon RDS Database Log Files (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/UserGuide/USER_LogAccess.html)
// in the Amazon RDS User Guide.
EnabledCloudwatchLogsExports []*string `type:"list"`
// Specifies the connection endpoint.
Endpoint *Endpoint `type:"structure"`
// Provides the name of the database engine to be used for this DB instance.
Engine *string `type:"string"`
// Indicates the database engine version.
EngineVersion *string `type:"string"`
// The Amazon Resource Name (ARN) of the Amazon CloudWatch Logs log stream that
// receives the Enhanced Monitoring metrics data for the DB instance.
EnhancedMonitoringResourceArn *string `type:"string"`
// True if mapping of AWS Identity and Access Management (IAM) accounts to database
// accounts is enabled, and otherwise false.
//
// IAM database authentication can be enabled for the following database engines
//
// * For MySQL 5.6, minor version 5.6.34 or higher
//
// * For MySQL 5.7, minor version 5.7.16 or higher
//
// * Aurora 5.6 or higher. To enable IAM database authentication for Aurora,
// see DBCluster Type.
IAMDatabaseAuthenticationEnabled *bool `type:"boolean"`
// Provides the date and time the DB instance was created.
InstanceCreateTime *time.Time `type:"timestamp"`
// Specifies the Provisioned IOPS (I/O operations per second) value.
Iops *int64 `type:"integer"`
// If StorageEncrypted is true, the AWS KMS key identifier for the encrypted
// DB instance.
KmsKeyId *string `type:"string"`
// Specifies the latest time to which a database can be restored with point-in-time
// restore.
LatestRestorableTime *time.Time `type:"timestamp"`
// License model information for this DB instance.
LicenseModel *string `type:"string"`
// Specifies the listener connection endpoint for SQL Server Always On.
ListenerEndpoint *Endpoint `type:"structure"`
// Contains the master username for the DB instance.
MasterUsername *string `type:"string"`
// The interval, in seconds, between points when Enhanced Monitoring metrics
// are collected for the DB instance.
MonitoringInterval *int64 `type:"integer"`
// The ARN for the IAM role that permits RDS to send Enhanced Monitoring metrics
// to Amazon CloudWatch Logs.
MonitoringRoleArn *string `type:"string"`
// Specifies if the DB instance is a Multi-AZ deployment.
MultiAZ *bool `type:"boolean"`
// Provides the list of option group memberships for this DB instance.
OptionGroupMemberships []*OptionGroupMembership `locationNameList:"OptionGroupMembership" type:"list"`
// Specifies that changes to the DB instance are pending. This element is only
// included when changes are pending. Specific changes are identified by subelements.
PendingModifiedValues *PendingModifiedValues `type:"structure"`
// True if Performance Insights is enabled for the DB instance, and otherwise
// false.
PerformanceInsightsEnabled *bool `type:"boolean"`
// The AWS KMS key identifier for encryption of Performance Insights data. The
// KMS key ID is the Amazon Resource Name (ARN), KMS key identifier, or the
// KMS key alias for the KMS encryption key.
PerformanceInsightsKMSKeyId *string `type:"string"`
// The amount of time, in days, to retain Performance Insights data. Valid values
// are 7 or 731 (2 years).
PerformanceInsightsRetentionPeriod *int64 `type:"integer"`
// Specifies the daily time range during which automated backups are created
// if automated backups are enabled, as determined by the BackupRetentionPeriod.
PreferredBackupWindow *string `type:"string"`
// Specifies the weekly time range during which system maintenance can occur,
// in Universal Coordinated Time (UTC).
PreferredMaintenanceWindow *string `type:"string"`
// The number of CPU cores and the number of threads per core for the DB instance
// class of the DB instance.
ProcessorFeatures []*ProcessorFeature `locationNameList:"ProcessorFeature" type:"list"`
// A value that specifies the order in which an Aurora Replica is promoted to
// the primary instance after a failure of the existing primary instance. For
// more information, see Fault Tolerance for an Aurora DB Cluster (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/AuroraUserGuide/Aurora.Managing.Backups.html#Aurora.Managing.FaultTolerance)
// in the Amazon Aurora User Guide.
PromotionTier *int64 `type:"integer"`
// Specifies the accessibility options for the DB instance. A value of true
// specifies an Internet-facing instance with a publicly resolvable DNS name,
// which resolves to a public IP address. A value of false specifies an internal
// instance with a DNS name that resolves to a private IP address.
PubliclyAccessible *bool `type:"boolean"`
// Contains one or more identifiers of Aurora DB clusters to which the RDS DB
// instance is replicated as a Read Replica. For example, when you create an
// Aurora Read Replica of an RDS MySQL DB instance, the Aurora MySQL DB cluster
// for the Aurora Read Replica is shown. This output does not contain information
// about cross region Aurora Read Replicas.
//
// Currently, each RDS DB instance can have only one Aurora Read Replica.
ReadReplicaDBClusterIdentifiers []*string `locationNameList:"ReadReplicaDBClusterIdentifier" type:"list"`
// Contains one or more identifiers of the Read Replicas associated with this
// DB instance.
ReadReplicaDBInstanceIdentifiers []*string `locationNameList:"ReadReplicaDBInstanceIdentifier" type:"list"`
// Contains the identifier of the source DB instance if this DB instance is
// a Read Replica.
ReadReplicaSourceDBInstanceIdentifier *string `type:"string"`
// If present, specifies the name of the secondary Availability Zone for a DB
// instance with multi-AZ support.
SecondaryAvailabilityZone *string `type:"string"`
// The status of a Read Replica. If the instance is not a Read Replica, this
// is blank.
StatusInfos []*DBInstanceStatusInfo `locationNameList:"DBInstanceStatusInfo" type:"list"`
// Specifies whether the DB instance is encrypted.
StorageEncrypted *bool `type:"boolean"`
// Specifies the storage type associated with DB instance.
StorageType *string `type:"string"`
// The ARN from the key store with which the instance is associated for TDE
// encryption.
TdeCredentialArn *string `type:"string"`
// The time zone of the DB instance. In most cases, the Timezone element is
// empty. Timezone content appears only for Microsoft SQL Server DB instances
// that were created with a time zone specified.
Timezone *string `type:"string"`
// Provides a list of VPC security group elements that the DB instance belongs
// to.
VpcSecurityGroups []*VpcSecurityGroupMembership `locationNameList:"VpcSecurityGroupMembership" type:"list"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s DBInstance) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s DBInstance) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetAllocatedStorage sets the AllocatedStorage field's value.
func (s *DBInstance) SetAllocatedStorage(v int64) *DBInstance {
s.AllocatedStorage = &v
return s
}
// SetAssociatedRoles sets the AssociatedRoles field's value.
func (s *DBInstance) SetAssociatedRoles(v []*DBInstanceRole) *DBInstance {
s.AssociatedRoles = v
return s
}
// SetAutoMinorVersionUpgrade sets the AutoMinorVersionUpgrade field's value.
func (s *DBInstance) SetAutoMinorVersionUpgrade(v bool) *DBInstance {
s.AutoMinorVersionUpgrade = &v
return s
}
// SetAvailabilityZone sets the AvailabilityZone field's value.
func (s *DBInstance) SetAvailabilityZone(v string) *DBInstance {
s.AvailabilityZone = &v
return s
}
// SetBackupRetentionPeriod sets the BackupRetentionPeriod field's value.
func (s *DBInstance) SetBackupRetentionPeriod(v int64) *DBInstance {
s.BackupRetentionPeriod = &v
return s
}
// SetCACertificateIdentifier sets the CACertificateIdentifier field's value.
func (s *DBInstance) SetCACertificateIdentifier(v string) *DBInstance {
s.CACertificateIdentifier = &v
return s
}
// SetCharacterSetName sets the CharacterSetName field's value.
func (s *DBInstance) SetCharacterSetName(v string) *DBInstance {
s.CharacterSetName = &v
return s
}
// SetCopyTagsToSnapshot sets the CopyTagsToSnapshot field's value.
func (s *DBInstance) SetCopyTagsToSnapshot(v bool) *DBInstance {
s.CopyTagsToSnapshot = &v
return s
}
// SetDBClusterIdentifier sets the DBClusterIdentifier field's value.
func (s *DBInstance) SetDBClusterIdentifier(v string) *DBInstance {
s.DBClusterIdentifier = &v
return s
}
// SetDBInstanceArn sets the DBInstanceArn field's value.
func (s *DBInstance) SetDBInstanceArn(v string) *DBInstance {
s.DBInstanceArn = &v
return s
}
// SetDBInstanceClass sets the DBInstanceClass field's value.
func (s *DBInstance) SetDBInstanceClass(v string) *DBInstance {
s.DBInstanceClass = &v
return s
}
// SetDBInstanceIdentifier sets the DBInstanceIdentifier field's value.
func (s *DBInstance) SetDBInstanceIdentifier(v string) *DBInstance {
s.DBInstanceIdentifier = &v
return s
}
// SetDBInstanceStatus sets the DBInstanceStatus field's value.
func (s *DBInstance) SetDBInstanceStatus(v string) *DBInstance {
s.DBInstanceStatus = &v
return s
}
// SetDBName sets the DBName field's value.
func (s *DBInstance) SetDBName(v string) *DBInstance {
s.DBName = &v
return s
}
// SetDBParameterGroups sets the DBParameterGroups field's value.
func (s *DBInstance) SetDBParameterGroups(v []*DBParameterGroupStatus) *DBInstance {
s.DBParameterGroups = v
return s
}
// SetDBSecurityGroups sets the DBSecurityGroups field's value.
func (s *DBInstance) SetDBSecurityGroups(v []*DBSecurityGroupMembership) *DBInstance {
s.DBSecurityGroups = v
return s
}
// SetDBSubnetGroup sets the DBSubnetGroup field's value.
func (s *DBInstance) SetDBSubnetGroup(v *DBSubnetGroup) *DBInstance {
s.DBSubnetGroup = v
return s
}
// SetDbInstancePort sets the DbInstancePort field's value.
func (s *DBInstance) SetDbInstancePort(v int64) *DBInstance {
s.DbInstancePort = &v
return s
}
// SetDbiResourceId sets the DbiResourceId field's value.
func (s *DBInstance) SetDbiResourceId(v string) *DBInstance {
s.DbiResourceId = &v
return s
}
// SetDeletionProtection sets the DeletionProtection field's value.
func (s *DBInstance) SetDeletionProtection(v bool) *DBInstance {
s.DeletionProtection = &v
return s
}
// SetDomainMemberships sets the DomainMemberships field's value.
func (s *DBInstance) SetDomainMemberships(v []*DomainMembership) *DBInstance {
s.DomainMemberships = v
return s
}
// SetEnabledCloudwatchLogsExports sets the EnabledCloudwatchLogsExports field's value.
func (s *DBInstance) SetEnabledCloudwatchLogsExports(v []*string) *DBInstance {
s.EnabledCloudwatchLogsExports = v
return s
}
// SetEndpoint sets the Endpoint field's value.
func (s *DBInstance) SetEndpoint(v *Endpoint) *DBInstance {
s.Endpoint = v
return s
}
// SetEngine sets the Engine field's value.
func (s *DBInstance) SetEngine(v string) *DBInstance {
s.Engine = &v
return s
}
// SetEngineVersion sets the EngineVersion field's value.
func (s *DBInstance) SetEngineVersion(v string) *DBInstance {
s.EngineVersion = &v
return s
}
// SetEnhancedMonitoringResourceArn sets the EnhancedMonitoringResourceArn field's value.
func (s *DBInstance) SetEnhancedMonitoringResourceArn(v string) *DBInstance {
s.EnhancedMonitoringResourceArn = &v
return s
}
// SetIAMDatabaseAuthenticationEnabled sets the IAMDatabaseAuthenticationEnabled field's value.
func (s *DBInstance) SetIAMDatabaseAuthenticationEnabled(v bool) *DBInstance {
s.IAMDatabaseAuthenticationEnabled = &v
return s
}
// SetInstanceCreateTime sets the InstanceCreateTime field's value.
func (s *DBInstance) SetInstanceCreateTime(v time.Time) *DBInstance {
s.InstanceCreateTime = &v
return s
}
// SetIops sets the Iops field's value.
func (s *DBInstance) SetIops(v int64) *DBInstance {
s.Iops = &v
return s
}
// SetKmsKeyId sets the KmsKeyId field's value.
func (s *DBInstance) SetKmsKeyId(v string) *DBInstance {
s.KmsKeyId = &v
return s
}
// SetLatestRestorableTime sets the LatestRestorableTime field's value.
func (s *DBInstance) SetLatestRestorableTime(v time.Time) *DBInstance {
s.LatestRestorableTime = &v
return s
}
// SetLicenseModel sets the LicenseModel field's value.
func (s *DBInstance) SetLicenseModel(v string) *DBInstance {
s.LicenseModel = &v
return s
}
// SetListenerEndpoint sets the ListenerEndpoint field's value.
func (s *DBInstance) SetListenerEndpoint(v *Endpoint) *DBInstance {
s.ListenerEndpoint = v
return s
}
// SetMasterUsername sets the MasterUsername field's value.
func (s *DBInstance) SetMasterUsername(v string) *DBInstance {
s.MasterUsername = &v
return s
}
// SetMonitoringInterval sets the MonitoringInterval field's value.
func (s *DBInstance) SetMonitoringInterval(v int64) *DBInstance {
s.MonitoringInterval = &v
return s
}
// SetMonitoringRoleArn sets the MonitoringRoleArn field's value.
func (s *DBInstance) SetMonitoringRoleArn(v string) *DBInstance {
s.MonitoringRoleArn = &v
return s
}
// SetMultiAZ sets the MultiAZ field's value.
func (s *DBInstance) SetMultiAZ(v bool) *DBInstance {
s.MultiAZ = &v
return s
}
// SetOptionGroupMemberships sets the OptionGroupMemberships field's value.
func (s *DBInstance) SetOptionGroupMemberships(v []*OptionGroupMembership) *DBInstance {
s.OptionGroupMemberships = v
return s
}
// SetPendingModifiedValues sets the PendingModifiedValues field's value.
func (s *DBInstance) SetPendingModifiedValues(v *PendingModifiedValues) *DBInstance {
s.PendingModifiedValues = v
return s
}
// SetPerformanceInsightsEnabled sets the PerformanceInsightsEnabled field's value.
func (s *DBInstance) SetPerformanceInsightsEnabled(v bool) *DBInstance {
s.PerformanceInsightsEnabled = &v
return s
}
// SetPerformanceInsightsKMSKeyId sets the PerformanceInsightsKMSKeyId field's value.
func (s *DBInstance) SetPerformanceInsightsKMSKeyId(v string) *DBInstance {
s.PerformanceInsightsKMSKeyId = &v
return s
}
// SetPerformanceInsightsRetentionPeriod sets the PerformanceInsightsRetentionPeriod field's value.
func (s *DBInstance) SetPerformanceInsightsRetentionPeriod(v int64) *DBInstance {
s.PerformanceInsightsRetentionPeriod = &v
return s
}
// SetPreferredBackupWindow sets the PreferredBackupWindow field's value.
func (s *DBInstance) SetPreferredBackupWindow(v string) *DBInstance {
s.PreferredBackupWindow = &v
return s
}
// SetPreferredMaintenanceWindow sets the PreferredMaintenanceWindow field's value.
func (s *DBInstance) SetPreferredMaintenanceWindow(v string) *DBInstance {
s.PreferredMaintenanceWindow = &v
return s
}
// SetProcessorFeatures sets the ProcessorFeatures field's value.
func (s *DBInstance) SetProcessorFeatures(v []*ProcessorFeature) *DBInstance {
s.ProcessorFeatures = v
return s
}
// SetPromotionTier sets the PromotionTier field's value.
func (s *DBInstance) SetPromotionTier(v int64) *DBInstance {
s.PromotionTier = &v
return s
}
// SetPubliclyAccessible sets the PubliclyAccessible field's value.
func (s *DBInstance) SetPubliclyAccessible(v bool) *DBInstance {
s.PubliclyAccessible = &v
return s
}
// SetReadReplicaDBClusterIdentifiers sets the ReadReplicaDBClusterIdentifiers field's value.
func (s *DBInstance) SetReadReplicaDBClusterIdentifiers(v []*string) *DBInstance {
s.ReadReplicaDBClusterIdentifiers = v
return s
}
// SetReadReplicaDBInstanceIdentifiers sets the ReadReplicaDBInstanceIdentifiers field's value.
func (s *DBInstance) SetReadReplicaDBInstanceIdentifiers(v []*string) *DBInstance {
s.ReadReplicaDBInstanceIdentifiers = v
return s
}
// SetReadReplicaSourceDBInstanceIdentifier sets the ReadReplicaSourceDBInstanceIdentifier field's value.
func (s *DBInstance) SetReadReplicaSourceDBInstanceIdentifier(v string) *DBInstance {
s.ReadReplicaSourceDBInstanceIdentifier = &v
return s
}
// SetSecondaryAvailabilityZone sets the SecondaryAvailabilityZone field's value.
func (s *DBInstance) SetSecondaryAvailabilityZone(v string) *DBInstance {
s.SecondaryAvailabilityZone = &v
return s
}
// SetStatusInfos sets the StatusInfos field's value.
func (s *DBInstance) SetStatusInfos(v []*DBInstanceStatusInfo) *DBInstance {
s.StatusInfos = v
return s
}
// SetStorageEncrypted sets the StorageEncrypted field's value.
func (s *DBInstance) SetStorageEncrypted(v bool) *DBInstance {
s.StorageEncrypted = &v
return s
}
// SetStorageType sets the StorageType field's value.
func (s *DBInstance) SetStorageType(v string) *DBInstance {
s.StorageType = &v
return s
}
// SetTdeCredentialArn sets the TdeCredentialArn field's value.
func (s *DBInstance) SetTdeCredentialArn(v string) *DBInstance {
s.TdeCredentialArn = &v
return s
}
// SetTimezone sets the Timezone field's value.
func (s *DBInstance) SetTimezone(v string) *DBInstance {
s.Timezone = &v
return s
}
// SetVpcSecurityGroups sets the VpcSecurityGroups field's value.
func (s *DBInstance) SetVpcSecurityGroups(v []*VpcSecurityGroupMembership) *DBInstance {
s.VpcSecurityGroups = v
return s
}
// An automated backup of a DB instance. It it consists of system backups, transaction
// logs, and the database instance properties that existed at the time you deleted
// the source instance.
type DBInstanceAutomatedBackup struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// Specifies the allocated storage size in gibibytes (GiB).
AllocatedStorage *int64 `type:"integer"`
// The Availability Zone that the automated backup was created in. For information
// on AWS Regions and Availability Zones, see Regions and Availability Zones
// (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/UserGuide/Concepts.RegionsAndAvailabilityZones.html).
AvailabilityZone *string `type:"string"`
// The Amazon Resource Name (ARN) for the automated backup.
DBInstanceArn *string `type:"string"`
// The customer id of the instance that is/was associated with the automated
// backup.
DBInstanceIdentifier *string `type:"string"`
// The identifier for the source DB instance, which can't be changed and which
// is unique to an AWS Region.
DbiResourceId *string `type:"string"`
// Specifies whether the automated backup is encrypted.
Encrypted *bool `type:"boolean"`
// The name of the database engine for this automated backup.
Engine *string `type:"string"`
// The version of the database engine for the automated backup.
EngineVersion *string `type:"string"`
// True if mapping of AWS Identity and Access Management (IAM) accounts to database
// accounts is enabled, and otherwise false.
IAMDatabaseAuthenticationEnabled *bool `type:"boolean"`
// Provides the date and time that the DB instance was created.
InstanceCreateTime *time.Time `type:"timestamp"`
// The IOPS (I/O operations per second) value for the automated backup.
Iops *int64 `type:"integer"`
// The AWS KMS key ID for an automated backup. The KMS key ID is the Amazon
// Resource Name (ARN), KMS key identifier, or the KMS key alias for the KMS
// encryption key.
KmsKeyId *string `type:"string"`
// License model information for the automated backup.
LicenseModel *string `type:"string"`
// The license model of an automated backup.
MasterUsername *string `type:"string"`
// The option group the automated backup is associated with. If omitted, the
// default option group for the engine specified is used.
OptionGroupName *string `type:"string"`
// The port number that the automated backup used for connections.
//
// Default: Inherits from the source DB instance
//
// Valid Values: 1150-65535
Port *int64 `type:"integer"`
// The AWS Region associated with the automated backup.
Region *string `type:"string"`
// Earliest and latest time an instance can be restored to.
RestoreWindow *RestoreWindow `type:"structure"`
// Provides a list of status information for an automated backup:
//
// * active - automated backups for current instances
//
// * retained - automated backups for deleted instances
//
// * creating - automated backups that are waiting for the first automated
// snapshot to be available.
Status *string `type:"string"`
// Specifies the storage type associated with the automated backup.
StorageType *string `type:"string"`
// The ARN from the key store with which the automated backup is associated
// for TDE encryption.
TdeCredentialArn *string `type:"string"`
// The time zone of the automated backup. In most cases, the Timezone element
// is empty. Timezone content appears only for Microsoft SQL Server DB instances
// that were created with a time zone specified.
Timezone *string `type:"string"`
// Provides the VPC ID associated with the DB instance
VpcId *string `type:"string"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s DBInstanceAutomatedBackup) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s DBInstanceAutomatedBackup) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetAllocatedStorage sets the AllocatedStorage field's value.
func (s *DBInstanceAutomatedBackup) SetAllocatedStorage(v int64) *DBInstanceAutomatedBackup {
s.AllocatedStorage = &v
return s
}
// SetAvailabilityZone sets the AvailabilityZone field's value.
func (s *DBInstanceAutomatedBackup) SetAvailabilityZone(v string) *DBInstanceAutomatedBackup {
s.AvailabilityZone = &v
return s
}
// SetDBInstanceArn sets the DBInstanceArn field's value.
func (s *DBInstanceAutomatedBackup) SetDBInstanceArn(v string) *DBInstanceAutomatedBackup {
s.DBInstanceArn = &v
return s
}
// SetDBInstanceIdentifier sets the DBInstanceIdentifier field's value.
func (s *DBInstanceAutomatedBackup) SetDBInstanceIdentifier(v string) *DBInstanceAutomatedBackup {
s.DBInstanceIdentifier = &v
return s
}
// SetDbiResourceId sets the DbiResourceId field's value.
func (s *DBInstanceAutomatedBackup) SetDbiResourceId(v string) *DBInstanceAutomatedBackup {
s.DbiResourceId = &v
return s
}
// SetEncrypted sets the Encrypted field's value.
func (s *DBInstanceAutomatedBackup) SetEncrypted(v bool) *DBInstanceAutomatedBackup {
s.Encrypted = &v
return s
}
// SetEngine sets the Engine field's value.
func (s *DBInstanceAutomatedBackup) SetEngine(v string) *DBInstanceAutomatedBackup {
s.Engine = &v
return s
}
// SetEngineVersion sets the EngineVersion field's value.
func (s *DBInstanceAutomatedBackup) SetEngineVersion(v string) *DBInstanceAutomatedBackup {
s.EngineVersion = &v
return s
}
// SetIAMDatabaseAuthenticationEnabled sets the IAMDatabaseAuthenticationEnabled field's value.
func (s *DBInstanceAutomatedBackup) SetIAMDatabaseAuthenticationEnabled(v bool) *DBInstanceAutomatedBackup {
s.IAMDatabaseAuthenticationEnabled = &v
return s
}
// SetInstanceCreateTime sets the InstanceCreateTime field's value.
func (s *DBInstanceAutomatedBackup) SetInstanceCreateTime(v time.Time) *DBInstanceAutomatedBackup {
s.InstanceCreateTime = &v
return s
}
// SetIops sets the Iops field's value.
func (s *DBInstanceAutomatedBackup) SetIops(v int64) *DBInstanceAutomatedBackup {
s.Iops = &v
return s
}
// SetKmsKeyId sets the KmsKeyId field's value.
func (s *DBInstanceAutomatedBackup) SetKmsKeyId(v string) *DBInstanceAutomatedBackup {
s.KmsKeyId = &v
return s
}
// SetLicenseModel sets the LicenseModel field's value.
func (s *DBInstanceAutomatedBackup) SetLicenseModel(v string) *DBInstanceAutomatedBackup {
s.LicenseModel = &v
return s
}
// SetMasterUsername sets the MasterUsername field's value.
func (s *DBInstanceAutomatedBackup) SetMasterUsername(v string) *DBInstanceAutomatedBackup {
s.MasterUsername = &v
return s
}
// SetOptionGroupName sets the OptionGroupName field's value.
func (s *DBInstanceAutomatedBackup) SetOptionGroupName(v string) *DBInstanceAutomatedBackup {
s.OptionGroupName = &v
return s
}
// SetPort sets the Port field's value.
func (s *DBInstanceAutomatedBackup) SetPort(v int64) *DBInstanceAutomatedBackup {
s.Port = &v
return s
}
// SetRegion sets the Region field's value.
func (s *DBInstanceAutomatedBackup) SetRegion(v string) *DBInstanceAutomatedBackup {
s.Region = &v
return s
}
// SetRestoreWindow sets the RestoreWindow field's value.
func (s *DBInstanceAutomatedBackup) SetRestoreWindow(v *RestoreWindow) *DBInstanceAutomatedBackup {
s.RestoreWindow = v
return s
}
// SetStatus sets the Status field's value.
func (s *DBInstanceAutomatedBackup) SetStatus(v string) *DBInstanceAutomatedBackup {
s.Status = &v
return s
}
// SetStorageType sets the StorageType field's value.
func (s *DBInstanceAutomatedBackup) SetStorageType(v string) *DBInstanceAutomatedBackup {
s.StorageType = &v
return s
}
// SetTdeCredentialArn sets the TdeCredentialArn field's value.
func (s *DBInstanceAutomatedBackup) SetTdeCredentialArn(v string) *DBInstanceAutomatedBackup {
s.TdeCredentialArn = &v
return s
}
// SetTimezone sets the Timezone field's value.
func (s *DBInstanceAutomatedBackup) SetTimezone(v string) *DBInstanceAutomatedBackup {
s.Timezone = &v
return s
}
// SetVpcId sets the VpcId field's value.
func (s *DBInstanceAutomatedBackup) SetVpcId(v string) *DBInstanceAutomatedBackup {
s.VpcId = &v
return s
}
// Describes an AWS Identity and Access Management (IAM) role that is associated
// with a DB instance.
type DBInstanceRole struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// The name of the feature associated with the AWS Identity and Access Management
// (IAM) role. For the list of supported feature names, see DBEngineVersion.
FeatureName *string `type:"string"`
// The Amazon Resource Name (ARN) of the IAM role that is associated with the
// DB instance.
RoleArn *string `type:"string"`
// Describes the state of association between the IAM role and the DB instance.
// The Status property returns one of the following values:
//
// * ACTIVE - the IAM role ARN is associated with the DB instance and can
// be used to access other AWS services on your behalf.
//
// * PENDING - the IAM role ARN is being associated with the DB instance.
//
// * INVALID - the IAM role ARN is associated with the DB instance, but the
// DB instance is unable to assume the IAM role in order to access other
// AWS services on your behalf.
Status *string `type:"string"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s DBInstanceRole) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s DBInstanceRole) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetFeatureName sets the FeatureName field's value.
func (s *DBInstanceRole) SetFeatureName(v string) *DBInstanceRole {
s.FeatureName = &v
return s
}
// SetRoleArn sets the RoleArn field's value.
func (s *DBInstanceRole) SetRoleArn(v string) *DBInstanceRole {
s.RoleArn = &v
return s
}
// SetStatus sets the Status field's value.
func (s *DBInstanceRole) SetStatus(v string) *DBInstanceRole {
s.Status = &v
return s
}
// Provides a list of status information for a DB instance.
type DBInstanceStatusInfo struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// Details of the error if there is an error for the instance. If the instance
// is not in an error state, this value is blank.
Message *string `type:"string"`
// Boolean value that is true if the instance is operating normally, or false
// if the instance is in an error state.
Normal *bool `type:"boolean"`
// Status of the DB instance. For a StatusType of read replica, the values can
// be replicating, replication stop point set, replication stop point reached,
// error, stopped, or terminated.
Status *string `type:"string"`
// This value is currently "read replication."
StatusType *string `type:"string"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s DBInstanceStatusInfo) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s DBInstanceStatusInfo) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetMessage sets the Message field's value.
func (s *DBInstanceStatusInfo) SetMessage(v string) *DBInstanceStatusInfo {
s.Message = &v
return s
}
// SetNormal sets the Normal field's value.
func (s *DBInstanceStatusInfo) SetNormal(v bool) *DBInstanceStatusInfo {
s.Normal = &v
return s
}
// SetStatus sets the Status field's value.
func (s *DBInstanceStatusInfo) SetStatus(v string) *DBInstanceStatusInfo {
s.Status = &v
return s
}
// SetStatusType sets the StatusType field's value.
func (s *DBInstanceStatusInfo) SetStatusType(v string) *DBInstanceStatusInfo {
s.StatusType = &v
return s
}
// Contains the details of an Amazon RDS DB parameter group.
//
// This data type is used as a response element in the DescribeDBParameterGroups
// action.
type DBParameterGroup struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// The Amazon Resource Name (ARN) for the DB parameter group.
DBParameterGroupArn *string `type:"string"`
// Provides the name of the DB parameter group family that this DB parameter
// group is compatible with.
DBParameterGroupFamily *string `type:"string"`
// Provides the name of the DB parameter group.
DBParameterGroupName *string `type:"string"`
// Provides the customer-specified description for this DB parameter group.
Description *string `type:"string"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s DBParameterGroup) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s DBParameterGroup) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetDBParameterGroupArn sets the DBParameterGroupArn field's value.
func (s *DBParameterGroup) SetDBParameterGroupArn(v string) *DBParameterGroup {
s.DBParameterGroupArn = &v
return s
}
// SetDBParameterGroupFamily sets the DBParameterGroupFamily field's value.
func (s *DBParameterGroup) SetDBParameterGroupFamily(v string) *DBParameterGroup {
s.DBParameterGroupFamily = &v
return s
}
// SetDBParameterGroupName sets the DBParameterGroupName field's value.
func (s *DBParameterGroup) SetDBParameterGroupName(v string) *DBParameterGroup {
s.DBParameterGroupName = &v
return s
}
// SetDescription sets the Description field's value.
func (s *DBParameterGroup) SetDescription(v string) *DBParameterGroup {
s.Description = &v
return s
}
// Contains the result of a successful invocation of the ModifyDBParameterGroup
// or ResetDBParameterGroup action.
type DBParameterGroupNameMessage struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// Provides the name of the DB parameter group.
DBParameterGroupName *string `type:"string"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s DBParameterGroupNameMessage) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s DBParameterGroupNameMessage) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetDBParameterGroupName sets the DBParameterGroupName field's value.
func (s *DBParameterGroupNameMessage) SetDBParameterGroupName(v string) *DBParameterGroupNameMessage {
s.DBParameterGroupName = &v
return s
}
// The status of the DB parameter group.
//
// This data type is used as a response element in the following actions:
//
// * CreateDBInstance
//
// * CreateDBInstanceReadReplica
//
// * DeleteDBInstance
//
// * ModifyDBInstance
//
// * RebootDBInstance
//
// * RestoreDBInstanceFromDBSnapshot
type DBParameterGroupStatus struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// The name of the DP parameter group.
DBParameterGroupName *string `type:"string"`
// The status of parameter updates.
ParameterApplyStatus *string `type:"string"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s DBParameterGroupStatus) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s DBParameterGroupStatus) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetDBParameterGroupName sets the DBParameterGroupName field's value.
func (s *DBParameterGroupStatus) SetDBParameterGroupName(v string) *DBParameterGroupStatus {
s.DBParameterGroupName = &v
return s
}
// SetParameterApplyStatus sets the ParameterApplyStatus field's value.
func (s *DBParameterGroupStatus) SetParameterApplyStatus(v string) *DBParameterGroupStatus {
s.ParameterApplyStatus = &v
return s
}
// Contains the details for an Amazon RDS DB security group.
//
// This data type is used as a response element in the DescribeDBSecurityGroups
// action.
type DBSecurityGroup struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// The Amazon Resource Name (ARN) for the DB security group.
DBSecurityGroupArn *string `type:"string"`
// Provides the description of the DB security group.
DBSecurityGroupDescription *string `type:"string"`
// Specifies the name of the DB security group.
DBSecurityGroupName *string `type:"string"`
// Contains a list of EC2SecurityGroup elements.
EC2SecurityGroups []*EC2SecurityGroup `locationNameList:"EC2SecurityGroup" type:"list"`
// Contains a list of IPRange elements.
IPRanges []*IPRange `locationNameList:"IPRange" type:"list"`
// Provides the AWS ID of the owner of a specific DB security group.
OwnerId *string `type:"string"`
// Provides the VpcId of the DB security group.
VpcId *string `type:"string"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s DBSecurityGroup) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s DBSecurityGroup) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetDBSecurityGroupArn sets the DBSecurityGroupArn field's value.
func (s *DBSecurityGroup) SetDBSecurityGroupArn(v string) *DBSecurityGroup {
s.DBSecurityGroupArn = &v
return s
}
// SetDBSecurityGroupDescription sets the DBSecurityGroupDescription field's value.
func (s *DBSecurityGroup) SetDBSecurityGroupDescription(v string) *DBSecurityGroup {
s.DBSecurityGroupDescription = &v
return s
}
// SetDBSecurityGroupName sets the DBSecurityGroupName field's value.
func (s *DBSecurityGroup) SetDBSecurityGroupName(v string) *DBSecurityGroup {
s.DBSecurityGroupName = &v
return s
}
// SetEC2SecurityGroups sets the EC2SecurityGroups field's value.
func (s *DBSecurityGroup) SetEC2SecurityGroups(v []*EC2SecurityGroup) *DBSecurityGroup {
s.EC2SecurityGroups = v
return s
}
// SetIPRanges sets the IPRanges field's value.
func (s *DBSecurityGroup) SetIPRanges(v []*IPRange) *DBSecurityGroup {
s.IPRanges = v
return s
}
// SetOwnerId sets the OwnerId field's value.
func (s *DBSecurityGroup) SetOwnerId(v string) *DBSecurityGroup {
s.OwnerId = &v
return s
}
// SetVpcId sets the VpcId field's value.
func (s *DBSecurityGroup) SetVpcId(v string) *DBSecurityGroup {
s.VpcId = &v
return s
}
// This data type is used as a response element in the following actions:
//
// * ModifyDBInstance
//
// * RebootDBInstance
//
// * RestoreDBInstanceFromDBSnapshot
//
// * RestoreDBInstanceToPointInTime
type DBSecurityGroupMembership struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// The name of the DB security group.
DBSecurityGroupName *string `type:"string"`
// The status of the DB security group.
Status *string `type:"string"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s DBSecurityGroupMembership) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s DBSecurityGroupMembership) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetDBSecurityGroupName sets the DBSecurityGroupName field's value.
func (s *DBSecurityGroupMembership) SetDBSecurityGroupName(v string) *DBSecurityGroupMembership {
s.DBSecurityGroupName = &v
return s
}
// SetStatus sets the Status field's value.
func (s *DBSecurityGroupMembership) SetStatus(v string) *DBSecurityGroupMembership {
s.Status = &v
return s
}
// Contains the details of an Amazon RDS DB snapshot.
//
// This data type is used as a response element in the DescribeDBSnapshots action.
type DBSnapshot struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// Specifies the allocated storage size in gibibytes (GiB).
AllocatedStorage *int64 `type:"integer"`
// Specifies the name of the Availability Zone the DB instance was located in
// at the time of the DB snapshot.
AvailabilityZone *string `type:"string"`
// Specifies the DB instance identifier of the DB instance this DB snapshot
// was created from.
DBInstanceIdentifier *string `type:"string"`
// The Amazon Resource Name (ARN) for the DB snapshot.
DBSnapshotArn *string `type:"string"`
// Specifies the identifier for the DB snapshot.
DBSnapshotIdentifier *string `type:"string"`
// The identifier for the source DB instance, which can't be changed and which
// is unique to an AWS Region.
DbiResourceId *string `type:"string"`
// Specifies whether the DB snapshot is encrypted.
Encrypted *bool `type:"boolean"`
// Specifies the name of the database engine.
Engine *string `type:"string"`
// Specifies the version of the database engine.
EngineVersion *string `type:"string"`
// True if mapping of AWS Identity and Access Management (IAM) accounts to database
// accounts is enabled, and otherwise false.
IAMDatabaseAuthenticationEnabled *bool `type:"boolean"`
// Specifies the time when the snapshot was taken, in Universal Coordinated
// Time (UTC).
InstanceCreateTime *time.Time `type:"timestamp"`
// Specifies the Provisioned IOPS (I/O operations per second) value of the DB
// instance at the time of the snapshot.
Iops *int64 `type:"integer"`
// If Encrypted is true, the AWS KMS key identifier for the encrypted DB snapshot.
KmsKeyId *string `type:"string"`
// License model information for the restored DB instance.
LicenseModel *string `type:"string"`
// Provides the master username for the DB snapshot.
MasterUsername *string `type:"string"`
// Provides the option group name for the DB snapshot.
OptionGroupName *string `type:"string"`
// The percentage of the estimated data that has been transferred.
PercentProgress *int64 `type:"integer"`
// Specifies the port that the database engine was listening on at the time
// of the snapshot.
Port *int64 `type:"integer"`
// The number of CPU cores and the number of threads per core for the DB instance
// class of the DB instance when the DB snapshot was created.
ProcessorFeatures []*ProcessorFeature `locationNameList:"ProcessorFeature" type:"list"`
// Provides the time when the snapshot was taken, in Universal Coordinated Time
// (UTC).
SnapshotCreateTime *time.Time `type:"timestamp"`
// Provides the type of the DB snapshot.
SnapshotType *string `type:"string"`
// The DB snapshot Amazon Resource Name (ARN) that the DB snapshot was copied
// from. It only has value in case of cross-customer or cross-region copy.
SourceDBSnapshotIdentifier *string `type:"string"`
// The AWS Region that the DB snapshot was created in or copied from.
SourceRegion *string `type:"string"`
// Specifies the status of this DB snapshot.
Status *string `type:"string"`
// Specifies the storage type associated with DB snapshot.
StorageType *string `type:"string"`
// The ARN from the key store with which to associate the instance for TDE encryption.
TdeCredentialArn *string `type:"string"`
// The time zone of the DB snapshot. In most cases, the Timezone element is
// empty. Timezone content appears only for snapshots taken from Microsoft SQL
// Server DB instances that were created with a time zone specified.
Timezone *string `type:"string"`
// Provides the VPC ID associated with the DB snapshot.
VpcId *string `type:"string"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s DBSnapshot) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s DBSnapshot) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetAllocatedStorage sets the AllocatedStorage field's value.
func (s *DBSnapshot) SetAllocatedStorage(v int64) *DBSnapshot {
s.AllocatedStorage = &v
return s
}
// SetAvailabilityZone sets the AvailabilityZone field's value.
func (s *DBSnapshot) SetAvailabilityZone(v string) *DBSnapshot {
s.AvailabilityZone = &v
return s
}
// SetDBInstanceIdentifier sets the DBInstanceIdentifier field's value.
func (s *DBSnapshot) SetDBInstanceIdentifier(v string) *DBSnapshot {
s.DBInstanceIdentifier = &v
return s
}
// SetDBSnapshotArn sets the DBSnapshotArn field's value.
func (s *DBSnapshot) SetDBSnapshotArn(v string) *DBSnapshot {
s.DBSnapshotArn = &v
return s
}
// SetDBSnapshotIdentifier sets the DBSnapshotIdentifier field's value.
func (s *DBSnapshot) SetDBSnapshotIdentifier(v string) *DBSnapshot {
s.DBSnapshotIdentifier = &v
return s
}
// SetDbiResourceId sets the DbiResourceId field's value.
func (s *DBSnapshot) SetDbiResourceId(v string) *DBSnapshot {
s.DbiResourceId = &v
return s
}
// SetEncrypted sets the Encrypted field's value.
func (s *DBSnapshot) SetEncrypted(v bool) *DBSnapshot {
s.Encrypted = &v
return s
}
// SetEngine sets the Engine field's value.
func (s *DBSnapshot) SetEngine(v string) *DBSnapshot {
s.Engine = &v
return s
}
// SetEngineVersion sets the EngineVersion field's value.
func (s *DBSnapshot) SetEngineVersion(v string) *DBSnapshot {
s.EngineVersion = &v
return s
}
// SetIAMDatabaseAuthenticationEnabled sets the IAMDatabaseAuthenticationEnabled field's value.
func (s *DBSnapshot) SetIAMDatabaseAuthenticationEnabled(v bool) *DBSnapshot {
s.IAMDatabaseAuthenticationEnabled = &v
return s
}
// SetInstanceCreateTime sets the InstanceCreateTime field's value.
func (s *DBSnapshot) SetInstanceCreateTime(v time.Time) *DBSnapshot {
s.InstanceCreateTime = &v
return s
}
// SetIops sets the Iops field's value.
func (s *DBSnapshot) SetIops(v int64) *DBSnapshot {
s.Iops = &v
return s
}
// SetKmsKeyId sets the KmsKeyId field's value.
func (s *DBSnapshot) SetKmsKeyId(v string) *DBSnapshot {
s.KmsKeyId = &v
return s
}
// SetLicenseModel sets the LicenseModel field's value.
func (s *DBSnapshot) SetLicenseModel(v string) *DBSnapshot {
s.LicenseModel = &v
return s
}
// SetMasterUsername sets the MasterUsername field's value.
func (s *DBSnapshot) SetMasterUsername(v string) *DBSnapshot {
s.MasterUsername = &v
return s
}
// SetOptionGroupName sets the OptionGroupName field's value.
func (s *DBSnapshot) SetOptionGroupName(v string) *DBSnapshot {
s.OptionGroupName = &v
return s
}
// SetPercentProgress sets the PercentProgress field's value.
func (s *DBSnapshot) SetPercentProgress(v int64) *DBSnapshot {
s.PercentProgress = &v
return s
}
// SetPort sets the Port field's value.
func (s *DBSnapshot) SetPort(v int64) *DBSnapshot {
s.Port = &v
return s
}
// SetProcessorFeatures sets the ProcessorFeatures field's value.
func (s *DBSnapshot) SetProcessorFeatures(v []*ProcessorFeature) *DBSnapshot {
s.ProcessorFeatures = v
return s
}
// SetSnapshotCreateTime sets the SnapshotCreateTime field's value.
func (s *DBSnapshot) SetSnapshotCreateTime(v time.Time) *DBSnapshot {
s.SnapshotCreateTime = &v
return s
}
// SetSnapshotType sets the SnapshotType field's value.
func (s *DBSnapshot) SetSnapshotType(v string) *DBSnapshot {
s.SnapshotType = &v
return s
}
// SetSourceDBSnapshotIdentifier sets the SourceDBSnapshotIdentifier field's value.
func (s *DBSnapshot) SetSourceDBSnapshotIdentifier(v string) *DBSnapshot {
s.SourceDBSnapshotIdentifier = &v
return s
}
// SetSourceRegion sets the SourceRegion field's value.
func (s *DBSnapshot) SetSourceRegion(v string) *DBSnapshot {
s.SourceRegion = &v
return s
}
// SetStatus sets the Status field's value.
func (s *DBSnapshot) SetStatus(v string) *DBSnapshot {
s.Status = &v
return s
}
// SetStorageType sets the StorageType field's value.
func (s *DBSnapshot) SetStorageType(v string) *DBSnapshot {
s.StorageType = &v
return s
}
// SetTdeCredentialArn sets the TdeCredentialArn field's value.
func (s *DBSnapshot) SetTdeCredentialArn(v string) *DBSnapshot {
s.TdeCredentialArn = &v
return s
}
// SetTimezone sets the Timezone field's value.
func (s *DBSnapshot) SetTimezone(v string) *DBSnapshot {
s.Timezone = &v
return s
}
// SetVpcId sets the VpcId field's value.
func (s *DBSnapshot) SetVpcId(v string) *DBSnapshot {
s.VpcId = &v
return s
}
// Contains the name and values of a manual DB snapshot attribute
//
// Manual DB snapshot attributes are used to authorize other AWS accounts to
// restore a manual DB snapshot. For more information, see the ModifyDBSnapshotAttribute
// API.
type DBSnapshotAttribute struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// The name of the manual DB snapshot attribute.
//
// The attribute named restore refers to the list of AWS accounts that have
// permission to copy or restore the manual DB cluster snapshot. For more information,
// see the ModifyDBSnapshotAttribute API action.
AttributeName *string `type:"string"`
// The value or values for the manual DB snapshot attribute.
//
// If the AttributeName field is set to restore, then this element returns a
// list of IDs of the AWS accounts that are authorized to copy or restore the
// manual DB snapshot. If a value of all is in the list, then the manual DB
// snapshot is public and available for any AWS account to copy or restore.
AttributeValues []*string `locationNameList:"AttributeValue" type:"list"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s DBSnapshotAttribute) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s DBSnapshotAttribute) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetAttributeName sets the AttributeName field's value.
func (s *DBSnapshotAttribute) SetAttributeName(v string) *DBSnapshotAttribute {
s.AttributeName = &v
return s
}
// SetAttributeValues sets the AttributeValues field's value.
func (s *DBSnapshotAttribute) SetAttributeValues(v []*string) *DBSnapshotAttribute {
s.AttributeValues = v
return s
}
// Contains the results of a successful call to the DescribeDBSnapshotAttributes
// API action.
//
// Manual DB snapshot attributes are used to authorize other AWS accounts to
// copy or restore a manual DB snapshot. For more information, see the ModifyDBSnapshotAttribute
// API action.
type DBSnapshotAttributesResult struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// The list of attributes and values for the manual DB snapshot.
DBSnapshotAttributes []*DBSnapshotAttribute `locationNameList:"DBSnapshotAttribute" type:"list"`
// The identifier of the manual DB snapshot that the attributes apply to.
DBSnapshotIdentifier *string `type:"string"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s DBSnapshotAttributesResult) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s DBSnapshotAttributesResult) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetDBSnapshotAttributes sets the DBSnapshotAttributes field's value.
func (s *DBSnapshotAttributesResult) SetDBSnapshotAttributes(v []*DBSnapshotAttribute) *DBSnapshotAttributesResult {
s.DBSnapshotAttributes = v
return s
}
// SetDBSnapshotIdentifier sets the DBSnapshotIdentifier field's value.
func (s *DBSnapshotAttributesResult) SetDBSnapshotIdentifier(v string) *DBSnapshotAttributesResult {
s.DBSnapshotIdentifier = &v
return s
}
// Contains the details of an Amazon RDS DB subnet group.
//
// This data type is used as a response element in the DescribeDBSubnetGroups
// action.
type DBSubnetGroup struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// The Amazon Resource Name (ARN) for the DB subnet group.
DBSubnetGroupArn *string `type:"string"`
// Provides the description of the DB subnet group.
DBSubnetGroupDescription *string `type:"string"`
// The name of the DB subnet group.
DBSubnetGroupName *string `type:"string"`
// Provides the status of the DB subnet group.
SubnetGroupStatus *string `type:"string"`
// Contains a list of Subnet elements.
Subnets []*Subnet `locationNameList:"Subnet" type:"list"`
// Provides the VpcId of the DB subnet group.
VpcId *string `type:"string"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s DBSubnetGroup) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s DBSubnetGroup) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetDBSubnetGroupArn sets the DBSubnetGroupArn field's value.
func (s *DBSubnetGroup) SetDBSubnetGroupArn(v string) *DBSubnetGroup {
s.DBSubnetGroupArn = &v
return s
}
// SetDBSubnetGroupDescription sets the DBSubnetGroupDescription field's value.
func (s *DBSubnetGroup) SetDBSubnetGroupDescription(v string) *DBSubnetGroup {
s.DBSubnetGroupDescription = &v
return s
}
// SetDBSubnetGroupName sets the DBSubnetGroupName field's value.
func (s *DBSubnetGroup) SetDBSubnetGroupName(v string) *DBSubnetGroup {
s.DBSubnetGroupName = &v
return s
}
// SetSubnetGroupStatus sets the SubnetGroupStatus field's value.
func (s *DBSubnetGroup) SetSubnetGroupStatus(v string) *DBSubnetGroup {
s.SubnetGroupStatus = &v
return s
}
// SetSubnets sets the Subnets field's value.
func (s *DBSubnetGroup) SetSubnets(v []*Subnet) *DBSubnetGroup {
s.Subnets = v
return s
}
// SetVpcId sets the VpcId field's value.
func (s *DBSubnetGroup) SetVpcId(v string) *DBSubnetGroup {
s.VpcId = &v
return s
}
type DeleteDBClusterEndpointInput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// The identifier associated with the custom endpoint. This parameter is stored
// as a lowercase string.
//
// DBClusterEndpointIdentifier is a required field
DBClusterEndpointIdentifier *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s DeleteDBClusterEndpointInput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s DeleteDBClusterEndpointInput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
func (s *DeleteDBClusterEndpointInput) Validate() error {
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "DeleteDBClusterEndpointInput"}
if s.DBClusterEndpointIdentifier == nil {
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("DBClusterEndpointIdentifier"))
}
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
return invalidParams
}
return nil
}
// SetDBClusterEndpointIdentifier sets the DBClusterEndpointIdentifier field's value.
func (s *DeleteDBClusterEndpointInput) SetDBClusterEndpointIdentifier(v string) *DeleteDBClusterEndpointInput {
s.DBClusterEndpointIdentifier = &v
return s
}
// This data type represents the information you need to connect to an Amazon
// Aurora DB cluster. This data type is used as a response element in the following
// actions:
//
// * CreateDBClusterEndpoint
//
// * DescribeDBClusterEndpoints
//
// * ModifyDBClusterEndpoint
//
// * DeleteDBClusterEndpoint
//
// For the data structure that represents Amazon RDS DB instance endpoints,
// see Endpoint.
type DeleteDBClusterEndpointOutput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// The type associated with a custom endpoint. One of: READER, ANY.
CustomEndpointType *string `type:"string"`
// The Amazon Resource Name (ARN) for the endpoint.
DBClusterEndpointArn *string `type:"string"`
// The identifier associated with the endpoint. This parameter is stored as
// a lowercase string.
DBClusterEndpointIdentifier *string `type:"string"`
// A unique system-generated identifier for an endpoint. It remains the same
// for the whole life of the endpoint.
DBClusterEndpointResourceIdentifier *string `type:"string"`
// The DB cluster identifier of the DB cluster associated with the endpoint.
// This parameter is stored as a lowercase string.
DBClusterIdentifier *string `type:"string"`
// The DNS address of the endpoint.
Endpoint *string `type:"string"`
// The type of the endpoint. One of: READER, WRITER, CUSTOM.
EndpointType *string `type:"string"`
// List of DB instance identifiers that aren't part of the custom endpoint group.
// All other eligible instances are reachable through the custom endpoint. Only
// relevant if the list of static members is empty.
ExcludedMembers []*string `type:"list"`
// List of DB instance identifiers that are part of the custom endpoint group.
StaticMembers []*string `type:"list"`
// The current status of the endpoint. One of: creating, available, deleting,
// modifying.
Status *string `type:"string"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s DeleteDBClusterEndpointOutput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s DeleteDBClusterEndpointOutput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetCustomEndpointType sets the CustomEndpointType field's value.
func (s *DeleteDBClusterEndpointOutput) SetCustomEndpointType(v string) *DeleteDBClusterEndpointOutput {
s.CustomEndpointType = &v
return s
}
// SetDBClusterEndpointArn sets the DBClusterEndpointArn field's value.
func (s *DeleteDBClusterEndpointOutput) SetDBClusterEndpointArn(v string) *DeleteDBClusterEndpointOutput {
s.DBClusterEndpointArn = &v
return s
}
// SetDBClusterEndpointIdentifier sets the DBClusterEndpointIdentifier field's value.
func (s *DeleteDBClusterEndpointOutput) SetDBClusterEndpointIdentifier(v string) *DeleteDBClusterEndpointOutput {
s.DBClusterEndpointIdentifier = &v
return s
}
// SetDBClusterEndpointResourceIdentifier sets the DBClusterEndpointResourceIdentifier field's value.
func (s *DeleteDBClusterEndpointOutput) SetDBClusterEndpointResourceIdentifier(v string) *DeleteDBClusterEndpointOutput {
s.DBClusterEndpointResourceIdentifier = &v
return s
}
// SetDBClusterIdentifier sets the DBClusterIdentifier field's value.
func (s *DeleteDBClusterEndpointOutput) SetDBClusterIdentifier(v string) *DeleteDBClusterEndpointOutput {
s.DBClusterIdentifier = &v
return s
}
// SetEndpoint sets the Endpoint field's value.
func (s *DeleteDBClusterEndpointOutput) SetEndpoint(v string) *DeleteDBClusterEndpointOutput {
s.Endpoint = &v
return s
}
// SetEndpointType sets the EndpointType field's value.
func (s *DeleteDBClusterEndpointOutput) SetEndpointType(v string) *DeleteDBClusterEndpointOutput {
s.EndpointType = &v
return s
}
// SetExcludedMembers sets the ExcludedMembers field's value.
func (s *DeleteDBClusterEndpointOutput) SetExcludedMembers(v []*string) *DeleteDBClusterEndpointOutput {
s.ExcludedMembers = v
return s
}
// SetStaticMembers sets the StaticMembers field's value.
func (s *DeleteDBClusterEndpointOutput) SetStaticMembers(v []*string) *DeleteDBClusterEndpointOutput {
s.StaticMembers = v
return s
}
// SetStatus sets the Status field's value.
func (s *DeleteDBClusterEndpointOutput) SetStatus(v string) *DeleteDBClusterEndpointOutput {
s.Status = &v
return s
}
type DeleteDBClusterInput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// The DB cluster identifier for the DB cluster to be deleted. This parameter
// isn't case-sensitive.
//
// Constraints:
//
// * Must match an existing DBClusterIdentifier.
//
// DBClusterIdentifier is a required field
DBClusterIdentifier *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
// The DB cluster snapshot identifier of the new DB cluster snapshot created
// when SkipFinalSnapshot is set to false.
//
// Specifying this parameter and also setting the SkipFinalShapshot parameter
// to true results in an error.
//
// Constraints:
//
// * Must be 1 to 255 letters, numbers, or hyphens.
//
// * First character must be a letter
//
// * Can't end with a hyphen or contain two consecutive hyphens
FinalDBSnapshotIdentifier *string `type:"string"`
// Determines whether a final DB cluster snapshot is created before the DB cluster
// is deleted. If true is specified, no DB cluster snapshot is created. If false
// is specified, a DB cluster snapshot is created before the DB cluster is deleted.
//
// You must specify a FinalDBSnapshotIdentifier parameter if SkipFinalSnapshot
// is false.
//
// Default: false
SkipFinalSnapshot *bool `type:"boolean"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s DeleteDBClusterInput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s DeleteDBClusterInput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
func (s *DeleteDBClusterInput) Validate() error {
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "DeleteDBClusterInput"}
if s.DBClusterIdentifier == nil {
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("DBClusterIdentifier"))
}
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
return invalidParams
}
return nil
}
// SetDBClusterIdentifier sets the DBClusterIdentifier field's value.
func (s *DeleteDBClusterInput) SetDBClusterIdentifier(v string) *DeleteDBClusterInput {
s.DBClusterIdentifier = &v
return s
}
// SetFinalDBSnapshotIdentifier sets the FinalDBSnapshotIdentifier field's value.
func (s *DeleteDBClusterInput) SetFinalDBSnapshotIdentifier(v string) *DeleteDBClusterInput {
s.FinalDBSnapshotIdentifier = &v
return s
}
// SetSkipFinalSnapshot sets the SkipFinalSnapshot field's value.
func (s *DeleteDBClusterInput) SetSkipFinalSnapshot(v bool) *DeleteDBClusterInput {
s.SkipFinalSnapshot = &v
return s
}
type DeleteDBClusterOutput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// Contains the details of an Amazon Aurora DB cluster.
//
// This data type is used as a response element in the DescribeDBClusters, StopDBCluster,
// and StartDBCluster actions.
DBCluster *DBCluster `type:"structure"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s DeleteDBClusterOutput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s DeleteDBClusterOutput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetDBCluster sets the DBCluster field's value.
func (s *DeleteDBClusterOutput) SetDBCluster(v *DBCluster) *DeleteDBClusterOutput {
s.DBCluster = v
return s
}
type DeleteDBClusterParameterGroupInput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// The name of the DB cluster parameter group.
//
// Constraints:
//
// * Must be the name of an existing DB cluster parameter group.
//
// * You can't delete a default DB cluster parameter group.
//
// * Can't be associated with any DB clusters.
//
// DBClusterParameterGroupName is a required field
DBClusterParameterGroupName *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s DeleteDBClusterParameterGroupInput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s DeleteDBClusterParameterGroupInput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
func (s *DeleteDBClusterParameterGroupInput) Validate() error {
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "DeleteDBClusterParameterGroupInput"}
if s.DBClusterParameterGroupName == nil {
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("DBClusterParameterGroupName"))
}
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
return invalidParams
}
return nil
}
// SetDBClusterParameterGroupName sets the DBClusterParameterGroupName field's value.
func (s *DeleteDBClusterParameterGroupInput) SetDBClusterParameterGroupName(v string) *DeleteDBClusterParameterGroupInput {
s.DBClusterParameterGroupName = &v
return s
}
type DeleteDBClusterParameterGroupOutput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s DeleteDBClusterParameterGroupOutput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s DeleteDBClusterParameterGroupOutput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
type DeleteDBClusterSnapshotInput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// The identifier of the DB cluster snapshot to delete.
//
// Constraints: Must be the name of an existing DB cluster snapshot in the available
// state.
//
// DBClusterSnapshotIdentifier is a required field
DBClusterSnapshotIdentifier *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s DeleteDBClusterSnapshotInput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s DeleteDBClusterSnapshotInput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
func (s *DeleteDBClusterSnapshotInput) Validate() error {
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "DeleteDBClusterSnapshotInput"}
if s.DBClusterSnapshotIdentifier == nil {
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("DBClusterSnapshotIdentifier"))
}
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
return invalidParams
}
return nil
}
// SetDBClusterSnapshotIdentifier sets the DBClusterSnapshotIdentifier field's value.
func (s *DeleteDBClusterSnapshotInput) SetDBClusterSnapshotIdentifier(v string) *DeleteDBClusterSnapshotInput {
s.DBClusterSnapshotIdentifier = &v
return s
}
type DeleteDBClusterSnapshotOutput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// Contains the details for an Amazon RDS DB cluster snapshot
//
// This data type is used as a response element in the DescribeDBClusterSnapshots
// action.
DBClusterSnapshot *DBClusterSnapshot `type:"structure"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s DeleteDBClusterSnapshotOutput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s DeleteDBClusterSnapshotOutput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetDBClusterSnapshot sets the DBClusterSnapshot field's value.
func (s *DeleteDBClusterSnapshotOutput) SetDBClusterSnapshot(v *DBClusterSnapshot) *DeleteDBClusterSnapshotOutput {
s.DBClusterSnapshot = v
return s
}
// Parameter input for the DeleteDBInstanceAutomatedBackup operation.
type DeleteDBInstanceAutomatedBackupInput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// The identifier for the source DB instance, which can't be changed and which
// is unique to an AWS Region.
//
// DbiResourceId is a required field
DbiResourceId *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s DeleteDBInstanceAutomatedBackupInput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s DeleteDBInstanceAutomatedBackupInput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
func (s *DeleteDBInstanceAutomatedBackupInput) Validate() error {
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "DeleteDBInstanceAutomatedBackupInput"}
if s.DbiResourceId == nil {
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("DbiResourceId"))
}
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
return invalidParams
}
return nil
}
// SetDbiResourceId sets the DbiResourceId field's value.
func (s *DeleteDBInstanceAutomatedBackupInput) SetDbiResourceId(v string) *DeleteDBInstanceAutomatedBackupInput {
s.DbiResourceId = &v
return s
}
type DeleteDBInstanceAutomatedBackupOutput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// An automated backup of a DB instance. It it consists of system backups, transaction
// logs, and the database instance properties that existed at the time you deleted
// the source instance.
DBInstanceAutomatedBackup *DBInstanceAutomatedBackup `type:"structure"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s DeleteDBInstanceAutomatedBackupOutput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s DeleteDBInstanceAutomatedBackupOutput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetDBInstanceAutomatedBackup sets the DBInstanceAutomatedBackup field's value.
func (s *DeleteDBInstanceAutomatedBackupOutput) SetDBInstanceAutomatedBackup(v *DBInstanceAutomatedBackup) *DeleteDBInstanceAutomatedBackupOutput {
s.DBInstanceAutomatedBackup = v
return s
}
type DeleteDBInstanceInput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// The DB instance identifier for the DB instance to be deleted. This parameter
// isn't case-sensitive.
//
// Constraints:
//
// * Must match the name of an existing DB instance.
//
// DBInstanceIdentifier is a required field
DBInstanceIdentifier *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
// A value that indicates whether to remove automated backups immediately after
// the DB instance is deleted. This parameter isn't case-sensitive. This parameter
// defaults to true.
DeleteAutomatedBackups *bool `type:"boolean"`
// The DBSnapshotIdentifier of the new DB snapshot created when SkipFinalSnapshot
// is set to false.
//
// Specifying this parameter and also setting the SkipFinalShapshot parameter
// to true results in an error.
//
// Constraints:
//
// * Must be 1 to 255 letters or numbers.
//
// * First character must be a letter.
//
// * Can't end with a hyphen or contain two consecutive hyphens.
//
// * Can't be specified when deleting a Read Replica.
FinalDBSnapshotIdentifier *string `type:"string"`
// A value that indicates whether a final DB snapshot is created before the
// DB instance is deleted. If true is specified, no DB snapshot is created.
// If false is specified, a DB snapshot is created before the DB instance is
// deleted.
//
// When a DB instance is in a failure state and has a status of failed, incompatible-restore,
// or incompatible-network, you can only delete it when the SkipFinalSnapshot
// parameter is set to true.
//
// Specify true when deleting a Read Replica.
//
// The FinalDBSnapshotIdentifier parameter must be specified if SkipFinalSnapshot
// is false.
//
// Default: false
SkipFinalSnapshot *bool `type:"boolean"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s DeleteDBInstanceInput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s DeleteDBInstanceInput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
func (s *DeleteDBInstanceInput) Validate() error {
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "DeleteDBInstanceInput"}
if s.DBInstanceIdentifier == nil {
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("DBInstanceIdentifier"))
}
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
return invalidParams
}
return nil
}
// SetDBInstanceIdentifier sets the DBInstanceIdentifier field's value.
func (s *DeleteDBInstanceInput) SetDBInstanceIdentifier(v string) *DeleteDBInstanceInput {
s.DBInstanceIdentifier = &v
return s
}
// SetDeleteAutomatedBackups sets the DeleteAutomatedBackups field's value.
func (s *DeleteDBInstanceInput) SetDeleteAutomatedBackups(v bool) *DeleteDBInstanceInput {
s.DeleteAutomatedBackups = &v
return s
}
// SetFinalDBSnapshotIdentifier sets the FinalDBSnapshotIdentifier field's value.
func (s *DeleteDBInstanceInput) SetFinalDBSnapshotIdentifier(v string) *DeleteDBInstanceInput {
s.FinalDBSnapshotIdentifier = &v
return s
}
// SetSkipFinalSnapshot sets the SkipFinalSnapshot field's value.
func (s *DeleteDBInstanceInput) SetSkipFinalSnapshot(v bool) *DeleteDBInstanceInput {
s.SkipFinalSnapshot = &v
return s
}
type DeleteDBInstanceOutput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// Contains the details of an Amazon RDS DB instance.
//
// This data type is used as a response element in the DescribeDBInstances action.
DBInstance *DBInstance `type:"structure"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s DeleteDBInstanceOutput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s DeleteDBInstanceOutput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetDBInstance sets the DBInstance field's value.
func (s *DeleteDBInstanceOutput) SetDBInstance(v *DBInstance) *DeleteDBInstanceOutput {
s.DBInstance = v
return s
}
type DeleteDBParameterGroupInput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// The name of the DB parameter group.
//
// Constraints:
//
// * Must be the name of an existing DB parameter group
//
// * You can't delete a default DB parameter group
//
// * Can't be associated with any DB instances
//
// DBParameterGroupName is a required field
DBParameterGroupName *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s DeleteDBParameterGroupInput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s DeleteDBParameterGroupInput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
func (s *DeleteDBParameterGroupInput) Validate() error {
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "DeleteDBParameterGroupInput"}
if s.DBParameterGroupName == nil {
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("DBParameterGroupName"))
}
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
return invalidParams
}
return nil
}
// SetDBParameterGroupName sets the DBParameterGroupName field's value.
func (s *DeleteDBParameterGroupInput) SetDBParameterGroupName(v string) *DeleteDBParameterGroupInput {
s.DBParameterGroupName = &v
return s
}
type DeleteDBParameterGroupOutput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s DeleteDBParameterGroupOutput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s DeleteDBParameterGroupOutput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
type DeleteDBSecurityGroupInput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// The name of the DB security group to delete.
//
// You can't delete the default DB security group.
//
// Constraints:
//
// * Must be 1 to 255 letters, numbers, or hyphens.
//
// * First character must be a letter
//
// * Can't end with a hyphen or contain two consecutive hyphens
//
// * Must not be "Default"
//
// DBSecurityGroupName is a required field
DBSecurityGroupName *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s DeleteDBSecurityGroupInput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s DeleteDBSecurityGroupInput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
func (s *DeleteDBSecurityGroupInput) Validate() error {
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "DeleteDBSecurityGroupInput"}
if s.DBSecurityGroupName == nil {
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("DBSecurityGroupName"))
}
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
return invalidParams
}
return nil
}
// SetDBSecurityGroupName sets the DBSecurityGroupName field's value.
func (s *DeleteDBSecurityGroupInput) SetDBSecurityGroupName(v string) *DeleteDBSecurityGroupInput {
s.DBSecurityGroupName = &v
return s
}
type DeleteDBSecurityGroupOutput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s DeleteDBSecurityGroupOutput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s DeleteDBSecurityGroupOutput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
type DeleteDBSnapshotInput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// The DB snapshot identifier.
//
// Constraints: Must be the name of an existing DB snapshot in the available
// state.
//
// DBSnapshotIdentifier is a required field
DBSnapshotIdentifier *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s DeleteDBSnapshotInput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s DeleteDBSnapshotInput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
func (s *DeleteDBSnapshotInput) Validate() error {
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "DeleteDBSnapshotInput"}
if s.DBSnapshotIdentifier == nil {
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("DBSnapshotIdentifier"))
}
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
return invalidParams
}
return nil
}
// SetDBSnapshotIdentifier sets the DBSnapshotIdentifier field's value.
func (s *DeleteDBSnapshotInput) SetDBSnapshotIdentifier(v string) *DeleteDBSnapshotInput {
s.DBSnapshotIdentifier = &v
return s
}
type DeleteDBSnapshotOutput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// Contains the details of an Amazon RDS DB snapshot.
//
// This data type is used as a response element in the DescribeDBSnapshots action.
DBSnapshot *DBSnapshot `type:"structure"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s DeleteDBSnapshotOutput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s DeleteDBSnapshotOutput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetDBSnapshot sets the DBSnapshot field's value.
func (s *DeleteDBSnapshotOutput) SetDBSnapshot(v *DBSnapshot) *DeleteDBSnapshotOutput {
s.DBSnapshot = v
return s
}
type DeleteDBSubnetGroupInput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// The name of the database subnet group to delete.
//
// You can't delete the default subnet group.
//
// Constraints:
//
// Constraints: Must match the name of an existing DBSubnetGroup. Must not be
// default.
//
// Example: mySubnetgroup
//
// DBSubnetGroupName is a required field
DBSubnetGroupName *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s DeleteDBSubnetGroupInput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s DeleteDBSubnetGroupInput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
func (s *DeleteDBSubnetGroupInput) Validate() error {
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "DeleteDBSubnetGroupInput"}
if s.DBSubnetGroupName == nil {
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("DBSubnetGroupName"))
}
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
return invalidParams
}
return nil
}
// SetDBSubnetGroupName sets the DBSubnetGroupName field's value.
func (s *DeleteDBSubnetGroupInput) SetDBSubnetGroupName(v string) *DeleteDBSubnetGroupInput {
s.DBSubnetGroupName = &v
return s
}
type DeleteDBSubnetGroupOutput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s DeleteDBSubnetGroupOutput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s DeleteDBSubnetGroupOutput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
type DeleteEventSubscriptionInput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// The name of the RDS event notification subscription you want to delete.
//
// SubscriptionName is a required field
SubscriptionName *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s DeleteEventSubscriptionInput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s DeleteEventSubscriptionInput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
func (s *DeleteEventSubscriptionInput) Validate() error {
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "DeleteEventSubscriptionInput"}
if s.SubscriptionName == nil {
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("SubscriptionName"))
}
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
return invalidParams
}
return nil
}
// SetSubscriptionName sets the SubscriptionName field's value.
func (s *DeleteEventSubscriptionInput) SetSubscriptionName(v string) *DeleteEventSubscriptionInput {
s.SubscriptionName = &v
return s
}
type DeleteEventSubscriptionOutput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// Contains the results of a successful invocation of the DescribeEventSubscriptions
// action.
EventSubscription *EventSubscription `type:"structure"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s DeleteEventSubscriptionOutput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s DeleteEventSubscriptionOutput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetEventSubscription sets the EventSubscription field's value.
func (s *DeleteEventSubscriptionOutput) SetEventSubscription(v *EventSubscription) *DeleteEventSubscriptionOutput {
s.EventSubscription = v
return s
}
type DeleteGlobalClusterInput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// The cluster identifier of the global database cluster being deleted.
//
// GlobalClusterIdentifier is a required field
GlobalClusterIdentifier *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s DeleteGlobalClusterInput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s DeleteGlobalClusterInput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
func (s *DeleteGlobalClusterInput) Validate() error {
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "DeleteGlobalClusterInput"}
if s.GlobalClusterIdentifier == nil {
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("GlobalClusterIdentifier"))
}
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
return invalidParams
}
return nil
}
// SetGlobalClusterIdentifier sets the GlobalClusterIdentifier field's value.
func (s *DeleteGlobalClusterInput) SetGlobalClusterIdentifier(v string) *DeleteGlobalClusterInput {
s.GlobalClusterIdentifier = &v
return s
}
type DeleteGlobalClusterOutput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// A data type representing an Aurora global database.
GlobalCluster *GlobalCluster `type:"structure"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s DeleteGlobalClusterOutput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s DeleteGlobalClusterOutput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetGlobalCluster sets the GlobalCluster field's value.
func (s *DeleteGlobalClusterOutput) SetGlobalCluster(v *GlobalCluster) *DeleteGlobalClusterOutput {
s.GlobalCluster = v
return s
}
type DeleteOptionGroupInput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// The name of the option group to be deleted.
//
// You can't delete default option groups.
//
// OptionGroupName is a required field
OptionGroupName *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s DeleteOptionGroupInput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s DeleteOptionGroupInput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
func (s *DeleteOptionGroupInput) Validate() error {
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "DeleteOptionGroupInput"}
if s.OptionGroupName == nil {
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("OptionGroupName"))
}
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
return invalidParams
}
return nil
}
// SetOptionGroupName sets the OptionGroupName field's value.
func (s *DeleteOptionGroupInput) SetOptionGroupName(v string) *DeleteOptionGroupInput {
s.OptionGroupName = &v
return s
}
type DeleteOptionGroupOutput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s DeleteOptionGroupOutput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s DeleteOptionGroupOutput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
type DescribeAccountAttributesInput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s DescribeAccountAttributesInput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s DescribeAccountAttributesInput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// Data returned by the DescribeAccountAttributes action.
type DescribeAccountAttributesOutput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// A list of AccountQuota objects. Within this list, each quota has a name,
// a count of usage toward the quota maximum, and a maximum value for the quota.
AccountQuotas []*AccountQuota `locationNameList:"AccountQuota" type:"list"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s DescribeAccountAttributesOutput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s DescribeAccountAttributesOutput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetAccountQuotas sets the AccountQuotas field's value.
func (s *DescribeAccountAttributesOutput) SetAccountQuotas(v []*AccountQuota) *DescribeAccountAttributesOutput {
s.AccountQuotas = v
return s
}
type DescribeCertificatesInput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// The user-supplied certificate identifier. If this parameter is specified,
// information for only the identified certificate is returned. This parameter
// isn't case-sensitive.
//
// Constraints:
//
// * Must match an existing CertificateIdentifier.
CertificateIdentifier *string `type:"string"`
// This parameter is not currently supported.
Filters []*Filter `locationNameList:"Filter" type:"list"`
// An optional pagination token provided by a previous DescribeCertificates
// request. If this parameter is specified, the response includes only records
// beyond the marker, up to the value specified by MaxRecords.
Marker *string `type:"string"`
// The maximum number of records to include in the response. If more records
// exist than the specified MaxRecords value, a pagination token called a marker
// is included in the response so that the remaining results can be retrieved.
//
// Default: 100
//
// Constraints: Minimum 20, maximum 100.
MaxRecords *int64 `type:"integer"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s DescribeCertificatesInput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s DescribeCertificatesInput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
func (s *DescribeCertificatesInput) Validate() error {
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "DescribeCertificatesInput"}
if s.Filters != nil {
for i, v := range s.Filters {
if v == nil {
continue
}
if err := v.Validate(); err != nil {
invalidParams.AddNested(fmt.Sprintf("%s[%v]", "Filters", i), err.(request.ErrInvalidParams))
}
}
}
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
return invalidParams
}
return nil
}
// SetCertificateIdentifier sets the CertificateIdentifier field's value.
func (s *DescribeCertificatesInput) SetCertificateIdentifier(v string) *DescribeCertificatesInput {
s.CertificateIdentifier = &v
return s
}
// SetFilters sets the Filters field's value.
func (s *DescribeCertificatesInput) SetFilters(v []*Filter) *DescribeCertificatesInput {
s.Filters = v
return s
}
// SetMarker sets the Marker field's value.
func (s *DescribeCertificatesInput) SetMarker(v string) *DescribeCertificatesInput {
s.Marker = &v
return s
}
// SetMaxRecords sets the MaxRecords field's value.
func (s *DescribeCertificatesInput) SetMaxRecords(v int64) *DescribeCertificatesInput {
s.MaxRecords = &v
return s
}
// Data returned by the DescribeCertificates action.
type DescribeCertificatesOutput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// The list of Certificate objects for the AWS account.
Certificates []*Certificate `locationNameList:"Certificate" type:"list"`
// An optional pagination token provided by a previous DescribeCertificates
// request. If this parameter is specified, the response includes only records
// beyond the marker, up to the value specified by MaxRecords .
Marker *string `type:"string"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s DescribeCertificatesOutput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s DescribeCertificatesOutput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetCertificates sets the Certificates field's value.
func (s *DescribeCertificatesOutput) SetCertificates(v []*Certificate) *DescribeCertificatesOutput {
s.Certificates = v
return s
}
// SetMarker sets the Marker field's value.
func (s *DescribeCertificatesOutput) SetMarker(v string) *DescribeCertificatesOutput {
s.Marker = &v
return s
}
type DescribeDBClusterBacktracksInput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// If specified, this value is the backtrack identifier of the backtrack to
// be described.
//
// Constraints:
//
// * Must contain a valid universally unique identifier (UUID). For more
// information about UUIDs, see A Universally Unique Identifier (UUID) URN
// Namespace (http://www.ietf.org/rfc/rfc4122.txt).
//
// Example: 123e4567-e89b-12d3-a456-426655440000
BacktrackIdentifier *string `type:"string"`
// The DB cluster identifier of the DB cluster to be described. This parameter
// is stored as a lowercase string.
//
// Constraints:
//
// * Must contain from 1 to 63 alphanumeric characters or hyphens.
//
// * First character must be a letter.
//
// * Can't end with a hyphen or contain two consecutive hyphens.
//
// Example: my-cluster1
//
// DBClusterIdentifier is a required field
DBClusterIdentifier *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
// A filter that specifies one or more DB clusters to describe. Supported filters
// include the following:
//
// * db-cluster-backtrack-id - Accepts backtrack identifiers. The results
// list includes information about only the backtracks identified by these
// identifiers.
//
// * db-cluster-backtrack-status - Accepts any of the following backtrack
// status values:
//
// applying
//
// completed
//
// failed
//
// pending
//
// The results list includes information about only the backtracks identified
// by these values. For more information about backtrack status values, see
// DBClusterBacktrack.
Filters []*Filter `locationNameList:"Filter" type:"list"`
// An optional pagination token provided by a previous DescribeDBClusterBacktracks
// request. If this parameter is specified, the response includes only records
// beyond the marker, up to the value specified by MaxRecords.
Marker *string `type:"string"`
// The maximum number of records to include in the response. If more records
// exist than the specified MaxRecords value, a pagination token called a marker
// is included in the response so that the remaining results can be retrieved.
//
// Default: 100
//
// Constraints: Minimum 20, maximum 100.
MaxRecords *int64 `type:"integer"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s DescribeDBClusterBacktracksInput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s DescribeDBClusterBacktracksInput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
func (s *DescribeDBClusterBacktracksInput) Validate() error {
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "DescribeDBClusterBacktracksInput"}
if s.DBClusterIdentifier == nil {
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("DBClusterIdentifier"))
}
if s.Filters != nil {
for i, v := range s.Filters {
if v == nil {
continue
}
if err := v.Validate(); err != nil {
invalidParams.AddNested(fmt.Sprintf("%s[%v]", "Filters", i), err.(request.ErrInvalidParams))
}
}
}
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
return invalidParams
}
return nil
}
// SetBacktrackIdentifier sets the BacktrackIdentifier field's value.
func (s *DescribeDBClusterBacktracksInput) SetBacktrackIdentifier(v string) *DescribeDBClusterBacktracksInput {
s.BacktrackIdentifier = &v
return s
}
// SetDBClusterIdentifier sets the DBClusterIdentifier field's value.
func (s *DescribeDBClusterBacktracksInput) SetDBClusterIdentifier(v string) *DescribeDBClusterBacktracksInput {
s.DBClusterIdentifier = &v
return s
}
// SetFilters sets the Filters field's value.
func (s *DescribeDBClusterBacktracksInput) SetFilters(v []*Filter) *DescribeDBClusterBacktracksInput {
s.Filters = v
return s
}
// SetMarker sets the Marker field's value.
func (s *DescribeDBClusterBacktracksInput) SetMarker(v string) *DescribeDBClusterBacktracksInput {
s.Marker = &v
return s
}
// SetMaxRecords sets the MaxRecords field's value.
func (s *DescribeDBClusterBacktracksInput) SetMaxRecords(v int64) *DescribeDBClusterBacktracksInput {
s.MaxRecords = &v
return s
}
// Contains the result of a successful invocation of the DescribeDBClusterBacktracks
// action.
type DescribeDBClusterBacktracksOutput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// Contains a list of backtracks for the user.
DBClusterBacktracks []*BacktrackDBClusterOutput `locationNameList:"DBClusterBacktrack" type:"list"`
// A pagination token that can be used in a subsequent DescribeDBClusterBacktracks
// request.
Marker *string `type:"string"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s DescribeDBClusterBacktracksOutput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s DescribeDBClusterBacktracksOutput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetDBClusterBacktracks sets the DBClusterBacktracks field's value.
func (s *DescribeDBClusterBacktracksOutput) SetDBClusterBacktracks(v []*BacktrackDBClusterOutput) *DescribeDBClusterBacktracksOutput {
s.DBClusterBacktracks = v
return s
}
// SetMarker sets the Marker field's value.
func (s *DescribeDBClusterBacktracksOutput) SetMarker(v string) *DescribeDBClusterBacktracksOutput {
s.Marker = &v
return s
}
type DescribeDBClusterEndpointsInput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// The identifier of the endpoint to describe. This parameter is stored as a
// lowercase string.
DBClusterEndpointIdentifier *string `type:"string"`
// The DB cluster identifier of the DB cluster associated with the endpoint.
// This parameter is stored as a lowercase string.
DBClusterIdentifier *string `type:"string"`
// A set of name-value pairs that define which endpoints to include in the output.
// The filters are specified as name-value pairs, in the format Name=endpoint_type,Values=endpoint_type1,endpoint_type2,....
// Name can be one of: db-cluster-endpoint-type, db-cluster-endpoint-custom-type,
// db-cluster-endpoint-id, db-cluster-endpoint-status. Values for the db-cluster-endpoint-type
// filter can be one or more of: reader, writer, custom. Values for the db-cluster-endpoint-custom-type
// filter can be one or more of: reader, any. Values for the db-cluster-endpoint-status
// filter can be one or more of: available, creating, deleting, modifying.
Filters []*Filter `locationNameList:"Filter" type:"list"`
// An optional pagination token provided by a previous DescribeDBClusterEndpoints
// request. If this parameter is specified, the response includes only records
// beyond the marker, up to the value specified by MaxRecords.
Marker *string `type:"string"`
// The maximum number of records to include in the response. If more records
// exist than the specified MaxRecords value, a pagination token called a marker
// is included in the response so that the remaining results can be retrieved.
//
// Default: 100
//
// Constraints: Minimum 20, maximum 100.
MaxRecords *int64 `type:"integer"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s DescribeDBClusterEndpointsInput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s DescribeDBClusterEndpointsInput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
func (s *DescribeDBClusterEndpointsInput) Validate() error {
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "DescribeDBClusterEndpointsInput"}
if s.Filters != nil {
for i, v := range s.Filters {
if v == nil {
continue
}
if err := v.Validate(); err != nil {
invalidParams.AddNested(fmt.Sprintf("%s[%v]", "Filters", i), err.(request.ErrInvalidParams))
}
}
}
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
return invalidParams
}
return nil
}
// SetDBClusterEndpointIdentifier sets the DBClusterEndpointIdentifier field's value.
func (s *DescribeDBClusterEndpointsInput) SetDBClusterEndpointIdentifier(v string) *DescribeDBClusterEndpointsInput {
s.DBClusterEndpointIdentifier = &v
return s
}
// SetDBClusterIdentifier sets the DBClusterIdentifier field's value.
func (s *DescribeDBClusterEndpointsInput) SetDBClusterIdentifier(v string) *DescribeDBClusterEndpointsInput {
s.DBClusterIdentifier = &v
return s
}
// SetFilters sets the Filters field's value.
func (s *DescribeDBClusterEndpointsInput) SetFilters(v []*Filter) *DescribeDBClusterEndpointsInput {
s.Filters = v
return s
}
// SetMarker sets the Marker field's value.
func (s *DescribeDBClusterEndpointsInput) SetMarker(v string) *DescribeDBClusterEndpointsInput {
s.Marker = &v
return s
}
// SetMaxRecords sets the MaxRecords field's value.
func (s *DescribeDBClusterEndpointsInput) SetMaxRecords(v int64) *DescribeDBClusterEndpointsInput {
s.MaxRecords = &v
return s
}
type DescribeDBClusterEndpointsOutput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// Contains the details of the endpoints associated with the cluster and matching
// any filter conditions.
DBClusterEndpoints []*DBClusterEndpoint `locationNameList:"DBClusterEndpointList" type:"list"`
// An optional pagination token provided by a previous DescribeDBClusterEndpoints
// request. If this parameter is specified, the response includes only records
// beyond the marker, up to the value specified by MaxRecords.
Marker *string `type:"string"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s DescribeDBClusterEndpointsOutput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s DescribeDBClusterEndpointsOutput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetDBClusterEndpoints sets the DBClusterEndpoints field's value.
func (s *DescribeDBClusterEndpointsOutput) SetDBClusterEndpoints(v []*DBClusterEndpoint) *DescribeDBClusterEndpointsOutput {
s.DBClusterEndpoints = v
return s
}
// SetMarker sets the Marker field's value.
func (s *DescribeDBClusterEndpointsOutput) SetMarker(v string) *DescribeDBClusterEndpointsOutput {
s.Marker = &v
return s
}
type DescribeDBClusterParameterGroupsInput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// The name of a specific DB cluster parameter group to return details for.
//
// Constraints:
//
// * If supplied, must match the name of an existing DBClusterParameterGroup.
DBClusterParameterGroupName *string `type:"string"`
// This parameter is not currently supported.
Filters []*Filter `locationNameList:"Filter" type:"list"`
// An optional pagination token provided by a previous DescribeDBClusterParameterGroups
// request. If this parameter is specified, the response includes only records
// beyond the marker, up to the value specified by MaxRecords.
Marker *string `type:"string"`
// The maximum number of records to include in the response. If more records
// exist than the specified MaxRecords value, a pagination token called a marker
// is included in the response so that the remaining results can be retrieved.
//
// Default: 100
//
// Constraints: Minimum 20, maximum 100.
MaxRecords *int64 `type:"integer"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s DescribeDBClusterParameterGroupsInput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s DescribeDBClusterParameterGroupsInput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
func (s *DescribeDBClusterParameterGroupsInput) Validate() error {
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "DescribeDBClusterParameterGroupsInput"}
if s.Filters != nil {
for i, v := range s.Filters {
if v == nil {
continue
}
if err := v.Validate(); err != nil {
invalidParams.AddNested(fmt.Sprintf("%s[%v]", "Filters", i), err.(request.ErrInvalidParams))
}
}
}
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
return invalidParams
}
return nil
}
// SetDBClusterParameterGroupName sets the DBClusterParameterGroupName field's value.
func (s *DescribeDBClusterParameterGroupsInput) SetDBClusterParameterGroupName(v string) *DescribeDBClusterParameterGroupsInput {
s.DBClusterParameterGroupName = &v
return s
}
// SetFilters sets the Filters field's value.
func (s *DescribeDBClusterParameterGroupsInput) SetFilters(v []*Filter) *DescribeDBClusterParameterGroupsInput {
s.Filters = v
return s
}
// SetMarker sets the Marker field's value.
func (s *DescribeDBClusterParameterGroupsInput) SetMarker(v string) *DescribeDBClusterParameterGroupsInput {
s.Marker = &v
return s
}
// SetMaxRecords sets the MaxRecords field's value.
func (s *DescribeDBClusterParameterGroupsInput) SetMaxRecords(v int64) *DescribeDBClusterParameterGroupsInput {
s.MaxRecords = &v
return s
}
type DescribeDBClusterParameterGroupsOutput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// A list of DB cluster parameter groups.
DBClusterParameterGroups []*DBClusterParameterGroup `locationNameList:"DBClusterParameterGroup" type:"list"`
// An optional pagination token provided by a previous DescribeDBClusterParameterGroups
// request. If this parameter is specified, the response includes only records
// beyond the marker, up to the value specified by MaxRecords.
Marker *string `type:"string"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s DescribeDBClusterParameterGroupsOutput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s DescribeDBClusterParameterGroupsOutput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetDBClusterParameterGroups sets the DBClusterParameterGroups field's value.
func (s *DescribeDBClusterParameterGroupsOutput) SetDBClusterParameterGroups(v []*DBClusterParameterGroup) *DescribeDBClusterParameterGroupsOutput {
s.DBClusterParameterGroups = v
return s
}
// SetMarker sets the Marker field's value.
func (s *DescribeDBClusterParameterGroupsOutput) SetMarker(v string) *DescribeDBClusterParameterGroupsOutput {
s.Marker = &v
return s
}
type DescribeDBClusterParametersInput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// The name of a specific DB cluster parameter group to return parameter details
// for.
//
// Constraints:
//
// * If supplied, must match the name of an existing DBClusterParameterGroup.
//
// DBClusterParameterGroupName is a required field
DBClusterParameterGroupName *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
// This parameter is not currently supported.
Filters []*Filter `locationNameList:"Filter" type:"list"`
// An optional pagination token provided by a previous DescribeDBClusterParameters
// request. If this parameter is specified, the response includes only records
// beyond the marker, up to the value specified by MaxRecords.
Marker *string `type:"string"`
// The maximum number of records to include in the response. If more records
// exist than the specified MaxRecords value, a pagination token called a marker
// is included in the response so that the remaining results can be retrieved.
//
// Default: 100
//
// Constraints: Minimum 20, maximum 100.
MaxRecords *int64 `type:"integer"`
// A value that indicates to return only parameters for a specific source. Parameter
// sources can be engine, service, or customer.
Source *string `type:"string"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s DescribeDBClusterParametersInput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s DescribeDBClusterParametersInput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
func (s *DescribeDBClusterParametersInput) Validate() error {
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "DescribeDBClusterParametersInput"}
if s.DBClusterParameterGroupName == nil {
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("DBClusterParameterGroupName"))
}
if s.Filters != nil {
for i, v := range s.Filters {
if v == nil {
continue
}
if err := v.Validate(); err != nil {
invalidParams.AddNested(fmt.Sprintf("%s[%v]", "Filters", i), err.(request.ErrInvalidParams))
}
}
}
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
return invalidParams
}
return nil
}
// SetDBClusterParameterGroupName sets the DBClusterParameterGroupName field's value.
func (s *DescribeDBClusterParametersInput) SetDBClusterParameterGroupName(v string) *DescribeDBClusterParametersInput {
s.DBClusterParameterGroupName = &v
return s
}
// SetFilters sets the Filters field's value.
func (s *DescribeDBClusterParametersInput) SetFilters(v []*Filter) *DescribeDBClusterParametersInput {
s.Filters = v
return s
}
// SetMarker sets the Marker field's value.
func (s *DescribeDBClusterParametersInput) SetMarker(v string) *DescribeDBClusterParametersInput {
s.Marker = &v
return s
}
// SetMaxRecords sets the MaxRecords field's value.
func (s *DescribeDBClusterParametersInput) SetMaxRecords(v int64) *DescribeDBClusterParametersInput {
s.MaxRecords = &v
return s
}
// SetSource sets the Source field's value.
func (s *DescribeDBClusterParametersInput) SetSource(v string) *DescribeDBClusterParametersInput {
s.Source = &v
return s
}
// Provides details about a DB cluster parameter group including the parameters
// in the DB cluster parameter group.
type DescribeDBClusterParametersOutput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// An optional pagination token provided by a previous DescribeDBClusterParameters
// request. If this parameter is specified, the response includes only records
// beyond the marker, up to the value specified by MaxRecords .
Marker *string `type:"string"`
// Provides a list of parameters for the DB cluster parameter group.
Parameters []*Parameter `locationNameList:"Parameter" type:"list"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s DescribeDBClusterParametersOutput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s DescribeDBClusterParametersOutput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetMarker sets the Marker field's value.
func (s *DescribeDBClusterParametersOutput) SetMarker(v string) *DescribeDBClusterParametersOutput {
s.Marker = &v
return s
}
// SetParameters sets the Parameters field's value.
func (s *DescribeDBClusterParametersOutput) SetParameters(v []*Parameter) *DescribeDBClusterParametersOutput {
s.Parameters = v
return s
}
type DescribeDBClusterSnapshotAttributesInput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// The identifier for the DB cluster snapshot to describe the attributes for.
//
// DBClusterSnapshotIdentifier is a required field
DBClusterSnapshotIdentifier *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s DescribeDBClusterSnapshotAttributesInput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s DescribeDBClusterSnapshotAttributesInput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
func (s *DescribeDBClusterSnapshotAttributesInput) Validate() error {
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "DescribeDBClusterSnapshotAttributesInput"}
if s.DBClusterSnapshotIdentifier == nil {
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("DBClusterSnapshotIdentifier"))
}
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
return invalidParams
}
return nil
}
// SetDBClusterSnapshotIdentifier sets the DBClusterSnapshotIdentifier field's value.
func (s *DescribeDBClusterSnapshotAttributesInput) SetDBClusterSnapshotIdentifier(v string) *DescribeDBClusterSnapshotAttributesInput {
s.DBClusterSnapshotIdentifier = &v
return s
}
type DescribeDBClusterSnapshotAttributesOutput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// Contains the results of a successful call to the DescribeDBClusterSnapshotAttributes
// API action.
//
// Manual DB cluster snapshot attributes are used to authorize other AWS accounts
// to copy or restore a manual DB cluster snapshot. For more information, see
// the ModifyDBClusterSnapshotAttribute API action.
DBClusterSnapshotAttributesResult *DBClusterSnapshotAttributesResult `type:"structure"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s DescribeDBClusterSnapshotAttributesOutput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s DescribeDBClusterSnapshotAttributesOutput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetDBClusterSnapshotAttributesResult sets the DBClusterSnapshotAttributesResult field's value.
func (s *DescribeDBClusterSnapshotAttributesOutput) SetDBClusterSnapshotAttributesResult(v *DBClusterSnapshotAttributesResult) *DescribeDBClusterSnapshotAttributesOutput {
s.DBClusterSnapshotAttributesResult = v
return s
}
type DescribeDBClusterSnapshotsInput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// The ID of the DB cluster to retrieve the list of DB cluster snapshots for.
// This parameter can't be used in conjunction with the DBClusterSnapshotIdentifier
// parameter. This parameter is not case-sensitive.
//
// Constraints:
//
// * If supplied, must match the identifier of an existing DBCluster.
DBClusterIdentifier *string `type:"string"`
// A specific DB cluster snapshot identifier to describe. This parameter can't
// be used in conjunction with the DBClusterIdentifier parameter. This value
// is stored as a lowercase string.
//
// Constraints:
//
// * If supplied, must match the identifier of an existing DBClusterSnapshot.
//
// * If this identifier is for an automated snapshot, the SnapshotType parameter
// must also be specified.
DBClusterSnapshotIdentifier *string `type:"string"`
// This parameter is not currently supported.
Filters []*Filter `locationNameList:"Filter" type:"list"`
// True to include manual DB cluster snapshots that are public and can be copied
// or restored by any AWS account, and otherwise false. The default is false.
// The default is false.
//
// You can share a manual DB cluster snapshot as public by using the ModifyDBClusterSnapshotAttribute
// API action.
IncludePublic *bool `type:"boolean"`
// True to include shared manual DB cluster snapshots from other AWS accounts
// that this AWS account has been given permission to copy or restore, and otherwise
// false. The default is false.
//
// You can give an AWS account permission to restore a manual DB cluster snapshot
// from another AWS account by the ModifyDBClusterSnapshotAttribute API action.
IncludeShared *bool `type:"boolean"`
// An optional pagination token provided by a previous DescribeDBClusterSnapshots
// request. If this parameter is specified, the response includes only records
// beyond the marker, up to the value specified by MaxRecords.
Marker *string `type:"string"`
// The maximum number of records to include in the response. If more records
// exist than the specified MaxRecords value, a pagination token called a marker
// is included in the response so that the remaining results can be retrieved.
//
// Default: 100
//
// Constraints: Minimum 20, maximum 100.
MaxRecords *int64 `type:"integer"`
// The type of DB cluster snapshots to be returned. You can specify one of the
// following values:
//
// * automated - Return all DB cluster snapshots that have been automatically
// taken by Amazon RDS for my AWS account.
//
// * manual - Return all DB cluster snapshots that have been taken by my
// AWS account.
//
// * shared - Return all manual DB cluster snapshots that have been shared
// to my AWS account.
//
// * public - Return all DB cluster snapshots that have been marked as public.
//
// If you don't specify a SnapshotType value, then both automated and manual
// DB cluster snapshots are returned. You can include shared DB cluster snapshots
// with these results by setting the IncludeShared parameter to true. You can
// include public DB cluster snapshots with these results by setting the IncludePublic
// parameter to true.
//
// The IncludeShared and IncludePublic parameters don't apply for SnapshotType
// values of manual or automated. The IncludePublic parameter doesn't apply
// when SnapshotType is set to shared. The IncludeShared parameter doesn't apply
// when SnapshotType is set to public.
SnapshotType *string `type:"string"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s DescribeDBClusterSnapshotsInput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s DescribeDBClusterSnapshotsInput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
func (s *DescribeDBClusterSnapshotsInput) Validate() error {
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "DescribeDBClusterSnapshotsInput"}
if s.Filters != nil {
for i, v := range s.Filters {
if v == nil {
continue
}
if err := v.Validate(); err != nil {
invalidParams.AddNested(fmt.Sprintf("%s[%v]", "Filters", i), err.(request.ErrInvalidParams))
}
}
}
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
return invalidParams
}
return nil
}
// SetDBClusterIdentifier sets the DBClusterIdentifier field's value.
func (s *DescribeDBClusterSnapshotsInput) SetDBClusterIdentifier(v string) *DescribeDBClusterSnapshotsInput {
s.DBClusterIdentifier = &v
return s
}
// SetDBClusterSnapshotIdentifier sets the DBClusterSnapshotIdentifier field's value.
func (s *DescribeDBClusterSnapshotsInput) SetDBClusterSnapshotIdentifier(v string) *DescribeDBClusterSnapshotsInput {
s.DBClusterSnapshotIdentifier = &v
return s
}
// SetFilters sets the Filters field's value.
func (s *DescribeDBClusterSnapshotsInput) SetFilters(v []*Filter) *DescribeDBClusterSnapshotsInput {
s.Filters = v
return s
}
// SetIncludePublic sets the IncludePublic field's value.
func (s *DescribeDBClusterSnapshotsInput) SetIncludePublic(v bool) *DescribeDBClusterSnapshotsInput {
s.IncludePublic = &v
return s
}
// SetIncludeShared sets the IncludeShared field's value.
func (s *DescribeDBClusterSnapshotsInput) SetIncludeShared(v bool) *DescribeDBClusterSnapshotsInput {
s.IncludeShared = &v
return s
}
// SetMarker sets the Marker field's value.
func (s *DescribeDBClusterSnapshotsInput) SetMarker(v string) *DescribeDBClusterSnapshotsInput {
s.Marker = &v
return s
}
// SetMaxRecords sets the MaxRecords field's value.
func (s *DescribeDBClusterSnapshotsInput) SetMaxRecords(v int64) *DescribeDBClusterSnapshotsInput {
s.MaxRecords = &v
return s
}
// SetSnapshotType sets the SnapshotType field's value.
func (s *DescribeDBClusterSnapshotsInput) SetSnapshotType(v string) *DescribeDBClusterSnapshotsInput {
s.SnapshotType = &v
return s
}
// Provides a list of DB cluster snapshots for the user as the result of a call
// to the DescribeDBClusterSnapshots action.
type DescribeDBClusterSnapshotsOutput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// Provides a list of DB cluster snapshots for the user.
DBClusterSnapshots []*DBClusterSnapshot `locationNameList:"DBClusterSnapshot" type:"list"`
// An optional pagination token provided by a previous DescribeDBClusterSnapshots
// request. If this parameter is specified, the response includes only records
// beyond the marker, up to the value specified by MaxRecords.
Marker *string `type:"string"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s DescribeDBClusterSnapshotsOutput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s DescribeDBClusterSnapshotsOutput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetDBClusterSnapshots sets the DBClusterSnapshots field's value.
func (s *DescribeDBClusterSnapshotsOutput) SetDBClusterSnapshots(v []*DBClusterSnapshot) *DescribeDBClusterSnapshotsOutput {
s.DBClusterSnapshots = v
return s
}
// SetMarker sets the Marker field's value.
func (s *DescribeDBClusterSnapshotsOutput) SetMarker(v string) *DescribeDBClusterSnapshotsOutput {
s.Marker = &v
return s
}
type DescribeDBClustersInput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// The user-supplied DB cluster identifier. If this parameter is specified,
// information from only the specific DB cluster is returned. This parameter
// isn't case-sensitive.
//
// Constraints:
//
// * If supplied, must match an existing DBClusterIdentifier.
DBClusterIdentifier *string `type:"string"`
// A filter that specifies one or more DB clusters to describe.
//
// Supported filters:
//
// * db-cluster-id - Accepts DB cluster identifiers and DB cluster Amazon
// Resource Names (ARNs). The results list will only include information
// about the DB clusters identified by these ARNs.
Filters []*Filter `locationNameList:"Filter" type:"list"`
// An optional pagination token provided by a previous DescribeDBClusters request.
// If this parameter is specified, the response includes only records beyond
// the marker, up to the value specified by MaxRecords.
Marker *string `type:"string"`
// The maximum number of records to include in the response. If more records
// exist than the specified MaxRecords value, a pagination token called a marker
// is included in the response so that the remaining results can be retrieved.
//
// Default: 100
//
// Constraints: Minimum 20, maximum 100.
MaxRecords *int64 `type:"integer"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s DescribeDBClustersInput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s DescribeDBClustersInput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
func (s *DescribeDBClustersInput) Validate() error {
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "DescribeDBClustersInput"}
if s.Filters != nil {
for i, v := range s.Filters {
if v == nil {
continue
}
if err := v.Validate(); err != nil {
invalidParams.AddNested(fmt.Sprintf("%s[%v]", "Filters", i), err.(request.ErrInvalidParams))
}
}
}
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
return invalidParams
}
return nil
}
// SetDBClusterIdentifier sets the DBClusterIdentifier field's value.
func (s *DescribeDBClustersInput) SetDBClusterIdentifier(v string) *DescribeDBClustersInput {
s.DBClusterIdentifier = &v
return s
}
// SetFilters sets the Filters field's value.
func (s *DescribeDBClustersInput) SetFilters(v []*Filter) *DescribeDBClustersInput {
s.Filters = v
return s
}
// SetMarker sets the Marker field's value.
func (s *DescribeDBClustersInput) SetMarker(v string) *DescribeDBClustersInput {
s.Marker = &v
return s
}
// SetMaxRecords sets the MaxRecords field's value.
func (s *DescribeDBClustersInput) SetMaxRecords(v int64) *DescribeDBClustersInput {
s.MaxRecords = &v
return s
}
// Contains the result of a successful invocation of the DescribeDBClusters
// action.
type DescribeDBClustersOutput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// Contains a list of DB clusters for the user.
DBClusters []*DBCluster `locationNameList:"DBCluster" type:"list"`
// A pagination token that can be used in a subsequent DescribeDBClusters request.
Marker *string `type:"string"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s DescribeDBClustersOutput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s DescribeDBClustersOutput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetDBClusters sets the DBClusters field's value.
func (s *DescribeDBClustersOutput) SetDBClusters(v []*DBCluster) *DescribeDBClustersOutput {
s.DBClusters = v
return s
}
// SetMarker sets the Marker field's value.
func (s *DescribeDBClustersOutput) SetMarker(v string) *DescribeDBClustersOutput {
s.Marker = &v
return s
}
type DescribeDBEngineVersionsInput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// The name of a specific DB parameter group family to return details for.
//
// Constraints:
//
// * If supplied, must match an existing DBParameterGroupFamily.
DBParameterGroupFamily *string `type:"string"`
// Indicates that only the default version of the specified engine or engine
// and major version combination is returned.
DefaultOnly *bool `type:"boolean"`
// The database engine to return.
Engine *string `type:"string"`
// The database engine version to return.
//
// Example: 5.1.49
EngineVersion *string `type:"string"`
// This parameter is not currently supported.
Filters []*Filter `locationNameList:"Filter" type:"list"`
// If this parameter is specified and the requested engine supports the CharacterSetName
// parameter for CreateDBInstance, the response includes a list of supported
// character sets for each engine version.
ListSupportedCharacterSets *bool `type:"boolean"`
// If this parameter is specified and the requested engine supports the TimeZone
// parameter for CreateDBInstance, the response includes a list of supported
// time zones for each engine version.
ListSupportedTimezones *bool `type:"boolean"`
// An optional pagination token provided by a previous request. If this parameter
// is specified, the response includes only records beyond the marker, up to
// the value specified by MaxRecords.
Marker *string `type:"string"`
// The maximum number of records to include in the response. If more than the
// MaxRecords value is available, a pagination token called a marker is included
// in the response so that the following results can be retrieved.
//
// Default: 100
//
// Constraints: Minimum 20, maximum 100.
MaxRecords *int64 `type:"integer"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s DescribeDBEngineVersionsInput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s DescribeDBEngineVersionsInput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
func (s *DescribeDBEngineVersionsInput) Validate() error {
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "DescribeDBEngineVersionsInput"}
if s.Filters != nil {
for i, v := range s.Filters {
if v == nil {
continue
}
if err := v.Validate(); err != nil {
invalidParams.AddNested(fmt.Sprintf("%s[%v]", "Filters", i), err.(request.ErrInvalidParams))
}
}
}
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
return invalidParams
}
return nil
}
// SetDBParameterGroupFamily sets the DBParameterGroupFamily field's value.
func (s *DescribeDBEngineVersionsInput) SetDBParameterGroupFamily(v string) *DescribeDBEngineVersionsInput {
s.DBParameterGroupFamily = &v
return s
}
// SetDefaultOnly sets the DefaultOnly field's value.
func (s *DescribeDBEngineVersionsInput) SetDefaultOnly(v bool) *DescribeDBEngineVersionsInput {
s.DefaultOnly = &v
return s
}
// SetEngine sets the Engine field's value.
func (s *DescribeDBEngineVersionsInput) SetEngine(v string) *DescribeDBEngineVersionsInput {
s.Engine = &v
return s
}
// SetEngineVersion sets the EngineVersion field's value.
func (s *DescribeDBEngineVersionsInput) SetEngineVersion(v string) *DescribeDBEngineVersionsInput {
s.EngineVersion = &v
return s
}
// SetFilters sets the Filters field's value.
func (s *DescribeDBEngineVersionsInput) SetFilters(v []*Filter) *DescribeDBEngineVersionsInput {
s.Filters = v
return s
}
// SetListSupportedCharacterSets sets the ListSupportedCharacterSets field's value.
func (s *DescribeDBEngineVersionsInput) SetListSupportedCharacterSets(v bool) *DescribeDBEngineVersionsInput {
s.ListSupportedCharacterSets = &v
return s
}
// SetListSupportedTimezones sets the ListSupportedTimezones field's value.
func (s *DescribeDBEngineVersionsInput) SetListSupportedTimezones(v bool) *DescribeDBEngineVersionsInput {
s.ListSupportedTimezones = &v
return s
}
// SetMarker sets the Marker field's value.
func (s *DescribeDBEngineVersionsInput) SetMarker(v string) *DescribeDBEngineVersionsInput {
s.Marker = &v
return s
}
// SetMaxRecords sets the MaxRecords field's value.
func (s *DescribeDBEngineVersionsInput) SetMaxRecords(v int64) *DescribeDBEngineVersionsInput {
s.MaxRecords = &v
return s
}
// Contains the result of a successful invocation of the DescribeDBEngineVersions
// action.
type DescribeDBEngineVersionsOutput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// A list of DBEngineVersion elements.
DBEngineVersions []*DBEngineVersion `locationNameList:"DBEngineVersion" type:"list"`
// An optional pagination token provided by a previous request. If this parameter
// is specified, the response includes only records beyond the marker, up to
// the value specified by MaxRecords.
Marker *string `type:"string"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s DescribeDBEngineVersionsOutput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s DescribeDBEngineVersionsOutput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetDBEngineVersions sets the DBEngineVersions field's value.
func (s *DescribeDBEngineVersionsOutput) SetDBEngineVersions(v []*DBEngineVersion) *DescribeDBEngineVersionsOutput {
s.DBEngineVersions = v
return s
}
// SetMarker sets the Marker field's value.
func (s *DescribeDBEngineVersionsOutput) SetMarker(v string) *DescribeDBEngineVersionsOutput {
s.Marker = &v
return s
}
// Parameter input for DescribeDBInstanceAutomatedBackups.
type DescribeDBInstanceAutomatedBackupsInput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// (Optional) The user-supplied instance identifier. If this parameter is specified,
// it must match the identifier of an existing DB instance. It returns information
// from the specific DB instance' automated backup. This parameter isn't case-sensitive.
DBInstanceIdentifier *string `type:"string"`
// The resource ID of the DB instance that is the source of the automated backup.
// This parameter isn't case-sensitive.
DbiResourceId *string `type:"string"`
// A filter that specifies which resources to return based on status.
//
// Supported filters are the following:
//
// * status
//
// active - automated backups for current instances
//
// retained - automated backups for deleted instances
//
// creating - automated backups that are waiting for the first automated snapshot
// to be available
//
// * db-instance-id - Accepts DB instance identifiers and Amazon Resource
// Names (ARNs) for DB instances. The results list includes only information
// about the DB instance automated backupss identified by these ARNs.
//
// * dbi-resource-id - Accepts DB instance resource identifiers and DB Amazon
// Resource Names (ARNs) for DB instances. The results list includes only
// information about the DB instance resources identified by these ARNs.
//
// Returns all resources by default. The status for each resource is specified
// in the response.
Filters []*Filter `locationNameList:"Filter" type:"list"`
// The pagination token provided in the previous request. If this parameter
// is specified the response includes only records beyond the marker, up to
// MaxRecords.
Marker *string `type:"string"`
// The maximum number of records to include in the response. If more records
// exist than the specified MaxRecords value, a pagination token called a marker
// is included in the response so that the remaining results can be retrieved.
MaxRecords *int64 `type:"integer"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s DescribeDBInstanceAutomatedBackupsInput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s DescribeDBInstanceAutomatedBackupsInput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
func (s *DescribeDBInstanceAutomatedBackupsInput) Validate() error {
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "DescribeDBInstanceAutomatedBackupsInput"}
if s.Filters != nil {
for i, v := range s.Filters {
if v == nil {
continue
}
if err := v.Validate(); err != nil {
invalidParams.AddNested(fmt.Sprintf("%s[%v]", "Filters", i), err.(request.ErrInvalidParams))
}
}
}
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
return invalidParams
}
return nil
}
// SetDBInstanceIdentifier sets the DBInstanceIdentifier field's value.
func (s *DescribeDBInstanceAutomatedBackupsInput) SetDBInstanceIdentifier(v string) *DescribeDBInstanceAutomatedBackupsInput {
s.DBInstanceIdentifier = &v
return s
}
// SetDbiResourceId sets the DbiResourceId field's value.
func (s *DescribeDBInstanceAutomatedBackupsInput) SetDbiResourceId(v string) *DescribeDBInstanceAutomatedBackupsInput {
s.DbiResourceId = &v
return s
}
// SetFilters sets the Filters field's value.
func (s *DescribeDBInstanceAutomatedBackupsInput) SetFilters(v []*Filter) *DescribeDBInstanceAutomatedBackupsInput {
s.Filters = v
return s
}
// SetMarker sets the Marker field's value.
func (s *DescribeDBInstanceAutomatedBackupsInput) SetMarker(v string) *DescribeDBInstanceAutomatedBackupsInput {
s.Marker = &v
return s
}
// SetMaxRecords sets the MaxRecords field's value.
func (s *DescribeDBInstanceAutomatedBackupsInput) SetMaxRecords(v int64) *DescribeDBInstanceAutomatedBackupsInput {
s.MaxRecords = &v
return s
}
// Contains the result of a successful invocation of the DescribeDBInstanceAutomatedBackups
// action.
type DescribeDBInstanceAutomatedBackupsOutput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// A list of DBInstanceAutomatedBackup instances.
DBInstanceAutomatedBackups []*DBInstanceAutomatedBackup `locationNameList:"DBInstanceAutomatedBackup" type:"list"`
// An optional pagination token provided by a previous request. If this parameter
// is specified, the response includes only records beyond the marker, up to
// the value specified by MaxRecords .
Marker *string `type:"string"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s DescribeDBInstanceAutomatedBackupsOutput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s DescribeDBInstanceAutomatedBackupsOutput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetDBInstanceAutomatedBackups sets the DBInstanceAutomatedBackups field's value.
func (s *DescribeDBInstanceAutomatedBackupsOutput) SetDBInstanceAutomatedBackups(v []*DBInstanceAutomatedBackup) *DescribeDBInstanceAutomatedBackupsOutput {
s.DBInstanceAutomatedBackups = v
return s
}
// SetMarker sets the Marker field's value.
func (s *DescribeDBInstanceAutomatedBackupsOutput) SetMarker(v string) *DescribeDBInstanceAutomatedBackupsOutput {
s.Marker = &v
return s
}
type DescribeDBInstancesInput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// The user-supplied instance identifier. If this parameter is specified, information
// from only the specific DB instance is returned. This parameter isn't case-sensitive.
//
// Constraints:
//
// * If supplied, must match the identifier of an existing DBInstance.
DBInstanceIdentifier *string `type:"string"`
// A filter that specifies one or more DB instances to describe.
//
// Supported filters:
//
// * db-cluster-id - Accepts DB cluster identifiers and DB cluster Amazon
// Resource Names (ARNs). The results list will only include information
// about the DB instances associated with the DB clusters identified by these
// ARNs.
//
// * db-instance-id - Accepts DB instance identifiers and DB instance Amazon
// Resource Names (ARNs). The results list will only include information
// about the DB instances identified by these ARNs.
Filters []*Filter `locationNameList:"Filter" type:"list"`
// An optional pagination token provided by a previous DescribeDBInstances request.
// If this parameter is specified, the response includes only records beyond
// the marker, up to the value specified by MaxRecords.
Marker *string `type:"string"`
// The maximum number of records to include in the response. If more records
// exist than the specified MaxRecords value, a pagination token called a marker
// is included in the response so that the remaining results can be retrieved.
//
// Default: 100
//
// Constraints: Minimum 20, maximum 100.
MaxRecords *int64 `type:"integer"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s DescribeDBInstancesInput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s DescribeDBInstancesInput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
func (s *DescribeDBInstancesInput) Validate() error {
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "DescribeDBInstancesInput"}
if s.Filters != nil {
for i, v := range s.Filters {
if v == nil {
continue
}
if err := v.Validate(); err != nil {
invalidParams.AddNested(fmt.Sprintf("%s[%v]", "Filters", i), err.(request.ErrInvalidParams))
}
}
}
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
return invalidParams
}
return nil
}
// SetDBInstanceIdentifier sets the DBInstanceIdentifier field's value.
func (s *DescribeDBInstancesInput) SetDBInstanceIdentifier(v string) *DescribeDBInstancesInput {
s.DBInstanceIdentifier = &v
return s
}
// SetFilters sets the Filters field's value.
func (s *DescribeDBInstancesInput) SetFilters(v []*Filter) *DescribeDBInstancesInput {
s.Filters = v
return s
}
// SetMarker sets the Marker field's value.
func (s *DescribeDBInstancesInput) SetMarker(v string) *DescribeDBInstancesInput {
s.Marker = &v
return s
}
// SetMaxRecords sets the MaxRecords field's value.
func (s *DescribeDBInstancesInput) SetMaxRecords(v int64) *DescribeDBInstancesInput {
s.MaxRecords = &v
return s
}
// Contains the result of a successful invocation of the DescribeDBInstances
// action.
type DescribeDBInstancesOutput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// A list of DBInstance instances.
DBInstances []*DBInstance `locationNameList:"DBInstance" type:"list"`
// An optional pagination token provided by a previous request. If this parameter
// is specified, the response includes only records beyond the marker, up to
// the value specified by MaxRecords .
Marker *string `type:"string"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s DescribeDBInstancesOutput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s DescribeDBInstancesOutput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetDBInstances sets the DBInstances field's value.
func (s *DescribeDBInstancesOutput) SetDBInstances(v []*DBInstance) *DescribeDBInstancesOutput {
s.DBInstances = v
return s
}
// SetMarker sets the Marker field's value.
func (s *DescribeDBInstancesOutput) SetMarker(v string) *DescribeDBInstancesOutput {
s.Marker = &v
return s
}
// This data type is used as a response element to DescribeDBLogFiles.
type DescribeDBLogFilesDetails struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// A POSIX timestamp when the last log entry was written.
LastWritten *int64 `type:"long"`
// The name of the log file for the specified DB instance.
LogFileName *string `type:"string"`
// The size, in bytes, of the log file for the specified DB instance.
Size *int64 `type:"long"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s DescribeDBLogFilesDetails) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s DescribeDBLogFilesDetails) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetLastWritten sets the LastWritten field's value.
func (s *DescribeDBLogFilesDetails) SetLastWritten(v int64) *DescribeDBLogFilesDetails {
s.LastWritten = &v
return s
}
// SetLogFileName sets the LogFileName field's value.
func (s *DescribeDBLogFilesDetails) SetLogFileName(v string) *DescribeDBLogFilesDetails {
s.LogFileName = &v
return s
}
// SetSize sets the Size field's value.
func (s *DescribeDBLogFilesDetails) SetSize(v int64) *DescribeDBLogFilesDetails {
s.Size = &v
return s
}
type DescribeDBLogFilesInput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// The customer-assigned name of the DB instance that contains the log files
// you want to list.
//
// Constraints:
//
// * Must match the identifier of an existing DBInstance.
//
// DBInstanceIdentifier is a required field
DBInstanceIdentifier *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
// Filters the available log files for files written since the specified date,
// in POSIX timestamp format with milliseconds.
FileLastWritten *int64 `type:"long"`
// Filters the available log files for files larger than the specified size.
FileSize *int64 `type:"long"`
// Filters the available log files for log file names that contain the specified
// string.
FilenameContains *string `type:"string"`
// This parameter is not currently supported.
Filters []*Filter `locationNameList:"Filter" type:"list"`
// The pagination token provided in the previous request. If this parameter
// is specified the response includes only records beyond the marker, up to
// MaxRecords.
Marker *string `type:"string"`
// The maximum number of records to include in the response. If more records
// exist than the specified MaxRecords value, a pagination token called a marker
// is included in the response so that the remaining results can be retrieved.
MaxRecords *int64 `type:"integer"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s DescribeDBLogFilesInput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s DescribeDBLogFilesInput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
func (s *DescribeDBLogFilesInput) Validate() error {
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "DescribeDBLogFilesInput"}
if s.DBInstanceIdentifier == nil {
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("DBInstanceIdentifier"))
}
if s.Filters != nil {
for i, v := range s.Filters {
if v == nil {
continue
}
if err := v.Validate(); err != nil {
invalidParams.AddNested(fmt.Sprintf("%s[%v]", "Filters", i), err.(request.ErrInvalidParams))
}
}
}
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
return invalidParams
}
return nil
}
// SetDBInstanceIdentifier sets the DBInstanceIdentifier field's value.
func (s *DescribeDBLogFilesInput) SetDBInstanceIdentifier(v string) *DescribeDBLogFilesInput {
s.DBInstanceIdentifier = &v
return s
}
// SetFileLastWritten sets the FileLastWritten field's value.
func (s *DescribeDBLogFilesInput) SetFileLastWritten(v int64) *DescribeDBLogFilesInput {
s.FileLastWritten = &v
return s
}
// SetFileSize sets the FileSize field's value.
func (s *DescribeDBLogFilesInput) SetFileSize(v int64) *DescribeDBLogFilesInput {
s.FileSize = &v
return s
}
// SetFilenameContains sets the FilenameContains field's value.
func (s *DescribeDBLogFilesInput) SetFilenameContains(v string) *DescribeDBLogFilesInput {
s.FilenameContains = &v
return s
}
// SetFilters sets the Filters field's value.
func (s *DescribeDBLogFilesInput) SetFilters(v []*Filter) *DescribeDBLogFilesInput {
s.Filters = v
return s
}
// SetMarker sets the Marker field's value.
func (s *DescribeDBLogFilesInput) SetMarker(v string) *DescribeDBLogFilesInput {
s.Marker = &v
return s
}
// SetMaxRecords sets the MaxRecords field's value.
func (s *DescribeDBLogFilesInput) SetMaxRecords(v int64) *DescribeDBLogFilesInput {
s.MaxRecords = &v
return s
}
// The response from a call to DescribeDBLogFiles.
type DescribeDBLogFilesOutput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// The DB log files returned.
DescribeDBLogFiles []*DescribeDBLogFilesDetails `locationNameList:"DescribeDBLogFilesDetails" type:"list"`
// A pagination token that can be used in a subsequent DescribeDBLogFiles request.
Marker *string `type:"string"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s DescribeDBLogFilesOutput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s DescribeDBLogFilesOutput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetDescribeDBLogFiles sets the DescribeDBLogFiles field's value.
func (s *DescribeDBLogFilesOutput) SetDescribeDBLogFiles(v []*DescribeDBLogFilesDetails) *DescribeDBLogFilesOutput {
s.DescribeDBLogFiles = v
return s
}
// SetMarker sets the Marker field's value.
func (s *DescribeDBLogFilesOutput) SetMarker(v string) *DescribeDBLogFilesOutput {
s.Marker = &v
return s
}
type DescribeDBParameterGroupsInput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// The name of a specific DB parameter group to return details for.
//
// Constraints:
//
// * If supplied, must match the name of an existing DBClusterParameterGroup.
DBParameterGroupName *string `type:"string"`
// This parameter is not currently supported.
Filters []*Filter `locationNameList:"Filter" type:"list"`
// An optional pagination token provided by a previous DescribeDBParameterGroups
// request. If this parameter is specified, the response includes only records
// beyond the marker, up to the value specified by MaxRecords.
Marker *string `type:"string"`
// The maximum number of records to include in the response. If more records
// exist than the specified MaxRecords value, a pagination token called a marker
// is included in the response so that the remaining results can be retrieved.
//
// Default: 100
//
// Constraints: Minimum 20, maximum 100.
MaxRecords *int64 `type:"integer"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s DescribeDBParameterGroupsInput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s DescribeDBParameterGroupsInput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
func (s *DescribeDBParameterGroupsInput) Validate() error {
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "DescribeDBParameterGroupsInput"}
if s.Filters != nil {
for i, v := range s.Filters {
if v == nil {
continue
}
if err := v.Validate(); err != nil {
invalidParams.AddNested(fmt.Sprintf("%s[%v]", "Filters", i), err.(request.ErrInvalidParams))
}
}
}
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
return invalidParams
}
return nil
}
// SetDBParameterGroupName sets the DBParameterGroupName field's value.
func (s *DescribeDBParameterGroupsInput) SetDBParameterGroupName(v string) *DescribeDBParameterGroupsInput {
s.DBParameterGroupName = &v
return s
}
// SetFilters sets the Filters field's value.
func (s *DescribeDBParameterGroupsInput) SetFilters(v []*Filter) *DescribeDBParameterGroupsInput {
s.Filters = v
return s
}
// SetMarker sets the Marker field's value.
func (s *DescribeDBParameterGroupsInput) SetMarker(v string) *DescribeDBParameterGroupsInput {
s.Marker = &v
return s
}
// SetMaxRecords sets the MaxRecords field's value.
func (s *DescribeDBParameterGroupsInput) SetMaxRecords(v int64) *DescribeDBParameterGroupsInput {
s.MaxRecords = &v
return s
}
// Contains the result of a successful invocation of the DescribeDBParameterGroups
// action.
type DescribeDBParameterGroupsOutput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// A list of DBParameterGroup instances.
DBParameterGroups []*DBParameterGroup `locationNameList:"DBParameterGroup" type:"list"`
// An optional pagination token provided by a previous request. If this parameter
// is specified, the response includes only records beyond the marker, up to
// the value specified by MaxRecords.
Marker *string `type:"string"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s DescribeDBParameterGroupsOutput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s DescribeDBParameterGroupsOutput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetDBParameterGroups sets the DBParameterGroups field's value.
func (s *DescribeDBParameterGroupsOutput) SetDBParameterGroups(v []*DBParameterGroup) *DescribeDBParameterGroupsOutput {
s.DBParameterGroups = v
return s
}
// SetMarker sets the Marker field's value.
func (s *DescribeDBParameterGroupsOutput) SetMarker(v string) *DescribeDBParameterGroupsOutput {
s.Marker = &v
return s
}
type DescribeDBParametersInput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// The name of a specific DB parameter group to return details for.
//
// Constraints:
//
// * If supplied, must match the name of an existing DBParameterGroup.
//
// DBParameterGroupName is a required field
DBParameterGroupName *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
// This parameter is not currently supported.
Filters []*Filter `locationNameList:"Filter" type:"list"`
// An optional pagination token provided by a previous DescribeDBParameters
// request. If this parameter is specified, the response includes only records
// beyond the marker, up to the value specified by MaxRecords.
Marker *string `type:"string"`
// The maximum number of records to include in the response. If more records
// exist than the specified MaxRecords value, a pagination token called a marker
// is included in the response so that the remaining results can be retrieved.
//
// Default: 100
//
// Constraints: Minimum 20, maximum 100.
MaxRecords *int64 `type:"integer"`
// The parameter types to return.
//
// Default: All parameter types returned
//
// Valid Values: user | system | engine-default
Source *string `type:"string"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s DescribeDBParametersInput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s DescribeDBParametersInput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
func (s *DescribeDBParametersInput) Validate() error {
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "DescribeDBParametersInput"}
if s.DBParameterGroupName == nil {
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("DBParameterGroupName"))
}
if s.Filters != nil {
for i, v := range s.Filters {
if v == nil {
continue
}
if err := v.Validate(); err != nil {
invalidParams.AddNested(fmt.Sprintf("%s[%v]", "Filters", i), err.(request.ErrInvalidParams))
}
}
}
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
return invalidParams
}
return nil
}
// SetDBParameterGroupName sets the DBParameterGroupName field's value.
func (s *DescribeDBParametersInput) SetDBParameterGroupName(v string) *DescribeDBParametersInput {
s.DBParameterGroupName = &v
return s
}
// SetFilters sets the Filters field's value.
func (s *DescribeDBParametersInput) SetFilters(v []*Filter) *DescribeDBParametersInput {
s.Filters = v
return s
}
// SetMarker sets the Marker field's value.
func (s *DescribeDBParametersInput) SetMarker(v string) *DescribeDBParametersInput {
s.Marker = &v
return s
}
// SetMaxRecords sets the MaxRecords field's value.
func (s *DescribeDBParametersInput) SetMaxRecords(v int64) *DescribeDBParametersInput {
s.MaxRecords = &v
return s
}
// SetSource sets the Source field's value.
func (s *DescribeDBParametersInput) SetSource(v string) *DescribeDBParametersInput {
s.Source = &v
return s
}
// Contains the result of a successful invocation of the DescribeDBParameters
// action.
type DescribeDBParametersOutput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// An optional pagination token provided by a previous request. If this parameter
// is specified, the response includes only records beyond the marker, up to
// the value specified by MaxRecords.
Marker *string `type:"string"`
// A list of Parameter values.
Parameters []*Parameter `locationNameList:"Parameter" type:"list"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s DescribeDBParametersOutput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s DescribeDBParametersOutput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetMarker sets the Marker field's value.
func (s *DescribeDBParametersOutput) SetMarker(v string) *DescribeDBParametersOutput {
s.Marker = &v
return s
}
// SetParameters sets the Parameters field's value.
func (s *DescribeDBParametersOutput) SetParameters(v []*Parameter) *DescribeDBParametersOutput {
s.Parameters = v
return s
}
type DescribeDBSecurityGroupsInput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// The name of the DB security group to return details for.
DBSecurityGroupName *string `type:"string"`
// This parameter is not currently supported.
Filters []*Filter `locationNameList:"Filter" type:"list"`
// An optional pagination token provided by a previous DescribeDBSecurityGroups
// request. If this parameter is specified, the response includes only records
// beyond the marker, up to the value specified by MaxRecords.
Marker *string `type:"string"`
// The maximum number of records to include in the response. If more records
// exist than the specified MaxRecords value, a pagination token called a marker
// is included in the response so that the remaining results can be retrieved.
//
// Default: 100
//
// Constraints: Minimum 20, maximum 100.
MaxRecords *int64 `type:"integer"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s DescribeDBSecurityGroupsInput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s DescribeDBSecurityGroupsInput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
func (s *DescribeDBSecurityGroupsInput) Validate() error {
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "DescribeDBSecurityGroupsInput"}
if s.Filters != nil {
for i, v := range s.Filters {
if v == nil {
continue
}
if err := v.Validate(); err != nil {
invalidParams.AddNested(fmt.Sprintf("%s[%v]", "Filters", i), err.(request.ErrInvalidParams))
}
}
}
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
return invalidParams
}
return nil
}
// SetDBSecurityGroupName sets the DBSecurityGroupName field's value.
func (s *DescribeDBSecurityGroupsInput) SetDBSecurityGroupName(v string) *DescribeDBSecurityGroupsInput {
s.DBSecurityGroupName = &v
return s
}
// SetFilters sets the Filters field's value.
func (s *DescribeDBSecurityGroupsInput) SetFilters(v []*Filter) *DescribeDBSecurityGroupsInput {
s.Filters = v
return s
}
// SetMarker sets the Marker field's value.
func (s *DescribeDBSecurityGroupsInput) SetMarker(v string) *DescribeDBSecurityGroupsInput {
s.Marker = &v
return s
}
// SetMaxRecords sets the MaxRecords field's value.
func (s *DescribeDBSecurityGroupsInput) SetMaxRecords(v int64) *DescribeDBSecurityGroupsInput {
s.MaxRecords = &v
return s
}
// Contains the result of a successful invocation of the DescribeDBSecurityGroups
// action.
type DescribeDBSecurityGroupsOutput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// A list of DBSecurityGroup instances.
DBSecurityGroups []*DBSecurityGroup `locationNameList:"DBSecurityGroup" type:"list"`
// An optional pagination token provided by a previous request. If this parameter
// is specified, the response includes only records beyond the marker, up to
// the value specified by MaxRecords.
Marker *string `type:"string"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s DescribeDBSecurityGroupsOutput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s DescribeDBSecurityGroupsOutput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetDBSecurityGroups sets the DBSecurityGroups field's value.
func (s *DescribeDBSecurityGroupsOutput) SetDBSecurityGroups(v []*DBSecurityGroup) *DescribeDBSecurityGroupsOutput {
s.DBSecurityGroups = v
return s
}
// SetMarker sets the Marker field's value.
func (s *DescribeDBSecurityGroupsOutput) SetMarker(v string) *DescribeDBSecurityGroupsOutput {
s.Marker = &v
return s
}
type DescribeDBSnapshotAttributesInput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// The identifier for the DB snapshot to describe the attributes for.
//
// DBSnapshotIdentifier is a required field
DBSnapshotIdentifier *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s DescribeDBSnapshotAttributesInput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s DescribeDBSnapshotAttributesInput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
func (s *DescribeDBSnapshotAttributesInput) Validate() error {
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "DescribeDBSnapshotAttributesInput"}
if s.DBSnapshotIdentifier == nil {
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("DBSnapshotIdentifier"))
}
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
return invalidParams
}
return nil
}
// SetDBSnapshotIdentifier sets the DBSnapshotIdentifier field's value.
func (s *DescribeDBSnapshotAttributesInput) SetDBSnapshotIdentifier(v string) *DescribeDBSnapshotAttributesInput {
s.DBSnapshotIdentifier = &v
return s
}
type DescribeDBSnapshotAttributesOutput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// Contains the results of a successful call to the DescribeDBSnapshotAttributes
// API action.
//
// Manual DB snapshot attributes are used to authorize other AWS accounts to
// copy or restore a manual DB snapshot. For more information, see the ModifyDBSnapshotAttribute
// API action.
DBSnapshotAttributesResult *DBSnapshotAttributesResult `type:"structure"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s DescribeDBSnapshotAttributesOutput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s DescribeDBSnapshotAttributesOutput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetDBSnapshotAttributesResult sets the DBSnapshotAttributesResult field's value.
func (s *DescribeDBSnapshotAttributesOutput) SetDBSnapshotAttributesResult(v *DBSnapshotAttributesResult) *DescribeDBSnapshotAttributesOutput {
s.DBSnapshotAttributesResult = v
return s
}
type DescribeDBSnapshotsInput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// The ID of the DB instance to retrieve the list of DB snapshots for. This
// parameter can't be used in conjunction with DBSnapshotIdentifier. This parameter
// is not case-sensitive.
//
// Constraints:
//
// * If supplied, must match the identifier of an existing DBInstance.
DBInstanceIdentifier *string `type:"string"`
// A specific DB snapshot identifier to describe. This parameter can't be used
// in conjunction with DBInstanceIdentifier. This value is stored as a lowercase
// string.
//
// Constraints:
//
// * If supplied, must match the identifier of an existing DBSnapshot.
//
// * If this identifier is for an automated snapshot, the SnapshotType parameter
// must also be specified.
DBSnapshotIdentifier *string `type:"string"`
// A specific DB resource ID to describe.
DbiResourceId *string `type:"string"`
// This parameter is not currently supported.
Filters []*Filter `locationNameList:"Filter" type:"list"`
// True to include manual DB snapshots that are public and can be copied or
// restored by any AWS account, and otherwise false. The default is false.
//
// You can share a manual DB snapshot as public by using the ModifyDBSnapshotAttribute
// API.
IncludePublic *bool `type:"boolean"`
// True to include shared manual DB snapshots from other AWS accounts that this
// AWS account has been given permission to copy or restore, and otherwise false.
// The default is false.
//
// You can give an AWS account permission to restore a manual DB snapshot from
// another AWS account by using the ModifyDBSnapshotAttribute API action.
IncludeShared *bool `type:"boolean"`
// An optional pagination token provided by a previous DescribeDBSnapshots request.
// If this parameter is specified, the response includes only records beyond
// the marker, up to the value specified by MaxRecords.
Marker *string `type:"string"`
// The maximum number of records to include in the response. If more records
// exist than the specified MaxRecords value, a pagination token called a marker
// is included in the response so that the remaining results can be retrieved.
//
// Default: 100
//
// Constraints: Minimum 20, maximum 100.
MaxRecords *int64 `type:"integer"`
// The type of snapshots to be returned. You can specify one of the following
// values:
//
// * automated - Return all DB snapshots that have been automatically taken
// by Amazon RDS for my AWS account.
//
// * manual - Return all DB snapshots that have been taken by my AWS account.
//
// * shared - Return all manual DB snapshots that have been shared to my
// AWS account.
//
// * public - Return all DB snapshots that have been marked as public.
//
// * awsbackup - Return the DB snapshots managed by the AWS Backup service.
//
// For information about AWS Backup, see the AWS Backup Developer Guide. (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/aws-backup/latest/devguide/whatisbackup.html)
//
// The awsbackup type does not apply to Aurora.
//
// If you don't specify a SnapshotType value, then both automated and manual
// snapshots are returned. Shared and public DB snapshots are not included in
// the returned results by default. You can include shared snapshots with these
// results by setting the IncludeShared parameter to true. You can include public
// snapshots with these results by setting the IncludePublic parameter to true.
//
// The IncludeShared and IncludePublic parameters don't apply for SnapshotType
// values of manual or automated. The IncludePublic parameter doesn't apply
// when SnapshotType is set to shared. The IncludeShared parameter doesn't apply
// when SnapshotType is set to public.
SnapshotType *string `type:"string"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s DescribeDBSnapshotsInput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s DescribeDBSnapshotsInput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
func (s *DescribeDBSnapshotsInput) Validate() error {
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "DescribeDBSnapshotsInput"}
if s.Filters != nil {
for i, v := range s.Filters {
if v == nil {
continue
}
if err := v.Validate(); err != nil {
invalidParams.AddNested(fmt.Sprintf("%s[%v]", "Filters", i), err.(request.ErrInvalidParams))
}
}
}
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
return invalidParams
}
return nil
}
// SetDBInstanceIdentifier sets the DBInstanceIdentifier field's value.
func (s *DescribeDBSnapshotsInput) SetDBInstanceIdentifier(v string) *DescribeDBSnapshotsInput {
s.DBInstanceIdentifier = &v
return s
}
// SetDBSnapshotIdentifier sets the DBSnapshotIdentifier field's value.
func (s *DescribeDBSnapshotsInput) SetDBSnapshotIdentifier(v string) *DescribeDBSnapshotsInput {
s.DBSnapshotIdentifier = &v
return s
}
// SetDbiResourceId sets the DbiResourceId field's value.
func (s *DescribeDBSnapshotsInput) SetDbiResourceId(v string) *DescribeDBSnapshotsInput {
s.DbiResourceId = &v
return s
}
// SetFilters sets the Filters field's value.
func (s *DescribeDBSnapshotsInput) SetFilters(v []*Filter) *DescribeDBSnapshotsInput {
s.Filters = v
return s
}
// SetIncludePublic sets the IncludePublic field's value.
func (s *DescribeDBSnapshotsInput) SetIncludePublic(v bool) *DescribeDBSnapshotsInput {
s.IncludePublic = &v
return s
}
// SetIncludeShared sets the IncludeShared field's value.
func (s *DescribeDBSnapshotsInput) SetIncludeShared(v bool) *DescribeDBSnapshotsInput {
s.IncludeShared = &v
return s
}
// SetMarker sets the Marker field's value.
func (s *DescribeDBSnapshotsInput) SetMarker(v string) *DescribeDBSnapshotsInput {
s.Marker = &v
return s
}
// SetMaxRecords sets the MaxRecords field's value.
func (s *DescribeDBSnapshotsInput) SetMaxRecords(v int64) *DescribeDBSnapshotsInput {
s.MaxRecords = &v
return s
}
// SetSnapshotType sets the SnapshotType field's value.
func (s *DescribeDBSnapshotsInput) SetSnapshotType(v string) *DescribeDBSnapshotsInput {
s.SnapshotType = &v
return s
}
// Contains the result of a successful invocation of the DescribeDBSnapshots
// action.
type DescribeDBSnapshotsOutput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// A list of DBSnapshot instances.
DBSnapshots []*DBSnapshot `locationNameList:"DBSnapshot" type:"list"`
// An optional pagination token provided by a previous request. If this parameter
// is specified, the response includes only records beyond the marker, up to
// the value specified by MaxRecords.
Marker *string `type:"string"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s DescribeDBSnapshotsOutput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s DescribeDBSnapshotsOutput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetDBSnapshots sets the DBSnapshots field's value.
func (s *DescribeDBSnapshotsOutput) SetDBSnapshots(v []*DBSnapshot) *DescribeDBSnapshotsOutput {
s.DBSnapshots = v
return s
}
// SetMarker sets the Marker field's value.
func (s *DescribeDBSnapshotsOutput) SetMarker(v string) *DescribeDBSnapshotsOutput {
s.Marker = &v
return s
}
type DescribeDBSubnetGroupsInput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// The name of the DB subnet group to return details for.
DBSubnetGroupName *string `type:"string"`
// This parameter is not currently supported.
Filters []*Filter `locationNameList:"Filter" type:"list"`
// An optional pagination token provided by a previous DescribeDBSubnetGroups
// request. If this parameter is specified, the response includes only records
// beyond the marker, up to the value specified by MaxRecords.
Marker *string `type:"string"`
// The maximum number of records to include in the response. If more records
// exist than the specified MaxRecords value, a pagination token called a marker
// is included in the response so that the remaining results can be retrieved.
//
// Default: 100
//
// Constraints: Minimum 20, maximum 100.
MaxRecords *int64 `type:"integer"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s DescribeDBSubnetGroupsInput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s DescribeDBSubnetGroupsInput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
func (s *DescribeDBSubnetGroupsInput) Validate() error {
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "DescribeDBSubnetGroupsInput"}
if s.Filters != nil {
for i, v := range s.Filters {
if v == nil {
continue
}
if err := v.Validate(); err != nil {
invalidParams.AddNested(fmt.Sprintf("%s[%v]", "Filters", i), err.(request.ErrInvalidParams))
}
}
}
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
return invalidParams
}
return nil
}
// SetDBSubnetGroupName sets the DBSubnetGroupName field's value.
func (s *DescribeDBSubnetGroupsInput) SetDBSubnetGroupName(v string) *DescribeDBSubnetGroupsInput {
s.DBSubnetGroupName = &v
return s
}
// SetFilters sets the Filters field's value.
func (s *DescribeDBSubnetGroupsInput) SetFilters(v []*Filter) *DescribeDBSubnetGroupsInput {
s.Filters = v
return s
}
// SetMarker sets the Marker field's value.
func (s *DescribeDBSubnetGroupsInput) SetMarker(v string) *DescribeDBSubnetGroupsInput {
s.Marker = &v
return s
}
// SetMaxRecords sets the MaxRecords field's value.
func (s *DescribeDBSubnetGroupsInput) SetMaxRecords(v int64) *DescribeDBSubnetGroupsInput {
s.MaxRecords = &v
return s
}
// Contains the result of a successful invocation of the DescribeDBSubnetGroups
// action.
type DescribeDBSubnetGroupsOutput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// A list of DBSubnetGroup instances.
DBSubnetGroups []*DBSubnetGroup `locationNameList:"DBSubnetGroup" type:"list"`
// An optional pagination token provided by a previous request. If this parameter
// is specified, the response includes only records beyond the marker, up to
// the value specified by MaxRecords.
Marker *string `type:"string"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s DescribeDBSubnetGroupsOutput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s DescribeDBSubnetGroupsOutput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetDBSubnetGroups sets the DBSubnetGroups field's value.
func (s *DescribeDBSubnetGroupsOutput) SetDBSubnetGroups(v []*DBSubnetGroup) *DescribeDBSubnetGroupsOutput {
s.DBSubnetGroups = v
return s
}
// SetMarker sets the Marker field's value.
func (s *DescribeDBSubnetGroupsOutput) SetMarker(v string) *DescribeDBSubnetGroupsOutput {
s.Marker = &v
return s
}
type DescribeEngineDefaultClusterParametersInput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// The name of the DB cluster parameter group family to return engine parameter
// information for.
//
// DBParameterGroupFamily is a required field
DBParameterGroupFamily *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
// This parameter is not currently supported.
Filters []*Filter `locationNameList:"Filter" type:"list"`
// An optional pagination token provided by a previous DescribeEngineDefaultClusterParameters
// request. If this parameter is specified, the response includes only records
// beyond the marker, up to the value specified by MaxRecords.
Marker *string `type:"string"`
// The maximum number of records to include in the response. If more records
// exist than the specified MaxRecords value, a pagination token called a marker
// is included in the response so that the remaining results can be retrieved.
//
// Default: 100
//
// Constraints: Minimum 20, maximum 100.
MaxRecords *int64 `type:"integer"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s DescribeEngineDefaultClusterParametersInput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s DescribeEngineDefaultClusterParametersInput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
func (s *DescribeEngineDefaultClusterParametersInput) Validate() error {
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "DescribeEngineDefaultClusterParametersInput"}
if s.DBParameterGroupFamily == nil {
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("DBParameterGroupFamily"))
}
if s.Filters != nil {
for i, v := range s.Filters {
if v == nil {
continue
}
if err := v.Validate(); err != nil {
invalidParams.AddNested(fmt.Sprintf("%s[%v]", "Filters", i), err.(request.ErrInvalidParams))
}
}
}
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
return invalidParams
}
return nil
}
// SetDBParameterGroupFamily sets the DBParameterGroupFamily field's value.
func (s *DescribeEngineDefaultClusterParametersInput) SetDBParameterGroupFamily(v string) *DescribeEngineDefaultClusterParametersInput {
s.DBParameterGroupFamily = &v
return s
}
// SetFilters sets the Filters field's value.
func (s *DescribeEngineDefaultClusterParametersInput) SetFilters(v []*Filter) *DescribeEngineDefaultClusterParametersInput {
s.Filters = v
return s
}
// SetMarker sets the Marker field's value.
func (s *DescribeEngineDefaultClusterParametersInput) SetMarker(v string) *DescribeEngineDefaultClusterParametersInput {
s.Marker = &v
return s
}
// SetMaxRecords sets the MaxRecords field's value.
func (s *DescribeEngineDefaultClusterParametersInput) SetMaxRecords(v int64) *DescribeEngineDefaultClusterParametersInput {
s.MaxRecords = &v
return s
}
type DescribeEngineDefaultClusterParametersOutput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// Contains the result of a successful invocation of the DescribeEngineDefaultParameters
// action.
EngineDefaults *EngineDefaults `type:"structure"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s DescribeEngineDefaultClusterParametersOutput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s DescribeEngineDefaultClusterParametersOutput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetEngineDefaults sets the EngineDefaults field's value.
func (s *DescribeEngineDefaultClusterParametersOutput) SetEngineDefaults(v *EngineDefaults) *DescribeEngineDefaultClusterParametersOutput {
s.EngineDefaults = v
return s
}
type DescribeEngineDefaultParametersInput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// The name of the DB parameter group family.
//
// DBParameterGroupFamily is a required field
DBParameterGroupFamily *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
// This parameter is not currently supported.
Filters []*Filter `locationNameList:"Filter" type:"list"`
// An optional pagination token provided by a previous DescribeEngineDefaultParameters
// request. If this parameter is specified, the response includes only records
// beyond the marker, up to the value specified by MaxRecords.
Marker *string `type:"string"`
// The maximum number of records to include in the response. If more records
// exist than the specified MaxRecords value, a pagination token called a marker
// is included in the response so that the remaining results can be retrieved.
//
// Default: 100
//
// Constraints: Minimum 20, maximum 100.
MaxRecords *int64 `type:"integer"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s DescribeEngineDefaultParametersInput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s DescribeEngineDefaultParametersInput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
func (s *DescribeEngineDefaultParametersInput) Validate() error {
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "DescribeEngineDefaultParametersInput"}
if s.DBParameterGroupFamily == nil {
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("DBParameterGroupFamily"))
}
if s.Filters != nil {
for i, v := range s.Filters {
if v == nil {
continue
}
if err := v.Validate(); err != nil {
invalidParams.AddNested(fmt.Sprintf("%s[%v]", "Filters", i), err.(request.ErrInvalidParams))
}
}
}
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
return invalidParams
}
return nil
}
// SetDBParameterGroupFamily sets the DBParameterGroupFamily field's value.
func (s *DescribeEngineDefaultParametersInput) SetDBParameterGroupFamily(v string) *DescribeEngineDefaultParametersInput {
s.DBParameterGroupFamily = &v
return s
}
// SetFilters sets the Filters field's value.
func (s *DescribeEngineDefaultParametersInput) SetFilters(v []*Filter) *DescribeEngineDefaultParametersInput {
s.Filters = v
return s
}
// SetMarker sets the Marker field's value.
func (s *DescribeEngineDefaultParametersInput) SetMarker(v string) *DescribeEngineDefaultParametersInput {
s.Marker = &v
return s
}
// SetMaxRecords sets the MaxRecords field's value.
func (s *DescribeEngineDefaultParametersInput) SetMaxRecords(v int64) *DescribeEngineDefaultParametersInput {
s.MaxRecords = &v
return s
}
type DescribeEngineDefaultParametersOutput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// Contains the result of a successful invocation of the DescribeEngineDefaultParameters
// action.
EngineDefaults *EngineDefaults `type:"structure"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s DescribeEngineDefaultParametersOutput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s DescribeEngineDefaultParametersOutput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetEngineDefaults sets the EngineDefaults field's value.
func (s *DescribeEngineDefaultParametersOutput) SetEngineDefaults(v *EngineDefaults) *DescribeEngineDefaultParametersOutput {
s.EngineDefaults = v
return s
}
type DescribeEventCategoriesInput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// This parameter is not currently supported.
Filters []*Filter `locationNameList:"Filter" type:"list"`
// The type of source that is generating the events.
//
// Valid values: db-instance | db-parameter-group | db-security-group | db-snapshot
SourceType *string `type:"string"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s DescribeEventCategoriesInput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s DescribeEventCategoriesInput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
func (s *DescribeEventCategoriesInput) Validate() error {
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "DescribeEventCategoriesInput"}
if s.Filters != nil {
for i, v := range s.Filters {
if v == nil {
continue
}
if err := v.Validate(); err != nil {
invalidParams.AddNested(fmt.Sprintf("%s[%v]", "Filters", i), err.(request.ErrInvalidParams))
}
}
}
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
return invalidParams
}
return nil
}
// SetFilters sets the Filters field's value.
func (s *DescribeEventCategoriesInput) SetFilters(v []*Filter) *DescribeEventCategoriesInput {
s.Filters = v
return s
}
// SetSourceType sets the SourceType field's value.
func (s *DescribeEventCategoriesInput) SetSourceType(v string) *DescribeEventCategoriesInput {
s.SourceType = &v
return s
}
// Data returned from the DescribeEventCategories action.
type DescribeEventCategoriesOutput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// A list of EventCategoriesMap data types.
EventCategoriesMapList []*EventCategoriesMap `locationNameList:"EventCategoriesMap" type:"list"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s DescribeEventCategoriesOutput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s DescribeEventCategoriesOutput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetEventCategoriesMapList sets the EventCategoriesMapList field's value.
func (s *DescribeEventCategoriesOutput) SetEventCategoriesMapList(v []*EventCategoriesMap) *DescribeEventCategoriesOutput {
s.EventCategoriesMapList = v
return s
}
type DescribeEventSubscriptionsInput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// This parameter is not currently supported.
Filters []*Filter `locationNameList:"Filter" type:"list"`
// An optional pagination token provided by a previous DescribeOrderableDBInstanceOptions
// request. If this parameter is specified, the response includes only records
// beyond the marker, up to the value specified by MaxRecords .
Marker *string `type:"string"`
// The maximum number of records to include in the response. If more records
// exist than the specified MaxRecords value, a pagination token called a marker
// is included in the response so that the remaining results can be retrieved.
//
// Default: 100
//
// Constraints: Minimum 20, maximum 100.
MaxRecords *int64 `type:"integer"`
// The name of the RDS event notification subscription you want to describe.
SubscriptionName *string `type:"string"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s DescribeEventSubscriptionsInput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s DescribeEventSubscriptionsInput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
func (s *DescribeEventSubscriptionsInput) Validate() error {
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "DescribeEventSubscriptionsInput"}
if s.Filters != nil {
for i, v := range s.Filters {
if v == nil {
continue
}
if err := v.Validate(); err != nil {
invalidParams.AddNested(fmt.Sprintf("%s[%v]", "Filters", i), err.(request.ErrInvalidParams))
}
}
}
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
return invalidParams
}
return nil
}
// SetFilters sets the Filters field's value.
func (s *DescribeEventSubscriptionsInput) SetFilters(v []*Filter) *DescribeEventSubscriptionsInput {
s.Filters = v
return s
}
// SetMarker sets the Marker field's value.
func (s *DescribeEventSubscriptionsInput) SetMarker(v string) *DescribeEventSubscriptionsInput {
s.Marker = &v
return s
}
// SetMaxRecords sets the MaxRecords field's value.
func (s *DescribeEventSubscriptionsInput) SetMaxRecords(v int64) *DescribeEventSubscriptionsInput {
s.MaxRecords = &v
return s
}
// SetSubscriptionName sets the SubscriptionName field's value.
func (s *DescribeEventSubscriptionsInput) SetSubscriptionName(v string) *DescribeEventSubscriptionsInput {
s.SubscriptionName = &v
return s
}
// Data returned by the DescribeEventSubscriptions action.
type DescribeEventSubscriptionsOutput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// A list of EventSubscriptions data types.
EventSubscriptionsList []*EventSubscription `locationNameList:"EventSubscription" type:"list"`
// An optional pagination token provided by a previous DescribeOrderableDBInstanceOptions
// request. If this parameter is specified, the response includes only records
// beyond the marker, up to the value specified by MaxRecords.
Marker *string `type:"string"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s DescribeEventSubscriptionsOutput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s DescribeEventSubscriptionsOutput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetEventSubscriptionsList sets the EventSubscriptionsList field's value.
func (s *DescribeEventSubscriptionsOutput) SetEventSubscriptionsList(v []*EventSubscription) *DescribeEventSubscriptionsOutput {
s.EventSubscriptionsList = v
return s
}
// SetMarker sets the Marker field's value.
func (s *DescribeEventSubscriptionsOutput) SetMarker(v string) *DescribeEventSubscriptionsOutput {
s.Marker = &v
return s
}
type DescribeEventsInput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// The number of minutes to retrieve events for.
//
// Default: 60
Duration *int64 `type:"integer"`
// The end of the time interval for which to retrieve events, specified in ISO
// 8601 format. For more information about ISO 8601, go to the ISO8601 Wikipedia
// page. (http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/ISO_8601)
//
// Example: 2009-07-08T18:00Z
EndTime *time.Time `type:"timestamp"`
// A list of event categories that trigger notifications for a event notification
// subscription.
EventCategories []*string `locationNameList:"EventCategory" type:"list"`
// This parameter is not currently supported.
Filters []*Filter `locationNameList:"Filter" type:"list"`
// An optional pagination token provided by a previous DescribeEvents request.
// If this parameter is specified, the response includes only records beyond
// the marker, up to the value specified by MaxRecords.
Marker *string `type:"string"`
// The maximum number of records to include in the response. If more records
// exist than the specified MaxRecords value, a pagination token called a marker
// is included in the response so that the remaining results can be retrieved.
//
// Default: 100
//
// Constraints: Minimum 20, maximum 100.
MaxRecords *int64 `type:"integer"`
// The identifier of the event source for which events are returned. If not
// specified, then all sources are included in the response.
//
// Constraints:
//
// * If SourceIdentifier is supplied, SourceType must also be provided.
//
// * If the source type is DBInstance, then a DBInstanceIdentifier must be
// supplied.
//
// * If the source type is DBSecurityGroup, a DBSecurityGroupName must be
// supplied.
//
// * If the source type is DBParameterGroup, a DBParameterGroupName must
// be supplied.
//
// * If the source type is DBSnapshot, a DBSnapshotIdentifier must be supplied.
//
// * Can't end with a hyphen or contain two consecutive hyphens.
SourceIdentifier *string `type:"string"`
// The event source to retrieve events for. If no value is specified, all events
// are returned.
SourceType *string `type:"string" enum:"SourceType"`
// The beginning of the time interval to retrieve events for, specified in ISO
// 8601 format. For more information about ISO 8601, go to the ISO8601 Wikipedia
// page. (http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/ISO_8601)
//
// Example: 2009-07-08T18:00Z
StartTime *time.Time `type:"timestamp"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s DescribeEventsInput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s DescribeEventsInput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
func (s *DescribeEventsInput) Validate() error {
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "DescribeEventsInput"}
if s.Filters != nil {
for i, v := range s.Filters {
if v == nil {
continue
}
if err := v.Validate(); err != nil {
invalidParams.AddNested(fmt.Sprintf("%s[%v]", "Filters", i), err.(request.ErrInvalidParams))
}
}
}
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
return invalidParams
}
return nil
}
// SetDuration sets the Duration field's value.
func (s *DescribeEventsInput) SetDuration(v int64) *DescribeEventsInput {
s.Duration = &v
return s
}
// SetEndTime sets the EndTime field's value.
func (s *DescribeEventsInput) SetEndTime(v time.Time) *DescribeEventsInput {
s.EndTime = &v
return s
}
// SetEventCategories sets the EventCategories field's value.
func (s *DescribeEventsInput) SetEventCategories(v []*string) *DescribeEventsInput {
s.EventCategories = v
return s
}
// SetFilters sets the Filters field's value.
func (s *DescribeEventsInput) SetFilters(v []*Filter) *DescribeEventsInput {
s.Filters = v
return s
}
// SetMarker sets the Marker field's value.
func (s *DescribeEventsInput) SetMarker(v string) *DescribeEventsInput {
s.Marker = &v
return s
}
// SetMaxRecords sets the MaxRecords field's value.
func (s *DescribeEventsInput) SetMaxRecords(v int64) *DescribeEventsInput {
s.MaxRecords = &v
return s
}
// SetSourceIdentifier sets the SourceIdentifier field's value.
func (s *DescribeEventsInput) SetSourceIdentifier(v string) *DescribeEventsInput {
s.SourceIdentifier = &v
return s
}
// SetSourceType sets the SourceType field's value.
func (s *DescribeEventsInput) SetSourceType(v string) *DescribeEventsInput {
s.SourceType = &v
return s
}
// SetStartTime sets the StartTime field's value.
func (s *DescribeEventsInput) SetStartTime(v time.Time) *DescribeEventsInput {
s.StartTime = &v
return s
}
// Contains the result of a successful invocation of the DescribeEvents action.
type DescribeEventsOutput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// A list of Event instances.
Events []*Event `locationNameList:"Event" type:"list"`
// An optional pagination token provided by a previous Events request. If this
// parameter is specified, the response includes only records beyond the marker,
// up to the value specified by MaxRecords .
Marker *string `type:"string"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s DescribeEventsOutput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s DescribeEventsOutput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetEvents sets the Events field's value.
func (s *DescribeEventsOutput) SetEvents(v []*Event) *DescribeEventsOutput {
s.Events = v
return s
}
// SetMarker sets the Marker field's value.
func (s *DescribeEventsOutput) SetMarker(v string) *DescribeEventsOutput {
s.Marker = &v
return s
}
type DescribeGlobalClustersInput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// A filter that specifies one or more global DB clusters to describe.
//
// Supported filters:
//
// * db-cluster-id - Accepts DB cluster identifiers and DB cluster Amazon
// Resource Names (ARNs). The results list will only include information
// about the DB clusters identified by these ARNs.
Filters []*Filter `locationNameList:"Filter" type:"list"`
// The user-supplied DB cluster identifier. If this parameter is specified,
// information from only the specific DB cluster is returned. This parameter
// isn't case-sensitive.
//
// Constraints:
//
// * If supplied, must match an existing DBClusterIdentifier.
GlobalClusterIdentifier *string `type:"string"`
// An optional pagination token provided by a previous DescribeGlobalClusters
// request. If this parameter is specified, the response includes only records
// beyond the marker, up to the value specified by MaxRecords.
Marker *string `type:"string"`
// The maximum number of records to include in the response. If more records
// exist than the specified MaxRecords value, a pagination token called a marker
// is included in the response so that the remaining results can be retrieved.
//
// Default: 100
//
// Constraints: Minimum 20, maximum 100.
MaxRecords *int64 `type:"integer"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s DescribeGlobalClustersInput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s DescribeGlobalClustersInput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
func (s *DescribeGlobalClustersInput) Validate() error {
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "DescribeGlobalClustersInput"}
if s.Filters != nil {
for i, v := range s.Filters {
if v == nil {
continue
}
if err := v.Validate(); err != nil {
invalidParams.AddNested(fmt.Sprintf("%s[%v]", "Filters", i), err.(request.ErrInvalidParams))
}
}
}
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
return invalidParams
}
return nil
}
// SetFilters sets the Filters field's value.
func (s *DescribeGlobalClustersInput) SetFilters(v []*Filter) *DescribeGlobalClustersInput {
s.Filters = v
return s
}
// SetGlobalClusterIdentifier sets the GlobalClusterIdentifier field's value.
func (s *DescribeGlobalClustersInput) SetGlobalClusterIdentifier(v string) *DescribeGlobalClustersInput {
s.GlobalClusterIdentifier = &v
return s
}
// SetMarker sets the Marker field's value.
func (s *DescribeGlobalClustersInput) SetMarker(v string) *DescribeGlobalClustersInput {
s.Marker = &v
return s
}
// SetMaxRecords sets the MaxRecords field's value.
func (s *DescribeGlobalClustersInput) SetMaxRecords(v int64) *DescribeGlobalClustersInput {
s.MaxRecords = &v
return s
}
type DescribeGlobalClustersOutput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// The list of global clusters returned by this request.
GlobalClusters []*GlobalCluster `locationNameList:"GlobalClusterMember" type:"list"`
// An optional pagination token provided by a previous DescribeGlobalClusters
// request. If this parameter is specified, the response includes only records
// beyond the marker, up to the value specified by MaxRecords.
Marker *string `type:"string"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s DescribeGlobalClustersOutput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s DescribeGlobalClustersOutput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetGlobalClusters sets the GlobalClusters field's value.
func (s *DescribeGlobalClustersOutput) SetGlobalClusters(v []*GlobalCluster) *DescribeGlobalClustersOutput {
s.GlobalClusters = v
return s
}
// SetMarker sets the Marker field's value.
func (s *DescribeGlobalClustersOutput) SetMarker(v string) *DescribeGlobalClustersOutput {
s.Marker = &v
return s
}
type DescribeOptionGroupOptionsInput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// A required parameter. Options available for the given engine name are described.
//
// EngineName is a required field
EngineName *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
// This parameter is not currently supported.
Filters []*Filter `locationNameList:"Filter" type:"list"`
// If specified, filters the results to include only options for the specified
// major engine version.
MajorEngineVersion *string `type:"string"`
// An optional pagination token provided by a previous request. If this parameter
// is specified, the response includes only records beyond the marker, up to
// the value specified by MaxRecords.
Marker *string `type:"string"`
// The maximum number of records to include in the response. If more records
// exist than the specified MaxRecords value, a pagination token called a marker
// is included in the response so that the remaining results can be retrieved.
//
// Default: 100
//
// Constraints: Minimum 20, maximum 100.
MaxRecords *int64 `type:"integer"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s DescribeOptionGroupOptionsInput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s DescribeOptionGroupOptionsInput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
func (s *DescribeOptionGroupOptionsInput) Validate() error {
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "DescribeOptionGroupOptionsInput"}
if s.EngineName == nil {
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("EngineName"))
}
if s.Filters != nil {
for i, v := range s.Filters {
if v == nil {
continue
}
if err := v.Validate(); err != nil {
invalidParams.AddNested(fmt.Sprintf("%s[%v]", "Filters", i), err.(request.ErrInvalidParams))
}
}
}
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
return invalidParams
}
return nil
}
// SetEngineName sets the EngineName field's value.
func (s *DescribeOptionGroupOptionsInput) SetEngineName(v string) *DescribeOptionGroupOptionsInput {
s.EngineName = &v
return s
}
// SetFilters sets the Filters field's value.
func (s *DescribeOptionGroupOptionsInput) SetFilters(v []*Filter) *DescribeOptionGroupOptionsInput {
s.Filters = v
return s
}
// SetMajorEngineVersion sets the MajorEngineVersion field's value.
func (s *DescribeOptionGroupOptionsInput) SetMajorEngineVersion(v string) *DescribeOptionGroupOptionsInput {
s.MajorEngineVersion = &v
return s
}
// SetMarker sets the Marker field's value.
func (s *DescribeOptionGroupOptionsInput) SetMarker(v string) *DescribeOptionGroupOptionsInput {
s.Marker = &v
return s
}
// SetMaxRecords sets the MaxRecords field's value.
func (s *DescribeOptionGroupOptionsInput) SetMaxRecords(v int64) *DescribeOptionGroupOptionsInput {
s.MaxRecords = &v
return s
}
type DescribeOptionGroupOptionsOutput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// An optional pagination token provided by a previous request. If this parameter
// is specified, the response includes only records beyond the marker, up to
// the value specified by MaxRecords.
Marker *string `type:"string"`
// List of available option group options.
OptionGroupOptions []*OptionGroupOption `locationNameList:"OptionGroupOption" type:"list"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s DescribeOptionGroupOptionsOutput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s DescribeOptionGroupOptionsOutput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetMarker sets the Marker field's value.
func (s *DescribeOptionGroupOptionsOutput) SetMarker(v string) *DescribeOptionGroupOptionsOutput {
s.Marker = &v
return s
}
// SetOptionGroupOptions sets the OptionGroupOptions field's value.
func (s *DescribeOptionGroupOptionsOutput) SetOptionGroupOptions(v []*OptionGroupOption) *DescribeOptionGroupOptionsOutput {
s.OptionGroupOptions = v
return s
}
type DescribeOptionGroupsInput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// Filters the list of option groups to only include groups associated with
// a specific database engine.
EngineName *string `type:"string"`
// This parameter is not currently supported.
Filters []*Filter `locationNameList:"Filter" type:"list"`
// Filters the list of option groups to only include groups associated with
// a specific database engine version. If specified, then EngineName must also
// be specified.
MajorEngineVersion *string `type:"string"`
// An optional pagination token provided by a previous DescribeOptionGroups
// request. If this parameter is specified, the response includes only records
// beyond the marker, up to the value specified by MaxRecords.
Marker *string `type:"string"`
// The maximum number of records to include in the response. If more records
// exist than the specified MaxRecords value, a pagination token called a marker
// is included in the response so that the remaining results can be retrieved.
//
// Default: 100
//
// Constraints: Minimum 20, maximum 100.
MaxRecords *int64 `type:"integer"`
// The name of the option group to describe. Can't be supplied together with
// EngineName or MajorEngineVersion.
OptionGroupName *string `type:"string"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s DescribeOptionGroupsInput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s DescribeOptionGroupsInput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
func (s *DescribeOptionGroupsInput) Validate() error {
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "DescribeOptionGroupsInput"}
if s.Filters != nil {
for i, v := range s.Filters {
if v == nil {
continue
}
if err := v.Validate(); err != nil {
invalidParams.AddNested(fmt.Sprintf("%s[%v]", "Filters", i), err.(request.ErrInvalidParams))
}
}
}
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
return invalidParams
}
return nil
}
// SetEngineName sets the EngineName field's value.
func (s *DescribeOptionGroupsInput) SetEngineName(v string) *DescribeOptionGroupsInput {
s.EngineName = &v
return s
}
// SetFilters sets the Filters field's value.
func (s *DescribeOptionGroupsInput) SetFilters(v []*Filter) *DescribeOptionGroupsInput {
s.Filters = v
return s
}
// SetMajorEngineVersion sets the MajorEngineVersion field's value.
func (s *DescribeOptionGroupsInput) SetMajorEngineVersion(v string) *DescribeOptionGroupsInput {
s.MajorEngineVersion = &v
return s
}
// SetMarker sets the Marker field's value.
func (s *DescribeOptionGroupsInput) SetMarker(v string) *DescribeOptionGroupsInput {
s.Marker = &v
return s
}
// SetMaxRecords sets the MaxRecords field's value.
func (s *DescribeOptionGroupsInput) SetMaxRecords(v int64) *DescribeOptionGroupsInput {
s.MaxRecords = &v
return s
}
// SetOptionGroupName sets the OptionGroupName field's value.
func (s *DescribeOptionGroupsInput) SetOptionGroupName(v string) *DescribeOptionGroupsInput {
s.OptionGroupName = &v
return s
}
// List of option groups.
type DescribeOptionGroupsOutput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// An optional pagination token provided by a previous request. If this parameter
// is specified, the response includes only records beyond the marker, up to
// the value specified by MaxRecords.
Marker *string `type:"string"`
// List of option groups.
OptionGroupsList []*OptionGroup `locationNameList:"OptionGroup" type:"list"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s DescribeOptionGroupsOutput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s DescribeOptionGroupsOutput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetMarker sets the Marker field's value.
func (s *DescribeOptionGroupsOutput) SetMarker(v string) *DescribeOptionGroupsOutput {
s.Marker = &v
return s
}
// SetOptionGroupsList sets the OptionGroupsList field's value.
func (s *DescribeOptionGroupsOutput) SetOptionGroupsList(v []*OptionGroup) *DescribeOptionGroupsOutput {
s.OptionGroupsList = v
return s
}
type DescribeOrderableDBInstanceOptionsInput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// The DB instance class filter value. Specify this parameter to show only the
// available offerings matching the specified DB instance class.
DBInstanceClass *string `type:"string"`
// The name of the engine to retrieve DB instance options for.
//
// Engine is a required field
Engine *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
// The engine version filter value. Specify this parameter to show only the
// available offerings matching the specified engine version.
EngineVersion *string `type:"string"`
// This parameter is not currently supported.
Filters []*Filter `locationNameList:"Filter" type:"list"`
// The license model filter value. Specify this parameter to show only the available
// offerings matching the specified license model.
LicenseModel *string `type:"string"`
// An optional pagination token provided by a previous DescribeOrderableDBInstanceOptions
// request. If this parameter is specified, the response includes only records
// beyond the marker, up to the value specified by MaxRecords .
Marker *string `type:"string"`
// The maximum number of records to include in the response. If more records
// exist than the specified MaxRecords value, a pagination token called a marker
// is included in the response so that the remaining results can be retrieved.
//
// Default: 100
//
// Constraints: Minimum 20, maximum 100.
MaxRecords *int64 `type:"integer"`
// The VPC filter value. Specify this parameter to show only the available VPC
// or non-VPC offerings.
Vpc *bool `type:"boolean"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s DescribeOrderableDBInstanceOptionsInput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s DescribeOrderableDBInstanceOptionsInput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
func (s *DescribeOrderableDBInstanceOptionsInput) Validate() error {
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "DescribeOrderableDBInstanceOptionsInput"}
if s.Engine == nil {
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Engine"))
}
if s.Filters != nil {
for i, v := range s.Filters {
if v == nil {
continue
}
if err := v.Validate(); err != nil {
invalidParams.AddNested(fmt.Sprintf("%s[%v]", "Filters", i), err.(request.ErrInvalidParams))
}
}
}
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
return invalidParams
}
return nil
}
// SetDBInstanceClass sets the DBInstanceClass field's value.
func (s *DescribeOrderableDBInstanceOptionsInput) SetDBInstanceClass(v string) *DescribeOrderableDBInstanceOptionsInput {
s.DBInstanceClass = &v
return s
}
// SetEngine sets the Engine field's value.
func (s *DescribeOrderableDBInstanceOptionsInput) SetEngine(v string) *DescribeOrderableDBInstanceOptionsInput {
s.Engine = &v
return s
}
// SetEngineVersion sets the EngineVersion field's value.
func (s *DescribeOrderableDBInstanceOptionsInput) SetEngineVersion(v string) *DescribeOrderableDBInstanceOptionsInput {
s.EngineVersion = &v
return s
}
// SetFilters sets the Filters field's value.
func (s *DescribeOrderableDBInstanceOptionsInput) SetFilters(v []*Filter) *DescribeOrderableDBInstanceOptionsInput {
s.Filters = v
return s
}
// SetLicenseModel sets the LicenseModel field's value.
func (s *DescribeOrderableDBInstanceOptionsInput) SetLicenseModel(v string) *DescribeOrderableDBInstanceOptionsInput {
s.LicenseModel = &v
return s
}
// SetMarker sets the Marker field's value.
func (s *DescribeOrderableDBInstanceOptionsInput) SetMarker(v string) *DescribeOrderableDBInstanceOptionsInput {
s.Marker = &v
return s
}
// SetMaxRecords sets the MaxRecords field's value.
func (s *DescribeOrderableDBInstanceOptionsInput) SetMaxRecords(v int64) *DescribeOrderableDBInstanceOptionsInput {
s.MaxRecords = &v
return s
}
// SetVpc sets the Vpc field's value.
func (s *DescribeOrderableDBInstanceOptionsInput) SetVpc(v bool) *DescribeOrderableDBInstanceOptionsInput {
s.Vpc = &v
return s
}
// Contains the result of a successful invocation of the DescribeOrderableDBInstanceOptions
// action.
type DescribeOrderableDBInstanceOptionsOutput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// An optional pagination token provided by a previous OrderableDBInstanceOptions
// request. If this parameter is specified, the response includes only records
// beyond the marker, up to the value specified by MaxRecords .
Marker *string `type:"string"`
// An OrderableDBInstanceOption structure containing information about orderable
// options for the DB instance.
OrderableDBInstanceOptions []*OrderableDBInstanceOption `locationNameList:"OrderableDBInstanceOption" type:"list"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s DescribeOrderableDBInstanceOptionsOutput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s DescribeOrderableDBInstanceOptionsOutput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetMarker sets the Marker field's value.
func (s *DescribeOrderableDBInstanceOptionsOutput) SetMarker(v string) *DescribeOrderableDBInstanceOptionsOutput {
s.Marker = &v
return s
}
// SetOrderableDBInstanceOptions sets the OrderableDBInstanceOptions field's value.
func (s *DescribeOrderableDBInstanceOptionsOutput) SetOrderableDBInstanceOptions(v []*OrderableDBInstanceOption) *DescribeOrderableDBInstanceOptionsOutput {
s.OrderableDBInstanceOptions = v
return s
}
type DescribePendingMaintenanceActionsInput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// A filter that specifies one or more resources to return pending maintenance
// actions for.
//
// Supported filters:
//
// * db-cluster-id - Accepts DB cluster identifiers and DB cluster Amazon
// Resource Names (ARNs). The results list will only include pending maintenance
// actions for the DB clusters identified by these ARNs.
//
// * db-instance-id - Accepts DB instance identifiers and DB instance ARNs.
// The results list will only include pending maintenance actions for the
// DB instances identified by these ARNs.
Filters []*Filter `locationNameList:"Filter" type:"list"`
// An optional pagination token provided by a previous DescribePendingMaintenanceActions
// request. If this parameter is specified, the response includes only records
// beyond the marker, up to a number of records specified by MaxRecords.
Marker *string `type:"string"`
// The maximum number of records to include in the response. If more records
// exist than the specified MaxRecords value, a pagination token called a marker
// is included in the response so that the remaining results can be retrieved.
//
// Default: 100
//
// Constraints: Minimum 20, maximum 100.
MaxRecords *int64 `type:"integer"`
// The ARN of a resource to return pending maintenance actions for.
ResourceIdentifier *string `type:"string"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s DescribePendingMaintenanceActionsInput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s DescribePendingMaintenanceActionsInput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
func (s *DescribePendingMaintenanceActionsInput) Validate() error {
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "DescribePendingMaintenanceActionsInput"}
if s.Filters != nil {
for i, v := range s.Filters {
if v == nil {
continue
}
if err := v.Validate(); err != nil {
invalidParams.AddNested(fmt.Sprintf("%s[%v]", "Filters", i), err.(request.ErrInvalidParams))
}
}
}
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
return invalidParams
}
return nil
}
// SetFilters sets the Filters field's value.
func (s *DescribePendingMaintenanceActionsInput) SetFilters(v []*Filter) *DescribePendingMaintenanceActionsInput {
s.Filters = v
return s
}
// SetMarker sets the Marker field's value.
func (s *DescribePendingMaintenanceActionsInput) SetMarker(v string) *DescribePendingMaintenanceActionsInput {
s.Marker = &v
return s
}
// SetMaxRecords sets the MaxRecords field's value.
func (s *DescribePendingMaintenanceActionsInput) SetMaxRecords(v int64) *DescribePendingMaintenanceActionsInput {
s.MaxRecords = &v
return s
}
// SetResourceIdentifier sets the ResourceIdentifier field's value.
func (s *DescribePendingMaintenanceActionsInput) SetResourceIdentifier(v string) *DescribePendingMaintenanceActionsInput {
s.ResourceIdentifier = &v
return s
}
// Data returned from the DescribePendingMaintenanceActions action.
type DescribePendingMaintenanceActionsOutput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// An optional pagination token provided by a previous DescribePendingMaintenanceActions
// request. If this parameter is specified, the response includes only records
// beyond the marker, up to a number of records specified by MaxRecords.
Marker *string `type:"string"`
// A list of the pending maintenance actions for the resource.
PendingMaintenanceActions []*ResourcePendingMaintenanceActions `locationNameList:"ResourcePendingMaintenanceActions" type:"list"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s DescribePendingMaintenanceActionsOutput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s DescribePendingMaintenanceActionsOutput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetMarker sets the Marker field's value.
func (s *DescribePendingMaintenanceActionsOutput) SetMarker(v string) *DescribePendingMaintenanceActionsOutput {
s.Marker = &v
return s
}
// SetPendingMaintenanceActions sets the PendingMaintenanceActions field's value.
func (s *DescribePendingMaintenanceActionsOutput) SetPendingMaintenanceActions(v []*ResourcePendingMaintenanceActions) *DescribePendingMaintenanceActionsOutput {
s.PendingMaintenanceActions = v
return s
}
type DescribeReservedDBInstancesInput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// The DB instance class filter value. Specify this parameter to show only those
// reservations matching the specified DB instances class.
DBInstanceClass *string `type:"string"`
// The duration filter value, specified in years or seconds. Specify this parameter
// to show only reservations for this duration.
//
// Valid Values: 1 | 3 | 31536000 | 94608000
Duration *string `type:"string"`
// This parameter is not currently supported.
Filters []*Filter `locationNameList:"Filter" type:"list"`
// An optional pagination token provided by a previous request. If this parameter
// is specified, the response includes only records beyond the marker, up to
// the value specified by MaxRecords.
Marker *string `type:"string"`
// The maximum number of records to include in the response. If more than the
// MaxRecords value is available, a pagination token called a marker is included
// in the response so that the following results can be retrieved.
//
// Default: 100
//
// Constraints: Minimum 20, maximum 100.
MaxRecords *int64 `type:"integer"`
// The Multi-AZ filter value. Specify this parameter to show only those reservations
// matching the specified Multi-AZ parameter.
MultiAZ *bool `type:"boolean"`
// The offering type filter value. Specify this parameter to show only the available
// offerings matching the specified offering type.
//
// Valid Values: "Partial Upfront" | "All Upfront" | "No Upfront"
OfferingType *string `type:"string"`
// The product description filter value. Specify this parameter to show only
// those reservations matching the specified product description.
ProductDescription *string `type:"string"`
// The reserved DB instance identifier filter value. Specify this parameter
// to show only the reservation that matches the specified reservation ID.
ReservedDBInstanceId *string `type:"string"`
// The offering identifier filter value. Specify this parameter to show only
// purchased reservations matching the specified offering identifier.
ReservedDBInstancesOfferingId *string `type:"string"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s DescribeReservedDBInstancesInput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s DescribeReservedDBInstancesInput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
func (s *DescribeReservedDBInstancesInput) Validate() error {
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "DescribeReservedDBInstancesInput"}
if s.Filters != nil {
for i, v := range s.Filters {
if v == nil {
continue
}
if err := v.Validate(); err != nil {
invalidParams.AddNested(fmt.Sprintf("%s[%v]", "Filters", i), err.(request.ErrInvalidParams))
}
}
}
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
return invalidParams
}
return nil
}
// SetDBInstanceClass sets the DBInstanceClass field's value.
func (s *DescribeReservedDBInstancesInput) SetDBInstanceClass(v string) *DescribeReservedDBInstancesInput {
s.DBInstanceClass = &v
return s
}
// SetDuration sets the Duration field's value.
func (s *DescribeReservedDBInstancesInput) SetDuration(v string) *DescribeReservedDBInstancesInput {
s.Duration = &v
return s
}
// SetFilters sets the Filters field's value.
func (s *DescribeReservedDBInstancesInput) SetFilters(v []*Filter) *DescribeReservedDBInstancesInput {
s.Filters = v
return s
}
// SetMarker sets the Marker field's value.
func (s *DescribeReservedDBInstancesInput) SetMarker(v string) *DescribeReservedDBInstancesInput {
s.Marker = &v
return s
}
// SetMaxRecords sets the MaxRecords field's value.
func (s *DescribeReservedDBInstancesInput) SetMaxRecords(v int64) *DescribeReservedDBInstancesInput {
s.MaxRecords = &v
return s
}
// SetMultiAZ sets the MultiAZ field's value.
func (s *DescribeReservedDBInstancesInput) SetMultiAZ(v bool) *DescribeReservedDBInstancesInput {
s.MultiAZ = &v
return s
}
// SetOfferingType sets the OfferingType field's value.
func (s *DescribeReservedDBInstancesInput) SetOfferingType(v string) *DescribeReservedDBInstancesInput {
s.OfferingType = &v
return s
}
// SetProductDescription sets the ProductDescription field's value.
func (s *DescribeReservedDBInstancesInput) SetProductDescription(v string) *DescribeReservedDBInstancesInput {
s.ProductDescription = &v
return s
}
// SetReservedDBInstanceId sets the ReservedDBInstanceId field's value.
func (s *DescribeReservedDBInstancesInput) SetReservedDBInstanceId(v string) *DescribeReservedDBInstancesInput {
s.ReservedDBInstanceId = &v
return s
}
// SetReservedDBInstancesOfferingId sets the ReservedDBInstancesOfferingId field's value.
func (s *DescribeReservedDBInstancesInput) SetReservedDBInstancesOfferingId(v string) *DescribeReservedDBInstancesInput {
s.ReservedDBInstancesOfferingId = &v
return s
}
type DescribeReservedDBInstancesOfferingsInput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// The DB instance class filter value. Specify this parameter to show only the
// available offerings matching the specified DB instance class.
DBInstanceClass *string `type:"string"`
// Duration filter value, specified in years or seconds. Specify this parameter
// to show only reservations for this duration.
//
// Valid Values: 1 | 3 | 31536000 | 94608000
Duration *string `type:"string"`
// This parameter is not currently supported.
Filters []*Filter `locationNameList:"Filter" type:"list"`
// An optional pagination token provided by a previous request. If this parameter
// is specified, the response includes only records beyond the marker, up to
// the value specified by MaxRecords.
Marker *string `type:"string"`
// The maximum number of records to include in the response. If more than the
// MaxRecords value is available, a pagination token called a marker is included
// in the response so that the following results can be retrieved.
//
// Default: 100
//
// Constraints: Minimum 20, maximum 100.
MaxRecords *int64 `type:"integer"`
// The Multi-AZ filter value. Specify this parameter to show only the available
// offerings matching the specified Multi-AZ parameter.
MultiAZ *bool `type:"boolean"`
// The offering type filter value. Specify this parameter to show only the available
// offerings matching the specified offering type.
//
// Valid Values: "Partial Upfront" | "All Upfront" | "No Upfront"
OfferingType *string `type:"string"`
// Product description filter value. Specify this parameter to show only the
// available offerings that contain the specified product description.
//
// The results show offerings that partially match the filter value.
ProductDescription *string `type:"string"`
// The offering identifier filter value. Specify this parameter to show only
// the available offering that matches the specified reservation identifier.
//
// Example: 438012d3-4052-4cc7-b2e3-8d3372e0e706
ReservedDBInstancesOfferingId *string `type:"string"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s DescribeReservedDBInstancesOfferingsInput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s DescribeReservedDBInstancesOfferingsInput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
func (s *DescribeReservedDBInstancesOfferingsInput) Validate() error {
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "DescribeReservedDBInstancesOfferingsInput"}
if s.Filters != nil {
for i, v := range s.Filters {
if v == nil {
continue
}
if err := v.Validate(); err != nil {
invalidParams.AddNested(fmt.Sprintf("%s[%v]", "Filters", i), err.(request.ErrInvalidParams))
}
}
}
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
return invalidParams
}
return nil
}
// SetDBInstanceClass sets the DBInstanceClass field's value.
func (s *DescribeReservedDBInstancesOfferingsInput) SetDBInstanceClass(v string) *DescribeReservedDBInstancesOfferingsInput {
s.DBInstanceClass = &v
return s
}
// SetDuration sets the Duration field's value.
func (s *DescribeReservedDBInstancesOfferingsInput) SetDuration(v string) *DescribeReservedDBInstancesOfferingsInput {
s.Duration = &v
return s
}
// SetFilters sets the Filters field's value.
func (s *DescribeReservedDBInstancesOfferingsInput) SetFilters(v []*Filter) *DescribeReservedDBInstancesOfferingsInput {
s.Filters = v
return s
}
// SetMarker sets the Marker field's value.
func (s *DescribeReservedDBInstancesOfferingsInput) SetMarker(v string) *DescribeReservedDBInstancesOfferingsInput {
s.Marker = &v
return s
}
// SetMaxRecords sets the MaxRecords field's value.
func (s *DescribeReservedDBInstancesOfferingsInput) SetMaxRecords(v int64) *DescribeReservedDBInstancesOfferingsInput {
s.MaxRecords = &v
return s
}
// SetMultiAZ sets the MultiAZ field's value.
func (s *DescribeReservedDBInstancesOfferingsInput) SetMultiAZ(v bool) *DescribeReservedDBInstancesOfferingsInput {
s.MultiAZ = &v
return s
}
// SetOfferingType sets the OfferingType field's value.
func (s *DescribeReservedDBInstancesOfferingsInput) SetOfferingType(v string) *DescribeReservedDBInstancesOfferingsInput {
s.OfferingType = &v
return s
}
// SetProductDescription sets the ProductDescription field's value.
func (s *DescribeReservedDBInstancesOfferingsInput) SetProductDescription(v string) *DescribeReservedDBInstancesOfferingsInput {
s.ProductDescription = &v
return s
}
// SetReservedDBInstancesOfferingId sets the ReservedDBInstancesOfferingId field's value.
func (s *DescribeReservedDBInstancesOfferingsInput) SetReservedDBInstancesOfferingId(v string) *DescribeReservedDBInstancesOfferingsInput {
s.ReservedDBInstancesOfferingId = &v
return s
}
// Contains the result of a successful invocation of the DescribeReservedDBInstancesOfferings
// action.
type DescribeReservedDBInstancesOfferingsOutput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// An optional pagination token provided by a previous request. If this parameter
// is specified, the response includes only records beyond the marker, up to
// the value specified by MaxRecords.
Marker *string `type:"string"`
// A list of reserved DB instance offerings.
ReservedDBInstancesOfferings []*ReservedDBInstancesOffering `locationNameList:"ReservedDBInstancesOffering" type:"list"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s DescribeReservedDBInstancesOfferingsOutput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s DescribeReservedDBInstancesOfferingsOutput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetMarker sets the Marker field's value.
func (s *DescribeReservedDBInstancesOfferingsOutput) SetMarker(v string) *DescribeReservedDBInstancesOfferingsOutput {
s.Marker = &v
return s
}
// SetReservedDBInstancesOfferings sets the ReservedDBInstancesOfferings field's value.
func (s *DescribeReservedDBInstancesOfferingsOutput) SetReservedDBInstancesOfferings(v []*ReservedDBInstancesOffering) *DescribeReservedDBInstancesOfferingsOutput {
s.ReservedDBInstancesOfferings = v
return s
}
// Contains the result of a successful invocation of the DescribeReservedDBInstances
// action.
type DescribeReservedDBInstancesOutput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// An optional pagination token provided by a previous request. If this parameter
// is specified, the response includes only records beyond the marker, up to
// the value specified by MaxRecords.
Marker *string `type:"string"`
// A list of reserved DB instances.
ReservedDBInstances []*ReservedDBInstance `locationNameList:"ReservedDBInstance" type:"list"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s DescribeReservedDBInstancesOutput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s DescribeReservedDBInstancesOutput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetMarker sets the Marker field's value.
func (s *DescribeReservedDBInstancesOutput) SetMarker(v string) *DescribeReservedDBInstancesOutput {
s.Marker = &v
return s
}
// SetReservedDBInstances sets the ReservedDBInstances field's value.
func (s *DescribeReservedDBInstancesOutput) SetReservedDBInstances(v []*ReservedDBInstance) *DescribeReservedDBInstancesOutput {
s.ReservedDBInstances = v
return s
}
type DescribeSourceRegionsInput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// This parameter is not currently supported.
Filters []*Filter `locationNameList:"Filter" type:"list"`
// An optional pagination token provided by a previous DescribeSourceRegions
// request. If this parameter is specified, the response includes only records
// beyond the marker, up to the value specified by MaxRecords.
Marker *string `type:"string"`
// The maximum number of records to include in the response. If more records
// exist than the specified MaxRecords value, a pagination token called a marker
// is included in the response so that the remaining results can be retrieved.
//
// Default: 100
//
// Constraints: Minimum 20, maximum 100.
MaxRecords *int64 `type:"integer"`
// The source AWS Region name. For example, us-east-1.
//
// Constraints:
//
// * Must specify a valid AWS Region name.
RegionName *string `type:"string"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s DescribeSourceRegionsInput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s DescribeSourceRegionsInput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
func (s *DescribeSourceRegionsInput) Validate() error {
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "DescribeSourceRegionsInput"}
if s.Filters != nil {
for i, v := range s.Filters {
if v == nil {
continue
}
if err := v.Validate(); err != nil {
invalidParams.AddNested(fmt.Sprintf("%s[%v]", "Filters", i), err.(request.ErrInvalidParams))
}
}
}
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
return invalidParams
}
return nil
}
// SetFilters sets the Filters field's value.
func (s *DescribeSourceRegionsInput) SetFilters(v []*Filter) *DescribeSourceRegionsInput {
s.Filters = v
return s
}
// SetMarker sets the Marker field's value.
func (s *DescribeSourceRegionsInput) SetMarker(v string) *DescribeSourceRegionsInput {
s.Marker = &v
return s
}
// SetMaxRecords sets the MaxRecords field's value.
func (s *DescribeSourceRegionsInput) SetMaxRecords(v int64) *DescribeSourceRegionsInput {
s.MaxRecords = &v
return s
}
// SetRegionName sets the RegionName field's value.
func (s *DescribeSourceRegionsInput) SetRegionName(v string) *DescribeSourceRegionsInput {
s.RegionName = &v
return s
}
// Contains the result of a successful invocation of the DescribeSourceRegions
// action.
type DescribeSourceRegionsOutput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// An optional pagination token provided by a previous request. If this parameter
// is specified, the response includes only records beyond the marker, up to
// the value specified by MaxRecords.
Marker *string `type:"string"`
// A list of SourceRegion instances that contains each source AWS Region that
// the current AWS Region can get a Read Replica or a DB snapshot from.
SourceRegions []*SourceRegion `locationNameList:"SourceRegion" type:"list"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s DescribeSourceRegionsOutput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s DescribeSourceRegionsOutput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetMarker sets the Marker field's value.
func (s *DescribeSourceRegionsOutput) SetMarker(v string) *DescribeSourceRegionsOutput {
s.Marker = &v
return s
}
// SetSourceRegions sets the SourceRegions field's value.
func (s *DescribeSourceRegionsOutput) SetSourceRegions(v []*SourceRegion) *DescribeSourceRegionsOutput {
s.SourceRegions = v
return s
}
type DescribeValidDBInstanceModificationsInput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// The customer identifier or the ARN of your DB instance.
//
// DBInstanceIdentifier is a required field
DBInstanceIdentifier *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s DescribeValidDBInstanceModificationsInput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s DescribeValidDBInstanceModificationsInput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
func (s *DescribeValidDBInstanceModificationsInput) Validate() error {
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "DescribeValidDBInstanceModificationsInput"}
if s.DBInstanceIdentifier == nil {
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("DBInstanceIdentifier"))
}
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
return invalidParams
}
return nil
}
// SetDBInstanceIdentifier sets the DBInstanceIdentifier field's value.
func (s *DescribeValidDBInstanceModificationsInput) SetDBInstanceIdentifier(v string) *DescribeValidDBInstanceModificationsInput {
s.DBInstanceIdentifier = &v
return s
}
type DescribeValidDBInstanceModificationsOutput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// Information about valid modifications that you can make to your DB instance.
// Contains the result of a successful call to the DescribeValidDBInstanceModifications
// action. You can use this information when you call ModifyDBInstance.
ValidDBInstanceModificationsMessage *ValidDBInstanceModificationsMessage `type:"structure"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s DescribeValidDBInstanceModificationsOutput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s DescribeValidDBInstanceModificationsOutput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetValidDBInstanceModificationsMessage sets the ValidDBInstanceModificationsMessage field's value.
func (s *DescribeValidDBInstanceModificationsOutput) SetValidDBInstanceModificationsMessage(v *ValidDBInstanceModificationsMessage) *DescribeValidDBInstanceModificationsOutput {
s.ValidDBInstanceModificationsMessage = v
return s
}
// An Active Directory Domain membership record associated with the DB instance.
type DomainMembership struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// The identifier of the Active Directory Domain.
Domain *string `type:"string"`
// The fully qualified domain name of the Active Directory Domain.
FQDN *string `type:"string"`
// The name of the IAM role to be used when making API calls to the Directory
// Service.
IAMRoleName *string `type:"string"`
// The status of the DB instance's Active Directory Domain membership, such
// as joined, pending-join, failed etc).
Status *string `type:"string"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s DomainMembership) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s DomainMembership) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetDomain sets the Domain field's value.
func (s *DomainMembership) SetDomain(v string) *DomainMembership {
s.Domain = &v
return s
}
// SetFQDN sets the FQDN field's value.
func (s *DomainMembership) SetFQDN(v string) *DomainMembership {
s.FQDN = &v
return s
}
// SetIAMRoleName sets the IAMRoleName field's value.
func (s *DomainMembership) SetIAMRoleName(v string) *DomainMembership {
s.IAMRoleName = &v
return s
}
// SetStatus sets the Status field's value.
func (s *DomainMembership) SetStatus(v string) *DomainMembership {
s.Status = &v
return s
}
// A range of double values.
type DoubleRange struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// The minimum value in the range.
From *float64 `type:"double"`
// The maximum value in the range.
To *float64 `type:"double"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s DoubleRange) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s DoubleRange) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetFrom sets the From field's value.
func (s *DoubleRange) SetFrom(v float64) *DoubleRange {
s.From = &v
return s
}
// SetTo sets the To field's value.
func (s *DoubleRange) SetTo(v float64) *DoubleRange {
s.To = &v
return s
}
type DownloadDBLogFilePortionInput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// The customer-assigned name of the DB instance that contains the log files
// you want to list.
//
// Constraints:
//
// * Must match the identifier of an existing DBInstance.
//
// DBInstanceIdentifier is a required field
DBInstanceIdentifier *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
// The name of the log file to be downloaded.
//
// LogFileName is a required field
LogFileName *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
// The pagination token provided in the previous request or "0". If the Marker
// parameter is specified the response includes only records beyond the marker
// until the end of the file or up to NumberOfLines.
Marker *string `type:"string"`
// The number of lines to download. If the number of lines specified results
// in a file over 1 MB in size, the file is truncated at 1 MB in size.
//
// If the NumberOfLines parameter is specified, then the block of lines returned
// can be from the beginning or the end of the log file, depending on the value
// of the Marker parameter.
//
// * If neither Marker or NumberOfLines are specified, the entire log file
// is returned up to a maximum of 10000 lines, starting with the most recent
// log entries first.
//
// * If NumberOfLines is specified and Marker is not specified, then the
// most recent lines from the end of the log file are returned.
//
// * If Marker is specified as "0", then the specified number of lines from
// the beginning of the log file are returned.
//
// * You can download the log file in blocks of lines by specifying the size
// of the block using the NumberOfLines parameter, and by specifying a value
// of "0" for the Marker parameter in your first request. Include the Marker
// value returned in the response as the Marker value for the next request,
// continuing until the AdditionalDataPending response element returns false.
NumberOfLines *int64 `type:"integer"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s DownloadDBLogFilePortionInput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s DownloadDBLogFilePortionInput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
func (s *DownloadDBLogFilePortionInput) Validate() error {
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "DownloadDBLogFilePortionInput"}
if s.DBInstanceIdentifier == nil {
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("DBInstanceIdentifier"))
}
if s.LogFileName == nil {
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("LogFileName"))
}
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
return invalidParams
}
return nil
}
// SetDBInstanceIdentifier sets the DBInstanceIdentifier field's value.
func (s *DownloadDBLogFilePortionInput) SetDBInstanceIdentifier(v string) *DownloadDBLogFilePortionInput {
s.DBInstanceIdentifier = &v
return s
}
// SetLogFileName sets the LogFileName field's value.
func (s *DownloadDBLogFilePortionInput) SetLogFileName(v string) *DownloadDBLogFilePortionInput {
s.LogFileName = &v
return s
}
// SetMarker sets the Marker field's value.
func (s *DownloadDBLogFilePortionInput) SetMarker(v string) *DownloadDBLogFilePortionInput {
s.Marker = &v
return s
}
// SetNumberOfLines sets the NumberOfLines field's value.
func (s *DownloadDBLogFilePortionInput) SetNumberOfLines(v int64) *DownloadDBLogFilePortionInput {
s.NumberOfLines = &v
return s
}
// This data type is used as a response element to DownloadDBLogFilePortion.
type DownloadDBLogFilePortionOutput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// Boolean value that if true, indicates there is more data to be downloaded.
AdditionalDataPending *bool `type:"boolean"`
// Entries from the specified log file.
LogFileData *string `type:"string"`
// A pagination token that can be used in a subsequent DownloadDBLogFilePortion
// request.
Marker *string `type:"string"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s DownloadDBLogFilePortionOutput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s DownloadDBLogFilePortionOutput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetAdditionalDataPending sets the AdditionalDataPending field's value.
func (s *DownloadDBLogFilePortionOutput) SetAdditionalDataPending(v bool) *DownloadDBLogFilePortionOutput {
s.AdditionalDataPending = &v
return s
}
// SetLogFileData sets the LogFileData field's value.
func (s *DownloadDBLogFilePortionOutput) SetLogFileData(v string) *DownloadDBLogFilePortionOutput {
s.LogFileData = &v
return s
}
// SetMarker sets the Marker field's value.
func (s *DownloadDBLogFilePortionOutput) SetMarker(v string) *DownloadDBLogFilePortionOutput {
s.Marker = &v
return s
}
// This data type is used as a response element in the following actions:
//
// * AuthorizeDBSecurityGroupIngress
//
// * DescribeDBSecurityGroups
//
// * RevokeDBSecurityGroupIngress
type EC2SecurityGroup struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// Specifies the id of the EC2 security group.
EC2SecurityGroupId *string `type:"string"`
// Specifies the name of the EC2 security group.
EC2SecurityGroupName *string `type:"string"`
// Specifies the AWS ID of the owner of the EC2 security group specified in
// the EC2SecurityGroupName field.
EC2SecurityGroupOwnerId *string `type:"string"`
// Provides the status of the EC2 security group. Status can be "authorizing",
// "authorized", "revoking", and "revoked".
Status *string `type:"string"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s EC2SecurityGroup) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s EC2SecurityGroup) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetEC2SecurityGroupId sets the EC2SecurityGroupId field's value.
func (s *EC2SecurityGroup) SetEC2SecurityGroupId(v string) *EC2SecurityGroup {
s.EC2SecurityGroupId = &v
return s
}
// SetEC2SecurityGroupName sets the EC2SecurityGroupName field's value.
func (s *EC2SecurityGroup) SetEC2SecurityGroupName(v string) *EC2SecurityGroup {
s.EC2SecurityGroupName = &v
return s
}
// SetEC2SecurityGroupOwnerId sets the EC2SecurityGroupOwnerId field's value.
func (s *EC2SecurityGroup) SetEC2SecurityGroupOwnerId(v string) *EC2SecurityGroup {
s.EC2SecurityGroupOwnerId = &v
return s
}
// SetStatus sets the Status field's value.
func (s *EC2SecurityGroup) SetStatus(v string) *EC2SecurityGroup {
s.Status = &v
return s
}
// This data type represents the information you need to connect to an Amazon
// RDS DB instance. This data type is used as a response element in the following
// actions:
//
// * CreateDBInstance
//
// * DescribeDBInstances
//
// * DeleteDBInstance
//
// For the data structure that represents Amazon Aurora DB cluster endpoints,
// see DBClusterEndpoint.
type Endpoint struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// Specifies the DNS address of the DB instance.
Address *string `type:"string"`
// Specifies the ID that Amazon Route 53 assigns when you create a hosted zone.
HostedZoneId *string `type:"string"`
// Specifies the port that the database engine is listening on.
Port *int64 `type:"integer"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s Endpoint) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s Endpoint) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetAddress sets the Address field's value.
func (s *Endpoint) SetAddress(v string) *Endpoint {
s.Address = &v
return s
}
// SetHostedZoneId sets the HostedZoneId field's value.
func (s *Endpoint) SetHostedZoneId(v string) *Endpoint {
s.HostedZoneId = &v
return s
}
// SetPort sets the Port field's value.
func (s *Endpoint) SetPort(v int64) *Endpoint {
s.Port = &v
return s
}
// Contains the result of a successful invocation of the DescribeEngineDefaultParameters
// action.
type EngineDefaults struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// Specifies the name of the DB parameter group family that the engine default
// parameters apply to.
DBParameterGroupFamily *string `type:"string"`
// An optional pagination token provided by a previous EngineDefaults request.
// If this parameter is specified, the response includes only records beyond
// the marker, up to the value specified by MaxRecords .
Marker *string `type:"string"`
// Contains a list of engine default parameters.
Parameters []*Parameter `locationNameList:"Parameter" type:"list"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s EngineDefaults) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s EngineDefaults) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetDBParameterGroupFamily sets the DBParameterGroupFamily field's value.
func (s *EngineDefaults) SetDBParameterGroupFamily(v string) *EngineDefaults {
s.DBParameterGroupFamily = &v
return s
}
// SetMarker sets the Marker field's value.
func (s *EngineDefaults) SetMarker(v string) *EngineDefaults {
s.Marker = &v
return s
}
// SetParameters sets the Parameters field's value.
func (s *EngineDefaults) SetParameters(v []*Parameter) *EngineDefaults {
s.Parameters = v
return s
}
// This data type is used as a response element in the DescribeEvents action.
type Event struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// Specifies the date and time of the event.
Date *time.Time `type:"timestamp"`
// Specifies the category for the event.
EventCategories []*string `locationNameList:"EventCategory" type:"list"`
// Provides the text of this event.
Message *string `type:"string"`
// The Amazon Resource Name (ARN) for the event.
SourceArn *string `type:"string"`
// Provides the identifier for the source of the event.
SourceIdentifier *string `type:"string"`
// Specifies the source type for this event.
SourceType *string `type:"string" enum:"SourceType"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s Event) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s Event) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetDate sets the Date field's value.
func (s *Event) SetDate(v time.Time) *Event {
s.Date = &v
return s
}
// SetEventCategories sets the EventCategories field's value.
func (s *Event) SetEventCategories(v []*string) *Event {
s.EventCategories = v
return s
}
// SetMessage sets the Message field's value.
func (s *Event) SetMessage(v string) *Event {
s.Message = &v
return s
}
// SetSourceArn sets the SourceArn field's value.
func (s *Event) SetSourceArn(v string) *Event {
s.SourceArn = &v
return s
}
// SetSourceIdentifier sets the SourceIdentifier field's value.
func (s *Event) SetSourceIdentifier(v string) *Event {
s.SourceIdentifier = &v
return s
}
// SetSourceType sets the SourceType field's value.
func (s *Event) SetSourceType(v string) *Event {
s.SourceType = &v
return s
}
// Contains the results of a successful invocation of the DescribeEventCategories
// action.
type EventCategoriesMap struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// The event categories for the specified source type
EventCategories []*string `locationNameList:"EventCategory" type:"list"`
// The source type that the returned categories belong to
SourceType *string `type:"string"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s EventCategoriesMap) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s EventCategoriesMap) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetEventCategories sets the EventCategories field's value.
func (s *EventCategoriesMap) SetEventCategories(v []*string) *EventCategoriesMap {
s.EventCategories = v
return s
}
// SetSourceType sets the SourceType field's value.
func (s *EventCategoriesMap) SetSourceType(v string) *EventCategoriesMap {
s.SourceType = &v
return s
}
// Contains the results of a successful invocation of the DescribeEventSubscriptions
// action.
type EventSubscription struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// The RDS event notification subscription Id.
CustSubscriptionId *string `type:"string"`
// The AWS customer account associated with the RDS event notification subscription.
CustomerAwsId *string `type:"string"`
// A Boolean value indicating if the subscription is enabled. True indicates
// the subscription is enabled.
Enabled *bool `type:"boolean"`
// A list of event categories for the RDS event notification subscription.
EventCategoriesList []*string `locationNameList:"EventCategory" type:"list"`
// The Amazon Resource Name (ARN) for the event subscription.
EventSubscriptionArn *string `type:"string"`
// The topic ARN of the RDS event notification subscription.
SnsTopicArn *string `type:"string"`
// A list of source IDs for the RDS event notification subscription.
SourceIdsList []*string `locationNameList:"SourceId" type:"list"`
// The source type for the RDS event notification subscription.
SourceType *string `type:"string"`
// The status of the RDS event notification subscription.
//
// Constraints:
//
// Can be one of the following: creating | modifying | deleting | active | no-permission
// | topic-not-exist
//
// The status "no-permission" indicates that RDS no longer has permission to
// post to the SNS topic. The status "topic-not-exist" indicates that the topic
// was deleted after the subscription was created.
Status *string `type:"string"`
// The time the RDS event notification subscription was created.
SubscriptionCreationTime *string `type:"string"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s EventSubscription) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s EventSubscription) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetCustSubscriptionId sets the CustSubscriptionId field's value.
func (s *EventSubscription) SetCustSubscriptionId(v string) *EventSubscription {
s.CustSubscriptionId = &v
return s
}
// SetCustomerAwsId sets the CustomerAwsId field's value.
func (s *EventSubscription) SetCustomerAwsId(v string) *EventSubscription {
s.CustomerAwsId = &v
return s
}
// SetEnabled sets the Enabled field's value.
func (s *EventSubscription) SetEnabled(v bool) *EventSubscription {
s.Enabled = &v
return s
}
// SetEventCategoriesList sets the EventCategoriesList field's value.
func (s *EventSubscription) SetEventCategoriesList(v []*string) *EventSubscription {
s.EventCategoriesList = v
return s
}
// SetEventSubscriptionArn sets the EventSubscriptionArn field's value.
func (s *EventSubscription) SetEventSubscriptionArn(v string) *EventSubscription {
s.EventSubscriptionArn = &v
return s
}
// SetSnsTopicArn sets the SnsTopicArn field's value.
func (s *EventSubscription) SetSnsTopicArn(v string) *EventSubscription {
s.SnsTopicArn = &v
return s
}
// SetSourceIdsList sets the SourceIdsList field's value.
func (s *EventSubscription) SetSourceIdsList(v []*string) *EventSubscription {
s.SourceIdsList = v
return s
}
// SetSourceType sets the SourceType field's value.
func (s *EventSubscription) SetSourceType(v string) *EventSubscription {
s.SourceType = &v
return s
}
// SetStatus sets the Status field's value.
func (s *EventSubscription) SetStatus(v string) *EventSubscription {
s.Status = &v
return s
}
// SetSubscriptionCreationTime sets the SubscriptionCreationTime field's value.
func (s *EventSubscription) SetSubscriptionCreationTime(v string) *EventSubscription {
s.SubscriptionCreationTime = &v
return s
}
type FailoverDBClusterInput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// A DB cluster identifier to force a failover for. This parameter is not case-sensitive.
//
// Constraints:
//
// * Must match the identifier of an existing DBCluster.
//
// DBClusterIdentifier is a required field
DBClusterIdentifier *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
// The name of the instance to promote to the primary instance.
//
// You must specify the instance identifier for an Aurora Replica in the DB
// cluster. For example, mydbcluster-replica1.
TargetDBInstanceIdentifier *string `type:"string"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s FailoverDBClusterInput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s FailoverDBClusterInput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
func (s *FailoverDBClusterInput) Validate() error {
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "FailoverDBClusterInput"}
if s.DBClusterIdentifier == nil {
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("DBClusterIdentifier"))
}
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
return invalidParams
}
return nil
}
// SetDBClusterIdentifier sets the DBClusterIdentifier field's value.
func (s *FailoverDBClusterInput) SetDBClusterIdentifier(v string) *FailoverDBClusterInput {
s.DBClusterIdentifier = &v
return s
}
// SetTargetDBInstanceIdentifier sets the TargetDBInstanceIdentifier field's value.
func (s *FailoverDBClusterInput) SetTargetDBInstanceIdentifier(v string) *FailoverDBClusterInput {
s.TargetDBInstanceIdentifier = &v
return s
}
type FailoverDBClusterOutput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// Contains the details of an Amazon Aurora DB cluster.
//
// This data type is used as a response element in the DescribeDBClusters, StopDBCluster,
// and StartDBCluster actions.
DBCluster *DBCluster `type:"structure"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s FailoverDBClusterOutput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s FailoverDBClusterOutput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetDBCluster sets the DBCluster field's value.
func (s *FailoverDBClusterOutput) SetDBCluster(v *DBCluster) *FailoverDBClusterOutput {
s.DBCluster = v
return s
}
// A filter name and value pair that is used to return a more specific list
// of results from a describe operation. Filters can be used to match a set
// of resources by specific criteria, such as IDs. The filters supported by
// a describe operation are documented with the describe operation.
//
// Currently, wildcards are not supported in filters.
//
// The following actions can be filtered:
//
// * DescribeDBClusterBacktracks
//
// * DescribeDBClusterEndpoints
//
// * DescribeDBClusters
//
// * DescribeDBInstances
//
// * DescribePendingMaintenanceActions
type Filter struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// The name of the filter. Filter names are case-sensitive.
//
// Name is a required field
Name *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
// One or more filter values. Filter values are case-sensitive.
//
// Values is a required field
Values []*string `locationNameList:"Value" type:"list" required:"true"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s Filter) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s Filter) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
func (s *Filter) Validate() error {
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "Filter"}
if s.Name == nil {
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Name"))
}
if s.Values == nil {
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Values"))
}
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
return invalidParams
}
return nil
}
// SetName sets the Name field's value.
func (s *Filter) SetName(v string) *Filter {
s.Name = &v
return s
}
// SetValues sets the Values field's value.
func (s *Filter) SetValues(v []*string) *Filter {
s.Values = v
return s
}
// A data type representing an Aurora global database.
type GlobalCluster struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// The default database name within the new global database cluster.
DatabaseName *string `type:"string"`
// The deletion protection setting for the new global database cluster.
DeletionProtection *bool `type:"boolean"`
// The Aurora database engine used by the global database cluster.
Engine *string `type:"string"`
// Indicates the database engine version.
EngineVersion *string `type:"string"`
// The Amazon Resource Name (ARN) for the global database cluster.
GlobalClusterArn *string `type:"string"`
// Contains a user-supplied global database cluster identifier. This identifier
// is the unique key that identifies a global database cluster.
GlobalClusterIdentifier *string `type:"string"`
// The list of cluster IDs for secondary clusters within the global database
// cluster. Currently limited to 1 item.
GlobalClusterMembers []*GlobalClusterMember `locationNameList:"GlobalClusterMember" type:"list"`
// The AWS Region-unique, immutable identifier for the global database cluster.
// This identifier is found in AWS CloudTrail log entries whenever the AWS KMS
// key for the DB cluster is accessed.
GlobalClusterResourceId *string `type:"string"`
// Specifies the current state of this global database cluster.
Status *string `type:"string"`
// The storage encryption setting for the global database cluster.
StorageEncrypted *bool `type:"boolean"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s GlobalCluster) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s GlobalCluster) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetDatabaseName sets the DatabaseName field's value.
func (s *GlobalCluster) SetDatabaseName(v string) *GlobalCluster {
s.DatabaseName = &v
return s
}
// SetDeletionProtection sets the DeletionProtection field's value.
func (s *GlobalCluster) SetDeletionProtection(v bool) *GlobalCluster {
s.DeletionProtection = &v
return s
}
// SetEngine sets the Engine field's value.
func (s *GlobalCluster) SetEngine(v string) *GlobalCluster {
s.Engine = &v
return s
}
// SetEngineVersion sets the EngineVersion field's value.
func (s *GlobalCluster) SetEngineVersion(v string) *GlobalCluster {
s.EngineVersion = &v
return s
}
// SetGlobalClusterArn sets the GlobalClusterArn field's value.
func (s *GlobalCluster) SetGlobalClusterArn(v string) *GlobalCluster {
s.GlobalClusterArn = &v
return s
}
// SetGlobalClusterIdentifier sets the GlobalClusterIdentifier field's value.
func (s *GlobalCluster) SetGlobalClusterIdentifier(v string) *GlobalCluster {
s.GlobalClusterIdentifier = &v
return s
}
// SetGlobalClusterMembers sets the GlobalClusterMembers field's value.
func (s *GlobalCluster) SetGlobalClusterMembers(v []*GlobalClusterMember) *GlobalCluster {
s.GlobalClusterMembers = v
return s
}
// SetGlobalClusterResourceId sets the GlobalClusterResourceId field's value.
func (s *GlobalCluster) SetGlobalClusterResourceId(v string) *GlobalCluster {
s.GlobalClusterResourceId = &v
return s
}
// SetStatus sets the Status field's value.
func (s *GlobalCluster) SetStatus(v string) *GlobalCluster {
s.Status = &v
return s
}
// SetStorageEncrypted sets the StorageEncrypted field's value.
func (s *GlobalCluster) SetStorageEncrypted(v bool) *GlobalCluster {
s.StorageEncrypted = &v
return s
}
// A data structure with information about any primary and secondary clusters
// associated with an Aurora global database.
type GlobalClusterMember struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// The Amazon Resource Name (ARN) for each Aurora cluster.
DBClusterArn *string `type:"string"`
// Specifies whether the Aurora cluster is the primary cluster (that is, has
// read-write capability) for the Aurora global database with which it is associated.
IsWriter *bool `type:"boolean"`
// The Amazon Resource Name (ARN) for each read-only secondary cluster associated
// with the Aurora global database.
Readers []*string `type:"list"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s GlobalClusterMember) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s GlobalClusterMember) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetDBClusterArn sets the DBClusterArn field's value.
func (s *GlobalClusterMember) SetDBClusterArn(v string) *GlobalClusterMember {
s.DBClusterArn = &v
return s
}
// SetIsWriter sets the IsWriter field's value.
func (s *GlobalClusterMember) SetIsWriter(v bool) *GlobalClusterMember {
s.IsWriter = &v
return s
}
// SetReaders sets the Readers field's value.
func (s *GlobalClusterMember) SetReaders(v []*string) *GlobalClusterMember {
s.Readers = v
return s
}
// This data type is used as a response element in the DescribeDBSecurityGroups
// action.
type IPRange struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// Specifies the IP range.
CIDRIP *string `type:"string"`
// Specifies the status of the IP range. Status can be "authorizing", "authorized",
// "revoking", and "revoked".
Status *string `type:"string"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s IPRange) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s IPRange) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetCIDRIP sets the CIDRIP field's value.
func (s *IPRange) SetCIDRIP(v string) *IPRange {
s.CIDRIP = &v
return s
}
// SetStatus sets the Status field's value.
func (s *IPRange) SetStatus(v string) *IPRange {
s.Status = &v
return s
}
type ListTagsForResourceInput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// This parameter is not currently supported.
Filters []*Filter `locationNameList:"Filter" type:"list"`
// The Amazon RDS resource with tags to be listed. This value is an Amazon Resource
// Name (ARN). For information about creating an ARN, see Constructing an ARN
// for Amazon RDS (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/UserGuide/USER_Tagging.ARN.html#USER_Tagging.ARN.Constructing)
// in the Amazon RDS User Guide.
//
// ResourceName is a required field
ResourceName *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s ListTagsForResourceInput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s ListTagsForResourceInput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
func (s *ListTagsForResourceInput) Validate() error {
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "ListTagsForResourceInput"}
if s.ResourceName == nil {
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("ResourceName"))
}
if s.Filters != nil {
for i, v := range s.Filters {
if v == nil {
continue
}
if err := v.Validate(); err != nil {
invalidParams.AddNested(fmt.Sprintf("%s[%v]", "Filters", i), err.(request.ErrInvalidParams))
}
}
}
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
return invalidParams
}
return nil
}
// SetFilters sets the Filters field's value.
func (s *ListTagsForResourceInput) SetFilters(v []*Filter) *ListTagsForResourceInput {
s.Filters = v
return s
}
// SetResourceName sets the ResourceName field's value.
func (s *ListTagsForResourceInput) SetResourceName(v string) *ListTagsForResourceInput {
s.ResourceName = &v
return s
}
type ListTagsForResourceOutput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// List of tags returned by the ListTagsForResource operation.
TagList []*Tag `locationNameList:"Tag" type:"list"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s ListTagsForResourceOutput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s ListTagsForResourceOutput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetTagList sets the TagList field's value.
func (s *ListTagsForResourceOutput) SetTagList(v []*Tag) *ListTagsForResourceOutput {
s.TagList = v
return s
}
// The minimum DB engine version required for each corresponding allowed value
// for an option setting.
type MinimumEngineVersionPerAllowedValue struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// The allowed value for an option setting.
AllowedValue *string `type:"string"`
// The minimum DB engine version required for the allowed value.
MinimumEngineVersion *string `type:"string"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s MinimumEngineVersionPerAllowedValue) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s MinimumEngineVersionPerAllowedValue) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetAllowedValue sets the AllowedValue field's value.
func (s *MinimumEngineVersionPerAllowedValue) SetAllowedValue(v string) *MinimumEngineVersionPerAllowedValue {
s.AllowedValue = &v
return s
}
// SetMinimumEngineVersion sets the MinimumEngineVersion field's value.
func (s *MinimumEngineVersionPerAllowedValue) SetMinimumEngineVersion(v string) *MinimumEngineVersionPerAllowedValue {
s.MinimumEngineVersion = &v
return s
}
type ModifyCurrentDBClusterCapacityInput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// The DB cluster capacity.
//
// Constraints:
//
// * Value must be 2, 4, 8, 16, 32, 64, 128, or 256.
Capacity *int64 `type:"integer"`
// The DB cluster identifier for the cluster being modified. This parameter
// is not case-sensitive.
//
// Constraints:
//
// * Must match the identifier of an existing DB cluster.
//
// DBClusterIdentifier is a required field
DBClusterIdentifier *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
// The amount of time, in seconds, that Aurora Serverless tries to find a scaling
// point to perform seamless scaling before enforcing the timeout action. The
// default is 300.
//
// * Value must be from 10 through 600.
SecondsBeforeTimeout *int64 `type:"integer"`
// The action to take when the timeout is reached, either ForceApplyCapacityChange
// or RollbackCapacityChange.
//
// ForceApplyCapacityChange, the default, sets the capacity to the specified
// value as soon as possible.
//
// RollbackCapacityChange ignores the capacity change if a scaling point is
// not found in the timeout period.
TimeoutAction *string `type:"string"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s ModifyCurrentDBClusterCapacityInput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s ModifyCurrentDBClusterCapacityInput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
func (s *ModifyCurrentDBClusterCapacityInput) Validate() error {
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "ModifyCurrentDBClusterCapacityInput"}
if s.DBClusterIdentifier == nil {
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("DBClusterIdentifier"))
}
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
return invalidParams
}
return nil
}
// SetCapacity sets the Capacity field's value.
func (s *ModifyCurrentDBClusterCapacityInput) SetCapacity(v int64) *ModifyCurrentDBClusterCapacityInput {
s.Capacity = &v
return s
}
// SetDBClusterIdentifier sets the DBClusterIdentifier field's value.
func (s *ModifyCurrentDBClusterCapacityInput) SetDBClusterIdentifier(v string) *ModifyCurrentDBClusterCapacityInput {
s.DBClusterIdentifier = &v
return s
}
// SetSecondsBeforeTimeout sets the SecondsBeforeTimeout field's value.
func (s *ModifyCurrentDBClusterCapacityInput) SetSecondsBeforeTimeout(v int64) *ModifyCurrentDBClusterCapacityInput {
s.SecondsBeforeTimeout = &v
return s
}
// SetTimeoutAction sets the TimeoutAction field's value.
func (s *ModifyCurrentDBClusterCapacityInput) SetTimeoutAction(v string) *ModifyCurrentDBClusterCapacityInput {
s.TimeoutAction = &v
return s
}
type ModifyCurrentDBClusterCapacityOutput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// The current capacity of the DB cluster.
CurrentCapacity *int64 `type:"integer"`
// A user-supplied DB cluster identifier. This identifier is the unique key
// that identifies a DB cluster.
DBClusterIdentifier *string `type:"string"`
// A value that specifies the capacity that the DB cluster scales to next.
PendingCapacity *int64 `type:"integer"`
// The number of seconds before a call to ModifyCurrentDBClusterCapacity times
// out.
SecondsBeforeTimeout *int64 `type:"integer"`
// The timeout action of a call to ModifyCurrentDBClusterCapacity, either ForceApplyCapacityChange
// or RollbackCapacityChange.
TimeoutAction *string `type:"string"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s ModifyCurrentDBClusterCapacityOutput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s ModifyCurrentDBClusterCapacityOutput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetCurrentCapacity sets the CurrentCapacity field's value.
func (s *ModifyCurrentDBClusterCapacityOutput) SetCurrentCapacity(v int64) *ModifyCurrentDBClusterCapacityOutput {
s.CurrentCapacity = &v
return s
}
// SetDBClusterIdentifier sets the DBClusterIdentifier field's value.
func (s *ModifyCurrentDBClusterCapacityOutput) SetDBClusterIdentifier(v string) *ModifyCurrentDBClusterCapacityOutput {
s.DBClusterIdentifier = &v
return s
}
// SetPendingCapacity sets the PendingCapacity field's value.
func (s *ModifyCurrentDBClusterCapacityOutput) SetPendingCapacity(v int64) *ModifyCurrentDBClusterCapacityOutput {
s.PendingCapacity = &v
return s
}
// SetSecondsBeforeTimeout sets the SecondsBeforeTimeout field's value.
func (s *ModifyCurrentDBClusterCapacityOutput) SetSecondsBeforeTimeout(v int64) *ModifyCurrentDBClusterCapacityOutput {
s.SecondsBeforeTimeout = &v
return s
}
// SetTimeoutAction sets the TimeoutAction field's value.
func (s *ModifyCurrentDBClusterCapacityOutput) SetTimeoutAction(v string) *ModifyCurrentDBClusterCapacityOutput {
s.TimeoutAction = &v
return s
}
type ModifyDBClusterEndpointInput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// The identifier of the endpoint to modify. This parameter is stored as a lowercase
// string.
//
// DBClusterEndpointIdentifier is a required field
DBClusterEndpointIdentifier *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
// The type of the endpoint. One of: READER, ANY.
EndpointType *string `type:"string"`
// List of DB instance identifiers that aren't part of the custom endpoint group.
// All other eligible instances are reachable through the custom endpoint. Only
// relevant if the list of static members is empty.
ExcludedMembers []*string `type:"list"`
// List of DB instance identifiers that are part of the custom endpoint group.
StaticMembers []*string `type:"list"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s ModifyDBClusterEndpointInput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s ModifyDBClusterEndpointInput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
func (s *ModifyDBClusterEndpointInput) Validate() error {
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "ModifyDBClusterEndpointInput"}
if s.DBClusterEndpointIdentifier == nil {
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("DBClusterEndpointIdentifier"))
}
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
return invalidParams
}
return nil
}
// SetDBClusterEndpointIdentifier sets the DBClusterEndpointIdentifier field's value.
func (s *ModifyDBClusterEndpointInput) SetDBClusterEndpointIdentifier(v string) *ModifyDBClusterEndpointInput {
s.DBClusterEndpointIdentifier = &v
return s
}
// SetEndpointType sets the EndpointType field's value.
func (s *ModifyDBClusterEndpointInput) SetEndpointType(v string) *ModifyDBClusterEndpointInput {
s.EndpointType = &v
return s
}
// SetExcludedMembers sets the ExcludedMembers field's value.
func (s *ModifyDBClusterEndpointInput) SetExcludedMembers(v []*string) *ModifyDBClusterEndpointInput {
s.ExcludedMembers = v
return s
}
// SetStaticMembers sets the StaticMembers field's value.
func (s *ModifyDBClusterEndpointInput) SetStaticMembers(v []*string) *ModifyDBClusterEndpointInput {
s.StaticMembers = v
return s
}
// This data type represents the information you need to connect to an Amazon
// Aurora DB cluster. This data type is used as a response element in the following
// actions:
//
// * CreateDBClusterEndpoint
//
// * DescribeDBClusterEndpoints
//
// * ModifyDBClusterEndpoint
//
// * DeleteDBClusterEndpoint
//
// For the data structure that represents Amazon RDS DB instance endpoints,
// see Endpoint.
type ModifyDBClusterEndpointOutput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// The type associated with a custom endpoint. One of: READER, ANY.
CustomEndpointType *string `type:"string"`
// The Amazon Resource Name (ARN) for the endpoint.
DBClusterEndpointArn *string `type:"string"`
// The identifier associated with the endpoint. This parameter is stored as
// a lowercase string.
DBClusterEndpointIdentifier *string `type:"string"`
// A unique system-generated identifier for an endpoint. It remains the same
// for the whole life of the endpoint.
DBClusterEndpointResourceIdentifier *string `type:"string"`
// The DB cluster identifier of the DB cluster associated with the endpoint.
// This parameter is stored as a lowercase string.
DBClusterIdentifier *string `type:"string"`
// The DNS address of the endpoint.
Endpoint *string `type:"string"`
// The type of the endpoint. One of: READER, WRITER, CUSTOM.
EndpointType *string `type:"string"`
// List of DB instance identifiers that aren't part of the custom endpoint group.
// All other eligible instances are reachable through the custom endpoint. Only
// relevant if the list of static members is empty.
ExcludedMembers []*string `type:"list"`
// List of DB instance identifiers that are part of the custom endpoint group.
StaticMembers []*string `type:"list"`
// The current status of the endpoint. One of: creating, available, deleting,
// modifying.
Status *string `type:"string"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s ModifyDBClusterEndpointOutput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s ModifyDBClusterEndpointOutput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetCustomEndpointType sets the CustomEndpointType field's value.
func (s *ModifyDBClusterEndpointOutput) SetCustomEndpointType(v string) *ModifyDBClusterEndpointOutput {
s.CustomEndpointType = &v
return s
}
// SetDBClusterEndpointArn sets the DBClusterEndpointArn field's value.
func (s *ModifyDBClusterEndpointOutput) SetDBClusterEndpointArn(v string) *ModifyDBClusterEndpointOutput {
s.DBClusterEndpointArn = &v
return s
}
// SetDBClusterEndpointIdentifier sets the DBClusterEndpointIdentifier field's value.
func (s *ModifyDBClusterEndpointOutput) SetDBClusterEndpointIdentifier(v string) *ModifyDBClusterEndpointOutput {
s.DBClusterEndpointIdentifier = &v
return s
}
// SetDBClusterEndpointResourceIdentifier sets the DBClusterEndpointResourceIdentifier field's value.
func (s *ModifyDBClusterEndpointOutput) SetDBClusterEndpointResourceIdentifier(v string) *ModifyDBClusterEndpointOutput {
s.DBClusterEndpointResourceIdentifier = &v
return s
}
// SetDBClusterIdentifier sets the DBClusterIdentifier field's value.
func (s *ModifyDBClusterEndpointOutput) SetDBClusterIdentifier(v string) *ModifyDBClusterEndpointOutput {
s.DBClusterIdentifier = &v
return s
}
// SetEndpoint sets the Endpoint field's value.
func (s *ModifyDBClusterEndpointOutput) SetEndpoint(v string) *ModifyDBClusterEndpointOutput {
s.Endpoint = &v
return s
}
// SetEndpointType sets the EndpointType field's value.
func (s *ModifyDBClusterEndpointOutput) SetEndpointType(v string) *ModifyDBClusterEndpointOutput {
s.EndpointType = &v
return s
}
// SetExcludedMembers sets the ExcludedMembers field's value.
func (s *ModifyDBClusterEndpointOutput) SetExcludedMembers(v []*string) *ModifyDBClusterEndpointOutput {
s.ExcludedMembers = v
return s
}
// SetStaticMembers sets the StaticMembers field's value.
func (s *ModifyDBClusterEndpointOutput) SetStaticMembers(v []*string) *ModifyDBClusterEndpointOutput {
s.StaticMembers = v
return s
}
// SetStatus sets the Status field's value.
func (s *ModifyDBClusterEndpointOutput) SetStatus(v string) *ModifyDBClusterEndpointOutput {
s.Status = &v
return s
}
type ModifyDBClusterInput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// A value that specifies whether the modifications in this request and any
// pending modifications are asynchronously applied as soon as possible, regardless
// of the PreferredMaintenanceWindow setting for the DB cluster. If this parameter
// is set to false, changes to the DB cluster are applied during the next maintenance
// window.
//
// The ApplyImmediately parameter only affects the EnableIAMDatabaseAuthentication,
// MasterUserPassword, and NewDBClusterIdentifier values. If you set the ApplyImmediately
// parameter value to false, then changes to the EnableIAMDatabaseAuthentication,
// MasterUserPassword, and NewDBClusterIdentifier values are applied during
// the next maintenance window. All other changes are applied immediately, regardless
// of the value of the ApplyImmediately parameter.
//
// Default: false
ApplyImmediately *bool `type:"boolean"`
// The target backtrack window, in seconds. To disable backtracking, set this
// value to 0.
//
// Default: 0
//
// Constraints:
//
// * If specified, this value must be set to a number from 0 to 259,200 (72
// hours).
BacktrackWindow *int64 `type:"long"`
// The number of days for which automated backups are retained. You must specify
// a minimum value of 1.
//
// Default: 1
//
// Constraints:
//
// * Must be a value from 1 to 35
BackupRetentionPeriod *int64 `type:"integer"`
// The configuration setting for the log types to be enabled for export to CloudWatch
// Logs for a specific DB cluster.
CloudwatchLogsExportConfiguration *CloudwatchLogsExportConfiguration `type:"structure"`
// True to copy all tags from the DB cluster to snapshots of the DB cluster,
// and otherwise false. The default is false.
CopyTagsToSnapshot *bool `type:"boolean"`
// The DB cluster identifier for the cluster being modified. This parameter
// is not case-sensitive.
//
// Constraints:
//
// * Must match the identifier of an existing DBCluster.
//
// DBClusterIdentifier is a required field
DBClusterIdentifier *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
// The name of the DB cluster parameter group to use for the DB cluster.
DBClusterParameterGroupName *string `type:"string"`
// Indicates if the DB cluster has deletion protection enabled. The database
// can't be deleted when this value is set to true.
DeletionProtection *bool `type:"boolean"`
// HTTP endpoint functionality is in beta for Aurora Serverless and is subject
// to change.
//
// A value that indicates whether to enable the HTTP endpoint for an Aurora
// Serverless DB cluster. By default, the HTTP endpoint is disabled.
//
// When enabled, the HTTP endpoint provides a connectionless web service API
// for running SQL queries on the Aurora Serverless DB cluster. You can also
// query your database from inside the RDS console with the query editor.
//
// For more information about Aurora Serverless, see Using Amazon Aurora Serverless
// (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/AuroraUserGuide/aurora-serverless.html)
// in the Amazon Aurora User Guide.
EnableHttpEndpoint *bool `type:"boolean"`
// True to enable mapping of AWS Identity and Access Management (IAM) accounts
// to database accounts, and otherwise false.
//
// Default: false
EnableIAMDatabaseAuthentication *bool `type:"boolean"`
// The version number of the database engine to which you want to upgrade. Changing
// this parameter results in an outage. The change is applied during the next
// maintenance window unless the ApplyImmediately parameter is set to true.
//
// For a list of valid engine versions, see CreateDBCluster, or call DescribeDBEngineVersions.
EngineVersion *string `type:"string"`
// The new password for the master database user. This password can contain
// any printable ASCII character except "/", """, or "@".
//
// Constraints: Must contain from 8 to 41 characters.
MasterUserPassword *string `type:"string"`
// The new DB cluster identifier for the DB cluster when renaming a DB cluster.
// This value is stored as a lowercase string.
//
// Constraints:
//
// * Must contain from 1 to 63 letters, numbers, or hyphens
//
// * The first character must be a letter
//
// * Can't end with a hyphen or contain two consecutive hyphens
//
// Example: my-cluster2
NewDBClusterIdentifier *string `type:"string"`
// A value that indicates that the DB cluster should be associated with the
// specified option group. Changing this parameter doesn't result in an outage
// except in the following case, and the change is applied during the next maintenance
// window unless the ApplyImmediately parameter is set to true for this request.
// If the parameter change results in an option group that enables OEM, this
// change can cause a brief (sub-second) period during which new connections
// are rejected but existing connections are not interrupted.
//
// Permanent options can't be removed from an option group. The option group
// can't be removed from a DB cluster once it is associated with a DB cluster.
OptionGroupName *string `type:"string"`
// The port number on which the DB cluster accepts connections.
//
// Constraints: Value must be 1150-65535
//
// Default: The same port as the original DB cluster.
Port *int64 `type:"integer"`
// The daily time range during which automated backups are created if automated
// backups are enabled, using the BackupRetentionPeriod parameter.
//
// The default is a 30-minute window selected at random from an 8-hour block
// of time for each AWS Region. To see the time blocks available, see Adjusting
// the Preferred DB Cluster Maintenance Window (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/AuroraUserGuide/USER_UpgradeDBInstance.Maintenance.html#AdjustingTheMaintenanceWindow.Aurora)
// in the Amazon Aurora User Guide.
//
// Constraints:
//
// * Must be in the format hh24:mi-hh24:mi.
//
// * Must be in Universal Coordinated Time (UTC).
//
// * Must not conflict with the preferred maintenance window.
//
// * Must be at least 30 minutes.
PreferredBackupWindow *string `type:"string"`
// The weekly time range during which system maintenance can occur, in Universal
// Coordinated Time (UTC).
//
// Format: ddd:hh24:mi-ddd:hh24:mi
//
// The default is a 30-minute window selected at random from an 8-hour block
// of time for each AWS Region, occurring on a random day of the week. To see
// the time blocks available, see Adjusting the Preferred DB Cluster Maintenance
// Window (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/AuroraUserGuide/USER_UpgradeDBInstance.Maintenance.html#AdjustingTheMaintenanceWindow.Aurora)
// in the Amazon Aurora User Guide.
//
// Valid Days: Mon, Tue, Wed, Thu, Fri, Sat, Sun.
//
// Constraints: Minimum 30-minute window.
PreferredMaintenanceWindow *string `type:"string"`
// The scaling properties of the DB cluster. You can only modify scaling properties
// for DB clusters in serverless DB engine mode.
ScalingConfiguration *ScalingConfiguration `type:"structure"`
// A list of VPC security groups that the DB cluster will belong to.
VpcSecurityGroupIds []*string `locationNameList:"VpcSecurityGroupId" type:"list"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s ModifyDBClusterInput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s ModifyDBClusterInput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
func (s *ModifyDBClusterInput) Validate() error {
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "ModifyDBClusterInput"}
if s.DBClusterIdentifier == nil {
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("DBClusterIdentifier"))
}
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
return invalidParams
}
return nil
}
// SetApplyImmediately sets the ApplyImmediately field's value.
func (s *ModifyDBClusterInput) SetApplyImmediately(v bool) *ModifyDBClusterInput {
s.ApplyImmediately = &v
return s
}
// SetBacktrackWindow sets the BacktrackWindow field's value.
func (s *ModifyDBClusterInput) SetBacktrackWindow(v int64) *ModifyDBClusterInput {
s.BacktrackWindow = &v
return s
}
// SetBackupRetentionPeriod sets the BackupRetentionPeriod field's value.
func (s *ModifyDBClusterInput) SetBackupRetentionPeriod(v int64) *ModifyDBClusterInput {
s.BackupRetentionPeriod = &v
return s
}
// SetCloudwatchLogsExportConfiguration sets the CloudwatchLogsExportConfiguration field's value.
func (s *ModifyDBClusterInput) SetCloudwatchLogsExportConfiguration(v *CloudwatchLogsExportConfiguration) *ModifyDBClusterInput {
s.CloudwatchLogsExportConfiguration = v
return s
}
// SetCopyTagsToSnapshot sets the CopyTagsToSnapshot field's value.
func (s *ModifyDBClusterInput) SetCopyTagsToSnapshot(v bool) *ModifyDBClusterInput {
s.CopyTagsToSnapshot = &v
return s
}
// SetDBClusterIdentifier sets the DBClusterIdentifier field's value.
func (s *ModifyDBClusterInput) SetDBClusterIdentifier(v string) *ModifyDBClusterInput {
s.DBClusterIdentifier = &v
return s
}
// SetDBClusterParameterGroupName sets the DBClusterParameterGroupName field's value.
func (s *ModifyDBClusterInput) SetDBClusterParameterGroupName(v string) *ModifyDBClusterInput {
s.DBClusterParameterGroupName = &v
return s
}
// SetDeletionProtection sets the DeletionProtection field's value.
func (s *ModifyDBClusterInput) SetDeletionProtection(v bool) *ModifyDBClusterInput {
s.DeletionProtection = &v
return s
}
// SetEnableHttpEndpoint sets the EnableHttpEndpoint field's value.
func (s *ModifyDBClusterInput) SetEnableHttpEndpoint(v bool) *ModifyDBClusterInput {
s.EnableHttpEndpoint = &v
return s
}
// SetEnableIAMDatabaseAuthentication sets the EnableIAMDatabaseAuthentication field's value.
func (s *ModifyDBClusterInput) SetEnableIAMDatabaseAuthentication(v bool) *ModifyDBClusterInput {
s.EnableIAMDatabaseAuthentication = &v
return s
}
// SetEngineVersion sets the EngineVersion field's value.
func (s *ModifyDBClusterInput) SetEngineVersion(v string) *ModifyDBClusterInput {
s.EngineVersion = &v
return s
}
// SetMasterUserPassword sets the MasterUserPassword field's value.
func (s *ModifyDBClusterInput) SetMasterUserPassword(v string) *ModifyDBClusterInput {
s.MasterUserPassword = &v
return s
}
// SetNewDBClusterIdentifier sets the NewDBClusterIdentifier field's value.
func (s *ModifyDBClusterInput) SetNewDBClusterIdentifier(v string) *ModifyDBClusterInput {
s.NewDBClusterIdentifier = &v
return s
}
// SetOptionGroupName sets the OptionGroupName field's value.
func (s *ModifyDBClusterInput) SetOptionGroupName(v string) *ModifyDBClusterInput {
s.OptionGroupName = &v
return s
}
// SetPort sets the Port field's value.
func (s *ModifyDBClusterInput) SetPort(v int64) *ModifyDBClusterInput {
s.Port = &v
return s
}
// SetPreferredBackupWindow sets the PreferredBackupWindow field's value.
func (s *ModifyDBClusterInput) SetPreferredBackupWindow(v string) *ModifyDBClusterInput {
s.PreferredBackupWindow = &v
return s
}
// SetPreferredMaintenanceWindow sets the PreferredMaintenanceWindow field's value.
func (s *ModifyDBClusterInput) SetPreferredMaintenanceWindow(v string) *ModifyDBClusterInput {
s.PreferredMaintenanceWindow = &v
return s
}
// SetScalingConfiguration sets the ScalingConfiguration field's value.
func (s *ModifyDBClusterInput) SetScalingConfiguration(v *ScalingConfiguration) *ModifyDBClusterInput {
s.ScalingConfiguration = v
return s
}
// SetVpcSecurityGroupIds sets the VpcSecurityGroupIds field's value.
func (s *ModifyDBClusterInput) SetVpcSecurityGroupIds(v []*string) *ModifyDBClusterInput {
s.VpcSecurityGroupIds = v
return s
}
type ModifyDBClusterOutput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// Contains the details of an Amazon Aurora DB cluster.
//
// This data type is used as a response element in the DescribeDBClusters, StopDBCluster,
// and StartDBCluster actions.
DBCluster *DBCluster `type:"structure"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s ModifyDBClusterOutput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s ModifyDBClusterOutput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetDBCluster sets the DBCluster field's value.
func (s *ModifyDBClusterOutput) SetDBCluster(v *DBCluster) *ModifyDBClusterOutput {
s.DBCluster = v
return s
}
type ModifyDBClusterParameterGroupInput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// The name of the DB cluster parameter group to modify.
//
// DBClusterParameterGroupName is a required field
DBClusterParameterGroupName *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
// A list of parameters in the DB cluster parameter group to modify.
//
// Parameters is a required field
Parameters []*Parameter `locationNameList:"Parameter" type:"list" required:"true"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s ModifyDBClusterParameterGroupInput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s ModifyDBClusterParameterGroupInput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
func (s *ModifyDBClusterParameterGroupInput) Validate() error {
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "ModifyDBClusterParameterGroupInput"}
if s.DBClusterParameterGroupName == nil {
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("DBClusterParameterGroupName"))
}
if s.Parameters == nil {
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Parameters"))
}
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
return invalidParams
}
return nil
}
// SetDBClusterParameterGroupName sets the DBClusterParameterGroupName field's value.
func (s *ModifyDBClusterParameterGroupInput) SetDBClusterParameterGroupName(v string) *ModifyDBClusterParameterGroupInput {
s.DBClusterParameterGroupName = &v
return s
}
// SetParameters sets the Parameters field's value.
func (s *ModifyDBClusterParameterGroupInput) SetParameters(v []*Parameter) *ModifyDBClusterParameterGroupInput {
s.Parameters = v
return s
}
type ModifyDBClusterSnapshotAttributeInput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// The name of the DB cluster snapshot attribute to modify.
//
// To manage authorization for other AWS accounts to copy or restore a manual
// DB cluster snapshot, set this value to restore.
//
// AttributeName is a required field
AttributeName *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
// The identifier for the DB cluster snapshot to modify the attributes for.
//
// DBClusterSnapshotIdentifier is a required field
DBClusterSnapshotIdentifier *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
// A list of DB cluster snapshot attributes to add to the attribute specified
// by AttributeName.
//
// To authorize other AWS accounts to copy or restore a manual DB cluster snapshot,
// set this list to include one or more AWS account IDs, or all to make the
// manual DB cluster snapshot restorable by any AWS account. Do not add the
// all value for any manual DB cluster snapshots that contain private information
// that you don't want available to all AWS accounts.
ValuesToAdd []*string `locationNameList:"AttributeValue" type:"list"`
// A list of DB cluster snapshot attributes to remove from the attribute specified
// by AttributeName.
//
// To remove authorization for other AWS accounts to copy or restore a manual
// DB cluster snapshot, set this list to include one or more AWS account identifiers,
// or all to remove authorization for any AWS account to copy or restore the
// DB cluster snapshot. If you specify all, an AWS account whose account ID
// is explicitly added to the restore attribute can still copy or restore a
// manual DB cluster snapshot.
ValuesToRemove []*string `locationNameList:"AttributeValue" type:"list"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s ModifyDBClusterSnapshotAttributeInput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s ModifyDBClusterSnapshotAttributeInput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
func (s *ModifyDBClusterSnapshotAttributeInput) Validate() error {
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "ModifyDBClusterSnapshotAttributeInput"}
if s.AttributeName == nil {
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("AttributeName"))
}
if s.DBClusterSnapshotIdentifier == nil {
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("DBClusterSnapshotIdentifier"))
}
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
return invalidParams
}
return nil
}
// SetAttributeName sets the AttributeName field's value.
func (s *ModifyDBClusterSnapshotAttributeInput) SetAttributeName(v string) *ModifyDBClusterSnapshotAttributeInput {
s.AttributeName = &v
return s
}
// SetDBClusterSnapshotIdentifier sets the DBClusterSnapshotIdentifier field's value.
func (s *ModifyDBClusterSnapshotAttributeInput) SetDBClusterSnapshotIdentifier(v string) *ModifyDBClusterSnapshotAttributeInput {
s.DBClusterSnapshotIdentifier = &v
return s
}
// SetValuesToAdd sets the ValuesToAdd field's value.
func (s *ModifyDBClusterSnapshotAttributeInput) SetValuesToAdd(v []*string) *ModifyDBClusterSnapshotAttributeInput {
s.ValuesToAdd = v
return s
}
// SetValuesToRemove sets the ValuesToRemove field's value.
func (s *ModifyDBClusterSnapshotAttributeInput) SetValuesToRemove(v []*string) *ModifyDBClusterSnapshotAttributeInput {
s.ValuesToRemove = v
return s
}
type ModifyDBClusterSnapshotAttributeOutput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// Contains the results of a successful call to the DescribeDBClusterSnapshotAttributes
// API action.
//
// Manual DB cluster snapshot attributes are used to authorize other AWS accounts
// to copy or restore a manual DB cluster snapshot. For more information, see
// the ModifyDBClusterSnapshotAttribute API action.
DBClusterSnapshotAttributesResult *DBClusterSnapshotAttributesResult `type:"structure"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s ModifyDBClusterSnapshotAttributeOutput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s ModifyDBClusterSnapshotAttributeOutput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetDBClusterSnapshotAttributesResult sets the DBClusterSnapshotAttributesResult field's value.
func (s *ModifyDBClusterSnapshotAttributeOutput) SetDBClusterSnapshotAttributesResult(v *DBClusterSnapshotAttributesResult) *ModifyDBClusterSnapshotAttributeOutput {
s.DBClusterSnapshotAttributesResult = v
return s
}
type ModifyDBInstanceInput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// The new amount of storage (in gibibytes) to allocate for the DB instance.
//
// For MariaDB, MySQL, Oracle, and PostgreSQL, the value supplied must be at
// least 10% greater than the current value. Values that are not at least 10%
// greater than the existing value are rounded up so that they are 10% greater
// than the current value.
//
// For the valid values for allocated storage for each engine, see CreateDBInstance.
AllocatedStorage *int64 `type:"integer"`
// Indicates that major version upgrades are allowed. Changing this parameter
// doesn't result in an outage and the change is asynchronously applied as soon
// as possible.
//
// Constraints: This parameter must be set to true when specifying a value for
// the EngineVersion parameter that is a different major version than the DB
// instance's current version.
AllowMajorVersionUpgrade *bool `type:"boolean"`
// Specifies whether the modifications in this request and any pending modifications
// are asynchronously applied as soon as possible, regardless of the PreferredMaintenanceWindow
// setting for the DB instance.
//
// If this parameter is set to false, changes to the DB instance are applied
// during the next maintenance window. Some parameter changes can cause an outage
// and are applied on the next call to RebootDBInstance, or the next failure
// reboot. Review the table of parameters in Modifying a DB Instance and Using
// the Apply Immediately Parameter (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/UserGuide/Overview.DBInstance.Modifying.html)
// in the Amazon RDS User Guide. to see the impact that setting ApplyImmediately
// to true or false has for each modified parameter and to determine when the
// changes are applied.
//
// Default: false
ApplyImmediately *bool `type:"boolean"`
// Indicates that minor version upgrades are applied automatically to the DB
// instance during the maintenance window. Changing this parameter doesn't result
// in an outage except in the following case and the change is asynchronously
// applied as soon as possible. An outage will result if this parameter is set
// to true during the maintenance window, and a newer minor version is available,
// and RDS has enabled auto patching for that engine version.
AutoMinorVersionUpgrade *bool `type:"boolean"`
// The number of days to retain automated backups. Setting this parameter to
// a positive number enables backups. Setting this parameter to 0 disables automated
// backups.
//
// Changing this parameter can result in an outage if you change from 0 to a
// non-zero value or from a non-zero value to 0. These changes are applied during
// the next maintenance window unless the ApplyImmediately parameter is set
// to true for this request. If you change the parameter from one non-zero value
// to another non-zero value, the change is asynchronously applied as soon as
// possible.
//
// Amazon Aurora
//
// Not applicable. The retention period for automated backups is managed by
// the DB cluster. For more information, see ModifyDBCluster.
//
// Default: Uses existing setting
//
// Constraints:
//
// * Must be a value from 0 to 35
//
// * Can be specified for a MySQL Read Replica only if the source is running
// MySQL 5.6 or later
//
// * Can be specified for a PostgreSQL Read Replica only if the source is
// running PostgreSQL 9.3.5
//
// * Can't be set to 0 if the DB instance is a source to Read Replicas
BackupRetentionPeriod *int64 `type:"integer"`
// Indicates the certificate that needs to be associated with the instance.
CACertificateIdentifier *string `type:"string"`
// The configuration setting for the log types to be enabled for export to CloudWatch
// Logs for a specific DB instance.
//
// A change to the CloudwatchLogsExportConfiguration parameter is always applied
// to the DB instance immediately. Therefore, the ApplyImmediately parameter
// has no effect.
CloudwatchLogsExportConfiguration *CloudwatchLogsExportConfiguration `type:"structure"`
// True to copy all tags from the DB instance to snapshots of the DB instance,
// and otherwise false. The default is false.
//
// Amazon Aurora
//
// Not applicable. Copying tags to snapshots is managed by the DB cluster. Setting
// this value for an Aurora DB instance has no effect on the DB cluster setting.
// For more information, see ModifyDBCluster.
CopyTagsToSnapshot *bool `type:"boolean"`
// The new compute and memory capacity of the DB instance, for example, db.m4.large.
// Not all DB instance classes are available in all AWS Regions, or for all
// database engines. For the full list of DB instance classes, and availability
// for your engine, see DB Instance Class (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/UserGuide/Concepts.DBInstanceClass.html)
// in the Amazon RDS User Guide.
//
// If you modify the DB instance class, an outage occurs during the change.
// The change is applied during the next maintenance window, unless ApplyImmediately
// is specified as true for this request.
//
// Default: Uses existing setting
DBInstanceClass *string `type:"string"`
// The DB instance identifier. This value is stored as a lowercase string.
//
// Constraints:
//
// * Must match the identifier of an existing DBInstance.
//
// DBInstanceIdentifier is a required field
DBInstanceIdentifier *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
// The name of the DB parameter group to apply to the DB instance. Changing
// this setting doesn't result in an outage. The parameter group name itself
// is changed immediately, but the actual parameter changes are not applied
// until you reboot the instance without failover. The db instance will NOT
// be rebooted automatically and the parameter changes will NOT be applied during
// the next maintenance window.
//
// Default: Uses existing setting
//
// Constraints: The DB parameter group must be in the same DB parameter group
// family as this DB instance.
DBParameterGroupName *string `type:"string"`
// The port number on which the database accepts connections.
//
// The value of the DBPortNumber parameter must not match any of the port values
// specified for options in the option group for the DB instance.
//
// Your database will restart when you change the DBPortNumber value regardless
// of the value of the ApplyImmediately parameter.
//
// MySQL
//
// Default: 3306
//
// Valid Values: 1150-65535
//
// MariaDB
//
// Default: 3306
//
// Valid Values: 1150-65535
//
// PostgreSQL
//
// Default: 5432
//
// Valid Values: 1150-65535
//
// Type: Integer
//
// Oracle
//
// Default: 1521
//
// Valid Values: 1150-65535
//
// SQL Server
//
// Default: 1433
//
// Valid Values: 1150-65535 except for 1434, 3389, 47001, 49152, and 49152 through
// 49156.
//
// Amazon Aurora
//
// Default: 3306
//
// Valid Values: 1150-65535
DBPortNumber *int64 `type:"integer"`
// A list of DB security groups to authorize on this DB instance. Changing this
// setting doesn't result in an outage and the change is asynchronously applied
// as soon as possible.
//
// Constraints:
//
// * If supplied, must match existing DBSecurityGroups.
DBSecurityGroups []*string `locationNameList:"DBSecurityGroupName" type:"list"`
// The new DB subnet group for the DB instance. You can use this parameter to
// move your DB instance to a different VPC. If your DB instance is not in a
// VPC, you can also use this parameter to move your DB instance into a VPC.
// For more information, see Updating the VPC for a DB Instance (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/UserGuide/USER_VPC.WorkingWithRDSInstanceinaVPC.html#USER_VPC.Non-VPC2VPC)
// in the Amazon RDS User Guide.
//
// Changing the subnet group causes an outage during the change. The change
// is applied during the next maintenance window, unless you specify true for
// the ApplyImmediately parameter.
//
// Constraints: If supplied, must match the name of an existing DBSubnetGroup.
//
// Example: mySubnetGroup
DBSubnetGroupName *string `type:"string"`
// Indicates if the DB instance has deletion protection enabled. The database
// can't be deleted when this value is set to true. For more information, see
// Deleting a DB Instance (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/UserGuide/USER_DeleteInstance.html).
DeletionProtection *bool `type:"boolean"`
// The Active Directory Domain to move the instance to. Specify none to remove
// the instance from its current domain. The domain must be created prior to
// this operation. Currently only a Microsoft SQL Server instance can be created
// in a Active Directory Domain.
Domain *string `type:"string"`
// The name of the IAM role to use when making API calls to the Directory Service.
DomainIAMRoleName *string `type:"string"`
// True to enable mapping of AWS Identity and Access Management (IAM) accounts
// to database accounts, and otherwise false.
//
// You can enable IAM database authentication for the following database engines
//
// Amazon Aurora
//
// Not applicable. Mapping AWS IAM accounts to database accounts is managed
// by the DB cluster. For more information, see ModifyDBCluster.
//
// MySQL
//
// * For MySQL 5.6, minor version 5.6.34 or higher
//
// * For MySQL 5.7, minor version 5.7.16 or higher
//
// Default: false
EnableIAMDatabaseAuthentication *bool `type:"boolean"`
// True to enable Performance Insights for the DB instance, and otherwise false.
//
// For more information, see Using Amazon Performance Insights (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/UserGuide/USER_PerfInsights.html)
// in the Amazon Relational Database Service User Guide.
EnablePerformanceInsights *bool `type:"boolean"`
// The version number of the database engine to upgrade to. Changing this parameter
// results in an outage and the change is applied during the next maintenance
// window unless the ApplyImmediately parameter is set to true for this request.
//
// For major version upgrades, if a nondefault DB parameter group is currently
// in use, a new DB parameter group in the DB parameter group family for the
// new engine version must be specified. The new DB parameter group can be the
// default for that DB parameter group family.
//
// For information about valid engine versions, see CreateDBInstance, or call
// DescribeDBEngineVersions.
EngineVersion *string `type:"string"`
// The new Provisioned IOPS (I/O operations per second) value for the RDS instance.
//
// Changing this setting doesn't result in an outage and the change is applied
// during the next maintenance window unless the ApplyImmediately parameter
// is set to true for this request. If you are migrating from Provisioned IOPS
// to standard storage, set this value to 0. The DB instance will require a
// reboot for the change in storage type to take effect.
//
// If you choose to migrate your DB instance from using standard storage to
// using Provisioned IOPS, or from using Provisioned IOPS to using standard
// storage, the process can take time. The duration of the migration depends
// on several factors such as database load, storage size, storage type (standard
// or Provisioned IOPS), amount of IOPS provisioned (if any), and the number
// of prior scale storage operations. Typical migration times are under 24 hours,
// but the process can take up to several days in some cases. During the migration,
// the DB instance is available for use, but might experience performance degradation.
// While the migration takes place, nightly backups for the instance are suspended.
// No other Amazon RDS operations can take place for the instance, including
// modifying the instance, rebooting the instance, deleting the instance, creating
// a Read Replica for the instance, and creating a DB snapshot of the instance.
//
// Constraints: For MariaDB, MySQL, Oracle, and PostgreSQL, the value supplied
// must be at least 10% greater than the current value. Values that are not
// at least 10% greater than the existing value are rounded up so that they
// are 10% greater than the current value.
//
// Default: Uses existing setting
Iops *int64 `type:"integer"`
// The license model for the DB instance.
//
// Valid values: license-included | bring-your-own-license | general-public-license
LicenseModel *string `type:"string"`
// The new password for the master user. The password can include any printable
// ASCII character except "/", """, or "@".
//
// Changing this parameter doesn't result in an outage and the change is asynchronously
// applied as soon as possible. Between the time of the request and the completion
// of the request, the MasterUserPassword element exists in the PendingModifiedValues
// element of the operation response.
//
// Amazon Aurora
//
// Not applicable. The password for the master user is managed by the DB cluster.
// For more information, see ModifyDBCluster.
//
// Default: Uses existing setting
//
// MariaDB
//
// Constraints: Must contain from 8 to 41 characters.
//
// Microsoft SQL Server
//
// Constraints: Must contain from 8 to 128 characters.
//
// MySQL
//
// Constraints: Must contain from 8 to 41 characters.
//
// Oracle
//
// Constraints: Must contain from 8 to 30 characters.
//
// PostgreSQL
//
// Constraints: Must contain from 8 to 128 characters.
//
// Amazon RDS API actions never return the password, so this action provides
// a way to regain access to a primary instance user if the password is lost.
// This includes restoring privileges that might have been accidentally revoked.
MasterUserPassword *string `type:"string"`
// The interval, in seconds, between points when Enhanced Monitoring metrics
// are collected for the DB instance. To disable collecting Enhanced Monitoring
// metrics, specify 0. The default is 0.
//
// If MonitoringRoleArn is specified, then you must also set MonitoringInterval
// to a value other than 0.
//
// Valid Values: 0, 1, 5, 10, 15, 30, 60
MonitoringInterval *int64 `type:"integer"`
// The ARN for the IAM role that permits RDS to send enhanced monitoring metrics
// to Amazon CloudWatch Logs. For example, arn:aws:iam:123456789012:role/emaccess.
// For information on creating a monitoring role, go to To create an IAM role
// for Amazon RDS Enhanced Monitoring (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/UserGuide/USER_Monitoring.html#USER_Monitoring.OS.IAMRole)
// in the Amazon RDS User Guide.
//
// If MonitoringInterval is set to a value other than 0, then you must supply
// a MonitoringRoleArn value.
MonitoringRoleArn *string `type:"string"`
// Specifies if the DB instance is a Multi-AZ deployment. Changing this parameter
// doesn't result in an outage and the change is applied during the next maintenance
// window unless the ApplyImmediately parameter is set to true for this request.
MultiAZ *bool `type:"boolean"`
// The new DB instance identifier for the DB instance when renaming a DB instance.
// When you change the DB instance identifier, an instance reboot will occur
// immediately if you set Apply Immediately to true, or will occur during the
// next maintenance window if Apply Immediately to false. This value is stored
// as a lowercase string.
//
// Constraints:
//
// * Must contain from 1 to 63 letters, numbers, or hyphens.
//
// * The first character must be a letter.
//
// * Can't end with a hyphen or contain two consecutive hyphens.
//
// Example: mydbinstance
NewDBInstanceIdentifier *string `type:"string"`
// Indicates that the DB instance should be associated with the specified option
// group. Changing this parameter doesn't result in an outage except in the
// following case and the change is applied during the next maintenance window
// unless the ApplyImmediately parameter is set to true for this request. If
// the parameter change results in an option group that enables OEM, this change
// can cause a brief (sub-second) period during which new connections are rejected
// but existing connections are not interrupted.
//
// Permanent options, such as the TDE option for Oracle Advanced Security TDE,
// can't be removed from an option group, and that option group can't be removed
// from a DB instance once it is associated with a DB instance
OptionGroupName *string `type:"string"`
// The AWS KMS key identifier for encryption of Performance Insights data. The
// KMS key ID is the Amazon Resource Name (ARN), KMS key identifier, or the
// KMS key alias for the KMS encryption key.
PerformanceInsightsKMSKeyId *string `type:"string"`
// The amount of time, in days, to retain Performance Insights data. Valid values
// are 7 or 731 (2 years).
PerformanceInsightsRetentionPeriod *int64 `type:"integer"`
// The daily time range during which automated backups are created if automated
// backups are enabled, as determined by the BackupRetentionPeriod parameter.
// Changing this parameter doesn't result in an outage and the change is asynchronously
// applied as soon as possible.
//
// Amazon Aurora
//
// Not applicable. The daily time range for creating automated backups is managed
// by the DB cluster. For more information, see ModifyDBCluster.
//
// Constraints:
//
// * Must be in the format hh24:mi-hh24:mi
//
// * Must be in Universal Time Coordinated (UTC)
//
// * Must not conflict with the preferred maintenance window
//
// * Must be at least 30 minutes
PreferredBackupWindow *string `type:"string"`
// The weekly time range (in UTC) during which system maintenance can occur,
// which might result in an outage. Changing this parameter doesn't result in
// an outage, except in the following situation, and the change is asynchronously
// applied as soon as possible. If there are pending actions that cause a reboot,
// and the maintenance window is changed to include the current time, then changing
// this parameter will cause a reboot of the DB instance. If moving this window
// to the current time, there must be at least 30 minutes between the current
// time and end of the window to ensure pending changes are applied.
//
// Default: Uses existing setting
//
// Format: ddd:hh24:mi-ddd:hh24:mi
//
// Valid Days: Mon | Tue | Wed | Thu | Fri | Sat | Sun
//
// Constraints: Must be at least 30 minutes
PreferredMaintenanceWindow *string `type:"string"`
// The number of CPU cores and the number of threads per core for the DB instance
// class of the DB instance.
ProcessorFeatures []*ProcessorFeature `locationNameList:"ProcessorFeature" type:"list"`
// A value that specifies the order in which an Aurora Replica is promoted to
// the primary instance after a failure of the existing primary instance. For
// more information, see Fault Tolerance for an Aurora DB Cluster (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/AuroraUserGuide/Aurora.Managing.Backups.html#Aurora.Managing.FaultTolerance)
// in the Amazon Aurora User Guide.
//
// Default: 1
//
// Valid Values: 0 - 15
PromotionTier *int64 `type:"integer"`
// Boolean value that indicates if the DB instance has a publicly resolvable
// DNS name. Set to True to make the DB instance Internet-facing with a publicly
// resolvable DNS name, which resolves to a public IP address. Set to False
// to make the DB instance internal with a DNS name that resolves to a private
// IP address.
//
// PubliclyAccessible only applies to DB instances in a VPC. The DB instance
// must be part of a public subnet and PubliclyAccessible must be true in order
// for it to be publicly accessible.
//
// Changes to the PubliclyAccessible parameter are applied immediately regardless
// of the value of the ApplyImmediately parameter.
//
// Default: false
PubliclyAccessible *bool `type:"boolean"`
// Specifies the storage type to be associated with the DB instance.
//
// If you specify Provisioned IOPS (io1), you must also include a value for
// the Iops parameter.
//
// If you choose to migrate your DB instance from using standard storage to
// using Provisioned IOPS, or from using Provisioned IOPS to using standard
// storage, the process can take time. The duration of the migration depends
// on several factors such as database load, storage size, storage type (standard
// or Provisioned IOPS), amount of IOPS provisioned (if any), and the number
// of prior scale storage operations. Typical migration times are under 24 hours,
// but the process can take up to several days in some cases. During the migration,
// the DB instance is available for use, but might experience performance degradation.
// While the migration takes place, nightly backups for the instance are suspended.
// No other Amazon RDS operations can take place for the instance, including
// modifying the instance, rebooting the instance, deleting the instance, creating
// a Read Replica for the instance, and creating a DB snapshot of the instance.
//
// Valid values: standard | gp2 | io1
//
// Default: io1 if the Iops parameter is specified, otherwise standard
StorageType *string `type:"string"`
// The ARN from the key store with which to associate the instance for TDE encryption.
TdeCredentialArn *string `type:"string"`
// The password for the given ARN from the key store in order to access the
// device.
TdeCredentialPassword *string `type:"string"`
// A value that specifies that the DB instance class of the DB instance uses
// its default processor features.
UseDefaultProcessorFeatures *bool `type:"boolean"`
// A list of EC2 VPC security groups to authorize on this DB instance. This
// change is asynchronously applied as soon as possible.
//
// Amazon Aurora
//
// Not applicable. The associated list of EC2 VPC security groups is managed
// by the DB cluster. For more information, see ModifyDBCluster.
//
// Constraints:
//
// * If supplied, must match existing VpcSecurityGroupIds.
VpcSecurityGroupIds []*string `locationNameList:"VpcSecurityGroupId" type:"list"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s ModifyDBInstanceInput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s ModifyDBInstanceInput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
func (s *ModifyDBInstanceInput) Validate() error {
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "ModifyDBInstanceInput"}
if s.DBInstanceIdentifier == nil {
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("DBInstanceIdentifier"))
}
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
return invalidParams
}
return nil
}
// SetAllocatedStorage sets the AllocatedStorage field's value.
func (s *ModifyDBInstanceInput) SetAllocatedStorage(v int64) *ModifyDBInstanceInput {
s.AllocatedStorage = &v
return s
}
// SetAllowMajorVersionUpgrade sets the AllowMajorVersionUpgrade field's value.
func (s *ModifyDBInstanceInput) SetAllowMajorVersionUpgrade(v bool) *ModifyDBInstanceInput {
s.AllowMajorVersionUpgrade = &v
return s
}
// SetApplyImmediately sets the ApplyImmediately field's value.
func (s *ModifyDBInstanceInput) SetApplyImmediately(v bool) *ModifyDBInstanceInput {
s.ApplyImmediately = &v
return s
}
// SetAutoMinorVersionUpgrade sets the AutoMinorVersionUpgrade field's value.
func (s *ModifyDBInstanceInput) SetAutoMinorVersionUpgrade(v bool) *ModifyDBInstanceInput {
s.AutoMinorVersionUpgrade = &v
return s
}
// SetBackupRetentionPeriod sets the BackupRetentionPeriod field's value.
func (s *ModifyDBInstanceInput) SetBackupRetentionPeriod(v int64) *ModifyDBInstanceInput {
s.BackupRetentionPeriod = &v
return s
}
// SetCACertificateIdentifier sets the CACertificateIdentifier field's value.
func (s *ModifyDBInstanceInput) SetCACertificateIdentifier(v string) *ModifyDBInstanceInput {
s.CACertificateIdentifier = &v
return s
}
// SetCloudwatchLogsExportConfiguration sets the CloudwatchLogsExportConfiguration field's value.
func (s *ModifyDBInstanceInput) SetCloudwatchLogsExportConfiguration(v *CloudwatchLogsExportConfiguration) *ModifyDBInstanceInput {
s.CloudwatchLogsExportConfiguration = v
return s
}
// SetCopyTagsToSnapshot sets the CopyTagsToSnapshot field's value.
func (s *ModifyDBInstanceInput) SetCopyTagsToSnapshot(v bool) *ModifyDBInstanceInput {
s.CopyTagsToSnapshot = &v
return s
}
// SetDBInstanceClass sets the DBInstanceClass field's value.
func (s *ModifyDBInstanceInput) SetDBInstanceClass(v string) *ModifyDBInstanceInput {
s.DBInstanceClass = &v
return s
}
// SetDBInstanceIdentifier sets the DBInstanceIdentifier field's value.
func (s *ModifyDBInstanceInput) SetDBInstanceIdentifier(v string) *ModifyDBInstanceInput {
s.DBInstanceIdentifier = &v
return s
}
// SetDBParameterGroupName sets the DBParameterGroupName field's value.
func (s *ModifyDBInstanceInput) SetDBParameterGroupName(v string) *ModifyDBInstanceInput {
s.DBParameterGroupName = &v
return s
}
// SetDBPortNumber sets the DBPortNumber field's value.
func (s *ModifyDBInstanceInput) SetDBPortNumber(v int64) *ModifyDBInstanceInput {
s.DBPortNumber = &v
return s
}
// SetDBSecurityGroups sets the DBSecurityGroups field's value.
func (s *ModifyDBInstanceInput) SetDBSecurityGroups(v []*string) *ModifyDBInstanceInput {
s.DBSecurityGroups = v
return s
}
// SetDBSubnetGroupName sets the DBSubnetGroupName field's value.
func (s *ModifyDBInstanceInput) SetDBSubnetGroupName(v string) *ModifyDBInstanceInput {
s.DBSubnetGroupName = &v
return s
}
// SetDeletionProtection sets the DeletionProtection field's value.
func (s *ModifyDBInstanceInput) SetDeletionProtection(v bool) *ModifyDBInstanceInput {
s.DeletionProtection = &v
return s
}
// SetDomain sets the Domain field's value.
func (s *ModifyDBInstanceInput) SetDomain(v string) *ModifyDBInstanceInput {
s.Domain = &v
return s
}
// SetDomainIAMRoleName sets the DomainIAMRoleName field's value.
func (s *ModifyDBInstanceInput) SetDomainIAMRoleName(v string) *ModifyDBInstanceInput {
s.DomainIAMRoleName = &v
return s
}
// SetEnableIAMDatabaseAuthentication sets the EnableIAMDatabaseAuthentication field's value.
func (s *ModifyDBInstanceInput) SetEnableIAMDatabaseAuthentication(v bool) *ModifyDBInstanceInput {
s.EnableIAMDatabaseAuthentication = &v
return s
}
// SetEnablePerformanceInsights sets the EnablePerformanceInsights field's value.
func (s *ModifyDBInstanceInput) SetEnablePerformanceInsights(v bool) *ModifyDBInstanceInput {
s.EnablePerformanceInsights = &v
return s
}
// SetEngineVersion sets the EngineVersion field's value.
func (s *ModifyDBInstanceInput) SetEngineVersion(v string) *ModifyDBInstanceInput {
s.EngineVersion = &v
return s
}
// SetIops sets the Iops field's value.
func (s *ModifyDBInstanceInput) SetIops(v int64) *ModifyDBInstanceInput {
s.Iops = &v
return s
}
// SetLicenseModel sets the LicenseModel field's value.
func (s *ModifyDBInstanceInput) SetLicenseModel(v string) *ModifyDBInstanceInput {
s.LicenseModel = &v
return s
}
// SetMasterUserPassword sets the MasterUserPassword field's value.
func (s *ModifyDBInstanceInput) SetMasterUserPassword(v string) *ModifyDBInstanceInput {
s.MasterUserPassword = &v
return s
}
// SetMonitoringInterval sets the MonitoringInterval field's value.
func (s *ModifyDBInstanceInput) SetMonitoringInterval(v int64) *ModifyDBInstanceInput {
s.MonitoringInterval = &v
return s
}
// SetMonitoringRoleArn sets the MonitoringRoleArn field's value.
func (s *ModifyDBInstanceInput) SetMonitoringRoleArn(v string) *ModifyDBInstanceInput {
s.MonitoringRoleArn = &v
return s
}
// SetMultiAZ sets the MultiAZ field's value.
func (s *ModifyDBInstanceInput) SetMultiAZ(v bool) *ModifyDBInstanceInput {
s.MultiAZ = &v
return s
}
// SetNewDBInstanceIdentifier sets the NewDBInstanceIdentifier field's value.
func (s *ModifyDBInstanceInput) SetNewDBInstanceIdentifier(v string) *ModifyDBInstanceInput {
s.NewDBInstanceIdentifier = &v
return s
}
// SetOptionGroupName sets the OptionGroupName field's value.
func (s *ModifyDBInstanceInput) SetOptionGroupName(v string) *ModifyDBInstanceInput {
s.OptionGroupName = &v
return s
}
// SetPerformanceInsightsKMSKeyId sets the PerformanceInsightsKMSKeyId field's value.
func (s *ModifyDBInstanceInput) SetPerformanceInsightsKMSKeyId(v string) *ModifyDBInstanceInput {
s.PerformanceInsightsKMSKeyId = &v
return s
}
// SetPerformanceInsightsRetentionPeriod sets the PerformanceInsightsRetentionPeriod field's value.
func (s *ModifyDBInstanceInput) SetPerformanceInsightsRetentionPeriod(v int64) *ModifyDBInstanceInput {
s.PerformanceInsightsRetentionPeriod = &v
return s
}
// SetPreferredBackupWindow sets the PreferredBackupWindow field's value.
func (s *ModifyDBInstanceInput) SetPreferredBackupWindow(v string) *ModifyDBInstanceInput {
s.PreferredBackupWindow = &v
return s
}
// SetPreferredMaintenanceWindow sets the PreferredMaintenanceWindow field's value.
func (s *ModifyDBInstanceInput) SetPreferredMaintenanceWindow(v string) *ModifyDBInstanceInput {
s.PreferredMaintenanceWindow = &v
return s
}
// SetProcessorFeatures sets the ProcessorFeatures field's value.
func (s *ModifyDBInstanceInput) SetProcessorFeatures(v []*ProcessorFeature) *ModifyDBInstanceInput {
s.ProcessorFeatures = v
return s
}
// SetPromotionTier sets the PromotionTier field's value.
func (s *ModifyDBInstanceInput) SetPromotionTier(v int64) *ModifyDBInstanceInput {
s.PromotionTier = &v
return s
}
// SetPubliclyAccessible sets the PubliclyAccessible field's value.
func (s *ModifyDBInstanceInput) SetPubliclyAccessible(v bool) *ModifyDBInstanceInput {
s.PubliclyAccessible = &v
return s
}
// SetStorageType sets the StorageType field's value.
func (s *ModifyDBInstanceInput) SetStorageType(v string) *ModifyDBInstanceInput {
s.StorageType = &v
return s
}
// SetTdeCredentialArn sets the TdeCredentialArn field's value.
func (s *ModifyDBInstanceInput) SetTdeCredentialArn(v string) *ModifyDBInstanceInput {
s.TdeCredentialArn = &v
return s
}
// SetTdeCredentialPassword sets the TdeCredentialPassword field's value.
func (s *ModifyDBInstanceInput) SetTdeCredentialPassword(v string) *ModifyDBInstanceInput {
s.TdeCredentialPassword = &v
return s
}
// SetUseDefaultProcessorFeatures sets the UseDefaultProcessorFeatures field's value.
func (s *ModifyDBInstanceInput) SetUseDefaultProcessorFeatures(v bool) *ModifyDBInstanceInput {
s.UseDefaultProcessorFeatures = &v
return s
}
// SetVpcSecurityGroupIds sets the VpcSecurityGroupIds field's value.
func (s *ModifyDBInstanceInput) SetVpcSecurityGroupIds(v []*string) *ModifyDBInstanceInput {
s.VpcSecurityGroupIds = v
return s
}
type ModifyDBInstanceOutput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// Contains the details of an Amazon RDS DB instance.
//
// This data type is used as a response element in the DescribeDBInstances action.
DBInstance *DBInstance `type:"structure"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s ModifyDBInstanceOutput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s ModifyDBInstanceOutput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetDBInstance sets the DBInstance field's value.
func (s *ModifyDBInstanceOutput) SetDBInstance(v *DBInstance) *ModifyDBInstanceOutput {
s.DBInstance = v
return s
}
type ModifyDBParameterGroupInput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// The name of the DB parameter group.
//
// Constraints:
//
// * If supplied, must match the name of an existing DBParameterGroup.
//
// DBParameterGroupName is a required field
DBParameterGroupName *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
// An array of parameter names, values, and the apply method for the parameter
// update. At least one parameter name, value, and apply method must be supplied;
// subsequent arguments are optional. A maximum of 20 parameters can be modified
// in a single request.
//
// Valid Values (for the application method): immediate | pending-reboot
//
// You can use the immediate value with dynamic parameters only. You can use
// the pending-reboot value for both dynamic and static parameters, and changes
// are applied when you reboot the DB instance without failover.
//
// Parameters is a required field
Parameters []*Parameter `locationNameList:"Parameter" type:"list" required:"true"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s ModifyDBParameterGroupInput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s ModifyDBParameterGroupInput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
func (s *ModifyDBParameterGroupInput) Validate() error {
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "ModifyDBParameterGroupInput"}
if s.DBParameterGroupName == nil {
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("DBParameterGroupName"))
}
if s.Parameters == nil {
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Parameters"))
}
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
return invalidParams
}
return nil
}
// SetDBParameterGroupName sets the DBParameterGroupName field's value.
func (s *ModifyDBParameterGroupInput) SetDBParameterGroupName(v string) *ModifyDBParameterGroupInput {
s.DBParameterGroupName = &v
return s
}
// SetParameters sets the Parameters field's value.
func (s *ModifyDBParameterGroupInput) SetParameters(v []*Parameter) *ModifyDBParameterGroupInput {
s.Parameters = v
return s
}
type ModifyDBSnapshotAttributeInput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// The name of the DB snapshot attribute to modify.
//
// To manage authorization for other AWS accounts to copy or restore a manual
// DB snapshot, set this value to restore.
//
// AttributeName is a required field
AttributeName *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
// The identifier for the DB snapshot to modify the attributes for.
//
// DBSnapshotIdentifier is a required field
DBSnapshotIdentifier *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
// A list of DB snapshot attributes to add to the attribute specified by AttributeName.
//
// To authorize other AWS accounts to copy or restore a manual snapshot, set
// this list to include one or more AWS account IDs, or all to make the manual
// DB snapshot restorable by any AWS account. Do not add the all value for any
// manual DB snapshots that contain private information that you don't want
// available to all AWS accounts.
ValuesToAdd []*string `locationNameList:"AttributeValue" type:"list"`
// A list of DB snapshot attributes to remove from the attribute specified by
// AttributeName.
//
// To remove authorization for other AWS accounts to copy or restore a manual
// snapshot, set this list to include one or more AWS account identifiers, or
// all to remove authorization for any AWS account to copy or restore the DB
// snapshot. If you specify all, an AWS account whose account ID is explicitly
// added to the restore attribute can still copy or restore the manual DB snapshot.
ValuesToRemove []*string `locationNameList:"AttributeValue" type:"list"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s ModifyDBSnapshotAttributeInput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s ModifyDBSnapshotAttributeInput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
func (s *ModifyDBSnapshotAttributeInput) Validate() error {
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "ModifyDBSnapshotAttributeInput"}
if s.AttributeName == nil {
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("AttributeName"))
}
if s.DBSnapshotIdentifier == nil {
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("DBSnapshotIdentifier"))
}
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
return invalidParams
}
return nil
}
// SetAttributeName sets the AttributeName field's value.
func (s *ModifyDBSnapshotAttributeInput) SetAttributeName(v string) *ModifyDBSnapshotAttributeInput {
s.AttributeName = &v
return s
}
// SetDBSnapshotIdentifier sets the DBSnapshotIdentifier field's value.
func (s *ModifyDBSnapshotAttributeInput) SetDBSnapshotIdentifier(v string) *ModifyDBSnapshotAttributeInput {
s.DBSnapshotIdentifier = &v
return s
}
// SetValuesToAdd sets the ValuesToAdd field's value.
func (s *ModifyDBSnapshotAttributeInput) SetValuesToAdd(v []*string) *ModifyDBSnapshotAttributeInput {
s.ValuesToAdd = v
return s
}
// SetValuesToRemove sets the ValuesToRemove field's value.
func (s *ModifyDBSnapshotAttributeInput) SetValuesToRemove(v []*string) *ModifyDBSnapshotAttributeInput {
s.ValuesToRemove = v
return s
}
type ModifyDBSnapshotAttributeOutput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// Contains the results of a successful call to the DescribeDBSnapshotAttributes
// API action.
//
// Manual DB snapshot attributes are used to authorize other AWS accounts to
// copy or restore a manual DB snapshot. For more information, see the ModifyDBSnapshotAttribute
// API action.
DBSnapshotAttributesResult *DBSnapshotAttributesResult `type:"structure"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s ModifyDBSnapshotAttributeOutput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s ModifyDBSnapshotAttributeOutput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetDBSnapshotAttributesResult sets the DBSnapshotAttributesResult field's value.
func (s *ModifyDBSnapshotAttributeOutput) SetDBSnapshotAttributesResult(v *DBSnapshotAttributesResult) *ModifyDBSnapshotAttributeOutput {
s.DBSnapshotAttributesResult = v
return s
}
type ModifyDBSnapshotInput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// The identifier of the DB snapshot to modify.
//
// DBSnapshotIdentifier is a required field
DBSnapshotIdentifier *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
// The engine version to upgrade the DB snapshot to.
//
// The following are the database engines and engine versions that are available
// when you upgrade a DB snapshot.
//
// MySQL
//
// * 5.5.46 (supported for 5.1 DB snapshots)
//
// Oracle
//
// * 12.1.0.2.v8 (supported for 12.1.0.1 DB snapshots)
//
// * 11.2.0.4.v12 (supported for 11.2.0.2 DB snapshots)
//
// * 11.2.0.4.v11 (supported for 11.2.0.3 DB snapshots)
EngineVersion *string `type:"string"`
// The option group to identify with the upgraded DB snapshot.
//
// You can specify this parameter when you upgrade an Oracle DB snapshot. The
// same option group considerations apply when upgrading a DB snapshot as when
// upgrading a DB instance. For more information, see Option Group Considerations
// (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/UserGuide/USER_UpgradeDBInstance.Oracle.html#USER_UpgradeDBInstance.Oracle.OGPG.OG)
// in the Amazon RDS User Guide.
OptionGroupName *string `type:"string"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s ModifyDBSnapshotInput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s ModifyDBSnapshotInput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
func (s *ModifyDBSnapshotInput) Validate() error {
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "ModifyDBSnapshotInput"}
if s.DBSnapshotIdentifier == nil {
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("DBSnapshotIdentifier"))
}
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
return invalidParams
}
return nil
}
// SetDBSnapshotIdentifier sets the DBSnapshotIdentifier field's value.
func (s *ModifyDBSnapshotInput) SetDBSnapshotIdentifier(v string) *ModifyDBSnapshotInput {
s.DBSnapshotIdentifier = &v
return s
}
// SetEngineVersion sets the EngineVersion field's value.
func (s *ModifyDBSnapshotInput) SetEngineVersion(v string) *ModifyDBSnapshotInput {
s.EngineVersion = &v
return s
}
// SetOptionGroupName sets the OptionGroupName field's value.
func (s *ModifyDBSnapshotInput) SetOptionGroupName(v string) *ModifyDBSnapshotInput {
s.OptionGroupName = &v
return s
}
type ModifyDBSnapshotOutput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// Contains the details of an Amazon RDS DB snapshot.
//
// This data type is used as a response element in the DescribeDBSnapshots action.
DBSnapshot *DBSnapshot `type:"structure"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s ModifyDBSnapshotOutput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s ModifyDBSnapshotOutput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetDBSnapshot sets the DBSnapshot field's value.
func (s *ModifyDBSnapshotOutput) SetDBSnapshot(v *DBSnapshot) *ModifyDBSnapshotOutput {
s.DBSnapshot = v
return s
}
type ModifyDBSubnetGroupInput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// The description for the DB subnet group.
DBSubnetGroupDescription *string `type:"string"`
// The name for the DB subnet group. This value is stored as a lowercase string.
// You can't modify the default subnet group.
//
// Constraints: Must match the name of an existing DBSubnetGroup. Must not be
// default.
//
// Example: mySubnetgroup
//
// DBSubnetGroupName is a required field
DBSubnetGroupName *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
// The EC2 subnet IDs for the DB subnet group.
//
// SubnetIds is a required field
SubnetIds []*string `locationNameList:"SubnetIdentifier" type:"list" required:"true"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s ModifyDBSubnetGroupInput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s ModifyDBSubnetGroupInput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
func (s *ModifyDBSubnetGroupInput) Validate() error {
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "ModifyDBSubnetGroupInput"}
if s.DBSubnetGroupName == nil {
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("DBSubnetGroupName"))
}
if s.SubnetIds == nil {
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("SubnetIds"))
}
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
return invalidParams
}
return nil
}
// SetDBSubnetGroupDescription sets the DBSubnetGroupDescription field's value.
func (s *ModifyDBSubnetGroupInput) SetDBSubnetGroupDescription(v string) *ModifyDBSubnetGroupInput {
s.DBSubnetGroupDescription = &v
return s
}
// SetDBSubnetGroupName sets the DBSubnetGroupName field's value.
func (s *ModifyDBSubnetGroupInput) SetDBSubnetGroupName(v string) *ModifyDBSubnetGroupInput {
s.DBSubnetGroupName = &v
return s
}
// SetSubnetIds sets the SubnetIds field's value.
func (s *ModifyDBSubnetGroupInput) SetSubnetIds(v []*string) *ModifyDBSubnetGroupInput {
s.SubnetIds = v
return s
}
type ModifyDBSubnetGroupOutput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// Contains the details of an Amazon RDS DB subnet group.
//
// This data type is used as a response element in the DescribeDBSubnetGroups
// action.
DBSubnetGroup *DBSubnetGroup `type:"structure"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s ModifyDBSubnetGroupOutput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s ModifyDBSubnetGroupOutput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetDBSubnetGroup sets the DBSubnetGroup field's value.
func (s *ModifyDBSubnetGroupOutput) SetDBSubnetGroup(v *DBSubnetGroup) *ModifyDBSubnetGroupOutput {
s.DBSubnetGroup = v
return s
}
type ModifyEventSubscriptionInput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// A Boolean value; set to true to activate the subscription.
Enabled *bool `type:"boolean"`
// A list of event categories for a SourceType that you want to subscribe to.
// You can see a list of the categories for a given SourceType in the Events
// (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/UserGuide/USER_Events.html)
// topic in the Amazon RDS User Guide or by using the DescribeEventCategories
// action.
EventCategories []*string `locationNameList:"EventCategory" type:"list"`
// The Amazon Resource Name (ARN) of the SNS topic created for event notification.
// The ARN is created by Amazon SNS when you create a topic and subscribe to
// it.
SnsTopicArn *string `type:"string"`
// The type of source that is generating the events. For example, if you want
// to be notified of events generated by a DB instance, you would set this parameter
// to db-instance. if this value is not specified, all events are returned.
//
// Valid values: db-instance | db-parameter-group | db-security-group | db-snapshot
SourceType *string `type:"string"`
// The name of the RDS event notification subscription.
//
// SubscriptionName is a required field
SubscriptionName *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s ModifyEventSubscriptionInput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s ModifyEventSubscriptionInput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
func (s *ModifyEventSubscriptionInput) Validate() error {
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "ModifyEventSubscriptionInput"}
if s.SubscriptionName == nil {
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("SubscriptionName"))
}
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
return invalidParams
}
return nil
}
// SetEnabled sets the Enabled field's value.
func (s *ModifyEventSubscriptionInput) SetEnabled(v bool) *ModifyEventSubscriptionInput {
s.Enabled = &v
return s
}
// SetEventCategories sets the EventCategories field's value.
func (s *ModifyEventSubscriptionInput) SetEventCategories(v []*string) *ModifyEventSubscriptionInput {
s.EventCategories = v
return s
}
// SetSnsTopicArn sets the SnsTopicArn field's value.
func (s *ModifyEventSubscriptionInput) SetSnsTopicArn(v string) *ModifyEventSubscriptionInput {
s.SnsTopicArn = &v
return s
}
// SetSourceType sets the SourceType field's value.
func (s *ModifyEventSubscriptionInput) SetSourceType(v string) *ModifyEventSubscriptionInput {
s.SourceType = &v
return s
}
// SetSubscriptionName sets the SubscriptionName field's value.
func (s *ModifyEventSubscriptionInput) SetSubscriptionName(v string) *ModifyEventSubscriptionInput {
s.SubscriptionName = &v
return s
}
type ModifyEventSubscriptionOutput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// Contains the results of a successful invocation of the DescribeEventSubscriptions
// action.
EventSubscription *EventSubscription `type:"structure"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s ModifyEventSubscriptionOutput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s ModifyEventSubscriptionOutput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetEventSubscription sets the EventSubscription field's value.
func (s *ModifyEventSubscriptionOutput) SetEventSubscription(v *EventSubscription) *ModifyEventSubscriptionOutput {
s.EventSubscription = v
return s
}
type ModifyGlobalClusterInput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// Indicates if the global database cluster has deletion protection enabled.
// The global database cluster can't be deleted when this value is set to true.
DeletionProtection *bool `type:"boolean"`
// The DB cluster identifier for the global cluster being modified. This parameter
// is not case-sensitive.
//
// Constraints:
//
// * Must match the identifier of an existing global database cluster.
GlobalClusterIdentifier *string `type:"string"`
// The new cluster identifier for the global database cluster when modifying
// a global database cluster. This value is stored as a lowercase string.
//
// Constraints:
//
// * Must contain from 1 to 63 letters, numbers, or hyphens
//
// * The first character must be a letter
//
// * Can't end with a hyphen or contain two consecutive hyphens
//
// Example: my-cluster2
NewGlobalClusterIdentifier *string `type:"string"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s ModifyGlobalClusterInput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s ModifyGlobalClusterInput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetDeletionProtection sets the DeletionProtection field's value.
func (s *ModifyGlobalClusterInput) SetDeletionProtection(v bool) *ModifyGlobalClusterInput {
s.DeletionProtection = &v
return s
}
// SetGlobalClusterIdentifier sets the GlobalClusterIdentifier field's value.
func (s *ModifyGlobalClusterInput) SetGlobalClusterIdentifier(v string) *ModifyGlobalClusterInput {
s.GlobalClusterIdentifier = &v
return s
}
// SetNewGlobalClusterIdentifier sets the NewGlobalClusterIdentifier field's value.
func (s *ModifyGlobalClusterInput) SetNewGlobalClusterIdentifier(v string) *ModifyGlobalClusterInput {
s.NewGlobalClusterIdentifier = &v
return s
}
type ModifyGlobalClusterOutput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// A data type representing an Aurora global database.
GlobalCluster *GlobalCluster `type:"structure"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s ModifyGlobalClusterOutput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s ModifyGlobalClusterOutput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetGlobalCluster sets the GlobalCluster field's value.
func (s *ModifyGlobalClusterOutput) SetGlobalCluster(v *GlobalCluster) *ModifyGlobalClusterOutput {
s.GlobalCluster = v
return s
}
type ModifyOptionGroupInput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// Indicates whether the changes should be applied immediately, or during the
// next maintenance window for each instance associated with the option group.
ApplyImmediately *bool `type:"boolean"`
// The name of the option group to be modified.
//
// Permanent options, such as the TDE option for Oracle Advanced Security TDE,
// can't be removed from an option group, and that option group can't be removed
// from a DB instance once it is associated with a DB instance
//
// OptionGroupName is a required field
OptionGroupName *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
// Options in this list are added to the option group or, if already present,
// the specified configuration is used to update the existing configuration.
OptionsToInclude []*OptionConfiguration `locationNameList:"OptionConfiguration" type:"list"`
// Options in this list are removed from the option group.
OptionsToRemove []*string `type:"list"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s ModifyOptionGroupInput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s ModifyOptionGroupInput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
func (s *ModifyOptionGroupInput) Validate() error {
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "ModifyOptionGroupInput"}
if s.OptionGroupName == nil {
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("OptionGroupName"))
}
if s.OptionsToInclude != nil {
for i, v := range s.OptionsToInclude {
if v == nil {
continue
}
if err := v.Validate(); err != nil {
invalidParams.AddNested(fmt.Sprintf("%s[%v]", "OptionsToInclude", i), err.(request.ErrInvalidParams))
}
}
}
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
return invalidParams
}
return nil
}
// SetApplyImmediately sets the ApplyImmediately field's value.
func (s *ModifyOptionGroupInput) SetApplyImmediately(v bool) *ModifyOptionGroupInput {
s.ApplyImmediately = &v
return s
}
// SetOptionGroupName sets the OptionGroupName field's value.
func (s *ModifyOptionGroupInput) SetOptionGroupName(v string) *ModifyOptionGroupInput {
s.OptionGroupName = &v
return s
}
// SetOptionsToInclude sets the OptionsToInclude field's value.
func (s *ModifyOptionGroupInput) SetOptionsToInclude(v []*OptionConfiguration) *ModifyOptionGroupInput {
s.OptionsToInclude = v
return s
}
// SetOptionsToRemove sets the OptionsToRemove field's value.
func (s *ModifyOptionGroupInput) SetOptionsToRemove(v []*string) *ModifyOptionGroupInput {
s.OptionsToRemove = v
return s
}
type ModifyOptionGroupOutput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
OptionGroup *OptionGroup `type:"structure"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s ModifyOptionGroupOutput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s ModifyOptionGroupOutput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetOptionGroup sets the OptionGroup field's value.
func (s *ModifyOptionGroupOutput) SetOptionGroup(v *OptionGroup) *ModifyOptionGroupOutput {
s.OptionGroup = v
return s
}
// Option details.
type Option struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// If the option requires access to a port, then this DB security group allows
// access to the port.
DBSecurityGroupMemberships []*DBSecurityGroupMembership `locationNameList:"DBSecurityGroup" type:"list"`
// The description of the option.
OptionDescription *string `type:"string"`
// The name of the option.
OptionName *string `type:"string"`
// The option settings for this option.
OptionSettings []*OptionSetting `locationNameList:"OptionSetting" type:"list"`
// The version of the option.
OptionVersion *string `type:"string"`
// Indicate if this option is permanent.
Permanent *bool `type:"boolean"`
// Indicate if this option is persistent.
Persistent *bool `type:"boolean"`
// If required, the port configured for this option to use.
Port *int64 `type:"integer"`
// If the option requires access to a port, then this VPC security group allows
// access to the port.
VpcSecurityGroupMemberships []*VpcSecurityGroupMembership `locationNameList:"VpcSecurityGroupMembership" type:"list"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s Option) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s Option) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetDBSecurityGroupMemberships sets the DBSecurityGroupMemberships field's value.
func (s *Option) SetDBSecurityGroupMemberships(v []*DBSecurityGroupMembership) *Option {
s.DBSecurityGroupMemberships = v
return s
}
// SetOptionDescription sets the OptionDescription field's value.
func (s *Option) SetOptionDescription(v string) *Option {
s.OptionDescription = &v
return s
}
// SetOptionName sets the OptionName field's value.
func (s *Option) SetOptionName(v string) *Option {
s.OptionName = &v
return s
}
// SetOptionSettings sets the OptionSettings field's value.
func (s *Option) SetOptionSettings(v []*OptionSetting) *Option {
s.OptionSettings = v
return s
}
// SetOptionVersion sets the OptionVersion field's value.
func (s *Option) SetOptionVersion(v string) *Option {
s.OptionVersion = &v
return s
}
// SetPermanent sets the Permanent field's value.
func (s *Option) SetPermanent(v bool) *Option {
s.Permanent = &v
return s
}
// SetPersistent sets the Persistent field's value.
func (s *Option) SetPersistent(v bool) *Option {
s.Persistent = &v
return s
}
// SetPort sets the Port field's value.
func (s *Option) SetPort(v int64) *Option {
s.Port = &v
return s
}
// SetVpcSecurityGroupMemberships sets the VpcSecurityGroupMemberships field's value.
func (s *Option) SetVpcSecurityGroupMemberships(v []*VpcSecurityGroupMembership) *Option {
s.VpcSecurityGroupMemberships = v
return s
}
// A list of all available options
type OptionConfiguration struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// A list of DBSecurityGroupMemebrship name strings used for this option.
DBSecurityGroupMemberships []*string `locationNameList:"DBSecurityGroupName" type:"list"`
// The configuration of options to include in a group.
//
// OptionName is a required field
OptionName *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
// The option settings to include in an option group.
OptionSettings []*OptionSetting `locationNameList:"OptionSetting" type:"list"`
// The version for the option.
OptionVersion *string `type:"string"`
// The optional port for the option.
Port *int64 `type:"integer"`
// A list of VpcSecurityGroupMemebrship name strings used for this option.
VpcSecurityGroupMemberships []*string `locationNameList:"VpcSecurityGroupId" type:"list"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s OptionConfiguration) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s OptionConfiguration) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
func (s *OptionConfiguration) Validate() error {
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "OptionConfiguration"}
if s.OptionName == nil {
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("OptionName"))
}
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
return invalidParams
}
return nil
}
// SetDBSecurityGroupMemberships sets the DBSecurityGroupMemberships field's value.
func (s *OptionConfiguration) SetDBSecurityGroupMemberships(v []*string) *OptionConfiguration {
s.DBSecurityGroupMemberships = v
return s
}
// SetOptionName sets the OptionName field's value.
func (s *OptionConfiguration) SetOptionName(v string) *OptionConfiguration {
s.OptionName = &v
return s
}
// SetOptionSettings sets the OptionSettings field's value.
func (s *OptionConfiguration) SetOptionSettings(v []*OptionSetting) *OptionConfiguration {
s.OptionSettings = v
return s
}
// SetOptionVersion sets the OptionVersion field's value.
func (s *OptionConfiguration) SetOptionVersion(v string) *OptionConfiguration {
s.OptionVersion = &v
return s
}
// SetPort sets the Port field's value.
func (s *OptionConfiguration) SetPort(v int64) *OptionConfiguration {
s.Port = &v
return s
}
// SetVpcSecurityGroupMemberships sets the VpcSecurityGroupMemberships field's value.
func (s *OptionConfiguration) SetVpcSecurityGroupMemberships(v []*string) *OptionConfiguration {
s.VpcSecurityGroupMemberships = v
return s
}
type OptionGroup struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// Indicates whether this option group can be applied to both VPC and non-VPC
// instances. The value true indicates the option group can be applied to both
// VPC and non-VPC instances.
AllowsVpcAndNonVpcInstanceMemberships *bool `type:"boolean"`
// Indicates the name of the engine that this option group can be applied to.
EngineName *string `type:"string"`
// Indicates the major engine version associated with this option group.
MajorEngineVersion *string `type:"string"`
// The Amazon Resource Name (ARN) for the option group.
OptionGroupArn *string `type:"string"`
// Provides a description of the option group.
OptionGroupDescription *string `type:"string"`
// Specifies the name of the option group.
OptionGroupName *string `type:"string"`
// Indicates what options are available in the option group.
Options []*Option `locationNameList:"Option" type:"list"`
// If AllowsVpcAndNonVpcInstanceMemberships is false, this field is blank. If
// AllowsVpcAndNonVpcInstanceMemberships is true and this field is blank, then
// this option group can be applied to both VPC and non-VPC instances. If this
// field contains a value, then this option group can only be applied to instances
// that are in the VPC indicated by this field.
VpcId *string `type:"string"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s OptionGroup) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s OptionGroup) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetAllowsVpcAndNonVpcInstanceMemberships sets the AllowsVpcAndNonVpcInstanceMemberships field's value.
func (s *OptionGroup) SetAllowsVpcAndNonVpcInstanceMemberships(v bool) *OptionGroup {
s.AllowsVpcAndNonVpcInstanceMemberships = &v
return s
}
// SetEngineName sets the EngineName field's value.
func (s *OptionGroup) SetEngineName(v string) *OptionGroup {
s.EngineName = &v
return s
}
// SetMajorEngineVersion sets the MajorEngineVersion field's value.
func (s *OptionGroup) SetMajorEngineVersion(v string) *OptionGroup {
s.MajorEngineVersion = &v
return s
}
// SetOptionGroupArn sets the OptionGroupArn field's value.
func (s *OptionGroup) SetOptionGroupArn(v string) *OptionGroup {
s.OptionGroupArn = &v
return s
}
// SetOptionGroupDescription sets the OptionGroupDescription field's value.
func (s *OptionGroup) SetOptionGroupDescription(v string) *OptionGroup {
s.OptionGroupDescription = &v
return s
}
// SetOptionGroupName sets the OptionGroupName field's value.
func (s *OptionGroup) SetOptionGroupName(v string) *OptionGroup {
s.OptionGroupName = &v
return s
}
// SetOptions sets the Options field's value.
func (s *OptionGroup) SetOptions(v []*Option) *OptionGroup {
s.Options = v
return s
}
// SetVpcId sets the VpcId field's value.
func (s *OptionGroup) SetVpcId(v string) *OptionGroup {
s.VpcId = &v
return s
}
// Provides information on the option groups the DB instance is a member of.
type OptionGroupMembership struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// The name of the option group that the instance belongs to.
OptionGroupName *string `type:"string"`
// The status of the DB instance's option group membership. Valid values are:
// in-sync, pending-apply, pending-removal, pending-maintenance-apply, pending-maintenance-removal,
// applying, removing, and failed.
Status *string `type:"string"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s OptionGroupMembership) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s OptionGroupMembership) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetOptionGroupName sets the OptionGroupName field's value.
func (s *OptionGroupMembership) SetOptionGroupName(v string) *OptionGroupMembership {
s.OptionGroupName = &v
return s
}
// SetStatus sets the Status field's value.
func (s *OptionGroupMembership) SetStatus(v string) *OptionGroupMembership {
s.Status = &v
return s
}
// Available option.
type OptionGroupOption struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// If the option requires a port, specifies the default port for the option.
DefaultPort *int64 `type:"integer"`
// The description of the option.
Description *string `type:"string"`
// The name of the engine that this option can be applied to.
EngineName *string `type:"string"`
// Indicates the major engine version that the option is available for.
MajorEngineVersion *string `type:"string"`
// The minimum required engine version for the option to be applied.
MinimumRequiredMinorEngineVersion *string `type:"string"`
// The name of the option.
Name *string `type:"string"`
// The option settings that are available (and the default value) for each option
// in an option group.
OptionGroupOptionSettings []*OptionGroupOptionSetting `locationNameList:"OptionGroupOptionSetting" type:"list"`
// The versions that are available for the option.
OptionGroupOptionVersions []*OptionVersion `locationNameList:"OptionVersion" type:"list"`
// The options that conflict with this option.
OptionsConflictsWith []*string `locationNameList:"OptionConflictName" type:"list"`
// The options that are prerequisites for this option.
OptionsDependedOn []*string `locationNameList:"OptionName" type:"list"`
// Permanent options can never be removed from an option group. An option group
// containing a permanent option can't be removed from a DB instance.
Permanent *bool `type:"boolean"`
// Persistent options can't be removed from an option group while DB instances
// are associated with the option group. If you disassociate all DB instances
// from the option group, your can remove the persistent option from the option
// group.
Persistent *bool `type:"boolean"`
// Specifies whether the option requires a port.
PortRequired *bool `type:"boolean"`
// If true, you must enable the Auto Minor Version Upgrade setting for your
// DB instance before you can use this option. You can enable Auto Minor Version
// Upgrade when you first create your DB instance, or by modifying your DB instance
// later.
RequiresAutoMinorEngineVersionUpgrade *bool `type:"boolean"`
// If true, you can change the option to an earlier version of the option. This
// only applies to options that have different versions available.
SupportsOptionVersionDowngrade *bool `type:"boolean"`
// If true, you can only use this option with a DB instance that is in a VPC.
VpcOnly *bool `type:"boolean"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s OptionGroupOption) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s OptionGroupOption) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetDefaultPort sets the DefaultPort field's value.
func (s *OptionGroupOption) SetDefaultPort(v int64) *OptionGroupOption {
s.DefaultPort = &v
return s
}
// SetDescription sets the Description field's value.
func (s *OptionGroupOption) SetDescription(v string) *OptionGroupOption {
s.Description = &v
return s
}
// SetEngineName sets the EngineName field's value.
func (s *OptionGroupOption) SetEngineName(v string) *OptionGroupOption {
s.EngineName = &v
return s
}
// SetMajorEngineVersion sets the MajorEngineVersion field's value.
func (s *OptionGroupOption) SetMajorEngineVersion(v string) *OptionGroupOption {
s.MajorEngineVersion = &v
return s
}
// SetMinimumRequiredMinorEngineVersion sets the MinimumRequiredMinorEngineVersion field's value.
func (s *OptionGroupOption) SetMinimumRequiredMinorEngineVersion(v string) *OptionGroupOption {
s.MinimumRequiredMinorEngineVersion = &v
return s
}
// SetName sets the Name field's value.
func (s *OptionGroupOption) SetName(v string) *OptionGroupOption {
s.Name = &v
return s
}
// SetOptionGroupOptionSettings sets the OptionGroupOptionSettings field's value.
func (s *OptionGroupOption) SetOptionGroupOptionSettings(v []*OptionGroupOptionSetting) *OptionGroupOption {
s.OptionGroupOptionSettings = v
return s
}
// SetOptionGroupOptionVersions sets the OptionGroupOptionVersions field's value.
func (s *OptionGroupOption) SetOptionGroupOptionVersions(v []*OptionVersion) *OptionGroupOption {
s.OptionGroupOptionVersions = v
return s
}
// SetOptionsConflictsWith sets the OptionsConflictsWith field's value.
func (s *OptionGroupOption) SetOptionsConflictsWith(v []*string) *OptionGroupOption {
s.OptionsConflictsWith = v
return s
}
// SetOptionsDependedOn sets the OptionsDependedOn field's value.
func (s *OptionGroupOption) SetOptionsDependedOn(v []*string) *OptionGroupOption {
s.OptionsDependedOn = v
return s
}
// SetPermanent sets the Permanent field's value.
func (s *OptionGroupOption) SetPermanent(v bool) *OptionGroupOption {
s.Permanent = &v
return s
}
// SetPersistent sets the Persistent field's value.
func (s *OptionGroupOption) SetPersistent(v bool) *OptionGroupOption {
s.Persistent = &v
return s
}
// SetPortRequired sets the PortRequired field's value.
func (s *OptionGroupOption) SetPortRequired(v bool) *OptionGroupOption {
s.PortRequired = &v
return s
}
// SetRequiresAutoMinorEngineVersionUpgrade sets the RequiresAutoMinorEngineVersionUpgrade field's value.
func (s *OptionGroupOption) SetRequiresAutoMinorEngineVersionUpgrade(v bool) *OptionGroupOption {
s.RequiresAutoMinorEngineVersionUpgrade = &v
return s
}
// SetSupportsOptionVersionDowngrade sets the SupportsOptionVersionDowngrade field's value.
func (s *OptionGroupOption) SetSupportsOptionVersionDowngrade(v bool) *OptionGroupOption {
s.SupportsOptionVersionDowngrade = &v
return s
}
// SetVpcOnly sets the VpcOnly field's value.
func (s *OptionGroupOption) SetVpcOnly(v bool) *OptionGroupOption {
s.VpcOnly = &v
return s
}
// Option group option settings are used to display settings available for each
// option with their default values and other information. These values are
// used with the DescribeOptionGroupOptions action.
type OptionGroupOptionSetting struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// Indicates the acceptable values for the option group option.
AllowedValues *string `type:"string"`
// The DB engine specific parameter type for the option group option.
ApplyType *string `type:"string"`
// The default value for the option group option.
DefaultValue *string `type:"string"`
// Boolean value where true indicates that this option group option can be changed
// from the default value.
IsModifiable *bool `type:"boolean"`
// Boolean value where true indicates that a value must be specified for this
// option setting of the option group option.
IsRequired *bool `type:"boolean"`
// The minimum DB engine version required for the corresponding allowed value
// for this option setting.
MinimumEngineVersionPerAllowedValue []*MinimumEngineVersionPerAllowedValue `locationNameList:"MinimumEngineVersionPerAllowedValue" type:"list"`
// The description of the option group option.
SettingDescription *string `type:"string"`
// The name of the option group option.
SettingName *string `type:"string"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s OptionGroupOptionSetting) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s OptionGroupOptionSetting) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetAllowedValues sets the AllowedValues field's value.
func (s *OptionGroupOptionSetting) SetAllowedValues(v string) *OptionGroupOptionSetting {
s.AllowedValues = &v
return s
}
// SetApplyType sets the ApplyType field's value.
func (s *OptionGroupOptionSetting) SetApplyType(v string) *OptionGroupOptionSetting {
s.ApplyType = &v
return s
}
// SetDefaultValue sets the DefaultValue field's value.
func (s *OptionGroupOptionSetting) SetDefaultValue(v string) *OptionGroupOptionSetting {
s.DefaultValue = &v
return s
}
// SetIsModifiable sets the IsModifiable field's value.
func (s *OptionGroupOptionSetting) SetIsModifiable(v bool) *OptionGroupOptionSetting {
s.IsModifiable = &v
return s
}
// SetIsRequired sets the IsRequired field's value.
func (s *OptionGroupOptionSetting) SetIsRequired(v bool) *OptionGroupOptionSetting {
s.IsRequired = &v
return s
}
// SetMinimumEngineVersionPerAllowedValue sets the MinimumEngineVersionPerAllowedValue field's value.
func (s *OptionGroupOptionSetting) SetMinimumEngineVersionPerAllowedValue(v []*MinimumEngineVersionPerAllowedValue) *OptionGroupOptionSetting {
s.MinimumEngineVersionPerAllowedValue = v
return s
}
// SetSettingDescription sets the SettingDescription field's value.
func (s *OptionGroupOptionSetting) SetSettingDescription(v string) *OptionGroupOptionSetting {
s.SettingDescription = &v
return s
}
// SetSettingName sets the SettingName field's value.
func (s *OptionGroupOptionSetting) SetSettingName(v string) *OptionGroupOptionSetting {
s.SettingName = &v
return s
}
// Option settings are the actual settings being applied or configured for that
// option. It is used when you modify an option group or describe option groups.
// For example, the NATIVE_NETWORK_ENCRYPTION option has a setting called SQLNET.ENCRYPTION_SERVER
// that can have several different values.
type OptionSetting struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// The allowed values of the option setting.
AllowedValues *string `type:"string"`
// The DB engine specific parameter type.
ApplyType *string `type:"string"`
// The data type of the option setting.
DataType *string `type:"string"`
// The default value of the option setting.
DefaultValue *string `type:"string"`
// The description of the option setting.
Description *string `type:"string"`
// Indicates if the option setting is part of a collection.
IsCollection *bool `type:"boolean"`
// A Boolean value that, when true, indicates the option setting can be modified
// from the default.
IsModifiable *bool `type:"boolean"`
// The name of the option that has settings that you can set.
Name *string `type:"string"`
// The current value of the option setting.
Value *string `type:"string"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s OptionSetting) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s OptionSetting) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetAllowedValues sets the AllowedValues field's value.
func (s *OptionSetting) SetAllowedValues(v string) *OptionSetting {
s.AllowedValues = &v
return s
}
// SetApplyType sets the ApplyType field's value.
func (s *OptionSetting) SetApplyType(v string) *OptionSetting {
s.ApplyType = &v
return s
}
// SetDataType sets the DataType field's value.
func (s *OptionSetting) SetDataType(v string) *OptionSetting {
s.DataType = &v
return s
}
// SetDefaultValue sets the DefaultValue field's value.
func (s *OptionSetting) SetDefaultValue(v string) *OptionSetting {
s.DefaultValue = &v
return s
}
// SetDescription sets the Description field's value.
func (s *OptionSetting) SetDescription(v string) *OptionSetting {
s.Description = &v
return s
}
// SetIsCollection sets the IsCollection field's value.
func (s *OptionSetting) SetIsCollection(v bool) *OptionSetting {
s.IsCollection = &v
return s
}
// SetIsModifiable sets the IsModifiable field's value.
func (s *OptionSetting) SetIsModifiable(v bool) *OptionSetting {
s.IsModifiable = &v
return s
}
// SetName sets the Name field's value.
func (s *OptionSetting) SetName(v string) *OptionSetting {
s.Name = &v
return s
}
// SetValue sets the Value field's value.
func (s *OptionSetting) SetValue(v string) *OptionSetting {
s.Value = &v
return s
}
// The version for an option. Option group option versions are returned by the
// DescribeOptionGroupOptions action.
type OptionVersion struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// True if the version is the default version of the option, and otherwise false.
IsDefault *bool `type:"boolean"`
// The version of the option.
Version *string `type:"string"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s OptionVersion) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s OptionVersion) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetIsDefault sets the IsDefault field's value.
func (s *OptionVersion) SetIsDefault(v bool) *OptionVersion {
s.IsDefault = &v
return s
}
// SetVersion sets the Version field's value.
func (s *OptionVersion) SetVersion(v string) *OptionVersion {
s.Version = &v
return s
}
// Contains a list of available options for a DB instance.
//
// This data type is used as a response element in the DescribeOrderableDBInstanceOptions
// action.
type OrderableDBInstanceOption struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// A list of Availability Zones for a DB instance.
AvailabilityZones []*AvailabilityZone `locationNameList:"AvailabilityZone" type:"list"`
// A list of the available processor features for the DB instance class of a
// DB instance.
AvailableProcessorFeatures []*AvailableProcessorFeature `locationNameList:"AvailableProcessorFeature" type:"list"`
// The DB instance class for a DB instance.
DBInstanceClass *string `type:"string"`
// The engine type of a DB instance.
Engine *string `type:"string"`
// The engine version of a DB instance.
EngineVersion *string `type:"string"`
// The license model for a DB instance.
LicenseModel *string `type:"string"`
// Maximum total provisioned IOPS for a DB instance.
MaxIopsPerDbInstance *int64 `type:"integer"`
// Maximum provisioned IOPS per GiB for a DB instance.
MaxIopsPerGib *float64 `type:"double"`
// Maximum storage size for a DB instance.
MaxStorageSize *int64 `type:"integer"`
// Minimum total provisioned IOPS for a DB instance.
MinIopsPerDbInstance *int64 `type:"integer"`
// Minimum provisioned IOPS per GiB for a DB instance.
MinIopsPerGib *float64 `type:"double"`
// Minimum storage size for a DB instance.
MinStorageSize *int64 `type:"integer"`
// Indicates whether a DB instance is Multi-AZ capable.
MultiAZCapable *bool `type:"boolean"`
// Indicates whether a DB instance can have a Read Replica.
ReadReplicaCapable *bool `type:"boolean"`
// Indicates the storage type for a DB instance.
StorageType *string `type:"string"`
// A list of the supported DB engine modes.
SupportedEngineModes []*string `type:"list"`
// Indicates whether a DB instance supports Enhanced Monitoring at intervals
// from 1 to 60 seconds.
SupportsEnhancedMonitoring *bool `type:"boolean"`
// Indicates whether a DB instance supports IAM database authentication.
SupportsIAMDatabaseAuthentication *bool `type:"boolean"`
// Indicates whether a DB instance supports provisioned IOPS.
SupportsIops *bool `type:"boolean"`
// True if a DB instance supports Performance Insights, otherwise false.
SupportsPerformanceInsights *bool `type:"boolean"`
// Indicates whether a DB instance supports encrypted storage.
SupportsStorageEncryption *bool `type:"boolean"`
// Indicates whether a DB instance is in a VPC.
Vpc *bool `type:"boolean"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s OrderableDBInstanceOption) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s OrderableDBInstanceOption) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetAvailabilityZones sets the AvailabilityZones field's value.
func (s *OrderableDBInstanceOption) SetAvailabilityZones(v []*AvailabilityZone) *OrderableDBInstanceOption {
s.AvailabilityZones = v
return s
}
// SetAvailableProcessorFeatures sets the AvailableProcessorFeatures field's value.
func (s *OrderableDBInstanceOption) SetAvailableProcessorFeatures(v []*AvailableProcessorFeature) *OrderableDBInstanceOption {
s.AvailableProcessorFeatures = v
return s
}
// SetDBInstanceClass sets the DBInstanceClass field's value.
func (s *OrderableDBInstanceOption) SetDBInstanceClass(v string) *OrderableDBInstanceOption {
s.DBInstanceClass = &v
return s
}
// SetEngine sets the Engine field's value.
func (s *OrderableDBInstanceOption) SetEngine(v string) *OrderableDBInstanceOption {
s.Engine = &v
return s
}
// SetEngineVersion sets the EngineVersion field's value.
func (s *OrderableDBInstanceOption) SetEngineVersion(v string) *OrderableDBInstanceOption {
s.EngineVersion = &v
return s
}
// SetLicenseModel sets the LicenseModel field's value.
func (s *OrderableDBInstanceOption) SetLicenseModel(v string) *OrderableDBInstanceOption {
s.LicenseModel = &v
return s
}
// SetMaxIopsPerDbInstance sets the MaxIopsPerDbInstance field's value.
func (s *OrderableDBInstanceOption) SetMaxIopsPerDbInstance(v int64) *OrderableDBInstanceOption {
s.MaxIopsPerDbInstance = &v
return s
}
// SetMaxIopsPerGib sets the MaxIopsPerGib field's value.
func (s *OrderableDBInstanceOption) SetMaxIopsPerGib(v float64) *OrderableDBInstanceOption {
s.MaxIopsPerGib = &v
return s
}
// SetMaxStorageSize sets the MaxStorageSize field's value.
func (s *OrderableDBInstanceOption) SetMaxStorageSize(v int64) *OrderableDBInstanceOption {
s.MaxStorageSize = &v
return s
}
// SetMinIopsPerDbInstance sets the MinIopsPerDbInstance field's value.
func (s *OrderableDBInstanceOption) SetMinIopsPerDbInstance(v int64) *OrderableDBInstanceOption {
s.MinIopsPerDbInstance = &v
return s
}
// SetMinIopsPerGib sets the MinIopsPerGib field's value.
func (s *OrderableDBInstanceOption) SetMinIopsPerGib(v float64) *OrderableDBInstanceOption {
s.MinIopsPerGib = &v
return s
}
// SetMinStorageSize sets the MinStorageSize field's value.
func (s *OrderableDBInstanceOption) SetMinStorageSize(v int64) *OrderableDBInstanceOption {
s.MinStorageSize = &v
return s
}
// SetMultiAZCapable sets the MultiAZCapable field's value.
func (s *OrderableDBInstanceOption) SetMultiAZCapable(v bool) *OrderableDBInstanceOption {
s.MultiAZCapable = &v
return s
}
// SetReadReplicaCapable sets the ReadReplicaCapable field's value.
func (s *OrderableDBInstanceOption) SetReadReplicaCapable(v bool) *OrderableDBInstanceOption {
s.ReadReplicaCapable = &v
return s
}
// SetStorageType sets the StorageType field's value.
func (s *OrderableDBInstanceOption) SetStorageType(v string) *OrderableDBInstanceOption {
s.StorageType = &v
return s
}
// SetSupportedEngineModes sets the SupportedEngineModes field's value.
func (s *OrderableDBInstanceOption) SetSupportedEngineModes(v []*string) *OrderableDBInstanceOption {
s.SupportedEngineModes = v
return s
}
// SetSupportsEnhancedMonitoring sets the SupportsEnhancedMonitoring field's value.
func (s *OrderableDBInstanceOption) SetSupportsEnhancedMonitoring(v bool) *OrderableDBInstanceOption {
s.SupportsEnhancedMonitoring = &v
return s
}
// SetSupportsIAMDatabaseAuthentication sets the SupportsIAMDatabaseAuthentication field's value.
func (s *OrderableDBInstanceOption) SetSupportsIAMDatabaseAuthentication(v bool) *OrderableDBInstanceOption {
s.SupportsIAMDatabaseAuthentication = &v
return s
}
// SetSupportsIops sets the SupportsIops field's value.
func (s *OrderableDBInstanceOption) SetSupportsIops(v bool) *OrderableDBInstanceOption {
s.SupportsIops = &v
return s
}
// SetSupportsPerformanceInsights sets the SupportsPerformanceInsights field's value.
func (s *OrderableDBInstanceOption) SetSupportsPerformanceInsights(v bool) *OrderableDBInstanceOption {
s.SupportsPerformanceInsights = &v
return s
}
// SetSupportsStorageEncryption sets the SupportsStorageEncryption field's value.
func (s *OrderableDBInstanceOption) SetSupportsStorageEncryption(v bool) *OrderableDBInstanceOption {
s.SupportsStorageEncryption = &v
return s
}
// SetVpc sets the Vpc field's value.
func (s *OrderableDBInstanceOption) SetVpc(v bool) *OrderableDBInstanceOption {
s.Vpc = &v
return s
}
// This data type is used as a request parameter in the ModifyDBParameterGroup
// and ResetDBParameterGroup actions.
//
// This data type is used as a response element in the DescribeEngineDefaultParameters
// and DescribeDBParameters actions.
type Parameter struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// Specifies the valid range of values for the parameter.
AllowedValues *string `type:"string"`
// Indicates when to apply parameter updates.
ApplyMethod *string `type:"string" enum:"ApplyMethod"`
// Specifies the engine specific parameters type.
ApplyType *string `type:"string"`
// Specifies the valid data type for the parameter.
DataType *string `type:"string"`
// Provides a description of the parameter.
Description *string `type:"string"`
// Indicates whether (true) or not (false) the parameter can be modified. Some
// parameters have security or operational implications that prevent them from
// being changed.
IsModifiable *bool `type:"boolean"`
// The earliest engine version to which the parameter can apply.
MinimumEngineVersion *string `type:"string"`
// Specifies the name of the parameter.
ParameterName *string `type:"string"`
// Specifies the value of the parameter.
ParameterValue *string `type:"string"`
// Indicates the source of the parameter value.
Source *string `type:"string"`
// The valid DB engine modes.
SupportedEngineModes []*string `type:"list"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s Parameter) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s Parameter) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetAllowedValues sets the AllowedValues field's value.
func (s *Parameter) SetAllowedValues(v string) *Parameter {
s.AllowedValues = &v
return s
}
// SetApplyMethod sets the ApplyMethod field's value.
func (s *Parameter) SetApplyMethod(v string) *Parameter {
s.ApplyMethod = &v
return s
}
// SetApplyType sets the ApplyType field's value.
func (s *Parameter) SetApplyType(v string) *Parameter {
s.ApplyType = &v
return s
}
// SetDataType sets the DataType field's value.
func (s *Parameter) SetDataType(v string) *Parameter {
s.DataType = &v
return s
}
// SetDescription sets the Description field's value.
func (s *Parameter) SetDescription(v string) *Parameter {
s.Description = &v
return s
}
// SetIsModifiable sets the IsModifiable field's value.
func (s *Parameter) SetIsModifiable(v bool) *Parameter {
s.IsModifiable = &v
return s
}
// SetMinimumEngineVersion sets the MinimumEngineVersion field's value.
func (s *Parameter) SetMinimumEngineVersion(v string) *Parameter {
s.MinimumEngineVersion = &v
return s
}
// SetParameterName sets the ParameterName field's value.
func (s *Parameter) SetParameterName(v string) *Parameter {
s.ParameterName = &v
return s
}
// SetParameterValue sets the ParameterValue field's value.
func (s *Parameter) SetParameterValue(v string) *Parameter {
s.ParameterValue = &v
return s
}
// SetSource sets the Source field's value.
func (s *Parameter) SetSource(v string) *Parameter {
s.Source = &v
return s
}
// SetSupportedEngineModes sets the SupportedEngineModes field's value.
func (s *Parameter) SetSupportedEngineModes(v []*string) *Parameter {
s.SupportedEngineModes = v
return s
}
// A list of the log types whose configuration is still pending. In other words,
// these log types are in the process of being activated or deactivated.
type PendingCloudwatchLogsExports struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// Log types that are in the process of being enabled. After they are enabled,
// these log types are exported to CloudWatch Logs.
LogTypesToDisable []*string `type:"list"`
// Log types that are in the process of being deactivated. After they are deactivated,
// these log types aren't exported to CloudWatch Logs.
LogTypesToEnable []*string `type:"list"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s PendingCloudwatchLogsExports) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s PendingCloudwatchLogsExports) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetLogTypesToDisable sets the LogTypesToDisable field's value.
func (s *PendingCloudwatchLogsExports) SetLogTypesToDisable(v []*string) *PendingCloudwatchLogsExports {
s.LogTypesToDisable = v
return s
}
// SetLogTypesToEnable sets the LogTypesToEnable field's value.
func (s *PendingCloudwatchLogsExports) SetLogTypesToEnable(v []*string) *PendingCloudwatchLogsExports {
s.LogTypesToEnable = v
return s
}
// Provides information about a pending maintenance action for a resource.
type PendingMaintenanceAction struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// The type of pending maintenance action that is available for the resource.
// Valid actions are system-update and db-upgrade.
Action *string `type:"string"`
// The date of the maintenance window when the action is applied. The maintenance
// action is applied to the resource during its first maintenance window after
// this date. If this date is specified, any next-maintenance opt-in requests
// are ignored.
AutoAppliedAfterDate *time.Time `type:"timestamp"`
// The effective date when the pending maintenance action is applied to the
// resource. This date takes into account opt-in requests received from the
// ApplyPendingMaintenanceAction API, the AutoAppliedAfterDate, and the ForcedApplyDate.
// This value is blank if an opt-in request has not been received and nothing
// has been specified as AutoAppliedAfterDate or ForcedApplyDate.
CurrentApplyDate *time.Time `type:"timestamp"`
// A description providing more detail about the maintenance action.
Description *string `type:"string"`
// The date when the maintenance action is automatically applied. The maintenance
// action is applied to the resource on this date regardless of the maintenance
// window for the resource. If this date is specified, any immediate opt-in
// requests are ignored.
ForcedApplyDate *time.Time `type:"timestamp"`
// Indicates the type of opt-in request that has been received for the resource.
OptInStatus *string `type:"string"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s PendingMaintenanceAction) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s PendingMaintenanceAction) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetAction sets the Action field's value.
func (s *PendingMaintenanceAction) SetAction(v string) *PendingMaintenanceAction {
s.Action = &v
return s
}
// SetAutoAppliedAfterDate sets the AutoAppliedAfterDate field's value.
func (s *PendingMaintenanceAction) SetAutoAppliedAfterDate(v time.Time) *PendingMaintenanceAction {
s.AutoAppliedAfterDate = &v
return s
}
// SetCurrentApplyDate sets the CurrentApplyDate field's value.
func (s *PendingMaintenanceAction) SetCurrentApplyDate(v time.Time) *PendingMaintenanceAction {
s.CurrentApplyDate = &v
return s
}
// SetDescription sets the Description field's value.
func (s *PendingMaintenanceAction) SetDescription(v string) *PendingMaintenanceAction {
s.Description = &v
return s
}
// SetForcedApplyDate sets the ForcedApplyDate field's value.
func (s *PendingMaintenanceAction) SetForcedApplyDate(v time.Time) *PendingMaintenanceAction {
s.ForcedApplyDate = &v
return s
}
// SetOptInStatus sets the OptInStatus field's value.
func (s *PendingMaintenanceAction) SetOptInStatus(v string) *PendingMaintenanceAction {
s.OptInStatus = &v
return s
}
// This data type is used as a response element in the ModifyDBInstance action.
type PendingModifiedValues struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// Contains the new AllocatedStorage size for the DB instance that will be applied
// or is currently being applied.
AllocatedStorage *int64 `type:"integer"`
// Specifies the pending number of days for which automated backups are retained.
BackupRetentionPeriod *int64 `type:"integer"`
// Specifies the identifier of the CA certificate for the DB instance.
CACertificateIdentifier *string `type:"string"`
// Contains the new DBInstanceClass for the DB instance that will be applied
// or is currently being applied.
DBInstanceClass *string `type:"string"`
// Contains the new DBInstanceIdentifier for the DB instance that will be applied
// or is currently being applied.
DBInstanceIdentifier *string `type:"string"`
// The new DB subnet group for the DB instance.
DBSubnetGroupName *string `type:"string"`
// Indicates the database engine version.
EngineVersion *string `type:"string"`
// Specifies the new Provisioned IOPS value for the DB instance that will be
// applied or is currently being applied.
Iops *int64 `type:"integer"`
// The license model for the DB instance.
//
// Valid values: license-included | bring-your-own-license | general-public-license
LicenseModel *string `type:"string"`
// Contains the pending or currently-in-progress change of the master credentials
// for the DB instance.
MasterUserPassword *string `type:"string"`
// Indicates that the Single-AZ DB instance is to change to a Multi-AZ deployment.
MultiAZ *bool `type:"boolean"`
// A list of the log types whose configuration is still pending. In other words,
// these log types are in the process of being activated or deactivated.
PendingCloudwatchLogsExports *PendingCloudwatchLogsExports `type:"structure"`
// Specifies the pending port for the DB instance.
Port *int64 `type:"integer"`
// The number of CPU cores and the number of threads per core for the DB instance
// class of the DB instance.
ProcessorFeatures []*ProcessorFeature `locationNameList:"ProcessorFeature" type:"list"`
// Specifies the storage type to be associated with the DB instance.
StorageType *string `type:"string"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s PendingModifiedValues) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s PendingModifiedValues) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetAllocatedStorage sets the AllocatedStorage field's value.
func (s *PendingModifiedValues) SetAllocatedStorage(v int64) *PendingModifiedValues {
s.AllocatedStorage = &v
return s
}
// SetBackupRetentionPeriod sets the BackupRetentionPeriod field's value.
func (s *PendingModifiedValues) SetBackupRetentionPeriod(v int64) *PendingModifiedValues {
s.BackupRetentionPeriod = &v
return s
}
// SetCACertificateIdentifier sets the CACertificateIdentifier field's value.
func (s *PendingModifiedValues) SetCACertificateIdentifier(v string) *PendingModifiedValues {
s.CACertificateIdentifier = &v
return s
}
// SetDBInstanceClass sets the DBInstanceClass field's value.
func (s *PendingModifiedValues) SetDBInstanceClass(v string) *PendingModifiedValues {
s.DBInstanceClass = &v
return s
}
// SetDBInstanceIdentifier sets the DBInstanceIdentifier field's value.
func (s *PendingModifiedValues) SetDBInstanceIdentifier(v string) *PendingModifiedValues {
s.DBInstanceIdentifier = &v
return s
}
// SetDBSubnetGroupName sets the DBSubnetGroupName field's value.
func (s *PendingModifiedValues) SetDBSubnetGroupName(v string) *PendingModifiedValues {
s.DBSubnetGroupName = &v
return s
}
// SetEngineVersion sets the EngineVersion field's value.
func (s *PendingModifiedValues) SetEngineVersion(v string) *PendingModifiedValues {
s.EngineVersion = &v
return s
}
// SetIops sets the Iops field's value.
func (s *PendingModifiedValues) SetIops(v int64) *PendingModifiedValues {
s.Iops = &v
return s
}
// SetLicenseModel sets the LicenseModel field's value.
func (s *PendingModifiedValues) SetLicenseModel(v string) *PendingModifiedValues {
s.LicenseModel = &v
return s
}
// SetMasterUserPassword sets the MasterUserPassword field's value.
func (s *PendingModifiedValues) SetMasterUserPassword(v string) *PendingModifiedValues {
s.MasterUserPassword = &v
return s
}
// SetMultiAZ sets the MultiAZ field's value.
func (s *PendingModifiedValues) SetMultiAZ(v bool) *PendingModifiedValues {
s.MultiAZ = &v
return s
}
// SetPendingCloudwatchLogsExports sets the PendingCloudwatchLogsExports field's value.
func (s *PendingModifiedValues) SetPendingCloudwatchLogsExports(v *PendingCloudwatchLogsExports) *PendingModifiedValues {
s.PendingCloudwatchLogsExports = v
return s
}
// SetPort sets the Port field's value.
func (s *PendingModifiedValues) SetPort(v int64) *PendingModifiedValues {
s.Port = &v
return s
}
// SetProcessorFeatures sets the ProcessorFeatures field's value.
func (s *PendingModifiedValues) SetProcessorFeatures(v []*ProcessorFeature) *PendingModifiedValues {
s.ProcessorFeatures = v
return s
}
// SetStorageType sets the StorageType field's value.
func (s *PendingModifiedValues) SetStorageType(v string) *PendingModifiedValues {
s.StorageType = &v
return s
}
// Contains the processor features of a DB instance class.
//
// To specify the number of CPU cores, use the coreCount feature name for the
// Name parameter. To specify the number of threads per core, use the threadsPerCore
// feature name for the Name parameter.
//
// You can set the processor features of the DB instance class for a DB instance
// when you call one of the following actions:
//
// * CreateDBInstance
//
// * ModifyDBInstance
//
// * RestoreDBInstanceFromDBSnapshot
//
// * RestoreDBInstanceFromS3
//
// * RestoreDBInstanceToPointInTime
//
// You can view the valid processor values for a particular instance class by
// calling the DescribeOrderableDBInstanceOptions action and specifying the
// instance class for the DBInstanceClass parameter.
//
// In addition, you can use the following actions for DB instance class processor
// information:
//
// * DescribeDBInstances
//
// * DescribeDBSnapshots
//
// * DescribeValidDBInstanceModifications
//
// For more information, see Configuring the Processor of the DB Instance Class
// (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/UserGuide/Concepts.DBInstanceClass.html#USER_ConfigureProcessor)
// in the Amazon RDS User Guide.
type ProcessorFeature struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// The name of the processor feature. Valid names are coreCount and threadsPerCore.
Name *string `type:"string"`
// The value of a processor feature name.
Value *string `type:"string"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s ProcessorFeature) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s ProcessorFeature) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetName sets the Name field's value.
func (s *ProcessorFeature) SetName(v string) *ProcessorFeature {
s.Name = &v
return s
}
// SetValue sets the Value field's value.
func (s *ProcessorFeature) SetValue(v string) *ProcessorFeature {
s.Value = &v
return s
}
type PromoteReadReplicaDBClusterInput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// The identifier of the DB cluster Read Replica to promote. This parameter
// is not case-sensitive.
//
// Constraints:
//
// * Must match the identifier of an existing DBCluster Read Replica.
//
// Example: my-cluster-replica1
//
// DBClusterIdentifier is a required field
DBClusterIdentifier *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s PromoteReadReplicaDBClusterInput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s PromoteReadReplicaDBClusterInput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
func (s *PromoteReadReplicaDBClusterInput) Validate() error {
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "PromoteReadReplicaDBClusterInput"}
if s.DBClusterIdentifier == nil {
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("DBClusterIdentifier"))
}
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
return invalidParams
}
return nil
}
// SetDBClusterIdentifier sets the DBClusterIdentifier field's value.
func (s *PromoteReadReplicaDBClusterInput) SetDBClusterIdentifier(v string) *PromoteReadReplicaDBClusterInput {
s.DBClusterIdentifier = &v
return s
}
type PromoteReadReplicaDBClusterOutput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// Contains the details of an Amazon Aurora DB cluster.
//
// This data type is used as a response element in the DescribeDBClusters, StopDBCluster,
// and StartDBCluster actions.
DBCluster *DBCluster `type:"structure"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s PromoteReadReplicaDBClusterOutput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s PromoteReadReplicaDBClusterOutput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetDBCluster sets the DBCluster field's value.
func (s *PromoteReadReplicaDBClusterOutput) SetDBCluster(v *DBCluster) *PromoteReadReplicaDBClusterOutput {
s.DBCluster = v
return s
}
type PromoteReadReplicaInput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// The number of days to retain automated backups. Setting this parameter to
// a positive number enables backups. Setting this parameter to 0 disables automated
// backups.
//
// Default: 1
//
// Constraints:
//
// * Must be a value from 0 to 8
BackupRetentionPeriod *int64 `type:"integer"`
// The DB instance identifier. This value is stored as a lowercase string.
//
// Constraints:
//
// * Must match the identifier of an existing Read Replica DB instance.
//
// Example: mydbinstance
//
// DBInstanceIdentifier is a required field
DBInstanceIdentifier *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
// The daily time range during which automated backups are created if automated
// backups are enabled, using the BackupRetentionPeriod parameter.
//
// The default is a 30-minute window selected at random from an 8-hour block
// of time for each AWS Region. To see the time blocks available, see Adjusting
// the Preferred Maintenance Window (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/UserGuide/AdjustingTheMaintenanceWindow.html)
// in the Amazon RDS User Guide.
//
// Constraints:
//
// * Must be in the format hh24:mi-hh24:mi.
//
// * Must be in Universal Coordinated Time (UTC).
//
// * Must not conflict with the preferred maintenance window.
//
// * Must be at least 30 minutes.
PreferredBackupWindow *string `type:"string"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s PromoteReadReplicaInput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s PromoteReadReplicaInput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
func (s *PromoteReadReplicaInput) Validate() error {
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "PromoteReadReplicaInput"}
if s.DBInstanceIdentifier == nil {
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("DBInstanceIdentifier"))
}
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
return invalidParams
}
return nil
}
// SetBackupRetentionPeriod sets the BackupRetentionPeriod field's value.
func (s *PromoteReadReplicaInput) SetBackupRetentionPeriod(v int64) *PromoteReadReplicaInput {
s.BackupRetentionPeriod = &v
return s
}
// SetDBInstanceIdentifier sets the DBInstanceIdentifier field's value.
func (s *PromoteReadReplicaInput) SetDBInstanceIdentifier(v string) *PromoteReadReplicaInput {
s.DBInstanceIdentifier = &v
return s
}
// SetPreferredBackupWindow sets the PreferredBackupWindow field's value.
func (s *PromoteReadReplicaInput) SetPreferredBackupWindow(v string) *PromoteReadReplicaInput {
s.PreferredBackupWindow = &v
return s
}
type PromoteReadReplicaOutput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// Contains the details of an Amazon RDS DB instance.
//
// This data type is used as a response element in the DescribeDBInstances action.
DBInstance *DBInstance `type:"structure"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s PromoteReadReplicaOutput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s PromoteReadReplicaOutput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetDBInstance sets the DBInstance field's value.
func (s *PromoteReadReplicaOutput) SetDBInstance(v *DBInstance) *PromoteReadReplicaOutput {
s.DBInstance = v
return s
}
type PurchaseReservedDBInstancesOfferingInput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// The number of instances to reserve.
//
// Default: 1
DBInstanceCount *int64 `type:"integer"`
// Customer-specified identifier to track this reservation.
//
// Example: myreservationID
ReservedDBInstanceId *string `type:"string"`
// The ID of the Reserved DB instance offering to purchase.
//
// Example: 438012d3-4052-4cc7-b2e3-8d3372e0e706
//
// ReservedDBInstancesOfferingId is a required field
ReservedDBInstancesOfferingId *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
// A list of tags. For more information, see Tagging Amazon RDS Resources (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/UserGuide/USER_Tagging.html)
// in the Amazon RDS User Guide.
Tags []*Tag `locationNameList:"Tag" type:"list"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s PurchaseReservedDBInstancesOfferingInput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s PurchaseReservedDBInstancesOfferingInput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
func (s *PurchaseReservedDBInstancesOfferingInput) Validate() error {
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "PurchaseReservedDBInstancesOfferingInput"}
if s.ReservedDBInstancesOfferingId == nil {
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("ReservedDBInstancesOfferingId"))
}
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
return invalidParams
}
return nil
}
// SetDBInstanceCount sets the DBInstanceCount field's value.
func (s *PurchaseReservedDBInstancesOfferingInput) SetDBInstanceCount(v int64) *PurchaseReservedDBInstancesOfferingInput {
s.DBInstanceCount = &v
return s
}
// SetReservedDBInstanceId sets the ReservedDBInstanceId field's value.
func (s *PurchaseReservedDBInstancesOfferingInput) SetReservedDBInstanceId(v string) *PurchaseReservedDBInstancesOfferingInput {
s.ReservedDBInstanceId = &v
return s
}
// SetReservedDBInstancesOfferingId sets the ReservedDBInstancesOfferingId field's value.
func (s *PurchaseReservedDBInstancesOfferingInput) SetReservedDBInstancesOfferingId(v string) *PurchaseReservedDBInstancesOfferingInput {
s.ReservedDBInstancesOfferingId = &v
return s
}
// SetTags sets the Tags field's value.
func (s *PurchaseReservedDBInstancesOfferingInput) SetTags(v []*Tag) *PurchaseReservedDBInstancesOfferingInput {
s.Tags = v
return s
}
type PurchaseReservedDBInstancesOfferingOutput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// This data type is used as a response element in the DescribeReservedDBInstances
// and PurchaseReservedDBInstancesOffering actions.
ReservedDBInstance *ReservedDBInstance `type:"structure"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s PurchaseReservedDBInstancesOfferingOutput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s PurchaseReservedDBInstancesOfferingOutput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetReservedDBInstance sets the ReservedDBInstance field's value.
func (s *PurchaseReservedDBInstancesOfferingOutput) SetReservedDBInstance(v *ReservedDBInstance) *PurchaseReservedDBInstancesOfferingOutput {
s.ReservedDBInstance = v
return s
}
// A range of integer values.
type Range struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// The minimum value in the range.
From *int64 `type:"integer"`
// The step value for the range. For example, if you have a range of 5,000 to
// 10,000, with a step value of 1,000, the valid values start at 5,000 and step
// up by 1,000. Even though 7,500 is within the range, it isn't a valid value
// for the range. The valid values are 5,000, 6,000, 7,000, 8,000...
Step *int64 `type:"integer"`
// The maximum value in the range.
To *int64 `type:"integer"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s Range) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s Range) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetFrom sets the From field's value.
func (s *Range) SetFrom(v int64) *Range {
s.From = &v
return s
}
// SetStep sets the Step field's value.
func (s *Range) SetStep(v int64) *Range {
s.Step = &v
return s
}
// SetTo sets the To field's value.
func (s *Range) SetTo(v int64) *Range {
s.To = &v
return s
}
type RebootDBInstanceInput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// The DB instance identifier. This parameter is stored as a lowercase string.
//
// Constraints:
//
// * Must match the identifier of an existing DBInstance.
//
// DBInstanceIdentifier is a required field
DBInstanceIdentifier *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
// When true, the reboot is conducted through a MultiAZ failover.
//
// Constraint: You can't specify true if the instance is not configured for
// MultiAZ.
ForceFailover *bool `type:"boolean"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s RebootDBInstanceInput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s RebootDBInstanceInput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
func (s *RebootDBInstanceInput) Validate() error {
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "RebootDBInstanceInput"}
if s.DBInstanceIdentifier == nil {
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("DBInstanceIdentifier"))
}
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
return invalidParams
}
return nil
}
// SetDBInstanceIdentifier sets the DBInstanceIdentifier field's value.
func (s *RebootDBInstanceInput) SetDBInstanceIdentifier(v string) *RebootDBInstanceInput {
s.DBInstanceIdentifier = &v
return s
}
// SetForceFailover sets the ForceFailover field's value.
func (s *RebootDBInstanceInput) SetForceFailover(v bool) *RebootDBInstanceInput {
s.ForceFailover = &v
return s
}
type RebootDBInstanceOutput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// Contains the details of an Amazon RDS DB instance.
//
// This data type is used as a response element in the DescribeDBInstances action.
DBInstance *DBInstance `type:"structure"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s RebootDBInstanceOutput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s RebootDBInstanceOutput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetDBInstance sets the DBInstance field's value.
func (s *RebootDBInstanceOutput) SetDBInstance(v *DBInstance) *RebootDBInstanceOutput {
s.DBInstance = v
return s
}
// This data type is used as a response element in the DescribeReservedDBInstances
// and DescribeReservedDBInstancesOfferings actions.
type RecurringCharge struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// The amount of the recurring charge.
RecurringChargeAmount *float64 `type:"double"`
// The frequency of the recurring charge.
RecurringChargeFrequency *string `type:"string"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s RecurringCharge) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s RecurringCharge) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetRecurringChargeAmount sets the RecurringChargeAmount field's value.
func (s *RecurringCharge) SetRecurringChargeAmount(v float64) *RecurringCharge {
s.RecurringChargeAmount = &v
return s
}
// SetRecurringChargeFrequency sets the RecurringChargeFrequency field's value.
func (s *RecurringCharge) SetRecurringChargeFrequency(v string) *RecurringCharge {
s.RecurringChargeFrequency = &v
return s
}
type RemoveFromGlobalClusterInput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// The Amazon Resource Name (ARN) identifying the cluster that was detached
// from the Aurora global database cluster.
DbClusterIdentifier *string `type:"string"`
// The cluster identifier to detach from the Aurora global database cluster.
GlobalClusterIdentifier *string `type:"string"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s RemoveFromGlobalClusterInput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s RemoveFromGlobalClusterInput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetDbClusterIdentifier sets the DbClusterIdentifier field's value.
func (s *RemoveFromGlobalClusterInput) SetDbClusterIdentifier(v string) *RemoveFromGlobalClusterInput {
s.DbClusterIdentifier = &v
return s
}
// SetGlobalClusterIdentifier sets the GlobalClusterIdentifier field's value.
func (s *RemoveFromGlobalClusterInput) SetGlobalClusterIdentifier(v string) *RemoveFromGlobalClusterInput {
s.GlobalClusterIdentifier = &v
return s
}
type RemoveFromGlobalClusterOutput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// A data type representing an Aurora global database.
GlobalCluster *GlobalCluster `type:"structure"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s RemoveFromGlobalClusterOutput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s RemoveFromGlobalClusterOutput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetGlobalCluster sets the GlobalCluster field's value.
func (s *RemoveFromGlobalClusterOutput) SetGlobalCluster(v *GlobalCluster) *RemoveFromGlobalClusterOutput {
s.GlobalCluster = v
return s
}
type RemoveRoleFromDBClusterInput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// The name of the DB cluster to disassociate the IAM role from.
//
// DBClusterIdentifier is a required field
DBClusterIdentifier *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
// The Amazon Resource Name (ARN) of the IAM role to disassociate from the Aurora
// DB cluster, for example arn:aws:iam::123456789012:role/AuroraAccessRole.
//
// RoleArn is a required field
RoleArn *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s RemoveRoleFromDBClusterInput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s RemoveRoleFromDBClusterInput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
func (s *RemoveRoleFromDBClusterInput) Validate() error {
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "RemoveRoleFromDBClusterInput"}
if s.DBClusterIdentifier == nil {
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("DBClusterIdentifier"))
}
if s.RoleArn == nil {
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("RoleArn"))
}
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
return invalidParams
}
return nil
}
// SetDBClusterIdentifier sets the DBClusterIdentifier field's value.
func (s *RemoveRoleFromDBClusterInput) SetDBClusterIdentifier(v string) *RemoveRoleFromDBClusterInput {
s.DBClusterIdentifier = &v
return s
}
// SetRoleArn sets the RoleArn field's value.
func (s *RemoveRoleFromDBClusterInput) SetRoleArn(v string) *RemoveRoleFromDBClusterInput {
s.RoleArn = &v
return s
}
type RemoveRoleFromDBClusterOutput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s RemoveRoleFromDBClusterOutput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s RemoveRoleFromDBClusterOutput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
type RemoveRoleFromDBInstanceInput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// The name of the DB instance to disassociate the IAM role from.
//
// DBInstanceIdentifier is a required field
DBInstanceIdentifier *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
// The name of the feature for the DB instance that the IAM role is to be disassociated
// from. For the list of supported feature names, see DBEngineVersion.
//
// FeatureName is a required field
FeatureName *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
// The Amazon Resource Name (ARN) of the IAM role to disassociate from the DB
// instance, for example arn:aws:iam::123456789012:role/AccessRole.
//
// RoleArn is a required field
RoleArn *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s RemoveRoleFromDBInstanceInput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s RemoveRoleFromDBInstanceInput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
func (s *RemoveRoleFromDBInstanceInput) Validate() error {
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "RemoveRoleFromDBInstanceInput"}
if s.DBInstanceIdentifier == nil {
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("DBInstanceIdentifier"))
}
if s.FeatureName == nil {
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("FeatureName"))
}
if s.RoleArn == nil {
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("RoleArn"))
}
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
return invalidParams
}
return nil
}
// SetDBInstanceIdentifier sets the DBInstanceIdentifier field's value.
func (s *RemoveRoleFromDBInstanceInput) SetDBInstanceIdentifier(v string) *RemoveRoleFromDBInstanceInput {
s.DBInstanceIdentifier = &v
return s
}
// SetFeatureName sets the FeatureName field's value.
func (s *RemoveRoleFromDBInstanceInput) SetFeatureName(v string) *RemoveRoleFromDBInstanceInput {
s.FeatureName = &v
return s
}
// SetRoleArn sets the RoleArn field's value.
func (s *RemoveRoleFromDBInstanceInput) SetRoleArn(v string) *RemoveRoleFromDBInstanceInput {
s.RoleArn = &v
return s
}
type RemoveRoleFromDBInstanceOutput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s RemoveRoleFromDBInstanceOutput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s RemoveRoleFromDBInstanceOutput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
type RemoveSourceIdentifierFromSubscriptionInput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// The source identifier to be removed from the subscription, such as the DB
// instance identifier for a DB instance or the name of a security group.
//
// SourceIdentifier is a required field
SourceIdentifier *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
// The name of the RDS event notification subscription you want to remove a
// source identifier from.
//
// SubscriptionName is a required field
SubscriptionName *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s RemoveSourceIdentifierFromSubscriptionInput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s RemoveSourceIdentifierFromSubscriptionInput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
func (s *RemoveSourceIdentifierFromSubscriptionInput) Validate() error {
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "RemoveSourceIdentifierFromSubscriptionInput"}
if s.SourceIdentifier == nil {
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("SourceIdentifier"))
}
if s.SubscriptionName == nil {
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("SubscriptionName"))
}
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
return invalidParams
}
return nil
}
// SetSourceIdentifier sets the SourceIdentifier field's value.
func (s *RemoveSourceIdentifierFromSubscriptionInput) SetSourceIdentifier(v string) *RemoveSourceIdentifierFromSubscriptionInput {
s.SourceIdentifier = &v
return s
}
// SetSubscriptionName sets the SubscriptionName field's value.
func (s *RemoveSourceIdentifierFromSubscriptionInput) SetSubscriptionName(v string) *RemoveSourceIdentifierFromSubscriptionInput {
s.SubscriptionName = &v
return s
}
type RemoveSourceIdentifierFromSubscriptionOutput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// Contains the results of a successful invocation of the DescribeEventSubscriptions
// action.
EventSubscription *EventSubscription `type:"structure"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s RemoveSourceIdentifierFromSubscriptionOutput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s RemoveSourceIdentifierFromSubscriptionOutput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetEventSubscription sets the EventSubscription field's value.
func (s *RemoveSourceIdentifierFromSubscriptionOutput) SetEventSubscription(v *EventSubscription) *RemoveSourceIdentifierFromSubscriptionOutput {
s.EventSubscription = v
return s
}
type RemoveTagsFromResourceInput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// The Amazon RDS resource that the tags are removed from. This value is an
// Amazon Resource Name (ARN). For information about creating an ARN, see Constructing
// an ARN for Amazon RDS (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/UserGuide/USER_Tagging.ARN.html#USER_Tagging.ARN.Constructing)
// in the Amazon RDS User Guide.
//
// ResourceName is a required field
ResourceName *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
// The tag key (name) of the tag to be removed.
//
// TagKeys is a required field
TagKeys []*string `type:"list" required:"true"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s RemoveTagsFromResourceInput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s RemoveTagsFromResourceInput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
func (s *RemoveTagsFromResourceInput) Validate() error {
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "RemoveTagsFromResourceInput"}
if s.ResourceName == nil {
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("ResourceName"))
}
if s.TagKeys == nil {
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("TagKeys"))
}
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
return invalidParams
}
return nil
}
// SetResourceName sets the ResourceName field's value.
func (s *RemoveTagsFromResourceInput) SetResourceName(v string) *RemoveTagsFromResourceInput {
s.ResourceName = &v
return s
}
// SetTagKeys sets the TagKeys field's value.
func (s *RemoveTagsFromResourceInput) SetTagKeys(v []*string) *RemoveTagsFromResourceInput {
s.TagKeys = v
return s
}
type RemoveTagsFromResourceOutput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s RemoveTagsFromResourceOutput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s RemoveTagsFromResourceOutput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// This data type is used as a response element in the DescribeReservedDBInstances
// and PurchaseReservedDBInstancesOffering actions.
type ReservedDBInstance struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// The currency code for the reserved DB instance.
CurrencyCode *string `type:"string"`
// The DB instance class for the reserved DB instance.
DBInstanceClass *string `type:"string"`
// The number of reserved DB instances.
DBInstanceCount *int64 `type:"integer"`
// The duration of the reservation in seconds.
Duration *int64 `type:"integer"`
// The fixed price charged for this reserved DB instance.
FixedPrice *float64 `type:"double"`
// Indicates if the reservation applies to Multi-AZ deployments.
MultiAZ *bool `type:"boolean"`
// The offering type of this reserved DB instance.
OfferingType *string `type:"string"`
// The description of the reserved DB instance.
ProductDescription *string `type:"string"`
// The recurring price charged to run this reserved DB instance.
RecurringCharges []*RecurringCharge `locationNameList:"RecurringCharge" type:"list"`
// The Amazon Resource Name (ARN) for the reserved DB instance.
ReservedDBInstanceArn *string `type:"string"`
// The unique identifier for the reservation.
ReservedDBInstanceId *string `type:"string"`
// The offering identifier.
ReservedDBInstancesOfferingId *string `type:"string"`
// The time the reservation started.
StartTime *time.Time `type:"timestamp"`
// The state of the reserved DB instance.
State *string `type:"string"`
// The hourly price charged for this reserved DB instance.
UsagePrice *float64 `type:"double"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s ReservedDBInstance) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s ReservedDBInstance) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetCurrencyCode sets the CurrencyCode field's value.
func (s *ReservedDBInstance) SetCurrencyCode(v string) *ReservedDBInstance {
s.CurrencyCode = &v
return s
}
// SetDBInstanceClass sets the DBInstanceClass field's value.
func (s *ReservedDBInstance) SetDBInstanceClass(v string) *ReservedDBInstance {
s.DBInstanceClass = &v
return s
}
// SetDBInstanceCount sets the DBInstanceCount field's value.
func (s *ReservedDBInstance) SetDBInstanceCount(v int64) *ReservedDBInstance {
s.DBInstanceCount = &v
return s
}
// SetDuration sets the Duration field's value.
func (s *ReservedDBInstance) SetDuration(v int64) *ReservedDBInstance {
s.Duration = &v
return s
}
// SetFixedPrice sets the FixedPrice field's value.
func (s *ReservedDBInstance) SetFixedPrice(v float64) *ReservedDBInstance {
s.FixedPrice = &v
return s
}
// SetMultiAZ sets the MultiAZ field's value.
func (s *ReservedDBInstance) SetMultiAZ(v bool) *ReservedDBInstance {
s.MultiAZ = &v
return s
}
// SetOfferingType sets the OfferingType field's value.
func (s *ReservedDBInstance) SetOfferingType(v string) *ReservedDBInstance {
s.OfferingType = &v
return s
}
// SetProductDescription sets the ProductDescription field's value.
func (s *ReservedDBInstance) SetProductDescription(v string) *ReservedDBInstance {
s.ProductDescription = &v
return s
}
// SetRecurringCharges sets the RecurringCharges field's value.
func (s *ReservedDBInstance) SetRecurringCharges(v []*RecurringCharge) *ReservedDBInstance {
s.RecurringCharges = v
return s
}
// SetReservedDBInstanceArn sets the ReservedDBInstanceArn field's value.
func (s *ReservedDBInstance) SetReservedDBInstanceArn(v string) *ReservedDBInstance {
s.ReservedDBInstanceArn = &v
return s
}
// SetReservedDBInstanceId sets the ReservedDBInstanceId field's value.
func (s *ReservedDBInstance) SetReservedDBInstanceId(v string) *ReservedDBInstance {
s.ReservedDBInstanceId = &v
return s
}
// SetReservedDBInstancesOfferingId sets the ReservedDBInstancesOfferingId field's value.
func (s *ReservedDBInstance) SetReservedDBInstancesOfferingId(v string) *ReservedDBInstance {
s.ReservedDBInstancesOfferingId = &v
return s
}
// SetStartTime sets the StartTime field's value.
func (s *ReservedDBInstance) SetStartTime(v time.Time) *ReservedDBInstance {
s.StartTime = &v
return s
}
// SetState sets the State field's value.
func (s *ReservedDBInstance) SetState(v string) *ReservedDBInstance {
s.State = &v
return s
}
// SetUsagePrice sets the UsagePrice field's value.
func (s *ReservedDBInstance) SetUsagePrice(v float64) *ReservedDBInstance {
s.UsagePrice = &v
return s
}
// This data type is used as a response element in the DescribeReservedDBInstancesOfferings
// action.
type ReservedDBInstancesOffering struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// The currency code for the reserved DB instance offering.
CurrencyCode *string `type:"string"`
// The DB instance class for the reserved DB instance.
DBInstanceClass *string `type:"string"`
// The duration of the offering in seconds.
Duration *int64 `type:"integer"`
// The fixed price charged for this offering.
FixedPrice *float64 `type:"double"`
// Indicates if the offering applies to Multi-AZ deployments.
MultiAZ *bool `type:"boolean"`
// The offering type.
OfferingType *string `type:"string"`
// The database engine used by the offering.
ProductDescription *string `type:"string"`
// The recurring price charged to run this reserved DB instance.
RecurringCharges []*RecurringCharge `locationNameList:"RecurringCharge" type:"list"`
// The offering identifier.
ReservedDBInstancesOfferingId *string `type:"string"`
// The hourly price charged for this offering.
UsagePrice *float64 `type:"double"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s ReservedDBInstancesOffering) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s ReservedDBInstancesOffering) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetCurrencyCode sets the CurrencyCode field's value.
func (s *ReservedDBInstancesOffering) SetCurrencyCode(v string) *ReservedDBInstancesOffering {
s.CurrencyCode = &v
return s
}
// SetDBInstanceClass sets the DBInstanceClass field's value.
func (s *ReservedDBInstancesOffering) SetDBInstanceClass(v string) *ReservedDBInstancesOffering {
s.DBInstanceClass = &v
return s
}
// SetDuration sets the Duration field's value.
func (s *ReservedDBInstancesOffering) SetDuration(v int64) *ReservedDBInstancesOffering {
s.Duration = &v
return s
}
// SetFixedPrice sets the FixedPrice field's value.
func (s *ReservedDBInstancesOffering) SetFixedPrice(v float64) *ReservedDBInstancesOffering {
s.FixedPrice = &v
return s
}
// SetMultiAZ sets the MultiAZ field's value.
func (s *ReservedDBInstancesOffering) SetMultiAZ(v bool) *ReservedDBInstancesOffering {
s.MultiAZ = &v
return s
}
// SetOfferingType sets the OfferingType field's value.
func (s *ReservedDBInstancesOffering) SetOfferingType(v string) *ReservedDBInstancesOffering {
s.OfferingType = &v
return s
}
// SetProductDescription sets the ProductDescription field's value.
func (s *ReservedDBInstancesOffering) SetProductDescription(v string) *ReservedDBInstancesOffering {
s.ProductDescription = &v
return s
}
// SetRecurringCharges sets the RecurringCharges field's value.
func (s *ReservedDBInstancesOffering) SetRecurringCharges(v []*RecurringCharge) *ReservedDBInstancesOffering {
s.RecurringCharges = v
return s
}
// SetReservedDBInstancesOfferingId sets the ReservedDBInstancesOfferingId field's value.
func (s *ReservedDBInstancesOffering) SetReservedDBInstancesOfferingId(v string) *ReservedDBInstancesOffering {
s.ReservedDBInstancesOfferingId = &v
return s
}
// SetUsagePrice sets the UsagePrice field's value.
func (s *ReservedDBInstancesOffering) SetUsagePrice(v float64) *ReservedDBInstancesOffering {
s.UsagePrice = &v
return s
}
type ResetDBClusterParameterGroupInput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// The name of the DB cluster parameter group to reset.
//
// DBClusterParameterGroupName is a required field
DBClusterParameterGroupName *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
// A list of parameter names in the DB cluster parameter group to reset to the
// default values. You can't use this parameter if the ResetAllParameters parameter
// is set to true.
Parameters []*Parameter `locationNameList:"Parameter" type:"list"`
// A value that is set to true to reset all parameters in the DB cluster parameter
// group to their default values, and false otherwise. You can't use this parameter
// if there is a list of parameter names specified for the Parameters parameter.
ResetAllParameters *bool `type:"boolean"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s ResetDBClusterParameterGroupInput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s ResetDBClusterParameterGroupInput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
func (s *ResetDBClusterParameterGroupInput) Validate() error {
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "ResetDBClusterParameterGroupInput"}
if s.DBClusterParameterGroupName == nil {
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("DBClusterParameterGroupName"))
}
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
return invalidParams
}
return nil
}
// SetDBClusterParameterGroupName sets the DBClusterParameterGroupName field's value.
func (s *ResetDBClusterParameterGroupInput) SetDBClusterParameterGroupName(v string) *ResetDBClusterParameterGroupInput {
s.DBClusterParameterGroupName = &v
return s
}
// SetParameters sets the Parameters field's value.
func (s *ResetDBClusterParameterGroupInput) SetParameters(v []*Parameter) *ResetDBClusterParameterGroupInput {
s.Parameters = v
return s
}
// SetResetAllParameters sets the ResetAllParameters field's value.
func (s *ResetDBClusterParameterGroupInput) SetResetAllParameters(v bool) *ResetDBClusterParameterGroupInput {
s.ResetAllParameters = &v
return s
}
type ResetDBParameterGroupInput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// The name of the DB parameter group.
//
// Constraints:
//
// * Must match the name of an existing DBParameterGroup.
//
// DBParameterGroupName is a required field
DBParameterGroupName *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
// To reset the entire DB parameter group, specify the DBParameterGroup name
// and ResetAllParameters parameters. To reset specific parameters, provide
// a list of the following: ParameterName and ApplyMethod. A maximum of 20 parameters
// can be modified in a single request.
//
// MySQL
//
// Valid Values (for Apply method): immediate | pending-reboot
//
// You can use the immediate value with dynamic parameters only. You can use
// the pending-reboot value for both dynamic and static parameters, and changes
// are applied when DB instance reboots.
//
// MariaDB
//
// Valid Values (for Apply method): immediate | pending-reboot
//
// You can use the immediate value with dynamic parameters only. You can use
// the pending-reboot value for both dynamic and static parameters, and changes
// are applied when DB instance reboots.
//
// Oracle
//
// Valid Values (for Apply method): pending-reboot
Parameters []*Parameter `locationNameList:"Parameter" type:"list"`
// Specifies whether (true) or not (false) to reset all parameters in the DB
// parameter group to default values.
//
// Default: true
ResetAllParameters *bool `type:"boolean"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s ResetDBParameterGroupInput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s ResetDBParameterGroupInput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
func (s *ResetDBParameterGroupInput) Validate() error {
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "ResetDBParameterGroupInput"}
if s.DBParameterGroupName == nil {
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("DBParameterGroupName"))
}
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
return invalidParams
}
return nil
}
// SetDBParameterGroupName sets the DBParameterGroupName field's value.
func (s *ResetDBParameterGroupInput) SetDBParameterGroupName(v string) *ResetDBParameterGroupInput {
s.DBParameterGroupName = &v
return s
}
// SetParameters sets the Parameters field's value.
func (s *ResetDBParameterGroupInput) SetParameters(v []*Parameter) *ResetDBParameterGroupInput {
s.Parameters = v
return s
}
// SetResetAllParameters sets the ResetAllParameters field's value.
func (s *ResetDBParameterGroupInput) SetResetAllParameters(v bool) *ResetDBParameterGroupInput {
s.ResetAllParameters = &v
return s
}
// Describes the pending maintenance actions for a resource.
type ResourcePendingMaintenanceActions struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// A list that provides details about the pending maintenance actions for the
// resource.
PendingMaintenanceActionDetails []*PendingMaintenanceAction `locationNameList:"PendingMaintenanceAction" type:"list"`
// The ARN of the resource that has pending maintenance actions.
ResourceIdentifier *string `type:"string"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s ResourcePendingMaintenanceActions) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s ResourcePendingMaintenanceActions) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetPendingMaintenanceActionDetails sets the PendingMaintenanceActionDetails field's value.
func (s *ResourcePendingMaintenanceActions) SetPendingMaintenanceActionDetails(v []*PendingMaintenanceAction) *ResourcePendingMaintenanceActions {
s.PendingMaintenanceActionDetails = v
return s
}
// SetResourceIdentifier sets the ResourceIdentifier field's value.
func (s *ResourcePendingMaintenanceActions) SetResourceIdentifier(v string) *ResourcePendingMaintenanceActions {
s.ResourceIdentifier = &v
return s
}
type RestoreDBClusterFromS3Input struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// A list of EC2 Availability Zones that instances in the restored DB cluster
// can be created in.
AvailabilityZones []*string `locationNameList:"AvailabilityZone" type:"list"`
// The target backtrack window, in seconds. To disable backtracking, set this
// value to 0.
//
// Default: 0
//
// Constraints:
//
// * If specified, this value must be set to a number from 0 to 259,200 (72
// hours).
BacktrackWindow *int64 `type:"long"`
// The number of days for which automated backups of the restored DB cluster
// are retained. You must specify a minimum value of 1.
//
// Default: 1
//
// Constraints:
//
// * Must be a value from 1 to 35
BackupRetentionPeriod *int64 `type:"integer"`
// A value that indicates that the restored DB cluster should be associated
// with the specified CharacterSet.
CharacterSetName *string `type:"string"`
// True to copy all tags from the restored DB cluster to snapshots of the restored
// DB cluster, and otherwise false. The default is false.
CopyTagsToSnapshot *bool `type:"boolean"`
// The name of the DB cluster to create from the source data in the Amazon S3
// bucket. This parameter is isn't case-sensitive.
//
// Constraints:
//
// * Must contain from 1 to 63 letters, numbers, or hyphens.
//
// * First character must be a letter.
//
// * Can't end with a hyphen or contain two consecutive hyphens.
//
// Example: my-cluster1
//
// DBClusterIdentifier is a required field
DBClusterIdentifier *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
// The name of the DB cluster parameter group to associate with the restored
// DB cluster. If this argument is omitted, default.aurora5.6 is used.
//
// Constraints:
//
// * If supplied, must match the name of an existing DBClusterParameterGroup.
DBClusterParameterGroupName *string `type:"string"`
// A DB subnet group to associate with the restored DB cluster.
//
// Constraints: If supplied, must match the name of an existing DBSubnetGroup.
//
// Example: mySubnetgroup
DBSubnetGroupName *string `type:"string"`
// The database name for the restored DB cluster.
DatabaseName *string `type:"string"`
// Indicates if the DB cluster should have deletion protection enabled. The
// database can't be deleted when this value is set to true. The default is
// false.
DeletionProtection *bool `type:"boolean"`
// The list of logs that the restored DB cluster is to export to CloudWatch
// Logs. The values in the list depend on the DB engine being used. For more
// information, see Publishing Database Logs to Amazon CloudWatch Logs (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/AuroraUserGuide/USER_LogAccess.html#USER_LogAccess.Procedural.UploadtoCloudWatch)
// in the Amazon Aurora User Guide.
EnableCloudwatchLogsExports []*string `type:"list"`
// True to enable mapping of AWS Identity and Access Management (IAM) accounts
// to database accounts, and otherwise false.
//
// Default: false
EnableIAMDatabaseAuthentication *bool `type:"boolean"`
// The name of the database engine to be used for the restored DB cluster.
//
// Valid Values: aurora, aurora-postgresql
//
// Engine is a required field
Engine *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
// The version number of the database engine to use.
//
// Aurora MySQL
//
// Example: 5.6.10a
//
// Aurora PostgreSQL
//
// Example: 9.6.3
EngineVersion *string `type:"string"`
// The AWS KMS key identifier for an encrypted DB cluster.
//
// The KMS key identifier is the Amazon Resource Name (ARN) for the KMS encryption
// key. If you are creating a DB cluster with the same AWS account that owns
// the KMS encryption key used to encrypt the new DB cluster, then you can use
// the KMS key alias instead of the ARN for the KM encryption key.
//
// If the StorageEncrypted parameter is true, and you do not specify a value
// for the KmsKeyId parameter, then Amazon RDS will use your default encryption
// key. AWS KMS creates the default encryption key for your AWS account. Your
// AWS account has a different default encryption key for each AWS Region.
KmsKeyId *string `type:"string"`
// The password for the master database user. This password can contain any
// printable ASCII character except "/", """, or "@".
//
// Constraints: Must contain from 8 to 41 characters.
//
// MasterUserPassword is a required field
MasterUserPassword *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
// The name of the master user for the restored DB cluster.
//
// Constraints:
//
// * Must be 1 to 16 letters or numbers.
//
// * First character must be a letter.
//
// * Can't be a reserved word for the chosen database engine.
//
// MasterUsername is a required field
MasterUsername *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
// A value that indicates that the restored DB cluster should be associated
// with the specified option group.
//
// Permanent options can't be removed from an option group. An option group
// can't be removed from a DB cluster once it is associated with a DB cluster.
OptionGroupName *string `type:"string"`
// The port number on which the instances in the restored DB cluster accept
// connections.
//
// Default: 3306
Port *int64 `type:"integer"`
// The daily time range during which automated backups are created if automated
// backups are enabled using the BackupRetentionPeriod parameter.
//
// The default is a 30-minute window selected at random from an 8-hour block
// of time for each AWS Region. To see the time blocks available, see Adjusting
// the Preferred Maintenance Window (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/AuroraUserGuide/USER_UpgradeDBInstance.Maintenance.html#AdjustingTheMaintenanceWindow.Aurora)
// in the Amazon Aurora User Guide.
//
// Constraints:
//
// * Must be in the format hh24:mi-hh24:mi.
//
// * Must be in Universal Coordinated Time (UTC).
//
// * Must not conflict with the preferred maintenance window.
//
// * Must be at least 30 minutes.
PreferredBackupWindow *string `type:"string"`
// The weekly time range during which system maintenance can occur, in Universal
// Coordinated Time (UTC).
//
// Format: ddd:hh24:mi-ddd:hh24:mi
//
// The default is a 30-minute window selected at random from an 8-hour block
// of time for each AWS Region, occurring on a random day of the week. To see
// the time blocks available, see Adjusting the Preferred Maintenance Window
// (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/AuroraUserGuide/USER_UpgradeDBInstance.Maintenance.html#AdjustingTheMaintenanceWindow.Aurora)
// in the Amazon Aurora User Guide.
//
// Valid Days: Mon, Tue, Wed, Thu, Fri, Sat, Sun.
//
// Constraints: Minimum 30-minute window.
PreferredMaintenanceWindow *string `type:"string"`
// The name of the Amazon S3 bucket that contains the data used to create the
// Amazon Aurora DB cluster.
//
// S3BucketName is a required field
S3BucketName *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
// The Amazon Resource Name (ARN) of the AWS Identity and Access Management
// (IAM) role that authorizes Amazon RDS to access the Amazon S3 bucket on your
// behalf.
//
// S3IngestionRoleArn is a required field
S3IngestionRoleArn *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
// The prefix for all of the file names that contain the data used to create
// the Amazon Aurora DB cluster. If you do not specify a SourceS3Prefix value,
// then the Amazon Aurora DB cluster is created by using all of the files in
// the Amazon S3 bucket.
S3Prefix *string `type:"string"`
// The identifier for the database engine that was backed up to create the files
// stored in the Amazon S3 bucket.
//
// Valid values: mysql
//
// SourceEngine is a required field
SourceEngine *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
// The version of the database that the backup files were created from.
//
// MySQL version 5.5 and 5.6 are supported.
//
// Example: 5.6.22
//
// SourceEngineVersion is a required field
SourceEngineVersion *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
// Specifies whether the restored DB cluster is encrypted.
StorageEncrypted *bool `type:"boolean"`
// A list of tags. For more information, see Tagging Amazon RDS Resources (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/UserGuide/USER_Tagging.html)
// in the Amazon RDS User Guide.
Tags []*Tag `locationNameList:"Tag" type:"list"`
// A list of EC2 VPC security groups to associate with the restored DB cluster.
VpcSecurityGroupIds []*string `locationNameList:"VpcSecurityGroupId" type:"list"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s RestoreDBClusterFromS3Input) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s RestoreDBClusterFromS3Input) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
func (s *RestoreDBClusterFromS3Input) Validate() error {
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "RestoreDBClusterFromS3Input"}
if s.DBClusterIdentifier == nil {
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("DBClusterIdentifier"))
}
if s.Engine == nil {
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Engine"))
}
if s.MasterUserPassword == nil {
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("MasterUserPassword"))
}
if s.MasterUsername == nil {
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("MasterUsername"))
}
if s.S3BucketName == nil {
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("S3BucketName"))
}
if s.S3IngestionRoleArn == nil {
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("S3IngestionRoleArn"))
}
if s.SourceEngine == nil {
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("SourceEngine"))
}
if s.SourceEngineVersion == nil {
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("SourceEngineVersion"))
}
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
return invalidParams
}
return nil
}
// SetAvailabilityZones sets the AvailabilityZones field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBClusterFromS3Input) SetAvailabilityZones(v []*string) *RestoreDBClusterFromS3Input {
s.AvailabilityZones = v
return s
}
// SetBacktrackWindow sets the BacktrackWindow field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBClusterFromS3Input) SetBacktrackWindow(v int64) *RestoreDBClusterFromS3Input {
s.BacktrackWindow = &v
return s
}
// SetBackupRetentionPeriod sets the BackupRetentionPeriod field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBClusterFromS3Input) SetBackupRetentionPeriod(v int64) *RestoreDBClusterFromS3Input {
s.BackupRetentionPeriod = &v
return s
}
// SetCharacterSetName sets the CharacterSetName field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBClusterFromS3Input) SetCharacterSetName(v string) *RestoreDBClusterFromS3Input {
s.CharacterSetName = &v
return s
}
// SetCopyTagsToSnapshot sets the CopyTagsToSnapshot field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBClusterFromS3Input) SetCopyTagsToSnapshot(v bool) *RestoreDBClusterFromS3Input {
s.CopyTagsToSnapshot = &v
return s
}
// SetDBClusterIdentifier sets the DBClusterIdentifier field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBClusterFromS3Input) SetDBClusterIdentifier(v string) *RestoreDBClusterFromS3Input {
s.DBClusterIdentifier = &v
return s
}
// SetDBClusterParameterGroupName sets the DBClusterParameterGroupName field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBClusterFromS3Input) SetDBClusterParameterGroupName(v string) *RestoreDBClusterFromS3Input {
s.DBClusterParameterGroupName = &v
return s
}
// SetDBSubnetGroupName sets the DBSubnetGroupName field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBClusterFromS3Input) SetDBSubnetGroupName(v string) *RestoreDBClusterFromS3Input {
s.DBSubnetGroupName = &v
return s
}
// SetDatabaseName sets the DatabaseName field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBClusterFromS3Input) SetDatabaseName(v string) *RestoreDBClusterFromS3Input {
s.DatabaseName = &v
return s
}
// SetDeletionProtection sets the DeletionProtection field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBClusterFromS3Input) SetDeletionProtection(v bool) *RestoreDBClusterFromS3Input {
s.DeletionProtection = &v
return s
}
// SetEnableCloudwatchLogsExports sets the EnableCloudwatchLogsExports field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBClusterFromS3Input) SetEnableCloudwatchLogsExports(v []*string) *RestoreDBClusterFromS3Input {
s.EnableCloudwatchLogsExports = v
return s
}
// SetEnableIAMDatabaseAuthentication sets the EnableIAMDatabaseAuthentication field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBClusterFromS3Input) SetEnableIAMDatabaseAuthentication(v bool) *RestoreDBClusterFromS3Input {
s.EnableIAMDatabaseAuthentication = &v
return s
}
// SetEngine sets the Engine field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBClusterFromS3Input) SetEngine(v string) *RestoreDBClusterFromS3Input {
s.Engine = &v
return s
}
// SetEngineVersion sets the EngineVersion field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBClusterFromS3Input) SetEngineVersion(v string) *RestoreDBClusterFromS3Input {
s.EngineVersion = &v
return s
}
// SetKmsKeyId sets the KmsKeyId field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBClusterFromS3Input) SetKmsKeyId(v string) *RestoreDBClusterFromS3Input {
s.KmsKeyId = &v
return s
}
// SetMasterUserPassword sets the MasterUserPassword field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBClusterFromS3Input) SetMasterUserPassword(v string) *RestoreDBClusterFromS3Input {
s.MasterUserPassword = &v
return s
}
// SetMasterUsername sets the MasterUsername field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBClusterFromS3Input) SetMasterUsername(v string) *RestoreDBClusterFromS3Input {
s.MasterUsername = &v
return s
}
// SetOptionGroupName sets the OptionGroupName field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBClusterFromS3Input) SetOptionGroupName(v string) *RestoreDBClusterFromS3Input {
s.OptionGroupName = &v
return s
}
// SetPort sets the Port field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBClusterFromS3Input) SetPort(v int64) *RestoreDBClusterFromS3Input {
s.Port = &v
return s
}
// SetPreferredBackupWindow sets the PreferredBackupWindow field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBClusterFromS3Input) SetPreferredBackupWindow(v string) *RestoreDBClusterFromS3Input {
s.PreferredBackupWindow = &v
return s
}
// SetPreferredMaintenanceWindow sets the PreferredMaintenanceWindow field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBClusterFromS3Input) SetPreferredMaintenanceWindow(v string) *RestoreDBClusterFromS3Input {
s.PreferredMaintenanceWindow = &v
return s
}
// SetS3BucketName sets the S3BucketName field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBClusterFromS3Input) SetS3BucketName(v string) *RestoreDBClusterFromS3Input {
s.S3BucketName = &v
return s
}
// SetS3IngestionRoleArn sets the S3IngestionRoleArn field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBClusterFromS3Input) SetS3IngestionRoleArn(v string) *RestoreDBClusterFromS3Input {
s.S3IngestionRoleArn = &v
return s
}
// SetS3Prefix sets the S3Prefix field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBClusterFromS3Input) SetS3Prefix(v string) *RestoreDBClusterFromS3Input {
s.S3Prefix = &v
return s
}
// SetSourceEngine sets the SourceEngine field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBClusterFromS3Input) SetSourceEngine(v string) *RestoreDBClusterFromS3Input {
s.SourceEngine = &v
return s
}
// SetSourceEngineVersion sets the SourceEngineVersion field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBClusterFromS3Input) SetSourceEngineVersion(v string) *RestoreDBClusterFromS3Input {
s.SourceEngineVersion = &v
return s
}
// SetStorageEncrypted sets the StorageEncrypted field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBClusterFromS3Input) SetStorageEncrypted(v bool) *RestoreDBClusterFromS3Input {
s.StorageEncrypted = &v
return s
}
// SetTags sets the Tags field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBClusterFromS3Input) SetTags(v []*Tag) *RestoreDBClusterFromS3Input {
s.Tags = v
return s
}
// SetVpcSecurityGroupIds sets the VpcSecurityGroupIds field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBClusterFromS3Input) SetVpcSecurityGroupIds(v []*string) *RestoreDBClusterFromS3Input {
s.VpcSecurityGroupIds = v
return s
}
type RestoreDBClusterFromS3Output struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// Contains the details of an Amazon Aurora DB cluster.
//
// This data type is used as a response element in the DescribeDBClusters, StopDBCluster,
// and StartDBCluster actions.
DBCluster *DBCluster `type:"structure"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s RestoreDBClusterFromS3Output) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s RestoreDBClusterFromS3Output) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetDBCluster sets the DBCluster field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBClusterFromS3Output) SetDBCluster(v *DBCluster) *RestoreDBClusterFromS3Output {
s.DBCluster = v
return s
}
type RestoreDBClusterFromSnapshotInput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// Provides the list of Amazon EC2 Availability Zones that instances in the
// restored DB cluster can be created in.
AvailabilityZones []*string `locationNameList:"AvailabilityZone" type:"list"`
// The target backtrack window, in seconds. To disable backtracking, set this
// value to 0.
//
// Default: 0
//
// Constraints:
//
// * If specified, this value must be set to a number from 0 to 259,200 (72
// hours).
BacktrackWindow *int64 `type:"long"`
// True to copy all tags from the restored DB cluster to snapshots of the restored
// DB cluster, and otherwise false. The default is false.
CopyTagsToSnapshot *bool `type:"boolean"`
// The name of the DB cluster to create from the DB snapshot or DB cluster snapshot.
// This parameter isn't case-sensitive.
//
// Constraints:
//
// * Must contain from 1 to 63 letters, numbers, or hyphens
//
// * First character must be a letter
//
// * Can't end with a hyphen or contain two consecutive hyphens
//
// Example: my-snapshot-id
//
// DBClusterIdentifier is a required field
DBClusterIdentifier *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
// The name of the DB cluster parameter group to associate with this DB cluster.
// If this argument is omitted, the default DB cluster parameter group for the
// specified engine is used.
//
// Constraints:
//
// * If supplied, must match the name of an existing default DB cluster parameter
// group.
//
// * Must be 1 to 255 letters, numbers, or hyphens.
//
// * First character must be a letter.
//
// * Can't end with a hyphen or contain two consecutive hyphens.
DBClusterParameterGroupName *string `type:"string"`
// The name of the DB subnet group to use for the new DB cluster.
//
// Constraints: If supplied, must match the name of an existing DB subnet group.
//
// Example: mySubnetgroup
DBSubnetGroupName *string `type:"string"`
// The database name for the restored DB cluster.
DatabaseName *string `type:"string"`
// Indicates if the DB cluster should have deletion protection enabled. The
// database can't be deleted when this value is set to true. The default is
// false.
DeletionProtection *bool `type:"boolean"`
// The list of logs that the restored DB cluster is to export to Amazon CloudWatch
// Logs. The values in the list depend on the DB engine being used. For more
// information, see Publishing Database Logs to Amazon CloudWatch Logs (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/AuroraUserGuide/USER_LogAccess.html#USER_LogAccess.Procedural.UploadtoCloudWatch)
// in the Amazon Aurora User Guide.
EnableCloudwatchLogsExports []*string `type:"list"`
// True to enable mapping of AWS Identity and Access Management (IAM) accounts
// to database accounts, and otherwise false.
//
// Default: false
EnableIAMDatabaseAuthentication *bool `type:"boolean"`
// The database engine to use for the new DB cluster.
//
// Default: The same as source
//
// Constraint: Must be compatible with the engine of the source
//
// Engine is a required field
Engine *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
// The DB engine mode of the DB cluster, either provisioned, serverless, or
// parallelquery.
EngineMode *string `type:"string"`
// The version of the database engine to use for the new DB cluster.
EngineVersion *string `type:"string"`
// The AWS KMS key identifier to use when restoring an encrypted DB cluster
// from a DB snapshot or DB cluster snapshot.
//
// The KMS key identifier is the Amazon Resource Name (ARN) for the KMS encryption
// key. If you are restoring a DB cluster with the same AWS account that owns
// the KMS encryption key used to encrypt the new DB cluster, then you can use
// the KMS key alias instead of the ARN for the KMS encryption key.
//
// If you don't specify a value for the KmsKeyId parameter, then the following
// occurs:
//
// * If the DB snapshot or DB cluster snapshot in SnapshotIdentifier is encrypted,
// then the restored DB cluster is encrypted using the KMS key that was used
// to encrypt the DB snapshot or DB cluster snapshot.
//
// * If the DB snapshot or DB cluster snapshot in SnapshotIdentifier is not
// encrypted, then the restored DB cluster is not encrypted.
KmsKeyId *string `type:"string"`
// The name of the option group to use for the restored DB cluster.
OptionGroupName *string `type:"string"`
// The port number on which the new DB cluster accepts connections.
//
// Constraints: This value must be 1150-65535
//
// Default: The same port as the original DB cluster.
Port *int64 `type:"integer"`
// For DB clusters in serverless DB engine mode, the scaling properties of the
// DB cluster.
ScalingConfiguration *ScalingConfiguration `type:"structure"`
// The identifier for the DB snapshot or DB cluster snapshot to restore from.
//
// You can use either the name or the Amazon Resource Name (ARN) to specify
// a DB cluster snapshot. However, you can use only the ARN to specify a DB
// snapshot.
//
// Constraints:
//
// * Must match the identifier of an existing Snapshot.
//
// SnapshotIdentifier is a required field
SnapshotIdentifier *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
// The tags to be assigned to the restored DB cluster.
Tags []*Tag `locationNameList:"Tag" type:"list"`
// A list of VPC security groups that the new DB cluster will belong to.
VpcSecurityGroupIds []*string `locationNameList:"VpcSecurityGroupId" type:"list"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s RestoreDBClusterFromSnapshotInput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s RestoreDBClusterFromSnapshotInput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
func (s *RestoreDBClusterFromSnapshotInput) Validate() error {
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "RestoreDBClusterFromSnapshotInput"}
if s.DBClusterIdentifier == nil {
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("DBClusterIdentifier"))
}
if s.Engine == nil {
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Engine"))
}
if s.SnapshotIdentifier == nil {
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("SnapshotIdentifier"))
}
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
return invalidParams
}
return nil
}
// SetAvailabilityZones sets the AvailabilityZones field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBClusterFromSnapshotInput) SetAvailabilityZones(v []*string) *RestoreDBClusterFromSnapshotInput {
s.AvailabilityZones = v
return s
}
// SetBacktrackWindow sets the BacktrackWindow field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBClusterFromSnapshotInput) SetBacktrackWindow(v int64) *RestoreDBClusterFromSnapshotInput {
s.BacktrackWindow = &v
return s
}
// SetCopyTagsToSnapshot sets the CopyTagsToSnapshot field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBClusterFromSnapshotInput) SetCopyTagsToSnapshot(v bool) *RestoreDBClusterFromSnapshotInput {
s.CopyTagsToSnapshot = &v
return s
}
// SetDBClusterIdentifier sets the DBClusterIdentifier field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBClusterFromSnapshotInput) SetDBClusterIdentifier(v string) *RestoreDBClusterFromSnapshotInput {
s.DBClusterIdentifier = &v
return s
}
// SetDBClusterParameterGroupName sets the DBClusterParameterGroupName field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBClusterFromSnapshotInput) SetDBClusterParameterGroupName(v string) *RestoreDBClusterFromSnapshotInput {
s.DBClusterParameterGroupName = &v
return s
}
// SetDBSubnetGroupName sets the DBSubnetGroupName field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBClusterFromSnapshotInput) SetDBSubnetGroupName(v string) *RestoreDBClusterFromSnapshotInput {
s.DBSubnetGroupName = &v
return s
}
// SetDatabaseName sets the DatabaseName field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBClusterFromSnapshotInput) SetDatabaseName(v string) *RestoreDBClusterFromSnapshotInput {
s.DatabaseName = &v
return s
}
// SetDeletionProtection sets the DeletionProtection field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBClusterFromSnapshotInput) SetDeletionProtection(v bool) *RestoreDBClusterFromSnapshotInput {
s.DeletionProtection = &v
return s
}
// SetEnableCloudwatchLogsExports sets the EnableCloudwatchLogsExports field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBClusterFromSnapshotInput) SetEnableCloudwatchLogsExports(v []*string) *RestoreDBClusterFromSnapshotInput {
s.EnableCloudwatchLogsExports = v
return s
}
// SetEnableIAMDatabaseAuthentication sets the EnableIAMDatabaseAuthentication field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBClusterFromSnapshotInput) SetEnableIAMDatabaseAuthentication(v bool) *RestoreDBClusterFromSnapshotInput {
s.EnableIAMDatabaseAuthentication = &v
return s
}
// SetEngine sets the Engine field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBClusterFromSnapshotInput) SetEngine(v string) *RestoreDBClusterFromSnapshotInput {
s.Engine = &v
return s
}
// SetEngineMode sets the EngineMode field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBClusterFromSnapshotInput) SetEngineMode(v string) *RestoreDBClusterFromSnapshotInput {
s.EngineMode = &v
return s
}
// SetEngineVersion sets the EngineVersion field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBClusterFromSnapshotInput) SetEngineVersion(v string) *RestoreDBClusterFromSnapshotInput {
s.EngineVersion = &v
return s
}
// SetKmsKeyId sets the KmsKeyId field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBClusterFromSnapshotInput) SetKmsKeyId(v string) *RestoreDBClusterFromSnapshotInput {
s.KmsKeyId = &v
return s
}
// SetOptionGroupName sets the OptionGroupName field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBClusterFromSnapshotInput) SetOptionGroupName(v string) *RestoreDBClusterFromSnapshotInput {
s.OptionGroupName = &v
return s
}
// SetPort sets the Port field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBClusterFromSnapshotInput) SetPort(v int64) *RestoreDBClusterFromSnapshotInput {
s.Port = &v
return s
}
// SetScalingConfiguration sets the ScalingConfiguration field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBClusterFromSnapshotInput) SetScalingConfiguration(v *ScalingConfiguration) *RestoreDBClusterFromSnapshotInput {
s.ScalingConfiguration = v
return s
}
// SetSnapshotIdentifier sets the SnapshotIdentifier field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBClusterFromSnapshotInput) SetSnapshotIdentifier(v string) *RestoreDBClusterFromSnapshotInput {
s.SnapshotIdentifier = &v
return s
}
// SetTags sets the Tags field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBClusterFromSnapshotInput) SetTags(v []*Tag) *RestoreDBClusterFromSnapshotInput {
s.Tags = v
return s
}
// SetVpcSecurityGroupIds sets the VpcSecurityGroupIds field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBClusterFromSnapshotInput) SetVpcSecurityGroupIds(v []*string) *RestoreDBClusterFromSnapshotInput {
s.VpcSecurityGroupIds = v
return s
}
type RestoreDBClusterFromSnapshotOutput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// Contains the details of an Amazon Aurora DB cluster.
//
// This data type is used as a response element in the DescribeDBClusters, StopDBCluster,
// and StartDBCluster actions.
DBCluster *DBCluster `type:"structure"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s RestoreDBClusterFromSnapshotOutput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s RestoreDBClusterFromSnapshotOutput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetDBCluster sets the DBCluster field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBClusterFromSnapshotOutput) SetDBCluster(v *DBCluster) *RestoreDBClusterFromSnapshotOutput {
s.DBCluster = v
return s
}
type RestoreDBClusterToPointInTimeInput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// The target backtrack window, in seconds. To disable backtracking, set this
// value to 0.
//
// Default: 0
//
// Constraints:
//
// * If specified, this value must be set to a number from 0 to 259,200 (72
// hours).
BacktrackWindow *int64 `type:"long"`
// True to copy all tags from the restored DB cluster to snapshots of the restored
// DB cluster, and otherwise false. The default is false.
CopyTagsToSnapshot *bool `type:"boolean"`
// The name of the new DB cluster to be created.
//
// Constraints:
//
// * Must contain from 1 to 63 letters, numbers, or hyphens
//
// * First character must be a letter
//
// * Can't end with a hyphen or contain two consecutive hyphens
//
// DBClusterIdentifier is a required field
DBClusterIdentifier *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
// The name of the DB cluster parameter group to associate with this DB cluster.
// If this argument is omitted, the default DB cluster parameter group for the
// specified engine is used.
//
// Constraints:
//
// * If supplied, must match the name of an existing DB cluster parameter
// group.
//
// * Must be 1 to 255 letters, numbers, or hyphens.
//
// * First character must be a letter.
//
// * Can't end with a hyphen or contain two consecutive hyphens.
DBClusterParameterGroupName *string `type:"string"`
// The DB subnet group name to use for the new DB cluster.
//
// Constraints: If supplied, must match the name of an existing DBSubnetGroup.
//
// Example: mySubnetgroup
DBSubnetGroupName *string `type:"string"`
// Indicates if the DB cluster should have deletion protection enabled. The
// database can't be deleted when this value is set to true. The default is
// false.
DeletionProtection *bool `type:"boolean"`
// The list of logs that the restored DB cluster is to export to CloudWatch
// Logs. The values in the list depend on the DB engine being used. For more
// information, see Publishing Database Logs to Amazon CloudWatch Logs (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/AuroraUserGuide/USER_LogAccess.html#USER_LogAccess.Procedural.UploadtoCloudWatch)
// in the Amazon Aurora User Guide.
EnableCloudwatchLogsExports []*string `type:"list"`
// True to enable mapping of AWS Identity and Access Management (IAM) accounts
// to database accounts, and otherwise false.
//
// Default: false
EnableIAMDatabaseAuthentication *bool `type:"boolean"`
// The AWS KMS key identifier to use when restoring an encrypted DB cluster
// from an encrypted DB cluster.
//
// The KMS key identifier is the Amazon Resource Name (ARN) for the KMS encryption
// key. If you are restoring a DB cluster with the same AWS account that owns
// the KMS encryption key used to encrypt the new DB cluster, then you can use
// the KMS key alias instead of the ARN for the KMS encryption key.
//
// You can restore to a new DB cluster and encrypt the new DB cluster with a
// KMS key that is different than the KMS key used to encrypt the source DB
// cluster. The new DB cluster is encrypted with the KMS key identified by the
// KmsKeyId parameter.
//
// If you don't specify a value for the KmsKeyId parameter, then the following
// occurs:
//
// * If the DB cluster is encrypted, then the restored DB cluster is encrypted
// using the KMS key that was used to encrypt the source DB cluster.
//
// * If the DB cluster is not encrypted, then the restored DB cluster is
// not encrypted.
//
// If DBClusterIdentifier refers to a DB cluster that is not encrypted, then
// the restore request is rejected.
KmsKeyId *string `type:"string"`
// The name of the option group for the new DB cluster.
OptionGroupName *string `type:"string"`
// The port number on which the new DB cluster accepts connections.
//
// Constraints: A value from 1150-65535.
//
// Default: The default port for the engine.
Port *int64 `type:"integer"`
// The date and time to restore the DB cluster to.
//
// Valid Values: Value must be a time in Universal Coordinated Time (UTC) format
//
// Constraints:
//
// * Must be before the latest restorable time for the DB instance
//
// * Must be specified if UseLatestRestorableTime parameter is not provided
//
// * Can't be specified if UseLatestRestorableTime parameter is true
//
// * Can't be specified if RestoreType parameter is copy-on-write
//
// Example: 2015-03-07T23:45:00Z
RestoreToTime *time.Time `type:"timestamp"`
// The type of restore to be performed. You can specify one of the following
// values:
//
// * full-copy - The new DB cluster is restored as a full copy of the source
// DB cluster.
//
// * copy-on-write - The new DB cluster is restored as a clone of the source
// DB cluster.
//
// Constraints: You can't specify copy-on-write if the engine version of the
// source DB cluster is earlier than 1.11.
//
// If you don't specify a RestoreType value, then the new DB cluster is restored
// as a full copy of the source DB cluster.
RestoreType *string `type:"string"`
// The identifier of the source DB cluster from which to restore.
//
// Constraints:
//
// * Must match the identifier of an existing DBCluster.
//
// SourceDBClusterIdentifier is a required field
SourceDBClusterIdentifier *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
// A list of tags. For more information, see Tagging Amazon RDS Resources (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/UserGuide/USER_Tagging.html)
// in the Amazon RDS User Guide.
Tags []*Tag `locationNameList:"Tag" type:"list"`
// A value that is set to true to restore the DB cluster to the latest restorable
// backup time, and false otherwise.
//
// Default: false
//
// Constraints: Can't be specified if RestoreToTime parameter is provided.
UseLatestRestorableTime *bool `type:"boolean"`
// A list of VPC security groups that the new DB cluster belongs to.
VpcSecurityGroupIds []*string `locationNameList:"VpcSecurityGroupId" type:"list"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s RestoreDBClusterToPointInTimeInput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s RestoreDBClusterToPointInTimeInput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
func (s *RestoreDBClusterToPointInTimeInput) Validate() error {
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "RestoreDBClusterToPointInTimeInput"}
if s.DBClusterIdentifier == nil {
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("DBClusterIdentifier"))
}
if s.SourceDBClusterIdentifier == nil {
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("SourceDBClusterIdentifier"))
}
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
return invalidParams
}
return nil
}
// SetBacktrackWindow sets the BacktrackWindow field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBClusterToPointInTimeInput) SetBacktrackWindow(v int64) *RestoreDBClusterToPointInTimeInput {
s.BacktrackWindow = &v
return s
}
// SetCopyTagsToSnapshot sets the CopyTagsToSnapshot field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBClusterToPointInTimeInput) SetCopyTagsToSnapshot(v bool) *RestoreDBClusterToPointInTimeInput {
s.CopyTagsToSnapshot = &v
return s
}
// SetDBClusterIdentifier sets the DBClusterIdentifier field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBClusterToPointInTimeInput) SetDBClusterIdentifier(v string) *RestoreDBClusterToPointInTimeInput {
s.DBClusterIdentifier = &v
return s
}
// SetDBClusterParameterGroupName sets the DBClusterParameterGroupName field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBClusterToPointInTimeInput) SetDBClusterParameterGroupName(v string) *RestoreDBClusterToPointInTimeInput {
s.DBClusterParameterGroupName = &v
return s
}
// SetDBSubnetGroupName sets the DBSubnetGroupName field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBClusterToPointInTimeInput) SetDBSubnetGroupName(v string) *RestoreDBClusterToPointInTimeInput {
s.DBSubnetGroupName = &v
return s
}
// SetDeletionProtection sets the DeletionProtection field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBClusterToPointInTimeInput) SetDeletionProtection(v bool) *RestoreDBClusterToPointInTimeInput {
s.DeletionProtection = &v
return s
}
// SetEnableCloudwatchLogsExports sets the EnableCloudwatchLogsExports field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBClusterToPointInTimeInput) SetEnableCloudwatchLogsExports(v []*string) *RestoreDBClusterToPointInTimeInput {
s.EnableCloudwatchLogsExports = v
return s
}
// SetEnableIAMDatabaseAuthentication sets the EnableIAMDatabaseAuthentication field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBClusterToPointInTimeInput) SetEnableIAMDatabaseAuthentication(v bool) *RestoreDBClusterToPointInTimeInput {
s.EnableIAMDatabaseAuthentication = &v
return s
}
// SetKmsKeyId sets the KmsKeyId field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBClusterToPointInTimeInput) SetKmsKeyId(v string) *RestoreDBClusterToPointInTimeInput {
s.KmsKeyId = &v
return s
}
// SetOptionGroupName sets the OptionGroupName field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBClusterToPointInTimeInput) SetOptionGroupName(v string) *RestoreDBClusterToPointInTimeInput {
s.OptionGroupName = &v
return s
}
// SetPort sets the Port field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBClusterToPointInTimeInput) SetPort(v int64) *RestoreDBClusterToPointInTimeInput {
s.Port = &v
return s
}
// SetRestoreToTime sets the RestoreToTime field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBClusterToPointInTimeInput) SetRestoreToTime(v time.Time) *RestoreDBClusterToPointInTimeInput {
s.RestoreToTime = &v
return s
}
// SetRestoreType sets the RestoreType field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBClusterToPointInTimeInput) SetRestoreType(v string) *RestoreDBClusterToPointInTimeInput {
s.RestoreType = &v
return s
}
// SetSourceDBClusterIdentifier sets the SourceDBClusterIdentifier field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBClusterToPointInTimeInput) SetSourceDBClusterIdentifier(v string) *RestoreDBClusterToPointInTimeInput {
s.SourceDBClusterIdentifier = &v
return s
}
// SetTags sets the Tags field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBClusterToPointInTimeInput) SetTags(v []*Tag) *RestoreDBClusterToPointInTimeInput {
s.Tags = v
return s
}
// SetUseLatestRestorableTime sets the UseLatestRestorableTime field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBClusterToPointInTimeInput) SetUseLatestRestorableTime(v bool) *RestoreDBClusterToPointInTimeInput {
s.UseLatestRestorableTime = &v
return s
}
// SetVpcSecurityGroupIds sets the VpcSecurityGroupIds field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBClusterToPointInTimeInput) SetVpcSecurityGroupIds(v []*string) *RestoreDBClusterToPointInTimeInput {
s.VpcSecurityGroupIds = v
return s
}
type RestoreDBClusterToPointInTimeOutput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// Contains the details of an Amazon Aurora DB cluster.
//
// This data type is used as a response element in the DescribeDBClusters, StopDBCluster,
// and StartDBCluster actions.
DBCluster *DBCluster `type:"structure"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s RestoreDBClusterToPointInTimeOutput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s RestoreDBClusterToPointInTimeOutput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetDBCluster sets the DBCluster field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBClusterToPointInTimeOutput) SetDBCluster(v *DBCluster) *RestoreDBClusterToPointInTimeOutput {
s.DBCluster = v
return s
}
type RestoreDBInstanceFromDBSnapshotInput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// Indicates that minor version upgrades are applied automatically to the DB
// instance during the maintenance window.
AutoMinorVersionUpgrade *bool `type:"boolean"`
// The EC2 Availability Zone that the DB instance is created in.
//
// Default: A random, system-chosen Availability Zone.
//
// Constraint: You can't specify the AvailabilityZone parameter if the MultiAZ
// parameter is set to true.
//
// Example: us-east-1a
AvailabilityZone *string `type:"string"`
// True to copy all tags from the restored DB instance to snapshots of the restored
// DB instance, and otherwise false. The default is false.
CopyTagsToSnapshot *bool `type:"boolean"`
// The compute and memory capacity of the Amazon RDS DB instance, for example,
// db.m4.large. Not all DB instance classes are available in all AWS Regions,
// or for all database engines. For the full list of DB instance classes, and
// availability for your engine, see DB Instance Class (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/UserGuide/Concepts.DBInstanceClass.html)
// in the Amazon RDS User Guide.
//
// Default: The same DBInstanceClass as the original DB instance.
DBInstanceClass *string `type:"string"`
// Name of the DB instance to create from the DB snapshot. This parameter isn't
// case-sensitive.
//
// Constraints:
//
// * Must contain from 1 to 63 numbers, letters, or hyphens
//
// * First character must be a letter
//
// * Can't end with a hyphen or contain two consecutive hyphens
//
// Example: my-snapshot-id
//
// DBInstanceIdentifier is a required field
DBInstanceIdentifier *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
// The database name for the restored DB instance.
//
// This parameter doesn't apply to the MySQL, PostgreSQL, or MariaDB engines.
DBName *string `type:"string"`
// The name of the DB parameter group to associate with this DB instance. If
// this argument is omitted, the default DBParameterGroup for the specified
// engine is used.
//
// Constraints:
//
// * If supplied, must match the name of an existing DBParameterGroup.
//
// * Must be 1 to 255 letters, numbers, or hyphens.
//
// * First character must be a letter.
//
// * Can't end with a hyphen or contain two consecutive hyphens.
DBParameterGroupName *string `type:"string"`
// The identifier for the DB snapshot to restore from.
//
// Constraints:
//
// * Must match the identifier of an existing DBSnapshot.
//
// * If you are restoring from a shared manual DB snapshot, the DBSnapshotIdentifier
// must be the ARN of the shared DB snapshot.
//
// DBSnapshotIdentifier is a required field
DBSnapshotIdentifier *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
// The DB subnet group name to use for the new instance.
//
// Constraints: If supplied, must match the name of an existing DBSubnetGroup.
//
// Example: mySubnetgroup
DBSubnetGroupName *string `type:"string"`
// Indicates if the DB instance should have deletion protection enabled. The
// database can't be deleted when this value is set to true. The default is
// false. For more information, see Deleting a DB Instance (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/UserGuide/USER_DeleteInstance.html).
DeletionProtection *bool `type:"boolean"`
// Specify the Active Directory Domain to restore the instance in.
Domain *string `type:"string"`
// Specify the name of the IAM role to be used when making API calls to the
// Directory Service.
DomainIAMRoleName *string `type:"string"`
// The list of logs that the restored DB instance is to export to CloudWatch
// Logs. The values in the list depend on the DB engine being used. For more
// information, see Publishing Database Logs to Amazon CloudWatch Logs (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/AuroraUserGuide/USER_LogAccess.html#USER_LogAccess.Procedural.UploadtoCloudWatch)
// in the Amazon Aurora User Guide.
EnableCloudwatchLogsExports []*string `type:"list"`
// True to enable mapping of AWS Identity and Access Management (IAM) accounts
// to database accounts, and otherwise false.
//
// You can enable IAM database authentication for the following database engines
//
// * For MySQL 5.6, minor version 5.6.34 or higher
//
// * For MySQL 5.7, minor version 5.7.16 or higher
//
// Default: false
EnableIAMDatabaseAuthentication *bool `type:"boolean"`
// The database engine to use for the new instance.
//
// Default: The same as source
//
// Constraint: Must be compatible with the engine of the source. For example,
// you can restore a MariaDB 10.1 DB instance from a MySQL 5.6 snapshot.
//
// Valid Values:
//
// * mariadb
//
// * mysql
//
// * oracle-ee
//
// * oracle-se2
//
// * oracle-se1
//
// * oracle-se
//
// * postgres
//
// * sqlserver-ee
//
// * sqlserver-se
//
// * sqlserver-ex
//
// * sqlserver-web
Engine *string `type:"string"`
// Specifies the amount of provisioned IOPS for the DB instance, expressed in
// I/O operations per second. If this parameter is not specified, the IOPS value
// is taken from the backup. If this parameter is set to 0, the new instance
// is converted to a non-PIOPS instance. The conversion takes additional time,
// though your DB instance is available for connections before the conversion
// starts.
//
// The provisioned IOPS value must follow the requirements for your database
// engine. For more information, see Amazon RDS Provisioned IOPS Storage to
// Improve Performance (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/UserGuide/CHAP_Storage.html#USER_PIOPS)
// in the Amazon RDS User Guide.
//
// Constraints: Must be an integer greater than 1000.
Iops *int64 `type:"integer"`
// License model information for the restored DB instance.
//
// Default: Same as source.
//
// Valid values: license-included | bring-your-own-license | general-public-license
LicenseModel *string `type:"string"`
// Specifies if the DB instance is a Multi-AZ deployment.
//
// Constraint: You can't specify the AvailabilityZone parameter if the MultiAZ
// parameter is set to true.
MultiAZ *bool `type:"boolean"`
// The name of the option group to be used for the restored DB instance.
//
// Permanent options, such as the TDE option for Oracle Advanced Security TDE,
// can't be removed from an option group, and that option group can't be removed
// from a DB instance once it is associated with a DB instance
OptionGroupName *string `type:"string"`
// The port number on which the database accepts connections.
//
// Default: The same port as the original DB instance
//
// Constraints: Value must be 1150-65535
Port *int64 `type:"integer"`
// The number of CPU cores and the number of threads per core for the DB instance
// class of the DB instance.
ProcessorFeatures []*ProcessorFeature `locationNameList:"ProcessorFeature" type:"list"`
// Specifies the accessibility options for the DB instance. A value of true
// specifies an Internet-facing instance with a publicly resolvable DNS name,
// which resolves to a public IP address. A value of false specifies an internal
// instance with a DNS name that resolves to a private IP address. For more
// information, see CreateDBInstance.
PubliclyAccessible *bool `type:"boolean"`
// Specifies the storage type to be associated with the DB instance.
//
// Valid values: standard | gp2 | io1
//
// If you specify io1, you must also include a value for the Iops parameter.
//
// Default: io1 if the Iops parameter is specified, otherwise standard
StorageType *string `type:"string"`
// A list of tags. For more information, see Tagging Amazon RDS Resources (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/UserGuide/USER_Tagging.html)
// in the Amazon RDS User Guide.
Tags []*Tag `locationNameList:"Tag" type:"list"`
// The ARN from the key store with which to associate the instance for TDE encryption.
TdeCredentialArn *string `type:"string"`
// The password for the given ARN from the key store in order to access the
// device.
TdeCredentialPassword *string `type:"string"`
// A value that specifies that the DB instance class of the DB instance uses
// its default processor features.
UseDefaultProcessorFeatures *bool `type:"boolean"`
// A list of EC2 VPC security groups to associate with this DB instance.
//
// Default: The default EC2 VPC security group for the DB subnet group's VPC.
VpcSecurityGroupIds []*string `locationNameList:"VpcSecurityGroupId" type:"list"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s RestoreDBInstanceFromDBSnapshotInput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s RestoreDBInstanceFromDBSnapshotInput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
func (s *RestoreDBInstanceFromDBSnapshotInput) Validate() error {
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "RestoreDBInstanceFromDBSnapshotInput"}
if s.DBInstanceIdentifier == nil {
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("DBInstanceIdentifier"))
}
if s.DBSnapshotIdentifier == nil {
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("DBSnapshotIdentifier"))
}
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
return invalidParams
}
return nil
}
// SetAutoMinorVersionUpgrade sets the AutoMinorVersionUpgrade field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBInstanceFromDBSnapshotInput) SetAutoMinorVersionUpgrade(v bool) *RestoreDBInstanceFromDBSnapshotInput {
s.AutoMinorVersionUpgrade = &v
return s
}
// SetAvailabilityZone sets the AvailabilityZone field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBInstanceFromDBSnapshotInput) SetAvailabilityZone(v string) *RestoreDBInstanceFromDBSnapshotInput {
s.AvailabilityZone = &v
return s
}
// SetCopyTagsToSnapshot sets the CopyTagsToSnapshot field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBInstanceFromDBSnapshotInput) SetCopyTagsToSnapshot(v bool) *RestoreDBInstanceFromDBSnapshotInput {
s.CopyTagsToSnapshot = &v
return s
}
// SetDBInstanceClass sets the DBInstanceClass field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBInstanceFromDBSnapshotInput) SetDBInstanceClass(v string) *RestoreDBInstanceFromDBSnapshotInput {
s.DBInstanceClass = &v
return s
}
// SetDBInstanceIdentifier sets the DBInstanceIdentifier field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBInstanceFromDBSnapshotInput) SetDBInstanceIdentifier(v string) *RestoreDBInstanceFromDBSnapshotInput {
s.DBInstanceIdentifier = &v
return s
}
// SetDBName sets the DBName field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBInstanceFromDBSnapshotInput) SetDBName(v string) *RestoreDBInstanceFromDBSnapshotInput {
s.DBName = &v
return s
}
// SetDBParameterGroupName sets the DBParameterGroupName field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBInstanceFromDBSnapshotInput) SetDBParameterGroupName(v string) *RestoreDBInstanceFromDBSnapshotInput {
s.DBParameterGroupName = &v
return s
}
// SetDBSnapshotIdentifier sets the DBSnapshotIdentifier field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBInstanceFromDBSnapshotInput) SetDBSnapshotIdentifier(v string) *RestoreDBInstanceFromDBSnapshotInput {
s.DBSnapshotIdentifier = &v
return s
}
// SetDBSubnetGroupName sets the DBSubnetGroupName field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBInstanceFromDBSnapshotInput) SetDBSubnetGroupName(v string) *RestoreDBInstanceFromDBSnapshotInput {
s.DBSubnetGroupName = &v
return s
}
// SetDeletionProtection sets the DeletionProtection field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBInstanceFromDBSnapshotInput) SetDeletionProtection(v bool) *RestoreDBInstanceFromDBSnapshotInput {
s.DeletionProtection = &v
return s
}
// SetDomain sets the Domain field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBInstanceFromDBSnapshotInput) SetDomain(v string) *RestoreDBInstanceFromDBSnapshotInput {
s.Domain = &v
return s
}
// SetDomainIAMRoleName sets the DomainIAMRoleName field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBInstanceFromDBSnapshotInput) SetDomainIAMRoleName(v string) *RestoreDBInstanceFromDBSnapshotInput {
s.DomainIAMRoleName = &v
return s
}
// SetEnableCloudwatchLogsExports sets the EnableCloudwatchLogsExports field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBInstanceFromDBSnapshotInput) SetEnableCloudwatchLogsExports(v []*string) *RestoreDBInstanceFromDBSnapshotInput {
s.EnableCloudwatchLogsExports = v
return s
}
// SetEnableIAMDatabaseAuthentication sets the EnableIAMDatabaseAuthentication field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBInstanceFromDBSnapshotInput) SetEnableIAMDatabaseAuthentication(v bool) *RestoreDBInstanceFromDBSnapshotInput {
s.EnableIAMDatabaseAuthentication = &v
return s
}
// SetEngine sets the Engine field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBInstanceFromDBSnapshotInput) SetEngine(v string) *RestoreDBInstanceFromDBSnapshotInput {
s.Engine = &v
return s
}
// SetIops sets the Iops field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBInstanceFromDBSnapshotInput) SetIops(v int64) *RestoreDBInstanceFromDBSnapshotInput {
s.Iops = &v
return s
}
// SetLicenseModel sets the LicenseModel field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBInstanceFromDBSnapshotInput) SetLicenseModel(v string) *RestoreDBInstanceFromDBSnapshotInput {
s.LicenseModel = &v
return s
}
// SetMultiAZ sets the MultiAZ field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBInstanceFromDBSnapshotInput) SetMultiAZ(v bool) *RestoreDBInstanceFromDBSnapshotInput {
s.MultiAZ = &v
return s
}
// SetOptionGroupName sets the OptionGroupName field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBInstanceFromDBSnapshotInput) SetOptionGroupName(v string) *RestoreDBInstanceFromDBSnapshotInput {
s.OptionGroupName = &v
return s
}
// SetPort sets the Port field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBInstanceFromDBSnapshotInput) SetPort(v int64) *RestoreDBInstanceFromDBSnapshotInput {
s.Port = &v
return s
}
// SetProcessorFeatures sets the ProcessorFeatures field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBInstanceFromDBSnapshotInput) SetProcessorFeatures(v []*ProcessorFeature) *RestoreDBInstanceFromDBSnapshotInput {
s.ProcessorFeatures = v
return s
}
// SetPubliclyAccessible sets the PubliclyAccessible field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBInstanceFromDBSnapshotInput) SetPubliclyAccessible(v bool) *RestoreDBInstanceFromDBSnapshotInput {
s.PubliclyAccessible = &v
return s
}
// SetStorageType sets the StorageType field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBInstanceFromDBSnapshotInput) SetStorageType(v string) *RestoreDBInstanceFromDBSnapshotInput {
s.StorageType = &v
return s
}
// SetTags sets the Tags field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBInstanceFromDBSnapshotInput) SetTags(v []*Tag) *RestoreDBInstanceFromDBSnapshotInput {
s.Tags = v
return s
}
// SetTdeCredentialArn sets the TdeCredentialArn field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBInstanceFromDBSnapshotInput) SetTdeCredentialArn(v string) *RestoreDBInstanceFromDBSnapshotInput {
s.TdeCredentialArn = &v
return s
}
// SetTdeCredentialPassword sets the TdeCredentialPassword field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBInstanceFromDBSnapshotInput) SetTdeCredentialPassword(v string) *RestoreDBInstanceFromDBSnapshotInput {
s.TdeCredentialPassword = &v
return s
}
// SetUseDefaultProcessorFeatures sets the UseDefaultProcessorFeatures field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBInstanceFromDBSnapshotInput) SetUseDefaultProcessorFeatures(v bool) *RestoreDBInstanceFromDBSnapshotInput {
s.UseDefaultProcessorFeatures = &v
return s
}
// SetVpcSecurityGroupIds sets the VpcSecurityGroupIds field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBInstanceFromDBSnapshotInput) SetVpcSecurityGroupIds(v []*string) *RestoreDBInstanceFromDBSnapshotInput {
s.VpcSecurityGroupIds = v
return s
}
type RestoreDBInstanceFromDBSnapshotOutput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// Contains the details of an Amazon RDS DB instance.
//
// This data type is used as a response element in the DescribeDBInstances action.
DBInstance *DBInstance `type:"structure"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s RestoreDBInstanceFromDBSnapshotOutput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s RestoreDBInstanceFromDBSnapshotOutput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetDBInstance sets the DBInstance field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBInstanceFromDBSnapshotOutput) SetDBInstance(v *DBInstance) *RestoreDBInstanceFromDBSnapshotOutput {
s.DBInstance = v
return s
}
type RestoreDBInstanceFromS3Input struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// The amount of storage (in gigabytes) to allocate initially for the DB instance.
// Follow the allocation rules specified in CreateDBInstance.
//
// Be sure to allocate enough memory for your new DB instance so that the restore
// operation can succeed. You can also allocate additional memory for future
// growth.
AllocatedStorage *int64 `type:"integer"`
// True to indicate that minor engine upgrades are applied automatically to
// the DB instance during the maintenance window, and otherwise false.
//
// Default: true
AutoMinorVersionUpgrade *bool `type:"boolean"`
// The Availability Zone that the DB instance is created in. For information
// about AWS Regions and Availability Zones, see Regions and Availability Zones
// (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/UserGuide/Concepts.RegionsAndAvailabilityZones.html)
// in the Amazon RDS User Guide.
//
// Default: A random, system-chosen Availability Zone in the endpoint's AWS
// Region.
//
// Example: us-east-1d
//
// Constraint: The AvailabilityZone parameter can't be specified if the MultiAZ
// parameter is set to true. The specified Availability Zone must be in the
// same AWS Region as the current endpoint.
AvailabilityZone *string `type:"string"`
// The number of days for which automated backups are retained. Setting this
// parameter to a positive number enables backups. For more information, see
// CreateDBInstance.
BackupRetentionPeriod *int64 `type:"integer"`
// True to copy all tags from the restored DB instance to snapshots of the restored
// DB instance, and otherwise false.
//
// Default: false.
CopyTagsToSnapshot *bool `type:"boolean"`
// The compute and memory capacity of the DB instance, for example, db.m4.large.
// Not all DB instance classes are available in all AWS Regions, or for all
// database engines. For the full list of DB instance classes, and availability
// for your engine, see DB Instance Class (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/UserGuide/Concepts.DBInstanceClass.html)
// in the Amazon RDS User Guide.
//
// Importing from Amazon S3 is not supported on the db.t2.micro DB instance
// class.
//
// DBInstanceClass is a required field
DBInstanceClass *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
// The DB instance identifier. This parameter is stored as a lowercase string.
//
// Constraints:
//
// * Must contain from 1 to 63 letters, numbers, or hyphens.
//
// * First character must be a letter.
//
// * Can't end with a hyphen or contain two consecutive hyphens.
//
// Example: mydbinstance
//
// DBInstanceIdentifier is a required field
DBInstanceIdentifier *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
// The name of the database to create when the DB instance is created. Follow
// the naming rules specified in CreateDBInstance.
DBName *string `type:"string"`
// The name of the DB parameter group to associate with this DB instance. If
// this argument is omitted, the default parameter group for the specified engine
// is used.
DBParameterGroupName *string `type:"string"`
// A list of DB security groups to associate with this DB instance.
//
// Default: The default DB security group for the database engine.
DBSecurityGroups []*string `locationNameList:"DBSecurityGroupName" type:"list"`
// A DB subnet group to associate with this DB instance.
DBSubnetGroupName *string `type:"string"`
// Indicates if the DB instance should have deletion protection enabled. The
// database can't be deleted when this value is set to true. The default is
// false. For more information, see Deleting a DB Instance (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/UserGuide/USER_DeleteInstance.html).
DeletionProtection *bool `type:"boolean"`
// The list of logs that the restored DB instance is to export to CloudWatch
// Logs. The values in the list depend on the DB engine being used. For more
// information, see Publishing Database Logs to Amazon CloudWatch Logs (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/UserGuide/USER_LogAccess.html#USER_LogAccess.Procedural.UploadtoCloudWatch)
// in the Amazon RDS User Guide.
EnableCloudwatchLogsExports []*string `type:"list"`
// True to enable mapping of AWS Identity and Access Management (IAM) accounts
// to database accounts, and otherwise false.
//
// Default: false
EnableIAMDatabaseAuthentication *bool `type:"boolean"`
// True to enable Performance Insights for the DB instance, and otherwise false.
//
// For more information, see Using Amazon Performance Insights (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/UserGuide/USER_PerfInsights.html)
// in the Amazon Relational Database Service User Guide.
EnablePerformanceInsights *bool `type:"boolean"`
// The name of the database engine to be used for this instance.
//
// Valid Values: mysql
//
// Engine is a required field
Engine *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
// The version number of the database engine to use. Choose the latest minor
// version of your database engine. For information about engine versions, see
// CreateDBInstance, or call DescribeDBEngineVersions.
EngineVersion *string `type:"string"`
// The amount of Provisioned IOPS (input/output operations per second) to allocate
// initially for the DB instance. For information about valid Iops values, see
// see Amazon RDS Provisioned IOPS Storage to Improve Performance (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/UserGuide/CHAP_Storage.html#USER_PIOPS)
// in the Amazon RDS User Guide.
Iops *int64 `type:"integer"`
// The AWS KMS key identifier for an encrypted DB instance.
//
// The KMS key identifier is the Amazon Resource Name (ARN) for the KMS encryption
// key. If you are creating a DB instance with the same AWS account that owns
// the KMS encryption key used to encrypt the new DB instance, then you can
// use the KMS key alias instead of the ARN for the KM encryption key.
//
// If the StorageEncrypted parameter is true, and you do not specify a value
// for the KmsKeyId parameter, then Amazon RDS will use your default encryption
// key. AWS KMS creates the default encryption key for your AWS account. Your
// AWS account has a different default encryption key for each AWS Region.
KmsKeyId *string `type:"string"`
// The license model for this DB instance. Use general-public-license.
LicenseModel *string `type:"string"`
// The password for the master user. The password can include any printable
// ASCII character except "/", """, or "@".
//
// Constraints: Must contain from 8 to 41 characters.
MasterUserPassword *string `type:"string"`
// The name for the master user.
//
// Constraints:
//
// * Must be 1 to 16 letters or numbers.
//
// * First character must be a letter.
//
// * Can't be a reserved word for the chosen database engine.
MasterUsername *string `type:"string"`
// The interval, in seconds, between points when Enhanced Monitoring metrics
// are collected for the DB instance. To disable collecting Enhanced Monitoring
// metrics, specify 0.
//
// If MonitoringRoleArn is specified, then you must also set MonitoringInterval
// to a value other than 0.
//
// Valid Values: 0, 1, 5, 10, 15, 30, 60
//
// Default: 0
MonitoringInterval *int64 `type:"integer"`
// The ARN for the IAM role that permits RDS to send enhanced monitoring metrics
// to Amazon CloudWatch Logs. For example, arn:aws:iam:123456789012:role/emaccess.
// For information on creating a monitoring role, see Setting Up and Enabling
// Enhanced Monitoring (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/UserGuide/USER_Monitoring.OS.html#USER_Monitoring.OS.Enabling)
// in the Amazon RDS User Guide.
//
// If MonitoringInterval is set to a value other than 0, then you must supply
// a MonitoringRoleArn value.
MonitoringRoleArn *string `type:"string"`
// Specifies whether the DB instance is a Multi-AZ deployment. If MultiAZ is
// set to true, you can't set the AvailabilityZone parameter.
MultiAZ *bool `type:"boolean"`
// The name of the option group to associate with this DB instance. If this
// argument is omitted, the default option group for the specified engine is
// used.
OptionGroupName *string `type:"string"`
// The AWS KMS key identifier for encryption of Performance Insights data. The
// KMS key ID is the Amazon Resource Name (ARN), the KMS key identifier, or
// the KMS key alias for the KMS encryption key.
PerformanceInsightsKMSKeyId *string `type:"string"`
// The amount of time, in days, to retain Performance Insights data. Valid values
// are 7 or 731 (2 years).
PerformanceInsightsRetentionPeriod *int64 `type:"integer"`
// The port number on which the database accepts connections.
//
// Type: Integer
//
// Valid Values: 1150-65535
//
// Default: 3306
Port *int64 `type:"integer"`
// The time range each day during which automated backups are created if automated
// backups are enabled. For more information, see The Backup Window (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/UserGuide/USER_WorkingWithAutomatedBackups.html#USER_WorkingWithAutomatedBackups.BackupWindow)
// in the Amazon RDS User Guide.
//
// Constraints:
//
// * Must be in the format hh24:mi-hh24:mi.
//
// * Must be in Universal Coordinated Time (UTC).
//
// * Must not conflict with the preferred maintenance window.
//
// * Must be at least 30 minutes.
PreferredBackupWindow *string `type:"string"`
// The time range each week during which system maintenance can occur, in Universal
// Coordinated Time (UTC). For more information, see Amazon RDS Maintenance
// Window (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/UserGuide/USER_UpgradeDBInstance.Maintenance.html#Concepts.DBMaintenance)
// in the Amazon RDS User Guide.
//
// Constraints:
//
// * Must be in the format ddd:hh24:mi-ddd:hh24:mi.
//
// * Valid Days: Mon, Tue, Wed, Thu, Fri, Sat, Sun.
//
// * Must be in Universal Coordinated Time (UTC).
//
// * Must not conflict with the preferred backup window.
//
// * Must be at least 30 minutes.
PreferredMaintenanceWindow *string `type:"string"`
// The number of CPU cores and the number of threads per core for the DB instance
// class of the DB instance.
ProcessorFeatures []*ProcessorFeature `locationNameList:"ProcessorFeature" type:"list"`
// Specifies the accessibility options for the DB instance. A value of true
// specifies an Internet-facing instance with a publicly resolvable DNS name,
// which resolves to a public IP address. A value of false specifies an internal
// instance with a DNS name that resolves to a private IP address. For more
// information, see CreateDBInstance.
PubliclyAccessible *bool `type:"boolean"`
// The name of your Amazon S3 bucket that contains your database backup file.
//
// S3BucketName is a required field
S3BucketName *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
// An AWS Identity and Access Management (IAM) role to allow Amazon RDS to access
// your Amazon S3 bucket.
//
// S3IngestionRoleArn is a required field
S3IngestionRoleArn *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
// The prefix of your Amazon S3 bucket.
S3Prefix *string `type:"string"`
// The name of the engine of your source database.
//
// Valid Values: mysql
//
// SourceEngine is a required field
SourceEngine *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
// The engine version of your source database.
//
// Valid Values: 5.6
//
// SourceEngineVersion is a required field
SourceEngineVersion *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
// Specifies whether the new DB instance is encrypted or not.
StorageEncrypted *bool `type:"boolean"`
// Specifies the storage type to be associated with the DB instance.
//
// Valid values: standard | gp2 | io1
//
// If you specify io1, you must also include a value for the Iops parameter.
//
// Default: io1 if the Iops parameter is specified; otherwise standard
StorageType *string `type:"string"`
// A list of tags to associate with this DB instance. For more information,
// see Tagging Amazon RDS Resources (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/UserGuide/USER_Tagging.html)
// in the Amazon RDS User Guide.
Tags []*Tag `locationNameList:"Tag" type:"list"`
// A value that specifies that the DB instance class of the DB instance uses
// its default processor features.
UseDefaultProcessorFeatures *bool `type:"boolean"`
// A list of VPC security groups to associate with this DB instance.
VpcSecurityGroupIds []*string `locationNameList:"VpcSecurityGroupId" type:"list"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s RestoreDBInstanceFromS3Input) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s RestoreDBInstanceFromS3Input) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
func (s *RestoreDBInstanceFromS3Input) Validate() error {
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "RestoreDBInstanceFromS3Input"}
if s.DBInstanceClass == nil {
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("DBInstanceClass"))
}
if s.DBInstanceIdentifier == nil {
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("DBInstanceIdentifier"))
}
if s.Engine == nil {
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Engine"))
}
if s.S3BucketName == nil {
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("S3BucketName"))
}
if s.S3IngestionRoleArn == nil {
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("S3IngestionRoleArn"))
}
if s.SourceEngine == nil {
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("SourceEngine"))
}
if s.SourceEngineVersion == nil {
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("SourceEngineVersion"))
}
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
return invalidParams
}
return nil
}
// SetAllocatedStorage sets the AllocatedStorage field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBInstanceFromS3Input) SetAllocatedStorage(v int64) *RestoreDBInstanceFromS3Input {
s.AllocatedStorage = &v
return s
}
// SetAutoMinorVersionUpgrade sets the AutoMinorVersionUpgrade field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBInstanceFromS3Input) SetAutoMinorVersionUpgrade(v bool) *RestoreDBInstanceFromS3Input {
s.AutoMinorVersionUpgrade = &v
return s
}
// SetAvailabilityZone sets the AvailabilityZone field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBInstanceFromS3Input) SetAvailabilityZone(v string) *RestoreDBInstanceFromS3Input {
s.AvailabilityZone = &v
return s
}
// SetBackupRetentionPeriod sets the BackupRetentionPeriod field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBInstanceFromS3Input) SetBackupRetentionPeriod(v int64) *RestoreDBInstanceFromS3Input {
s.BackupRetentionPeriod = &v
return s
}
// SetCopyTagsToSnapshot sets the CopyTagsToSnapshot field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBInstanceFromS3Input) SetCopyTagsToSnapshot(v bool) *RestoreDBInstanceFromS3Input {
s.CopyTagsToSnapshot = &v
return s
}
// SetDBInstanceClass sets the DBInstanceClass field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBInstanceFromS3Input) SetDBInstanceClass(v string) *RestoreDBInstanceFromS3Input {
s.DBInstanceClass = &v
return s
}
// SetDBInstanceIdentifier sets the DBInstanceIdentifier field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBInstanceFromS3Input) SetDBInstanceIdentifier(v string) *RestoreDBInstanceFromS3Input {
s.DBInstanceIdentifier = &v
return s
}
// SetDBName sets the DBName field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBInstanceFromS3Input) SetDBName(v string) *RestoreDBInstanceFromS3Input {
s.DBName = &v
return s
}
// SetDBParameterGroupName sets the DBParameterGroupName field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBInstanceFromS3Input) SetDBParameterGroupName(v string) *RestoreDBInstanceFromS3Input {
s.DBParameterGroupName = &v
return s
}
// SetDBSecurityGroups sets the DBSecurityGroups field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBInstanceFromS3Input) SetDBSecurityGroups(v []*string) *RestoreDBInstanceFromS3Input {
s.DBSecurityGroups = v
return s
}
// SetDBSubnetGroupName sets the DBSubnetGroupName field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBInstanceFromS3Input) SetDBSubnetGroupName(v string) *RestoreDBInstanceFromS3Input {
s.DBSubnetGroupName = &v
return s
}
// SetDeletionProtection sets the DeletionProtection field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBInstanceFromS3Input) SetDeletionProtection(v bool) *RestoreDBInstanceFromS3Input {
s.DeletionProtection = &v
return s
}
// SetEnableCloudwatchLogsExports sets the EnableCloudwatchLogsExports field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBInstanceFromS3Input) SetEnableCloudwatchLogsExports(v []*string) *RestoreDBInstanceFromS3Input {
s.EnableCloudwatchLogsExports = v
return s
}
// SetEnableIAMDatabaseAuthentication sets the EnableIAMDatabaseAuthentication field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBInstanceFromS3Input) SetEnableIAMDatabaseAuthentication(v bool) *RestoreDBInstanceFromS3Input {
s.EnableIAMDatabaseAuthentication = &v
return s
}
// SetEnablePerformanceInsights sets the EnablePerformanceInsights field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBInstanceFromS3Input) SetEnablePerformanceInsights(v bool) *RestoreDBInstanceFromS3Input {
s.EnablePerformanceInsights = &v
return s
}
// SetEngine sets the Engine field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBInstanceFromS3Input) SetEngine(v string) *RestoreDBInstanceFromS3Input {
s.Engine = &v
return s
}
// SetEngineVersion sets the EngineVersion field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBInstanceFromS3Input) SetEngineVersion(v string) *RestoreDBInstanceFromS3Input {
s.EngineVersion = &v
return s
}
// SetIops sets the Iops field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBInstanceFromS3Input) SetIops(v int64) *RestoreDBInstanceFromS3Input {
s.Iops = &v
return s
}
// SetKmsKeyId sets the KmsKeyId field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBInstanceFromS3Input) SetKmsKeyId(v string) *RestoreDBInstanceFromS3Input {
s.KmsKeyId = &v
return s
}
// SetLicenseModel sets the LicenseModel field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBInstanceFromS3Input) SetLicenseModel(v string) *RestoreDBInstanceFromS3Input {
s.LicenseModel = &v
return s
}
// SetMasterUserPassword sets the MasterUserPassword field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBInstanceFromS3Input) SetMasterUserPassword(v string) *RestoreDBInstanceFromS3Input {
s.MasterUserPassword = &v
return s
}
// SetMasterUsername sets the MasterUsername field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBInstanceFromS3Input) SetMasterUsername(v string) *RestoreDBInstanceFromS3Input {
s.MasterUsername = &v
return s
}
// SetMonitoringInterval sets the MonitoringInterval field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBInstanceFromS3Input) SetMonitoringInterval(v int64) *RestoreDBInstanceFromS3Input {
s.MonitoringInterval = &v
return s
}
// SetMonitoringRoleArn sets the MonitoringRoleArn field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBInstanceFromS3Input) SetMonitoringRoleArn(v string) *RestoreDBInstanceFromS3Input {
s.MonitoringRoleArn = &v
return s
}
// SetMultiAZ sets the MultiAZ field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBInstanceFromS3Input) SetMultiAZ(v bool) *RestoreDBInstanceFromS3Input {
s.MultiAZ = &v
return s
}
// SetOptionGroupName sets the OptionGroupName field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBInstanceFromS3Input) SetOptionGroupName(v string) *RestoreDBInstanceFromS3Input {
s.OptionGroupName = &v
return s
}
// SetPerformanceInsightsKMSKeyId sets the PerformanceInsightsKMSKeyId field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBInstanceFromS3Input) SetPerformanceInsightsKMSKeyId(v string) *RestoreDBInstanceFromS3Input {
s.PerformanceInsightsKMSKeyId = &v
return s
}
// SetPerformanceInsightsRetentionPeriod sets the PerformanceInsightsRetentionPeriod field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBInstanceFromS3Input) SetPerformanceInsightsRetentionPeriod(v int64) *RestoreDBInstanceFromS3Input {
s.PerformanceInsightsRetentionPeriod = &v
return s
}
// SetPort sets the Port field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBInstanceFromS3Input) SetPort(v int64) *RestoreDBInstanceFromS3Input {
s.Port = &v
return s
}
// SetPreferredBackupWindow sets the PreferredBackupWindow field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBInstanceFromS3Input) SetPreferredBackupWindow(v string) *RestoreDBInstanceFromS3Input {
s.PreferredBackupWindow = &v
return s
}
// SetPreferredMaintenanceWindow sets the PreferredMaintenanceWindow field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBInstanceFromS3Input) SetPreferredMaintenanceWindow(v string) *RestoreDBInstanceFromS3Input {
s.PreferredMaintenanceWindow = &v
return s
}
// SetProcessorFeatures sets the ProcessorFeatures field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBInstanceFromS3Input) SetProcessorFeatures(v []*ProcessorFeature) *RestoreDBInstanceFromS3Input {
s.ProcessorFeatures = v
return s
}
// SetPubliclyAccessible sets the PubliclyAccessible field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBInstanceFromS3Input) SetPubliclyAccessible(v bool) *RestoreDBInstanceFromS3Input {
s.PubliclyAccessible = &v
return s
}
// SetS3BucketName sets the S3BucketName field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBInstanceFromS3Input) SetS3BucketName(v string) *RestoreDBInstanceFromS3Input {
s.S3BucketName = &v
return s
}
// SetS3IngestionRoleArn sets the S3IngestionRoleArn field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBInstanceFromS3Input) SetS3IngestionRoleArn(v string) *RestoreDBInstanceFromS3Input {
s.S3IngestionRoleArn = &v
return s
}
// SetS3Prefix sets the S3Prefix field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBInstanceFromS3Input) SetS3Prefix(v string) *RestoreDBInstanceFromS3Input {
s.S3Prefix = &v
return s
}
// SetSourceEngine sets the SourceEngine field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBInstanceFromS3Input) SetSourceEngine(v string) *RestoreDBInstanceFromS3Input {
s.SourceEngine = &v
return s
}
// SetSourceEngineVersion sets the SourceEngineVersion field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBInstanceFromS3Input) SetSourceEngineVersion(v string) *RestoreDBInstanceFromS3Input {
s.SourceEngineVersion = &v
return s
}
// SetStorageEncrypted sets the StorageEncrypted field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBInstanceFromS3Input) SetStorageEncrypted(v bool) *RestoreDBInstanceFromS3Input {
s.StorageEncrypted = &v
return s
}
// SetStorageType sets the StorageType field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBInstanceFromS3Input) SetStorageType(v string) *RestoreDBInstanceFromS3Input {
s.StorageType = &v
return s
}
// SetTags sets the Tags field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBInstanceFromS3Input) SetTags(v []*Tag) *RestoreDBInstanceFromS3Input {
s.Tags = v
return s
}
// SetUseDefaultProcessorFeatures sets the UseDefaultProcessorFeatures field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBInstanceFromS3Input) SetUseDefaultProcessorFeatures(v bool) *RestoreDBInstanceFromS3Input {
s.UseDefaultProcessorFeatures = &v
return s
}
// SetVpcSecurityGroupIds sets the VpcSecurityGroupIds field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBInstanceFromS3Input) SetVpcSecurityGroupIds(v []*string) *RestoreDBInstanceFromS3Input {
s.VpcSecurityGroupIds = v
return s
}
type RestoreDBInstanceFromS3Output struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// Contains the details of an Amazon RDS DB instance.
//
// This data type is used as a response element in the DescribeDBInstances action.
DBInstance *DBInstance `type:"structure"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s RestoreDBInstanceFromS3Output) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s RestoreDBInstanceFromS3Output) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetDBInstance sets the DBInstance field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBInstanceFromS3Output) SetDBInstance(v *DBInstance) *RestoreDBInstanceFromS3Output {
s.DBInstance = v
return s
}
type RestoreDBInstanceToPointInTimeInput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// Indicates that minor version upgrades are applied automatically to the DB
// instance during the maintenance window.
AutoMinorVersionUpgrade *bool `type:"boolean"`
// The EC2 Availability Zone that the DB instance is created in.
//
// Default: A random, system-chosen Availability Zone.
//
// Constraint: You can't specify the AvailabilityZone parameter if the MultiAZ
// parameter is set to true.
//
// Example: us-east-1a
AvailabilityZone *string `type:"string"`
// True to copy all tags from the restored DB instance to snapshots of the restored
// DB instance, and otherwise false. The default is false.
CopyTagsToSnapshot *bool `type:"boolean"`
// The compute and memory capacity of the Amazon RDS DB instance, for example,
// db.m4.large. Not all DB instance classes are available in all AWS Regions,
// or for all database engines. For the full list of DB instance classes, and
// availability for your engine, see DB Instance Class (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/UserGuide/Concepts.DBInstanceClass.html)
// in the Amazon RDS User Guide.
//
// Default: The same DBInstanceClass as the original DB instance.
DBInstanceClass *string `type:"string"`
// The database name for the restored DB instance.
//
// This parameter is not used for the MySQL or MariaDB engines.
DBName *string `type:"string"`
// The name of the DB parameter group to associate with this DB instance. If
// this argument is omitted, the default DBParameterGroup for the specified
// engine is used.
//
// Constraints:
//
// * If supplied, must match the name of an existing DBParameterGroup.
//
// * Must be 1 to 255 letters, numbers, or hyphens.
//
// * First character must be a letter.
//
// * Can't end with a hyphen or contain two consecutive hyphens.
DBParameterGroupName *string `type:"string"`
// The DB subnet group name to use for the new instance.
//
// Constraints: If supplied, must match the name of an existing DBSubnetGroup.
//
// Example: mySubnetgroup
DBSubnetGroupName *string `type:"string"`
// Indicates if the DB instance should have deletion protection enabled. The
// database can't be deleted when this value is set to true. The default is
// false. For more information, see Deleting a DB Instance (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/UserGuide/USER_DeleteInstance.html).
DeletionProtection *bool `type:"boolean"`
// Specify the Active Directory Domain to restore the instance in.
Domain *string `type:"string"`
// Specify the name of the IAM role to be used when making API calls to the
// Directory Service.
DomainIAMRoleName *string `type:"string"`
// The list of logs that the restored DB instance is to export to CloudWatch
// Logs. The values in the list depend on the DB engine being used. For more
// information, see Publishing Database Logs to Amazon CloudWatch Logs (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/UserGuide/USER_LogAccess.html#USER_LogAccess.Procedural.UploadtoCloudWatch)
// in the Amazon RDS User Guide.
EnableCloudwatchLogsExports []*string `type:"list"`
// True to enable mapping of AWS Identity and Access Management (IAM) accounts
// to database accounts, and otherwise false.
//
// You can enable IAM database authentication for the following database engines
//
// * For MySQL 5.6, minor version 5.6.34 or higher
//
// * For MySQL 5.7, minor version 5.7.16 or higher
//
// Default: false
EnableIAMDatabaseAuthentication *bool `type:"boolean"`
// The database engine to use for the new instance.
//
// Default: The same as source
//
// Constraint: Must be compatible with the engine of the source
//
// Valid Values:
//
// * mariadb
//
// * mysql
//
// * oracle-ee
//
// * oracle-se2
//
// * oracle-se1
//
// * oracle-se
//
// * postgres
//
// * sqlserver-ee
//
// * sqlserver-se
//
// * sqlserver-ex
//
// * sqlserver-web
Engine *string `type:"string"`
// The amount of Provisioned IOPS (input/output operations per second) to be
// initially allocated for the DB instance.
//
// Constraints: Must be an integer greater than 1000.
//
// SQL Server
//
// Setting the IOPS value for the SQL Server database engine is not supported.
Iops *int64 `type:"integer"`
// License model information for the restored DB instance.
//
// Default: Same as source.
//
// Valid values: license-included | bring-your-own-license | general-public-license
LicenseModel *string `type:"string"`
// Specifies if the DB instance is a Multi-AZ deployment.
//
// Constraint: You can't specify the AvailabilityZone parameter if the MultiAZ
// parameter is set to true.
MultiAZ *bool `type:"boolean"`
// The name of the option group to be used for the restored DB instance.
//
// Permanent options, such as the TDE option for Oracle Advanced Security TDE,
// can't be removed from an option group, and that option group can't be removed
// from a DB instance once it is associated with a DB instance
OptionGroupName *string `type:"string"`
// The port number on which the database accepts connections.
//
// Constraints: Value must be 1150-65535
//
// Default: The same port as the original DB instance.
Port *int64 `type:"integer"`
// The number of CPU cores and the number of threads per core for the DB instance
// class of the DB instance.
ProcessorFeatures []*ProcessorFeature `locationNameList:"ProcessorFeature" type:"list"`
// Specifies the accessibility options for the DB instance. A value of true
// specifies an Internet-facing instance with a publicly resolvable DNS name,
// which resolves to a public IP address. A value of false specifies an internal
// instance with a DNS name that resolves to a private IP address. For more
// information, see CreateDBInstance.
PubliclyAccessible *bool `type:"boolean"`
// The date and time to restore from.
//
// Valid Values: Value must be a time in Universal Coordinated Time (UTC) format
//
// Constraints:
//
// * Must be before the latest restorable time for the DB instance
//
// * Can't be specified if UseLatestRestorableTime parameter is true
//
// Example: 2009-09-07T23:45:00Z
RestoreTime *time.Time `type:"timestamp"`
// The identifier of the source DB instance from which to restore.
//
// Constraints:
//
// * Must match the identifier of an existing DB instance.
SourceDBInstanceIdentifier *string `type:"string"`
// The resource ID of the source DB instance from which to restore.
SourceDbiResourceId *string `type:"string"`
// Specifies the storage type to be associated with the DB instance.
//
// Valid values: standard | gp2 | io1
//
// If you specify io1, you must also include a value for the Iops parameter.
//
// Default: io1 if the Iops parameter is specified, otherwise standard
StorageType *string `type:"string"`
// A list of tags. For more information, see Tagging Amazon RDS Resources (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/UserGuide/USER_Tagging.html)
// in the Amazon RDS User Guide.
Tags []*Tag `locationNameList:"Tag" type:"list"`
// The name of the new DB instance to be created.
//
// Constraints:
//
// * Must contain from 1 to 63 letters, numbers, or hyphens
//
// * First character must be a letter
//
// * Can't end with a hyphen or contain two consecutive hyphens
//
// TargetDBInstanceIdentifier is a required field
TargetDBInstanceIdentifier *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
// The ARN from the key store with which to associate the instance for TDE encryption.
TdeCredentialArn *string `type:"string"`
// The password for the given ARN from the key store in order to access the
// device.
TdeCredentialPassword *string `type:"string"`
// A value that specifies that the DB instance class of the DB instance uses
// its default processor features.
UseDefaultProcessorFeatures *bool `type:"boolean"`
// Specifies whether (true) or not (false) the DB instance is restored from
// the latest backup time.
//
// Default: false
//
// Constraints: Can't be specified if RestoreTime parameter is provided.
UseLatestRestorableTime *bool `type:"boolean"`
// A list of EC2 VPC security groups to associate with this DB instance.
//
// Default: The default EC2 VPC security group for the DB subnet group's VPC.
VpcSecurityGroupIds []*string `locationNameList:"VpcSecurityGroupId" type:"list"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s RestoreDBInstanceToPointInTimeInput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s RestoreDBInstanceToPointInTimeInput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
func (s *RestoreDBInstanceToPointInTimeInput) Validate() error {
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "RestoreDBInstanceToPointInTimeInput"}
if s.TargetDBInstanceIdentifier == nil {
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("TargetDBInstanceIdentifier"))
}
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
return invalidParams
}
return nil
}
// SetAutoMinorVersionUpgrade sets the AutoMinorVersionUpgrade field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBInstanceToPointInTimeInput) SetAutoMinorVersionUpgrade(v bool) *RestoreDBInstanceToPointInTimeInput {
s.AutoMinorVersionUpgrade = &v
return s
}
// SetAvailabilityZone sets the AvailabilityZone field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBInstanceToPointInTimeInput) SetAvailabilityZone(v string) *RestoreDBInstanceToPointInTimeInput {
s.AvailabilityZone = &v
return s
}
// SetCopyTagsToSnapshot sets the CopyTagsToSnapshot field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBInstanceToPointInTimeInput) SetCopyTagsToSnapshot(v bool) *RestoreDBInstanceToPointInTimeInput {
s.CopyTagsToSnapshot = &v
return s
}
// SetDBInstanceClass sets the DBInstanceClass field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBInstanceToPointInTimeInput) SetDBInstanceClass(v string) *RestoreDBInstanceToPointInTimeInput {
s.DBInstanceClass = &v
return s
}
// SetDBName sets the DBName field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBInstanceToPointInTimeInput) SetDBName(v string) *RestoreDBInstanceToPointInTimeInput {
s.DBName = &v
return s
}
// SetDBParameterGroupName sets the DBParameterGroupName field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBInstanceToPointInTimeInput) SetDBParameterGroupName(v string) *RestoreDBInstanceToPointInTimeInput {
s.DBParameterGroupName = &v
return s
}
// SetDBSubnetGroupName sets the DBSubnetGroupName field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBInstanceToPointInTimeInput) SetDBSubnetGroupName(v string) *RestoreDBInstanceToPointInTimeInput {
s.DBSubnetGroupName = &v
return s
}
// SetDeletionProtection sets the DeletionProtection field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBInstanceToPointInTimeInput) SetDeletionProtection(v bool) *RestoreDBInstanceToPointInTimeInput {
s.DeletionProtection = &v
return s
}
// SetDomain sets the Domain field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBInstanceToPointInTimeInput) SetDomain(v string) *RestoreDBInstanceToPointInTimeInput {
s.Domain = &v
return s
}
// SetDomainIAMRoleName sets the DomainIAMRoleName field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBInstanceToPointInTimeInput) SetDomainIAMRoleName(v string) *RestoreDBInstanceToPointInTimeInput {
s.DomainIAMRoleName = &v
return s
}
// SetEnableCloudwatchLogsExports sets the EnableCloudwatchLogsExports field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBInstanceToPointInTimeInput) SetEnableCloudwatchLogsExports(v []*string) *RestoreDBInstanceToPointInTimeInput {
s.EnableCloudwatchLogsExports = v
return s
}
// SetEnableIAMDatabaseAuthentication sets the EnableIAMDatabaseAuthentication field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBInstanceToPointInTimeInput) SetEnableIAMDatabaseAuthentication(v bool) *RestoreDBInstanceToPointInTimeInput {
s.EnableIAMDatabaseAuthentication = &v
return s
}
// SetEngine sets the Engine field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBInstanceToPointInTimeInput) SetEngine(v string) *RestoreDBInstanceToPointInTimeInput {
s.Engine = &v
return s
}
// SetIops sets the Iops field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBInstanceToPointInTimeInput) SetIops(v int64) *RestoreDBInstanceToPointInTimeInput {
s.Iops = &v
return s
}
// SetLicenseModel sets the LicenseModel field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBInstanceToPointInTimeInput) SetLicenseModel(v string) *RestoreDBInstanceToPointInTimeInput {
s.LicenseModel = &v
return s
}
// SetMultiAZ sets the MultiAZ field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBInstanceToPointInTimeInput) SetMultiAZ(v bool) *RestoreDBInstanceToPointInTimeInput {
s.MultiAZ = &v
return s
}
// SetOptionGroupName sets the OptionGroupName field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBInstanceToPointInTimeInput) SetOptionGroupName(v string) *RestoreDBInstanceToPointInTimeInput {
s.OptionGroupName = &v
return s
}
// SetPort sets the Port field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBInstanceToPointInTimeInput) SetPort(v int64) *RestoreDBInstanceToPointInTimeInput {
s.Port = &v
return s
}
// SetProcessorFeatures sets the ProcessorFeatures field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBInstanceToPointInTimeInput) SetProcessorFeatures(v []*ProcessorFeature) *RestoreDBInstanceToPointInTimeInput {
s.ProcessorFeatures = v
return s
}
// SetPubliclyAccessible sets the PubliclyAccessible field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBInstanceToPointInTimeInput) SetPubliclyAccessible(v bool) *RestoreDBInstanceToPointInTimeInput {
s.PubliclyAccessible = &v
return s
}
// SetRestoreTime sets the RestoreTime field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBInstanceToPointInTimeInput) SetRestoreTime(v time.Time) *RestoreDBInstanceToPointInTimeInput {
s.RestoreTime = &v
return s
}
// SetSourceDBInstanceIdentifier sets the SourceDBInstanceIdentifier field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBInstanceToPointInTimeInput) SetSourceDBInstanceIdentifier(v string) *RestoreDBInstanceToPointInTimeInput {
s.SourceDBInstanceIdentifier = &v
return s
}
// SetSourceDbiResourceId sets the SourceDbiResourceId field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBInstanceToPointInTimeInput) SetSourceDbiResourceId(v string) *RestoreDBInstanceToPointInTimeInput {
s.SourceDbiResourceId = &v
return s
}
// SetStorageType sets the StorageType field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBInstanceToPointInTimeInput) SetStorageType(v string) *RestoreDBInstanceToPointInTimeInput {
s.StorageType = &v
return s
}
// SetTags sets the Tags field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBInstanceToPointInTimeInput) SetTags(v []*Tag) *RestoreDBInstanceToPointInTimeInput {
s.Tags = v
return s
}
// SetTargetDBInstanceIdentifier sets the TargetDBInstanceIdentifier field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBInstanceToPointInTimeInput) SetTargetDBInstanceIdentifier(v string) *RestoreDBInstanceToPointInTimeInput {
s.TargetDBInstanceIdentifier = &v
return s
}
// SetTdeCredentialArn sets the TdeCredentialArn field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBInstanceToPointInTimeInput) SetTdeCredentialArn(v string) *RestoreDBInstanceToPointInTimeInput {
s.TdeCredentialArn = &v
return s
}
// SetTdeCredentialPassword sets the TdeCredentialPassword field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBInstanceToPointInTimeInput) SetTdeCredentialPassword(v string) *RestoreDBInstanceToPointInTimeInput {
s.TdeCredentialPassword = &v
return s
}
// SetUseDefaultProcessorFeatures sets the UseDefaultProcessorFeatures field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBInstanceToPointInTimeInput) SetUseDefaultProcessorFeatures(v bool) *RestoreDBInstanceToPointInTimeInput {
s.UseDefaultProcessorFeatures = &v
return s
}
// SetUseLatestRestorableTime sets the UseLatestRestorableTime field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBInstanceToPointInTimeInput) SetUseLatestRestorableTime(v bool) *RestoreDBInstanceToPointInTimeInput {
s.UseLatestRestorableTime = &v
return s
}
// SetVpcSecurityGroupIds sets the VpcSecurityGroupIds field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBInstanceToPointInTimeInput) SetVpcSecurityGroupIds(v []*string) *RestoreDBInstanceToPointInTimeInput {
s.VpcSecurityGroupIds = v
return s
}
type RestoreDBInstanceToPointInTimeOutput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// Contains the details of an Amazon RDS DB instance.
//
// This data type is used as a response element in the DescribeDBInstances action.
DBInstance *DBInstance `type:"structure"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s RestoreDBInstanceToPointInTimeOutput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s RestoreDBInstanceToPointInTimeOutput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetDBInstance sets the DBInstance field's value.
func (s *RestoreDBInstanceToPointInTimeOutput) SetDBInstance(v *DBInstance) *RestoreDBInstanceToPointInTimeOutput {
s.DBInstance = v
return s
}
// Earliest and latest time an instance can be restored to:
type RestoreWindow struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// The earliest time you can restore an instance to.
EarliestTime *time.Time `type:"timestamp"`
// The latest time you can restore an instance to.
LatestTime *time.Time `type:"timestamp"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s RestoreWindow) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s RestoreWindow) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetEarliestTime sets the EarliestTime field's value.
func (s *RestoreWindow) SetEarliestTime(v time.Time) *RestoreWindow {
s.EarliestTime = &v
return s
}
// SetLatestTime sets the LatestTime field's value.
func (s *RestoreWindow) SetLatestTime(v time.Time) *RestoreWindow {
s.LatestTime = &v
return s
}
type RevokeDBSecurityGroupIngressInput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// The IP range to revoke access from. Must be a valid CIDR range. If CIDRIP
// is specified, EC2SecurityGroupName, EC2SecurityGroupId and EC2SecurityGroupOwnerId
// can't be provided.
CIDRIP *string `type:"string"`
// The name of the DB security group to revoke ingress from.
//
// DBSecurityGroupName is a required field
DBSecurityGroupName *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
// The id of the EC2 security group to revoke access from. For VPC DB security
// groups, EC2SecurityGroupId must be provided. Otherwise, EC2SecurityGroupOwnerId
// and either EC2SecurityGroupName or EC2SecurityGroupId must be provided.
EC2SecurityGroupId *string `type:"string"`
// The name of the EC2 security group to revoke access from. For VPC DB security
// groups, EC2SecurityGroupId must be provided. Otherwise, EC2SecurityGroupOwnerId
// and either EC2SecurityGroupName or EC2SecurityGroupId must be provided.
EC2SecurityGroupName *string `type:"string"`
// The AWS Account Number of the owner of the EC2 security group specified in
// the EC2SecurityGroupName parameter. The AWS Access Key ID is not an acceptable
// value. For VPC DB security groups, EC2SecurityGroupId must be provided. Otherwise,
// EC2SecurityGroupOwnerId and either EC2SecurityGroupName or EC2SecurityGroupId
// must be provided.
EC2SecurityGroupOwnerId *string `type:"string"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s RevokeDBSecurityGroupIngressInput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s RevokeDBSecurityGroupIngressInput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
func (s *RevokeDBSecurityGroupIngressInput) Validate() error {
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "RevokeDBSecurityGroupIngressInput"}
if s.DBSecurityGroupName == nil {
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("DBSecurityGroupName"))
}
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
return invalidParams
}
return nil
}
// SetCIDRIP sets the CIDRIP field's value.
func (s *RevokeDBSecurityGroupIngressInput) SetCIDRIP(v string) *RevokeDBSecurityGroupIngressInput {
s.CIDRIP = &v
return s
}
// SetDBSecurityGroupName sets the DBSecurityGroupName field's value.
func (s *RevokeDBSecurityGroupIngressInput) SetDBSecurityGroupName(v string) *RevokeDBSecurityGroupIngressInput {
s.DBSecurityGroupName = &v
return s
}
// SetEC2SecurityGroupId sets the EC2SecurityGroupId field's value.
func (s *RevokeDBSecurityGroupIngressInput) SetEC2SecurityGroupId(v string) *RevokeDBSecurityGroupIngressInput {
s.EC2SecurityGroupId = &v
return s
}
// SetEC2SecurityGroupName sets the EC2SecurityGroupName field's value.
func (s *RevokeDBSecurityGroupIngressInput) SetEC2SecurityGroupName(v string) *RevokeDBSecurityGroupIngressInput {
s.EC2SecurityGroupName = &v
return s
}
// SetEC2SecurityGroupOwnerId sets the EC2SecurityGroupOwnerId field's value.
func (s *RevokeDBSecurityGroupIngressInput) SetEC2SecurityGroupOwnerId(v string) *RevokeDBSecurityGroupIngressInput {
s.EC2SecurityGroupOwnerId = &v
return s
}
type RevokeDBSecurityGroupIngressOutput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// Contains the details for an Amazon RDS DB security group.
//
// This data type is used as a response element in the DescribeDBSecurityGroups
// action.
DBSecurityGroup *DBSecurityGroup `type:"structure"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s RevokeDBSecurityGroupIngressOutput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s RevokeDBSecurityGroupIngressOutput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetDBSecurityGroup sets the DBSecurityGroup field's value.
func (s *RevokeDBSecurityGroupIngressOutput) SetDBSecurityGroup(v *DBSecurityGroup) *RevokeDBSecurityGroupIngressOutput {
s.DBSecurityGroup = v
return s
}
// Contains the scaling configuration of an Aurora Serverless DB cluster.
//
// For more information, see Using Amazon Aurora Serverless (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/AuroraUserGuide/aurora-serverless.html)
// in the Amazon Aurora User Guide.
type ScalingConfiguration struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// A value that specifies whether to allow or disallow automatic pause for an
// Aurora DB cluster in serverless DB engine mode. A DB cluster can be paused
// only when it's idle (it has no connections).
//
// If a DB cluster is paused for more than seven days, the DB cluster might
// be backed up with a snapshot. In this case, the DB cluster is restored when
// there is a request to connect to it.
AutoPause *bool `type:"boolean"`
// The maximum capacity for an Aurora DB cluster in serverless DB engine mode.
//
// Valid capacity values are 2, 4, 8, 16, 32, 64, 128, and 256.
//
// The maximum capacity must be greater than or equal to the minimum capacity.
MaxCapacity *int64 `type:"integer"`
// The minimum capacity for an Aurora DB cluster in serverless DB engine mode.
//
// Valid capacity values are 2, 4, 8, 16, 32, 64, 128, and 256.
//
// The minimum capacity must be less than or equal to the maximum capacity.
MinCapacity *int64 `type:"integer"`
// The time, in seconds, before an Aurora DB cluster in serverless mode is paused.
SecondsUntilAutoPause *int64 `type:"integer"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s ScalingConfiguration) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s ScalingConfiguration) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetAutoPause sets the AutoPause field's value.
func (s *ScalingConfiguration) SetAutoPause(v bool) *ScalingConfiguration {
s.AutoPause = &v
return s
}
// SetMaxCapacity sets the MaxCapacity field's value.
func (s *ScalingConfiguration) SetMaxCapacity(v int64) *ScalingConfiguration {
s.MaxCapacity = &v
return s
}
// SetMinCapacity sets the MinCapacity field's value.
func (s *ScalingConfiguration) SetMinCapacity(v int64) *ScalingConfiguration {
s.MinCapacity = &v
return s
}
// SetSecondsUntilAutoPause sets the SecondsUntilAutoPause field's value.
func (s *ScalingConfiguration) SetSecondsUntilAutoPause(v int64) *ScalingConfiguration {
s.SecondsUntilAutoPause = &v
return s
}
// Shows the scaling configuration for an Aurora DB cluster in serverless DB
// engine mode.
//
// For more information, see Using Amazon Aurora Serverless (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/AuroraUserGuide/aurora-serverless.html)
// in the Amazon Aurora User Guide.
type ScalingConfigurationInfo struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// A value that indicates whether automatic pause is allowed for the Aurora
// DB cluster in serverless DB engine mode.
AutoPause *bool `type:"boolean"`
// The maximum capacity for an Aurora DB cluster in serverless DB engine mode.
MaxCapacity *int64 `type:"integer"`
// The maximum capacity for the Aurora DB cluster in serverless DB engine mode.
MinCapacity *int64 `type:"integer"`
// The remaining amount of time, in seconds, before the Aurora DB cluster in
// serverless mode is paused. A DB cluster can be paused only when it's idle
// (it has no connections).
SecondsUntilAutoPause *int64 `type:"integer"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s ScalingConfigurationInfo) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s ScalingConfigurationInfo) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetAutoPause sets the AutoPause field's value.
func (s *ScalingConfigurationInfo) SetAutoPause(v bool) *ScalingConfigurationInfo {
s.AutoPause = &v
return s
}
// SetMaxCapacity sets the MaxCapacity field's value.
func (s *ScalingConfigurationInfo) SetMaxCapacity(v int64) *ScalingConfigurationInfo {
s.MaxCapacity = &v
return s
}
// SetMinCapacity sets the MinCapacity field's value.
func (s *ScalingConfigurationInfo) SetMinCapacity(v int64) *ScalingConfigurationInfo {
s.MinCapacity = &v
return s
}
// SetSecondsUntilAutoPause sets the SecondsUntilAutoPause field's value.
func (s *ScalingConfigurationInfo) SetSecondsUntilAutoPause(v int64) *ScalingConfigurationInfo {
s.SecondsUntilAutoPause = &v
return s
}
// Contains an AWS Region name as the result of a successful call to the DescribeSourceRegions
// action.
type SourceRegion struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// The endpoint for the source AWS Region endpoint.
Endpoint *string `type:"string"`
// The name of the source AWS Region.
RegionName *string `type:"string"`
// The status of the source AWS Region.
Status *string `type:"string"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s SourceRegion) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s SourceRegion) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetEndpoint sets the Endpoint field's value.
func (s *SourceRegion) SetEndpoint(v string) *SourceRegion {
s.Endpoint = &v
return s
}
// SetRegionName sets the RegionName field's value.
func (s *SourceRegion) SetRegionName(v string) *SourceRegion {
s.RegionName = &v
return s
}
// SetStatus sets the Status field's value.
func (s *SourceRegion) SetStatus(v string) *SourceRegion {
s.Status = &v
return s
}
type StartDBClusterInput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// The DB cluster identifier of the Amazon Aurora DB cluster to be started.
// This parameter is stored as a lowercase string.
//
// DBClusterIdentifier is a required field
DBClusterIdentifier *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s StartDBClusterInput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s StartDBClusterInput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
func (s *StartDBClusterInput) Validate() error {
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "StartDBClusterInput"}
if s.DBClusterIdentifier == nil {
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("DBClusterIdentifier"))
}
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
return invalidParams
}
return nil
}
// SetDBClusterIdentifier sets the DBClusterIdentifier field's value.
func (s *StartDBClusterInput) SetDBClusterIdentifier(v string) *StartDBClusterInput {
s.DBClusterIdentifier = &v
return s
}
type StartDBClusterOutput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// Contains the details of an Amazon Aurora DB cluster.
//
// This data type is used as a response element in the DescribeDBClusters, StopDBCluster,
// and StartDBCluster actions.
DBCluster *DBCluster `type:"structure"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s StartDBClusterOutput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s StartDBClusterOutput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetDBCluster sets the DBCluster field's value.
func (s *StartDBClusterOutput) SetDBCluster(v *DBCluster) *StartDBClusterOutput {
s.DBCluster = v
return s
}
type StartDBInstanceInput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// The user-supplied instance identifier.
//
// DBInstanceIdentifier is a required field
DBInstanceIdentifier *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s StartDBInstanceInput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s StartDBInstanceInput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
func (s *StartDBInstanceInput) Validate() error {
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "StartDBInstanceInput"}
if s.DBInstanceIdentifier == nil {
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("DBInstanceIdentifier"))
}
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
return invalidParams
}
return nil
}
// SetDBInstanceIdentifier sets the DBInstanceIdentifier field's value.
func (s *StartDBInstanceInput) SetDBInstanceIdentifier(v string) *StartDBInstanceInput {
s.DBInstanceIdentifier = &v
return s
}
type StartDBInstanceOutput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// Contains the details of an Amazon RDS DB instance.
//
// This data type is used as a response element in the DescribeDBInstances action.
DBInstance *DBInstance `type:"structure"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s StartDBInstanceOutput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s StartDBInstanceOutput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetDBInstance sets the DBInstance field's value.
func (s *StartDBInstanceOutput) SetDBInstance(v *DBInstance) *StartDBInstanceOutput {
s.DBInstance = v
return s
}
type StopDBClusterInput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// The DB cluster identifier of the Amazon Aurora DB cluster to be stopped.
// This parameter is stored as a lowercase string.
//
// DBClusterIdentifier is a required field
DBClusterIdentifier *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s StopDBClusterInput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s StopDBClusterInput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
func (s *StopDBClusterInput) Validate() error {
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "StopDBClusterInput"}
if s.DBClusterIdentifier == nil {
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("DBClusterIdentifier"))
}
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
return invalidParams
}
return nil
}
// SetDBClusterIdentifier sets the DBClusterIdentifier field's value.
func (s *StopDBClusterInput) SetDBClusterIdentifier(v string) *StopDBClusterInput {
s.DBClusterIdentifier = &v
return s
}
type StopDBClusterOutput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// Contains the details of an Amazon Aurora DB cluster.
//
// This data type is used as a response element in the DescribeDBClusters, StopDBCluster,
// and StartDBCluster actions.
DBCluster *DBCluster `type:"structure"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s StopDBClusterOutput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s StopDBClusterOutput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetDBCluster sets the DBCluster field's value.
func (s *StopDBClusterOutput) SetDBCluster(v *DBCluster) *StopDBClusterOutput {
s.DBCluster = v
return s
}
type StopDBInstanceInput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// The user-supplied instance identifier.
//
// DBInstanceIdentifier is a required field
DBInstanceIdentifier *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
// The user-supplied instance identifier of the DB Snapshot created immediately
// before the DB instance is stopped.
DBSnapshotIdentifier *string `type:"string"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s StopDBInstanceInput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s StopDBInstanceInput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
func (s *StopDBInstanceInput) Validate() error {
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "StopDBInstanceInput"}
if s.DBInstanceIdentifier == nil {
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("DBInstanceIdentifier"))
}
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
return invalidParams
}
return nil
}
// SetDBInstanceIdentifier sets the DBInstanceIdentifier field's value.
func (s *StopDBInstanceInput) SetDBInstanceIdentifier(v string) *StopDBInstanceInput {
s.DBInstanceIdentifier = &v
return s
}
// SetDBSnapshotIdentifier sets the DBSnapshotIdentifier field's value.
func (s *StopDBInstanceInput) SetDBSnapshotIdentifier(v string) *StopDBInstanceInput {
s.DBSnapshotIdentifier = &v
return s
}
type StopDBInstanceOutput struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// Contains the details of an Amazon RDS DB instance.
//
// This data type is used as a response element in the DescribeDBInstances action.
DBInstance *DBInstance `type:"structure"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s StopDBInstanceOutput) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s StopDBInstanceOutput) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetDBInstance sets the DBInstance field's value.
func (s *StopDBInstanceOutput) SetDBInstance(v *DBInstance) *StopDBInstanceOutput {
s.DBInstance = v
return s
}
// This data type is used as a response element in the DescribeDBSubnetGroups
// action.
type Subnet struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// Contains Availability Zone information.
//
// This data type is used as an element in the following data type:
//
// * OrderableDBInstanceOption
SubnetAvailabilityZone *AvailabilityZone `type:"structure"`
// Specifies the identifier of the subnet.
SubnetIdentifier *string `type:"string"`
// Specifies the status of the subnet.
SubnetStatus *string `type:"string"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s Subnet) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s Subnet) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetSubnetAvailabilityZone sets the SubnetAvailabilityZone field's value.
func (s *Subnet) SetSubnetAvailabilityZone(v *AvailabilityZone) *Subnet {
s.SubnetAvailabilityZone = v
return s
}
// SetSubnetIdentifier sets the SubnetIdentifier field's value.
func (s *Subnet) SetSubnetIdentifier(v string) *Subnet {
s.SubnetIdentifier = &v
return s
}
// SetSubnetStatus sets the SubnetStatus field's value.
func (s *Subnet) SetSubnetStatus(v string) *Subnet {
s.SubnetStatus = &v
return s
}
// Metadata assigned to an Amazon RDS resource consisting of a key-value pair.
type Tag struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// A key is the required name of the tag. The string value can be from 1 to
// 128 Unicode characters in length and can't be prefixed with "aws:" or "rds:".
// The string can only contain only the set of Unicode letters, digits, white-space,
// '_', '.', '/', '=', '+', '-' (Java regex: "^([\\p{L}\\p{Z}\\p{N}_.:/=+\\-]*)$").
Key *string `type:"string"`
// A value is the optional value of the tag. The string value can be from 1
// to 256 Unicode characters in length and can't be prefixed with "aws:" or
// "rds:". The string can only contain only the set of Unicode letters, digits,
// white-space, '_', '.', '/', '=', '+', '-' (Java regex: "^([\\p{L}\\p{Z}\\p{N}_.:/=+\\-]*)$").
Value *string `type:"string"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s Tag) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s Tag) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetKey sets the Key field's value.
func (s *Tag) SetKey(v string) *Tag {
s.Key = &v
return s
}
// SetValue sets the Value field's value.
func (s *Tag) SetValue(v string) *Tag {
s.Value = &v
return s
}
// A time zone associated with a DBInstance or a DBSnapshot. This data type
// is an element in the response to the DescribeDBInstances, the DescribeDBSnapshots,
// and the DescribeDBEngineVersions actions.
type Timezone struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// The name of the time zone.
TimezoneName *string `type:"string"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s Timezone) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s Timezone) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetTimezoneName sets the TimezoneName field's value.
func (s *Timezone) SetTimezoneName(v string) *Timezone {
s.TimezoneName = &v
return s
}
// The version of the database engine that a DB instance can be upgraded to.
type UpgradeTarget struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// A value that indicates whether the target version is applied to any source
// DB instances that have AutoMinorVersionUpgrade set to true.
AutoUpgrade *bool `type:"boolean"`
// The version of the database engine that a DB instance can be upgraded to.
Description *string `type:"string"`
// The name of the upgrade target database engine.
Engine *string `type:"string"`
// The version number of the upgrade target database engine.
EngineVersion *string `type:"string"`
// A value that indicates whether a database engine is upgraded to a major version.
IsMajorVersionUpgrade *bool `type:"boolean"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s UpgradeTarget) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s UpgradeTarget) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetAutoUpgrade sets the AutoUpgrade field's value.
func (s *UpgradeTarget) SetAutoUpgrade(v bool) *UpgradeTarget {
s.AutoUpgrade = &v
return s
}
// SetDescription sets the Description field's value.
func (s *UpgradeTarget) SetDescription(v string) *UpgradeTarget {
s.Description = &v
return s
}
// SetEngine sets the Engine field's value.
func (s *UpgradeTarget) SetEngine(v string) *UpgradeTarget {
s.Engine = &v
return s
}
// SetEngineVersion sets the EngineVersion field's value.
func (s *UpgradeTarget) SetEngineVersion(v string) *UpgradeTarget {
s.EngineVersion = &v
return s
}
// SetIsMajorVersionUpgrade sets the IsMajorVersionUpgrade field's value.
func (s *UpgradeTarget) SetIsMajorVersionUpgrade(v bool) *UpgradeTarget {
s.IsMajorVersionUpgrade = &v
return s
}
// Information about valid modifications that you can make to your DB instance.
// Contains the result of a successful call to the DescribeValidDBInstanceModifications
// action. You can use this information when you call ModifyDBInstance.
type ValidDBInstanceModificationsMessage struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// Valid storage options for your DB instance.
Storage []*ValidStorageOptions `locationNameList:"ValidStorageOptions" type:"list"`
// Valid processor features for your DB instance.
ValidProcessorFeatures []*AvailableProcessorFeature `locationNameList:"AvailableProcessorFeature" type:"list"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s ValidDBInstanceModificationsMessage) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s ValidDBInstanceModificationsMessage) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetStorage sets the Storage field's value.
func (s *ValidDBInstanceModificationsMessage) SetStorage(v []*ValidStorageOptions) *ValidDBInstanceModificationsMessage {
s.Storage = v
return s
}
// SetValidProcessorFeatures sets the ValidProcessorFeatures field's value.
func (s *ValidDBInstanceModificationsMessage) SetValidProcessorFeatures(v []*AvailableProcessorFeature) *ValidDBInstanceModificationsMessage {
s.ValidProcessorFeatures = v
return s
}
// Information about valid modifications that you can make to your DB instance.
// Contains the result of a successful call to the DescribeValidDBInstanceModifications
// action.
type ValidStorageOptions struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// The valid range of Provisioned IOPS to gibibytes of storage multiplier. For
// example, 3-10, which means that provisioned IOPS can be between 3 and 10
// times storage.
IopsToStorageRatio []*DoubleRange `locationNameList:"DoubleRange" type:"list"`
// The valid range of provisioned IOPS. For example, 1000-20000.
ProvisionedIops []*Range `locationNameList:"Range" type:"list"`
// The valid range of storage in gibibytes. For example, 100 to 16384.
StorageSize []*Range `locationNameList:"Range" type:"list"`
// The valid storage types for your DB instance. For example, gp2, io1.
StorageType *string `type:"string"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s ValidStorageOptions) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s ValidStorageOptions) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetIopsToStorageRatio sets the IopsToStorageRatio field's value.
func (s *ValidStorageOptions) SetIopsToStorageRatio(v []*DoubleRange) *ValidStorageOptions {
s.IopsToStorageRatio = v
return s
}
// SetProvisionedIops sets the ProvisionedIops field's value.
func (s *ValidStorageOptions) SetProvisionedIops(v []*Range) *ValidStorageOptions {
s.ProvisionedIops = v
return s
}
// SetStorageSize sets the StorageSize field's value.
func (s *ValidStorageOptions) SetStorageSize(v []*Range) *ValidStorageOptions {
s.StorageSize = v
return s
}
// SetStorageType sets the StorageType field's value.
func (s *ValidStorageOptions) SetStorageType(v string) *ValidStorageOptions {
s.StorageType = &v
return s
}
// This data type is used as a response element for queries on VPC security
// group membership.
type VpcSecurityGroupMembership struct {
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
// The status of the VPC security group.
Status *string `type:"string"`
// The name of the VPC security group.
VpcSecurityGroupId *string `type:"string"`
}
// String returns the string representation
func (s VpcSecurityGroupMembership) String() string {
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
}
// GoString returns the string representation
func (s VpcSecurityGroupMembership) GoString() string {
return s.String()
}
// SetStatus sets the Status field's value.
func (s *VpcSecurityGroupMembership) SetStatus(v string) *VpcSecurityGroupMembership {
s.Status = &v
return s
}
// SetVpcSecurityGroupId sets the VpcSecurityGroupId field's value.
func (s *VpcSecurityGroupMembership) SetVpcSecurityGroupId(v string) *VpcSecurityGroupMembership {
s.VpcSecurityGroupId = &v
return s
}
const (
// ApplyMethodImmediate is a ApplyMethod enum value
ApplyMethodImmediate = "immediate"
// ApplyMethodPendingReboot is a ApplyMethod enum value
ApplyMethodPendingReboot = "pending-reboot"
)
const (
// SourceTypeDbInstance is a SourceType enum value
SourceTypeDbInstance = "db-instance"
// SourceTypeDbParameterGroup is a SourceType enum value
SourceTypeDbParameterGroup = "db-parameter-group"
// SourceTypeDbSecurityGroup is a SourceType enum value
SourceTypeDbSecurityGroup = "db-security-group"
// SourceTypeDbSnapshot is a SourceType enum value
SourceTypeDbSnapshot = "db-snapshot"
// SourceTypeDbCluster is a SourceType enum value
SourceTypeDbCluster = "db-cluster"
// SourceTypeDbClusterSnapshot is a SourceType enum value
SourceTypeDbClusterSnapshot = "db-cluster-snapshot"
)